Professional Documents
Culture Documents
Bansallllasiodf Sdif Physics Notes For IIT JEE
Bansallllasiodf Sdif Physics Notes For IIT JEE
BANSAL CLASSES TARGET LIT JEE 2007 XI (PQRS) CALORIMETRY & HEAT TRANSFER CONTENT
S KEYCONCEPT EXERCISE-I EXERCISE-II EXERCISE-III ANSWER KEY
THERMAL Definition of Heat: EXPANSION Heat is a form of energy which is transfer
red between a system and its surroundi ng as a result of temperature difference
only. due to increase in temperature. F or temperature change At change in lengt
h Al = l0a At Area AA= A^At volume AV = V yAt 0 Thermal Expansion : Expansion 1.
Type of thermal expansion Coefficient of expansion (i) Linear (ii) Superficial
(iii) Volume (a) (b) 2. . a = At>0 / 1 A/t Lim A T 0 P = Lim 1 AA AtA0 At y = At>o
v1 AV Lim At 0 For isotropic solids otj = a = a = olids p = otj + a and y = a, +
a + pansion in X , Y and Z directions. rature volume increases so density 2 3 2
2 3 2 3 0 3 a (let) so P =2a and y = 3a For anisotropic s a Here , a and a are
coeffis dfasdfsdfasdfcient of linear ex Variation in density : With increase of
tempe decreases
and vice-versa. H d =(1 + yAt)
Note For solids values of y are generally small so we can write d = d (1-yAt) (u
sing bimomial expansion) (0 (ii) y for liquids are in order of 10~ For water de
n sity increases from 0 to 4C so y is -ve (0 to 4 C) and for 4 C to higher temperat
ur e y is +ve. At 4 C density is maximum. 3. Thermal Stress: Arod of length 1 is
cla mped between two fixed walls with distance 1 . If temperature is changed by
amou nt At then F stress A (area assumed to be constant) 0 0 : so, or A/ strain
= I F/A F/ Y = A/// AAI F =YAa A t 0 0 F AaAt (!l Bansal Classes Calorimetry & H
eat Transfer [3]
4. If a is not constant (i) (a varies with distance) Let a = ax+b Total expansio
n = Jexpansion of length dx i = |(ax + b)dxAt " x 1 (ii) ( a varies with tempear
ture) Let a = f (T) T2 0 dx A/ _ j"a/ dT T i Caution: If a is in C then put Tj an
d T in C. similarly if a is i n K then put Tj and T in K. 2 2 CAL ORIMETR Quantit
y of heat transfered and specific heat Y The amount ofheat needed to incerase th
e temperature of 1 gmofwaterfrom 14.5Cto 1 5.5CatSTP is 1 calorie dQ = mcdT Q = m
[ C dT (be careful about unit of temperatu re, use units according to the given
units of C) T i Heat transfer in phase change 'h Q = rnL L = latent heat of subs
tance in cal/ gm/ C or in Kcal/ kg/ C L = 80 cal/ gm for ic e ice L steam = 5 4 0
C a l / g m (A) (i) (ii) Note: 1.
vibration and collision of medium particles. Steady State : In this state heat a
bsorption stops and temperature gradient throughout the rod dT becomes constant
i.e. = constant. dx Before steady state : Temp of rod at any point changes If s
p ecific heat of any substance is zero, it can be considered always in steady st
at e. Let the two ends of rod of length 1 is maintained at temp Tj and T ( Tj >
T ) dQ i ~ 2 I Thermal current D 1 = K-XH L T 2 2 T T 1 Conduction : Due to HEAT
TRANSFER Ohm's law for Thermal Conduction in Steady State : / Where thermal resi
stance R = K A Th 1 1 2. Differential form of Ohm's Law T-dT dQ dT =KA dT dx dT =
temperature gradient dx dx (!lBansal Classes Calorimetry & Heat Transfer [3]
(B) (Q 1. Heat transfer due to movement ofmedium particles. Radiation: Every bod
y radiates electromagnetic radiation of all possible wavelength at all temp>0 K.
Stefan's Law: Rate of heat emitted by a body at temp T K from per unit area E =
GT J/sec/ m d = P = oAT watt Q Radiation power dl If a body is placed in a surr
ounding of temperature T dQ Convection: 4 2 4 s valid only for black body heat f
rom general body Emissmty or emmisive power e = ~ Iftemp ofbody falls by dT in t
ime dt dT _ _ j4x (dT/dt=rate of cooling) dt ~ m S h e a t f r o m s ^ =cA(T -T
) 4 s 4 Newton's law of cooling Iftemp difference ofbody with surrounding is sma
ll i.e. T = T eA then, dT 4mS -a T ( T - T ) dt dT a ( T - T ) so dt rr3/ 2 s Av
erage form of Newtons law of cooling If a body cools from T j to T in time 51 T
- T _ K T, +T, -T (used generally in objective questions) 5t mS s 2 dt 4. mS (fo
r better results use this generally in subjective) At every temperature (>0K) a
body radiates energy radiations ofall wavelengths. According to Wein's displacem
ent law if the wavelength corresponding to maximum energy is X then X T = b wher
e b = is a constant (Wein's constant) T=temperature of body m m Wein's black bod
y radiation T3>T2>T, ess (!l Bansal Classes
Calorimetry & Heat Transfer [3]
EXERCISE -1 Q. 1 An aluminium container of mass 100 gm contains 200 gm of ice at
- 20C. Heat is added to the system at the rate of 100 cal/s. Find the temperatur
e of the sys tem after 4 minutes (specific heat of ice = 0.5 and L = 80 cal/gm,
specific heat of A1 = 0.2 cal/gm/C) Q. 2 A U-tubefilledwith a liquid ofvolumetric
coefficient of 10 /C lies in a vertical plane. The height of liquid column in th
e left vertic al limb is 100 cm. The liquid in the left vertical limb is maintai
ned at a tempe rature = 0C while the liquid in the right limb is maintained at a
temperature = 1 00C. Find the difference in levels in the two limbs. _5 Q.3 A thi
n walled metal tank of surface area 5m is filled with water tank and contai ns a
n immersion heater dissipating 1 kW. The tank is covered with 4 cm thick lay er
of insulation whose thermal conductivity is 0.2 W/m/K. The outer face of the ins
ulation is 25C. Find the temperature of the tank in the steady state 2 Q.4 A glas
sflaskcontains some mercury at room temperature. It is found that at diffe rent
temperatures the volume of air inside the flask remains the same. If the vo lume
of mercury in the flask is 300 cm , thenfindvolume of the flask (given that coe
fficient of volume expansion of mercury and coefficient oflinear expansion o f g
lass are 1.8 x 10^(C) and9x 10~ (C) respectively) 3 _1 6 _1 Q.5 Q.6 Q.7 A clock pe
ndulum made of invar has a period of 0.5 sec at 20C. If the clock is us ed in a c
limate where average temperature is 30C, aporoximately. How much fast or slow wil
l the clock run in 10 sec. (a =lxlO /C) 6 ilwar -6 A pan filled with hot food coo
ls from 50.1 C to 49.9 C in 5 sec. How long will it take to cool from 40.1 C to 39.
9C if room temperature is 30C? A composite rod made of three rods of equal length
and cross-section as shown in the fig. The thermal conductivities of the materia
ls of the rods are K/2, 5K and K respectively. The end A and end B are at consta
nt temperatures. All heat entering the face A goes out of the end B there being
no loss of heat from the sides of the bar. Find th e effective thermal conductiv
ity of the bar A I Q.8 Q.9 K/2 I 11 5K 2 6 1 K
1 B An iron bar (Young's modulus = 10 N/m , a = 10" /C) 1 m long and 10~ m in are
a is heated from 0C to 100C without being allowed to bend or expand. Find the comp
ress ive force developed inside the bar. 3 2 A solid copper cube and sphere, bot
h of same mass & emissivity are heated to sam e initial temperature and kept und
er identical conditions. What is the ratio of their initial rate of fall of temp
erature? Q. 10 A cylindrical rod with one end in a stream chamber and other end
in ice ca use melting of 0.1 gm of ice/sec. If the rod is replaced with another
rod of hal f the length and double the radius of first and thermal conductivity
of second r od is 1/4 that of first, find the rate of ice melting in gm/sec (!l
Bansal Classes Calorimetry & Heat Transfer [3]
Q.ll Three aluminium rods of equal length form an equilateral triangle ABC. Taki
ng O (mid point of rod BC) as the origin. Find the increase in Y-coordinate per
unit change in temperature ofthe centre ofmass of the system. Assume the length
of the each rod is 2m, and a = 4 v3 x10" /C d 6 Q.12 Three conducting rods of sa
me material and cross-section are shown in figur e. Temperature of A, D and C ar
e maintained at 20C, 90C and 0C. Find the ratio of l ength BD and BC if there is no
heat flow in AB 20C 90'C 0C Q. 13 If two rods of layer L and 2 L having coefficie
nts of linear expansion a a nd 2a respectively are connected so that total lengt
h becomes 3 L, determine the average coefficient of linear expansion of the comp
osite rod. Q.14 A volume of 120 ml of drink (half alcohol + half water by mass)
originally at a temperature of 25C is cooled by adding 20 gm ice at 0C. If all the
ice melts, find the final t emperature of the drink, (density of drink = 0.833
gm/cc, specific heat of alcoh ol = 0.6 cal/gm/C) Q.15 A solid receives heat by ra
diation over its surface at th e rate of 4 kW. The heat convection rate from the
surface of solid to the surrou nding is 5.2 kW, and heat is generated at a rate
of 1.7 kW over the volume of th e solid. The rate of change of the average temp
erature of the solid is 0.5 Cs . Find the heat capacity of the solid. o -1 Q.16
The figure shows the face and interface temperature of a composite slab con tain
ing offour layers oftwo materials having identical thickness. Under steady s tat
e condition, find the value of temperature 6. 20C 10C E -5C -10C 2k 2k k = thermal c
onductivity Q.17 Two identical calorimeter A and B contain equal quantity of wat
er at 20C. A 5 gm piece of metal X of specific heat 0.2 cal g (C) is dropped into
A and a 5 gm piece of metal Y into B. The equilibrium temperature in A is 22C and
in B 23C. Th e initial temperature of both the metals is 40C. Find the specific h
eat of metal Y in cal g" (C)~ 4 _1 1 l Q.18 Two spheres of same radius R have the
ir densities in the ration 8 . 1 and t he ratio of their specific heats are 1 :
4. If by radiation their rates of fall of temperature are same, thenfindthe rati
o of their rates of losing heat. Q.19 I n the square frame of side I of metallic
rods, the corners A and C are maintaine d at Tj and T respectively. The rate of
heat flow from A to Cisa. IfA and D are instead maintained Tj & T respectivleyf
ind,findthe total rate ofheat flow. 2 2 Q.20 A hot liquid contained in a contain
er of negligible heat capacity loses tem perature at rate 3 K/min, just before i
t begins to solidify. The temperature rem ains constant for 30 min, Find the rat
io of specific heat capacity of liquid to
specific latent heat of fusion is in Kr (given that rate of losing heat is const
ant). 1 (!l Bansal Classes Calorimetry & Heat Transfer [3]
Q. 21 A thermostatted chamber at small height h above earth's surface maintained
at 30C has a clock fitted in it with an uncompensated pendulum. The clock design
er correctly designs it for height h, but for temperature of 20C. Ifthis chamber
is taken to earth's surface, the clock in it would click correct time. Find the
coefficient oflinear expansion ofmaterial of pendulum, (earth's radius is R) Q.
2 2 The coefficient of volume expansion of mercury is 20 times the coefficient o
f linear expansion of glass. Find the volume of mercury that must be poured into
a glass vessel ofvolume V so that the volume above mercury may remain constant
at all temperature. Q. 23 Two 50 gm ice cubes are dropped into 250 gm ofwater io
n a glass. Ifthe water was initially at a temperature of 25C and the temperature
of ice -15C. Find the final temperature of water, (specific heat ofice = 0.5 cal/
gm /C and L = 80 cal/gm) Q.24 Water is heated from 10C to 90C in a residential hot
wat er heater at a rate of 70 litre per minute. Natural gas with a density of 1.
2 kg /m is used in the heater, which has a transfer efficiency of 32%. Find the
gas c onsumption rate in cubic meters per hour, (heat combustion for natural gas
is 84 00 kcal/kg) 3 Q.25 A metal rod A of 25cm lengths expands by 0.050cm. When
its temperature is r aised from 0C to 100C. Another rod B of a different metal of
length 40cm expands b y 0.040 cm for the same rise in temperature. A third rod
C of 50cm length is mad e up of pieces of rods A and B placed end to end expands
by 0.03 cm on heating f rom 0C to 50C. Find the lengths of each portion of the co
mposite rod. Q.26 A subst ance is in the solid form at 0C. The amount of heat add
ed to this substance and i ts temperature are plotted in the following graph. If
the relative specific heat capacity of the solid substance is 0.5, find from th
e graph (i) the mass of the substance; (ii) the specific latent heat of the melt
ing process, and (iii) the specific heat of the substance in the liquid state. Q
. 27 One end of copper rod ofuniform cross-section and of length 1.5 meters is i
n contact with melting ice and the other end with boiling water. At what point a
long its length should a te mperature of200C be maintained, so that in steady sta
te, the mass ofice melting i s equal to that of steam produced in the same inter
val oftime? Assume that the w hole system is insulatedfromthe surroundings. Q.28
Two solids spheres are heated to the same temperature and allowed to cool under
identical conditions. Compare : (i) initial rates of fall of temperature, and (
ii) initial rates of loss of he at. Assume that all the surfaces have the same e
missivity and ratios of their ra dii of, specific heats and densities are respec
tively 1 : a, 1 : p, 1 : y. Q.29 A vessel containing 100 gm water at 0C is suspen
ded in the middle of a room. In 1 5 minutes the temperature of the water rises b
y 2C. When an equal amount of ice i s placed in the vessel, it melts in 10 hours.
Calculate the specific heat offusi on ofice. Q. 3 0 The maximum in the energy d
istribution spectrum of the sun is a t 4753 A and its temperature is 6050K. What
will be the temperature of the star whose energy distribution shows a maximum a
t 9506 A. (!l Bansal Classes Calorimetry & Heat Transfer [3]
EXERCISE-II Q. 1 A copper calorimeter of mass 100 gm contains 200 gm of a mixtur
e of ice and water. Steam at 100C under normal pressure is passed into the calori
meter and th e temperature of the mixture is allowed to rise to 50C. If the mass
of the calori meter and its contents is now 330 gm, what was the ratio of ice an
d water in the beginning? Neglect heat losses. Given : Specific heat capacity of
copper = 0.42 x 10 J kg K" , Specific heat capacity of water = 4.2 x 10 J kg^Kr
, Specific he at of fusion of ice = 3.36 x 10 J kg Latent heat of condensation
of steam = 22.5 x 1Q Jkg" 3 _1 x 3 1 5 -1 5 1 Q.2 base and two thin rods each of
length l and coefficient of linear expansion a fo r the two pieces, ifthe dista
nce between the apex and the midpoint ofthe base re main unchanged as the temper
atures /, varied show that 7 2 2 l A n isoscetes triangte is form ed w ith a rod
of length l and coefficient of linea r expansion OTJ for the x 2 Q.3 A solid su
bstance of mass 10 gm at - 10C was heated to - 2C (still in the solid st ate). The
heat required was 64 calories. Another 880 calories was required to ra ise the
temperature ofthe substance (now in the liquid state) to 1C, while 900 ca lories
was required to raise the temperature from -2C to 3C. Calculate the specifi c heat
capacities of the substances in the solid and liquid state in calories pe r kil
ogram per kelvin. Show that the latent heat of fusion L is related to the m elti
ng point temperature t by L = 85400 + 200 t . m m Q.4 (a) (b) Q. 5 Q.6 Q. 7 A st
eel drill making 180 rpm is used to drill a hole in a block of steel. The ma ss
of the steel block and the drill is 180 gm. If the entire mechanical work is use
d up in producing heat and the rate of raise in temperature of the block and the
drill is 0.5 C/s. Find the rate of working of the drill in watts, and the tor qu
e required to drive the drill. Specific heat of steel = 0.1 and J = 4.2 J/cal. U
se ;P = i o A brass rod of mass m = 4.25 kg and a cross sectional area 5 cm in c
reases its length by 0.3 mm upon heatingfrom0C. What amount ofheat is spent for h
eating the rod? The coefficient of linear expansic 1 for brass is 2xl0 /K, its s
pecific heat is 0.39 kJ/kg.K and the density of brass is 8.5 x 10 kg/m . A subm
arine made of steel weighing 10 g has to take 10 g of water in order to submerge
when the temperature of the sea is 10C. How much less water it will have to take
in when the sea is at 15C? (Coefficient of cubic expansion of sea water = 2 x 10
"VC, coefficient of linear expansion of steel = 1.2 x 10- /C) A flow calorimeter
i s used to measure the specific heat of a liquid. Heat is added at a known rate
t o a stream of the liquid as it passes through the calorimeter at a known rate
. T hen a measurement of the resulting temperature difference between the inflow
and the outflow points of the liquid stream enables us to compute the specific
heat of the liquid. A liquid of density 0.2 g/cm flows through a calorimeter at
the rate of 10 cm /s. Heat is added by means of a 250-W electric heating coil, a
nd a temperature difference of 25 C is established in steady-state conditions bet
ween
the inflow and the outflow points. Find the specific heat of the liquid. 2 -5 3
3 9 8 5 3 3 (!lBansalClasses Calorimetry & Heat Transfer [3]
Q.8 Toluene liquid of volume 300 cm at 0C is contained in a beaker an another qua
ntit y of toluene of volume 110 cm at 100C is in another beaker. (The combined vo
lume is 410 cm ). Determine the total volume of the mixture ofthe toluene liquid
s whe n they are mixed together. Given the coefficient of volume expansion y = 0
.001/C and all forms of heat losses can be ignored. Also find the final temperat
ure of the mixture. Q. 9 Ice at -20C isfilledupto height h = 10 cm in a uniform c
ylindr ical vessel. Water at temperature 9C is filled in another identical vessel
upto t he same height h= 10 cm. Now, water from second vessel is poured into fi
rst vess el and it is found that level of upper surface falls through Ah = 0. 5
cm when t hermal equilibrium is reached. Neglecting thermal capacity of vessels,
change in density of water due to change in temperature and loss of heat due to
radiation , calculate initial temperature 0 of water. Given, Density of water,
p = 1 gm cm Density of ice, p. =0.9gm/cm Specific heat of water, s = 1 cal/gm C S
pecific hea t of ice, s = 0.5 cal/gmC Specific latent heat of ice, L = 80 cal/gm
Q. 10 A comp osite body consists of two rectangular plates of the same dimension
s but differe nt thermal conductivities K and Kg. This body is used to transfer
heat between t wo objects maintained at different temperatures. The composite bo
dy can be place d such that flow of heat takes place either parallel to the inte
rface or perpend icular to it. Calculate the effective thermal conductivities K.
and Kj Of the co mposite body for the parallel and perpendicular orientations.
Which orientation will have more thermal conductivity? 3 3 3 w -3 3 w ; A Q. 11
Two identical thermally insulated vessels, each containing n mole of an id eal m
onatomic gas, are interconnected by a rod of length I and cross-sectional a rea
A. Material of the rod has thermal conductivity K and its lateral surface is the
rmally insulated. If, at initial moment (t = 0), temperature of gas in two v ess
els is T, and T (< T ), neglecting thermal capacity of the rod, calculate dif fe
rence between temperature of gas in two vessels as a function of time. 2 } Q. 12
A highly conducting solid cylinder of radius a and length I is surrounded by a
co-axial layer of a material having thermal conductivity K and negligible h eat
capacity. Temperature of surrounding space (out side the layer) is T , which is
higher than temperature of the cylinder. If heat capacity per unit volume of cyl
inder material is s and outer radius of the layer is b, calculate time requi red
to increase temperature of the cylinder from T to T Assume end faces to be t he
rmally insulated. 0 t r Q. 13 A vertical brick duct(tube) is filled with cast ir
on. The lower end of the duct is maintained at a temperature T, which is greater
than the melting point T of cast iron and the upper end at a temperature T whic
h is less than the tempe rature ofthe melting point of cast iron. It is given th
at the conductivity of li quid cast iron is equal to k times the conductivity of
solid cast iron. Determin e the fraction ofthe duct filled with molten metal. Q
.14 Water is filled in a no n-conducting cylindrical vessel of uniform cross-sec
tional area. Height of water column is h and temperature is 0C. Ifthe vessel is e
xposed to an atmosphere havi ng constant temperature of- 0C (< 0C) at t = 0, calcu
late total height h ofthe col umn at time t .Assume thermal conductivity ofice t
o be equal to K.Density ofwate r is p and that of ice is p.. Latent heat offusio
n ofice isL. m 2 0 ffi (!l Bansal Classes Calorimetry & Heat Transfer [3]
Q.15 A lagged stick of cross section area 1 cm and length 1 m is initially at a
temperature of 0C. It is then kept between 2 reservoirs of tempeature 100C and 0C.
Specific heat capacity is 10 J/kgC and linear mass density is 2 kg/m. Find 100C oc
(a) temperature gradient along the rod in steady state. (b) total heat absorbed
by the rod to reach steady state. Q.16 A cylindrical block of length 0.4 m an ar
ea of cross-section 0.04m is placed coaxially on a thin metal disc ofmass 0.4 k
g and ofthe same cross-section. The upper face of the cylinder is maintained at
a constant temperature of 400K and the initial temperature of the disc is 300K.
I f the thermal conductivity of the material of the cylinder is 10 watt/m-K and
th e specific heat of the material of the disc in 600 J/kg-K, how long will it t
ake for the temperature of the disc to increase to 350K? Assume, for purposes of
ca lculation, the thermal conductivity of the disc to be very high and the syst
em t o be thermally insulated except for the upper face of the cylinder. 2 2 Q.1
7 A copper calorimeter of negligible thermal capacity isfilledwith a liquid. The
mass of the liquid equals 250 gm. A heating element of negligible thermal ca pa
city is immersed in the liquid. It is found that the temperature of the calori m
eter and its contents risesfrom25C to 30C in 5 minutes when a or rent of 20.5 amp
ere is passed through it at potential difference of 5 volts. The liquid is throw
n off and the heater is again switched on. It is now found that the temperature
ofthe calorimeter alone is constantly maintained at 32C when the current through
the heater is 7A at the potential difference 6 volts. Calculate the specific he
a t capacity ofthe liquid. The temperature ofthe surroundings is 25C. Q.18 A soli
d copper sphere cools at the rate of 2.8C per minute, when its temperature is 127C
. Find the rate at which another solid copper sphere oftwice the radius lose its
t emperature at 327C, ifin both the cases, the room temperature is maintained at
27C . Q.19 A calorimeter contains 100 cm of a liquid of density 0.88 g/cm in whi
ch a re immersed a thermometer and a small heating coil. The effective water equ
ivale nt of calorimeter, thermometer and heater may be taken to be 13 gm. Curren
t of 2 A is passed through the coil. The potential difference across the coil is
6.3 V and the ultimate steady state temperature is 55C. The current is increased
so th at the temperature rises slightly above 55C, and then it is switched off.
The cal orimeter and the content are found to cool at the rate of 3.6C/min. (a) F
ind the specific heat of the liquid. (b) The room temperature during the experim
ent was 10C. If the room temperature rises to 26C, find the current required to ke
ep the l iquid at 55C. You may assume that Newton's law is obeyed and the resista
nce of th e heater remains constant. 3 3 Q.20 End A of a rod AB of length L = 0.
5 m and of uniform cross-sectional area i s maintained at some constant temperat
ure. The heat conductivity of the rod is k = 17 J/s-rnK. The other end B of this
rod is radiating energy into vacuum and th e wavelength with maximum energy dens
ity emitted from this end is XQ = 75000 A. If the emissivity of the end B is e =
1, determine the temperature of the end A. Assuming that except the ends, the r
od is thermally insulated. Q.21 A wire of l ength 1.0 m and radius 10" m is carr
ying a heavy current and is assumed to radia te as a blackbody. At equilibrium t
emperature of wire is 900 K while that of the surroundings is 300 K. The resisti
vity of the material of the wire at 300 K is n x 10" O-m and its temperature coe
fficient of resistance is 7.8 x 10' /C. Find t he current in the wire, [a = 5.68
x 10" w/m K ]. 3 2 8 3 8 2 4 (!l Bansal Classes Calorimetry & Heat Transfer [3]
Q.22 The temperature distribution of solar radiation is more or less same as tha
t of a black body whose maximum emission corresponds to the wavelength 0.483 ja
m . Find the rate of change of mass due to radiation. [Radius of Sun = 7.0 x 10
m] 8 Q.23 A black plane surface at a constant high temperature T , is parallel t
o ano ther black plane surface at constant lower temperature T . Between the pla
tes is vacuum. In order to reduce the heatflowdue to radiation, a heat shield co
nsisti ng oftwo thin black plates, thermally isolated from each other, it placed
betwee n the warm and the cold surfaces and parallel to these. After some time
stationa ry conditions are obtained. By what factor r) is the stationary heatflo
wreduced due to the presence of the heat shield? Neglect end effects due to thef
initesize of the surfaces. h ; Q.24 The shell of a space station is a blackened
sphere in which a temperature T = 500K is maintained due to operation of applian
ces of the station. Find the te mperature of the shell if the station is envelop
ed by a thin spherical black scr een of nearly the same radius as the radius of
the shell. Blackened envelop Q.25 A liquid takes 5 minutes to coolfrom80C to 50C.
How much time will it take to coolfrom60C to 30C ? The temperature of surrounding
is 20C. Use exact method. Q .2 6 Find the temperature of equilibrium of a perfect
ly black disc exposed normally to the Sun's ray on the surface of Earth. Imagine
that it has a nonconducting b acking so that it can radiate only to hemisphere
of space. Assume temperature of surface of Sun = 6200 K, radius of sun = 6.9 * 1
0 m, distance between the Sun a nd the Earth = 1.5 x lo m. Stefan's constant = 5
.7 x i0~ W/m .K . What will be t he temperature ifboth sides of the disc are rad
iate? s 11 s 2 4 (!l Bansal Classes Calorimetry & Heat Transfer [3]
Q. 1 Q.2 The temperature of 100 gm of water is to be raised from 24 C to 90 C by a
dding ste am to it. Calculate the mass of the steam required for this purpose. [
JEE '96] T wo metal cubes A & B of same size are arranged as shown in figure. Th
e extreme e nds of the combination are maintained at the indicated temperatures.
The arrange ment is thermally insulated. The coefficients of thermal conductivi
ty of A & B a re 300 W/mC and 200 W/mC respectively. After steady state is reached
the temperatu re T of the interface will be . [JEE' 96] 2 EXERCISE - III o A B
Q.3 A double pane window used for insulating a room thermally from outside consi
sts of two glass sheets each of area 1 m and thickness 0.01 m separated by a 0.0
5m t hick stagnant air space. In the steady state, the room glass interface and
the g lass outdoor interface are at constant temperatures of 27C and 0C respective
ly. Ca lculate the rate of heat flow through the window pane. Also find the temp
erature s of other interfaces. Given thermal conductivities of glass and air as
0.8 and 0.08 W nr'K- respectively. [JEE'97] 1 Q. 4 The apparatus shown in the fi
gure consists of four glass columns connected by ho rizontal sections. The heigh
t of two central columns B & C are 49 cm each. The t wo outer columns A & D are
open to the atmosphere. A & C are maintained at a tem perature of 95 C while the
columns B & D are maintained at 5 C. The height of the liquid in A & D measured f
rom the base line are 52.8 cm & 51 cm respectively. De termine the coefficient o
fthermal expansion ofthe liquid, [JEE '97] A 95 C 95 Q.5 Q.6 Q.7 A spherical black
body with a radius of 12 cm radiates 450 W power at 500 K . If the radius were
halved and the temperature doubled, the power radiated in watt would be : (A) 22
5 (B) 450 (C) 900 (D) 1800 Earth receives 1400 W/m of solar pow er . If all the
solar energy falling on a lens of area 0.2 m is focussed on to a block of ice of
mass 280 grams, the time taken to melt the ice will be minutes. (Latent heat of
fusion of ice = 3.3 x 10 J/kg) [JEE '97] 2 2 5 A solid body X of heat capacity
C is kept in an atmosphere whose temperature is T = 300K. At time t = 0, the tem
perature of X is T = 400K. It cools according to Newton's law of cooling. At tim
e tj its temperature is found to be 3 5 OK. At t his time t the body X is connec
ted to a larger body Y at atmospheric temperature T , through a conducting rod o
qj and q g/s be the rate of melt ing of ice in the two cases respectively. The
ratio q /q is (A) 1/2 (B) 2/1 (C) 4/1 (D) 1/4 [JEE'2004 (Scr.)] Q.21 Liquid oxyg
en at 50 K is heated to 300 K at c onstant pressure of 1 atm. The rate of heatin
g is constant. Which of the followi ng graphs represents the variation of temper
ature with time? a 2 9 T Temp.f Temp.f , Temp.f Temp. (A) [JEE' 2004 (Scr.)] Q.2
2 A cube of coefficient of linear expansion a is floating in a bath containing a
liquid of coefficient of volume expansion yt When the tem perature is raised by
AT, the depth upto which the cube is submerged in the liqu id remains the same.
Find the relation between a and y showing all the steps. [J EE 2004] Q.23 One e
nd of a rod of length L and cross-sectional area A is kept in a furnace of tempe
rature T The other end of the rod is kept at a temperature T . The thermal condu
ctivity ofthe material of the rod is K and emissivity ofthe r od is e. It is giv
en that T = T + AT where AT Insulated T , T being the temperat ure ofthe surroun
dings. IfAT oc (Tj - T ), Furance T Rod * L * find the proporti onality constant
. Consider that heat is lost only by radiation Insulated at the end where the te
mperature ofthe rod is T . [JEE 2004] s s b r 2 2 s s s s f
Time (B) Time (C) Time (D) Time 2 (!l Bansal Classes Calorimetry & Heat Transfer
[3]
Q. 24 Three graphs marked as 1,2,3 representing the variation of maximum emissiv
e power and wavelength of radiation of the sun, a welding arc and a tungsten fi
l ament. Which ofthe following combination is correct (A) 1-bulb, 2 > welding arc
, 3 > sun (B) 2-bulb, 3 welding arc, 1 - sun (C) 3-bulb, 1 welding arc, 2 sun (D)
1 -> welding arc, 3 sun [JEE' 2005 (Scr)] Q. 25 In which of the following phe n
omenon heat convection does not take place (A) land and sea breeze (B) boiling o
fwater (C) heating ofglass surface due to filament ofthe bulb (D) air around th
e furance [JEE' 2005 (Scr)] Q.26 2 litre water at 27C is heated by a 1 kW heater
in an open container. On an average heat is lost to surroundings at the rate 160
J/s. The time required for the temperature to reach 77C is (A) 8 min 20 sec (B)1
0min (C)7min (D)14min [JEE' 2005 (Scr)] Q.27 A spherical body of area A and emis
sivity e = 0.6 is kept insid e a black body. What is the rate at which energy is
radiated per second at tempe rature T (A) 0.6 a AT (B)0.4aAT (C)0.8cAT (D)l.OaA
T [JEE 2005 (Scr)] Q. 28 1 cal orie is the heat required to increased the temper
ature of 1 gm ofwater by 1 C fro m (A) 13.5Cto 14.5C at 76 mm of Hg (B) 14.5Cto 15.5C
at760mmofHg (C) 0C to 1C at 760 mm of Hg (D) 3C to 4C to 760 mm of Hg [JEE* 2005 (Sc
r)] 4 4 4 4 (!l Bansal Classes Calorimetry & Heat Transfer [3]
ANSWER KEY Q.i Q.5 Q.9 Q.12 Q.16 Q.20 Q.24 Q.27 Q.I Q.4 Q.7 25.5C 5 sec slow /6M/
3 .71. 7/2 5C 1/90 104.2 10.34 cm Q.2 Q.6 0.1 cm 10 sec EXERCISE -1 Q.3 Q.7 65C 1
5K/16 Q.ll Q.14 Q.18 Q.22 Q.4 Q.8 2000 cm 10, 000 N 3 Q.10 0.2 Q.13 5 a/3 Q.17 2
7/85 Q.21 h/5R Q.25 10cm, Q.28 ctPy: 4 x 10 m/C 4C Q.15 1000 J (C )2:1 Q.19 (4/3) 3
Y/20 Q.23 0 C -6 0 1 :a 2 Q.29 80 k cal/kg 1 1 1 -1 Q.30 3025 K Q.3 800 cal kg" K
, 1000 cal kg" K 1 : 1.26 (a) 37.8 J/s (Watts), (b) 2.005 N-m Q.5 25 kJ 5000 J/C
kg Q.8 decrease by 0.75 cm ,25C . K +K 2K K Q.10 K > Kj_, K| = K 1 B 3 T A R V A
B ; x EXERCISE-II Q.6 Q.9 Q.ll t m m m 9.02 x 10 gm 45C 5 \n i (T, ~T )e "3 R J 2
2 ( 4KAt N | Q.12 a s. ^log 2 (-) l0geV. 0 ~ 2 J T T Q 1 3 k(T - T ) I k(T -T )
+ (T -T ) 1 Q.14 h + 0
Q.17 21000 Jkg^Kr Q.20 T = 423 K a 1 - JBL V / \ 1 \ Pi f L 12k;6t Q.15 (a) 100 C
/m, (b) 1000 J Q.18 9.72C/min Q.21 36A 0 x Q.16 166.3 sec 9 1 Q.19 (a)0.42 cal/gmC
, (b) 1.6A Q.23 r| = 3 Q.25 10 minutes Q.I Q.4 Q.7 12 gm e Q.22 ~dt = 5.06 x 10
kg/s Q.24 T" = 500 = 600 K Q.26 T = 420 K, T = 353.6 K Q.2 60 C EXERCISE-III Q.3
Q.6 0 41.53 Watt; 26.48 C;0.55C 5.5 min Q.14 0.5 kg Q.19 B Q.24 A 2 x 10^ C Q.5 D
log 2 ; T = 300 + 50 exp. k= Q.9 B, D Q.10 Q.16 A Q.17 Q.21 C Q. 26 A Q.22 Q.27
Q.8 D Q.15 A Q.20 D Q.25 C (!l Bansal Classes [LC tj A Q.ll B Q.12 B Q.13 D A Q.
18 (a) 595 watt/m , ( b ) T * 4 2 0 K K y,= 2a s Q.23 4eaLTf+K A Q.28 B 2 0 Calo
rimetry & Heat Transfer [3]
BA TARGET IIT JEE 2007 XII (ALL) COHTENTS KEYCONCEPTS EXERCISE-1 EXERCISE-II EXE
RCISE-III ANSWER KEY
KEY 1. CAPACITANCE O F A N 0 ( CONCEPTS C = 471 e e R in a medium ISOLATED SPHER
ICAL CONDUCTOR : C = 47C G R in air This sphere is at infinite distance from all
the conductors. The Capacitance C = 4T E R exists between the surface of the sp
here & earth . 7 Q It consists of tw o concentric spherical shells as shown infi
gure.Here capacitance of region betwe en the two shells is C and that outside th
e shell is C . We have 471 e ab C = an d C = 471 e b b-a Depending on connection
, it may have different combinations of C, and -C . t 2 n 2 Q 2 SPHERICAL CAPACI
TOR : 3. PARALLEL PLATE CAPACITOR : If two parallel plates each of area A & sepa
rated by a distance d are charged wi th equal & opposite charge Q, then the syst
em is called a parallel plate capacit or & its capacitance is given by, ^ S)6 A
C = ; .in a medium C= with air as medi um r (i) UNIFORM DI-ELECTRIC M E D I U M
: This result is only valid when the electricfieldbetween plates of capacitor is
c onstant, (ii) M E D I U M PARTLY A I R : C = U d-lt-i r So A When a di-electr
ic slab of thickness t & relative permittivity e is l l l l intr oduced between
the plates of an air capacitor, then the distance between P3 the plates is effec
tively reduced by irrespective ofthe position of BSSSSii V ^rJ the di-electric sl
ab . (iii) COMPOSITE M E D I U M : c= GA I I -rl r2 0 r3
4. CYLINDRICAL CAPACITOR : It consist oftwo co-axial cylinders ofradii a& b, the
outer conductor is earthed . The di-electric constant ofthe mediumfilledin the
space between the cylinder i s Farad e . The capacitance per unit length is C =
2ne-ne m in r y r (fe^Bansal Classes CAPACITANCE 121
CONCEPT o r VARIATION OF PARAMETERS: 6. e kA , ifeither ofk, A or d varies in th
e region between As capacitance ofa para llel plate capacitor isC = the plates,
we choose a small dc in between the plate s and for total capacitance of system.
dx -, If all dC's are in parallel C = } d C If all dC's are in series 1 e k(x)A
(x) 0 T J 0 COMBINATION (i) OF CAPACITORS SERIES : : In this arrangement all the
capacitors when uncharged get the same charge Q but the potential difference ac
ross each will differ (if the capacitance are unequal ). 1 +1 1 1 + + + 1 (ii) CA
PACITORS I N rIMHh v, v, v, Q Q Q C| C2 C3 C 3 When one plate of each capacitor
is connected to the positive terminal of the ba ttery & the other plate of each
capacitor is connected to the negative terminals of the battery, then the capaci
tors are said to be in parallel connection. The capacitors have the same potenti
al difference, V but the charge on each one is d ifferent (if the capacitors are
unequal). eq. C CAPACITORS I N PARALLEL : I + C 2 + C 3 + +c
s 1 jC3,y 1 Q + v % 1Cj.V c,,v % ENERGY Capacitance C, charge Q & potential diff
erence V; then energy stored is 1 U = -1 CV = QV = 1 Q . This energy is stored i
n the electrostatic field set up in the di-electric - medium between the conduct
ing plates of the capacitor . 2 2 STORED IN A CHARGED CAPACITOR : HEAT PRODUCED
IN SWITCHING IN CAPACITIVE CIRCUIT Due to charge flow always some amount of heat
is produced when a switch is close d in a circuit which can be obtained by ener
gy conservation as Heat = Work done by battery - Energy absorbed by capacitor. 9
. 10 When two charged conductors of capacitance C & C at potential V & V respect
ively are connected by a conducting wire, the charge flows from higher potential
cond uctor to lower potential conductor, until the potential of the two condens
ers be comes equal. The common potential (V) after sharing of charges; C,V C V q
+ V =n etnet charge _ C,j + q capacitance C C+C charges after sharing qj = C,'V
& q = C V. In this process energy is lost in the connecting wire C C (V,-V ) as
heat. T his loss of energy is U - U = ^ r ^ g s 2 } 2 2 1+ 2 2 SHARING O F CHAR
GES : 2 2 t 2 2 2 2 2 initial eal
<Bansal Classes (i) The energy of a charged conductor resides outside the conduct
or in its EF, w here as in a condenser it is stored within the condenser in its
EF. (ii) The ene rgy of an uncharged condenser = 0 . (iii) The capacitance of a
capacitor depends only on its size & geometry & the di-electric between the cond
ucting surface .( i.e. independent ofthe conductor, like, whether it is copper,
silver, gold etc) REMEMBER : CAPACITANCE
Q.i A solid conducting sphere ofradius 10 cm is enclosed by a thin metallic shel
l of radius 20 cm. A charge Q.2 EXERCISE # I Q.3 Q.4 q = 20pC is given to the i
nner sphere. Find the heat generated in the process, t he inner sphere is connec
ted to the shell by a conducting wire The capacitor eac h having capacitance C =
2pF are connected with a .CO, battery of emf 30 V as sh own infigure.When the s
witch S is closed. Find (a) the amount of chargeflownthro ugh the battery (b) th
e heat generated in the circuit (c) the energy supplied by the battery '30V (d)
the amount of chargeflownthrough the switch S The plates o f a parallel plate ca
pacitor are given charges +4Q and -2Q. The capacitor is the n connected across a
1 & 3 are joined by another conductor. The junction of 1 & 3 and the plate 4 are
conne cted to a source of constant e.m.f. V . Find; the effective capacity of t
he syst em between the terminals ofthe source. the charges on plates 3 & 5. Give
n d = di stance between any 2 successive plates & A= area of either face of each
plate . 5 0 Apotential difference of300 Vis applied between the plates of a pla
ne capacitor spaced 1 cm apart. A plane parallel glass plate with a thickness of
0.5 cm and a plane parallel paraffin plate with a thickness of 0.5 cm are place
d in the spac e between the capacitor platesfind: Intensity of electricfieldin e
ach layer. The drop ofpotential in each layer. The surface charge density of the
charge on cap acitor the plates. Given that: k = 6, k =2 glass paraffin A charg
e 200pC is imparted to each of the two identical parallel plate capacitor s conn
ected in parallel. At t =0, the plates of both the capacitors are 0.1 m ap art.
The plates of first capacitor move towards each other with relative velocit y 0.
001 m/s and plates of second capacitor move apart with the same velocity. Fi nd
the current in the circuit at the moment. A parallel plate capacitor has plat es
with area A & separation d . A battery charges the plates to a potential diff e
rence ofV . The battery is then disconnected & a di-electric slab of constant K
& thickness d is introduced. Calculate the positive work done by the system (cap
acitor + slab) on the man who introduces the slab. 0 Q.6 Q.7 A capacitor of cap
acitance C is charged to a potential V and then isolated. A sm all capacitor C i
s then chargedfromC , discharged & charged again, the process b eing repeated n
times. The potential ofthe large capacitor has now fallen to V. Find the capacit
ance of the small capacitor. If V = 100 volt, V=35volt, find the value ofn for C
= 0.2 pF & C = 0.01075 pF . Is it possible to remove charge on
C this way? 0 0 0 0 0 0 Q. 8 When the switch S in thefigureis thrown to the left
, the plates of capacitors C, acquire a potential difference V. Initially the ca
pacitors C C are uncharged. T hw switchis now thrown to the right. What are thef
inalcharges q q & q on the cor responding capacitors. 2 3 p 2 3 .V TLPI Ic T (fe
^Bansal Classes CAPACITANCE 121
Q.9 (1) (ii) (lii) A parallel plate capacitor with air as a dielectric is arrang
ed horizontally. Th e lower plate isfixedand the other connected with a vertical
spring. The area of each plate is A. In the steady position, the distance betwe
en the plates is d . When the capacitor is connected with an electric source wit
h the voltage V, a n ew equilibrium appears, with the distance between the plate
s as d Mass of the up per plates is m. Find the spring constant K. What is the m
aximum voltage for a g iven K in which an equilibrium is possible ? What is the
angularfrequencyofthe o scillating system around the equilibrium value dj. (take
amplitude of oscillatio n d ) 0 r { Q.10 An insolated conductor initiallyfreefr
omcharge is charged by repeated conta cts with a plate which after each contact
has a charge Q due to some mechanism. If q is the charge on the conductor after
the first Qq operation, prove that the maximum charge which can be given to the
conductor in this way is ~ Q.ll A parallel plate capacitor is filled by a di-ele
ctric whose relative permit tivity varies with the applied voltage according to
the law = aV, where a = 1 pe r volt. The same (but containing no di-electric) ca
pacitor charged to a voltage V = 156 volt is connected in parallel to thefirst"n
on-linear" uncharged capacito r. Determine thefinalvoltage V across the capacito
rs. f Q.12 A capacitor consists oftwo air spaced concentric cylinders. The outer
ofrad ius b isfixed,and the inner is of radius a If breakdown ofair occurs atfi
eldstre ngths greater than E^, show that the inner cylinder should have (i) radi
us a = b /e ifthe potential of the inner cylinder is to be maximum (ii) radius a
= b/Ve i f the energy per unit length of the system is to be maximum. ,.JT 5V-r
46F =n 5V :d=6nf Q. 13 Find the charge flown through the switchfromAto B when it
is closed. Q.14 Figure shows three concentric conducting spherical shells with
inner and outer s hells earthed and the middle shell is given a charge q. Find t
he electrostatic e nergy of the system stored in the region I and II. 6mF Jr~ Q.
15 The capacitors shown infigurehas been charged to a potential difference of V
volts, so that it carries a charge CV with both the switches Sj and S remainin g
open. Switch Sj is closed at t=0. At t=R,C switch Sj is opened and S is closed
. Find the charge on the capacitor at t=2RjC + R^C. 2 2 s, Hi s, Q.16 In the fig
ure shown initially switch is open for a long time. Now the switc
14 The area ofthe plates of a parallel plate capacitor is A and the gap betwe e
n them is d. The gap is filled with a non-homogeneous dielectric whose dielectr
ic constant varies with the distance 'y'fromone plate as : K = ^sec(7ty/2d), whe
re X is a dimensionless constant. The capacitance ofthis capacitor is (A) 7ie ^
A/2d (B)7rs XA/d (C) 27te k A/d (D)none 0 0 0 Q.15 A capacitor stores 60pC char
ge when connected across a battery. When the ga p between the plates is filled w
ith a dielectric, a charge of 120pC flows throug h the battery. The dielectric c
onstant of the material inserted is: i (A) 1 (B) 2 . (C) 3 (D) none (fe Bansal C
lasses
Question Bank on Capacitance [13]
Q.16 In the above question, if the initial capacitance ofthe capacitor was 2pF,
the amount of heat produced when the dielectric is inserted. (A) 3600pJ (B) 2700
pJ (C) 1800pJ (D)none Q.17 A capacitor of capacitance C is initially charged to
a potential difference of V volt. Now it is connected j to a battery of 2V with
o pposite polarity. The ratio of heat generated to the final energy stored in th
e capacitor will be (A) 1.75 (B) 2.25 (C) 2.5 (D) 1/2 AQ.18 Three plates A B and
C each of area 0.1 m are separated by 0.885 Bmmfromea ch other as shown in the
figure. A10 V battery is used to Ccharge the system. Th e energy stored in the s
ystem is (A)lpJ (B) 10 pj (C) 10' pJ (D) 10" pJ 2 _1 2 3 hH 10V Q.19 A parallel
plate capacitor of capacitance C is connected to a battery and i s charged to a
potential difference V. Another capacitor of capacitance 2C is si milarly charge
d to a potential difference 2V. The charging battery is now discon nected and th
e capacitors are connect in parallel to each other in such a way th at the posit
ive terminal of one is connected to the negative terminal of the oth er. Thefina
lenergy I ofthe configuration is 2 5 (A)zero (D)-CV ( B ) - CV (C)yCV 2 2 2 Q.20
A 2 pF capacitor is charged to a potential = 10V. Another 4 pF capacitor is cha
rged to a potential = 20V. The two capacitors are then connected in a single loo
p, with the positive plate of one ; connected with negative plate of the oth er.
What heat is evolvecl in the circuit? (A) 300 pj (B) 600 pJ (C) 900 pj (D)45 0p
J Q.21 The plates S and T of an uncharged parallel plate capacitor are connect e
d across a battery. The battery is then disconnected and the charged plates are
now connected in a system as shown in thefigure.The system shown is in equilibr
ium. All the strings are insulating and massless. The magnitude of charge on one
ofthe capacitor plates is: [Area ofplates=A] -^svtvw 4mgA (A) pmgA (B) 77777777
7777777777ininiii (C)VmgA (D) 2mgA e m 0 Q.22 In the circuit shown, the energy
stored in 1 pF capacitor is (A) 40 pJ (B) 64 pJ (D)none (C) 32 pJ 3nF I^ HF Q.23
Four metallic plates arearranged as shown in thefigure.Ifthe distance betwe en
each plate then capacitance of the given system between points A and B is (Gi ve
n d A) 2s A I - , _ S pA sA / , I (A) d (B) 3s A 4s o A (C) d (D) n 0n 1 0 (fe B
ansal Classes Question Bank on Capacitance [13]
Q.24 What is the equivalent capacitance of the system of capacitors between A &
B W~6c .A 2. B Q.25 From a supply ofidentical capacitors rated 8 pF, 250 V, the
minimum numbe r of capacitors required to form a composite 16 pF, 1000 Vis : (A)
2 (B) 4 (C) 1 6 (D) 32 cP (B) 1.6 C (C)C (D) None . Q.26 The minimum number ofca
pacitors each of3 pF required to make a circuit with an equivalent capacitance 2
.25 pF is (A) 3 (B)4 (C)5 (D)6 0 Q.29 A capacitor of capacitance 1 pF withstands
the maximum voltage 6 kV while a capacitor of 2 pF withstands the maximum volta
ge 4 kV. What maximum voltage wil l the system of these two capacitor withstands
if they are connected in series? (A) lOkV (B)12kV (C) 8 kV (D)9kV Q.30 Four ide
ntical plates 1,2,3 and 4 are plac ed parallel to each other at equal distance a
s shown in the figure. Plates 1 and 4 are joined together and the space between
2 and 3 is filled with a dielectric of dielectric constant k = 2. The capacitanc
e of the system between 1 and 3 & 2 and 4 are Cj and C2 C, respectively. The rat
io is : C-2 3 (B)l (A)-: (D) 5 ( C ) Q.27 The capacitance (C) for an isolated co
nducting sphere of radius (a) is give n by 47ts a. Ifthe sphere is enclosed with
an earthed concentric sphere. The rat io ofthe radii of the spheres being n the
n the (n-1) Icapacitance of such a sphe re will be increased by a factor n (n-1)
(A)n (D) a. n (B) (n-1) (C) n -' Q.28 T wo capacitor having capacitances 8 pF a
nd 16 pF have breaking voltages 20 V and 80 V. They are combined in series. The
maximum charge they can store individuall y in the combination is (A) 160 pC (B)
200 p,C (C) 1280 p,C (D) none ofthese y Q.31 # In the circuit shown infigure,th
e ratio ofcharges on 5pF and 4pF capacitor is: ( A) 4/5 (B)3/5 (C) 3/8 (D) 1/2 3
jiF JL 5(iF 4nF 6V
Q.32 In the circuit shown, a potential difference of 60V is applied across AB. T
he potential difference between the point M and N is (A) 10 V (B) 15V (C) 20 V
( D) 30 V 60V B I Li r - Cr ^ h r 2d H (fe Bansal Classes Question Bank on Capac
itance [13]
v 15 (B) y p F (D)none Q, 3 4 A capacitor ofcapacitance 1 pF with stands the max
im um voltages 6 KV while a capacitor of capacitance 2.0 pF with stands the maxi
mum voltage = 4KV. if the two capacitors are connected in series, then the ~t. t
wo capacitors combined can take up a maximum voltage of V (A) 2.4 KV (B) 5 KV (C
) 9 KV (D) 10 KV t Q. 3 3 Find the equivalent capacitance across A& B (A) y pf (
C) 15 pF 28 23NF 7(iF 'h 1 IpF B !3pF A 12pF LIK 1 1 UiF lOtlF Q. 3 5 The diagram sho
ws four capacitors with capacitances and break down voltag es as mentioned. What
should be the maximum value of the external emf source suc h that no capacitor
breaks down?[Hint: First of allfindout the break down voltag es of each branch.
After that compare them. ] (A)2.5kV (B)10/3kV (C)3kV (D) 1 kV 3C;lkV H 2C;2kV H 7
C;lkV 3C;2kV Q.36 Three capacitors 2 pF, 3 pF and 5 pF can withstand voltages to
3V, 2V and I V respectively. Their series combination can withstand a maximum v
oltage equal t o (A) 5 Volts (B) (31/6) Volts (C) (26/5) Volts (D)None Q.37 Find
equivalent cap acitance across AB (all capacitances in pF) (A) 20p F y (B) 9pF
(C) 48 pF (D) No ne B Q. 3 8 Three long concentric conducting cylindrical shells
have radii R, 2R and 2^2 R. Inner and outer shells are connected to each other.
The capacitance acros s middle and inner shells per unit length is: (D) None (C
) 2/n2 /2 n Q.39 A char ged capacitor is allowed to discharge through a resistan
ce 2Q by closing the swi tch S at the instant t = 0. At time t = In 2 ps, the re
ading of the ammeter fall s halfof its initial value. The resistance ofthe ammet
er equal to (A) 0 (B)2Q (C )o (D) 2MQ Q. 40 A capacitor C = 100 pF is connected t
o three resistor each of re sistance 1 kf2 and a battery of emf 9V. The switch S
has been closed for long ti me so as to charge the capacitor. When switch S is
opened, the capacitor dischar ges with time constant (A) 33 ms (B) 5 ms (C) 3.3
ms (D) 50 ms (A) (B) In 2 a I 6^0 0.5 |JF Hh IkSl ikn rH^n Q. 41 A capacitor C =
100 pF is connected to three resistors each of resist ance 1 kW and AW ikn A ba
ttery of emf 9V. The switch S has been closed for long time so as to charge the
pvWv ikn ^ t { capacitor. When switch S is opened, the c apacitor discharges with
time constant. LAWvH S ^ O \ \ (A) 33 ms (B) 5 ms (C) 3 .3 ms (D) 50 ms ikn
t * ' r/r (fe Bansal Classes Question Bank on Capacitance [13]
Q. 42 In the transient shown the time constant of the circuit is: V (A)~RC (B)-R
C (D)|RC 2 2 2 Q.43 In the circuit shown in figure C,=2C . Switch S is closed at
time t=0. Let ij and i be the currents flowing through Cj and C at any time t,
then the ratio i ^ (A) is constant (B) increases with increase in time t (C) dec
reases with inc rease in time t (D)firstincreases then decreases Q.44 Find heat
produced in the capacitors on closing the switch S 20V 0.0002 (B) 0.0005 J (A) 0
.00075J (D) zero L \ (C) If c I I I I c VWWv R Q.45 In the circuit shown, when th
e key k is pressed at time t = 0, which of the following statements about curren
t I in the resistor AB is true K r| I ^IOOOSI IT ^V V (A) I = 2mA at all t 2V .100
0Q (B) I oscillates between 1 mA and 2mA (C) 1 = 1 mA at all t i (D) At t = 0,1
= 2mA and with time it goes to 1 mA Q.46 In the R-C circuit shown in thefigureth
e total energy of 3.6 *10~ J is dissipated in t he 10 Q resistor when the switch
S is closed. The initial charge on the capacito r is 60 ' !0Q (A) 60 pC (B) 120
pC (C) 60 ^ pC (D) ^ pC 3 c C = 0.5(JF Q. 47 A charged capacitor is allowed to
discharge through a resistor by closing the key at the instant t =0. At the inst
ant t = (In 4) ps, the readin g ofthe.ammeter yijc falls halfthe initial value.
The resistance of the ammeter is equal to (A) 1 MO (B) ID (C)2H (D) 2MQ Hg)- - W
2W Q Q.48 In the circuit shown, the cell is ideal, with emf= 15 V. Each resistan
ce is of 3Q. The potential difference across the capacitor is (A) zero (B)9V <y
(C) 1 2 V (D) 15 V 10nF 4|iF 6uF +i In the circuit shown infigure,four capacitor
s are connected to a battery. Q.49 T he equivalent capacitance ofthe circuit is
(A) 25 pF (B) 6 pF (C) 8.4 pF Question No. 49 to 52 (4 questions) 5HFV (D)none T
OY (fe Bansal Classes Question Bank on Capacitance [13]
charge on the capacitor (B) potential difference across the capacitor (C) energy
of the capacitor (D) energ y density between the plates. Q.23 Each plate ofa pa
rallel plate capacitor has a charge q on it. The capacitor is now connected to a
battery. Now, (A) the facin g surfaces of the capacitor have equal and opposite
charges. (B) the two plates of the capacitor have equal and opposite charges. (
C) the battery supplies equal and opposite charges to the two plates. (D) the ou
ter surfaces ofthe plates hav e equal charges. Q. 24 Following operations can be
performed on a capacitor: X connect the capacitor to a battery of emf E. Y - di
sconnect the battery Z - rec onnect the battery with polarity reversed. W - inse
rt a dielectric slab in the c apacitor (A) In XYZ (perform X, then Y, then Z) th
e stored electric energy remai ns unchanged and no thermal energy is developed.
(B) The charge appearing on the capacitor is greater after the action XWY than a
fter the action XYW. (C) The el ectric energy stored in the capacitor is greater
after the action WXY than after the action XYW. (D) The electricfieldin the cap
acitor after the action XW is th e same as that after WX. Q.25 A parallel plate
capacitor is charged and then dis connectedfromthe source of potential differenc
e. Ifthe plates of the condenser a re then moved farther apart by the use of ins
ulated handle, which one of the fol lowing is true? (A) the charge on the capaci
tor increases (B) the charge on the capacitor decreases (C) the capacitance of t
he capacitor increases (D) the poten tial difference across the plate increases
(fe Bansal Classes Question Bank on Capacitance [13]
Q.26 Aparallel plate capacitor is charged and then disconnected from the source
steady E.M.F. The plates are then drawn apart farther. Again it is connected to
the same source. Then: (A) the potential difference across the plate increases,
while the plates are being drawn apart. (B) the charge from the capacitorflowsin
to the source, when the capacitor is reconnected. (C) more charge is drawn to t
h e capacitor from the source, during the reconnection. (D) the electric intensi
ty between the plates remains constant during the drawing apart of plates. Q.27
Wh en a parallel plates capacitor is connected to a source of constant potential
di fference, (A) all the charge drawnfromthe source is stored in the capacitor.
(B) all the energy drawnfromthe source is stored in the capacitor. (C) the pote
ntia l difference across the capacitor grows very rapidly initially and this rat
e dec reases to zero eventually. (D) the capacity of the capacitor increases wit
h the increase of the charge in the capacitor. Q.28 When two identical capacitor
s are charged individually to different potentials and connected parallel to eac
h othe r, after disconnecting themfromthe source: (A) net charge on connected pl
ates is less than the sum of initial individual charges. (B) net charge on conne
cted pl ates equals the sum of initial charges. (C) the net potential difference
across them is differentfromthe sum ofthe individual initial potential differen
ces. (D) the net energy stored in the two capacitors is less than the sum ofthe
initial individual energies. Q. 29 Aparallel plate capacitor of plate area A and
plate s eperation d is charged to potential difference V and then the battery i
s disconn ected. A slab of dielectric constant K is then inserted between the pl
ates ofthe capacitor so as tofillthe space between the plates. If Q, E and W den
ote respec tively, the magnitude of charge on each plate, the electricfieldbetwe
en the plat es (after the slab is inserted) and the work done on the system, in
question, in the process of inserting the slab, then e AV s KAV V AV 1 - 1 K Q.
3 0 A parall el plate capacitor is connected to a battery. The quantities charge
, voltage, el ectricfieldand energy associated with the capacitor are given by Q
, V , E and U respectively. A dielectric slab is introduced between plates of c
apacitor but b attery is still in connection. The corresponding quantities now g
iven by Q, V, E and U related to previous ones are (A)Q>Q (B) V > V (C) E > E (D
)U<U Q.31 A par allel-plate capacitor is connected to a cell. Its positive plate
A and its negat ive plate B have charges +Q and -Q respectively. A third plate
C, identical to A and B, with charge +Q, is now introduced midway between A and
B, parallel to th em. Which of the following are correct? 3Q (A) The charge on t
he inner face of B is now (B) There is no change in the potential difference betw
een A and B. (C) T he potential difference between A and C is one-third of the p
otential difference betweenB and C. (D) The charge on the inner face ofA is now
Q/ 2. Q.32 Two capa citors Cj = 4 pF and C = 2pF are charged to same potential V
7 xlO " 12397x10 cm (B) A (Q m (D) 12397x10 cm (A) AE AE AE Q.2 In each ofthe fo
llowin g questions two statements are given as Assertion A and Reason R. Examine
the st atements carefully and answer the questions according to the instruction
s given below: (A) if both A and R are correct and R is the correct reason ofA.
(B) if b oth A and R are correct and R is not the correct reason of A. (C) if A
is correc t and R is wrong. (D) if A is wrong and R is correct. JE) if both A an
d R are wr ong. (a) Assertion A. The gases which are isosteres diffuse at the sa
me rate und er similar conditions. Reason R. Diffusion and effusion do not follo
w the same l aw. (b) Assertion A. The value of van der Waal constant b is higher
for N than f or NH . Reason R. NH molecules are associated withH-bonds. Asserti
on A. K.E. of all the gases approach zero as their temperature approach zero kel
vin. (c) Reaso n R Molecular motion ceases at absolute zero. Assertion A. Helium
shows only pos itive deviationfromideal behaviour. (d) Reason R Helium is chemi
cally inert nobl e gas. Q.L -10 10 10 2 3 3 ^Bansal Classes RAkslia Bandhan Holi
days Assignment [3]
Q.3 V vs T curves at differnt pressure P j and P for an ideal gas are shown belo
w. V Which one ofthe following is correct? (A) Pj > P (B) P < P 2 2 t 2 (C)Pj=P
Q.4 Q.5 2 (D) 1 1 ]_ 2 Q.6 Q.7 Q.8 Q.9 The units of compressibility factor are (
A) atm L~ (B)atnr (C)L(D)unitless Which of the following statements is most appr
opriate for a real gas. (A) Force of at traction between the molecules exists at
low pressure only. (B) Force of attract ion between the molecules exists at hig
h pressure only. (C) Force of attraction between the molecules affect gaseous pr
operty at high temperature. (D) Force of attraction between the molecules affect
gaseous property at low pressure. Which among the following has rate of effusio
n less than the moist air? (A) He (B) Dry air (C)NH (D) Heavy hydrogen The behav
iour ofreal gas is generally depicted by plotting which ofthe following paramete
r vs pressure (A) critical volume (B)dens ity (C)T /T (D)V /V The 'atom utilizat
ion' is obtained by dividing molar mass of the desired product by the sum ofthe
molar masses of all substances produced acc ording to the reaction equations. Th
e "E factor" is the amount (in kg) of by pro duct per kg of products. Calculate
"atom utilization" and "E factor". Identify X , the desired product. (NH ) S 0 +
MnS0 + 21^0 > (NH ) S0 + X + 2H2S0 D~ & Calcu late molality of a solution conta
ining 72 gm Buckminster Fullerene (C ) in one k g water. l 3 ldd real real ideal
4 2 2 8 4 4 2 4 4 60 3(s) 3 3 Q. 10 The density of CaC0 is 2.71 g/cm . What is
molarity of solid CaC0 . STRENGTHENING CONCEPTS Q.ll If in the hydrogen atom P.E
. at co is chosen to be 13.6eVthenwhatwouldbeP.E . &K.E. of e~ in the first Bohr
orbit. Q.12 The value of (nj +1^) and (n - n ) f or He ion in atomic spectrum a
re 4 and 8 respectively. Identify the series and f ind v of corresponding line i
n emission sp. 2 2 + ^Bansal Classes RAkslia Bandhan Holidays Assignment [3]
itU 0 BRAIN TEASERS <W (0,0) /o,o\ Q. 13 For a polymerisation reaction involving g
aseous reactant and product A ^ nB, 'A'undergoes polymerisation to an extent of'
a' as degree of polymerisation at a temp Tj. From this info calculate the follow
ing in terms ofn and a. (a) P /P ratio where P is the pressure with the given ex
tent o f polymerisation and P is the pressure before polymerisation when tempera
ture wa s T in a constant volume container (b) V /V ratio in a chamber where V i
s volume when polymerisation occurs and V is before polymerisation. Both volume
measured under similar condition ofpressure & temperature. (c) Vapour density of
the mixt ure ifthe molecular weight ofAis M . (d) Compare rate of effusions befo
re polyme risation and after the polymerisation. / T () T 0 0 T 0 T 0 A o o0 y^r
-JU ir 0 o o0 U* QUK^ij f-Uy - ^ 6t .^WL L-^rUMMX = yPf, fD ' RECALLING VARIOUS
CONCEPTS AT ONE PLACE Q.14 Calculate IE of oxygen atom. 8 Q.15 Calculate percen
tage dissociation ofH 0 into H & OH at 298 K of a neutral w ater sample [pH=7] 2
+ Q.16 A compound gave on analysis of 60 g sample 44.8 / ofa gas at STP which t
urn s lime water milky & other gas which increased the wt, of white. CuS0 crysta
l by 36 gm. Deduce the molecular formula of the compound. 4 Q.17 Elemental As, a
poison that kills humans and animal pests may be obtained b y reacting As 0 wit
h carbon to give As and CO. Compute masses ofAs and CO formed if 49.5 gm ofAs 0
reacts completely with 7.20 gm of C. [Given at. wt. As = 75] 'jj> + Co ) 2 3 2 3
M
CALCULATION SKILL Q.18 Under identical experimental conditions which ofthe follo
wing pairs ofgases will be the most easy to separate by using diffusion process
(A) H and D (B) U F and U F (C) C0 and C H (D) 0 and N Q.19 A solution of palmit
ic acid (M =256) i n benzene contains 5 gm acid per litre. When this solution is
dropped on surface , C H gets evaporated and acid forms aunimolecular layer on
the surface. Ifwe wi sh to cover an area 5000 cm withunimolecularfilm.What volum
e of solution in ml s hould be used? Area covered by one molecule of acid is 0.3
2 nm , 2 2 235 6 238 6 2 3 8 2 2 6 6 2 2 Q.20 105 ml ofpure water at 4 C is satur
ated with NH gas, producing a solution of density 0.9 gm/ml. Ifthis solution con
tains 3 0% ofNH by wt., calculate its vol ume. 3 3 ^Bansal Classes RAkslia Bandh
an Holidays Assignment [3]
SITTING-II @ EASY LIFE @ Q.l (a) (b) Q.2 In each ofthe following questions two s
tatements are given as Assertion A and Re ason R. Examine the statements careful
ly and answer the questions according to t he instructions given below: (A) if b
oth A and R are correct and R is the correc t reason ofA. (B) if both A and R ar
e correct and R is not the correct reason of A. (C) if A is correct and R is wro
ng. (D) ifA is wrong and R is correct. (E) if both A and R are wrong. Assertion
A. a-particles have quite less penetrating po wer. Reason R a-particles are di-p
ositive ions having appreciable mass. Assertio n A. Isotopes of an element can b
e identified with the help of a mass spectrogra ph. Reason R Amass spectrograph
can differentiate between ions having different charge to mass (e/m) ratio. If t
he mean free path is I at one bar pressure then its value at 5 bar pressure, if
temperature is kept constant. (A) 5 / (B) 11 (C) j (D)/. Open end manometer was
connected to gas chanber. The Hg level stood 15 mm higher in the open end as com
pared to the end connected to gas chamber. If th e atmospheric pressure is 101.3
kPa. The gas pressure in k Pa is Q.3 (A) 103.3 (B) 101.3 2 (C) 94.3 (D) 115.3 (
D)N 2 Q.4 Whichofthefollowinggashashighestvalueof'a'? (A) Ne (B)0 (C) Clj Q.5 Th
ree gases of densities A(0.82),B (0.26), C (0.51) are enclosed in a vessel of 4L
capacity. Pick up the correct statement assuming ideal gas behaviour: I. Gas A
will tend to lie at the bottom II. The number of atoms ofvarious gases A B, C ar
e same III. The gases will diffuse to form homogeneous mixture IV The average ki
netic energy of each gas is same (A) I, IV (B) only ID (C) III, IV (D) I, in R a
tio of C and C of a gas 'X' is 1.4. The number of atoms of the gas 'X' present i
n 11.2 litres of it at STPwillbe p u Q.6 Q.7 Q.8 (A) 6.02 x 10 3 23 (B) 1.2 x 10
23 (C) 3.01 x io 23
(D) 2.01 x 10 23 The moles o f 0 required for reacting with 8960 mLg of ammonia
at STP is (A) 5 XNH + y 0 ^ aNO + M^O is 2 2 (B) 2.5 (C)l (D) 0.5 Find the numbe
r of spectral lines in Paschen series emitted by atomic H, when el ectron is exc
ited from ground state to n energy level returns back. th ^Bansal Classes RAksli
a Bandhan Holidays Assignment [3]
0 0 0 0 B R A I N TEASERS W 0< 0 Q. 9 For calculating lattice energy of an ionic
crystal, the variation of potential e nergy was studied following . t n B the re
lation, Uw(r) = a e n A + r r where 'a ', 'e', n, Aand x are constants depending
upon type of crystal and 'r' is the di stance between the ions. Calculate expre
ssion ofB in terms ofgiven constant for a stable crystal lattice given that ions
are at a distance of r . Calculate pote ntial energy ofthe crystal in terms ofr
and other given constants. Plot an appro priate graph ofU (r) v/s r indicating
r in the graph. 2 2 0 0 0 (g) (g) (g) Q.10 For a gaseous reaction; A - > B + 2C
total pressure at various timefromthe start ofreaction is studied. Complete the
following table and calculate degreee of dissociation ofAattime t = 50 min. Give
n that reaction is 40% complete at tim e t =100 min. and 100% complete after a l
ong time. What can be said about averag e of dissociate ofAbetween 0 to 50 min &
between 50 to 100 min. Can you give a p ossible reason for this. lime t = 0 min
t = 50min. t-lOOmin. t = oo 100 mm 150 m m P(Total) 100 mm P A where P and P ar
e the partial pressures ofAand B. A B PB RECALLING VARIOUS CONCEPTS AT ONE PLACE
7 Q.ll A beam of some kind of particle of velocity 2.1 x 10 m/s is scattered by
a gold (z = 79) foil. Find specific charge ofthis particle (charge/mass) if the
di stance of closest approach is 2.5 x 10~ m. 14 Q. 12 Show that for large valu
e ofprincipal Q. no. the frequency of an electron rotating in adjacent energy le
vels of H-atom and the radiant frequency for trans ition between these value all
approach the same value. Q.13 Find molality ofmerc urous ion, ifthe concentrati
ch that after l osing contact at A and flying through the air, the particle will
reach at the po int B. Also find the normal reaction between particle and path
at A. Q.10 A ring of mass m slides on a smooth vertical rod. A light string is a
ttached to the ri ng and is passing over a smooth peg distant a from the rod, an
d at the other end ofthe string is a mass M (> m). The ring is held on a level w
ith the peg and re leased: Show that it first comes to rest after falling a dist
ance: =0 2mMa M Q 0 0 A M Q.5 Q.ll Ablock ofmass m is held at rest ona smooth ho
rizontal floor. Alight fiictio nless, small pulley isfixedat aheight of 6 mfromt
he floor. Alight inextensible s tring of length 16 m, connected with Apasses ove
r the pulley and another identic al block B is hungfromthe string. Initial heigh
t of B is 5mfromthe floor as 6m s hown in Fig. When the system is releasedfromre
st, B starts to move vertically do wnwards and A slides on the floor towards rig
ht. (i) Ifat an instant string make s an angle 0 with horizontal, calculate rela
tion between velocity u ofA and v of B Calculate v when B strikes the floor. M 2
-m2 l i l t 7 777 <! Bansal Classes Particle Dynamics [13]
Q.12 A small block can move in a straight horizontal linea along AB. Flash light
s from ^ one side projects its shadow on a vertical wall which has horizontal c
r oss section as a circle. Find tangential & normal acceleration of shadow of th
e block on the ^ v=! const./ wall as a function of time ifthe velocity of the bl
oc k is constant (v). <0 Tp View \\u\u o Q.13 In fig two identical springs, each
wi th a relaxed length of 50cm and a spring constant of 500N/m, are connected b
y a short cord of length 1 Ocm. The upper string is attached to the ceiling, a b
ox t hat weighs 100N hangsfromthe lower spring. Two additional cords, each 85cm
long, are also tied to the assembly; they are limp (i.e. slack). (a) If the shor
t cor d is cut, so that the box then hangsfromthe springs and the two longer cor
ds, do es the box move up or down? (b) How far does the box move before coming t
o rest again? Q.14 The small pendulum ofmass m is suspendedfroma trolley that ru
ns on a horizontal rail. The trolley and pendulum are initially at rest with 9 =
0. Ift he trolley is given a constant acceleration a=g determine the maximum an
gle 9 th rough which the pendulum swings. Also find the tension T in the cord in
terms of 9. Q.15 A weightless rod of length I with a small load of mass m at th
e end is hinged at point A as shown in the figure and occupies a strictly vertic
al positi on, touching a body of mass m M. A light j erk sets the system in moti
on. For wh at mass ratio M/m will the rod form an o M angle a = re/6 with the ho
rizontal at the moment of the separationfromthe body? TTwmvmr What will be the v
elocity u o f the body at this moment? Friction should be neglected. Q.16 The bl
ocks are of mass 2 kg shown is in equilibrium. At t = 0 right spring in fig (i)
and right st ring in fig (ii) breaks. Find the ratio of instantaneous accelerati
on of blocks? //////w/. itmuLuq^m) um max 2 kg figure (i) Q.l <! Bansal Classes A
smooth semicircular wire track of radius R isfixedin a vertical plane. One end o
f a massless spring of natural length (3R/4) is attached to the lowest point O o
f the wire track. A small ring of mass m, which can slide on the track, is att a
ched to the other end of the spring. The ring is held stationary at point P suc
h that the spring makes an angle of 60 with the vertical. The spring constant K=m
g/R. Consider the instant when the ring is released and (i) draw the free body
d iagram of the ring. (ii) determine the tangential acceleration of the ring and
t he normal reaction. [JEE 96] Q.2 Two blocks of mass m,=l 0kg and m =5kg conne
cte d to each other by a massless inextensible string of length 0.3m are placed
alon g a diameter of a turn table. The coefficient offrictionbetween the table a
nd m, is 0.5 while there is nofrictionbetween m and the table. The table is rota
ting with an angular velocity of 1 Orad/sec about a vertical axis passing throug
h its centre. The masses are placed along the diameter ofthe table on either sid
e oft he centre O such that m, is at a distance of 0.124mfromO. The masses are o
bserve d to be at rest with respect to an observer on the turn table. (i) Calcul
ate the frictionalforce on m, (ii) What should be the minimum angular speed ofth
e turn t able so that the masses will slipfromthis position. (iii) How should th
e masses be placed with the string remaining taut, so that there is nofrictional
force act ing on the mass m,. [JEE 97] 2 2 EXERCISE-III 2 kg figure (ii) Particl
e Dynamics [13]
Q.3 A small block of mass m slides along a smooth frictional track as shown in t
he f ig. (i) If it starts from rest at P, what is is the resultant force acting
on it at Q? (ii) At what height above the bottom of the loop should the block be
rele ased so that the force it exerts against the track at the top of the loop
equals its weight. [REE 97] . At rest 5R Q.4 Q.5 A force F = - K (y i + xj) wher
e K is a positive constant, acts on a particle mo ving in the x-y plane. Startin
gfromthe origin, the particle is taken along the p ositive x-axis to the point (
a,0) and then parallel to the y-axis to the pint (a ,a). The total work done by
the force F on the particle is [JEE 98] (A) - 2Ka (B ) 2Ka (C) - Ka (D) Ka A sto
ne is tied to a string of length I is whirled in a ve rtical circle with the oth
er end of the string at the centre. At a certain insta nt of time, the stone is
at its lowest position and has a speed u. The magnitude of the change in its vel
ocity at it reaches a position where the string is hori zontal is [JEE98] 2 2 2
2 (A) - 2gl) ( B ) V 2 Jl ( C ) 4(u2 - gl) (D) (u2-gl) I A Q.6 A particle is sus
pended verticallyfroma point O by an inextensible massless Q.7 string of length
L. A vertical line AB is at a distance L/8fromO as shown. The o bject given a ho
rizontal velocity u. At some point, its motion ceases T -L/8 to b e circular and
eventually the object passes through the line AB. At the instant of crossing AB,
its velocity is horizontal. Find u. [JEE'99,10] A long horizonta l rod has a be
ad which can slide along its length, and initially placed at a dis tance L from
one end ofA of the rod. The rod is set in angular motion about A wi th constant
angular acceleration a. If the coefficient offrictionbetween the rod and the bea
d is p and gravity is neglected, then the time after which the bead starts slipp
ing is [JEE'2000] (A)^ (B)^ (C)^= (D) infinitesimal Q.8 A small block is shot in
to each of the four tracks as shown below. Each of the t racks risks to the same
height. The speed with which the block enters the track is the same in all case
s. At the highest point ofthe track, the normal reaction is maximum in [JEE(Scr)
'2001 ] (A) (B) (D)
Q.9 An insect crawls up a hemispherical surface very slowly (see the figure). Th
e co efficient offrictionbetween the insect and the surface is 1/3. Ifthe line j
oini ng the centre of the hemispherical surface to the insect makes an angle a
with t he vertical, the maximum possible value of a is given by [JEE(Scr.)'2001
] (A) c ot a = 3 (B) tan a = 3 (C) sec a = 3 (D) cosec a = 3 A small ball ofmass
2x 10~ Kg having a charge of 1 pc is suspended by a string of length 0. 8m. Ano
ther ide ntical ball having the same charge is kept at the point of suspension.
Determine the minimum horizontal velocity which should be imparted to the lower
ball so t hat it can make complete revolution. [JEE'2001 ] 3 <! Bansal Classes Pa
rticle Dynamics [13]
Q.ll A simple pendulum is oscillating without damping. When the displacement oft
he bob is less that maximum, its acceleration vector a is correctly shown in [J
E E (Scr.)'2002] ///////// ///////// ///////// /mm (A) (C) Q.12 A particle, whic
h is constrained to move along the x-axis, is subjected to a force in the same d
irection which varies with the distance x of the particle x of the particle from
the origin as F(x) = - kx + ax . Here k and a are positive constants. For x > 0
, the functional form of the potential energy U (x) of the particle is [JEE (Scr
.)'2002] 2 U(x) U(x) U(x)f X U(x) X (A) (B) (C) (D) X Q.13 An ideal spring with
spring-constant k is hung from the ceiling and a block of mass M is attached to
its lower end. The mass is released with the spring in itially unstretched. Then
the maximum extension in the spring is [JEE (Scr.)'200 2] (A) 4 Mg/k (B) 2 Mg/k
(C)Mg/k (D)Mg/2k Q.14 A spherical ball of mass m is kep t at the highest point
in the space between two fixed, concentric spheres Aand B (see figure). The smal
ler sphere A has a radius R and the space between the two spheres has a width d.
The ball has a diameter veiy Sphere B slightly less than d. All surfaces are fr
ictionless. The ball is given a gentle push (towards the right in the figure). T
he angle made by the radius vector ofthe ball with Sphere A the upward vertical
is denoted by 9 (shown in the figure). [JEE' 2002] (a) Ex press the total normal
reaction force exerted by the spheres on the ball as a fu nction of angle 9. (b
) Let N and N denote the magnitudes of the normal reaction force on the ball exe
rted by the spheres A and B, respectively. Sketch the varia tions of N and N as
functions of cos0 in the range 0 < 9 < T by T drawing two se parate graphs in yo
ur answer book, taking cos9 on the horizontal axes. Q.15 In a region of only gra
vitational field of mass 'M' a particle is shifted from Ato B via three differen
t paths in the figure. The work done in different paths are W ,, W , W respectiv
ely then [JEE (Scr.)'2003] (A) W, = W = W (B) W, = w > w (C) W j > W~ > w (D) Wi
< W < W Q.16 A particle ofmass m, moving in a circular path of radius R with a
constant V2 V L speed v is located at point (2R, 0) at time t =
0 and a man starts moving with a velocity v, along the +ve y-axisfromorigin at t
ime t=0. (0,0) Calculate the linear momentum ofthe particle w.r.t. the man as a
function oftime. [JEE 2003] Q.17 A particle is placed at the origin and a force
F = kx is acting on it (where k is a positive constant). If U(0)=0, the graph o
f U(x) versus x will be (where U is the potential energy function) a B A B 2 3 2
3 2 3 3 2 3 2 U(x) U(x) U(x) U(x) (A) (B) (C) (D) [JEE' 2004(Scr)] <! Bansal Cla
sses Particle Dynamics [13]
CENTRE OF MASS MOMENTUM & COLLISION The action of force with respect to time is
defined in terms of Impulse, that is, 1= j*Fdt = mv -mv =Ap f i In the absence o
f a net external force, the momentum of a system is conserved. d P ^ =Fe*t = 0 p
= Pj + p + + p = constant 2 N Graphically, impulse is the area under the F-t gra
ph o ~t 1. 2. (i) (ii) (iii) 3. 1. Collision is a kind of interaction between tw
o or more bodies which come in cont act with each other for a very short time in
terval. Types of collision: Elastic and Inelastic Collisions may be either elast
ic or inelastic. Linear momentum is conserved in both cases. A perfectly elastic
collision is defined as one in whic h the total kinetic energy of the system is
conserved. In an inelastic collision , the total kinetic energy of the system c
hanges. In a completely inelastic coll ision, the two bodies couple or stick tog
ehter. Coefficient of Restitution : It is defined as the ratio of the velocity o
f separation to the velocity of approac h of the two colliding bodies. rel. velo
city of separation rel. velocity of appr oach For a perfectly elastic collision,
e = 1 For an inelastic collision, 0 < e < 1 For completely inelastic collision,
e = 0 Note that the velocity of approach and the velocity of separation are alw
ays taken along the normal to the strikin g surface. y CENTRE OF MASS f r. Discr
ete System : The position vector of the ce ntre of mass is m r,+m r + +m r 3 y'H
T HI3 ni4 c m!+m + m where fj, r ,..., r a re the position vectors of masses m
m ,..... m respectively. The components of t he position vector of centre of mas
s are defined as 1 2 2 n n r 2 n \ 2 n p
2 n X c = Zmixi . M ' Y c _ Zm.yi . M ' Z _ Zmizi M 2. Continuous system: The ce
ntre of mass of a continuous body is defined as r = fr dm M In the component for
m c c J Jfx dm ' M v = M Jfydm ' c z c = Jfzdm M <! Bansal Classes Particle Dynamic
s [13]
3. (i) (ii) (iii) (iv) (v) (vi) 4. Centre of Mass of Some Common Systems : A sys
tem oftwo point masses. The centre of mass lie closer to the heavier mass. A cir
cular cone h yc 4 A semi-circular r ing 2R y = ; x =0 TI c c c I* m,+m M nii+mj
im 2 A semi-circular disc 4R yc = 3tt ;x = o A hemispherical shell R y c = 7 ;xc
=0 A solid hemisphere 3R 0! X* 0' (iii) (iv) Motion of the centre of mass : Velo
city: The instantaneous velocity of the centr e of mass is defined as mv v X i i
M Acceleration: The acceleration of the centre of mass is defined as Xmia> c = M
Momentum : The total momentum of a system of particles is p = Mv Kinetic Energy
: The kinetic energy of a system ofparticles c onsisits of two parts. K = K + K'
1 2 where K - Mv , kinetic energy due to motio n of c.m. relative to the fixed
origin O, c a c c c c 5. <! Bansal Classes Vand K' = 2_, ^1 i i2> kinetic energy
of the particles relative to the c.m. Note that the term K' may involve translat
ional, rotational or vibrational energies relative to the centre of mass. Newon'
s Laws of a system of particles: The first and second laws of motion for a syste
m of particles are modified as: First law: The centre of mass of an isolated sys
tem is at rest or moves with constant velo city. Second law: The net external fo
rce acting on a system of total of mass M i s related to the acceleration of cen
tre of mass of the system. I S ext M < l m v
cm Particle Dynamics [13]
Q.l A hemisphere ofradius R and ofmass 4m isfreeto slide with its base on a smoo
th h orizontal table. A particle ofmass m is placed on the top ofthe hemisphere.
Find the angular velocity ofthe particle relative to hemisphere at an angular d
ispla cement 0 when velocity of hemisphere has become v. (CENTRE OF MASS MOMENTU
M & COLLISION) EXERCISE-I A man whose mass is m kg jumps vertically into airfrom
a sitting position in whic h his centre of mass is at a height hjfromthe ground.
When his feet are just abo ut to leave the ground his centre of mass is h from
the ground andfinallyrises t o h when he is at the top ofthe jump, (a) What is t
he average upward force exert ed by the ground on him? (b) Find work done by nor
mal reactionfromground. Q.3 In thefigureshown, each tiny ball has mass m, and th
e string has length L. One of the ball is imparted a velocity u, in the position
shown, in which the initial d istance between the balls is l / V3 . The motion
ofball occurs on smooth horizon tal plane. Find the impulse ofthe tension in the
string when it becomes taut. Q. 4 Two trolleys A and B arefreeto move on a leve
lfiictionlesstrack, and are init ially stationary. A man on trolley A throws a b
ag of mass 10 kg with a horizonta l velocity of 4 m/s with respect to himself on
to trolley B of mass 100 kg. The combined mass of trolley A (excluding bag) and
the man is 140 kg. Find the ratio of velocities of trolleys A and B, just after
the bag lands on trolley B. 2 3 Q.2 Q.5 Q.6 Q.7 A bob of mass m attached with a
string of length I tied to a point on ceiling is released from a position when
its string is horizontal. At the bottom most poin t of its motion, an identical
mass m gently stuck to it. Find the anglefromthe v ertical to which it rises. Tw
o balls of equal masses are projected upward simult aneously, one from the groun
d with speed 50 m/s and otherfroma 40 m high tower w ith initial speed 30 m/s. F
ind the maximum height attained by their centre of ma ss. 3 blocks of mass 1kg e
ach kept on horizontal smooth ground are connected by 2 taut strings of length/a
s shown. Bis pulled with constant ' L-r-' acceleration a in direction shown. Find
the relative velocity of A & C just before striking. <> A B 0 a Q. 8 Q. 9 Find
the distance of centre of mass from O of a composite solid cone and sol cyl inde
r made of same material. Two blocks ofmass 3 kg and 6 kg respectively are pl ace
d on a smooth horizontal surface. They are connected by a light spring. Initi al
ly the spring is unstretched and the velocity of 2 m/s is imparted to 3 kg blo c
k as shown. Find the maximum 2.0m/s-6OT555W5V 6kg 3kg velocity of 6 kg block du
ring subsequent motion. i h I m h it / um m 11 h i n t n Q.10 Two planks each of
mass m and length L are connected by africtionless,massle ss hinge as shown in t
he figure. Initially the system is at rest on a level fiic tionless surface. The
vertical plank falls anticlockwise and fmaly comes to rest on the top ofthe hor
izontal plank. Find the displacement ofthe hinge till the t wo planks come in co
ntact. <! Bansal Classes Particle Dynamics
[13]
Q.ll 2 bodies m, & m of mass 1 and 2 kg respectively are moving along x-axis und
er (' ) the influence of mutual force only. The velocity of their centre of mas
s at a given instant is 2 m/s. The x coordinate of m is plotted against time. Th
e n plot the x coordinate of m against time. (Both are initially located at orig
in ) 2 x n m t 2 2 t(in sec) Q.12 Two masses, nm and m, start simultaneouslyfrom
the intersection oftwo straig ht lines with velocities v and nv respectively. It
is observed that the path of their centre of mass is a straight line bisecting
the angle between the given st raight lines. Find the magnitude of the velocity
of centre of inertia, (here 6 = angle between the lines) Q.13 Two blocks of equa
l masses m are releasedfromthe top of a smooth fixed wedge as shown in the figur
e. Find the magnitude ofthe acc eleration of the centre of mass of the two block
s. Q.14 From a uniform circular disc of radius R, a square is cut out with radiu
s R as its diagonal. Find the ce ntre of mass of remainder is at a distance, (fr
om the centre) Q.15 A sphere of m ass m j in motion hits directly another sphere
of mass m, at rest and sticks to it, the total kinetic energy after collision i
s 2/3 oftheir total K.E. before co llision. Find the ratio ofm,: m . 2 Q.16 Two
bodies of same mass tied with an inelastic string of length I lie toget her. One
of them is projected vertically upwards with velocity ^/6g/ . Find the maximum
height up to which the centre of mass of system of the two masses rises. Q.17 Di
sc A of mass m collides with stationary disk B of mass 2m as shown in fi gure. F
ind the value of coefficient of restitution for which the two disks move in perp
endicular direction after collision. Q.18 A force time (F -1) graph for l inear
motion is shown in the following figure. The segments shown are circular. Find t
he linear momentum gained between 4 and 8 second.(Assume S.I. units) Q.19 A plat
n between an y surfaces of contact. The small sphere is now released. Find the c
oordinates of the centre of the large sphere when the smaller sphere reaches the
other extrem e position. [IIT 96] Q.4 A body of mass 5kg moves along the x axis
with a veloci ty 2m/s. A second body of mass 1 Okg moves along the y axis with
a velocity V3 m /s. They collide at the origin and stick together. Calculate (i)
the final veloc ity ofthe combined mass after collision (ii) the amount of heat
liberated in the collision. [REE 96] Q.5 An isolated particle of mass m is movi
ng in a horizonta l plane (x-y) along the x-axis at a certain height above the g
round. It suddenly explodes into twofragmentsof masses m/4 and 3m/4. An instant
later the smaller fragment is at y = +15 cm. The largerfragmentat this instant i
s at [IIT 97] (A) y = -5cm (B)y = + 20cm (C)y = + 5cm (D)y = -20cm Q.6 A cart is
moving along +x d irection with a velocity of 4m/s. A person in the cart throws
a stone with a vel ocity of 6m/s relative to himself. In theframeof reference o
f the cart the stone is thrown in y-z plane making an angle of 3 0 with the verti
cal z-axis. At the h ighest point of its trajectory, the stone hits an object of
equal mass hung vert icallyfrombranch of a tree by means of a string of length
L. A completely inelas tic collision occurs, in which the stone gets embedded in
the object. Determine (a) the speed ofthe combined mass immediately after the c
ollision with respect t o an observer on the ground. (b) the length L of the str
ing such that the tensio n in the string becomes zero when the string becomes ho
rizontal during the subse quent motion ofthe combined mass. [IIT 97] Q.7 A parti
cle ofmass m and velocity v collides elastically and obliquely with a stationary
particle ofmass m. Calcul ate the angle between the velocity vectors of the two
particles after the collis ion. [REE 97] Q. 8 Two blocks of mass 2kg and M are
at rest on an indiclined pla ne and are separated by a distance of 6.0m as shown
. The coefficient of friction between each of the blocks and the inclined plane
is 0.25. The 2kg block is giv en a velocity of 10.Om/s up the inclined plane. It
collides with M, comes back a nd has a velocity of 1.0m/s when it reaches its i
nitial position. The other bloc k M after the collision moves 0.5m up and comes
to rest. Calculate the coefficie nt of restitution between the blocks and the ma
ss of the block M. [Take sin9 * t anG = 0.05 and g = 10m/s ] [IIT 99] 2 <! Bansal
Classes Particle Dynamics [13]
Q.9 Two trolleys A and B of equal masses M are moving in oppsite directions with
velocities y and - v respectively on separate horizontal fiictionless parallel
tracks. When they start crossing each other, a ball of mass m is thrownfromB to
A and another of same mass is thrown from A to B with velocities normal to y The
balls may be thrown in following two ways: (i) ballsfromA to B and B to A are t
hrown simultaneously. (ii) ball is thrown from A to B after the ball thrown fro
m B reaches A. Which procedure would lead to a larger change in the velocities o
f the trolleys? [REE 2000] Q.10 A wind-powered generator converts wind energy in
t o electrical energy. Assume that the generator converts a fixed fraction of th
e wind energy intercepted by its blades into electrical energy. For wind speed v
, the electrical power output will be proportional to: [IIT (Scr) 2000] (A)v (B)
v (C) v (D) v 2 3 4 Q. 11 Two particles of masses m, and m in projectile motion
have velocities v, a nd v respectively at time t=0. They collide at time t . Th
eir velocities become vj and v, at time 2t while still moving in air. The value
of [(nijVj + m v ) - ( nijVj + m,v )j is [IIT (Scr) 2001] (A) zero (B) (m, + m )
gt (C) 2(1X1, + m )gt ( D) ^(m, + m )gt 2 2 0 0 2 2 0 2 0 2 0 2 0 Q.12 A car P i
s moving with a uniform speed of 5(3 ) m/s towards a carriage of m ass 9 Kg at r
est kept on the rails at a point B as shown infig.The height AC is 120 m. Cannon
balls of 1 Kg arefiredfrom the car with an initial velocity 100 m/ s at an angl
e 30 with the horizontal. Thefirstcanon ball hits the stationary carr iage after
a time t and sticks to it. Determine t . At t , the second cannon bal l isfired.
Assume that the resistive force between the rails and the carriage M M is consta
nt and ignore the vertical motion of the carriage throughout. If the ~ p second
ball also hits and sticks to the carriage. What will be the horizontal 1 velocit
y ofthe carriage just after the second impact? [IIT 2001] A B 1/2 0 0 0 Q.13 Two
block of masses 10 kg and 4 kg are connected by a spring of negligible mass and
placed on a fiictionless horizontal surface. An impulse gives a velocit y of 14
m/s to the heavier block in the direction of the lighter block. The velo city o
f the centre of mass is: [IIT (Scr) 2002] (A) 30 m/s (B) 20 m/s (C) 10 m/s (D)5m
/s <! Bansal Classes Particle Dynamics [13]
ANSWER KEY (NEWTONS LAW FORCE & FRICTION) EXERCISE-I Q.l Q.3 Q.4 Q.7 Q.8 contact
force between the block and the belt is 10.5 N 306 N , 4.7 m/s 2 Q.2 Q.6 Q.ll 3
5 kg 2 sec Q.5 1 sec 100 N towards left Q.9 2 x > x , > x x j : x : x : 1 5 :18
:10 2 3 2 3 1kg Q.10 3 N Q.15 300 N 4 Q.19 - sec Q.23 a Q.12 12 N Q.13 7.5 msQ.1
7 5 Q.21 40 N ^m] - 2 m ^ 2m 2 J 2 Q.14 10/3 kg Q.18 2 sec Q.22 tan1 v Q.16 55 Q
-20 | 1 Q.25 5 sec and - m 3V3y Q.24 1/2 sec EXERCISE-II m sin 0 cos 9 (a) a = g
cotO, (b) u Q.2 2V2 mcos 0 + M a = 12g/25 , ag = 9g/25 , N = 12mg/25 3mg Q.4 (a
) a =3g^= a ; a =0; T=mg/2; (b) a =2gt, a =2g4, a=0, T=0; (c) a =a = g/2t, a =gl
, T=7 T=2mg -^ '2 Q.5 2g/23 15x300 Q.6 T = 32 Q.7 (a) r) = ; (b) acceleration = 4
m/s ' | Q.l Q.3 2 A A A H c A B A B N a = m / s 2 2 Q.8 (a) 2ra/s* <45" 2 (b) 22
.5 m/s ; (c) -275 m; (d) 2 2 sec 2 2 2 Q.9 (a) (i) a, = a, = 3.2 m/s , (ii) a, =
5.75 m/s , a, = 2m/s ; (b) a, = 5 m/s ,a = -l0/3 m/s Q.10 (i)90N,(ii) 112.5N(ii
i) 15ON Q.ll =0.4 , = 0.3 mg cot a Q.12 Ar=5-,1cm 4ft k 2
Q.13 F mgu Q.3 B A [13] 2(1 - n K ) EXERCISE-III Q.l B Q.2 (i) zero, (ii) can't
be determined, (iii) can't be determined Q.4 (b) a = 3/5 m/s , T = 18 N, F = 60N
Q.5 C Q.6 D Q.7 Q.8 11.313m <! Bansal Classes Particle Dynamics
(CIRCULAR MOTION & WORK POWER EXERCISE-I ENERGY) CD X Q.l Q.5 Q.9 Q.2 Q.6 2 1 2
2 Q.3 Q.7 Q.ll Q.15 3 V 3 2 tan6 -1 m v2 -ka /4 2 Q.4 Q.8 - 1J 9 VTo m/s 2 Q.13
80 kW Q.17 9a/2 Q.22 - 3k rad/s , - 2k rad/s Q.21 625 J Q.23 (a) 2 rad/s , (b) 1
2+2t for t < 2s, 16 for t>2s,(c) ^28565 ~ 169,256 m/s (d) 44rad Q.24 0.1875 Q.25
P 2 2 2 T^. -+-> 2 4 2V2V 71R 4^5 m/s 2m g k Q.10 9 Q.14 ^2g rad/s Q.18 m i IS
Q.12 (l-V3/2)mg Q.16 6mg Q.20 2 sec 1 Q.19 - j T rad/s EXERCISE-II Q.l QF = -3ax
+ b, x 2 , KE 2 2b b 3V3 Q.2 2 m/s Q.3
v = v , 57ia/v 0 0 N=^^ /ra) -l g Q.5 Q.6 (i) ^,(ii)2V^g, 2a 500N/m : Q.7 40 (a)
V2 r, (b) h = 2 19r , (c) g Q.8 N 1.19R Q.9 V 2 R=0.2m, ION R(vt-R)v.1/2 (2Rt-v
t ) 2 3/2 Q.ll u = vsec9, v A/41 m/s Q.13 up, 10cm N Q.l Q.3 Q.8 mg max R Q.12 a
= (2Rt-vt ) ' EXERCISEIII Q.14 9 =7r/2, T=mg(3sin9+3cos9-2) Q.15 4, -J^fis 25 Q
.16 24 > Vo> , a=5V3 g/8, N=3mg/8 if C Q.2 Q.5 (i)36N,(ii) 11.66rad/sec,(iii) 0.
1m, 0.2m D Q.6 V u = - J g | 3 2 3 y Q.7 Q.13 B Q.12 D L + 2 F=-8mgi-mgj, h=3R Q
.4 A Q.9 A A Q.10 5.79 m/'s Q.ll C <! Bansal Classes
Particle Dynamics [13]
Q.14 (a) N=3mg cosG - 2mg, (b) p = m v mg Mng PM P M I CS O0 cos0~ 2/3 0=| COS0-1 cos0 2/3 =-mv sincoti+m(v cosa)t-v )j COS 2 2 1 Q.15 A Q.17 A COS0 (CENTRE OF
MASS & MOMENTUM) EXERCISE-I Q.l 5v RcosG 1 Q-2 Q.6 -6m (a) mg(h -h ) _ ;(b)0 3 2
( h 2 h ; ) Q.3 2^2V Q 1 3 [muV3] - Q.8 e/ 2 Q Q.4 Q.9 R 4 ^ 11/14 4/3 m/s Q Q.5
cos" (3/4) Q.10 L/4 Q.16 I Q.21 6.21 W Q.l Q.2 Q 100m Q.12 Q.7 5h ~ ' 1 4 Q.ll 2
J 1 2 0
2nvcos(0/2) T H Q.19 v 1 5 2 : 1 Q.17 1 2 Q.18 +2TI N - s = Q.22 v,heavy ball }h
' 27 Q.4 M -A Vfirst Mu^ 2g(M + 2m) Q.20 x = 6m 4Ur 4u 4Ur ball 27 ' Second bal
l g ' third ball 3 . N = f = V x = 3 units, tanG = 2/3 5/VT7 cm, 153L/80U V208 '
0 1 5 EXERCISE-II ' 6 8 4v 0 1 5 Q.5 22 14 7 9_ 16 Q.7 40cm Q.8 37
Q.9 (a) 0.66, (b)4 m Q.10 impulse = m(-3i + 4j), e 22 ? 2 Q.ll I ( - i + 7 j ) i
( - i + 9j) Q.12 Vj = ^/J m/s, vv = m/s, = m Q.14 (a)y(gy + v 2),(b)mg 0 N n 2
V (m,+m ) m/s Q.13 v=u /n| mj+m -Nmt , mv y ^ , mv2 ^ 27~ Vllk ' (0 10V3, (ii)l 1
.5 4 from AB IJ ' Q Q 1 6 EXERCISE-III 2 Q.l (iX (iii) Q.5 A Q.8 e= 5 + V3 8 Q.2
4.13 x 10~ m Q.3(L + 2R,0) Q.6 2.5 m, 0,319 m Q.7 90 , M=^kg, 11 26 Q.4 4/3 m/s,
35/3 J Q.9 2 in case I Q.10 C Q.ll C Q.12 t = 12 sec, v = 100V3 <! Bansal Classes
Q.13 C Particle Dynamics [13]
| BANSALCLASSES ^ TARGET IIT JEE 2007 XII (ALL) QUESTION BANK ON
QUESTION FOR SHORT ANSWER Q. 1 Fluorescent light bulbs are usually more efficien
t light emitters than inca ndescent bulbs. That is, for the same input energy, t
he fluorescent bulb gives o ffmore light than the incandescent bulb. Carefully t
ouch a fluorescent bulb and in an incandescent one after each has been lit for a
few minutes. Explain why th e incandesent bulb is a less efficient light emitte
r. Q. 2 Birds perch on high t ension wires all the time. Why are they not electr
ocuted, even when they perch o n a part ofthe wire where the insulation has worn
off? Q.3 Explain why touching an exposed circuit wire when you are in a damp ba
sement is much more dangerous t han touching the same wire when you are on the s
y it was connected in series with a standard cell in a certain circuit and a cur
rent Ij was obtained. When th e batteiy is connected to the same circuit opposit
e to the standard cell a curre nt \ flow in the external circuit from the positi
ve pole ofthe storage battery w as obtained. What is the e.m.f. s of the storage
battery? The e.m.f. of the stan dard cell is s . (C)s,= I1-I2 (D)e 1 , - 1 ( B
) M+h (A) 6,= h+h I2-I1 I, +u I1I2 In the network shown the potential difference
between A and B A-^jwv is(R = r = r = r i a , E = 3Y,E = 2 V E = l V ) (B) 2 V
(A) 1 V (D)4 V (C) 3 V Two batte ries one ofthe emf 3 V, internal resistance 1 o
hm and the other of emf 15 V, int ernal resistance 2 ohm are connected in series
with a resistance R as shown. If the 3V,IQ 15V.2Q potential difference between
a and b is zero the resistance ofR in ohm is R VvVv (A) 5 (B)7 (C)3 (D)l A wire
oflength L and 3 identical cells o fnegligible internal resistances are connecte
d in series. Due to the current, th e temperature of the wire is raised by AT in
time t. N number of similar cells i s now connected in series with a wire ofthe
same material and cross section but of length 2L. The temperature of the wire i
s raised by the same amount AT in the same time t. The value ofN is : (A) 4 (B)
6 (C) 8 (D) 9 A cell of emf E has an internal 1 esistance r & is connected to rh
eostat. When resistance R of rheostat is changed correct graph of potential diff
erence across it is } 2 6l 1 2 3 1 2 ; 3 (A) v (B) R (D) Q.14 The battery in the
diagram is to be charged by the generator G. The generat or has a terminal volt
age of 120 volts when the charging current isl 0 amperes. The battery has an emf
of 100 volts and an internal resistance of 1 ohm. In orde r to charge the batte
ry at 10 amperes charging current, the resistance R should be set at (A) 0.1 Q (
B) 0.5 H (cjl.on (D)5.0Q Q.15 Two current elements P and Q have current voltage
characteristics as shown below: a, 1 r 10 100 V, l f i y? r 10 P.D. (Volt) P.D.
(Volt) Which ofthe graphs given below represents current vol tage characteristic
s when P and Q are in series. 2 '/ " E 1, Ii _ J i1 (A) (B) ~ 10 20 10 20 10 20
10 20 P.D. rvoit) P.P. Ofclt)
2 2 r P.D. (Volt) P.D.fVWt) <!Bansal Classes Question Bank On Current Electricity
[3]
Q. 16 A wire of cross-section area A, length L,, resistivity p and temperature c
oefficient of resistivity otj is connected to a second wire oflength L , resist
i vity p , temperature coefficient of resistivity a and the same area A, so that
w ire carries same current. Total resistance R is independent of temperature fo
r O small temperature change if (Thermal expansion effect is negligible) (A) a !
= - a (B)p L a +p L a = 0 (C) Lj a j + L a = 0 (D)None t 2 2 2 2 1 1 1 2 2 2 2
2 Q.17 Resistances Rj and R each 600 are connected in series as shown in figure.
T he Potential difference between A and B is kept 120 volt. Then what will be t
he reading of voltmeter connected between the point C & D if resistance of voltm
ete r is 120fi. (A) 48 V (B) 24 V (C) 40V (D) None 2 R, R, WA Xww-T^ C Q.18 The
resistance of all the wires between any two adjacent dots is R. Then eq uivalent
resistance between A and B as shown infigureis : . (A) 7/3 R (B) 7/6 R (C) 14/8
R (D) None of these Q.19 Consider an infinte ladder network shown infig ure.A v
oltage V is applied between the points A and B. This applied value ofvolt age is
halved after each section. (A^/R^l (B) Rj/R^ -1/2 (QR^-2 (0)^/^ =3 See Q.20 AB
CD is a square where each side is a uniform wire of resistance 1Q. A poi nt E li
es on CD such that if a uniform wire of resistance 1Q is connected across AE and
constantpotentialdifferenceisappliedacrossAandCthenBandEareequipotential . CE C
E 1 CE CE CD) -V2 ED " i5= < ' e 5 VI ( A ) 1 ( B ) 2 c = S 'V Q.21 In order to
increase the resistance of a given wire of uniform cross sectio n to four times
its value, a 3 fraction ofits length is stretched uniformly till the full length
of the wire becomes times the original length what is the value ofthis fraction
? 1 1 (A) 4 (C) 16 8 Ri Q. 22 In the given circuit the current f lowing through
the resistance 20 ohms is 0.3 W v ampere while the ammetre reads 0.8 ampere. Wha
t is the value ofRj ? *VvVV (A) 30 ohms (B) 40 ohms (C) 50 ohms (D) 60 ohms 150 WvV
I <!Bansal Classes Question Bank On Current Electricity [3]
Q.23 The circuit diagram shown consists of a large number of element (each eleme
nt has two resistors R, and R^). The resistance of the resistors in each subseq
u ent element differs by a factor of K = 1/2 from the resistance ofthe resistors
i n the previous elements. The equivalent reistance between A and B shown in /
owe r supply Assume the light bulbs are rated for single connection to 120 V Wit
h th e mistaken connection, the power dissipated by each bulb is: (A) 6.7 W (B)
13.3 W (C)20W (D)40W R Q.41 The ratio of powers dissipatted respectively in R an
d 3R, as shown is: (A) 9 (B) 27/4 (C) 4/9 (D) 4/27 Q. 42 In thefigureshown the p
ower generated in y is maximum wheny=5Q. Then R is C (A) 2 H (B)6Q (C) 5f2 (D) 3
Q 2R 3R lOV^r 2Q R 3 R: :3on ^ Q. 43 In the circuit shown, the resistances are
given in ohms and the so n iVWvba tteiy is assumed ideal with emfequal to 3.0 vol
ts. The resistor i R ^60 Q that d issipates the most power is % $50 Q i 3V(C)R (
d)R 3 4 Q. 44 What amount ofheat will be generated in a coil ofresistance R due
to a cha rge q passing through it if the current in the coil decreases to zero u
niformly during a time interval At 1 (2At) 2q R (B)/n ^ R (D)ln (A) (C) 3At 2At
2 Q.45 The variation ofcurrent (I) and voltage (V) is as shown infigureA. The va
ri ation of power P with current / is best shown by which ofthe following graph
P" . T . (B) / (C) T I T 20Q Q. 46 In a galvanometer, the deflection becomes one
ha lfwhen the galvanometer is A/WVshunted by a 20Q resistor. The galvanometer r
esis tance is i/2 (A) 5Q (B) 10Q (C) 40H (D) 20Q - i i/2 Rg P <!Bansal Classes Qu
estion Bank On Current Electricity [3]
tig Sx Q.47 When a galvanometer is shunted with a 4 0 resistance, the deflection
is red uced to one-fifth. If the galvanometer is further shunted with 2 0 wire,
the fur ther reduction in the deflection will be (the main current remains same
) (A) ~ of the deflection when shunted with 4 0 only 5 (B) ~ of the deflection wh
en shunte d with 4 0 only 3 (C) ofthe deflection when shunted with 4Q only 3 (D)
of the de flection when shunted with 4 0 only Q. 48 A galvanometer has a resist
ance of 200 and readsfoil-scalewhen 0.2 V is applied across it. To convert it in
to a 10 A a mmeter, the galvanometer coil should have a (A) 0.010 resistor conne
cted across it (B) 0.020 resistor connected across it (C) 2000 resistor connecte
d in series with it (D) 2000 O resistor connected in series with it Q .49 A mill
iammeter of range 10 mA and resistance 9 O is joined in a circuit as shown. The
metre gives full-scale deflection for current I when A and B are use d as its te
rminals, i. e., current enters at A and leaves at B (C is left isolat ed). The v
alue ofI is (A) 100 mA (B) 900 mA (C) 1A (D)1.1A 9 Q 10 mA 8 V#v -WA 0.9 Q 0.1 Q B
C Q. 50 Agalvanometer coil has a resistance 90 O and full scale deflection curre
nt 10 mA. A 9100 resistance is connected in series with the galvanometer to make
a voltmeter. Ifthe least count of the voltmeter is 0. IV, the number of divisio
ns on its scale is (A) 90 (B) 91 (C) 100 (D) none Q.51 In the circuit shown the
re sistance ofvoltmeter is 10,000 ohm and that ofammeter pvw<>is 20 ohm. The ammet
er reading is 0.10 Amp and voltmeter reading is 12 volt. Q Then R is equal to (A
) 1 22 O (B) 140 O (C) 116 O (D)1000 Q 52 By error, a student places moving-coil
vol tmeter V (nearly ideal) in series with the resistance in a circuit in order
to r ead the current, as shown. The voltmeter reading will be (A) 0 (B)4V (C)6V
(D) 1 2V E = 12V, R = 2Q 4FI Q.53 In a balanced wheat stone bridge, current in
the galvanometer is zero. It r emains zero when; [1] battery emf is increased [2
] all resistances are increased by 10 ohms \ [3 ] all resistances are madefiveti
mes [4] the battery and the gal vanometer are interchanged (A) only [ 1 ] is cor
rect (B) [ 1 ], [2] and [3 ] are correct (C) [ 1 ], [3] and [4] are correct (D)
[1] and [3] are correct <!Bansal Classes Question Bank On Current Electricity [3]
Q. 54 A Wheatstone's bridge is balanced with a resistance of625 Q in the third a
rm, where P, Q and S are in the 1 , 2 and 4 arm respectively. If P and Q are in
t erchanged, the resistance in the third arm has to be increased by 5 lO to I\ s
ec ure balance. The unknown resistance in the fourth arm is (A) 625 Q (B)650n (C
)67 6Q (D)600fi st nd th ' 625C2 Q. 55 In thefigureshown for gives values of Rj
and Rj the balance point for Jock ey is at 40 cmfromA. When R2 is shunted by a r
esistance of 10 Q, balance shifts to 50 cm. Rj and Rj are (AB = 1 m): A 10 (B)2o
n,3on (C) 10 Q, 15 Q (D)5n, y f i 3 HH -wB Q. 56 A 6 V battery of negligible int
ernal resistance is connected across a unif orm wire oflength 1 m. The positive
terminal ofanother battery of A\ emf4V and i nternal resistance 1 Disjoined to t
he pointAas shown in y figure. The ammeter sh ows zero deflection when the jocke
y touches the wire at the point C. The AC is e qual to (A) 2/3 m (B) 1/3 m (C) 3
/5 m (D) 1/2 m 6V H4v, in g Q. 57 The figure shows a metre-bridge circuit, withA
B = 100 cm, X= 12Q and R = 1 8Q, and the jockey J in the position of balance. lf
R is now made 80, through wha t distance will J have to be moved to obtain balan
ce? (A) 10 cm (B) 20 cm (C) 30 cm (D) 40 cm 5EM Q.58 A potentiometer wire has le
ngth 10 m and resistance 100. It is connected to a battery ofEMF 11 volt and int
ernal resistance 10, then the potential gradient in the wire is (A) 10 V/m (B) 1
V/m (C) 0.1 V/m (D)none Q. 59 The length of a p otentiometer wire is I. Acell o
f emfE is balanced at a length 113fromthe positiv e end of the wire. Ifthe lengt
h ofthe wire is increased by 1/2. At what distance will the same cell give a bal
ance fW p o ^ * " point. (A) 21 Ptu cbGut (B) I I (D)y 41 Q.60 Inthefigure, the
potentiometer wire AB oflength Land resistance 9r is joine d to the cell D of em
f s and internal resistance r. The cell C's emf is s/2 and its internal resistan
ce is 2r. The galvanometer G will show no deflection when t
he A length AJ is 11L 4L 7L 5L x(C) 18 (D) 18 (B) (A) T 2r o <!Bansal Classes Que
stion Bank On Current Electricity [3]
& s Q.61 An ammeter A offiniteresistance, and a resistor R are joined in series
to a n ideal cell C. A potentiometer P is joined in parallel to R. The ammeter r
eadin g is I and the potentiometer reading is V . P is now replaced by a voltmet
er of finite resistance. The ammeter reading now is I and the voltmeter reading
is V. (D) I < I , V =V (A) I > I , V < V (B) I > I , V = V (C) I = I , V < V 0 0
Q 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 Q.62 In the given potentiometer circuit length ofthe wire AB is
3 m and resistan ce is R=4.5 O. The length AC for no deflection in galvanometer
is (A) 2 m (B) 1. 8 m (C) dependent on r (D) none ofthese t 0 E=5V r=0.5n E!=3V
i Q.63 A battery of emf E = 12 Vis connected across a 4m long uniform wire havi
ng resistance 4Q/m. The cells of small emfs = 2V and e = 4V having internal R=8Q
resistance 2Cl and 6 0 respectively, are connected as shown in the figure. If f
I galvanometer shows no deflection at the point N, the distance ofpoint N from
the point Ais equal to Hi W/k| VAV-J 1 2 '2 (B)|m (C) 25 cm (D) 50 cm CA) l 2 h 5
Q.64 In the arrangement shown infigurewhen the switch S is open, the galvanomete
r shows no deflection for I=L/2. When the switch S is j closed, the galvanomete
r shows no deflection for/= 5L/12. The internal resistance (r) of 6 V cell, and
t he emf E of the other battery are respectively (A)3Q,8V (B) 2Q, 12V (C)2Q,24V
(D )3Q, 12V 2 2 ion HiVvVWi 6V r 1* T HHH E S, Q.65 The diagram besides shows a c
ircuit used in an experiment to determine the emf and internal resistance of the
cell C. Agraph was plotted ofthe potential di fference V between the terminals
of the cell against the current I, which was va ried by adjusting the rheostat.
The graph is shown on the right; x and y are the intercepts of the graph with th
e axes as shown. What is the internal resistance ofthe cell ? (A)x (C)x/y (B)y (
D)y/x V(V) -<Y>L-VWV ! y i T(A) Q.66 Which ofthe following wiring diagrams could be used to exp
erimentally deter mine R using ohm's law? Assume an ideal voltmeter and an ideal
ammeter. R R R R w p r- W\ r <SH v W H W i (A) (B) S M (C) (D) 1 -AA |h AA |f -AA
|h Q. 67 A current of (2.5 0.05) Aflowsthrough a wire and develops a potential d
iff erence of (10 0.1) volt. Resistance of the wire in ohm, is (A) 4 0.12 (B) 4 0.
04 ( C) 4 0.08 (D) 4 0.02 <!Bansal Classes Question Bank On Current Electricity [
3]
Q. 68 Two wires each of radius of cross section r but of different materials are
connected together end to end (in series). Ifthe densities of charge carriers i
n the two wires are in the ratio 1 : 4, the drift velocity of electrons in the
t wo wires will be in the ratio: (A) 1:2 (B) 2 : 1 (C) 4 : 1 (D)l:4 Q. 69 In a w
ir e of cross-section radius r, free electrons travel with drift velocity v when
a current I flows through the wire. What is the current in another wire ofhalft
he radius and ofthe same material when the \ drift velocity is 2v? Tm^VO ( ) (B)
(C ) 1/2 CD) 1/4 H A 2 1 1 A Q. 70 Read the following statements careMy: Y: The
resistivity of a semiconducto r decreases with increases oftemperature. Z: In a
conducting solid, the rate of collision betweenfreeelectrons and ions increases
with increase of temperature. ' Select the correct statementfromthe following:
(A) Yis true but Z is false (B) Yis false but Z is true. (C) Both Y and Z are tr
ue. (D) Yis true and Z is the c orrect reason for Y. Q. 71 A piece of copper and
another ofgermanium are cooledf romroom temperature to 80 K. The resistance of:
(A) each of them increases (B) e ach of them decreases ^ (C) copper increases a
nd germanium decreases (D) copper decreases and germanium increases. Q. 72 An in
ONE OR MORE THAN ONE OPTION MAY BE CORRECT Take approx. 3 minutes for answering
each question. Q.l A battery is of emfE is being chargedfroma charger such that
positive terminal o fthe batteiy is connected to terminal A of charger and negat
ive terminal ofthe b attery is connected to terminal B of charger. The internal
resistance of the bat tery is r. (A) Potential difference across points A and B
must be more than E. ( B) Amust be at higher potential than B (C) In battery, cu
rrent flowsfrompositive terminal to the negative terminal (D) No currentflowsthr
ough battery A battery of emf E and internal resistance r is connected across a
resistance R. (volt) Re sistance R can be adjusted to any value greater than or
equal to zero. A graph j o is plotted between the current (i) passing through th
e resistance and potenti al difference (V) across it. S elect the correct altern
ative(s). (A) internal re sistance of battery is 5Q (B) emf ofthe battery is 20
V (C) maximum current whic h can be taken from the battery is 4A (D) V- i graph
can never be a straight lin e as shown in figure. 1 Q.2 (ampere) Q. 3 The equiva
lent resistance ofa group ofresistances is R. If another resistance is connected
in parallel to the group, its new equivalent becomes R, & ifit is con nected in
series to the group, its new equivalent becomes Rj we have : (A)Rj >R (B)Rj <R
(C)R2>R (D)R2<R Two identical fuses are rated at 10A. Ifthey are joined (A) in p
arallel, the combination acts as a fuse ofrating 20A (B) in parallel, t he combi
nation acts as a fuse ofrating 5A (C) in series, the combination acts as a fuse
ofrating 10A. (D) in series, the combination acts as afiiseofrating 20A. Two cir
cuits (shown below) are called' Circuit A' and' Circuit B'. The equivale nt resi
stance of' Circuit a' is x and that of 'Circuit B' is>' between 1 and 2. Q.4 Q.5
Circuit A Circuit B (A)y>x Q.6 (B)^ = (V3 + 1 ) R (C) x>' = 2R 2 The value ofth
e resistance Rinfigureis adjusted such that power dissipated in th e 2Q resistor
is maximum. Under this condition (A) R = 0 (B)R=8H (C) power dissi pated in the
2 O resistor is 72 W. (D) power dissipated in the 2 O resistor is 8 W. (D)x-j>
= 2R 8Q -WW 12V
<!Bansal Classes Question Bank On Current Electricity [3]
Q. 7 A galvanometer may be converted into ammeter or voltmeter. In which ofthe f
ollow ing cases the resistance of the device will be the largest ? (Asssume maxi
mum ra nge of galvanometer = 1 mA) (A) an ammeter of range 1 OA (B) a voltmeter
of rang e 5 V (C) an ammeter of range 5 A (D) a voltmeter of range 10 V Mark out
the cor rect options. (A) An ammeter should have small resistance. (B) An ammet
er should have large resistance. (C) A voltmeter should have small resistance. (
D) A volt meter should have large resistance. In the circuit shown the readings
of ammeter and voltmeter are 4A and 20V respectively. The meters are non ideal,
then R is: (A) 5Q (B) less than 5H (C) greater than 5Q (D) between 4Q&5Q ^ R maV
TAWV-r* ~~ L J Q. 8 Q.9 Q.10 A micrometer has a resistance of 100Q and a full sca
le range of 50pA. It ca n be used as a voltmeter or a higher range ammeter provi
ded a resistance is adde d to it. Pick the correct range and resistance combinat
ions). (A) 50 V range wit h 10 kC2 resistance in series. (B) 10 V range with 200
kQ resistance in series. (C) 5 mA range with 1 Q resistance in parallel. (D) 10
mA range with 1 kQ resist ance in parallel. Q.ll In a potentiometer arrangement
. Ej is the cell establishi ng current in primary circuit. E is the cell to be m
easured. AB is the potentiom eter wire and G is a galvanometer. Which ofthe foll
owing are the essential condi tion for balance to be obtained. (A) The emf ofEj
must be greater than the emf o f E . (B) Either the positive terminals of both E
j and E or the negative termina ls ofboth Ej and E must be joined to one end of
potentiometer wire. (C) The posi tive terminals ofE, and E must be joined to one
end of potentiometer wire. (D) T he resistance of G must be less than the resis
tance ofAB. 2 2 2 2 2 !l Q.12 In a potentiometer wire experiment the emf of a ba
ttery in the primary circ uit is 20V and its internal resistance is 5Q. There is
a resistance box in serie s with the battery and the potentiometer wire, whose
resistance can be variedfro m120Q to 170Q. Resistance ofthe potentiometer wire i
s 75 Q. The following potent ial differences can be measured using this potentio
meter. (A) 5 V (B)6V (C)7V (D )8V Q.13 In the given potentiometer circuit, the r
esistance of the potentiometer wire AB is Rq . C is a cell ofinternal resistance
r, FvLThe galvanometer G does n ot give zero deflection for any position ofthe jo
ckey J. Which of the following cannot be a lpcl reason for this? o (A)r>R (B)R>>R
e other two point s are always equal. (B) There always exists a branch through w
hich no current fl ows. (C) The current coming out ofthe battery in each case is
same. (D) None oft hese 40/\4fi Question No, 31 to 33 (3 questions) A ^ tAC The
givenfigureshows a network of resistances and a battery. Q.31 Identify the corr
ect statements) E=!2 V (A) The circuit satisfies the condition of a balanced Whe
atstone bridge. (B) V - V - 0 (C) V - V = 8 (D) no currentflowsin the branch BD
B D b d Q.32 Which ofthe two batteries is getting charged? (A) 8V battery (B) 12
ry (C) none Q.33 Choose the correct statement(s). (A) The current coming he 8V
battery is 2A (B) The current coming out of the 12V battery is 3 A currentflowin
gin all the 4 0 branches is same. (D) The currentflowingin gonally opposite bran
ches is same (D) can't be said <!Bansal Classes Question Bank On Current Electric
ity [3] V batte out oft (C) The the dia
ONLY ONE OPTION IS CORRECT ANSWER KEY Q.4 Q.ll Q.18 Q.25 Q.32 Q.39 Q.46 Q.53 Q.6
0 Q.67 Q.74 Q.81 Q.88 A C B B A D D C B A D B C Q.l Q.8 Q.15 Q.22 Q.29 Q.36 Q.43
Q.50 Q.57 Q.64 Q.71 Q.78 Q.85 Q.92 C C C D B B A C B B D B C C Q.2 Q.9 Q.16 Q.2
3 Q.30 Q.37 Q.44 Q.51 Q.58 Q.65 Q.72 Q.79 Q.86 Q.93 B A B C B D A D B D D B B B
Q.3 Q.10 Q.17 Q.24 Q.31 Q.38 Q.45 Q.52 Q.59 Q.66 Q.73 Q.80 Q.87 D B A A C A B D
B B A B A Q.5 Q.12 Q.19 Q.26 Q.33 Q.40 Q.47 Q.54 Q.61 Q.68 Q.75 Q.82 Q.89 D B B
A C A A B A C D A A Q.6 Q.13 Q.20 Q.27 Q.34 Q.41 Q.48 Q.55 Q.62 Q.69 Q.76 Q.83 Q
.90 C D D A A D B A D C C B C Q.7 Q.14 Q.21 Q.28 Q.35 Q.42 Q.49 Q.56 Q.63 Q.70 Q
.77 Q.84 Q.91 D C B D A D C A C C C D A ONE OR MORE THAN ONE OPTION MAY BE CORRE
CT Q.l Q5 Q9 Q.13 Q.17 Q.21 Q.25 Q.29 Q.33 AB,C AB,C C A C AB AC,D AB,C,D AB,D Q
2 Q.6 Q.10 Q.14 Q.18 Q.22 Q.26 Q.30 A AC B,C D AC,D B B,D AB,C Q.3 Q.7 Q.ll Q.15
Q.19 Q.23 Q.27 Q.31 B,C D AB AB,C,D A A AB C Q.4 Q.8 Q.12 Q.16 Q.20 Q.24 Q.28 Q
.32 AC AD AB,C B,C AD E AD C <!Bansal Classes Question Bank On Current Electricit
y [3]
BANSALCLASSES TARGET IIT JEE 2007 XII (ALL) CURRENT ELECTRICITY CONTENTS KEYCONC
EPTS EXERCISE-I EXERCISE-II EXERCISE-HI ANSWER KEY
CURRENT 1. ELECTRIC CURRENT : ELECTRICITY Electric charges in motion constitute
an electric current. Any medium having pra ctically free electric charges,freeto
migrate is a conductor of electricity. The electric charge flowsfromhigher pote
ntial energy state to lower potential energ y state. Positive charge flows from
higher to lower potential and negative charg e flowsfromlower to higher. Metals
such as gold, silver, copper, aluminium etc. are good conductors. In absence of
potential difference across a conductor no ne t current flows through a corss se
ction. When a potential difference is applied across a conductor the charge carr
iers (electrons in case of metallic conductors ) flow in a definite direction wh
ich constitutes a net current in it. These elec trons are not accelerated by ele
ctric field in the conductor produced by potenti al difference across the conduc
tor. They move with a constant drift velocity. Th e direction of current is alon
g the flow ofpositive charge (or opposite to flow of negative charge), i = nv eA
where V = drift velocity. d d 2. ELECTRIC CURRENT I N A CONDUCTOR : 3. The stre
ngth ofthe current i is the rate at which the electric charges are flowi ng. If
a charge Q coulomb passes through a given cross section ofthe conductor i n t se
cond the current I through the conductor is , Q gtven by I = = Coulomb =Q ampere
. t second t dq Ampere is the unit of current. If i is not constant then / = ,
where dq is net charge transported at . . . dt a section.in time dt. In a curren
t carrying conductor we can define a vector which gives the direction as c urren
t per unit normal, cross sectional area. Thus J = ^ n or I = J S Where n is the
unit vector in the direction of theflowof current. T CHARGE A N D CURRENT : > >
For random J or S, we use 1= - J -ds f 4. In conductors drift vol. of electrons
is proportional to the electric field in s ide the conductor as- v = pE where p
is the mobility of electrons current densit y is given as J = = ne v = ne(pE) =
aE d RELATION IN J , E AND V D : d where a = neu is called conductivity of mater
ial and we can also write p = -> re sistivity a of material. Thus E = p J. It is
called as differential form of Ohm' s Law. 5. Dry cells, secondary cells, gener
ator and thermo couple are the devices used for producing potential difference i
n an electric circuit. The potential difference between the two terminals ofa so
urce when no energy is drawn from it is called
the " Electromotive force" or " EMF " ofthe source. The unit of potential differ
. 9 In the circuit shown infigure,all wires have equal resistance r. Find the eq
uiva lent resistance between A and B. Find the resistor in which maximum heat wi
ll be produced. Q. 10 For what value of Rin circuit, current through 4f2 resista
nce is zero. Q.l l In the circuit shown infigurethe reading of ammeter is the sa
me with both swit ches open as with both closed. Thenfindthe resistance R. (amme
ter is ideal) 4y loon _ wwhf, . w wJWt w 1 ( ison [5] il.Bansal Classes
Current Electricity W^tlv
Q.12 Ifthe switches S , S and S in thefigureare arranged such that current throu
gh the battery is minimum,findthe voltage across points A and B. t 2 3 >J 6D -r
-Vv 24V 6n - 9fJ w h 3! Q.13 Thefigureshows a network ofresistor each heaving val
ue 12H. Find the equiva lent resistance between points Aand B. Q.14 A battery of
emfs = 10 Vis connected across a i m long uniform wire having resistance 1 OQ/m
. Two cells ofemfgj = 2V and e = 4V having internal resistances 1Q and 5Q respec
tively are connected as shown in thefigure.If a galvanometer sh ows no deflectio
n at the point P,findthe distance ofpoint P from the point a. 0 2 Q.15 A potenti
ometer wire AB is 100 cm long and has a total resistance of lOohm. If the galvan
ometer shows zero deflection at the position C, thenfindthe value ofunknown resi
stance R. Q.16 In thefigureshown for gives values ofRj and fL the balance point
for Jockey is at 40 cmfromA When R, is shunted by a resistance of 10 O, balance
shifts to 50 cm.findR, and R,. (AB = lm): -w R 3 -W2 R Q.17 A part of a circuit
is shown in figure. Here reading of ammeter is 5 R -A/W WWV ampere and voltmeter
is 96V & voltmeter resistance is 480 ohm. Then find the resistance R Q.18 An ac
cumulator of emf 2 Volt and negligible internal resistan ce is connected across
a uniform wire of length 10m and resistance 30Q. The appr opriate terminals ofa
cell of emf 1.5 Volt and internal resistance 10 is connect ed to one end ofthe w
ire, and the other terminal ofthe cell is connected through a sensitive galvanom
eter to a slider on the wire. What length ofthe wire will b e required to produc
e zero deflection of the galvanometer ? How will the balanci ng change (a) when
a coil ofresistance 5fi is placed in series with the accumula tor, (b) the cell
of 1.5 volt is shunted with 5Q resistor ? Q.19 The resistance ofthe galvanometer
G in the circuit is 25f2. The meter deflects Ri R-, full scal e for a current o
f 10 mA. The meter behaves as an ammeter of -v-AVrvWv- 'vVvVthr ee different ran
ges. The range is 0-10 A ifthe terminals O and P are taken; rang e is 0 - 1 A be
tween O and Q; range is 0 - 0.1A between O 10A 1A 0.1 A R and R. Calculate the r
esistance Rj, R2 and R . List of recommended questions from I.E. Irodov, 3,147,
3.149, 3.150,3.154,3.155,3.169, 3.175, 3.176, 3.179,3.186, 3.189, 3.190, 3.194,3
.196, 3.207 3 il.Bansal Classes
Current Electricity [5]
Q. 1 Atriangle is constructed using the wires AB, BC & CAof same material and of
resistance a, 2a & 3a respectively. Another wire of resistance a/3 from A can m
ake a sliding contact with wire BC. Find the maximum resistance ofthe network b
e tween points A and the point of sliding wire with BC. Q.2(a) The current densi
ty across a cylindrical conductor of radius R varies according to the equation ,
w here r is the distancefromthe axis. Thus the current density is a maximum J a
t t he axis r = 0 and decreases linearly to zero at the surface r = R. Calculate
the current in terms of J and the conductor's cross sectional areaisA=7iR Suppo
se t hat instead the current density is a maximum J at the surface and decreases
line arly to zero at the axis so that J = J . Calculate the current. 0 0 2 0 0 E
XERCISE # II (b) Q.3 Q4 What will be the change in the resistance of a circuit c
onsisting of five identi cal conductors iftwo similar conductors are added as sh
own by the dashed line in figure. The current I through a rod of a certain metal
lic oxide is given by 1 = 0.2 V , where V is the potential difference across it.
The rod is connected in series with a resistance to a 6V battery ofnegligible i
nternal resistance. What value should the series resistance have so that: the cu
rrent in the circuit is 0 .44 the power dissipated in the rod is twice that diss
ipated in the resistance. 5/2 00 Q.5 Q.6 (I) 01) Q.7 Q. 8 Apiece ofresistive wir
e is made up into two squares with a common side of length 10 cm. A currant ente
rs the rectangular system at one ofthe corners and leaves at the diagonally oppo
site corners. Show that the current in the common side is l/5th of the entering
current. What length of wire connected between input and o utput terminals wouid
ance, the unknown resistance should be connected between [JEE' 2004 (Scr)] (A)
B and C (B)CandD (C) A and D (D)B andC 1 1 ooo*oogTi 'jaTotoo o o fESuSsjEEOQi 3
Q. 14 Draw the circuit for experimental verification of Ohm's law using a source
ofvariable D.C. voltage, a main resistance of 100 O, two galvanometers and two
resistances ofvalues 10 Q and 10* O respectively. Clearly show the positions oft
he voltmeter and the ammeter. [JEE' 2004] 6 Q.15 In thefigureshown the current
through 2Q resistor is (A) 2 A (B) OA (C) 4 A (D) 6 A , 10V f50 VWv 10Q 2fJ Wr 20V
[JEE' 2005 (Scr)] Q.16 An uncharged capacitor of capacitance 4pF, a battery of
emf 12 volt and a r esistor of 2.5 MO are connected in series. The time after wh
ich v = 3v is (take /n2 = 0.693) (A) 6.93 sec. (B) 13.86 sec. (C) 20.52 sec, (D)
none of these [JEE' 2005 (Scr)] c R Q.17 A galvanometer has resistance 100Q and
it requires current lOOpAforfull sca le deflection. Aresistor 0. ID is connecte
d to make it an ammeter. The smallest current required in the circuit to produce
the full scale deflection is (A) 1000 .1mA (B) 1.1mA (C) 10.1mA (D) 100.1mA [JE
E' 2005 (Scr)] Q.18 An unknown resistan ce X is to be determined using resistanc
es R,, R or R,. Their corresponding null points are A, B and C. Find which of th
e above will give the most accurate read ing and why? [JEE 2005] 2 1| VWv -sC or
R 3 A B R=R, or R 2 Q.19 Consider a cylindrical element as shown in thefigure.Cu
rrent , flowing the through element is I and resistivity ofmaterial ofthe 4 cyli
nder is p. Choose th e correct option out * the following. (A) Power loss in sec
ond half is four time s the power loss infirsthalf. (B) Voltage drop infirsthalf
is twice ofvoltage dro p in second half. (C) Current density in both halves are
equal. (D) Electricfiel din both halves is equal.
r B $2r 1/2 1/2 [JEE 2006] il.Bansal Classes Current Electricity [5]
ANSWER KEY Q I in 12A-20W 4Q 9n 20 ohm Q.2 Q.5 Q.9 Q.13 Q.17 Q.l Q.4 22 I = 2.5
A V = 3.5 Volts Q.4 ^n 3r Q.7 8/7R Q.8 Q.6 V i 2 Q.10 lQ Q.ll 600n Q. 12 I V 10
Q.16 y n , 5 n Q.14 46.67 cm Q.15 4 ohm Q.18 7.5 m, 8.75m, 6.25m Q.19 Rj = 0.027
8 n , R2 = 0.25 n , R = 2.5 n 3.5 A R EXERCISE # I Q.3 R R _3 Q.3 R! 5 (3/1 l)a
Q.2 (a)J A/3;(b)2J A/3 Q.5 7/5 times the length of any si de of the square (i)10
.52n;(u)0.3125n (2 + 7i)ar Q.6 (i) (k - l ) ' ( kk- l )(ii ) ((k-l)/k )v Q7 R 8
Q.8 0.3n Q.9 4/9 kg/sec., 450 sec Q.10 (i) V = - 12 V, (ii) 3 amp from b to a Q.
ll II + 6V2 < ^ V Af - ^ Q.12 R PoL . - I ; i = ;v = V" (e" 1 - e -1 ) A Po e l , Q.13 r + R ( f - f ) ' m a f = 0 , l ; I f = l / 2 Q.14 7.2m Q.15 (a) 5/7R,
(b) 9R/14 22 Q eff ^ Q.19 1A Q.20 233.3n; 144V Q.21 (a) 6m, (b) i n Q.17 - V Q.2
2 (a) 1.01 W, (b) 0-5A 0-10V, (c) 0.05 A 2 0 0 2 2 0 k w 3 ab n 0 e EXERCISE # I
I 3 L v 0 2 f o r I X m in 1 8 a = a EXERCISE # III Vir +V r! l 2 2 2 r + r
Q. 1 20/3 V Q-4 Q.2 (i) D; (ii) M L~ T A ; (iii) Q.5 Q.6 D _1 3 3 2 ( Y ) rr t +
r 2 r l 2 Q.3 D Q.7 (a) No, (b) A J 0-y) ^ B VWV 12 O D (c)8n Q.8 A Q9 Q.10 Batte
ry should be connected across Aand B. Out put can be taken across the terminals
Aand C or B and C Q.ll A Q.12meterB Q.13 C Volt 10' n\ r t - ^ Q.14 t 2 Q.15 B Q
.16 B Q.17 D Q.19 A [5] Q.18 This is true for r = r ; So R, given most accurate
value il.BansalClasses Current Electricity
XII (ALL) ELECTROMAGNETIC INDUCTION ALTERNATING CURRENT CONTENTS & KEY CONCEPTS
EXERCISE-I EXERCISE-II EXERCJSE-llI ANSWER KEY
When a conductor is moved across a magnetic field, an electromotive force (emf)
is produced in the conductor. If the conductors forms part of a closed circuit t
hen the emf produced caused an electric current to flow round the circuit. Henc
e an emf (and thus a current) is induced in the conductor as a result of its mov
e ment across the magnetic field. This is known as "ELECTROMAGNETIC INDUCTION."
1. MAGNETIC FLUX : KEY CONCEPTS (]) = B . A ^BA cos 9 weber for uniform B . (j)
= j B . d A for non uniform B . 2. (i) (ii) An induced emf is setup whenever the
magnetic flux linking that circuit changes. The magnitude of the induced emf in
any circuit is proportional to the rate of change of the magnetic flux linking
the circuit, s a . dt The direction of an in duced emf is always such as to oppo
se the cause producing it. LAW O F EMI: LENZ'S LAWS : FARADAY'S LAWS O F ELECTRO
MAGNETIC INDUCTION : 3. 4. e = - . The neaative sign indicated that the induced
emf opposes the change of t he flux. dt 5. E = BLV sin 0 voltwhere B = flux dens
i ty in wb/m ; L = length of the conductor (m); V=velocity of the conductor (m/s
); 9 = angle between direction of motion of conductor & B . 2 E M F INDUCED IN A
STRAIGHT CONDUCTOR IN UNIFORM MAGNETIC FIELD : 6. COIL ROTATION IN MAGNETIC FIE
ncentric and coplanar circular coils have radii a and b(a)as shown in figur e. Re
sistance of the inner coil is R. Current in the outer coil is increased fro m 0
to i, thenfindthe total charge circulating the inner coil. A horizontal wire isf
reeto slide on the vertical rails of a conductingframeas shown infigure.The wire
has a mass m and length I and the resistance ofthe circuit is R. If a unifo rm
magneticfieldB is directed perpendicular to the frame, thenfindthe terminal s pe
ed ofthe wire as it falls under the force ofgravity. Q, 7 *B x -yww xR X Q.8 Q.9
A metal rod of resistance 200 isfixedalong a diameter of a conducting ring of r
a dius 0.1 m and lies on x-y plane. There is a magnetic field B = (50T)k- The ri
ng rotates with an angular velocity 0 = 20 rad/ sec about its axis. An external
re sistance of 10Q is connected across the centre of the ring andrim.Find the cu
rre nt through external resistance. 6Q r-VW\A 2 mH In the given current,findthe
rati o of i, to i where i, is the initial (at t = 0) current and i i s steady st
ate ( at t = 0 ) current through the battery. 0
2 2 10 Q 10 In the circuit shown, initially the switch is in position 1 for a lo
ng time . Then the switch is shifted to position 2 for a long time. Find the tot
al heat produced in R,. R. -WVVfe Bansal Classes H HVWVR; Electromagnetic Induct
ion [10]
Q.ll Two resistors of 1OQ and 20Q and an ideal inductor of 1 OH are connected to
a 2V battery as shown. The key K is shorted at time t = 0. Find the initial (t
= 0) and final (t oo) currents through battery. L = 10H IW-j I V V W R= ion H>J 2on
Q.12 There exists a uniform cylindrically symmetric magneticfielddirected along
the axis ofa cylinder but varying with time as B = kt. Ifan electron is release
d fromrest in thisfieldat a distance of' r'fromthe axis of cylinder, its acceler
at ion, just after it is released would be (e and m are the electronic charge an
d m ass respectively) Q.13 An emf of 15 volt is applied in a circuit containing
5 H inductance and 10 Q resistance. Find the ratio of the currents at time t = o
o an d t = 1 second. Q. 14 A uniform magnetic field of 0.08 T is directed into t
he pl ane of the page and perpendicular to it as shown in thefigure.A wire loop
in the plane of the page has constant area 0.010 m . The magnitude ofmagneticfie
lddecr ease at a constant rate of 3.0x10 Ts . Find the magnitude and direction o
fthe in duced emf in the loop. 2 4 -1 X x x x Q.15 In the circuit shown infigure
switch S is closed at time t = 0. Find the cha rge which passes through the batt
ery in one time constant. r ^ Li M Rn Q.16 Two coils, 1 & 2, have a mutual induc
tance=M and resistances R each. A curr ent flows in coil 1, which varies with ti
me as: Ij = kt , where K is a constant and't' is time. Find the total charge tha
t has flown through coil 2, between t = 0 and t = T. 2 Q.17 In a L-R decay circu
it, the initial current at t = 0 is I. Find the total c harge that hasflownthrou
gh the resistor till the energy in the inductor has redu ced to one-fourth its i
nitial value. Q.18 A charged ring of mass m = 50 gm, char ge 2 coulomb and radiu
s R=2m is placed on a smooth horizontal surface. Amagnetic fieldvarying with tim
e at a rate of(0.21) Tesla/sec is applied on to theringin a direction normal to
the surface of ring. Find the angular speed attained in a t ime t = 10 sec. x Q.
19 A capacitor C with a charge Q is connected across an inductor through a sw i
tch S. If at t = 0, the switch is closed, thenfindthe instantaneous charge q on
the upper plate of capacitor. 0 Q^ ^ 0 c Q.20 A uniform but time varying magneti
cfieldB = K t - C ; ( 0 < t < C/K), where
K and C are constants and t is time, is applied perpendicular to the plane ofth
e circular loop of radius' a' and resistance R. Find the total charge that will
pass around the loop. Q.21 A coil ofresistance 3000 and inductance 1.0 henry is
connected across an alternating voltage of frequency 3 00/271: Hz. Calculate the
phase difference between the voltage and current in the circuit. Q.22 Find the
value of an inductance which should be connected in series with a capacitor of 5
pF, a resistance of 10Q and an ac source of 50 Hz so that the power factor of t
he circuit is unity. fe Bansal Classes Electromagnetic Induction [10]
Q.23 In an L-R series A. C circuit the potential difference across an inductance
and resistance j oined in series are respectively 12 V and 16V. Find the total
potential difference across the circuit. Q.24 When 100 volt D.C. is applied acro
ss a coil, a current of one ampere flows through it, when 100 V ac of 5 0 Hz is
applied to the same coil, only 0.5 amp flows. Calculate the resistance and indu
c tance of the coil. Q.25 A 50W, 100V lamp is to be connected to an ac mains of2
00 V, 50Hz. What capacitance is essential to be put in seirs with the lamp. List
of recommended questions from I.E. Irodov. 3.288 to 3.299, 3.301 to 3.309, 3.31
1, 3.313, 3.315, 3.316, 3.326 to 3.329, 3.331, 3.333 to 3.335, 4.98, 4.99, 4.100
, 4 .134, 4.135, 4.121, 4.124, 4.125, 4.126, 4.136, 4.137, 4.141, 4.144 fe Bansa
l Classes Electromagnetic Induction [10]
EXERCISEII Q. 1 Two straight conducting rails form a right angle where their ends
are joine d. A conducting bar contact with the rails starts at vertex at the ti
me t = 0 & moves symmetrically with a constant velocity of 5.2 m/s to the right
as shown in figure. A 0.35 T magnetic field points out ofthe page. Calculate: (i
) The flux through the triangle by the rails & bar at t = 3.0 s. (ii) The emf ar
ound the tr iangle at that time. (iii) In what manner does the emf around the tr
iangle vary with time. Q. 2 5.2m/s
Two long parallel rails, a distance I apart and each having a resistance X per u
nit length are joined at one end by a resistance R. A perfectly conducting rod
M N of mass m is free to slide along the rails without friction. There is a unif
or m magnetic field of induction B normal to the plane of the paper and directed
in to the paper. A variable force F is applied to the rod MN such that, as the
rod moves, a constant current i flows through R. Find the velocity ofthe rod and
the applied force F as function of the distance x of the rod from R Q.3 A wirei
sben t into 3 circular segments ofradiusr = 10 cm as shown in figure. Each segme
nt is a quadrant of a circle, ab lying in the xy plane, be lying in the yz plane
& ca lying in the zx plane. (i) if a magnetic field B points in the positive x
direc tion, what is the magnitude of the emf developed in the wire, when B incre
ases a t the rate of 3 mT/s ? (ii) what is the direction ofthe current in the se
gment b e. Q. 4 Consider the possibility of a new design for an electric train.
The engi ne is driven by the force due to the vertical component ofthe earths ma
gneticfie ldon a conducting axle. Current is passed down one coil, into a conduc
ting wheel through the axle, through another conducting wheel & then back to the
source vi a the other rail. (i) what current is needed to provide a modest 10 KN force ? Take the vertical component of the earth'sfieldbe 10 pT & the length
of axle to be 3.0 m. (ii) how much power would be lost for each Q, of resistivi
ty in the r ails ? (iii) is such a train unrealistic ? Q.5 A square wire loop wi
th 2 m sides in perpendicular to a uniform magnetic field, o o o(s ao o o o wit
he ar e loop in the field. The loop contains a 20 V battery with 'i negligible i
nterna l resistance. If the magnitude of the field varies with time S according
to B = 0.042 - 0.871, withB in tesla&tin sec. V ' / (i) What is the total emf in
the ci rcuit ? \ /\ (ii) What is the direction of the current through the batte
ry ? Q.6 A rectangular loop of dimensions I & w and resistance R moves with cons
tant vel ocity V to the right as shown in the figure. It continues to move with
same spee d through a region containing a uniform magnetic field B directed into
the plane ofthe paper & extending a distance 3 W. Sketch the flux, induced emf
& external force acting on the loop as a function ofthe distance. ! : 0 0 0 v fe
Bansal Classes Electromagnetic Induction [10]
Q.7 Q.8 A rectangular loop with current I has dimension as shown in figure. Find
the mag netic flux $ through the infinite region to the right of line PQ. A squ
are loop of side 'a' & resistance R moves with a uniform velocity v away from a
long wire that carries current I as shown in the figure. The loop is moved awayf
romthe wi re with side AB always parallel to the wire. Initially, distance betwe
en the sid e AB of the loop & wire is 'a'. Find the work done when the loop is m
oved throug h distance 'a' from the initial position. Two long parallel conducti
ng horizonta l rails are connected by a conducting wire at one end. A uniform ma
gneticfieldB exists in the region of space. A light uniform ring of diameter d w
hich is pract ically equal to separation between the rails, is placed over the r
ails as shown in thefigure.Ifresistance of ring is X per unit length, calculate
the force requ ired to pull theringwith uniform velocity v. B ic c a 'I'D a | C 0
D * A Q.9 Q.10 Q.ll \ x x x x x x x x x x y. x x Q.12 Available magneticfieldcr
eates a constant emf E in a conductor ABCDA. The r esistances of portion ABC, CD
A and AMC are R R and R respectively. What current will be shown by meter M? The
magnetic field is concentrated near the axis ofthe circular conductor. p 2 3 Q
.13 In the circuit shown in the figure the switched S and S are closed at time t
= 0. After time t = (0.1) In 2 sec, switch S is opened. Find the current in t h
e circuit at time t = (0.2) In 2 sec. t 2 2 #100V 401 S 2 IH j Q.14 (i) (ii) (iii)
(iv) Find the values of / and i immediately after the switch S is closed. long
time l ater, with S closed. immediately after S is open. long time after S is op
ened. C ion i 30Q
i^ioov fe Bansal Classes Electromagnetic Induction [10]
Q.15 Consider the circuit shown infigure.The oscillating source ofemf deliver a
sinusoidal emfof amplitude e andfrequencyco to the inductor L and two capacitors
Cj and C . Find the maximum instantaneous current in each capacitor. max 2 R i(
t) Q.16 Suppose the emfofthe battery, the circuit shown varies with timet so the
current WvV ~ is given by /'(t) = 3 + 5t, where i is in amperes & t is in s eco
nds. Take R = 4Q, L = 6H &findan expression for the battery emf as function o f
time. Q.17 A current of 4 A flows in a coil when connected to a 12 Vdc source. I
fthe same coil is connected to a 12V, 50 rad/s ac source a current of 2.4 A fl o
ws in the circuit. Determine the inductance ofthe coil. Also find the power dev
eloped in the circuit if a 2500 pF capacitor is connected in series with the coi
l. Q.18 An LCR series circuit with 1000 resistance is connected to an ac source
of2 00 V and angular frequency 300 rad/s. When only the capacitance is removed,
the current lags behind the voltage by 60. When only the inductance is removed,
the c urrent leads the voltage by 60. Calculate the current and the power dissipa
ted in the LCR circuit. Q.19 A box P and a coil Q are connected in series with a
n ac s ource ofvariable frequency. The emf of source at 10 V. Box P contains a c
apacita nce of 1 pF in series with a resistance of 32Q coil Q has a self-inducta
nce 4.9 mH and a resistance of 68Q series. The frequency is adjusted so that the
maximum current flows in P and Q. Find the impedan-^ of P and Q at this frequen
cy. Also find the voltage across P and Q respectively. Q.20 A series LCR circuit
contain ing a resistance of 120Q has angular resonancefrequency4 x 10 rad s' .
At resona nce the voltages across resistance and inductance are 60 V and 40 V re
spectively . Find the values of L and C. At whatfrequencythe current in the circ
uit lags th e voltage by 45? 5 1 fe Bansal Classes Electromagnetic Induction [10]
EXERCISEIII Q. 1 Arectangular frame ABCD made of auniform metal wire has a straig
ht connecti on B between E & F made ofthe same wire as shown in thefigure.AEFD i
s a square x x x x of side 1 m & EB = FC = 0.5 m. The entire circuit is placed i
n a steadily X X X X X y increasing uniform magneticfielddirected into the place
ofthe paper & normal X IK X X X to it. The rate of change of the magneticfieldi
s 1 T/s, the resistance per unit D length ofthe wire is 1 O/m. Find the current
in segments AE, BE & EF. [JEE'93, 5] Q.2 An inductance L, resistance R, battery
B and switch S are ji H 3 H connected in series. Voltmeters V and V are connected a
cross L and R respectively. When switch is closed: (A) The initial reading in V
will be grea ter than in V . (B) The initial reading in V will be lesser than V
. (C) The ini tial readings in V and V will be the same. s (D) The reading in V
will be decrea sing as time increases. [JEE'93, 2] Q.3 Two parallel vertical met
allic rails AB & CD are separated by 1 m. They are connected at the two ends by
resistance R & R as shown in the figure. A horizontally metallic bar L of mass 0
.2 kg slides wi thoutfriction,vertically down the rails under the action of grav
ity. There is a uniform horizontal magnetic field of 0.6T perpendicular to the p
lane of the rail s, it is observed that when the terminal velocity is attained,
the power dissipa ted inRj & R, are 0.76 W & 1.2 W respectively. Find the termin
al velocity of bar L & value R, & R [JEE '94, 6] v L R L R L R L R L } 2 n Q. 4
Two different coils have self inductance 8mH and 2mH. The current in one coil is
increased at a constant rate. The current in the second coild is also increased
at the same constant. At a certain instant of time, the power given to the two
coils is the same. At that time the current, the induced voltage and the energy
stored in thefirstcoil are I Vj and respectively. Corresponding values for the s
econd coil at the same instant are I , v and W, respectively. Then: [JEE' 94,2]
]_ Ij 1 2 Ii Yl. (B) (D) V, 4 IT4 p 2 2 W ( A ) Q.5
(a) (b) A metal rod OA of mass m & length r is kept rotating with a constant ang
ular spe ed co in a vertical plane about a horizontal axis at the end O. Thefree
end Ais a rranged to slide withoutfrictionalong afixedconducting circular ring i
n the same plane as that ofrotation. Auniform & constant magnetic induction is a
pplied per pendicular & into the plane ofrotation as shown in figure. An inducto
r L and an external resistance R are connected through a switch S between the po
int O & a p oint C on the ring to form an electrical circuit. Neglect the resist
ance ofthe r ing and the rod. Initially, the switch is open. What is the induced
emf across t he terminals of the switch ? (i) Obtain an expression for the curr
ent as a funct ion of time after switch S is closed. (ii) Obtain the time depend
ence ofthe torq ue required to maintain the constant angular speed, given that t
he rod OA was al ong the positive X-axis at t = 0. [JEE '95,10] Electromagnetic
Induction fe Bansal Classes [10]
Q.6 Q.7 A solenoid has an inductance of 10 Henry & a resistance of 2 D. It is co
nnected to a 10 volt battery. How long will it take for the magnetic energy to r
each 1 / 4 of its maximum value ? [JEE'96, 3] Select the correct alternative. X
X X A thi n semicircular conducting ring of radius R is falling with its plane v
ertical in X :X B x a horizontal magnetic induction B. At the position MNQ the sp
eed of the ring is x /\ A x v & the potential difference developed across the ri
ng is: M B VTCR (A)zero & M is at higher potential (B) (D) 2 RB V & Q is at high
er potentia l (C) k RB V & Q is at higher potential Fill inthe blank. A metallic
block carry ing current I is subjected to a uniform magnetic induction which re
sults B j. Th e moving charges experience a force F given by in the lowering of
the potential of the face [JEE '96, 2] [assume the speed of the carrier to be v]
.' N >: x V V * , VI A X x x xY x \ X Q.8 [JEE'96,2] A pair ofparallel horizonta
l conducting rails ofnegligible resistance shorted at one end is fixed on a tabl
e. The distance between the rails is L. A conducting massless rod of resistance
R can slide on the rails frictionlessly. The rod is t ied to a massless string w
hich passes over a pulleyfixedto the edge of the table . Amass m, tied to the ot
her end of the string hangs vertically. A constant magn eticfieldB exists perpen
dicular to the table. If the system is releasedfromrest, calculate: the terminal
velocity achieved by the rod. 0) the acceleration ofthe mass at the instant whe
n the velocity ofthe rod is halfthe terminal velocity. ( ") [JEE '97, 5] Q.10 Ac
urrent/ = 3.36 (1 +2t) x 10" A increases at a steady rate in a long straight wir
e. A small circular loop of radius 10~ m is in the plane of the wire & is placed
at a distance of 1 m from the wire. The resistance of th e loop is 8.4 x 10" D.
Find the magnitude & the direction of the induced current in the loop. [REE '98
, 5] Q.ll Select the correct alternative(s). [ JEE '98, 3 x 2 = 6,4x2=8] The SI
unit of inductance, the Henry, can be written as : (i) (A) weber/ampere (B) volt
-second/ampere (C) joule/(ampere) (D) ohm-second of side I is placed inside a la
rge square wire of A small square loop ofwirecentres coinc ide. The mutual induc
tanceloop ofsystem isside L(L I ) .toThe loop are co-planar & their of the propo
rtional : (D)K (A) ( B )i Q9 2 3 2 2 2 (iii) fe Bansal Classes A metal rod moves
at a constant velocity in a direction perpendicular to its len gth. A constant,
uniform magneticfieldexists in space in a direction perpendicul ar to the rod a
s well as its velocity. Select the correct statement(s)fromthe fo llowing (A) th
e entire rod is at the same electric potential (B) there is an ele
ctricfieldin the rod (C) the electric potential is highest at the centre of the
rod & decreases towards its ends (D) the electric potential is lowest at the cen
tre of the rod & increases towards its ends. Electromagnetic Induction [10]
(iv) An inductor of inductance 2.0mH,is connected across a charged capacitor of
capac itance 5.0pF,and the resulting LC circuit is set oscillating at its natura
lfrequ ency.Let Q denote the instantaneous charge on the capacitor, and I the cu
rrent i n the circuit. It is found that the maximum value of Q is 200 pC. (a) wh
en Q= 10 0 pC, what is the value of | dl / dt| ? (b) when Q=200 pC ,what is the
value of I ? (c) Find the maximum value of I. (d) when I is equal to one half it
s maximum value, what is the value of | Q| Q.12 Two identical circular loops of
metal wir e are lying on a table without touching each other. Loop-A carries a c
urrent whi ch increases with time. In response, the loop-B [JEE' 99] (A) remains
stationary (B) is attracted by the loop-A (C) is repelled by the loop-A (D) rot
ates about its CM, with CM fixed Q.13 A coil of inductance 8.4 mH and resistance
6Q is conn ected to a 12V battery. The current in the coil is 1.0 A at approxim
ately the ti me (A) 500 s (B) 20 s (C)35 ms (D) 1 ms [ JEE'99 ] Q.14 A circular
loop of radiu s R, carrying current I, lies in x-y plane with its centre at orig
in. The total magnetic flux through x-y plane is (A) directly prop ortional to I
(B) directly proportional to R (C) directly proportional to R (D) zero [JEE' 99
] 2 Q.15 A magneticfieldB = (B y / a) k is into the plane ofpaper in the +z dire
ctio n. B and a are positive constants. A square loop EFGH of side a, mass m and
resi stance R in x-y plane, starts falling under the influence of gravity. Note
the d irections ofx and y axes in the figure. Find (a) the induced current in t
he loop and indicate its direction, (b) the total Lorentz force acting on the lo
op and indicate its direction, (c) an expression for the speed ofthe loop, v(t)
and its terminal value. 0 0 <g>E, F I GMH 8 0 0 0 1 1 [JEE '99] Q.16 Two circular
coils can be arranged in any ofthe three situations shown in t hefigure.Their m
utual inductance will be (A) maximum in situation (a) <=> 0 (B) maximum in situa
tion (b) ^ -^Q (C) maximum in situation (c) <a) (b) <c) (D) the s ame in all situ
ations [JEE'2001, (Scr)] g c Q.17 An inductor of inductance L = 400 mH and resis
tors of resistances R, = 2Q a nd II, = 2D. are connected to a battery of e.m.f.
E= 12V as shownin thefigure.Th e internal resistance of the battery is negligibl
e. The switch S is closed at ti me t = 0. What is the potential drop across L as
a function oftime? After the st eady state is reached, the switch is opened. Wh
at is the direction and the magni tude of current through R as a function of tim
e? [JEE'2001] : fe Bansal Classes Electromagnetic Induction [10]
Q 18 As shown inthefigure,P and Q are two coaxial conducting loops separated by
some distance. When the switch S is closed, a clockwise current I flows in P (as
seen by E) and an induced current I flows in Q. The switch remains closed for a
long time. When S is opened, a current I flows in Q. Then the directions of I a
dn I (as seen by E) are: (A) respectively clockwise and anti-clockwise (B) both
clockwise Battery' (C) both anti-clockwise (D) respectively anti-clockwise and
c lockwise [JEE 2002(Scr), 3] Q.19 A short -circuited coil is placed in a time v
ar ying magneticfield.Electrical power is dissipated due to the current induced
in the coil. Ifthe number ofturns were to be quadrupled and the wire radius halv
ed, the electrical power dissipated would be [JEE 2002(Scr), 3] (A) halved (B) t
he same (C) doubled (D) quadrupled p Q2 Q! Q2 Q . 20 A square loop of side 'a' w
ith a capacitor of capacitance C is located be tween two current carrying long p
arallel wires as shown. The value of I in the i s given as I = I sincot. (a) cal
culate maximum current in the square loop. (b) D raw a graph between charge on t
he lower plate of the capacitor v/s time. Q.21 Th e variation of induced emf (s)
with time (t) in a coil if a short bar magnet is moved along its axis with a co
nstant velocity is best represented as 0 [JEE 2003] mm [JEE 2004(Scr)] (A) (B) (
C) 0 (D) Q.22 In an LR series circuit, a sinusoidal voltage V = V sin cot is app
lied. It is given that L = 3 5 mH, R = 11 O, co V = 220 V,' 2% 50 Hz and % = 22/
7. Find t he amplitude of current in the steady state and obtain the phase diffe
rence betw een the current and the voltage. Also plot the variation of current f
or one cycl e on the given graph. [JEE 2004] Q.23 An infinitely long cylindrical
conducting rod is kept along + Z direction. A constant magneticfieldis also pre
sent in+Z direction. Then current induced wil l be (A) 0 (B) along +z direction
(C) along clockwise as seen from + Z (D) along anticlockwise as seen from+Z [JEE
' 2005 (Scr)] Q.24 A long solenoid of radius a and number ofturns per unit lengt
h n is enclosed by cylindrical shell of radius R, thickness d (d R ) and length
L. A variable current i = i sin cot flows thro ugh the coil. Ifthe resistivity o
f the material of cylindrical shell is p,findth e induced current inthe shell. [
JEE 2005] Q JT" 3 fe Bansal Classes Electromagnetic Induction [10]
Q.25 In the given diagram, a line offeree of a particular force field is shown.
Out ofthe following options, it can never represent (A) an electrostatic field (
B) a magnetostatic field (C) a gravitationalfieldof a mass at rest (D) an induc
e d electric field [JEE 2006] Comprehension -/ The capacitor of capacitance C ca
n be charged (with the help of a resistance R) by a voltage source V, by closing
s witch S[ while keeping switch S open. The capacitor can be connected in serie
s w ith an inductor 'L' by closing switch S and opening S j. 2 2 2 Q. 26 Initial
ly, the capacitor was uncharged. Now, switch Sj is closed and S is kept open. If
time constant of this circuit is x, then (A) after time interval x , charge on
the capacitor is CV/2 (B) after time interval 2x, charge on the capa citor is C
V( l-e~ ) (C) the work done by the voltage source will be half of the heat dissi
pated when the capacitor is fully charged. (D) after time interval 2x , charge o
n the capacitor is C V( 1-e ) [JEE 2006] 2 1 -npmw ! Q.27 After the capacitor ge
ts fully charged, Sj is opened and S is closed so tha t the inductor is connecte
d in series with the capacitor. Then, (A) at t = 0, en ergy stored in the circui
t is purely in the form of magnetic energy (B) at any t ime t > 0, current in th
e circuit is in the same direction (C) at t > 0, there i s no exchange of energy
between the inductor and capacitor 2 (D) at any time t > 0, instantaneous curre
nt in the circuit may V j 1 [JEE 2006] Q.28 If the total charge stored in the LC
circuit is Q , then for t > 0 (r 71 tt (A) the charge on the capacitor is Q = Q
cos V2 VLC (B) the charge on the capac itor is Q = Q cosf it t 2 VLC 0 tt 0 + 0
(C) the charge on the capacitor is Q = -LC d Q dt (D) the charge on the capacito
r is Q = - 1 d Q V L C dt 2 2 2 [JEE 2006] fe Bansal Classes Electromagnetic In
duction [10]
Comprehension IV Magler Train: This train is based on the Lenz law and phenomena
of electromagnetic induction. In this there is a coil on a railway track and mag
net on the base of train. So as train is deviated then as is move down coil on
t rack repel it and as it move up then coil attract it. Disadvantage of magler t
ra in is that as it slow down the forces decreases and as it moves forward so du
e t o Lenz law coil attract it backward. Due to motion oftrain current induces i
n th e coil of track which levitate it. Q.29 What is the advantage ofthe train?
(A) E lectrostatic force draws the train (C) Electromagnetic force draws the tra
in (B) Gravitational force is zero. (D) Dissipative force due to friction are ab
sent [ JEE 2006] Q.30 What is the disadvantage of the train? (A) Train experienc
e upward force du e to Lenz's law. (B) Friction force create a drag on the train
. (C) Retardation (D) By Lenz's law train experience a drag Q.31 Which force cau
ses the train to e levate up (A) Electrostatic force (C) magnetic force Q.32 Mat
ch the following Co lumns Column 1 (A) Dielectric ring uniformly charged (B) Die
lectric ring uniform ly charged rotating with angular velocity. (C) Constant cur
rent inringi (D) Curr ent i = i cos cot in ring 0 0 [JEE 2006] [JEE 2006] (B) Ti
me varying electric field (D) Induced electric field Column 2 (P) Time independe
nt electrostaticfieldout of system (Q) Magnetic field (R) Induced electric field
(S) Magnetic moment [JEE 2006] fe Bansal Classes Electromagnetic Induction [10]
ANSWER Q.l 10 n V Q.2 XVB0 Q.3 EXERCISE-I 5.0 p V KEY Q.4 I" 1 Q.5 2N LE Q.6 Q.l
l p ia % 2Rb 0 Q.7 mgR B/ 2 2 Q8 -A Q.9 O.J Q.10 2Rr erk Q12 Q-13 2 _ e d i r e
c t e d a i o n g tangent to the circle of radius r, whose centre lies on the ax
is of cylinder. Q.15 EL Q.16 kMT /(R) 2 1 Q.14 3nV, clockwise f Q.17 LI/2R Q.21
7t/4 T" ^ Q.18 200 rad/sec Q.19 q = Q sin LC t + 7C 1 2J 0 A Q.20 C7ta /R 2
nrr Q.22 = 2H Q 23 20 V 2 0 K Q.24 R= 100W, V3/71 Hz Q.25 C = 9.2 pF EXERCISE-II
Q.l 85.22Tm ;(ii)56.8 V; (iii)linearly 2 Q.2 8 Bd Bd 17 + Q.3 (i) 2.4 x 10-5 v
(ii) from to b Q.4 (i) 3.3 x 10 A,(ii) 1.0 x 10 W,(iii) totally unrealistic c 4Q
.5 21.74 V, anticlockwise Q.6 ~1 rl 3 Q.7 <|) = 271 L /n a+b ~I a Q.9 4B vd 2 Q.
8 ^o I a V (n 3a a 4 4n R 2 2 2 2 2 3 2 ^o I aV , 2tt R 3 4 2 2 1 2 nX Q.lO^^/n 2
71 a fe Bansal Classes Electromagnetic Induction [10]
Q.ll v / dB L 2 - R / 2 dt v 4 2 2 2 Q.12 R E Rj 1 2 2 3 3 1 R + R R + R R 2 2 Q
.13 67/32 A Q. 14 (i) ij = i = 10/3 A, 00 ii = 50/11 A; i = 30/11A (iii) h = 0,
i = 20/11 A, (iv) = i = 0 2 Q.15 C = 2 i r- f r V 1 1+M v coL-- 1 Ca fflL(Q+Cs). (
Cj + C ) Ci V 2 A V 2 A r c c C 2 Q.16 42 + 20t volt Q.17 0.08 H, 17.28 W Q.20 0
.2 mH, ^ F , 8 > < 10 rad/s 5 Q.18 2A 400W Q.19 77Q, 97.6Q, 7.7V, 9.76V EXERCISE
-III Q h \ 22 ' 1 A I b e 11 A ; i p E 22 A Q.2 A, D Q.3 V= 1 ms , i = 0.47 0 ,
R^, = 0.30D _1 R Q.4ACD 1 Bor [l-e" J mgr Q.5 (a) E= - Bror (b) (i) 1= ^ , (ii)
x= - f - coscot + coB r (l-e~ ) o 2 Rt/L 2 4 2 J 4 R Rt/L Q.6 t = /n2 = 3.47 sec
R mgR Q-9 V terminal Q.7 D o
Q.8 evBk , ABDC = ; (ii) f Q.10 1.6 71 x 10-13 A= 50.3 pA 4 Q. 11 (i) A, B, C, D
, (ii) B, (iii) B, (iv) (a) 10 A/s (b) 0 (c) 2A (d) 100^3 pC Q.12 C Q.13 D Q.14
D Q.15 (a) i = ~ in anticlockwise direction, v=velocity at tim e t, (b) F =B a V/R
, R nett 0 2 2 ( C ) V mgR ' 1 - e Ba 2 2 Bpa 2 t ^ m R fe Bansal Classes Electr
omagnetic Induction [10]
Q.16 A Q.18 D Q.17 I2e" , 6e 5t _10t Q.19 B 2 Q-20 ( a ) I = ^ C I G ) / n 2 , (
b) m a x 0 Q.21 B v = 220V2 sin cot i = 20 sin (at-n'4) V,I Q.22 20A,7, ' Steady s
tate current i = 20sin 71 lOOt71 2 ?> W-J2 r/8 r/4 \sr/8" T 9TIS Q.23 A Q.25 A,C Q
.29 D Q.26 B Q.30 D Q.24 1 = Q.27 D Q.31 C (H ni (Dcoscot)7ta (Ld) 0 0 p27iR Q.2
8 C Q.32 (A) P; (B) P, Q, S; (C) Q,S ; (D) Q, R, S
XII (ALL) ELECTROMAGNETIC INDUCTION & ALTERNATING CURRENT QUESTION BANK ON
QUESTION FOR SHORT ANSWER Q.l Q.2 Q.3 Q.4 Q.5 Are induced emfs and currents diff
erent in any way from emfs and currents provid ed by a battery connected to a co
nducting loop? Can a charged particle at rest b e set in motion by the action of
a magnetic field? If not, why not? If so, how? Consider both static and time-va
rying fields. In Faraday's law of induction, doe s the induced emf depend on the
resistance ofthe circuit? If so, how? Figure sho ws a copper ring that is hung
from a ceiling by two threads. Describe in detail how you might most effectively
use a bar magnet to get this ring to swing back a nd forth. Two conducting loop
s face each other a distance d apart, as shown in f igure. An observer sights al
ong their common axis from left to right. A clockwis e current i is suddenly est
ablished in the larger loop by a battery not shown, ( a) What is the direction o
f the induced current in the smaller loop? (b) What is the direction ofthe force
(if any) that acts on the smaller loop? A circular lo op moves with constant ve
locity through regions where uniform magneticfieldsofth e same magnitude are dir
ected into or out ofthe plane of the page, as indicated infigure.At which ofthe
seven indicated positions will the induced current be (a ) clockwise, (b) counte
rclockwise, and (c) zero? Q.6 IX X X Q.7 Q.8 Q. 9 Can an induced current ever es
tablish a magneticfieldB that is in the same direc tion as the magnetic field in
ducing the current? Justify your answer. A plane cl osed loop is placed in a uni
form magneticfield.In what ways can the loop be move d without inducing an emf?
Consider motions both oftranslation and rotation. Fig ure (a) shows a top view o
f the electron orbit in a betatron. Electrons are acce lerated in a circular orb
it in the xy plane and then withdrawn to strike the tar get T. The magneticfield
B is along the z axis (the positive z axis is out ofthe page). The magneticfield
B along this axis varies sinusoidally as shown in figure (b). Recall that the ma
gneticfieldmust (i) guide the electrons in their circula r path and (ii) generat
e the electricfieldthat accelerates the electrons. Which quarter cycle(s) infigu
reare suitable (a) according to (i), (b) according to (ii ), and (c) for operati
on of the betatron? z 2 5/-\6 '4 7\ (a) | | Bansal Classes (b) Question Bank on
EMI [2]
Q.10 (i) A piece of metal and a piece of non-metallic stone are droppedfromthe s
ame height near the surface of the earth. Which one will reach the ground earli
e r? (ii) (iii) (iv) (v) A metallic loop is placed in a nonuniform magneticfield
,w ill an emf be induced in the loop ? A wire loop is held with its plane horizo
nta l. Amagnet with its north pole downward is allowed to fall through itfromsom
e he ight. Will the magnet fall with constant acceleration? What will happen ift
he po les are reversed? A magnet is dropped down into long vertically copper tub
e. Sho w that, even neglecting air resistance the magnet will reach a constant t
erminal velocity. A magnet is droppedfromthe ceiling along the axis of a copper
loop ly ingflaton thefloor.Ifthe falling magnet is photographed with a time sequ
ence cam era, what differences, if any will be noted if, (i) the loop is at room
temperat ure the loop is packed in dry ice ? Q.ll A copper ring is suspended in
a vertical plane by a thread. A steel bar is passed through the ring in the hori
zontal direction which is perpendicular to th e plane of the loop. Then a magnet
is similarly passed through the loop. Will th e motion ofthe magnet and the bar
affect the position of the ring? Q.12 If the m agneticfieldoutside a copper box
is suddenly changed, what happens to the magnet icfieldinside the box ? Such lo
w-resistivity metals are used to form enclosures which shield objects inside the
m against varying magnetic fields. Q.13 Metallic (nonferromagnetic) and nonmetal
lic particles in a solid waste may be separated a s follows. The waste is allowe
d to slide down an incline over permanent magnets. The metallic particles slow d
own as compared to the nonmetallic ones and hence are separated. Discuss the rol
e of eddy currents in the process. Q.14 Ajet plane isflyingdue north. A potentia
l difference is produced between he wing tips ofth e plane. Will a passenger sit
ting inside the plane also expect some emfbetween t he wing tips? Will a tiny bu
lb connected to the wing tips glow? Q.15 Is the indu ctance per unit length for
a solenoid near its centre; (a) the same as(b) less t han or (c) greater than th
e inductance per unit length near its ends ? Q.16 Two solenoids A & B have the s
ame diameter & length & contain only one layer of wind ings, with adj acent turn
s touching, insulation thickness being negligible. Sole noid A contains many tur
ns offinewire & solenoid B contains fewer turns ofheavie r wire, (i) which solen
oid has the larger inductance? (i) which solenoid has the larger inductive time
constant ? (material is same) B Q.17 If thefluxN4> through each turn of a coil i
s the same, the inductance of th e coil may be computed passing from L = j . How
might one compute L for a coil f or which this assumption is not valid . (fe Ba
nsal Classes Question Bank on EMI [3]
Q.18 If a current in a source of emfis in the direction of the emf, the energy o
fthe source decreases, if a current is in a direction opposite to the emf (as i
n charging a battery), the energy of the source increases Do these statements ap
p ly to the inductor. Q.19 Does the time required for the current in particular
LR circuit to build up to any given fraction of its equilibrium value depend on
th e value of the applied emf. Q.20 A steady current is set up in a coil with a
ver y large inductive time constant. When the current is interupted with a switc
h a heavy arc tends to appear at the switch blades. Explain? [Note: interrupting
cur rents in highly inductive circuits can be dangerous] Q.21 What is the advan
tage of placing the two electric wires carrying ac close together? Q. 22 In an L
R ser ies circuit the selfinduced emfis a maximum at the instant the switch is c
losed. How can this be since there is no current in the inductance at this insta
nt. Q. 23 Explain what is meant by the statement "A motor acts as a motor and ge
nerato r at the same time." Can the same be said for a generator? Q. 24 In a tor
oid, is the energy density larger near the inner radius or near the outer radius
? Q.25 Two circular loop s are placed with their centres separated by afixeddis
tance. How would you orient the loops to have (a) the largest mutual inductance
(b) the smallest mutual inductance ? Q.26 If the resistance R in the left hand c
ircuit offigureis increased, what is the direction ofthe induced current in the
right h and circuit ? (fe Bansal Classes Question Bank on EMI [14]
ONLY ONE OPTION IS CORRECT. Take approx. 2 minutes for answering each question.
An electron is moving in a circular orbit on a. At the centre ofthe orbit is kep
t a The e.m.f induced in the smaller loop due ero, since charge on electron in c
onstant a er er y^Q-rl a conducting loop of radius R is present in a uniform mag
netic field B perpendic ular the plane ofthe ring. Ifradius R varies as a functi
on oftime't', as R = R + 1. The e.m.f induced in the loop is (A) 2TC(R + t)B clo
ckwise ( B ) 7 T ( R + T ) B clockwise (C) 27T(R + t)B anticlockwise (D) zero A
wire loop is placed in a region oftime varying magneticfieldwhich is oriented or
thogonally to the plane o f the loop as shown in thefigure.The graph shows the m
agneticfieldvariation as t he function oftime. Assume the positive emf is the on
e which drives a current in the clockwise direction and seen by the observer in
the direction of B. Which o f the following graphs best represents the induced e
mf as a function oftime. 0 d 4TTR Q 0 J J T 4 Q.5 (C) (D) ST A square wire loop
of 10.0 cm side lies at right angles to a uniform magneticfieldof 20T. A10 V lig
ht bulb is in a series with the loop as shown in t hefig.The magneticfieldis dec
reasing steadily to zero over a time interval At. T he bulb will shine with full
brightness if At is equal to (A) 20 ms (B) 0.02 ms (C) 2 ms (D) 0.2 ms A long s
traight wire is parallel to one edge as infig.If the current in the long wire is
varies intime as I = T -fx, what will be the induce d emf in the loop?" p bl d
+ a ^ d+a (A) In ( B ) ^ f e . 711 / 2ttc V e T 0 w (A) (B) t, t. (D) TIT In d+a
7ix v a A rectangular loop with a sliding connector oflength 10 c m is situated
in uniform magneticfieldperpendicular to plane of loop. The magnet ic induction
is 0.1 tesla and resistance of connector (R) is 1 ohm. The sides AB and CD have
resistances 2 ohm and 3 ohm respectively. Find the current in the c onnector dur
ing its motion with constant velocity one metre/sec. p 0 bl (B) 220 of radius R
with an angular accelerati conducting loop of radius r, (r R ) . to the motion o
f the electron is (A) z (B) Po a 4R (D) none of these (C) M-o
1 (D) 440 A (fe Bansal Classes Question Bank on EMI [5]
Q/f The magnetic flux through a stationary loop with resistance R varies during
inte rval of time T as <j> = at (T -1). The heat generated during this time negl
ectin g the inductance of loop will be a^T aT a a (C) 3R (A) 3R (B) 3R CD) R Q/8
" The dimensions of permeability offreespace can be given by (D) [MLA^ ] (A) [ML
T A" ] (B) [MLA" ] (C) [ML" T A ] Q.9 A wire as a parabola y = a x is located in
a uni form magnetic field of inductance B, the vector B being perpendicular to
the pla ne xy. At the moment t = 0 a connector starts translation wisefromthe pa
rabola a pex with a constant acceleration co tofindthe emf of electromagnetic in
duction i n the loop this formed as a function of y 2 2 2 2 2 3 2 2 1 2 (AW =2 B
y c S = (BK in By (D) s ( ) in a ' 2 A thin circular ring of area 10~ m is held
perpendicular t o a uniform magneticfieldofinduction 0.1 T. A small cut is made
in the ring and the galvanometer is connected across the ends such that the tota
l resistance of the circuit is 0.1 Q. The ring is squeezed to area 0.5 x 10 m in
time 0.1 sec. T he average induced current in the circuit is (A) insufficient d
ata (B) 0.05 A (C )0.5A (D)5A A closed planar wire loop ofarea A and arbitrary s
hape is placed in a uniform magneticfieldofmagnitude B, with its plane perpendic
ular to magneticfi eld.The resistance of the wire loop is R. The loop is now tur
ned upside down by 180 so that its plane again becomes perpendicular to the magne
ticfield.The total charge that must have flowed through the wire ring in the pro
cess is (A) < AB/R (B)=AB/R (C) = 2AB/R (D)None D fy r A square coil ABCD is pla
ced in x-y plane wi th its centre at origin. A long straight wire, passing throu
gh origin, carries a current in negative z-direction. Current in this wire incre
ases with time. The induced current in the coil is : (A) clockwise (B) anticlock
wise (C) zero (D) al ternating By 2 2 -2 2 J ^ 3 s j * r1I 5 (fe Bansal Classes
A vertical bar magnet is droppedfromposition on the axis ofafixedmetallic rh s c
ii coil as shown infig-1. Infig- II the magnet isfixedand horizontal coil is dr
opped. The acceleration ofthe magnet and coil are al and cl, respectively i1. N
L then C ]1 J) fixed fixed N (B) aj > g, a < g (A) a, > g , a > (C) a, < g a < g
fig-H (D) a. < fig-I Two identical coaxial circular loops carry a current i eac
h circulating inthe same direction. If the loops approach each other (A) the cur
r ent in each will decrease (B) the current in each will increase (C) the curren
t in each will remain the same (D) the current in one will increase and in other
w ill decrease A long straight conductor is placed along axis of a circular coi
l o f radius R. Ifthe current, B as shown infigure,starts decreasing with time,
the current induced in loop would be \ (A) clockwise (ACB) (B) anticlockwise (AB
C) S e ^ (C) can not be decided (D) there will be no induced current. 2
2 2 A Question Bank on EMI [6]
Q . 16 In a long hollow vertical metal pipe a magnet is dropped. During its fall
, the acceleration of magnet: (A) will decrease linearly (B) will decrease upto
a value which is less than g. (C) will decrease to zero and will attain a termi
n al speed (D) may increase or decrease s^tyrff In the arrangement shown in give
nf igurecurrentfromAto B is increasing inmagnitude. Induced current in the loop
wil l (A) have clockwise direction (B) have anticlockwise direction (C) be zero
(D) oscillate between clockwise and anticlockwise An electric current ij canflow
eith erdirectionthroughloop(l) and induced current i, in loop (2). Positive i, i
s whe n current isfrom'a' to 'b' in loop (1) ' loop (l) and positive i is when t
he cur rent is from 'c' to'd' in loop (2) In an experiment, the graph of i again
st time *t* is as shown below v 2 2 l o o p (2) Which one(s) of the following gr
aphs could have caused i to behave as give above . 2 (A) (C) (B)o (D) ^Qr1"9 A b
ar magnet is releasedfromrest along the axis of a very long, vertical copper tub
e after some time, the magnet (A) will stop the tube (B) will move wit h almost
constant speed (C) will move with acceleration g (D) will oscillate J^> 0 Figure
shows a bar magnet and a long straight wire W, carrying current into th e plane
of paper. Point P is the point of intersection of axis of magnet and the line N
of shortest distance between magnet and the wire. If P is the midpoint o f the
magnet, then which of the following statements is correct ? W (A) magnet e xperi
ences a torque in clockwise direction (B) magnet experiences a torque in an ticl
ockwise direction (C) magnet experiences a force, normal to the line of shor tes
t distance (D) magnet experiences a force along the line of shortest distance X
QrlT A square coil ABCD is lying in xy plane with its centre at origin. A lng st
raight wire passing through origin carries a current i = 2t in negative z-direc
t ion. The induced current in the coil is (A) clockwise (B) anticlockwise (C) al
ng th. Ignore gravity and any external magneticfield.If specific charge ofelectr
ons is (e/m), then the potential difference between the ends ofthe rod is steady
st ate must be (A)|F -F |mL/eM (B) (F -F )mL/eM (C) [mL/eM]/n [F,/F ] (D)None T
wo p arallel rigid wires arefixedat a distance' d' apart, with each wire in a ve
rtica l position. The top ends of the two wires are connected through an ideal i
nducto r of inductance L. Astraight connector of mass M can slidefreelyup and do
wn, mai ntaining electrical contact with the two wires, in a horizontal position
. Aunifo rm magneticfieldexists perpendicular to the plane of the wires. If the
connector is releasedfromrest, the graph ofits downward velocity with time is: 2
2 2 } 2 1 2 1 2 2 (D) (C) (B) 31 A rod closing the circuit shown infiguremoves
along a U shaped wi re at a constant speed v under the action of the force F. Th
e circuit is in a un iform magnetic field perpendicular to the plane. Calculate
F ifthe rate ofheat g eneration in the circuti is Q. (A) (A) F = Qv ( B ) F =v ?
(- Q F = ^ Q (D) F = a/Qv Two parallel long straight con ductors lie on a smoot
h surface. Two other parallel conductors rest on J^ them a t right angles so as
to form a square of side a initially. Auniform magneticfiel dB exists at right a
ngles to the plane containing the conductors. They start mov ing out with a cons
tant velocity v. If r is the resistance per unit length ofthe wire the current i
n the circuit will be Bv Br (B) (C)Bvr (D) Bv (A) r v <39 Ther e is a uniform mag
neticfieldB normal to the xy plane. A conductor ABC has length AB = l , parallel
to the x-axis, and length BC = / , parallel to the y-axis. AB C moves in the xy
plane with velocity ,c v i + v j . The potential difference be tween Aand C is
proportional to (A)v / v / (B )v / + v / (Qv/rV. () V i \l2 A con ducting rod PQ
of length 5 m oriented as shown infigureis moving with velocity ( 2 m/s) i witho
ut any rotation in a uniform magneticfield(3j + 4k) Tesla. Emf ind uced in the r
od is (A) 3 2 Volts (B) 40 Volt (C) 50 Volt (D)none An equilateral triangular lo
op ADC of somefinitemagneticfieldB as shown in thefigure.At time t = 0, side DC
ofloop is at edge ofthe magneticfield.Magnetic field is perpendicul ar to the pa
per inwards (or perpendicular to the plane of the x coil). The induc ed current
versus time graph will be as x
X X X X X X X X X X X X X X X X X X X X X X y~yF; 8 x 2 x y x 1 + y 2 x 2 y 1 x
x (A) (B) (Q (D) (fe Bansal Classes Question Bank on EMI [10]
QA2 In the circuit shown infigure,a conducting wire HE is moved with a constant
speed V towards left. The complete circuit is placed in a uniform magnetic field
B perpendicular to the plane of the circuit directed in inward direction. The c
urrent in HKDE is (A) clockwise (B) anticlockwise (C) alternating (D) zero C =
c A H K "C D The magnetic field in a region is given by B B 1 + X jk A square lo
op of edge length d is a] J*44 placed with its edge along x & y axis. The loop i
s moved with constant velocity V = v i The emf induced in the loop is VBa V B d^
%B d" (D) None (A) a (C) d (B) 2a When a ' J' shaped conducting rod is rotating
in its own plane with constant angular velocity w, about one of its end P, in a
uniform magneticfieldB directe d normally into the plane of paper) then magnitu
de of emfinduced across it will be o 0 0 0 0 0 (A)BQ^L +l 2 2 2 (B) ^ B o L 2 2
^ (fe Bansal Classes (C) ^-Bco(L / ) (D) ^-Bco/ Q.45 Ametal disc rotatesfreely,b
etween the poles ofa magnet in the direction N indicated. Brushes P and Q make c
ontact with the edge ofthe disc and the metal axle. What current, if any,flowsth
rough R? ^ 1 (A) a cu rrentfromP to Q (B) a currentfromQ to P (C) no current, be
cause the emf in the d isc is opposed by the back emf (D) no current, because th
e emfinduced in one sid e ofthe disc is opposed by the emf induced in the other
side. (E) no current, be cause no radial emf is induced inthe disc For L-R circu
it, the time constant is equal to (A) twice the ratio of the energy stored in th
e magneticfieldto the rat e of dissipation of energy in the resistance (B) ratio
of the energy stored in t he magneticfieldto the rate of dissipation of energy
in the resistance (C) half the ratio of the energy stored in the magneticfieldto
the rate of dissipation of energy in the resistance (D) square ofthe ratio ofth
e energy stored in the magn
eticfieldto the rate of dissipation of energy in the resistance A rectangular co
il of single turn, having area A, rotates in a uniform magneticfieldB an angula
r velocity 0) about an axis perpendicular to thefield.If initially the plane of
c oil is perpendicular to thefield,then the average induced e.m.f. when it has r
ot ated through 90 is CDBA coBA coBA 2CDBA (A) % (B)' 2tz (Q 4k (D)r * * ' % 8 A
rin g of resistance 10H, radius 10cm and 100 turns is rotated at a rate 100 revo
luti ons per second about afixedaxis which is perpendicular to a uniform magneti
cfiel dof induction 1 OmT. The amplitude of the current in the loop will be near
ly (Ta ke : k2 = 10) (A) 200A (B)2A (C)0.002A (D) none of these 2 Question Bank
on EMI [11]
v^ 9 A copper rod AB of length L, pivoted at one end A, rotates at constant angu
lar v elocity Q, at right angles to a uniform magneticfieldofinduction B. The e.
m.f de veloped between the mid point C of the rod and end B is 3B/ Bar B a r (C)
(B) (A) Figure shows auniform magneticfieldB confined to a cylindrical volume an
d is in creasing at a constant rate. The instantaneous acceleration experienced
by an el ectron placed at P is (A) zero (B) towards right (C) towards left (D) u
pwards A triangular wire frame (each side = 2m) is placed in a region oftime var
iant Xcv magneticfieldhaving dB/dt=V3 T/s. The magneticfieldis perpendicular to
the plane of the triangle. The base of the triangle AB has a resistance 1 Q whil
e the oth er two sides have resistance 2D each. The magnitude ofpotential differ
ence betwe en the points A and B will be (A) 0.4 V (B) 0.6 V (C) 1.2 V (D)None 1
0V In the a djoining circuit, initially the switch Sis open. The switch's' is cl
osed 0.1 H i on at t = 0. The difference between the maximum and minimum current
that A/VH TftM Tcan flow in the circuit is (A) 2 Amp (B) 3 Amp (C) 1 Amp (D) noth
ing can be con cluded R The ratio oftime constant in charging and discharging in
the AAAL 2R circ uit shown infigureis AAA(A)1 : 1 (B)3 : 2 (C)2:3 (D) 1:3 In anL-R
circuit connect ed to a battery of constant e.m.f. E switch S is closed at time
t = 0. If e deno tes the magnitude of induced e.m.f. across inductor and i the
current in the cir cuite at any time t. Then which of the following graphs shows
the variation of e with i ? 10Q y 0 51 (B) (C) (D) A curren of2A is increasing
at a rate of 4 A/s through a coil of inductance 2H. The energy stored in the ind
uctor per unit time is (A) 2 J/s (B) 1 J/s (C) 16 J/ s (D) 4 J/s x Q<56 Two iden
tical inductance carry currents that vary with time according to li near laws (a
s shown infigure).In which of two inductance is the self induction e mf greater?
(A) 1 1 (B)2 (C) same (D) data are insufficient to decide (fe Bansal Classes Qu
estion Bank on EMI [12]
y 5 8 The current in the given circuit is increasing with a rate a=4 amp/s. The
charge on the capacitor at an instant when the current in the circuit is 2 amp w
ill be : (A) 4pC (B) 5pC L=1H 0 3 P F (C) 6pC (D) none of these L, C and R repre
sent p hysical quantities inductance, capacitance and resistance. The combinatio
n which has the dimensions of frequency is 1 (A) ^ and I (B) V R C and (C) Vlc <
59 A coil of inductance 5H is joined to a c ell of emf 6 V through a resistance
10Q at time t = 0. The emf across the coil a t time t = In J2 s is: (A) 3V (B) 1
.5 V (C) 0.75 V (D)4.5V 60 Along solenoid of N turns has a self inductance L and
area of cross section A. When a current i fl ows through the solenoid, the magn
eticfieldinside it has magnitude B. The curren t i is equal to: (A) BAN/L (B)BAN
L (C) BN/AL (D) B/ANL Q.61 A long straight wire of circular cross-section is mad
e of a non-magnetic material. The wire is of ra dius a. The wire carries a curre
nt I which is uniformly ditributed over its cros s-section. The energy stored pe
r unit lenght in the magneticfieldcontained withi n the wire is ( A ) U = ^ (B)U
= M (C)U = M-QI (D)U = 2K 8tt 1671 4tc is part uQ - 6 2 The network shown in th
eIfigure and it isof a complete circuit.ofIf at a 1 Q + 5 mH certain instant, th
e current is 5 A decreasing at a rate A-WA11rsmRP 15 V 10 As" then V - V equals (A)
20 V ' (B) 15 V (C)10V (D) 5 V In Problem 62, if I is reversed in direction, th
en V - V equals (A) 5 V (B)10V (C) 15 V (D) 20 V 10H Two resistors of 10 D and 2
0 fl and an ideal inductor of 10 H are connected to a 2 V battery as shown. The
key K is inserted at time t = 0. The initial (t = 0) and lA/vW final (t ->00) curr
ents through battery are ion ^2on J_ J_ 15 ' 10 K V. WVo >T5 B 3 1 B A B A 1 ( A
) A A A A 2V A small coil of radius r is placed at the centre of a large coil o
f radius R, wh ere R r. The coils are coplanar. The coefficient inductance betwe
en the coils is
(A) 2R (B) 2R (C) 2R (D) 2 R ^ Q.66 Two long parallel wires whose centres are a
distance d apart carry equal currents in opposite directions. If the flux withi
n wires is neglected, the inductance of such arrangement of wire of length / and
in the dc ammeter will be: 1 D (B) V2 i (C) 0.637 i (D) zero (fe Bansal Classes
Question Bank on EMI [15]
QrSf In the circuti shown in 0. The current throughC and ual to: (A) CR (B) CR I
n (2) ce at an instant is 5 V, the nstant is 4 V. The potential (B)9V 0 c R S AW^
i R V (D)none Othe figure, R= J ~ . Switch S is closed at time t = r^MWT- -A/VW L R L would be
equal after a time t eq AAAAr (D)LR L' In the circuit shown ifthe emfof sour pote
ntial difference across capacitor at the same i difference across R at that inst
ant can be (A) 3 V
An AC current is given by I = I +1 j sin wt then its rms value will be (C)0 (D)
I /V2 (A) v V + O ^ (B) I + 0 . 5 I Let f = 50 Hz, and C = 100 pF in an AC circu
it containing a capicator only. If the peak value of the current in the circuit
isl.57Aatt = 0. The expression for the instantaneous voltage across the capacit
o r will be (A) E = 50 sin (100 TCt - 7t/2) (B)E= 100 sin (50 Tit) (C) E = 50 si
n 100 nt (D) E = 50 sin (100 7tt + TC/2) In a series CR circuit shown in figure,
t he applied voltage is 10 V and the voltage across capacitor is found to be 8
V. Then the voltage across R, and the phase difference between current and the a
ppl ied voltage will respectively be V 8V (B) 3 V, tan" (A) 6V, tan (!) 2 0 2 0
2 0 c 1 1 (C) 6V, tan,-1 (D)none 10V3, J > 9 2 The phase difference between curr
ent and vo ltage in an AC circuit is tc/4 radian. If thefrequencyofAC is 50 Hz,
then the ph ase difference is equivalent to the time difference : (A)0.78 s (B)
15.7ms (C) 0 .25 s (D)2.5ms The given figure represents the phasor diagram of a
series LCR ci rcuit connected to an ac source. At the instant t' when the source
voltage is gi ven by V = V cosa>t', the current in the circuit will be (A) I =
I cos(t' + TC/6) (B) I = I cos(t' - 7i/6) (C) I = I cos(ot' + tc/3) (D) I = I cos(t
' - tc/3) 0 0 0 0 0 V =3V V =VIV OL 0R J^ 4 A coil, a capacitor and an AC source
of rms voltage 24 V are connected in series . By varying the frequency of the s
ource, a maximum rms current of 6 A is observ ed. If coil is connected to a batt
ery of emf 12 volt and internal resistance 4Q, then current through it in steady
state is (A) 2.4 A (B) 1.8 A (C)1.5A (D)1.2A (fe Bansal Classes Question Bank o
n EMI [16]
0 ^ 5 Power factor of an L-R series circuit is 0.6 and that of a C-R series circ
uit is 0.5. If the element (L, C, and R) of the two circuits are joined in seri
e s the power factor of this circuit is found to be 1. The ratio of the resistan
ce in the L-R circuit to the resistance in the C-R circuit is 3V3 (B) 5/6 (D) (A
) 6/5 6 The direct current which would give the same heating effect in an equal
co nstant resistance as the current shown infigure,i.e. therms, current, is (B)
42 A (A) zero (D) 2 V2 A (C) 2A Current/A 1 0 0.0] -1 -2 2 0.02 0.03 0.04 Time/s
. ^ J ^ l The effective value of current i = 2 sin 100 n t + 2 sin(100 % t + 30)
is : (A) V2 A (B) 2^2 + 73 (C)4 (D) None Q.98 In the circuit diagram shown, X =
100 Q, X = 200 Q and R = 100 Q. The effective current through the source is (A)
2 A (B) V2 A (C) 0.5 A (D) 2V2 A c L aT <5 L-Y ^ Q.9 9 If Ij, Ij, I and I are th
e respective r.m.s. values of the time varying currents as shown in the four cas
es I, II, III and IV Then identify the correct relations. i Io In rv\ O O 0 -lo
-In (A) I, = I = I3 = I ( B ) I > I = I > I (C) I > I > I - Ij (D) I > I > Ij >
I 3 4 In Jt -In 2 4 3 1 2 4 3 4 2 3
2 4 ^ 1 0 0 In series LR circuit X = 3R. Now a capacitor with X = R is added in
seri es. Ratio of new to old power factor is 1 (B)2 (A) 1 (D)V2 L c vX 0 1 The c
urrent I, potential difference V across the inductor and potential differen ce V
across the capacitor in circuit as shown in thefigureare best represented v ect
orially as L c L -WW . ,c V, V. r F(A) iv, 02 (B) (C) ' 1 (D) v j A coil, a capa
citor and an A.C. source of rms voltage 24 V are connected in seri es. By varyin
g the frequency of the source, a maximum rms current of 6 A is obse rved. Ifthis
coil is connected to a battery of emf 12 V and internal resistance 4Q, the curr
ent through it will be (A) 2.4 A (B) 1.8 A (C)1.5A (D)1.2A (fe Bansal Classes Qu
estion Bank on EMI [17]
MV3 In the shown AC circuit phase different between currents I, and I is 2 ,,xc
- e TfOTWr W W R X 1 n a 04 ,x T (B) tan" L R C 1 X n ,x T (D) tan L ~ C 2 R X X
The circuit shown is in a uniform magnetic field that is into the page and is x
x x decreasing in magnitude at the rate of 150 tesla/second. The ideal ammeter (
A) reads X X X (A) 0.15 A (B) 0.35 A (C) 0.50 A (D) 0.65 A A Hh 5.0 V A capacit
o r C = 2pF and an inductor with L = 10 H and coil resistance 5 H are in series
in a circuit. When an alternating current of r.m.s. value 2Aflows in the circuit
, the average power in watts in the circuit is (A) 100 (B) 50 (C) 20 (D) 10 WA io
n 10cm ONE OR MORE THAN ONE OPTION MAY BE CORRECT Take approx. 3 minutes for ans
yvering each question. The dimension of the ratio of magneticfluxand the resista
nce is equal to that of : (A) induced emf (B) charge (C) inductance (D) current
Question No. 2 to 5 (4 questions) 1 1b** X J*2 II The value of magneticfluxin ea
ch case is given by (A) Case I: O = TI(L + Case II: <D = %(L - ) B (B) Case I: O
= u(L + Case II: $ = k(L + )B (C) Case I: <0 = (L + ^ )B; Case II: <D = (L - ^
)B (D) Case I: <D = (L + ^) B; Case II: <D = T
( - ) B C L The direction of induced current in the case I is (A) from a to b and
from c to d (B) from a to b and from/to e (C) from b to a and from d to c (D) f
rom b to a and from e t o / The direction ofinduced current in the case II is (
A ) from a to b and from c to d (B) from b to a and from/ t o e (C) from b to a
an d from c to d (D) from a to b and from d to c If Ij and I are the magnitudes
of induced current in the cases I and II, respectively, then (A) = I (B)I, > I (
C) Ij < I (D) nothing can be said 2 T* X x| X X X The adjoiningfigureshows two d
ifferent arrangements in which two square wirefram esare placed in a uniform con
stantly decreasing magneticfieldB. hi 2 2 2 2 2 2 2 2 2 2 2 2 2 2 2 (fe Bansal C
lasses Question Bank on EMI [18]
Qk^f Figure shown plane figure made of a conductor located in a magnetic field a
long the inward normal to the plane of thefigure.The magnetic field starts dimi
n ishing. Then the induced current (A) at point P is clockwise (B) at point Q is
a nticlockwise (C) at point Q is clockwise (D) at point R is zero vX 1 x A cond
ucting wire frame is placed in a magneticfieldwhich is directed into the p aper.
The magneticfieldis increasing at a constant rate. The directions of induc ed c
urrents in wires AB and CD are (A) B to Aand D to C (B)Ato B and Cto D (C) A to
B and D to C (D) B to A and C to D sj** Two circular coils A and B are facing ea
ch other as shown in figure. The current i through A can be altered (A) there wi
ll be repulsion between A and B if i is increased (B) there will be attraction b
etween A and B if i is increased (C) the re will be neither attraction nor repul
sion when i is changed (D) attraction or repulsion between Aand B depends on the
direction of current. It does not depend whether the current is increased or de
creased. When a magnet with its magnetic moment along the axis of a circular coi
l and directed towards the coil is withdr awn away from the coil, parallel to it
self, the current in the coil, as seen by the withdrawing magnet is (A) zero (B)
clockwise (C) anticlockwise (D) independe nt ofthe resistance of the coil 10 A
bar magnet is moved along the axis of coppe r ring placed far awayfromthe magnet
. Lookingfromthe side of the magnet, an anti clockwise current is found to be in
duced in the ring. Which of the following may be true? (A) The south pole faces
the ring and the magnet moves towards it. (B) The north pole faces the ring and
the magnet moves towards it. (C) The south po le faces theringand the magnet mov
es away from it. (D) The north pole faces ther ingand the magnet moves awayfromi
t. Q.ll In previous question, if P is on the le ft ofmidpoint: (A) magnet experi
ences no torque (B) magnet experiences no net fo rce but experiences a torque (C
) magnet experiences arightwardforce as well as a torque (D) magnet will not exp
eriences a rightward force as well as a torque X 2 Two circular coils P & Q are
fixed coaxially & carry currents I, and I respect ively (A) if \ = 0 & P moves t
owards Q, a current in the samedirection as I ^ is induced in Q (B) if Ij - 0 &
Q moves towards P, a current in the opposite direc tion to that of 1 isinduced i
n P. P' Q" (C) when ^ ^ 0 and 1, A 0 are in the sam e direction then the two coi
ls tend to move apart (D) when Ij ^ 0 and i ^ 0 are in opposite directions then
the coils tends to move apart. 2 ( 2 2 (ISBansal Classes Question Bank on EMI [1
9]
Q. 13 AB and CD are smooth parallel rails, separated by a distance /, and inclin
ed to the horizontal at an angle 9. Auniform magnetic field of magnitude B, dir
e cted vertically upwards, exists in the region. EF is a conductor of mass m, ca
rr ying a current /'. For EF to be in equilibrium, (A) i mustflowfrom E to F (B)
Bi l = mg tan 0 (C) Bil = mg sin 9 (D)Bil = mg In the previous question, if B i
s no rmal to the plane of the rails (A) Bil - mg tan 9 (B)Bil = mgsin9 (C) Bil =
mg c os 9 (D) equilibrium cannot be reached xp Qd5 A conducting rod PQ of lengt
h L = 1.0 m is moving with a uniform speed v = 20 m/s in a uniform magneticfield
B = 4. 0 T directed into the paper. A capacitor of capacity C = 10 pF is connect
ed as s hown in figure. Then C (A) q = + 800pC and q = - 800pC (B) q = - 800pC a
nd q = + 800pC (C) q = 0 = q (D) charged stored in the capacitor increases expon
entially with time The e.m.f. induced in a coil of wire, which is rotating in a
magnetic field,does not depend on (A) the angular speed of rotation (B) the area
of the c oil (C) the number of turns on the coil (D) the resistance of the coil
A B A B A B 17 A semicircle conducting ring of radius R is placed in the xy pla
ne, as shown in the figure. A uniform magneticfieldis set up along the x-axis. N
o emf, will b e induced in thering,if Y B / R X (A) it moves along the x-axis (C
) it moves along the z-axis Question No. 18 to 20 (3 questions) (B) it moves alo
ng the y-axis (D) it remains stationary A conducting ring of radius a is rotated
about a point O on its periphery as sho wn in thefigurein a plane perpendicular
to uniform magneticfieldB which exists e verywhere. The rotational velocity is
co. Q.18 Choose the correct statement(s) r elated to the potential of the points
P, Q and R (A) V - V > 0 and V - V < 0 (B) V = V > V (C) V > V = Vq (D) V - V =
V - V Q.19 Choose the correct statement(s) related to the magnitude of potentia
l differences 1 1 (A)V V = ~ Boa. (B) V - V Q = Bcoa ( C ) V - V 2Bcoa (D) V - V
= 2Bffla P 0 R 0 p R 0 0 p Q p p 0 p Q 2 p 2 Q 0 2 p R 2 (fe Bansal Classes Que
stion Bank on EMI [20]
Q.20 Choose the correct statement(s) related to the induced current inthe ring (
A) Current flows from Q P O >R > Q (B) Current flows from Q R > O >? > Q (C) Cu
r rent flows from Q > P > 0 and from Q ->R > O (D) No current flows Current growt
h in two L-R circuits (b) and (c) as shown in figure (a). Let L L , R and Rj be
th e \ corresponding values in two circuits. Then (D)L <L (A)R >R (B)R =R (C)L >
L WTv v L R2 L, Ri Tc) p 2 t 1 2 1 2 1 2 1 2 2 (a) (b) (c) A circuit consisting of
a constant e.m.f.'E', a self induction'L and a resistance'R'is closed at t = 0.
The relation between the current I in the ci rcuit and time t is as shown by cur
ve 'a' in the fig. When one or more of parame ters E, R & L are changed, the cur
ve 'b' is obtained .The steady state current i s same in both the cases. Thenit
is possible that : (A) E & R are kept constant & L is increased (B) E & R are ke
pt constant & L is decreased (C) E & R are both halved and L is kept constant (D
) E & L are kept constant and R is decreased A circuit element is placed in a cl
osed box. At time t=0, constant current v(voits ) generator supplying a current
of 1 amp, is connected across the box. Potential difference across the box varie
s according to graph shown in figure. The elemen t in the box is : (A) resistanc
e of 2H (B) battery of emf 6Y (C) inductance of 2 H (D) capacitance of 0. 5F A c
onstant current i is maintained in a solenoid. Whi ch ofthe following quantities
will increase if an iron rod is inserted in the so lenoid along its axis? (A) m
agneticfieldat the centre. (B) magnetic flux linked with the solenoid (C) self-i
nductance of the solenoid (D) rate of Joule heating. The symbols L, C, R represe
nt inductance, capacitance and resistance respective ly. Dimension of frequency
are given by the combination 1 (A) 1 / RC (B) R / L ( C) (D) C / L An LR circuit
with a battery is connected at t = 0. Which ofthe fol lowing quantities is not
zero just after the circuit (A) current in the circuit (B) magneticfieldenergy i
n the inductor (C) power delivered by the battery (D) e mf induced in the induct
or ^P^Z/ The switches in figures (a) and (b) are L R r^H W- - W n closed at t =
0 (A) The charge on C just after t = 0 is EC. (B) The cha rge on C long after t
= 0 is EC. -A. (C) The current in L just after t = 0 is E/ R. (D) The current in
L long after t = 0 is E/R. (b) s (fe Bansal Classes Question Bank on EMI [21]
Q.28 At a moment (t = 0) when charge on capacitor C, is zero, the switch is clos
ed. If I be the current through inductor at that instant, for t > 0, (A) maximu
m current through inductor equals I /2. C, (B) maximum current through inductor
e quals Cjlp 0 0 c I+ c 2 (C) maximum charge on C, = c,+c 2 (D) maximum charge o
n Cj = I C, ^ q QA9 For L - R circuit, the time constant is equal to (A) twice t
he ratio of the energy sto red in the magnetic field to the rate ofthe dissipati
on of energy in the resista nce. (B) the ratio ofthe energy stored in the magnet
ic field to the rate of diss ipation of energy in the resistance. (C) half ofthe
Q.49 Q.56 Q.63 Q.70 Q.77 Q.84 Q.91 Q.98 Q.105 A A D C A D D A C C A A C c c ONE
OR MORE THAN ONE OPTION MAY BE CORRECT B B B A,B A,B,C,D B,D A,B,C A B A,D (fe B
ansal Classes Question Bank on EMI [24]
TARGET IIT JEE 2007 XII (ALL) ELECTROSTATICS CONTENTS KEYCONCEPTS EXERCISE-I EXE
RCISE-II EXER CISE-III ANSWER KEY
1. ELECTRIC Charge of a material body is that possesion (acquired or natural) du
e to which i t strongly interacts with other material body. It can be postive or
negative. S. I. unit is coulomb. Charge is quantized, conserved, and additive.
COULOMB'S 0 CHARGE KEY CONCEPTS 2. LAW: F = - ^ r . In vector form F = r ? where
1 s = permittivity of free space = 8.85 x 10 N m~ c or F/m and e = Relative per
mit tivity of the medium = Spec. Inductive Capacity = Dielectric Const. s = 1 fo
r ai r (vacuum) = oo for metals e e = Absolute permittivity of the medium N O T
E : T he Law is applicable only for static and point charges. Only applicable to
stati c charges as moving charges may result magnetic <ii interaction also and
only fo r point charges as if charges are extended, induction may change the cha
rge dist ribution. -12 -1 2 2 r r 0 r 47ts0er r 47ls osr r 12 3. PRINCIPLE OF SU
PER POSITION 1 2 3 Force on a point charge due to many charges is given by F=F +
F +F + NOTE : The f orce due to one charge is not affected by the presence of ot
her charges. 4. ELECTRIC (VECTOR "The physical field where a charged particle, i
rrespective of the fact whether i t is in motion or at rest, experiences force i
s called an electric field". The d irection of the field is the direction of the
force experienced by a positively charged particle & the magnitude of the field
(electric intensity) is F the forc e experienced by the particle carrying unit
charge E = T^ unit is NC ; S.I. unit
is _1 FIELD, ELECTRIC QUANTITY) INTENSITY OR ELECTRIC FIELD STRENGTH V/m here Lu
n represents that this charge does not alter the magnitude of electri c field. D
ue to charge induction on the source ofelectric field. 5. ELECTRIC FIELD DUE TO
(i) (ii) (iii) (iv) Point charge: E = = --^-r (vector form) . Z 47ts r 471 G r q E
Where r = vector dr awn from the source charge to the point. Continuous charge
distribution E=- [ f dE ; dE = electric field due to an elementry charge 47TS r .
Note E* J dE because E is a vector quantity . dq = X dl (for line charge) = a ds
(for surface charge) = p dv (for volume charge) In general X, a & p are linear,
surface and volume ch arge densities respectively. 2kX Infinite line of charge
E = j where r=perpendicul ar distance of the point from the line charge. 0 q 0 J J
^Bansal Classes Semi oo line of charge E = r an angle 4 5 as, E = & E = at a poin
t above the end of wire at r r y ELECTROSTATICS [2]
(v) (vi) Uniformly charged ring, E centre = 0, E = axis dE . , Electricfieldis m
aximum when - = 0 for a point on the axis of the ring. He re we get x = R/V2. 0 (
X +R ) 2 2 kQx 3 / 2 (vii) Infinite non conducting sheet of charge E=-^-n where
2e ii = unit normal v ector to the plane of sheet, where c is surface charge den
sity (viii) oo charged conductor sheet having surface charge density a on both s
urfaces E = a/e . (ix) Just outside a conducting surface charged with a surface
charge density a, elec tricfieldis always given as E = a/e . (x) Uniformly charg
ed solid sphere (Insula ting material) E = Q j ; r > R, 0 0 t 4ne i 0 Behaves as
a point charge situated at the centre for these points E- = (xi) r < R where p
= volume charge density Uniformly charged spherical shell (conduct ing or non-do
nducting) or uniformly charged solid conducting sphere. E = ^ ^ ; r > R out 2 in
pr ; 47IqR 3Q Qr Behaves as a point charge situated at the centre for these point
s E J= 0 ; r < R (xii) uniformly charged cylinder with a charge density p is -(r
adius of cylinde r = R) for r < R pr pR E = 2 e ; for r > R o E= 2 e r ~ (xiii)
Uniformly charged cylinderical shell with surface charge density a is forr<R E =
0 ; forr>R E= pr 2 m 0 0 m e o r 6. ELECTRIC (i) (ii) (iii) (iv) (v) 7.
The line of force in an electricfieldis a hypothetical line, tangent to which at
any point on it represents' the direction of electricfieldat the given point. P
roperties of ( E L F ) : Electric lines offerees never intersects. ELF originat
e sfrompositive charge or oo and terminate on a negative charge of infinity. Pre
fe rence oftermination is towards a negative charge. If an ELF is originated, it
mu st require termination either at a negetive charge or at oo. Quantity of ELF
ori ginated or terminated from a charge or on a charge is proportional to the m
agnit ude of charge. ELECTROSTATIC LINES OF FORCE (ELF) (i) (ii) Position where
net force (or net torque) on a charge(or electric dipole) = 0 STA BLE EQUILIBRIU
M : If charge is displaced by a small distance the charge comes (o r tries to co
me back) to the equilibrium. UNSTABLE EQUILIBRIUM : If charge is di splaced by a
small distance the charge does not return to the equilibrium positi on. EQUILIB
RIUM tl^Bansal Classes ELECTROSTATICS [5]
8. ELECTRIC "Work done by external agent to bring a unit positive charge(without
accelaratio n) from infinity to a point in an electricfieldis called electric p
otential at t hat point" . if w is the work done to bring a charge q (very small
) from infinit y to a point then potential at that point is V = (W ) ; S.I. unit i
s volt (= 1 J/C ) w r POTENTIAL (Scalar Quantity) 9. POTENTIAL A B q r ext DIFFE
RENCE e (W ) V^ =V - V = ^ V ^ = p.d. between point A& B . W = w.d. by external
source t o transfer a point charge q from B to A (Withoutacceleration). * BA 10. E
LECTRIC FIELD & ELECTRIC E = - grad V = - V V {read as gradient of V} grad = iox
+ k ; oy oz Used whenEF varies in three dimensional coordinate system. Forfindi
ngpotential difference be tween two points in electricfield,we use V - V = ~ j E
dt if j varying with dista nce A if E is constant & here d is the distance betwe
en points A and B. A B s POINTENIAL ? d *d *d 11. POTENTIAL DUE TO 0 (i) (iii) (
iv) (v)
a point charge V = ^ 47is r (ii) . many charges V = ++ + 47tE r 47te r 47rs r 0 1 0 2
3 continuous charge distribution V = i f ^ spherical shell (conducting or non cond
uc ting) or solid conducting sphere non conducting uniformly charged solid spher
e : V o u t 4TTS r j 0 S r ' ( ] > V i n 2 4TTER 0 ' ( r " R ) 12. EQUIPOTENTIAL
In an electricfield the locus of points of equal potential is called an equipot
e ntial surface. An equipotential surface and the electricfieldmeet at right ang
le s. The region where E = 0, Potential of the whole region must remain constant
as no work is done in displacement of charge in it. It is called as equipotenti
al region like conducting bodies. SURFACE AND EQUIPOTENTIAL REGION ^Bansal Class
es ELECTROSTATICS [4] #
13. MUTUAL "The work to be done to integrate the charge system." q,q For 2 parti
cle system U = 47is r 2 mutual 0 POTENTIAL ENERGY OR INTERACTION ENERGY For 3 par
ticle system U 14. (a) m u t u a l = q,q q2qs , q3qi 47is r 47i8 r 47te r 2 0 12
0 23 0 31 15. (b) (c) For n particles there will be \ ^ terms . Total energy of
a system = U + U P.E. of charge q in potential field U = qV. Interaction energy
of a system of two cha rges U=q V = q V . ELECTRIC DIPOLE. O is mid point of li
ne AB (centre ofthe dipo le) - equitorial line on the axis (except points on lin
e AB) -q +q E= E P 27is [ r (a /4)] 27ts r ( i f r < < a ) p = qa = Dipole momen
t, r = distance of the poi nt from the centre of dipole p p on the equitorial ;
E= ~ 47is [r +(a /4)] 47cs r At a general point P(r, 0) in polar co-ordinate sys
tem is 2kp sin 0 Radial ele ctricfieldE= n ( se]f mutual 1 2 2 1 0 2 2 2 0 3 0 2
2 3/2 0 3 Tangentral electric field E = T net 2 kpcos0 2 2 Net electric field at
P is E = ^ E + E = ^ Vl + 3sin 0 kpsinO Potential at point P is V = N O T E : I
f 0 is measured from axis of dipole. Then sin0 and cos0 wil l be interchanged p
(d) (e) (f) (g) (i) 16. Dipole V = ^ p=qa electric dipole moment . If 0 is angle
between p and 4718 r 47is r reache
s vector of the point. Electric Dipole in uniform electric field : torque x=pxE
; F = 0 . Work done in rotation of dipole is w = PE (cos 0 - cos 0 ) P.E. of an
electric dipole in electric field U = - p.E. / ^ dEc Force on a dipole when plac
ed in a non uniform electricfieldis F= d (-PE)i = P.-i. dx ' dx PG Q _ p.r 2 0 1
2 v ELECTRIC FLUX (ii) For uniform electric field; (j) = E.A = EA cos 0 where 0
= angle between & area vector ( A ). Flux is contributed only due to the compon
ent of electricfieldwhic h is perpendicular to the plane. If E is not uniform th
roughout the area A, then <> = j" E.d A J tl^Bansal Classes ELECTROSTATICS [5]
17. GA USS'S LAW ." cj) = J>EdA = o o (j) does not depend on the E s q p - -> (Ap
plicable only to closed surface)" Net flux emerging out of a closed surface i s
q q = net charge enclosed by the closed surface . (i) (ii) shape and size of the
c losed surface The charges located Outside the closed surface. 18. 19. 20. Flu
x of charge q having through the circle of radius R is q/e q ( j ) = x O = r. (l
-cos9) o Energy stored p.u. volume in an electricfield= ^ 0 z e 2 2 CONCEPT OF S
OLID ANGLE : Solid angle of coneof half angle 9 is Q=2rt(l-cos0) Electric pressu
re due to its own charge on a surface having charged density a is P = c . 2s Ele
ctric pressur e on a charged surface with charged density a due to external elec
tric field is P E L E =aE 2 ele 0 t IMPORTANT POINTS TO BE REMEMBERED (i) (ii) (
iii) (iv) (v) (vi) (vii) (viii) (ix) (x) (xi) (xii) (xiii) (xiv) Electric field
is always perpendicular to a conducting surface (or any equipoten tial surface).
No tangential component on such surfaces. Charge density at sharp points on a c
onductor is greater. When a conductor is charged, the charge resid es only on th
e surface. For a conductor of any shape E (just outside) = o p.d. b etween two p
oints in an electric field does not depend on the path joining them. Potential a
t a point due to positive charge is positive & due to negative charg e is negati
ve. Positive charge flows from higher to lower (i. e. in the directio n of elect
ricfield)and negative charge from lower to higher (i.e. opposite to th e electri
c field) potential. When p||E the dipole is in stable equilibrium p||(E) the dip
ole is in unstable equilibrium When a charged isolated conducting sphe re is con
nected to an unchaged small conducting sphere then potential (and charg e) remai
ns almost same on the larger sphere while smaller is charged . Self pote ntial e
nergy of a charged shell = KO . 2R 3k0 Self potential energy of an insula ting u
niformly charged sphere = . 5R A spherically symmetric charge {i.e p depen ds on
ly on r} behaves as if its charge is concentrated at its centre (for outsid
e points). Dielectric strength of material: The minimum electricfieldrequired to
ionise the medium or the maximum electricfieldwhich the medium can bear without
breaking down. 8 2 2 tl^Bansal Classes ELECTROSTATICS [5]
EXERCISE # I Q. 1 A negative point charge 2q and a positive charge q are fixed a
t a distance I apart. Where should a positive test charge Q be placed on the lin
e connecting the charge for it to be in equilibrium? What is the nature ofthe eq
uilibrium wit h respect to longitudinal motions? Q.2 Two particles A and B each
carrying a cha rge Q are held fixed with a separation d between then A particle
C having mass m ans charge q is kept at the midpoint ofline AB. Ifit is displace
d through a sma ll distance x (x d) perpendicular to AB, (a) thenfindthe time pe
riod ofthe oscil lations of C. (b) If in the above question C is displaced along
AB,findthe time period ofthe oscillations of C. Q.3 Draw E - r graph for 0 < r
< b, if two point charges a & b are located r distance apart, when (i) both are
+ ve (ii) both ar e - ve _ (iii) a is + ve and b is - ve (iv) a is - ve and b is
+ ve Q.4 A charge + 10 C is located at the origin in free space & another charg
e Q at (2, 0, 0). If the X-component ofthe electricfieldat (3,1,1) is zero, calc
ulate the value of Q. Is the Y-component zero at (3,1, 1)? 9 Q.5 Six charges are
placed at the vertices of a regular hexagon as shown in the figure. +Q -Q Find
the electricfieldon the line passing through O and perpendicular to the pla ne Q< +Q of thefigureas a function of distance xfrompoint O. (assume x a) + + T hef
igureshows three infinite non-conducting + plates of charge perpendicular to the
plane of A + B _ + the paper with charge per unit area + a, + 2o + + and - a .
Find the ratio ofthe net electricfieldat + 2.5m that point Ato that at point B .
+C7 +2ct 5m 5m Q.7 A thin circular wire of radius r has a charge Q. If a point
charge q is placed at the centre ofthe ring, then find the increase in tension i
n the wire. Q.8 In thefigureshown S is a large nonconducting sheet ofuniform ch
arge density a. A rod R oflength / and mass 'm' is parallel to the sheet and hin
ged at its mid point. The linear charge densities on the upper and lower half o
f the rod are shown in the figure. Find the angular acceleration of the rod just
a fter it is released. Q.9 A simple pendulum of length / and bob mass m is hang
ing in front of a large nonconducting sheet having surface charge density a. If
sud denly a charge +q is given to the bob & it is releasedfromthe position shown
inf igure.Find the maximum angle through which the string is deflectedfromverti
cal. A particle of mass m and charge - q moves along a diameter of a uniformly c
harge d sphere of radius R and carrying a total charge + Q. Find the frequency o
f S .H .M. ofthe particle if the amplitude does not exceed R. Q.ll A charge + Q
is unif ormly distributed over a thin ring with radius R. A negative point charg
e - Q an d mass m starts from rest at a point far awayfromthe centre ofthe ring
and moves towards the centre. Find the velocity ofthis particle at the moment it
passes t hrough the centre of the ring. J ^Bansal Classes ELECTROSTATICS [9]
Q.12 A spherical balloon ofradius R charged uniformly on its surface with surfac
e density o. Find work done against electric forces in expanding it upto radius
2R. Q.13 A point charge + q & mass 100 gm experiences a force of 100 N at a poi
n t at a distance 20 cm from a long infinite uniformly charged wire. Ifit is rel
ea sedfindits speed when it is at a distance 40 cm from wire Q.14 Consider the c
onf iguration of a system offour charges each of value +q. Find the work done by
ext ernal agent in changing the +q configuration ofthe systemfromfigure(i) tofi
g(ii) . +qr fig(ii) fig (i) Q.15 There are 27 drops of a conducting fluid. Each
has ra dius r and they are charged to a potential V . They are then combined to
form a bigger drop. Find its potential. Q.16 Two identical particles of mass m c
arry ch arge Q each. Initially one is at rest on a smooth horizontal plane and t
he other is projected along the plane directly towards the first from a large di
stance w ith an initial speed V. Find the closest distance of approach. Q.17 A p
article o f mass m and negative charge q is thrown in a gravity free space with
speed u fr om the point A on the large non conducting charged sheet with surface
charge den sity a, as shown infigure.Find the maximum distancefromAon sheet whe
re the parti cle can strike. Q.18 Consider two concentric conducting spheres of
radii a & b ( b > a). Inside sphere has a positive charge q What charge should b
e given to the outer sphere so that potential of the inner sphere becomes zero?
How does the p otential varies between the two spheres & outside ? Q.19 Three ch
arges 0.1 coulo mb each are placed on the corners of an equilateral triangle of
side 1 m. If the energy is supplied to this system at the rate of 1 kW, how much
time would be r equired to move one of the charges onto the midpoint ofthe line
joining the othe r two? Q.20 Two thin conducting shells ofradii R and 3R are sh
own infigure.The o uter shell carries a charge +Q and the inner shell is neutral
. The inner shell i s earthed with the help of switch S. Find the charge attaine
d by the inner shell . 0 r Q.21 Consider three identical metal spheres A B and C
. Spheres A carries charge + 6q and sphere B carries charge - 3q. Sphere C carri
es no charge. Spheres A and B are touched together and then separated. Sphere C
is then touched to sphere A and separated from it. Finally the sphere C is touch
ed to sphere B and separated fromit. Find thefinalcharge on the sphere C. y p '(
0,y) Q.22 A dipole is placed at origin of coordinate system as shown infigure,fi
nd the electricfieldat point P (0, y). \p Q.23 Two point dipoles p k and -P k ar
e located at (0,0,0) and (lm, 0,2m) respectively. Find the resultant electricfie
lddue to the two dipoles at t he point (lm, 0,0). Q. 24 The length of each side
ofa cubical clo sed surface is /. If charge q is situated on one of the vertices
of the cube, thenfindthe flux passing through shaded face of the cube. Q.25 A p
oint charge Q is located on th e axis of a disc of radius R at a distance a from
the plane of the disc. If one fourth (l/4th) of the flux from the charge passes
through the disc, then find th e relation between a & R. *Q C] <!Bansal Classes
ELECTROSTATICS [11]
A rigid insulated wire frame in the form of a right angled triangle ABC, is set
in a vertical plane as shown. Two bead of equal masses m each and carrying charg
es qj & q are connected by a cord of length 1 & slide withoutfrictionon the wir
e s. Considering the case when the beads are stationary, determine. (b) The tens
io n in the cord & HORIZON (a) The angle a. The normal reaction on the beads. If
the cord is now cut, what are the values ofthe charges for which the '(c) beads
con tinue to remain stationary. Q.2 A proton and an a-particle are projected wit
h ve locity v = , ke each, when V ml Vo they are far away from each other, as sh
own. The distance between their initial velocities is L. Find their closest appr
oach distance, mass ofproton=m; charge=+e, mass of a-particle = 4m, charge = + 2
e. * ^ Q.3 A clock face has negative charges-q,-2q,^ 3 q, , 12qfixedat the posit
ion o f the corresponding numerals on the dial. The clock hands do not disturb t
he net field due to point charges. At what time does the hour hand point in the
same d irection is electricfieldat the centre ofthe dial. Q.4 A circular ring of
radius R with uniform positive charge density X per unit length isfixedin the YZ plane with its centre at the origin 0. Aparticle of mass m and positive charge
q is p rojectedfromthe point P (V3R,0,0) on the positive X-axis directly toward
s 0, wit h initial velocity v. Find the smallest value of the speed v such that
the parti cle does not return to P. Q.5 2 small balls having the same mass & cha
rge & loca ted on the same vertical at heights h & h^ are thrown in the same dir
ection alon g the horizontal at the same velocity v. The 1 ball touches the grou
nd at a dist ance / from the initial vertical. At what height will the 2 ball be
at this inst ant ? The air drag & the charges induced should be neglected. Q. 6
Two concentri c rings ofradii r and 2r are placed with centre at origin. Two '+
q charges +q ea ch arefixedat the diametrically opposite points of the rings as
shown infigure.S maller ring is now rotated by an angle 90 about Z-axis then it i
s again rotated b y 90 about Y-axis. Find the work done by electrostatic forces i
n each step. Iffin allylarger ring is rotated by 90 about X-axis,findthe total wo
rk required to perf orm all three steps. +q Q. 7 Apositive charge Q is uniformly
distributed through out the volume of a dielectric sphere ofradius R. A point m
ass having charge + q and mass m isfiredtowards the centre of the sphere with ve
locity v from a point at distance r (r > R) from the centre of the sphere. Find
the minimum velocity v so that it can penetrate R/2 distance of the sphere. Negl
ect any resistance ot her than electric interaction. Charge on the small mass re
mains constant through out the motion. Q.8 An electrometer consists of vertical
metal bar at the top of which is attached a thin rod which gets deflectedfromthe
bar under the action o f an electric charge (fig.). The reading are taken on a
quadrant graduated in de grees. The length ofthe rod is I and its mass is m. Wha
t will be the charge when the rod of such an electrometer is deflected through a
n angle a . Make the foll owing assumptions: Uu\uumuuuuuuvuft\\< (a) the charge
on the electrometer is equ ally distributed between the bar & the rod (b) the ch
arges are concentrated at p oint A on the rod & at point B on the bar. Q.l 2 0 1
81 nd EXERCISE # II ^Bansal Classes ELECTROSTATICS [9]
Q.9 A cavity ofradius r is present inside a solid dielectric sphere of radius R
havi ng a volume charge density of p. The distance between the centres of the sp
here and the cavity is a. An electron e is kept inside the cavity at an angle 6
= 45 a s shown. How long will it take to touch the sphere again? t 2 Q.10 Two ide
ntical balls of charges q & q initially have equal velocity of the s ame magnitu
de and direction. After a uniform electricfieldis applied for some ti me, the di
rection ofthe velocity ofthefirstball changes by 60 and the magnitude i s reduced
by half*. The direction of the velocity of the second ball changes the re by 90.
In what proportion will the velocity of the second ball changes ? Q. 11 Electri
cally charged drops of mercury fallfromaltitude h into a spherical metal vessel
of radius R in the upper part ofwhich there is a small opening. The mass of each
drop is m & charge is Q. What is the number 'n' of last drop that can s till en
ter the sphere. Given that the (n + 1)* drop just fails to enter the sphe re. Q.
12 Small identical balls with equal charges are fixed at vertices of regul ar 20
04 - gon with side a. At a certain instant, one ofthe balls is released & a suff
iciently long time interval later, the ball adjacent to the first released ball
is freed The kinetic energies of the released balls are found to differ by K at
a sufficiently long distancefromthe polygon. Determine the charge q of each part
. Ex Q.13 The electricfieldin a region is given by E = j -i. Find the charge conta
ined inside a cubical volume bounded by the surfaces x = 0, x = a, y = 0, y = a,
z = 0 and z = a. Take E = 5 * 10 N/C, /=2cm and a = 1 cm. 0 0 3 Q.14 2 small me
tallic balls ofradii R, & R are kept in vacuum at a large distanc e compared to
the radii. Find the ratio between the charges on the 2 balls at wh ich electrost
atic energy ofthe system is minimum. What is the potential differen ce between t
he 2 balls? Total charge ofballs is constant. 2 Q.15 Figure shows a section thro
ugh two long thin concentric cylinders of radii a & b with a < b . The cylinders
have equal and opposite charges per unit length X. Find the electricfieldat a d
istance rfromthe axis for (a) r < a (b) a < r < b (c) r > b Q.16 A solid non con
ducting sphere of radius R has a non-uniform cha rge distribution of volume char
ge density, p = p , where p is a constant and r is the distancefromthe centre oft
he sphere. Show that: R (a) the total charge on t he sphere is Q = I p R and T 0
0 0 3 (b) the electricfieldinside the sphere has a magnitude given by, E = R 4
. Q.17 A nonconducting ring ofmass m and radius R is charged as shown. The charg
ed density i.e. charge per unit length is X. It is then placed on a rough noncon
du cting horizontal surface plane. At time t=0, auniform electricfieldE = E0i is
sw itched on and the ring start rolling without sliding. Determine thefrictionf
orce (magnitude mvmmmuum and direction) acting on the ring, when it starts movin
g. <!Bansal Classes
ELECTROSTATICS [11]
Q. 18 Two spherical bobs of same mass & radius having equal charges are suspende
dfromthe same point by strings of same length. The bobs are immersed in a liqui
d of relative permittivity e & density p . Find the density c of the bob for whi
c h the angle of divergence ofthe strings to be the same in the air & in the liq
ui d? r 0 Q.19 An electron beam after being acceleratedfromrest through a potent
ial differ ence of500 V in vacuum is allowed to impinge normally on a fixed surf
ace. Ifthe incident current is 100 p A, determine the force exerted on the surfa
ce assuming that it brings the electrons to rest, (e = 1 6x 10~ C;m = 9.Ox 10~ k
g) 19 31 Y Q.20 Find the electricfieldat centre of semicircular ring shown in fi
gure. Q.21 A cone made of insulating material has a total charge Q spread unifor
mly over it s sloping surface. Calculate the energy required to take a test char
ge qfrominfi nity to apex A of cone. The slant length is L. Q.22 An infinite die
lectric sheet having charge density a has a hole ofradius R in it. An electron i
s released on the axis of the hole at a distance from the centre. What will be t
he velocity w hich it crosses the plane of sheet, (e = charge on electron and m
= mass of elec tron) Q.23 Two concentric rings, one ofradius 'a' and the other o
fradius 'b' hav e the charges +q and - (2/5)~ q respectively as shown in thefigu
re.Find the rati o b/a if a charge particle placed on the axis at z = a is in eq
uilibrium. 3/2 B Q.24 Two charges + qj & - q are placed at A and B respectively.
Aline of force e mergesfromqj at angle a with line AB. At what angle will it A/
^a terminate at q ? +q 2 2 t <!Bansal Classes ELECTROSTATICS [11]
Q. 1 Q.2 Q.3 The magnitude of electricfieldE in the annular region of charged cy
lindrical cap acitor (A) Is same throughout (B) Is higher near the outer cylinde
r than near th e inner cylinder (C) Varies as (1 /r) where r is the distancefrom
the axis (D) Va ries as (1 /r ) where r is the distancefromthe axis ^ [IIT '96,2
] A metallic sol id sphere is placed in a uniform electricfield.The " lines offo
rce follow the pa th (s) shown infigureas: (A) 1 (B) 2 (C) 3 (D) 4 [IIT'96,2] An
on-conducting ring ofradius 0.5 m carries a total charge of 1.11 x 10" C distrib
uted non-uniformly on its circumference producing an electricfieldE every where
in space. The valu e of the line integral 2 1 10 EXERCISE # III t=o Q. 4 (i) (ii
) | -EM (/= 0 being centre ofthe ring) in volts is: (X) + 2 (B) - 1 (C) - 2 (D)
ze ro[JEE '97, 1 ] Select the correct alternative: [JEE '982 + 2 + 2 = 6] A+ly c
har ged thin metal ring of radius R isfixedin the xy-plane with its centre at th
e or igin 0 . A - ly charged particle P is released from rest at the point (0, 0
, z ) where z > 0. Then the motion of P is: (A) periodic, for all values of z sa
tisfy ing 0 < z < oo (B) simple harmonic, for all values of Z satisfying 0 < Z <
R q q (C) approximately simple harmonic, provided Z G R (D) such that P crosses
0 & c ontinues to move along the -ve z-axis towards x = -oo A charge +q isfixed
at each of the points x = x , x = 3x , x = 5x , oo on the x-axis & a charge -q i
sfixeda t each ofthe points x = 2XQ, X=4XQ, X = 6XQ, .... oo. Here XQ is a +ve c
onstant. Take the electric potential at a point due to a charge Q at a distance
rfromit to be . Then the potential at the origin 47te r due to the above system of
charges is : q q^n2 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 (A ^Bansal Classes A non-conducting solid sp
here ofradius R is uniformly charged. The magnitude oft he electricfielddue to t
he sphere at a distance r from its centre: (A) increases as r increases, for r <
R (B) decreases as r increases, for 0 < r < oo (C) decr eases as r increases, f
or R < r < oo (D) is discontinuous at r = R. Q.5 A conduc ting sphere S of radiu
s r is attached to an insulating handle. Another conductin g sphere S of radius
R is mounted on an insulating stand. S is initially uncharg ed. S is given a cha
rge Q, brought into contact with S & removed, S j is recharg ed such that the ch
arge on it is again Q & it is again brought into contact with S & removed. This
procedure is repeated n times. (a) Find the electrostatic ene rgy of S after n s
uch contacts with S j. (b) What is the limiting value of this energy as n - oo? [
JEE '98, 7 +1 ] Q. 6(i) An ellipsoidal cavity is carved withi n a perfect condu
ctor. Apositive charge q is placed at the center of the cavity. The points A & B
are on the cavity surface as shown in thefigure.Then: (A) elec tricfieldnear A
in the cavity = electricfieldnear B in the cavity (B) charge den sity at A = cha
rge density at B (C) potential at A= potential at B (D) total ele ctricfieldflux
through the surface ofthe cavity is q/e . [ JEE '99, 3 ] l 2 2 l 2 2 2
of the square is zero (B) along diagonal AC e (A) along diagonal BD +2q i D (C)
(D) per pendicular to the side A Q.7 Twofreepositive charges 4q and q are a dis
tance 1 a part. What charge Q is needed to achieve equilibrium for the entire sy
stem and w here should it be placed form charge q? 4 I 4 / (A) Q q (negative) at
(B)Q= - q (positive) at 6 6 6 6 6 6 6 6 0 f a B c a b B c Q Q.l t Wl \/ f 0 n 2
q : I (C) Q = q (positive) at (D) Q = q (negative) at q / Six charges are place
d at the corner of a regular hexagon as shown. Ifan electron is placed at its ce
ntre O, force on it will be: (A) Zero (B) Along OF (C) Along OC (D) None of thes
e "-q 3q,B TS \.~2q - . SU [15]
(f| Bansal Classes Question Bank on Electrostatics
Two identical positive charges are fixed on the y-axis, at equal distancesfromth
e origin 0. Aparticle with a negative charge starts on the x-axis at a large di
s tancefromO, moves along the+x-axis, passes through O and moves far away from O
. Its acceleration a is taken as positive along its direction of motion. The par
ti cle's acceleration a is plotted against its x-coordinate. Which of the follow
ing best represents the plot? ta ta ta J ta x -> ^ x - (C) (A) (B) O x - (D) O 0 0
Q. l 0 / Four equal positive charges are fixed at the vertices of a square of s
ide L. Z-axis is perpendicular to the plane of the square. The point z = 0 is th
e po int where the diagonals of the square intersect each other. The plot of ele
ctric field due to the four charges, as one moves on the z-axis. E r t Ef (B) L
(C) (D) o V2L V2 Q. 1Y A nonconducting ring of radius R has uniformly dist ribut
ed positive charge Q. A small part ofthe ring, of length d, is removed (d R ). T
he electric field at the centre of the ring will now be (A) directed towards the
gap, inversely proportional to R . (B) directed towards the gap, inversely prop
ortional to R . (C) directed awayfromthe gap, inversely proportional to R . (D)
directed awayfromthe gap, inversely proportional to R . y -2a - if Q.12 The char
ge per unit length of the four quadrant of the ring is 2X, - 2X, X and \+ 21 X r
espectively. The electric field at the centre is +1 R j- a (A) 0 3 2 3 2 / i (A)
- 27is R 0 \ (B) 27te R J 0 y (C) 47is R 1 0 V2 X r (D) None 1 *y Q.13 The direc
tion (0) of E at point P due to uniformly charged finite rod will be ... 4 (A) a
t angle 30fromx-axis // ' (B) 45 from x-axis (C) 60fromx-axis 20/ (D) none of these
Q.14 Two equal negative charges are fixed at the points [0, a ] a nd [0, -a] on
the y-axis. A positive charge Q is releasedfromrest at the points [2a, 0] on th
e x-axis. The charge Q will (A) execute simple harmonic motion abou t the origin
(B) move to the origin and remain at rest (C) move to infinity (D) execute osci
llatory but not simple harmonic motion. Q / 5 An uncharged sphere of metal place
d inside a charged parallel plate capacitor. The lines of force look like (A)
(f| Bansal Classes DCC (C) (D) IX [15] Question Bank on Electrostatics
A small particle of mass m and charge -q is placed at point P and released. If R
x, the particle will undergo oscillations along the axis of symmetry with an an
gular frequency that is equal to qQ qQ* 47te mR 0 3 ( D ) 0 4 qQ qQx 4ns mR 4 mR
4 Q .VI Which ofthe following is a volt: (A) Erg per cm \jO) J oule per coulomb
(C) Erg per ampere (D) Newton / (coulomb x m ) Q.18 n small dro ps of same size
are charged to V volts each. Ifthey coalesce to form a signal la rge drop, then
its potential will be (A) V/n (B) Vn (C)Vn jPfVn Q.19 1000 identi cal drops of
mercury are charged to a potential of 1 V each. They join to form a single drop.
The potential ofthis drop will be 5 (A) 0.01 V (B)0.1V (C)10V (D>1 00V Q.20 Pot
ential difference between centre & the surface of sphere of radius R and uniform
volume charge densitv p within it will be: ( C ) 0 2 1/3 273 Q.21 If the electr
ic potential ofthe inner metal sphere is 10 volt & that of the outer shell is 5
volt, then the potential at the centre will be: (A) 10 volt (B ) 5 volt (C) 15 v
olt (D) 0 ^ pR 2 pR 2 () C 0 ( )pR D k 2 Q.22 Three concentric metallic spherica
l shell A, B and C or radii a, b and c (a < b < c) have surface charge densities
- cr, + cr, and - a respectively. The po tential of shell A is: (A)(o/e )[a + b
- c ] (B)(a/e )[a-b + c] J # ( a / e ) [ b - a - c ] (D)none Q.23 A charged par
ticle having some mass is resting in equil ibrium at a height H above the centre
ofa uniformly charged non-conducting horiz ontal ring ofradius R. The force ofg
ravity acts downwards. The equilibrium of th e particle will be stable i R R R (
A) for all values of H (B) only if H> ^ (C) o nly if H < ^ (D) only if H = 0 0 0
Q.24 An infinite number of concentric rings cany a charge Q each alternately po
s itive and negative. Their radii are 1,2,4,8 meters in geometric progression as
s hown in the figure. The potential at the centre ofthe rings will be Q Q (A) z
ero (B) ^ (C, ^ --..4 /I )\ Q.2J When a negative charge is released and moves in
electric field, it moves to ward a position of (A) lower electric potential and
lower potential energy (B) l ower electric potential and higher potential energ
y (C) higher electric potentia l and lower potential energy (D) higher electric
potential and higher potential energy (f| Bansal Classes
Question Bank on Electrostatics [15]
Q.26 A hollow metal sphere of radius 5 cm is charged such that the potential on
its surface is 10 V. The potential at the centre of the sphere is (A)0V fe (B)10
V (C) same as at point 5 cm away from the surface out side sphere. (D) same as
a point 25 cm away from the surface. Q.27 A solid sphere of radius R is charged
u niformly. At what distance from its surface is the electrostatic potential hal
f of the potential at the centre? i - (A)R (B)R/2 (C)R/3 (D)2R Q.28 An infinite
no nconducting sheet of charge has a surface charge density of 10~ C/m . The sep
ara tion ^ between two equipotential surfaces near the sheet whose potential dif
fer by 5 V is (A) 0.88 cm (B) 0.88 mm (C) 0.88 m (D)5xl0" m Q.29 Four equal char
ges +q are placed at four corners of a square with its centre at origin and lyin
g in yz plane. The electrostatic potential energy of a fifth charge +q' varies o
n xaxis as: u u /\ (A) (D) 7 2 7 2 Q.30 Two identical thin rings, each of radius
R meter are coaxially placed at di stance R meter apart. If Qj and Q coulomb ar
e respectively the charges uniformly spread on the two rings, the work done in m
oving a charge qfromthe centre of on e ring to that of the other is (A) zero (B)
< f a ^ J j 2 - \ ) / ( j 2 A n e R ) (C) qV2(Q +Q )/47i R (D) qr(Qj-Q )(V2+l)/(
V2.47rs R) Q.31 Two positively charge d particles X and Y are initially far away
fromeach other and at rest. X begins t o move towards Y with some initial veloci
ty. The total momentum and energy of th e system are p and E. (A) If Y is fixed,
both p and E are conserved. (B) If Y is fixed, E is conserved, but not p. (C) I
f both are free to move, p is conserved but not E. (D) If both are free, E is co
nserved, but not p. Q.33 Two particles X and Y, ofequal mass and with unequal po
sitive charges, arefreeto move and are i nitially far awayfromeach other. With Y
at rest, X begins to move towards it wit h initial velocity u. After a long tim
e, finally (A) X will stop, Y will move wi th velocity u. (B) X and Y will both
move with velocities u/2 each. (C) X will s top, Y will move with velocity < u.
(D) both will move with velocities < u/2. Q. 34 A circular ring of radius R with
uniform positive charge density X per unit l ength is located in the y-z plane
with its centre at the origin O. Aparticle of mass m and positive charge q is pr
ojected from the Xq_ point P(R V3 , 0 , 0 ) on the positive x-axis directly towa
rds O, with an initial kinetic energy *tb . (A ) The particle crosses O and goes
to infinity. (B) The particle returns to P. (C ) The particle will just reach O
. (D) The particle crosses O and goes to -RV3. 0 1 2 0 2 0 d 0 (f| Bansal Classe
s Question Bank on Electrostatics [15]
Q.35 A bullet of mass m and charge q is fired towards a solid uniformly charged
sphere of radius R and total charge + q. If it strikes the surface of sphere wit
h speed u,findthe minimum speed u so that it can penetrate through the sphere.
( Neglect all resistance forces orfiictionacting on bullet except electrostatic
fo rces) + + , ++ + \ m + I t+ + + V3q (C) yj 87i mR (D) yj 47ts mR (B) ^47is mR
Q.36 In space of horizontal EF (E = (mg)/q) exist as shown in figure and a /////
///// mass m attached at the end of a light rod. If mass m is releasedfromthe po
sition shown in figure find the ang ular velocity of the rod when it X passes th
rough the bottom most position (A) ^27rs mR 0 0 0 0 ( A ) v (B) - f (D) Q.37 Two
identical particles of mass m carry a charge Q each. Initially one is a t rest
on a smooth horizontal plane and the other is projected along the plane d irectl
y towardsfirstparticle from a large distance with speed v. The closed dist ance
of approach be VOr 1 3Q 1 2Q 1 4Q (D) 4tc8O m v (A) 4TCS m v (B) 47is mv (C ) 4T
IS MV Q.38 The diagram shows a small bead of mass m carrying charge q. The b ead
can freely move on the smooth fixed ring placed on a smooth horizontal plane .
In the same plane a charge +Q has also beenfixedas shown. The potential atthe po
int /* P due to +Q is V. The velocity with which the bead should projected fro m
the point P so that it can complete a circle should be greater than I qV 3qV 6
e, uniformly charged sheet with surface charge density a cuts th rough a spheric
al Gaussian surface of radius R at a distance xfromits center, as shown in the f
igure. The electric flux O through the Gaussian surface is HIV a 7tR u (A) " 7 o
2 E ztiiin. R- x x ) a 27t( - (B) ~ o 2 2 / V _ x /\ N ' o o Q. 72 Two spherica
l, nonconducting, and very thin shells ofuniformly distr ibuted positive charge
Q and radius d are located a distance 1 Odfromeach other. A positive point charg
e q is placed inside one ofthe shells at a distance d/2 f rom the center, on the
line connecting the centers of the two shells, as shown i n the figure. What is
the net force on the charge q? b s (C)
TT(R-X) 2 CT (D) * TT(R -X 2 ) A 2 (A) 36l7T8 d 0 qQ 2 t o t h e l e f t (B) 36l
7ts d totheright 0 2 qQ ' 362qQ < > 36l7TE d C 0 2 t o t h e l e f t 360qQ CD) 2
totheright 3 6 l 7 r g ( ) d iod w (f| Bansal Classes Question Bank on Electros
tatics [15]
Q.73 A positive charge q is placed in a spherical cavity made in apositively cha
rged sphere. The centres of sphere and cavity are displaced by a small distance
/ . Force on charge q is: (A) in the direction parallel to vector J (B) in radi
a l direction (C) in a direction which depends on the magnitude of charge densit
y in sphere (D) direction can not be determined. Q.74 There are four concentric
sh ells A, B, C and D ofradii a, 2a, 3a and 4a respectively. Shells B and D are
giv en charges +q and -q respectively. Shell C is now earthed. The potential dif
fere nce V - V is: Kq Kq Kq Kq (B)' 3a (D) 6a ^ y A c Q.75 A metal ball of radiu
s R is placed concentrically inside a hollow metal sph ere of inner radius 2R an
d outer radius 3R. The ball is given a charge +2Q and t he hollow sphere a total
charge - Q. The electrostatic potential energy ofthis s ystem is: 7Q 5Q 5Q (D)
None (A) 247is R (B) 167t8 R (C) 87is R Question No. 76 t o 80 % fcfcjtft wuLuff
x' b e soVv <4 oat Apoint charge +Q having mass m is fixed o n horizontal smooth
surface. Another point charge having magnitude +2Q & mass 2m is projected horiz
ontally towards the charge +Q from far distance with velocity V . Q.76 Force app
lied by floor on the fixed charge in horizontal direction, wh en distance betwee
n charges becomes'd'. 2KQ KQ (C) Zero (D) None (A) (B) 0 0 0 o 2 2 Q. 77 The imp
ulse acting on the system ofparticles (Q + 2Q) in the time interval when distanc
e between them becomes'd'. (A) 2m o 2 K md md Q -V (B)2mV (D) None n (C) 2m k 2
Q. 7 8 Minimum distance of approach. 2KQ KQ 4KQ (D) None (A) mV (B) (D) mV Q.79
Acceleration ofparticle 2Q when it is closest to fixed particle Q mV mV (A) Zero
(D) None (B) 2KQ (C) 4KQ Q.80 If particle +Q isfreeto move, then what will be t
he closest distance between the particles. 6KQ' 3KQ' (A) Zero (D) None (B) mV (
C ) mV 2 2 2 2 Z 2 2 (f| Bansal Classes Question Bank on Electrostatics [15]
ONE OR MORE THAN ONE OPTION MAY BE CORRECT Take approx. 3 minutes for answering
each question. Q.l Mid way between the two equal and similar charges, we placed
the third equal and similar charge. Which ofthe following statements is correct,
concerned to the equilibrium along the line joining the charges ? (A) The third
charge experienced a net force inclined to the line joining the charges (B) The
third charge is in stable equilibrium (C) The third charge is in unstable equil
ibrium (D) The third charge experiences a net force perpendicular to the line j
o ining the charges A negative point charge placed at the point A is (A) in stab
le equilibrium along x-axis (B) in unstable equilibrium along y-axis (p^-- (C) in
s table equilibrium along y-axis (D) in unstable equilibrium along x-axis Five
bal ls numbered 1 to 5 are suspended using separate threads. Pairs (1,2), (2,4)
and (4,1) show electrostatic attraction while pairs (2,3) and (4,5) show repulsi
on. Therefore ball 1 must be (A) positively charged (B) negatively charged (C) n
eutr al (D) made of metal a a Q.2 Q.3 Q.4 Four charges of 1 pC,2pC,3 pC, and-6pC
are placed one at each corner ofthe squar e of side lm. The square lies in the
x-y plane with its centre at the origin. (A ) The electric potential is zero at
the origin. (B) The electric potential is ze ro everywhere along the x-axis only
^f the sides ofthe square are parallel to x a nd y axis. (C) The electric potent
ial is zero everywhere along the z-axis for an y orientation ofthe square in the
xy plane. (D) The electric potential is not ze ro along the z-axis except at th
e origin. Twofixedcharges 4Q (positive) and Q (n egative) are located at A and B
, the distance AB being 3 m. + 4Q A - Q B Q. 5 (A) The point P where the resultan
tfielddue to both is zero is on AB outside AB. (B) The point P where the resulta
tricfi eldexists (D) Potential at every point of the sphere must be same Q.18 Fo
r a sph erical shell (A) Ifpotential inside it is zero then it necessarily elect
rically neutral (B) electricfieldin a charged conducting spherical shell can be
zero onl y when the charge is uniformly distributed. (C) electric potential due
to induce d charges at a point inside it will always be zero (D) none of these A
E = 0 2 2 3 / 2 Q.19 A circular ring carries a uniformly distributed positive c
harge. The electr icfield(E) and potential (V) varies with distance (r)fromthe c
entre of the ring along its axis as (A) (B) (C) Q.20 The figure shows a noncondu
cting ring which has positive and negative charg e non uniformly distributed on
it such that the total charge is zero. - I0 Which ofthe following statements is
true? ; axis I (A) The potential at all the point s on the axis will be zero. (B
) The electricfieldat all the points on the axis w ill be zero. (C) The directio
n of electricfieldat all points on the axis will be along the axis. (D) Ifthe ri
ng is placed inside a uniform external electricfiel dthen net torque and force a
cting on the ring would be zero. Q.21 At distance of 5cm and 1 Ocm outwards from
the surface of a uniformly charged solid sphere, th e potentials are 100V and 7
5V respectively. Then (A) potential at its surface is 150V. (B) the charge on th
e sphere is (5/3) * 10" C. (C) the electricfieldon th e surface is 1500 V/m. (D)
the electric potential at its centre is 225V. 10 Q.22 Four identical charges ar
e placed at the points (1,0,0), (0,1,0), (-1,0,0) and (0, -1,0). (A) The potenti
al at the origin is zero. (B) Thefieldat the origi n is zero. (C) The potential
at all points on the z-axis, other than the origin, is zero. (D) Thefieldat all
points on the z-axis, other than the origin acts al ong the z-axis. (f| Bansal C
lasses Question Bank on Electrostatics [15]
Q.23 Variation of electrostatic potential along x-direction is shown in the grap
h. The correct statement about electricfieldis (A) x component at point B is ma
x imum (B) x component at point A is towards positive x-axis. (C) x component at
p oint C is along negative x-axis (D) x component at point C is along positive
x-a xis Q.24 A particle of charge 1 pC & mass 1 gm moving with a velocity of 4 m
/s i s subj ected to a uniform electric field of magnitude 300 V/m for 10 sec. T
hen i t's final speed cannot be: (A) 0.5 m/s (B)4m/s (C)3m/s (D)6m/s Q.25 Two po
int ch arges q and 2q are placed at (a, 0) and (0, a). Apoint charge q[ is place
d at a point P on the quarter circle of radius a as shown in the diagram so that
the el ectricfieldat the origin becomes zero: a V2a '_a_ 2a ^ (A) the point P i
s 7 3 ' V T (B) the point Pis V5'V5 (C)q,=-5q (D) none of these Q.26 A charged c
ork of m ass m suspended by a light string is placed in uniform electricfiledof
strength E = (i + ]) x 10 NC~' as shown in thefig.Ifin equilibrium 2mg position
tension i n the string is then angle'a'with the vertical is (A) 60 (B) 30 (C) 45 (D
)18 Q.27 Tw o particles of same mass and charge are thrown in the same direction
along the h orizontal with same velocity vfromtwo different heights hj and h (h,
< h ). Init ially they were located on the same vertical line. Choose the corre
ct alternativ e. (A) Both the particles will always lie on a vertical line. (B)
Acceleration o fthe centre of mass of two particles will be g downwards. (C) Hor
izontal displac ement of the particle lying at hj is less and the particle lying
at h is more th an the value, which would had been inthe absence of charges on
them. (D) all of these. 5 2 2 2 Q.28 A proton and a deuteron are initially at re
st and are accelerated through t he same potential difference. Which ofthe follo
wing is false concerning thefinal properties ofthe two particles ? (A) They have
different speeds (B) They have sa me momentum (C) They have same kinetic energy
(D) They have been subj ected to s ame force Q.29 A particle of charge - q and
mass m moves in a circle around a lo ng wire of linear charge density + X. If r=
radius of the circular path and T = t ime period of the motion circular path. Th
en: (A) T = 2 ti r (m/2KXq) (B) T = 4 tt m r /2qK>, (C) T = 1/2 7r r (2KA,q/m) (
D) T = l/27tr (m/KTtAq) where K = l/4n e i/2 2 2 3 1/2 172 0 (f| Bansal Classes
Question Bank on Electrostatics [15]
Q.30 Charge Q is distributed non-uniformly over a ring of radius R, P is a point
on the axis of ring at a distance Sr from its centre. Which ofthe following is a
wrong statement. KQ (A) Potential at P is -2R V3KQ (B) Magnitude of electric fie
ld at P may be greater than y~ 8R V3KQ (C) Magnitude of electric field at P mus
t be equal to j 8R V3KQ (D) Magnitude of electric field at P cannot be less than
c conducting spherical shells have radius r, 2r and 3r and Q,, Q, and Q are fina
l charges respectively. Innermost and outermost shells are already earthed as sh
own in figure. Choose the wrong statement. . 0, 3 (D) The potential at a distanc
e r from C, where a<r<b, , (A) Q. + Q (C) 3 Qi Q .45 Two thin conducting shells
of radii R and 3R are shown in the figure. The outer shell carries a charge + Q
and the inner shell is neutral. The inner shell is earthed with the help of a sw
itch S. (A) With the switch S open, the potenti al ofthe inner sphere is equal t
o that ofthe outer. (B) When the switch S is clo sed, the potential of the inner
sphere becomes zero. (C) With the switch S close d, the charge attained by the
inner sphere is - q/3. (D) By closing the switch t he capacitance of the system
increases. Q.46 X and Y are large, parallel conduct ing plates closed to each ot
her. Each face has an area A. X is given a charge Q. Y is without any charge. Po
ints A, B and C are as shown in figure. (A) The fiel d at B is ^ T ^ o ,E Q. (B)
Q , =-Q r H Q -1 o7 T 2 3 ( D ) = Q X Y (B) The field at Bis 7 T (C) Thefieldsa
t A, B and C are of the same magnitude. ( D) Thefieldat Aand C are of the same m
agnitude, but in opposite directions. Q.47 Plates A andB constitute an isolated,
charge parallel-plate capacitor. [~1+Q [~ | _Q The inner surfaces (I and IV) of
A and B have charges +Q and - Q respective ly. A third plate C with charge +Q i
s now introduced midway " between Aand B. Wh ich ofthe following statements is n
ot correct? II III IV (A) The surfaces I and II will have equal and opposite cha
rges. (B) The surfaces III and IV will have e qual and opposite charges. (C) the
charge on surface III will be greater than Q. (D) The potential difference betw
een Aand C will be equal to the potential diff erence between C and B. B Q
B (f| Bansal Classes Question Bank on Electrostatics [15]
Q .4 8 A particle ofmass m and charge q is thrown in a region where uniform grav
itational field and electric field are present. The path of particle (A) may be
a straight line (B) may be a circle (C) may be a parabola (D) may be a hyperbol
a Question No. 49 to 54 (6 questions) An empty thick conducting shell of inner r
a dius a and outer radius b is shown in figure. If it is observed that the inner
f ace ofthe shell carries a uniform charge density -cr and the surface carries
a u niform charge density 'a' Q.49 If a point charge q is placed at the center o
f th e shell, then choose the correct statement(s) (A) The charge must be positi
ve (B ) The charge must be negative (C) The magnitude of charge must be 4naa2 (D
) The magnitude of charge must be 4na(b - a ) Q.50 If another point charge q is
also p laced at a distance c (>b) the center of shell, then choose the correct s
tatemen ts q (A) force experienced by charge A is s c A 2 2 B a A b 2 2 0 (B) fo
rce experienced by charge A is zero (C) The force experienced by charge B is s c
2 Q pq B b 2 (D) The force experienced by charge B is A kq q 2 A B (f| Bansal Cl
asses Q. 51 Ifthe charge q is slowly moved inside the shell, then choose the sta
tement (s) (A) Charge distribution on the inner and outer face ofthe shell chang
es (B) The force acting on the charge B charges (C) The charge B also starts mov
ing slo wly (D) None of these Q.52 Choose the correct statement related to the p
otential of the shell in absence of q (A) Potential ofthe outer surface is more
than tha t ofthe inner surface because it is positively charged (B) Potential of
the outer surface is more than that of the inner surface because it carries more
charge ( C) Both the surfaces have equal potential ob (D) The potential of the
outer surf ace is o Q. 5 3 If the outer surface of the shell is earthed, then id
entify the correct statement(s) (A) Only the potential of outer surface becomes
zero (B) Ch arge on the outer surface also becomes zero (C) The outer surface at
tains negati ve charge (D) Negative charge on the inner surface decreases Q.54 I
f the inner s urface of the shell is earthed, then identify the correct statemen
t(s) (A) The p otential of both the inner and outer surface ofthe shell becomes
zero (B) Charge on the outer surface becomes zero (C) Charge on the inner surfac
e decreases (D) Positive charge flows from the shell to the earth B fc C Questio
n Bank on Electrostatics [15]
ANSWER KEY Q.l Q.7 Q.13 Q.19 Q.25 Q.31 Q.38 Q.44 Q.50 Q.56 Q.62 Q.68 Q.74 Q.80 Q
.l Q.5 Q.9 Q.13 Q.17 Q.21 Q.25 Q.29 Q.33 Q.37 Q.41 Q.45 Q.49 Q.53 B A A D C B A
B C B A (a)B,(b)D D B B A, D A B D A, C, D B A A,B,D A,C,D A,D A,B ,C,D A,C B Q.
2 Q.8 Q.14 Q.20 Q.26 Q.33 Q.39 Q.45 Q.51 Q.57 Q.63 Q.69 Q.75 D D D A B A D B B B
D B A ONLY ONE OPTION IS Q.3 Q.9 Q.15 Q.21 Q.27 Q.34 Q.40 Q.46 Q.52 Q.58 Q.64 Q
.70 Q.76 C B B A C C A B A B B C A Q.4 Q.10 Q.16 Q.22 Q.28 Q.35 Q.41 Q.47 Q.53 Q
.59 Q.65 Q.71 Q.77 D D A C B B A D B C B D A CORRECT. Q.5 Q.ll Q.17 Q.23 Q.29 Q.
36 Q.42 Q.48 Q.54 Q.60 Q.66 Q.72 Q.78 B A B B B B B C B B A A A Q.6 Q.12 Q.18 Q.
24 Q.30 Q.37 Q.43 Q.49 Q.55 Q.61 Q.67 Q.73 Q.79 D A D D B B B A D A A A C ONE OR
MORE THAN ONE OPTION MAY BE CORRECT Q.2 Q.6 Q.10 Q.14 Q.18 Q.22 Q.26 Q.30 Q.34
Q.38 Q.42 Q.46 Q.50 Q.54 C, D A, C C B,C D B,D A,B C C A,B A,B,C A,C,D B A,B,D Q
.3 Q.7 Q.ll Q.15 Q.19 Q.23 Q.27 Q.31 Q.35 Q.39 Q.43 Q.47 Q.51 C, D B B, C A, C B
D D A, B, D C A,B,C A,C,D D D Q.4 Q.8 Q.12 Q.16 Q.20 Q.24 Q.28 Q.32 Q.36 Q.40 Q
.44 Q.48 Q.52 A, C A, B, C A, C A, B,D A A B A, D C, D A,D D A,C C,D 9 (f| Bansa
l Classes Question Bank on Electrostatics [15]
BANSALCLASSES TARGET IIT JEE 2007 1 1 YS ICS *1 !||| 11 (ALL) / ERRORIN MEASUREME
NTS INSTRUMENTS' &
Whenever an experiment is performed, two kinds of errors can appear in the measu
red quantity. (1) indeterminate and (2) determinate (or systematic) errors. 1.
I ndeterminate errors appear randomly because ofoperator, fluctuations in extern
al conditions and variability of measuring instruments. The effect ofindetermina
te error can be some what reduced by taking the average of measured values. Inde
te rminate errors have no fixed sign or size. 2. Determinate errors occur due to
er ror in the procedure, or miscalibration ofthe intrument etc. Such errors hav
e sa me size and sign for all the measurements. Such errors can be determined. A
measu rement with relatively small indeterminate error is said to have high prec
ision. Ameasurement with small indeterminate error and small determinate error i
s said to have high accuracy. The experimental error [uncertainty] can be expres
sed in several standard ways. Error limits Q AQ is the measured quantity and AQ
is the magnitude of its limit of error. This expresses the experimenter's judgme
nt tha t the 'true' value of Q lies between Q - AQ and Q + AQ. This entire inter
val wit hin which the measurement lies is called the range of error. Indetermina
te error s are expressed in this form. Absolute Error ERRORS Error may be expres
sed as absolute measures, giving the size ofthe error in a qu antity in the same
units as the quantity itself Relative (or Fractional) Error Error may be expres
sed as relative measures, giving the ratio ofthe quantity's e rror to the quanti
ty itself. In general absolute pnor in a measurement relative error = f the meas
urement We should know the error in the measurement because th ese errors propag
ate through the calculations to produce errors in results. A. D eterminate error
s : They have a known sign. 1. Suppose that a result R is calcul atedfromthe sum
of two measured quantities A and B. We' 11 use a and b to repres ent the error
in A and B respectively, r is the error in the result R. Then (R + r) = (A + B)
+ (a + b) The error in R is therefore : r = a + b. Similarly, when two quantitie
s are subtracted, the determinate errors also get subtracted. 2. S uppose that a
result R is calculated by multiplying two measured quantities A an d B. Then R=
AB. (R + r) = (A+ a) (B + b) = AB + aB + Ab + ab => = = + . Thus when two quantit
ies are multiplied, their relative determinate error add. R AB A B 3 . Quotient
rule: When two quantities are divided, the relative determinate error ofthe quot
ient is the relative A determinate error ofthe numerator minus the re lative det
erminate error ofthe denominator. Thus ifR = then D - JL_Jl R~A~B 4. P ower rule
: When a quantity Q is raised to a power, P, the relative determinate e rror in
the result is P times the relative determinate error in Q. . p = 0 I f R Q P x T
his also holds for negative powers. (1% Bansal Classes ERROR IN MEASUREMENTS & I
NSTRUMENTS [2]
5. The quotient rule is not applicable if the numerator and denominator are depe
nde nt on each other. XY e.g ifR = . We cannot apply quotient rule to find the erro
r in R. Instead we write the equation as follows .X. + Y 1 1 1 = A + Y Different
iati ng both the sides, we get R . dR _ dX dY _ * y r R x R y 7~ n 7. Thus 7 7 7
or x h X R X Y R X Y R X X Y Y Indeterminate error: They have unknown sign. Thus
they are represented in the form A a. Here we are only concerned with limits ofe
rror. We must assume a "worst-case" combination. In the case of substraction, A
- B, the worst-case deviation of the answer occurs when the errors are either +
a and - b or - a and + b. In either case, the maximum error will be (a + b) Addi
tion and subtraction rule: The absolute indeterminate errors add. Thus if R = A
+ B, r = a + b and if R = A-B, r = a + b Product and quotient rule: The relative
tiplication AND divisi on there is the following rule for expressing a computed
product or quotient wit h the proper number of significant digits. The product o
r quotient will be repor ted as having as many significant digits as the number
involved in the operation with the least number of significant digits. For examp
le : 0.000170 x 100.40 = 0.017068 The product could be expressed with no more th
at three significant digi ts since 0.000170 has only three significant digits, a
nd 100.40 hasfive.So accor ding to the rule the product answer could only be exp
ressed with three significa nt digits. Thus the answer should be 0.0171 (after r
ounding off) Another example : 2.000 x 10 / 6.0 x 10~ = 0.33 x 10 The answer cou
ld be expressed with no more that two significant digits since the least digited
number involved in the oper ation has two significant digits. Sometimes this wo
uld required expressing the a nswer in exponential notation. For example : 3.0 x
800.0 = 2.4 x 10 The number 3 .0 has two significant digits and then number 800
.0 has four. The rule states th at the answer can have no more than two digits e
xpressed. However the answer as we can all see would be 2400. How do we express
the answer 2400 while obeying th e rules? The only way is to express the answer
in exponential notation so 2400 c ould be expressed as : 2.4 x 10 6 6 4 2 5 4 3
7 3 3 COMPUTED VALUE (1% Bansal Classes ERROR IN MEASUREMENTS & INSTRUMENTS [4]
Rule for expressing the correct number of significant digits in an addition or s
ubstraction : The ruie for expressing a sum or difference is considerably diffe
r ent than the one for multiplication of division. The sum or difference can be
no more precise than the least precise number involved in the mathematical opera
ti on.Precision has to do with the number ofpositions to the RIGHT ofthe decimal
. T he more position to the right ofthe decimal, the more precise the number. So
a s um or difference can have no more indicated positions to therightof the dec
imal as the number involved in the operation with the LEAST indicated positions
to th erightofits decimal. For example: 160.45 + 6.732 = 167.18 (after rounding
off) T he answer could be expressed only to two positions to the right of the de
cimal, since 160.45 is the least precise. Another example: 45.621+4.3-6.41 =43.5
(after rounding off) The answer could be expressed only to one position to the
right o fthe decimal, since the number 4.3 is the least precise number (i.e. hav
ing only one position to therightofits decimal). Notice we aren't really determi
ning the total number ofsignificant digits in the answer with this rule. Rules f
or round ing off digits : There are a set of conventional rules for rounding off
. 1. Dete rmine according to the rule what the last reported digit should be. 2.
Consider the digit to the right ofthe last reported digit. 3. If the digit to t
he right o f the last reported digit is less than 5 round it and all digits to i
tsrightoff 4 If the digit to the right of the last reported digit is greater tha
n 5 round i t and all digits to its right off and increased the last reported di
git by one. 5 Ifthe digit to therightofthe last reported digit is a 5 followed b
y either no other digits or all zeros, round it and all digits to its right off
and ifthe la st reported digit is odd round up to the next even digit. Ifthe las
t reported di git is even then leave it as is. For example if we wish to round o
ffthe followin g number to 3 significant digits: 18.3 682 The last reported digi
ts would be the 3. The digit to its right is a 6 which is greater than 5. Accord
ing to the Rule -4 above, the digit 3 is increased by one and the answer is : 18
.4 Another examp le: Round off 4.565 to three significant digits. The last repor
ted digit would b e the 6. The digit to therightis a 5 followed by nothing. Ther
efore according to Rule-5 above since the 6 is even it remains so and the answer
would be 4.56. (i ) Measurement of length The simplest method measuring the len
gth of a straight l ine is by means of a meter scale. But there exists some limi
tation in the accura cy ofthe result: (i) the dividing lines have a finite thick
ness. (ii) naked eye cannot correctly estimate less than 0.5 mm For greater accu
racy devices like (a) Vernier callipers (b) micrometer scales (screw gauge) are
used. It consists of a main scale graduated in cm/mm over which an auxiliary sca
le (or Vernier scale) can slide along the length. The division ofthe Vernier sca
le being either sligh tly longer and shorter than the divisions ofthe main scale
. Least count of Verni er Callipers The least count or Vernier constant (v. c) i
s the minimum value of correct estimation of length without eye estimation. IfN
division ofvernier coin cides with (N-1) division ofmain scale, then N-O Vernier
ly to the observed dista nce to get the corrected distance. Speed of sound using
resonance column A tunin g fork of known frequency (f) is held at the mouth of
a long tube, which is dipp ed into water as shown in thefigure.The length (/j) o
fthe air column in the tube is adjusted until it resonates with the tuning fork.
The air temperature and hu midity are noted.The length of the tube is adjusted
again until a second resonan ce length (/ ) is found (provided the tube is long)
Then, / -1 -X i 2, provided l , l are resonance lengths for adjacent resonances
. X = 2(/ - /,), is the wavel ength of sound. Since thefrequencyi, is known; the
velocity of sound in air at t he temperature (9) and humidity (h) is given by C
= f A, = 2(/ ~/ )f It is also possible to use a single measurement ofthe resona
nt length directly, but, then i t has to be correctedfor the "end effect": /..(f
undamental) = 4(/j + 0.3 d), whe re d = diameter Errors: The major systematic er
rors introduced are due to end ef fects in (end correction) and also due to exce
ssive humidity. 2 2 { x 2 2 2 1 ^ Bansal Classes ERROR IN MEASUREMENTS & INSTRUM
ENTS [SJ
Random errors are given by SC _ S ( / - / ) _ 51 +5/, 2 t 2 1,-1, k-K (vii) Veri
fication of Ohm's law using voltmeter and ammeter A voltmeter (V) and an ammeter
(A) are connected in a circuit along with a resistance R as shown in thefigure,
along with a battery B and a rheostat, Rh Simultaneous readings ofthe current i
and the potential drop V are taken by changing the resistance in the r heostat (
Rh), Agraph ofV vs i is plotted and it is found to be linear (within er rors). T
he magnitude ofR is determined by either V (a) taking the ratio and then (b) fit
ting to a straight line: V=iR, and determining the slope R. Errors: Syst ematic
errors in this experiment arisefromthe currentflowingthrough V (finite re sistan
ce ofthe voltmeter), the Joule heating effect in the circuit and the resis tance
ofthe connecting wires/ connections of the resistance. The effect ofJoule heati
ng may be minimsed by switching on the circuit for a short while only, whil e th
e effect offiniteresistance of the voltmeter can be overcome by using a high res
istance instrument or a potentiometer. The lengths of connecting wires shoul d b
e minimised as much as possible. Error analysis: 5R SV Si The error in comput in
g the ratio R = is given by R V + i where 5V and 5i are ofthe order ofthe leas t
counts ofthe instruments used. (viii) Specific resistance of the material of a
wire using a meter bridge: A known length (/) of a wire is connected in one oft
he gaps (P) of a metre bridge, while a Resistance Box is inserted into the other
gap (Q). The circuit is completed by using a battery (B), a Rheostat (Rh), a Ke
y (K) and a galvanometer (G). The balance length (/) is found by closing key k
a nd momentarily connecting the galvanometer until it gives zero deflection (nul
l point). Then, P Q~100-/ CI) using the expression for the meter bridge at balan
ce . Here, represents the resistance of the wire while Q represents the resistan
ce in the resistance box. The key K is open when the circuit is not in use. L nr
Th e resistance of the wire, P = p Ttrj => p = P (2) 2 T where r is the radius
of wire and L is the length of the wire, r is measured usi ng a screw gauge whil
e L is measured with a scale. Errors: The major systematic errors in this experi
ment are due to the heating effect, end corrections introdu ced due to shift oft
he zero ofthe scale at A and B, and stray resistances in P a nd Q, and errors du
e to non-uniformity of the meter bridge wire. Error analysis: End corrections ca
n be estimated by including known resistances P, and Qj inthe two ends andfindin
gthe null point: Q, 100-/,+p +a (2), where a and p are the end corrections. <! Ba
nsal Classes ERROR IN MEASUREMENTS & INSTRUMENTS [15]
When the resistance Q is placed in the left gap and P, in the right gap, Qj _ /
+ a ~F\~~IOO-/ +[3 which give two linear equation forfindinga and (3. } 2 2 In o
rder that a and (3 be measured accurately, P and Qj should be as different f rom
each other as possible. For the actual balance point, _P I, l+ a Q 100-/ + P L
} Errors due to non-uniformity of the meter bridge wire can be minimised by inte
rc hanging the resistances in the gaps P and Q. 8P 51, + 51. P where, 8/' and S/
' a re of the order ofthe least count ofthe scale. } 2 (ix) The error is, theref
ore, minimum if /' = /' i.e. when the balance point is in th e middle ofthe brid
ge. The error in pis SP _ 28r 8L , SP P ~ r L^ P s Measuremen t of unknown resis
tance using a P.O. Box ~wm A P.O. Box can also be used to meas ure an unknown re
sistance. It is a Wheatstone Bridge with three arms P, Q and R; while the fourth
arm(s) is the unknown resistance. P and Q are known as the rat io arms while R
is known at the rheostat arm. At balance, the unknown resistance S = vvy R (1) t
2 + The ratio arms are first adjusted so that they carry 100 O each. The resist
ance in the rheostat arm is now adjusted so that the galvanometer deflection is
in on e direction, ifR = Rq (Ohm) and in the opposite direction when R=Rq+1 (ohm
). Thi s implies that the unknown resistance, S lies between R^and R^ + 1 (ohm).
Now, t he resistance in P and Q are made 100 Q and 1000 Q respectively, and the
process is repeated. Equation (1) is used to compute S. The ratio P/Q is progre
ssively made 1: 10, and then 1 :100. The resistance S can be accurately measured
. Errors : The major sources of error are the connecting wires, unclear resistan
ce plugs, change in resistance due to Joule heating, and the insensitivity ofthe
Wheatsto ne bridge. These may be removed by using thick connecting wires, clean
plugs, ke eping the circuit on for very brief periods (to avoid Joule heating)
and calcula ting the sensitivity. In order that the sensitivity is maximum, the
resistance i n the arm P is close to the value ofthe resistance S. <! Bansal Clas
ses ERROR IN MEASUREMENTS & INSTRUMENTS [15]
Q.l Q.2 Q.3 IN In a Vernier Calipers (VC), N divisions of the main scale coincid
e with N + m divisions ofthe vernier scale What is the value of m for which the
instrument h as minimum least count? (A) 1 (B)N (C) Infinity (D)N/2 EXERCISE Con
sider the vernier calipers as shown, the instrument has no zero error. What i s
the length ofthe rod shown, if 1 msd = 1mm? Use 7 msd = 8 vsd. (A) 4.6 mm (B)4 .
5mm (C) 4.3 mm (D)none Main Scale 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 1011121314 1 i 'i I i' i' i1
'i Vernier Scale In a vernier calipers the main scale and the vernier scale are
made up different materials. When the room temperature increases by ATC, it is f
ound the reading o f the instrument remains the same. Earlier it was observed th
at the front edge o fthe wooden rod placed for measurement crossed the N main sc
ale division and N + 2 msd coincided with the 2 vsd. Initially, 10 vsd coincided
with 9 msd. If coef ficient of linear expansion ofthe main scale is a, and that
ofthe vernier scale is c^ then what is the value of a,/a,? (Ignore the expansio
n of the rod on heati ng) (A) 1.8 / (N) (B) 1.8/(N+2) (C)1.8/(N-2) (D)None 4 nd
Q.4 Consider a screw gauge without any zero error. What will be thefinalreading
corr esponding to thefinalstate as shown? It is given that the circular head tra
nslat es P msd in N rotations. One msd is equal to 1mm. (A) (P/N) (2 + 45/100) m
m (B) (N/P) (2+45/N)mm f 45 P (C) P (2/N + 45/100)mm (D) 2 + 100 x mm N N Circul
ar scale I 45 Line of Reference The circular scale has 100 divisions Q.5 A screw
gauge has some zero error but its value is unknown. We have two identica l rods
. When thefirstrod is inserted in the screw, the state ofthe instrument is shown
by diagram (I). When both the rods are inserted together in series then t he st
ate is shown by the diagram (II). What is the zero error ofthe instrument? 1 msd
= 100 csd = 1mm (A) -0.16 mm (B)+0.16 mm (C)+0.14 mm (D) -0.14 mm (1) -12 (ii)
....... (ii)
Q.6 The hat of 314 .' 1 Q. 7 Consider a home made vernier scale as shown in the
figure. In this diagram, we are interested in measuring the length ofthe line PQ
. Ifthe angle ofboth the inclines is equal to 6 then what is the least count oft
he instr ument. <! Bansal Classes ERROR IN MEASUREMENTS & INSTRUMENTS [15] VC sho
wn in the diagram has zero error in it (as 9 msd = 10 vsd What is the magnitude
of the zero the length ofa rod measured by this VC comes out to be 5.4 mm. If th
e vernier had been error free l'.' coincided with vsd. you can see). It is error
? The observed 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 1 then msd would have given t reading 0 11121 \
\ I I
The zero of the main scale lies under the circular head. Q. 8 The diagram shows
the initial and thefinalstate of SQ which has zero error in it . What can be the
length ofthe object? 1 msd = 100 csd -12 S L -1 i 1+ 1 { +--+10 Q.9 In a meter bri
dge set up, which of the following should be the properties of the one meter lon
g wire? (A) High resistivity and low temperature coefficient (B) L ow resistivit
y and low temperature coefficient (C) Low resistivity and high temp erature coef
ficient (D) High resistivity and high temperature coefficient Q.10 Make the appr
opriate connections in the meter bridge set up shown. Resistan ce box is connect
ed between _. Unknown resistance is connected between . Battery is connected bet
ween. Options: (A)AB (B) CD (C)EF (D)None E r A Q.ll Let the end error on the LH
S and RHS be equal to one cm. For the balance po int at O,findout the % tage err
or in the value ofX? (Ifthe end error is 1 cm fro m both sides then it means the
corrected reading will become 10cm + 1 cm from LH S and 90cm + 1 cm from the RH
S) (A) 4.2% (B) 8.1% (C) 9.2% (D)None A x
Q.12 Consider the MB shown in the diagram, let the resistance X have temperature
coefficient a, and the resistancefromthe RB have the temperature coefficient 0L
2. Let the reading ofthe meter scale be 10cmfromthe LHS. Ifthe temperature ofth
e two resistance increase by small temperature AT then what is the shift in the
p osition ofthe null point? Neglect all the other changes in the bridge due to t
em perature rise. 1 1 (A) 9(a, - a )AT (B) 9(a + a )AT _ (C) - (a, + a )AT (D) (a , - a )AT Q.13 The diagram shows an incomplete sketch of a PO box. Battery i
s co nnected B C A SDDDdQD between . The unknown resistance is connected between The
galv anometer is connected between_ _. The key K^ is connected ]] between . ^sdaanndn
Opti ns: (A) CD (B) DA (C) CE (D)DF V|]V F (E)DE (F)BF (G) CF 2 t 2 9 V 1 2 9 2
Q.14 For a post office Box, the graph of galvanometer deflection versus R (resi
s tance pulled out ofRB) for the ratio 100 : 1 is given as shown. A careless stu
de nt pulls out two non consecutive values R as shown in thefigure.Find the valu
e o funknown resistance. (A) 3.2 ohm (B) 3.24 ohm (C) 3.206 ohm (D)None
Deflection (in division) RO <! Bansal Classes ERROR IN MEASUREMENTS & INSTRUMENTS
[15]
Q.15 When we operate a wheat stone bridge then in starting the key of the batter
y is closedfirstand the key ofthe G is closed later. When the circuit is to be
c losed then switches are released in the opposite order. Why? (A) Look at the d
ia gram of the PO box, the switch is battery is always on the right hand hence i
t i s easier to press it first. (B) This is done to avoid the damage ofthe galva
nome ter due to induced emf. (C) If the G switch is pressed before the battery s
witch then large sparking takes place at the battery switch. (D) While disconnec
ting if we open the battery switch before the G switch then we can observe induc
ed cu rrent in the circuit till the G switch is not opened. Q.16 Identify which
of the following diagrams represent the internal construction ofthe coils wound
in a r esistance box or PQ box? \...k ....JL^. / P -s \ (A) s / (B) S i1f>, tL Hy
/ ! (C)~ A -JL (D) mMk Q.17 Which ofthe following reading is most accurate (A)
4.00 cm (B) 0.004 mm (C) 40.00 cm (D) 4.00 m Q. 18 The least count of a stop wat
ch is 1/5 sec. The time of 20 oscillations of a pendulum is measured to be 25 se
c. The minimum percentage error in the measur ement oftime will be (A) 0.1% (B)
0.8% (C) 1.8% (D)8% Q.19 A vernier callipers h aving 1 main scale division = 0.1
cm is designed to have a least count of 0.02 c m. If n be the number of divisio
ns on vernier scale and m be the length ofvernie r scale, then (A) n= 10, m=0.5
cm (B) n=9, m=0.4 cm (C)n=10,m=0.8 cm (D) n=10, m =0.2 cm Q.20 Solve with due re
gard to significant digits >.91x0,3842 (i) V6.5-6. 32 (ii) 0.080 Q.21 Abody trav
els uniformly a distance of (13.8 0.2)m in time (4. 0 0.3) sec. Calculate its ve
locity. Q.22 The main scale of a vernier calipers re ads in millimeter and its v
ernier is divided into 10 divisions which coincide wi th 9 divisions ofthe main
scale. When the two jaws ofthe instrument touch each o ther the seventh division
of the vernier scale coincide with a scale division an d the zero of the vernie
r lies to the right of the zero of main scale. Furthermo
re, when a cylinder is tightly placed along its length between the two jaws, the
zero of the vernier scale lies slightly to the left of 3.2 cm and the fourth ve
rnier division coincides with a scale division. Calculate the measured length o
f the cylinder. Q.23 A short circuit occurs in a telephone cable having a resist
a nce of 0.45 Onr . The circuit is tested with a Wheatstone bridge. The two resi
st ors in the ratio arms ofthe Wheatstone bridge network have values of 100Q and
11 10Q respectively. Abalance condition is found when the variable resistor has
a v alue of4000. Calculate the distance down the cable, where the short has occ
urred . 1 Q.24 5.74 gm of a substance occupies a volume of 1.2 cm . Calculate it
s density with due regard for significant figures. 3 <! Bansal Classes ERROR IN M
EASUREMENTS & INSTRUMENTS [15]
Q.25 Thetimeperiod of oscillation ofa simple pendulum is given by The length of
the pendulum is measured as / = 10 0.1 cm and the time period as T = 0.5 0.02 s.
Determine percentage error in the value of g. Q.26 A physical quantity P is rel
fr adius r = 1 cm is inserted. The piston can enter a cylinder tightly and witho
ut friction, and initially it is at the bottom of the cylinder. 750gm of water i
s n ow H poured into the pipe so that the piston & pipe are lifted up as shown.
Find the height H ofwater in the cylinder and height h ofwater in the pipe. Q.3
A re ctangular vessel isfilledwith water & oil in equal proportion (by volume),
the o il being twice lighter than water. Show that the force on each wall of the
vesse l will be reduced by onefifthif the vessel is filled only with oil. (take
into c onsideration the fact that the oil is found at the top ofthe vessel). Q.
4 A soli d ball of density half that of water fallsfreelyunder gravityfroma heig
ht of 19. 6 m and then enter water. Upto what depth will the ball go? How much t
ime will i t take to come again to the water surface? Neglect air resistance & v
elocity eff ects in water. Q. 5 Place a glass beaker, partiallyfilledwith water,
in a sink. The beaker has a mass 390 gm and an interior volume of 500cm . You n
ow start tof illthe sink with water and you find, by experiment, that if the bea
ker is less t han half full, it willfloat;but if it is more than half full, it r
emains on the bottom ofthe sink as the water rises to its rim. What is the densi
ty ofthe mater ial ofwhich the beaker is made? Q. 6 Two spherical balls A and B
made up of same material having masses 2m and m are releasedfromrest. Ball B lie
s at a distance h below the water surface while A is at a height of 2h above wat
er surface in t he same vertical line, at the instant they are released. (a) Obt
ain the position where they collide. (b) If the bodies stick together due to col
lision, to what maximum height above water surface does the combined mass rise?
Specific gravity of the material ofthe balls is 2/3. Neglect viscosity and loss
due to splash. Q . 7 Two very large open tanks A and F both contain the same liq
uid. A horizontal pipe BCD, having a constriction at C leads out ofthe .-. botto
m oftank A and a vertical pipe E opens into the constriction at rs-.-i-.. ~ ~ C an
d dips into the l iquid in tank F. Assume streamline flow and no r fn>. } viscos
ity. Ifthe cross s ection at C is one halfthat at D and if D is at a distance h,
below the level of liquid in A to what height h (in r terms of h, )will liquidr
isein pipe E ? 8m Q .8 For the system shown in thefigure,the cylinder on the lef
t at L has a mass of 600kg and a cross sectional area of800 cm . The piston on t
he right, at S, has c ross sectional area 25cm and negligible weight. 600kg If t
he apparatus isfilledw ith oil.(p = 0.75 gm/cm ) Find the force F required to ho
ld the system in equili brium. 2 3 Q.l EXERCISE # I I 2 \ r~"i 2 2 3 Q.9 (a) (b)
(c)
A siphon has a uniform circular base of diameter ~j= cm with its crest V7t 1.8m
A1.8 m above water level as infigure.Find velocity of flow discharge rate ofthe
flow in m /sec. absolute pressure at the crest level A. [Use P = 10 N/m & g = 10
m/s ] 3 0 5 2 2 8 3.6m ^Bansal Classes Fluid Mechanics [12]
Q.10 A large tank isfilledwith two liquids of specific gravities 2a and c. Two h
oles are h,4 made on the wall ofthe tank as shown. Find the ratio ofthe distanc
e sfromO ofthe points on the ground where the jets fromholes A& B strike. h/2 Ml
Q .ll The horizontal pipe shown in the diagram has a cross sectional area of 40
cm at the wider position and 10cm at the narrow poriton. A liquid of 7 JT V _ 10c
m 4 0cm specific gravity 1.6 isflowingin the pipe with volumeflowrate equal to 5
x 1 0 m /s. Find the difference in the heights h between the mercury hJ mercury
colu mn in the manometer tube. (p = 13.6 * 10 kg/m ) Q.12(a)A spherical tank of
1.2m radius is half filled with oil of relative density 0.8 . Ifthe tank is giv
en a h orizontal acceleration of 10 m/s . Calculate the inclination ofthe oil su
rface t o horizontal and maximum pressure on the tank. (b) The volume of an air
bubble i s doubled as it rises from the bottom of a lake to its surface. If the
atmospher ic pressure is H m ofmercury & the density of mercury is n times that
of lake wa ter. Find the depth of the lake. Q.13 A test tube of thin walls has s
ome lead sh ots in it at its bottom and the system floats vertically in water, s
inking by a length 1= 10cm. A liquid of density less than that of water, is pour
ed into the tube till the levels inside and outside the tube are even. If the tu
be now sinks to a length / =40cm, the specific gravity ofthe liquid is . Kerosen
e W 2 2 2 2 -3 3 mg 3 3 A 2 o s=0.8 Q.14 For the arrangement shown in thefiguret
he value ofh ifthe pressure differen ce between the vessel Aand B is 3 kN/m is 2
Q.15 An open cubical tank completelyfilledwith water is kept on a horizontal su
r face. Its acceleration is then slowly increased to 2m/s as shown in the Fig. T
he side of the tank is lm. Find the mass ofwater that would spill out ofthe tank
. 2 1m 2m/s 2 lm Q.16 In air an object weighs 15N, when immersed completely in wa
ter the same object weighs 12N. When immersed in another liquid completely, it w
eighs 13N. Fi nd (a) the specific gravity of the obj ect and (b) the specific gr
avity ofthe ot her liquid. Q.17 Compute the work which must be performed to slow
ly pump the wat er put of a hemispherical reservoir of radius R - 0.6 m. Q.18 Bl
ock Ainfigurehan gs by a cord from spring balance D and is submerged in a liquid
C contained in a
beaker B. The mass of the beaker is 1 kg & the mass of theliquidis 1.5kg. The b
alance Dreads 2.5 kg & balance E reads 7.5kg.. The volume ofblock Ais 0.003 m .
(i) What is the density ofblock & the liquid, (ii) What will each balance read i
fblock is pulled out of the liquid. 3 Q.19 A solid cube, with faces either vert
ical or horizontal, isfloatingin a liqu id of density 6 g/cc. It has two third o
fits volume submerged. If enough water i s addedfromthe top so as to completely
cover the cube, whatfractionof its volume will remain immersed inthe liquid? foB
ansalClasses Fluid Mechanics [10]
Q.20 A ball is given velocity v (greater than the terminal velocity v ) in downw
ard direction inside a highly viscous liquid placed inside a large container. T
h e height ofliquid in the container is H. The ball attains the terminal velocit
y just before striking at the bottom of the container. Draw graph between veloci
ty ofthe ball and distance moved by the ball before getting terminal velocity. 0
T 2 2 XT Q.21 Two arms of a U-tube have unequal diameters d, = 1.0 mm and d = 1
.0 cm. Ifw ater (surface tension 7 x 10~ N/m) is poured into the tube held in th
e vertical position,findthe difference of level ofwater in the U-tube. Assume th
e angle ofc ontact to be zero. Q.22 A spherical ball of radius 1 x 10" m and den
sity 10 kg/m falls freely under gravity through a distance h before entering a t
ank of water . If after entering the water the velocity of the ball does not cha
nge, find h. The viscosity of water is 9.8 x 10 N-s/m . 4 4 3 -6 2 Q. 23 Calcula
te the rate of flow of glycerine of density 1.25 x 10 kg/m through the conical s
ection of a pipe if the radii of its ends are 0. lm & 0.04m and the pressure dro
p across its length is 10N/m . 3 3 2 Q. 24 The tank infigdischarges water at con
stant rate for all water levels above the air inlet R. The height above datum to
which water would rise in the manome ter tubes M and N respectively are & Q.25
A uniform cylindrical block of length / density d, and area of cross section A f
loats in a liquid of density d contain ed in a vessel (d >d ). The bottom of the
cylinder just rests on a spring of con stant k. The other end ofthe spring is f
ixed to the bottom ofthe vessel. The wei ght that may be placed on top ofthe cyl
inder such that the cylinder is just subm erged in the liquid is 2 2 1 Open io a
tmosphere 40cm 20cm 11 Q.26 Find the speed ofrotation of 1 m diameter tank, init
ially full ofwater such that water surface makes an angle of 45 with the horizont
al at a radius of 30 cm . What is the slope ofthe surface at the wall ofthe tank
. Q. 27 A vertical unifo rm U tube open at both ends contains mercury. Water is
poured in one limb until the level of mercury is depressed 2cm in that limb. Wha
t is the length ofwater c olumn when this happens. Q. 28 Apiece of copper having
an internal cavity weigh 264gm in air and 22 lgm in water. Find the volume of c
avity. Density of copper i s 8.8 gm/cc. Q.29 A vessel contains oil density = 0.
8gm/cm . A homogeneous sphe re floats with halfits volume immersed in mercury an
d the other half in oil. The density ofthe material ofthe sphere in gm/cm is Q.3
0 An expansible balloon fill ed with air floats on the surface of a lake with 2/
3 of its volume submerged. Ho w deep must it be sunk in the water so that it is
just in equilibrium neither si nking further nor rising ? It is assumed that the
temperature of the water is co nstant & that the height of the water barometer
is 9 meters. 3 3 fo Bansal Classes Fluid Mechanics [10]
EXERCISE # II Q.l Q.2 (a) (b) (c) Q.3 A solid block ofvolume V=10~ m and density
d=800kg/m is tied to one end of a str ing, the other end ofwhich istiedto the b
ottom ofthe vessel. The vessel contains 2 immiscible liquids of densities p.^l 0
00kg/ m and p =15 00kg/m . The solid bl ock is immersed with 2/5 th of its volum
e in the liquid of higher density & 3/5t h in the liquid of lower density. The v
essel is placed in an elevator which is m oving up with an acceleration of a=g/2
shown in the figure. A s mall hole having area a = 5 cm is made in right vertic
al wall at a height y=20cm from the bottom. Calculate h F* C velocity of efflux.
O horizontal force F to ke ep the cylinder in static equilibrium, ifit is placed
on a smooth horizontal pla ne, value of (iii) minimum and maximumm = 0.01.F to
keep the cylinder at rest. T he coefficient of friction between cylinder and the
plane is velocity of the top most layer ofthe liquid column and also the veloci
ty ofthe boundary separating the (iv) two liquids. base S 4000 Q.16 A cylindrica
l wooden float whosewood area 0,8=gf/cm cm & the altitude H = 50 cm drifts on th
e water surface. Specific weig ht of d= . (a) What work must be performed to tak
e the float out of the water ? (b) Compute the work to be performed to submerge
completely the float into the w ater. Q.17 A10cm side cube weighing 5N is immers
ed in a liquid ofrelative densit y 0.8 contained in a rectangular tank of cross
sectional area 15cmx 15cm. If the tank contained liquid to a height of 8cm befor
e the immersion, determine the le vels of the bottom of the cube and the liquid
surface. 2 2 3 fo Bansal Classes Fluid Mechanics [10]
Q.18 A jug contains 15 glasses of orange juice. When you open the tap at the bot
tom it takes 12sectofilla glass with juice. If you leave the tap open, how long
will it take tofillthe remaining 14 glasses and thus empty the jug? Q.19 An int
e rstellar explorer discovers a remarkable planet made entirely of a uniform inc
om pressiblefluidon density p. The radius ofthe planet is R and the acceleration
of gravity at its surface is g. What is the pressure at the center of the plane
t. Q.20 A cylindrical rod oflength I=2m & density floatsvertically in a liquid B
of density p as shown in Fig (a). A (a) Show that it performs SHM when pulled sl
igh tly up & released & (b) (a) find its time period. Neglect change in liquid l
evel . (b) Find the time taken by the rod to completely immerse when releasedfro
mposi tion shown in (b). Assume that it remains vertical throughout its motion,
(take g = % m/s ) 2 2 Q.21 A uniform cylinder of a light material of length /=0.
8m and radius of cross section r = 0.01 m floats on a liquid of specific density
p = 0.9 upto half its length. The container of the liquid is a long cylindrical
beaker of radius R = 0.04m. Another perfectly immiscible liquid of specific den
sity o = 0.6 is now sl owly poured all along the inner periphery of the beaker a
t a uniform rate of v = 0.25x 10 m /s and it spreads itself uniformly over the f
irst liquid. Find the v elocity with which the cylinder will rise or sink in the
liquid. 4 3 Q.22 Auniform rod of length b capable oftuning about its end which
is out ofwate r, rests inclined to the vertical. Ifits specific gravity is 5/9,f
indthe length immersed in water. Q.23 An open cylindrical vessel of large crosssection A cont ains liquid upto a height H = 120cm. After an orifice of area A/1
000 at a height ofh = 20cm is opened. (a) Calculate liquid heights above orifice
for which it f alls on both ends of H horizontal plate. (b) How long will the l
iquid be falling on the plate. Given: plate AB is of length 60cm. (g = 10m/s ) 2
2 T 20cm A B Q.24 A cylindrical vessel ofheightH = 4m&area of cross section 1 m
filled with w ater rests on a stand of same height H. It has a small plugged ho
le near its bot tom. When plug is removed the liquid starts to come out. (a) Fin
d the range ofth e liquid as a function ofinstantaneous height ofthe liquid in t
he upper vessel ( b) Find the volume of liquid collected in a large initially em
pty vessel lying o n floor at a distance Hfromthe stand. Assume that water falli
ng on to thefloordo es notflowinto the vessel. Q.25 A cube with a mass'm' comple
tely wettable by wat er floats on the surface of water. Each side of the cube is
'a'. What is the dis tance h between the lower face of cube and the surface of
the water if surface t ension is S. Take density ofwater as p Take angle of cont
act in zero. ZZ3 fo Bansal Classes Fluid Mechanics [10]
EXERCISE # III Q.l A horizontal pipe line carries water in a streamline flow. At
a point along the pipe where the cross-sectional area is 10 cm , the water velo
city is 1 ms" & the pressure is 2000 Pa. The pressure of water at another point
where the cross sectional area is 5 cm , is pa. [ Density ofwater = 10 kg. mr ]
[ JEE '94,2 ] 2 1 2 3 3 Q.2 A container oflarge uniform cross-sectional area A r
esting on a horizontal surfa ce, holds two immiscible, non-viscous & incompressi
ble liquids of densities d & 2d, each of height as shown in figure. The lower de
nsity liquid is open to the a tmosphere having pressure P . 0 (a) A homogeneous
solid cylinder oflength L fI < ) cross-sectional area A,is immerse d such that i
t floats with its axis vertical at the liquid-liquid 5 (i) 00 (b) CO (ii) (iii)
Q.3 (0 (ii) (iii) Q.4 interface with the length in the denser liquid. Determine:
The density D ofthe s olid & The total pressure at the bottom of the container.
The cylinder is remove d and the original arrangement is restored. A tiny hole
of area s (s A) is punch ed on the vertical side of the container at a height h
j^fc < -^J . Determine Th e initial speed of efflux of the liquid at the hole ;
The horizontal distance x travelled by the liquid initially & The height h at wh
ich the hold should be pun ched so that the liquid travels the maximum distance
x initially. Also calculate x . [Neglect the air resistance in these calculation
s]. [JEE '95,10] m m m Q.5 (0 (ii) A cylindrical tank 1 m in radius rests on a p
latform 5 m high. Initially the tan k isfilledwith water to a height of 5m. A pl
ug whose area is 1CT m is removed fr om an orifice on the side ofthe tank at the
bottom. Calculate the following: ini tial speed with which the water flows from
the orifice ; initial speed with whic h the water strikes the ground & time tak
en to empty the tank to halfits origina l value. [ REE '95,5] A thin rod of leng
th L & area of cross-section S is pivote d at its lowest point P inside a statio
nary, homogeneous & non-viscous liquid (F igure). The rod is free to rotate in a
vertical plane about a horizontal axis pa ssing through P. The density d, of th
e material of the rod is smaller than the e ntity d ofthe liquid. The rod is dis
placed by a small angle 9 from its equilibri um position and then released. Show
that the motion of the rod is simple harmoni c and determine its angular freque
ncy in terms ofthe given parameters. [ JEE '96 , 5 ] A large open top container
of negligible mass & uniform cross-sectional ar ea A has a small hole of cross-s
ectional area A/100 in its side wall near the bo ttom. The container is kept on
a smooth horizontal floor and contains a liquid o f density p and mass m.. Assum
ing that the liquid starts flowing out horizontall y through the hole at t = 0,
calculate the acceleration ofthe container and its velocity when 75 % ofthe liqu
id has drained out. [ JEE 97 , 5 ] 4 2 2 ^Bansal Classes Fluid Mechanics [12]
Q.6 A nonviscous liquid of constant density 1000 kg/m flows in a streamline moti
on a long a tube of variable cross section. The tube is kept inclined in the ver
tical plane as shown in the figure. The area of cross section of the tube at two
poin ts P and Q at heights of 2 meters and 5 meters are respectively 4 x 10 m a
nd 8 x 10~ m . The velocity ofthe liquid at point P is 1 m/s. Find the work done
per u nit volume by the pressure and the gravity forces as the fluid flows from
point P to Q. [ JEE '97] 3 3 2 3 3 Q. 7 Water from a tap emerges vertically dow
nwards with an initial speed of 1.0 ms" . The cross-sectional area of the tap is
10~ m . Assume that the pressure is cons tant throughout the stream ofwater, an
d that the flow is steady. The cross-secti onal area of the stream 0.15m below t
he tap is [ JEE '98, 2 ] (B) 1.0 xlO" m (C) 5.0 x 10" m (D) 2.0 x l0" m (A) 5.0
x 10~ m 1 4 2 4 2 5 2 5 2 5 2 Q.8 Q.9 A wooden stick of length 1, and radius R a
nd density p has a small metal piece o f mass m (of negligible volume) attached
to its one end. Find the minimum value for the mass m (in terms of given paramet
ers) that would make the stick float ve rtically in equilibrium in a liquid of d
ensity a (>p). [ JEE '99,10] A large ope n tank has two holes in the wall. One i
s a square hole of side L at a depth yfro mthe top and the other is a circular h
ole of radius R at a depth 4yfromthe top. When the tank is completely filled wit
h water, the quantities ofwater flowing ou t per secondfromboth holes are the sa
me. Then, R is equal to: (A) (B) 2nL (C)L (D) 2it [JEE 2000 (Scr.)] Q.10 A hemis
pherical portion of radius R is removed from the b ottom of a cylinder of radius
R. The volume ofthe remaining cylinder is V and it s mass is M. It is suspended
by a string in a liquid of density p where it stays vertical. The upper surface
of the cylinder is at a depth h below the liquid su rface. The force on the bot
tom of the cylinder by the liquid is [JEE 2001 (Scr.) ] (A)Mg (B)Mg-vpg (C) Mg +
tz R h p g 2 (D) pg (V + 7iR h) 2 Q.ll A wooden block, with a coin placed on it
s top, floats in water as shown in figure. The distances I and h are shown there
. After some time the coin falls in to the water. Then [JEE 2002 (Scr.)] (A) / d
ecreases and h increases (B) I incre ases and h decreases (C) both I and h incre
ase (D) both / and h decrease 3 yCoin Q.12 Auniform solid cylinder of density 0.
8 gm/cm floats in equilibrium in a com bination of two non mixing liquids A and
b with its axis vertical. The densities
ofthe liquids A and B are 0.7 gm/cm and 1.2 g/cm , respectively. The height of l
iquid Ais h = 1.2 cm. The length ofthe part of the cylinder immersed in liquid B
is h^ = 0.8 cm. (a) Find the toal force exerted by liquid Aon the cylinder. (b
) Find h, the length ofthe part of the cylinder in air. (c) The cylinder is depr
essed in such a way that its top surface is just below the upper surface ofliqu
i d A and is then released. Find the acceleration of the cylinder immediately af
te r it is released. [JEE 2002] 3 3 A fo Bansal Classes Fluid Mechanics [10]
Q.13 Consider a horizontally oriented syringe containing water located at a heig
ht of 1.25 m above the ground. The diameter ofthe plunger is 8 mm and the diame
t er of the nozzle is 2 mm. The plunger is pushed with a constant speed of 0.25
m/ s. Find the horizontal range of water stream on the ground. Take g = 10 m/s2.
[J EE 2004] D=8MM ^ IP d=2mm 1.25m A\\m\\Tu\\\\\u\\u\\\u'\ Q.14 A solid sphere o
f radius R is floating in a liquid of density p with half o f its volume submerg
ed. If the sphere is slightly pushed and released, it starts performing simple h
armonic motion. Find thefrequencyof these oscillations. [JEE 2004] Q.15 Water is
filledin a container upto height 3m. A small hole of area 'a ' is punched in the
wall ofthe container a at a height 52.5 cmfromthe bottom. Th e cross sectional
area ofthe container is A. If =0.1 then v is (where v is the v elocity ofwater c
oming out ofthe hole) (D) 51.5 (A) 48 (B) 51 (C) 50 [JEE to2005 (Scr)] z Q.16 A
U tube is rotated about one of it's limbs with an angular velocity a. Fin d the
difference in height H of the liquid (density p) level, where diameter oft he tu
be d L. [JEE 2005] . a fo Bansal Classes Fluid Mechanics [10]
ANSWER KEY EXERCISE # I Q Q.l Q.4 Q.7 Q.9 Q.ll 45,9600V2 (gauge)N/m 19.6 m, 4 sec
hj = 3 hj 375 24 15.6cm 2 , 2 2m 11 Q.5 Q.8 3 2.79 gm/cc 37.5 N 3 Q.6 at the wa
ter surface, h/2 Q.10 V3:V2 (a) 6^2 m/s, (b)9.6V2 xlQ- M /sec, (c) 4.6 x 10 N/m
4 2 Q.12 (a)9600 ^ , (b) nH Q.13 0.75 Q.14 -0.5m2.5 m Q.16 (a) 5, (b) 2/3 Q.17 10
1.8 Kgf-m Q.15 100kg 3 5000 Q.18 (i) 2500 kg/m , kg/m , (ii) \ = 7.5 kg, f ^ = 2.
5 kg 3 Q.19 3/5 Q.23 6.43 x 10^m /s 3 Q.20 | Dist. moved H Q.21 2.5 cm Q.22 20.4
m + Ag Q.24 20cm, 60cm Q.27 54.4 cm Q.25
(d -d ) 2 x V2 d Q.26 co= 3 1 0 5 rad/s, t a n a = Q.28 13cc Q.29 7.2gm/cm Q.30 4
.5m EXERCISE # II Q.l Q 3 6N 2(3 + 7t) li^ 0 2 2 6 3 + 71 -^"!^" 0 Q.2 4m/s , 10%,
0, 45kPa 2 1 9 5 Q 4 x = 1 / 3 Q.5 y-x+z Q.6 Q.7 Q.9 W P 7th gtana(R-|htana) (M
-m)gx (a) M + m j g - (M + m)L ^ v 7C L 2]l g M - m j v Q.8 18g 19a 80 % rrr Q.1
0 h ^ h j
Q.ll 80V5 sec, 40V5 sec Classes Fluid Mechanics [15]
Q.12 (a)33.2s,(b) 64.6 s Q.13 y = 4xl0~ x Q.14 431 sec 3 4 Q.15 (i) 4m/s, (ii) F
= 7.2N, (iii) F = 0, F = 52.2 N, (iv) both 4 x 10~ m/s mm max 3 Q16 (a) dHS 2 2
= 32 K g f - m , (b) - S H ( 1 - d) = 2 2 2 v, Kgf-m Q17 163 388 Q-" " ^ T J T
a 12Vl4 Q 1 9 pgR 2 Q.20 2 sec., 1 sec Q.21 1/90TC Q.22 b/3 3 Q.23 (a) 80cm, 5cm
; (b) 300sec. Q.24 2VhH, 3m Q.25 h= mg + 4sa Pw^ EXERCISE # III Q.l 500 Pa 5 1 /
3 Q.2 (a)(i) P = - d, (ii) p=P + - (6H+L)dg ; (b)(i) v = J % H - 4 h ) , (ii) =
Vh(3H-4h) (iii) x = 7 H 0 x
Q.3 (i) 10 m/s, (ii) 14.1 m/s, (iii) 2.5 hr m 0 fd2~dl^ 2L I dl J 3 3 Q.5 (i) 0.
2 m/s , (ii) Q.6 + 29625 J/m , - 30000 J/m Q.7 C Q.8 m = 7ir l (^pc p); if tilte
d then it's axis should become vertical. C.M. should be lower than c entre of bo
uyancy. Q.9 A Q.10 D Q.ll D Q.12 (a) 0, (b) h = 0.25 cm, (c) a= g/6 ( upward) 2
min 2 Q.13 x = 2m * 1 [37 Q.14 ^ = Q.15 C 271 V 2R L Q.16H= 2g 2 2 fo Bansal Clas
ses Fluid Mechanics [10]
BANSAL CLASSES TARGET IIT JEE 2007 XI (PQRS & J) WESTIMMM. QR FL UID MECHANICS T
ime Limit: 2 Sitting Each of 90 minutes, duration approx.
Q. 1 There are 58 questions in this question bank. QUESTION BANK ON FLUID MECHAN
ICS Q2 Two cubes of size 1.0m sides, one of relative density 0.60 and another of
relati ve density = 1.15 are connected by weightless wire and placed in a large
tank of water. Under equilibrium the lighter cube will project above the water
surface t o a height of (A) 50 cm (B) 25 cm (C)10cm (D) zero A rectangular tank
is placed on a horizontal ground and is filled with water to a height H above th
e base. A small hole is made on one vertical side at a depth D below the level o
f the wate r in the tank. The distance xfromthe bottom ofthe tank at which the w
ater jetfro mthe tank will hit the ground is (A) 2VD(H-D) (B) 2 VDH (C) 2VD(H7D)
2 -1 (D) | VDH Q.3 Q4 Q.5 Abeaker isfilledin with water is accelerated a m/s in
+x direction. The surface o fwater shall make on angle (A) tan (a/g) backwards (
B) tan (a/g) forwards (C) co t (g/a) backwards (D) cot (g/a) forwards A jet ofwa
ter with cross section of 6 c m strikes a wall at an angle of 60 to the normal an
d rebounds elastically from th e wall without losing energy. If the velocity of
the water in the jet is 12 m/s, the force acting on the wall is (A) 0.864 Nt (B)
86.4 Nt (C)72Nt (D)7.2Nt The v ertical limbs of a U shaped tube arefilledwith a
liquid of density p upto a heig ht h on each side. The horizontal portion ofthe
U tube having length 2h contains a liquid of density 2p. The U tube is moved ho
rizontally with an accelerator g/ 2 parallel to the horizontal arm. The differen
ce in heights in liquid levels in the two vertical limbs, at steady state will b
e 2h 8h 4h (D) None of these (A) ( B) ( Q T -1 -1 -1 2 Q.6 The cross sectional a
rea of a horizontal tube increases along its length linearl y, as we move in the
direction of flow. The variation of pressure, as we move al ong its length in t
he direction offlow (x-direction), is best depicted by which ofthe following gra
phs (A) (B) 2 (C) 2 (D) 2 Q.7 A cylindrical tank of height 1 m and cross section
area A= 4000 cm is initially empty when it is kept under a tap of cross section
al area 1 cm . Water starts fl owing from the tap at t = 0, with a speed = 2 m/s
. There is a small hole in the
base of the tank of cross-sectional area 0.5 cm . The variation of height of wat
er in tank (in meters) with time t is best depicted by (A) (B) (C) Q.8 A bucket
contains waterfilledupto a height = 15 cm. The bucket is tied to a rope which i
s passed over africtionlesslight pulley and the other end ofthe rope is tied to
a weight of mass which is half ofthat of the (bucket+water). The water p ressure
above atmosphere pressure at the bottom is (A) 0.5 kPa (B)lkPa (C) 5 kPa (D) No
ne of these % Bansal Classes Question Bank on Fluid Mechanics [2]
Q.9 A cubical box ofwine has a small spout located in one ofthe bottom corners.
When the box is full and placed on a level surface, opening the spout results in
a f low of wine with a initial speed of v (see figure). When the box is half em
pty, someone tilts it at 45 so that the spout is at the lowest point (see figure)
. Whe n the spout is opened the wine willflowout with a speed of .(A) v (B)V /2 '
(Qvo/ V2 (D) v M Q.10 A cone ofradius R and height H, is hanging inside a liqui
d of de nsity p by means of a string as shown in thefigure.The force, due to the
liquid acting on the slant surface ofthe cone is , 0 0 mn 0 0 (A) prtgHR 2 (B)
rcpHR 2 (C) ~ 7tpgHR 2 7TT77T7T77T7 TT (D) -TipgHR 2 Q.ll A cuboidal piece ofwoo
d has dimensions a, b and c. Its relative density is d. It isfloatingin a large
body of water such that side a is vertical. It is pus hed down a bit and release
d. The time period of SHM executed by it is : [be ( D ) 27T (C) 2tc (B) 2ti ^ da
\'dg Q.12 Water is flowing steadily through a horizon tal tube ofnonuniform cro
ss-section. If the pressure ofwater is 4 x 10 N/m at a point where cross-section
is 0.02 m and velocity of flow is 2 m/s, what is press ure at apoint where cros
s-section reduces to 0.01 m . (A) 1.4 x 10 N/m (B) 3,4 x 10 N/m (C) 2.4 x 10" N/
m (D)noneofthese Q.13 A vertical cylindrical container o f base area Aand upper
cross-section A, area Aj making an angle 30 with the. hori zontal is placed in an
open rainy field as shown near another cylindrical contai ner having same base
area A. The ratio of rates of collection ofwater inthe two containers A iimvnrfT
ii riffTTTrrTfnTr will be (D) None (A) 2/73 (B) 4/V3 (C)2 Q .14 The area of cros
s-section of the wider tube shown in figure is 121cg 800 cm . If a mass of 12 kg
is placed on the massless piston, the difference in heights h in the level ofwa
ter in the two tubes is : (A) 10 cm (B) 6 cm (C) 15 cm (D)2c m Q.15 A slender ho
mogeneous rod of length 2L floats partly immersed in water, b eing supported by
a string fastened to one ofits ends, as shown. The specific gr avity of the rod
is 0.75. The length of rod that extends out ofwater is : i 4 2 2 2 4 2 4 2 4 2 2
(A)L (B)-L (D) 3 (Q 4 L is accelerating upward on a as shown. Then the ) tan" (
B) tan -l gcosa (l-cosa) 1 Q.16 Afluidcontainer is containing a liquid of densit
y p with acceleration a along the inclined place ofinclinati angle of inclinatio
n 9 offree surface is: a + g sin a (A gcosa a-gsma (D) tan" a - g sin a (C) tan"
g(l + cosa) g
L % Bansal Classes Question Bank on Fluid Mechanics [3]
Q.17 A dumbbell is placed in water of density p. It is observed that by attachin
g a mass m to the rod, the dumbbell floats with the rod horizontal on the surfa
c e of water and each sphere exactly half submerged as shown in the figure. The
vo lume of the mass m is negligible. The value of length I is d(V -3M) d(V -2M)
(B) 2(V 3M) ( ) 2(V -2M) d(V -2M) d(V + 2M) (D) 2(V +3M) ( ) 2(V - 3M) p p A p P
p p C p P Q.18 Figure shows a three arm tube in which a liquid is filled upto l
evels of he ight I. It is now rotated at an angular frequency co about an axis p
assing throu gh arm B. The angular frequency co at which level of liquid in arm
B becomes zer o. (B) (C) (D) 3 Q.19 Two bodies having volumes Y and 2V are suspe
nded from the two arms of a com mon balance and they are found to balance each o
ther. If larger body is immersed in oil (density dj = 0.9 gm/cm ) and the smalle
r body is immersed in an unknown liquid, then the balance remain in equilibrium.
The density of unknown liquid i s given by: (A) 2.4 gm/cm (B) 1.8 gm/cm (C) 0.4
5 gm/cm (D) 2.7 gm/cm Q.20 A tube is attached as shown in closed vessel containi
ng water. The velocity of water c oming out from a small hole is : 20cm (A) ^ m/
s (B)2m/s (C) depends on pressure of air inside vessel (D) None ofthese Q.21 Ala
rge tank is filled with water to a height H. Asmall hole is made at the base oft
he tank. It takes Tj time to decre ase the height of water to H/r|, (r| > 1) and
it takes T time to take out the re st of water. If Tj = T , then the value ofr\
is : (A) 2 (B) 3 (C)4 (D) V2 i Q.22 A container oflarge surface arpa isfilledwi
th liquid of density p. Acubical blo ck of side edge a and m iss M is floating i
n it with four-fifth of its volume su bmerged. If a coin ofmass m is placed gent
ly on the top surface ofthe block is j ust submerged. M is (A) 4m/5 (B)m/5 (C)4m
(D)5m Q.23 The weight of an empty ball oon on a spring balance is Wj. The weigh
t becomes w when the balloon is filled w ith air. Let the weight ofthe air itsel
fbe w .Neglect the thickness ofthe balloo n when it isfilledwith air. Also negle
ct the difference in the densities of air inside & outside the balloon. Then: (A
) w w. (B) w Wj + w (C) w < Wj + w (D) w > Wj Q.24 In the case ofa fluid, Bernou
lli's theorem expresses the application of the principle of conservation of : (A
) linear momentum (B) energy (C)mass (D) an gular momentum Q.25 Fountains usuall
y seen in gardens are generated by a wide pi pe with an enclosure at one end hav
ing many small holes. Consider one such fount
ain which is produced by a pipe of internal diameter 2 cm in which waterflowsat
a rate 3 ms~ . The enclosure has 100 holes each of diameter 0.05 cm. The velocit
y ofwater coming out ofthe holes ids (in ms ): (A) 0.48 (B) 96 (C) 24 (D)48 3 3
3 3 2 2 2 2 2 : 2 : 2 2 ! -1 % Bansal Classes Question Bank on Fluid Mechanics
[4]
Q.26 Water flows through afiictionlessduct with a cross-section varying as shown
in figure. Pressure p at points along the axis is represented by (A) (B) (C) (D
) Q.27 A boy carries a fish in one hand and a bucket(not full) of water in the o
th er hand . If he places the fish in the bucket, the weight now carried by him
(as sume that water does not spill) : (A) is less than before (B) is more than b
efor e (C) is the same as before (D) depends upon his speed Q.28 A cubical block
ofwo od ofedge 10cmandmass0.92kgfloatsonatankofwaterwithoilofrel. density0.6 to
a dep th of 4cm above water. When the block attains equilibrium with four ofits
sides edges vertical (A) 1 cm of it will be above the free surface of oil. (B)
5cm of it will be under water. (C) 2cm ofit will be above the common surface of
oil and water. (D) 8cm of it will be under water. Q. 29 The spring balance Aread
s 2 kg with a block m suspended from it. A balance B reads 5 kg when a beaker wi
th liqu id is put on the pan ofthe balance. The two balances are now so arranged
that th e hanging mass is inside the liquid in the beaker as shown in thefigure
in this s ituation: (A) the balance A will read more than 2 kg (B) the balance B
will read more than 5 .kg (C) the balance A will read less than 2 kg and B will
read more than 5 kg (D) the balances A and B will read 2 kg and 5 kg respective
ly. Q.30 A n open cubical tank was initially fullyfilledwith water. When the tan
k was accel erated on a horizontal plane along one ofits side it was found that
one third of volume ofwater spilled out. The acceleration was (A) g/3 (B) 2g/3 (
C) 3g/2 (D)No ne Q.31 Acork of density 0.5gcm floats on a calm swimming pool. Th
e fraction oft he cork's volume which is under water is (A) 0% (B) 25% (C)10% (D
) 50% Q.32 A cy lindrical vesselfilledwith water upto the height H becomes empty
in time t due t o a small hole at the bottom of the vessel. Ifwater isfilledto
a height 4H it wi llflowout in time (A) to (B)4t (C)8t (D)2t Q.33 Acylindrical v
essel open at the top is 20cm high and 1 Ocmin diameter. A circular hole whose c
ross-sectional are a 1 cm is cut at the centre ofthe bottom ofthe vessel. Waterf
lowsfroma tube abov e it into the vessel at the rate 100 cm s"'. The height ofwa
ter in the vessel un der steady state is (Take g=1000 cms ) (A) 20 cm (B) 15 cm
(C)10cm (D) 5 cm -3 0 0 0 0 2 3 -2 Q.34 A fire hydrant delivers water of density
p at a volume rate L. The water tr avels /- vertically upward through the hydran
t and then does 90 turn to emerge hor izontally at speed V. The pipe and nozzle h
ave uniform crosssection throughout. The force exerted by the water on the corne
r ofthe hydrant is (A)pVL (B) zero (C )2pVL (D)V2 VL P v % Bansal Classes Questi
on Bank on Fluid Mechanics [5]
Q.35 Avertical tank, open at the top, isfilledwith a liquid and rests on a smoot
h horizontal surface. A small hole is opened at the centre of one side ofthe ta
n k. The area of cross-section ofthe tank is N times the area of the hole, where
N is a large number. Neglect mass ofthe tank itself. The initial acceleration o
ft he tank is Q.36 A body of density p' is droppedfromrest at a height h into a
lak e of density p, where p > p'. Neglecting all dissipative forces, calculate t
he m aximum depth to which the body sinks before returning to float on the surfa
ce. ( A) A (B, V (C) J ^ P-P p P-P P-P Q.37 A Newtonianfluidfillsthe clearance b
etween a shaft and a sleeve. When aforce of800N is applied to the shaft, paralle
l to t he sleev,e, the shaft attains a speed of 1.5 cm/sec. If a force of 2.4 kN
is app lied instead, the shaft would move with a speed of (A) 1.5 cm/sec (B) 13
.5 cm/se c (C) 4.5 cm/sec (D) None Q.38 A solid metallic sphere ofradius r is al
lowed to fallfreelythrough air. Ifthefrictionalresistance due to air is proporti
onal to t he cross-sectional area and to the square of the velocity, then the te
rminal vel ocity of the sphere is proportional to which of the following? (A) r
(B)r (C)r ( D)r Q.39 Two water pipes P and Q having diameters 2 x 10" m and 4x10
" m, respect ively, are j oined in series with the main supply line ofwater. The
velocity ofw aterflowingin pipe P is (A) 4 times that of Q (B) 2 times that of
Q (C) 1/2 time s of that of Q (D) 1/4 times that of Q Q. 40 Waterflowsinto a cyl
indrical vessel oflarge cross-sectional area at a rate of 10~ m /s. Itflowsoutfr
oma hole of are a 10^ m , which has been punched through the base. How high does
the water rise in the vessel? (A) 0.075 m (B) 0.051m (C) 0.031m (D) 0.025 m Q.4
1 Two cyllinders of same cross-section and length L but made of two materi al of
densities d j a nd d are cemented together to form a cylinder oflength 2L, The
combinationfloats in a liquid of density d with a length L/2 above the surface o
f the liquid. If d j > d then: ( D ) 2 3/2 1/2 2 2 4 3 2 2 2 (A) dj > d (B)|>d 1
(C) - > d , 4 (D) d < d j Q.42 There is a horizontalfilmof soap solution. On it
a thread is placed in the form of a loop. Thefilmis pierced inside the loop and
the thread becomes a circu lar loop of radius R. If the surface tension of the
loop be T, then what will be the tension in the thread? (A) 7cR /T (b) TIR T (C)
2TTRT (D)2RT Q.43 S ome liq uid isfilledin a cylindrical vessel ofradius R. Let
F j be the force applied by the liquid on the bottom ofthe cylinder. Now the sa
me liquid is poured into a ve ssel ofuniform square crss-section of side R. Let
F be the force applied by the liquid on the bottom of this new vessel. Then. 2 2
2 (A) Fj = 7tF. (6) ^ = 571" '' (C) F, = VttF (D)F,=F Q. 44 A tank isfilledup t
o a height 2H with a liquid and is placedon a platform ofheight Hfromthe ground.
Th e distance xfromthe ground where a small hole is punched to get the maximum
rang e R is: (A)H (B) 1.25 H (C) 1.5 H (D)2H 2 2
2 % Bansal Classes Question Bank on Fluid Mechanics [6]
Q.45 Acontainer, whose bottom has round holes with diameter 0.1 mm isfilledwith
water. Themaximum height in cm upto which water can befilledwithout leakage will
be what? Surface tension = 75 x 10 N/m and g = 10 m/s : (A) 20 cm (B) 40 cm (C)
30cm (D)60cm Q.46 In a cylindrical vessel containing liquid of density p, there
are two holes in the side walls at heights ofhj and h respectively such that th
e range of efflux at the bottom ofthe vessel is same. The height of a hole, for
w hich the range of efflux would be maximum, will be ( B ^ + hj (A) - hj h -h, (
C) (D) h +hj 3 2 2 0 2 Q.47 Apiece of steel has a weight Win air, Wj when comple
tely immersed in water and W when completely immersed in an unknown liquid. The
relative density (speci fic gravity)ofliquid is: W-W, w -w W, - w W-Wo (A) W - W
, (C) W-W, (D) w - w (B ) W -T , wW Q.48 Alarge tank isfilledwith water (densit
y = 10 kg/m ). Asmall hol e is made at 10m a depth 10 m below water surface. The
range ofwater issuing out ofthe hole is Ron ground. What extra pressure must be
applied on the water surf ace so that the range becomes 2R (take 1 atm = 10 Pa
and g = 10 m/s ): (A) 9 atm (B) 4 atm (C) 5 atm (D) 3 atm R Q.49 Two drops of sa
me radius are falling throu gh air with steady velocity of v cm/s. If the two dr
ops coalesce, what would be the terminal velocity? (A) 4 v (C)2v (D) 64 v (B) (4
) 1/3, Q.50 A ball ofrelativ e density 0.8 falls into waterfroma height of 2m. T
he depth to which the ball wi ll sink is (neglect viscous forces): (A) 8 m (B)2m
(C)6m (D)4m i Q.51 A liquid o f mass 1 kg isfilledin a flask as shown infigure.
The force exerted by the flask on the liquid is (g = 10 m/s ): (A) ION (B) great
er than ION (C) less than 1 ON (D)zero 2 2 ; 2 2 3 3 5 2 2 Q.52 Figure shows a s
iphon. Choose the wrong statement: (A) Siphon works when h > 0 (B) Pressure at p
oint 2 is P = P - pgh h=0 (C) Pressure at point 3 is P (D) None of the above X 1
(P = atmospheric pressure) Q.53 If two soap bubbles of diff erent radii are conn
ected by a tube, (A) air flowsfromthe bigger bubble to the s maller bubble till
the sizes become equal (B) air flowsfrombigger bubble to the smaller bubble till
the sizes are interchanged (C) airflowsfromthe smaller bubbl e to the bigger (D
) there is noflowof air. i 3 2 0 3 0 0 % Bansal Classes Question Bank on Fluid M
echanics m
Q.54 A cubical block of side 'a' and density 'p' slides over a fixed inclined pl
ane with constant velocity V . There is a thinfilmof viscousfluidofthickness't'
between the plane and the block. Then the coefficient ofviscosity ofthe thinfil
m will be \B=37 3pagt pagt 4pagt (D) none ofthese (A) 5v (C) v (B) 5v Q.55 Which
of the following graphs best represents the motion of a raindrop? (A) (B) 5 2 (C
) CD) Q.56 Two soap bubbles with radii r and (r > r ) come in contact. Their com
mon su rface has a radius of curvature r. r, + r, (C)r (D)r = ^ 7 (B)r = l 2 r,+
r <A)rV i ~h Q.57 A spherical ball of density p and radius 0.003m is dropped int
o a tu be containing a viscousfluidfilledup to the 0 cm mark as shown in the fig
ure. Vi scosity of 0 cm thefluid= 1.260 N.m' and its density p = p/2 = 1260 kg.nr
. Assum e the ball -10 cm reaches a terminal speed by the 10 cm mark. The time
taken by the ball to traverse the distance between the 10 cm and 20 cm mark is 20 cm (A) 500 ps (B) 50 ms (C)0.5s (D) 5 s (g = acceleration due to gravity = 10
ms ) Q.5 8 A sphere is dropped under gravity through afluidofviscosity r). Ifth
e average acceleration is half ofthe initial acceleration, the time to attain th
e terminal velocity is (p = density of sphere ; r = radius) 4pr 9pr 4pr 9pr (A)
9rj (B) 4r \ (C) 9rj (D) 4r| r r r 2 2 2 L 3 -2 Q.l Q.6 Q.ll Q.16 Q.21 Q.26 Q.31
Q.36 Q.41 Q.46 Q.51 Q.56 B A D B C A D C A D A B Q2 Q.7 Q.12 Q.17 Q.22 Q27 Q.32
Q.37 Q.42 Q.47 Q.52 Q.57 A C B B C C D C D B D D ANSWER KEY Q.3 Q.8 Q.13 Q.18 Q
.23 Q.28 Q.33 Q.38 Q.43 Q.48 Q.53 Q.58 AC B C C AC C,D D D D D C A Q.4 Q.9 Q.14
Q.19 Q.24 Q.29 Q.34 Q.39 Q.44 Q.49 Q.54 B D C B B B,C D A C B A Q.5 Q.10 Q.15 Q.
20 Q.25 Q.30 Q.35 Q.40 Q.45 Q.50 Q.55 B D A B D B C B C A C 4SBansal Classes Que
stion Bank on Fluid Mechanics [8]
XII (ALL) QIMIMMMMMM i GEOMETRICAL OPTICS
SHORT QUESTIONS Q.l Q.2 Q.3 The po sition ofthe optical axis N, N , the path of
ray AB incident upon a lens A. and the refracted ray BC are known (figure). Find
by construction the positio n of the main foci of the lens. N, 2 N, Point S' is
the image of a point source of light S in a spherical mirror whose o ptical axi
s is N N (figure). Find by construction the position of the centre of N, curvatu
re and its focus. } 2 2 S' N 2 The positions of optical axis N j N of a spherical
mirror, the source and the .B image are known (figure). Find by construction th
e positions ofthe centre ofthe .A curvature, its focus and the pole for the case
s: N, (b) B - source, A - imag e (a) A-source, B-image; The layered lens shown i
nfigureis made oftwo kinds ofgl ass. What image will be produced by this lens wi
th a point source arranged on th e optical axis? Disregard the reflection ofligh
t on the boundary between layers. A ray of light falls on a convex mirror, as sh
own infigure.Trace the path ofthe ray further. N, Q. 4 Q.5 Q.6 A double convex l
ens of focal length/lies between a source oflight and a screen. The distance bet
ween the source oflight and the screen is less than 4f. It is k nown that in the
se conditions it is not possible to obtain an image of the sourc e on the screen
, whatever the position ofthe lens. How can an image ofthe source be obtained on
the screen with quite simple means and without moving either len s or screen? I
nfigureis depicted the path of a ray oflight BC after refraction i n a double co
nvex lens L of principal focus F and of principal axis OO. Find by construction
the path of this ray before reaching the lens. Q.7 Q.8 Where should a point sour
ce oflight lie along the principal axis of a converging lens so that it is impos
sible to see the source and its image simultaneouslyfro many point? Q.9 A disk w
hose plane surface are parallel is cut as shown infigure (i), then the lenses so
obtained are moved apart. What will happen to a beam of parallel rays falling o
n to the resulting system: figure (iii) figure (ii) 8 (a) from the side ofthe co
nverging lens (figure ii), (b) form the side ofthe diverg ing lens (figure iii)?
Consider the cases when the distance between the lenses i s less than the focal
length and when it is greater than the focal length. Q.10 What will happen if a
plane mirror is placed in the path ofa converging beam ? Q
.ll Can a prism transmit rays at all angles of incidence? fl ure <!I Bansal Clas
ses Question Bank on Geometrical Optics [13]
Q.12 Why is it difficult to shoot afishswimming in water ? Q.13 A light ray pass
es through the interface between two transparent media. Under what condition wi
l l the angle of refraction be equal to the angle of incidence ? Q.14 In what ca
se will a bi-convex lens be diverging ? Q.15 Is the width ofa beam increased or
de creased in goingfromair to water? Q.16 Ordinary paper becomes transparent whe
n i t is oiled. Explain. Q.17 If there are scratches on the lens of a camera, th
ey d o not appear on a photograph taken with the camera. Explain. Do the scratch
es af fect the photograph at all? Q.18 Concave mirrors are used as shaving mirro
rs. Wh y? Should such mirrors have short or long focal lengths? Q.19 A sign pain
ted on a store window is reversed when viewedfrominside the store. If a person i
nside t he store views the reversed sign in a plane mirror, does the sign appear
as it w ould when viewed from outside the store? (Try it by writing some letter
s on a tr ansparent sheet of paper and then holding the back side ofthe paper up
to a mirr or.) Explain. Q.20 If you stand between two parallel plane mirrors, y
ou see an i nfinite number of images of yourself. This occurs because an image i
n one mirror is reflected in the other mirror to produce another image, which is
then re-ref lected, and so forth. The multiple images are equally spaced. Suppo
se that you a re facing a convex mirror, with a plane mirror behind you. Describ
e what you wou ld see and comment about the spacing between any multiple images.
Explain your r easoning. Q.21 In the figure, suppose that a layer of oil were a
dded on top of t he water. The angle 9 at which the incident light travels throu
gh the air remain s the same. Assuming that light still enters the water, does t
he angle of refrac tion at which it does so change because of the presence of th
e oil? Explain. { Q. 22 A beam ofblue light is propagating in glass. When the li
ght reaches the bo undary between the glass and the surrounding air, the beam is
totally reflected back into the glass. However, red light with the same angle o
fincidence is not t otally reflected, and some ofthe light is refracted into the
air. Why do these t wo colors behave differently? Q.23 To a swimmer under water
, objects look blurre d and out of focus. However, when the swimmer wears goggle
s that keep the water awayfromthe eyes, the objects appear sharp and in focus. W
hy do goggles improve a swimmer's underwater vision? <!I Bansal Classes Question
Bank on Geometrical Optics [13]
Q.l ONLY ONE OPTION IS Take approx. 2 minutes for answering each question. CORRE
CT. Q.2 Q.3 Q.4 Q.5 Q.6 Q.7 Q.8 A person runs with a speed u towards a bicycle m
oving away from him with speed v . The person approaches his image in the plane
mirror fixed at the rear of bicyc le with a speed of (A) u - v (B) u - 2v (C) 2u
- v (D)2(u-v) original emerging A beam oflight strikes one mirror of a right an
gle mirror assembly at an angle of light beam incidence 45 as shown in thefigure.
The right angle mirror assembly is rotated such that the angle of incidence beco
mes 60. Which ofthe following state ment is correct about the emerging light beam
. (A) It will move through an angle of 15 w.r.t. the original emerging beam. (B)
It will move through an angle of 30 w.r.t. the original emerging beam. (C) It wil
l move through an angle 45 w.r.t. th e original beam. (D) It will emerge parallel
to the original emerging beam. . Li Two mirrors labelled Lj for left mirror and
L for right mirror in the figure ar e parallel to each other and 3.0 m apart. A
person standing 1.0 mfromthe right mi rror (L ) looks into this mirror and sees
a series ofimages. The second nearest image seen in the right mirror is situated
at a distance: (A) 2.0 mfromthe perso n (B) 4.0 m from the person 2m Tm (C) 6.0
mfromthe per son (D) 8.0 m from the pe rson. The reflection surface of a plane
mirror is vertical. Aparticle is project ed in a vertical plane which is also pe
rpendicular to the mirror. The initial ve locity ofthe particle is 10 m/s and th
e angle ofprojection is 60. The point ofpro jection is at a distance 5 mfromthe m
irror. The particle moves towards the mirro r. Just before the particle touches
the mirror the velocity of approach ofthe pa rticle and its image is: (B) 5 m/s
(A) 10 m/s (C) 10V3 m/s (D) 5V3 m/s A boy of height 1.5 m with his eye level at
1.4 m stands before a plane mirror of length 0.75m fixed on the wall. The height
ofthe lower edge ofthe mirror above thefloor is 0.8 m. Then; (A) the boy will s
ee his full image (B) the boy cannot see his h air (C) the boy cannot see his fe
et (D) the boy cannot see neither his hair nor his feet. Two plane mirrors are i
nclined at 70. Aray incident on one mirror at an gle 9 after reflection falls on
the second mirror and is reflected from there pa rallel to thefirstmirror, 9 is
: (A) 50 (B) 45 (C) 30 (D)55 Two plane mirror AB and AC are inclined at an angle 9 =
20. Aray oflight startingfrompoint P is incident at point Q on the mirroe AB, th
en at R on mirror AC and again on S on AB finally the ray ST goes parallel to mi
rror Ac. The angle iwhich the ray makes with the normal at point Q on mirror AB
is llll11II C (A) 20 (B) 30 (D) 60 (C) 40 Two plane m irrors oflength L are separate
d by distance L and a man Mj is standing M, at dis tance L from the connecting l
ine of mirrors as shown infigure.A man Mj is walkin g is a straight line at dist
ance 2 L parallel to mirrors at speed u, then man IV ^ M, at O will be able to s
ee image of Mj for total time: O9L 6L 3L 4L (D) u (C) u (A) u (B) u 2 2 2L <!I B
ansal Classes
Question Bank on Geometrical Optics [13]
Q.9 Q.10 Ci! Q.12 Q.13 Q.14 Q.15 Q 16 Q.17 <!I Bansal Classes Two plane mirrors
are placed parallel to each other at a distance L apart. Apoin t object O is pla
ced between them, at a distance L / 3 from one mirror. Both mir rors form multip
le images. The distance between any two images cannot be (A) 3L/ 2 (B)2L/3 , (C)
2L (D)None Two blocks each ofmass m lie on a smooth table. They a re attached to
two other masses as shown in the figure. The pulleys and strings are light. An
object O is C kept at rest on the table. The sides AB & CD ofthe t wo blocks are
made reflecting. isr nAolm The acceleration oftwo images formed in those two re
flecting surfaces w.r.t. each other is: (A) 5g / 6 (B)5g/3 (C)g/3 ( D)17g/6^ As
shown in the figure a particle is placed at 0 in front of a plane mi rror M. A m
an at P can move along path PY and PY' then which of the following is true (A) F
or all point on P Y man can see the image of O (B) For all point on P Y' man can
see the image, but for no point on P Y he can L see the image of O ( C) For all
point on PY' he can see the image but on PY he can see the image only upto dist
ance d. (D) He can see the image only upto a distance d on either side of P. A m
an of height 'h' is walkingawayfroma street lamp with a constant speed V . The h
eight ofthe street lamp is 3h. The rate at which of the length ofthe m an's shad
ow is increasing when he is at a distance 1 Oh from the base of the str eet lamp
is: (A) v/2 (B) v/3 (C)2v (D)v/6 A two eyed man is looking at the junct ion oft
wo large mutually perpendicular mirrorsfroma far off distance. Assume no reflect
ion to occur from the edge. Then if both the eyes are open (A) The eye 1 of man
can see image of both eye 1 and eye 2. (B) The eye 1 can see image of eye 1 only
and eye 2 see image of eye 2 only. (C) The eye 1 can see image of eye 2 only an
d eye 2 can see image of eye one only. M i r r o r ( l ) (D) All the abov e stat
ements are false. In the diagram shown, all the velocities are given with respec
t to earth. What is the relative velocity of the image in mirror (1) with respec
t to the image in the mirror (2)? The mirror (1) forms an angle (3 with th e ver
tical. (A)2Vsin2P (B)2Vsinp ' (C)2V/sin2p (D)none Mirror(2) Apoint object i s ke
pt infrontof a plane mirror. The plane mirror is doing SHM of amplitude 2 cm . T
he plane mirror moves along the x-axis and x-axis is normal to the mirror. Th e
amplitude of the mirror is such that the object is always infront of the mirro r
. The amplitude of SHM of the image is (A) zero (B)2cm (C)4cm (D) 1 cm c. A poi
nt source oflight S is placed infrontoftwo large mirrors as shown. Which of the
following observers will see only one image of S? (A) only A (B)onlyC A. mm^muuu
uu (C) Both A and C (D) Both B and C LM RM Two mirrors, labeled LM for left mir
r or and RM for right mirror in the adjacent figure, are parallel to each other
an d 3.0 m apart. Aperson standing 1.0 m from the right mirror (RM) looks into t
his mirror and sees a series ofimages. How far from the person is the second clo
ses t image seen in the right mirror (RM)? (A) 10.0 m (B)4.0m 2m lm (C) 6.0 m '
(D) 8.0 m Question Bank on Geometrical Optics [13]
A Q.18 Two mirrors AB and CD are arranged along two parallel lines. The maximum
nu mber of | images of obj ect O that can be seen by any observer is B .0 (A) On
e ( B)Two (C)Four (D) Infinite Q.19 A concave mirror is used to form image of th
e Su n on a white screen. If the lower half of the mirror ~ were covered with an
opaq ue card, the effect on the image on the screen would be YJ, , , <> (A) negl
igible AW a-fiii Cv^GQe eJ comJc(*Mo ego c oOken er^t r^ t ^ (B) to make the ima
ge les s bright than before (C) to make the upper half of the image disappear (D
) to ma ke the lower half of the image disappear Q.20 Aconvex mirror of focal le
ngth 'f is placed at the origin with its reflecting surface towards the negative
x-axis. Choose the correct graphs between V and 'u' for u < 0. D i (D) fo o Q.2
1 In the figure shown, the image of a real object is formed at point I. AB is th
e principal axis ofthe mirror. The mirror must be: T2 l I 1 (A) concave & p lace
d towards right I (B) concave & placed towards left of I (C) convex and plac ed
towards right of I (D) convex & placed towards left of I. Q.22 An infinitely lon
g rod lies along the axis of a concave mirror of focal length f. The near end of
the rod is at a distance u > f from the mirror. Its image will have a length (A)
u - f (D) Uuf f (B) uuff (C) U + f ~/ + Q.23 Apoint source is situated at a dis
tance x < ffromthe pole ofthe concave mirror of focal length f. At time t = 0 ,
the point source starts moving awayfromthe mirror with constant velocity. Whic h
ofthe graphs below represents best, variation ofimage distance j v | with the d
istance x between the pole ofmirror and the source. |V| M M It d >d V & Bansal C
lasses Xo f Xo f Xo f Xo f Q.24 Apoint object is between the Pole and Focus of a
concav e mirror, and moving away from the mirror with a constant speed. Then, t
he veloc ity of the image is: (A) awayfrommirror and increasing in magnitude (B)
towards mirror and increasing magnitude (C) awayfrommirror and decreasing in ma
gnitude ( D) towards mirror and decreasing in magnitude Q.25 An object is placed
in front of a convex mirror at a distance of 50 cm. A plane mirror is introduce
d covering the lower half of the convex mirror. Ifthe distance between the objec
t and the plane mirror is 30 cm, it is found that there is no gap between the im
ages forme d by the two mirrors. The radius ofthe convex mirror is: (A) 12.5 cm
(B) 25 cm ( C)50cm (D) 100 cm (A) (B) (C) (D)
Question Bank on Geometrical Optics [61
Q.26 A concave mirror is placed on a horizontal table, with its axis directed ve
rtically upwards. Let O be the pole of the mirror and C its centre of curvature
. Apoint object is placed at C. It has a real image, also located at C (a condit
i on called auto-collimation). Ifthe mirror is nowfilledwith water, the image wi
ll be: (A) real, and will remain at C (B) real, and located at a point between C
a nd oo (C) virtual, and located at a point between C and 0. (D) real, and loca
ted at a point between C and O. Q.27 Aray oflight is incident on a concave mirro
r. It is parallel to the principal axis and its heightfromprincipal axis is equa
l t o the focal length of the mirror. The ratio of the distance of point B to th
e di stance of the focusfromthe centre of curvature is (AB is the reflected ray)
< (B) s cof (D) Q.28 A luminous point object is moving along the principal axis
ofa concave mirr or offocal length 12 cm towards it. its distancefrommirror 4 v
elocity e Whentowa rds the mirror is 20 cm its velocity is(B)cm/s. Thefromthe of
the image in cm/s a t that instant is: (A) 6 6 away mirror (C) 9 awayfromthe mir
ror (D) 9 towards th e mirror Q.29 When an object is placed at a distance of 25
cmfroma concave mirro r, the magnification is m . The object is moved 15 cm farh
ter away with respect to the earlier position, and the magnification becomes m .
If m,/m = 4 the focal length of the mirror is (Assume image is real m,, m are n
umerical values) (A) 1 0 cm (B) 30 cm (C) 15 cm (D) 20 cm 2L . | 71X Q.30 A refl
ecting surface is repre sented by the equation Y = j ~L~ 0 < x < L. A ray travel
ling y horizontally beco mes vertical after reflection. The coordinates of the p
oint (s) where this ray i s incident is t 2 2 2 s m 1s (A) 1,4' (L -J2L) % Q.31
The origin ofx and y coordinates is the pole of a concave mirror of focal l engt
h 20 cm. The x-axis is the optical axis with x > 0 being the real side of mi rro
r. A point object at the point (25 cm, 1 cm) is moving C with a velocity 10 c m/
s in positive x-direction. The velocity of the image in cm/s is approximately (A
) - 80 i + 8 j (B) 160 i + 8 j (C) - 160 i + 8 j (D) 1 6 0 i - 4 j Q.32 In the f
igure shown ifthe object 'O' moves towards the plane mirror, then the image (f I
(which is formed after successive reflectionsfromMj & M respectively) -- '* w i
ll move: -r* : Mi (A) towards right (B) towards left (C) with zero velocity (D)
cannot be determined 2 M J (B) I ' 3 (L V3L^ 71
J 2L V 3 L " ] (C) ^ 4 ' t t J (D) [ 3 ' t t J r 3L V2L N r Q.33 All ofthe follo
wing statements are correct except (for real object): (A) th e magnification pro
duced by a convex mirror is always less thenor equal to one ( B) a virtual, erec
t, same sized image can be obtained using a plane mirror (C) a virtual, erect, m
agnified image can be formed using a concave mirror (D) a real , inverted, same
sized image can be formed using a convex mirror. Q.34 The dista nce of an object
fromthe pole of a concave mirror is equal to its radius of curva ture. The image
must be : (A) real (B) inverted (C) same sized (D) erect Bansal Classes Questio
n Bank on Geometrical Optics m
r Q.35 A straight line joining the object point and image point is always perpen
di cular to the mirror (A)ifmirrorisplaneonly (B) ifmirror is concave only (C) i
f m irror is convex only (D) irrespective ofthe type of mirror. Q.36 A concave m
irro r forms a real image three times larger than the object on a screen. Object
and ( screen are moved until the image becomes twice the size of object. If the
shif t of object is 6 cm. The - shift of the screen & focal length of mirror ar
e (A) 36 cm, 36cm (B) 36cm, 16cm (C) 72cm, 36cm (D) none of these Q.37 A point s
ource oflight is 60 cmfroma screen and is kept at the focus of a concave mirror
which reflects \ light on the screen. The focal length ofthe mirror is 20 cm. Th
e rati o ofaverage intensities ofthe illumination on the screen when the mirror
is pres ent and when the mirror is removed is : (A) 36:1 (B) 37 : 1 (C)49:l (D)1
0:l Q.38 The distance of a real object from the focus of a convex mirror of radi
us of cu rvature 'a' is 'b'. Then the distance ofthe image from the focus is i2
^ ^2 (A) ( B) - (C) (D) none ofthese 4a b 4b Q.39 Choose the correct statement(s)
related t o the motion of object and its image inthe case ofmirrors (A) Object
and its ima ge always move along normal w.r.t. mirror in opposite directions (B)
Only in the case of convex mirror, it may happen that the object and its image
move in the same direction (C) Only in the case of concave mirror, it may happen
that the ob ject and its image move in the same direction (D) Only in case of p
lane mirrors, object and its image move in opposite directions Q.40 A point sour
ce oflight is placed at a distance h below the surface of a large deep lake. Wha
t is the perc entage oflight energy that escapes directlyfromthe water surface i
s p ofthe wate r=4/3 ? (neglect \\ partial reflection) (A) 50% (B) 25% (C) 20% (
D) 17% Q.41 The x-z plane separates two media Aand B with refractive indices p,j
and P2 respect ively. Aray oflight travels from A to B. Its directions in the t
wo media are giv en by the unit vectors, r = a i + b j & C r = a i + p j respect
ively where i & ] are unit vectors in the x and y directions. Then (A)pja = p a
(B) PjOC ~ p a (C )pjb = p P (D)pjp = p b Q.42 A ray Rj is incident on the plane
surface ofthe gla ss slab (kept in air) ofrefractive index -J2 at angle ofincid
ent equal to the cr itical angle for this air glass system. The refracted ray R2
undergoes partial r eflection & refraction at the other surface. t The angle be
tween reflected ray R and the refracted ray R at that surface is: (A)45 (B)135 (C)
105 (D) 75 Q.43 A ray oflight from a denser medium strike a rarer medium. The ang
le of reflection is r and that of refraction is r'. The reflected and refracted
rays make an angle of 90 with each other. The critical angle will be: (A) sin (ta
n r) (B) tan (sin r) (C) sin" (tan r') (D) tan" (sin r') Q. 44 A tiny air bubble
in a glass slab (p, = 1.5) appears from one side to be 6 cm from the glass surf
ace and 9 from other side, 4 cm. The thickness ofthe glass slab is (A) 10 cm (B)
6.67 cm (C)15cm (D) one of these 2 A B 2 2 2 2 3
4 -1 1 1 1 <!I Bansal Classes Question Bank on Geometrical Optics [13]
n,=\3 Q.231 In thefigureshown the angle made by the light ray with the normal in
the n,=v2 medium of refractive index 1 is : n,=l (A)30 (B)60 t (C) 90 (D) None of
these Q.46 A plane glass slab is placed over various coloured letters. The lette
r which appears to be raised the least is (D) green (B) yellow (C) violet a (A)
red Q.47 Bottom face of the glass cube is silvered as shown. Aray of light inci
d ent on top face ofthe cube as shown. Find the deviation of the ray when it com
es out of the glass cube : (A) 0 (B) 90 (C) 180 (D) 270 Q.48 A ray oflight is incid
ent upon an air/water interface (it passes from air i nto water) at an angle of
45. Which ofthe following quantities change as the ligh t enters the water? (I) w
avelength (II) frequency r(IV) direction of propagation 2 (IH) speed of propagat
ion (A) I, III only (B) III, IV only (C) I, II, IV only (D) I, III, IV only Q.49
The figure shows the path of a ray oflight as it passe s through three differen
t materials with refractive indices n,, n and n . The fi gure is drawn to scale.
The refractive indices of the material satisfy relation (A) n < < nj (B) n < nj
< nj (C) n < nj < n (D) n, < n < n Q.50 The critical ang le for glass to air re
fraction is least for which colour ? (B)blue (C) violet (D )red P c (A) orange Q.
51 Along rectangular slab oftransparent medium is placed on a horizontal table w
ith its length parallel to the x-axis and width parallel to the y-axis as shown
in thefigure.Aray oflight travelling in air makes a normal incidence { on the sl
ab. The refractive index p ofthe medium varies as , where p and r (>d) are const
ants. l-(x/r) Y I (A) The incident ray travels in parabolic ally inside the slab
. (B) The incident ray travels in hyperbolic path inside the slab. (C) The incid
ent ray travels in circular path inside the slab. (D) The in cident ray travels
in elliptical path inside the slab. Q.52 A ray oflight travel sfroman optical de
nser medium to rarer medium. The critical angle for the two me dia is C. The max
imum possible deviation ofthe refracted light ray can be : 71 ( A) 7t - C (B)2C
(C) it. - 2C (D)--C Q.53 A microscope is focused on a point obje ct and then its
objective is raised through a height of 2cm. If a glass slab ofr efractive inde
x 1.5 is placed over this point object such that it is focused aga in, the thick
ness of the glass slab is: (A) 6 cm (B) 3 cm (C)2cm (D) 1.5 cm Q.54 Aparaxial be
am oflight is converging towards a point P on the screen. Aplane pa rallel sheet
of glass of thickness t and refractive index p is introduced in the path ofbeam
. The convergence point is shifted by: (A) t (1 - 1/p) away (B) t (1 + 1/p) away
(C) t (1 - 1/p) nearer (D) t (1 + 1/p) nearer Q.55 A bird is flying 3 m above t
he surface ofwater. If the bird is diving vertically down with speed = 6 m/s, r
his apparent velocity as seen by a stationaryfishunderwater is : X, (A) 8 m/s (B
)6m/s (C) 12 m/s (D)4m/s 2 3 3 3 2 3 3 2 > 0
(feBansal Classes Question Bank on Geometrical Optics [12]
Q.56 A flat glass slab of thickness 6 cm and index 1.5 is placed in front of a p
lane mirror. An observer is standing behind the glass slab and looking at the m
i rror. The actual distance of the observer from the mirror is 50 cm. The distan
ce of his image from himself, as seen by the observer is : (A) 94 cm (B) 96 cm (
C) 98cm (D) 100 cm sini Q.57 In the figure shown is equal to: C Vh 1*3 Hi Q.58 A
ra y oflight moving along the unit vector (- i - 2j) undergoes refraction at an
int erface oftwo media, which is the x-z plane. The refractive index for y > 0
is 2 while for y < 0, it is -J5 j2 The unit vector along which the refracted ray
move s is: ( a ) MM) (D) None of these Q. 5 9 An object is placed 20 cm infront
of a 4 cm thick plane mirror. The image ofthe obj ect finally is formed at 45 cm
fromthe obj ect itself. The refractive i ndex of the material ofthe unpolished s
ide of the mirror C is (considering near normal incidence) (A) 1.5 (B) 1.6 (C) 1
.4 (D) none of these Q.60 A ray oflight i s incident on a parallel slab of thick
ness t and refractive index n. If the angl e of incidence 9 is small than the di
splacement in the incident and emergent ray will be : tOCn-1) t9 t9n (A) (B) (C)
(D) none Q.61 A ray oflight is incident at an angle of 75 into a medium having r
efractive index p. The reflected and the re fracted rays are found to suffer equ
al deviations in opposite direction p equals c r?^^' V3+1 V3+1 2V2 (A) ^ 2 ( C )
^ (D) None of these Q.62 A small source ofl ight is 4m below the surface of a l
iquid ofrefractive index 5/3. In order to cut off all the light coming out of li
quid surface, minimum diameter ofthe disc pla ced on the surface of liquid is: (
A) 3m (B)4m (C)6m (D)oo m \ ^ IvT Q. 63 From t he figure shojvn establish a rela
tion between, Pj, p , p . (A)pj<p <p * (B) p < p ; p = pj (C) p > p ; p = Pj (D)
None of these Q.64 The critical angle oflight going from medium A to medium B i
s 9 . The speed oflight in medium A is v. The s peed oflight in medium B is : 1
2 3 2 3 3 2 3 3 2 3 n ( A )sin0 (B) vsin9 (C) vcot9 (D) vtan9 Q.65 A cubical blo
ck of glass ofrefracti ve index n is in contact with the surface of water of ref
ractive index i^. Abeam oflight is incident on vertical face of the block (see i
nternal reflection at t he base and A refraction atfigure). After refraction, a
totalray emerges out at an angle 9. The \ the oppo site vertical face, the value
of 9 is given by: (A) s in 9 < ^ m - n (B) tan 9 < J ? - n 1 1 (C) sin 9 < , (D
) tan 9 < , Vl ~2 V 1 } 3 : , n 2 2 2 , n 2 n N/ n. 2
2 2: 2 n ~ n 2 <!I Bansal Classes Question Bank on Geometrical Optics [13]
Q.66 Theflatbottom of cylinder tank is silvered and water (p = 4/3) isfilledin t
he tank upto a height h. A small bird is hovering at a height 3hfromthe bottom
o fthe tank. When a small hole is opened near the bottom of the tank, the water
le vel falls at the rate of 1 cm/s. The bird will perceive that his image's velo
cit y is : (A) 0.5 cm/s upward , (B) 1 cm/s downwards (C) 0.5 cm/s downwards (D)
non e ofthese Q.67 A vertical pencil of rays comesfrombottom of a tankfilledwit
h a l iquid. When it is accelerated with an acceleration of 7.5 m/s , the ray is
seen to be totally reflected by liquid surface. What is minimum possible refrac
tive i ndex of liquid? s (A) slightly greater than 4/3 (B) slightly greater than
5/3 (C ) slightly greater than 1.5 (D) slightly greater than 1.75 Q.68 Look at
the ray diagram shown, what will be the focal ind length ofthe 1 and the 2 lens,
ifthe i ncident light ray passes without any deviation? ^emergent (A) -5 cm and
-10cm (B )+5 cm and + 10cm gt 5cm 5 cm (C)-5 cm and+5 cm (D) +5 cm and +5 cm Q.
69 A paral lel sided block of glass, of refractive index 1.5 which is 3 6 mm thi
ck rests on the floor of a tank which isfilledwith water (refractive index = 4/3
). The diff erence between apparent depth offloorat A& B when seenfromvertically
above is eq ual to E (A) 2 mm (B)3mm (C)4mm (D) none of these Q.70 A ray ofligh
t is incident on one face of a transparent slab of thickness 15 cm. The angle of
incidence is 60. Ifthe lateral displacement of the ray on emergingfromthe parall
el plane is 5 v3 cm, the refractive index ofthe material of the slab is (A) 1.41
4 (B) 1.532 (C ) 1.732 (D)none Q.71 A beam oflight has a small wavelength spread
5X about a cen tral wavelength X. The beam travels in vaccum until it enters a
glass plate at a n angle 9 relative to the normal to the plate, as shown infigur
e.The index of re fraction ofthe glass is given by n(> ). The angular spread 89'
ofthe refracted b eam is given by 2 st nd v -5X (A) 59' = n (B) 89'= dn(X) -8X
dX tan 9' dn(^,) sin 9 8X (C) 89'= n dX 5X (D) 59' = sin 9' X Q.72 When a pin is
mo ved along the principal axis of a small concave mirror, the image position c
oinc ides with the object at a point 0.5 m from the mirror, refer figure. Ifthe
mirro r is placed depth ofO. min a transparent L phenomenon occurs when the at a
is pla ced 0.42mfromthe mirror. liquid, the same pin The refractive index ofthe
liquid is (A) 6/5 (B) 5/4 (C) 4/3 (D)3/2 Vacuum Glass 0.2 m 0.2 m Q. 73 A light
ray is incident on a transparent sphere ofindex = ^ , at an angle of incidence =
45. What is the deviation ofa tiny fraction ofthe ray, which enter s the sphere,
undergoes two internal reflections, and then refracts out into air ? (B)240 (C)
120 (D)180 A) (A) 270 (feBansal Classes Question Bank on Geometrical Optics [12]
Q.74 Two identical thin isosceles prisms ofrefracting angle 'A' and refractive i
ndex p are placed with their bases touching each other. Two parallel rays oflig
h t are incident on this system as shown. The distance ofthe point where the ray
s convergefromthe prism is: h (A) pA 2h <*>X ph (D) ( p - l ) A (C) (p-l)A Q.75
A ray of sunlight enters a spherical water droplet (n=4/3) at an angle of incide
nc e 53 measured with respect to the normal to the surface. It is reflected from
the back surface ofthe droplet and re-enters into air. The angle between the inc
omi ng and outgoing ray is [Take sin 53 = 0.8] (A) 15 (B) 34 (C) 138 (D)30 Q.76 A con
cave spherical surface ofradius of curvature 10cm separates two medium x & y of
refr active index 4/3 & 3/2 respectively. If the object is placed along principa
l axi s in medium X then (A) image is always real (B) image is real ifthe object
dista nce is greater than 90cm (C) image is always virtual (D) image is virtual
if the object distance is less than 90cm Q.77 The correct conclusion that can b
e drawn fromthesefiguresis ih. Al * , \/ \ Q.78 Q.79 e-. Q.80 & Q.81 (b) (A) p,j<
p but p< p (B) pj>p but p< p (C) Pj= p but p< p (D) p, = p, but p < p Afishis ne
> z > y (C)y>z>x (D)None Q. 95 Abi-concave glass lens having refractive index 1.
5 has both surfaces of same radius of curvature R. On immersion in a medium of r
efract ive index 1.75, it will behave as a (A) convergent lens of focal length 3
.5 R (B ) convergent lens of focal length 3.0 R (C) divergent lens of focal leng
th 3.5 R (D) divergent lens of focal length 3.0 R Q. 96 The power (in diopters)
of an eq uiconvex lens with radii of curvature of 10 cm and refractive index ofl
,6is: (A) - 1 2 (B) +12 (C) +1.2 (D) -1.2 Q.97 The focal length ofa lens is grea
test for which colour? (A) violet (B)red (C) yellow (D) green Q.98 A converging
lens form s an image of an object on a screen. The image is real and twice the s
ize ofthe object. If the positions of the screen and the object are interchanged
, leaving the lens in the original position, the new image size on the screen is
(A) twice the obj ect size (B) same as the object size (C) halfthe object size
(D) can't say as it depends on the focal length of the lens. Q. 99 An object is
placed inf rontofa symmetrical convex lens with refractive index 1.5 and radius
of curvatur e 40 cm. The surface ofthe lens further awayfromthe object is silver
ed, Under au to-collimation condition, the object distance is (A) 20 cm (B) 10 c
m (C)40cm (D) 5cm Q. 100 When the object is at distances u and u the images form
ed by the same lens are real and virtual respectively and ofthe same size. Then
focal length o f the lens is: ] 2 (B)|(U!+U ) 2 ( O ^ T (D) 2 (u, + u ) 2 Q. 101
A planoconvex lens, when silvered at its plane surface is equivalent to a conca
ve mirror of focal length 28cm. When its curved surface is silvered and th e pla
ne surface not silvered, it is equivalent to a concave mirror of focal leng th 1
0cm, then the refractive index of the material of the lens is: (A) 9/14 (B) 14/9
(C) 17/9 (D)none Q. 102 The height of the image formed by a converging lens on
a screen is 8cm. For the same position ofthe object and screen again an imag e o
f size 12.5cm is formed on the screen by shifting the lens. The height M ofth e
object: (A) 625/32cm (B)64/12.5cm (C) 10cm (D)none <!I Bansal Classes Question B
ank on Geometrical Optics [13]
Q. 103 Parallel beam oflight is incident on a system of two convex lenses of foc
al A lengths fj = 20 cm and f = 10 cm. What should be the distance between the
t wo lenses so that rays after refraction from both the lenses pass undeviated :
V (A) 60 cm (B) 30 cm (C) 90 cm (D) 40 cm ' Q. 104 A bi-concave symmetric lens
ma de of glass has refractive index 1.5. It has both surfaces of same radius of
cur vature R. On immersion in a liquid of refractive index 1.25, it will behave
as a 6 (A) Converging lens of focal length 2.5 R (B) Converging lens offocal len
gth 2.0 R (C) Diverging lens of focal length 4.5 R (D) None of these Q. 105 A la
tera l object of height 0.5 cm is placed on the optical axis of bi-convexlens of
foca l length 80 cm, at an object distance = 60 cm. The image formed is: C (A)
virtua l, erect and 4 cm high (B) virtual, inverted and 2 cm high (C) virtual, e
rect an d 2 cm high (D) real, inverted and 2 cm high. Q.106 A converging lens of
focal l ength 20 cm and diameter 5 cm is cut along the line AB. The part of the
lens sho wn shaded in the diagram is now used to 2 cm form an image of a point
P placed 3 0 cm away from it on the line XY. Which is perpendicular to the plane
of the len s. The image of P will be formed. 30 cm (A) 0.5 cm above XY (B) 1 cm
below XY (C ) on XY (D) 1.5 cm below XY Q.107 A object is placed at a distance
of 15 cm from a convex lens of focal length 10 cm. On the other side of the lens
, a convex mi rror is placed at image formed by a its focus such that thefocal l
ength of the t he combination coincides with the obj ect itself. The convex mirr
or is (A) 20 cm (B)lOcm (C)15cm (D)30cm Q. 108 A thin lens of focal length f and
its aperture h as a diameter d. It forms an image of intensity I Now the centra
l part of the ap erture upto diameter (d/2) is blocked by an opaque paper. The f
ocal length and i mage intensity would change to (A) 172,1/2 (B) f, 1/4 (C) 3f/4
,1/2 (D)f,3I/4 Q. 109 Two planoconvex lenses each of focal length 10 cm & refrac
tive index 3/2 are placed as shown. In the space left, water (R.I = 4/3) is fill
ed. The whole arra ngement is in air. The optical power of the system is (in dio
pters) : P (A) 6.67 (B) - 6.67 (C) 33.3 (D) 20 Q. 110 A concave mirror is placed
on a horizontal su rface and two thin uniform layers of different transparent l
iquids (which do not mix or interact) are formed on the reflecting surface. The
refractive indices o f the upper and lower liquids are and p respectively. The b
right point source at a height 'd' (d is very large in comparison to the thickne
ss ofthe film) above the mirror coincides with its own final image. The radius o
f curvature ofthe ref lecting surface therefore is 11 2 2 (A) (B)p,p d 2 (C)pjd
(D) p d 2 Q. 111 An object is moving towards a converging lens on its axis. The
image is a lso found to be moving towards the lens. Then, the object distance 'u
' must sati fy (A) 2f < u < 4f ' (B) f < u < 2f (C) u > 4f (D)u<f <!I Bansal Cla
sses
Question Bank on Geometrical Optics [13]
0 Q. 112 An object is placed infrontof a thin convex lens of focal length 3 0 cm
a nd a plane mirror is placed 15 cm behind the lens. If the final image ofthe o
bje ct coincides with the object, the distance of the object from the lens is ot
v^ ( A) 60 cm (B) 30 cm (C)15cm (D)25cm Q. 113 Two point sources P and Q are 24
cm ap art. Where should a convex lens of focal length 9 cm be placed in between
them s o that the images of both sources are formed at the same place? (A) 3 cm
from P (B) 15 cm from Q (C) 9 cm from Q (D) 18 cm from P Q. 114 If a concave len
s is pl aced in path of converging rays real image will be produced if the dista
nce ofth e pole from the point of convergence of incident rays lies between (f=
magnitude of focal length of lens) c (A) 0 and f (B)fand2f (C) 2f and infinity (
D) fand i nfinity Q. 115 A point object is kept at thefirstfocus of a convex len
s. If the lens starts moving towards right with a constant velocity, the image w
ill /W (A) always move towards right object (B) always move towards left I (C)fi
rstmove to wards right & then towards left. V p Lr (D)firstmove towards left & t
hen towards right. Q. 116 The diagram shows a silvered equiconvex lens. An objec
t of length 1 cm has been placed in thefrontofthe lens. What will be thefinalima
ge properti es? The ; refractive index ofthe lens is p and the refractive index
ofthe medium in which the lens has been placed is 2p. Both the surface have the
radius R. 30 cm , V ( A ) Half size, erect and virtual (B) same size, erect and
real , ..:<< - l: A (C) same size, erect and virtual . (D) none J Q. 117 In the diag
ram shown, the lens is moving towards the object with a velocity V m/s and the o
bject is also moving towards the lens with the same speed. A What speed of the i
mage with resp ect to earth when the object is at a distance Object 2ffromthe le
ns? (fis the fo cal length.) \J (A) 2 V (B)4V (C)3V (D)V Q. 118 You are given tw
o lenses, a conv erging lens with focal length+10 cm and a diverging lens with f
ocal length - 20 cm. Which ofthe following would produce a virtual image that is
larger than the object? (A) Placing the object 5cmfromthe converging lens. a- (
B) Placing the ob ject 15cmfromthe converging lens. (C) Placing the object 25cmf
romthe converging lens. (D) Placing the obj ect 15 cmfromthe diverging lens. Q.
119 A screen is pl aced 90 cmfroma object. The image of an object on the screen
is formed by a conv ex lens ft at two different locations separated by 20 cm. Th
e focal length ofthe lens is 3 (A) 18 cm (B) 21.4 cm (C)60cm (D) 85.6 cm Q. 120
In the above problem , if the size of the image formed at the positions are 6 cm
and 3 cm, then the f highest ofthe obj ect is (D)none of these & (A) 4.2 cm (B)
4.5 cm (C) 5 cm Q. 1 21 If an object is placed at A(OA>f); Where f is the focal
length of the lens th e image is found to be formed at B. Aperpendicular is ere
cted at o and C is chos en on it such that the angle ZBCA is B a right angle. Th
en the value offwill be (A) AB/OC (B) (AC)(BC)/OC (C) OC /AB (D) (OC)(AB)/AC+BC
3 6 % f> t 2 2 <!I Bansal Classes Question Bank on Geometrical Optics
[13]
Q. 122 One ofthe refractive surfaces of a prism of angle 3 0 is silvered. A ray o
flight incident at an angle of 60 retraces it path. The refractive index of the
m aterial ofprism is : (A) V2 (B)^3 (C) 3/2 (D)2 Q. 123 On an equilateral prism,
i t is observed that a ray strikes grazingly at one face and ifrefractive index
of the prism is 2 then the angle of deviation is (A) 60 (B)120 (C) 30 (D) 90 c c
Q. 124 A parallel beam oflight is incident on the upper part of a prism of angle
1.8 and R.1.3/2. The light coming out ofthe prism falls on a concave mirror ofra
dius of curvature 20 cm. The distance of the point (where the rays are focused
a fter reflectionfromthe mirror)fromthe principal axis is: (A) 9 cm (B) 0.157 cm
( C) 0.314 cm (D) None of these Q: 125 The refractive index ofa prism is, cot wh
ere A= angle of prism. The angle ofminimum deviation is (in p degrees) (A) 2A (B
) 9 b - A (C) 180-2A (D)0 Q. 126 A ray oflight strikes a plane mirror at an angl
e o fincidence 45 as shown in thefigure.After reflection, the ray passes through
a pr ism ofrefractive index 1.5, whose apex angle is 4. The angle through which t
he mi rror , should be rotated if the total deviation of the ray is to be 90 is: (
A) 1 c lockwise (B) 1 anticlockwise (C) 2 clockwise (D) 2 anticlockwise 0 0 Q. 127
The refracting angle of prism is 60 and the index ofrefraction is 1 /2 rel ative
to surrounding. The limiting C^ angle ofincidence of a ray that the will b e tr
ansmitted through the prism is : (A) 30 (B) 45 (C) 15 (D) 50 Q. 128 One face of a pr
ism with a refracting angle of 30 is coated with silver. Aray incident on oth er
face at an angle of45 is refracted and reflected from the silvered coated face an
d retraces its path. The refractive index ofthe prism is : (A) 2 (B)VI (C)V3/ 2
(D)V2 1 Q. 129 An equilateral prism deviates a ray through 40 for two angles ofin
cidence differing by 20. The possible angles ofincidences are: (A) 40, 60 (B) 50, 30
(C) 45, 5 5 (D)30,60 Q. 13 0 A beam of monochromatic light is incident at i =5 0 on o
ne face o f an equilat eral prism, the angle of emergence is 40, then the angle o
f minimum deviation is: (A) 30 (B) <30 (D) > 30 (C) < 30 c Q.131 The dispersive pow
ers oftwo lenses are 0.01 and0.02. Iffocai length of one lens is + 10cm, then wh
at should the focal length ofthe second lens, so that th ey form an achromatic c
ombination? (A) Diverging lens having focal length 20 cm. (B) Converging lens ha
ving focal length 20 cm (C) Diverging lens having focal l ength 10 cm. (D) Conve
rging lens having focal length 10 cm <!I Bansal Classes Question Bank on Geometr
ical Optics [13]
Q. 132 A thin prism of angle 5 is placed at a distance of 10 cm from object. What
is the distance of the image from obj ect? (Given p. of prism =1.5) (A)-cm % (B
)-cm [3 71 (C) cm 571 (D) - cm 7T Q. 133 A prism has a refractive index J - and r
efracting angle 90. Find the minim um deviation produced by prism. V2 (A) 40 (B) 4
5 (C) 30 (D)49 Q. 13 4 Two lenses in contact made ofmaterials with dispersive power
s in the ratio 2:1, behaves as an achromatic lens of focal length 10 cm. The ind
ividual focal lengths ofthe lenses are: (A) 5 cm, -10 cm (B) - 5 cm, 10 cm (C) 1
0 cm, - 20 cm (D) - 20 cm, 10 cm Q . 13 5 R. I. of a prism is and the angle of p
rism is 60. The limiting angle of in cidence of a ray that will be j tansmitted t
hrough the prism is: (A) 30 (B) 45 (C) 15 (D) 50 Q. 13 6 A ray oflight strikes a pla
ne mirror at an angle of incidence 4 5 as shown in the figure. After reflection,
the ray passes through a prism of ref ractive index 1.50, whose apex angle is 4.
The angle through which the mirror sho uld be rotated ifthe total deviation ofth
e ray is to be 90 is (A) 1 clockwise (B) 1 anticlockwise (C) 2 clockwise (D) 2 anticl
ockwise ^ Q. 137 For a prism of apex angle 45, it is found that the angle of emer
gence is 4 5 for grazing incidence. Calculate the refractive index of the prism.
(A) (2) (B) (3)" (C) 2 (D)(5)" 1/2 2 2 Q. 13 8 A ray incident at an angle 5 3 on
a prism emerges at an angle at 3 7 as s hown. If the angle ofincidence is made 5
0, which ofthe following is a possible va lue ofthe angle 53 of emergence. (A) 35
(B) 42 (C) 40 (D)38 0 Q. 13 9 The diagram showsfiveisosceles right angled prisms.
Alight ray incident at 90 at thefirstface emerges at same angle with the normalfr
omthe last face. Whi ch ofthe following relations will hold regarding the refrac
tive / \ n / \ ^ indi ces? ' (A) pf + p + p j = p + p (B) p + p + p = 1 + p + p
(C) p + p + p ? = 2 + p + p (D)none 2 2 2 2 2 2 2 2 2 2 2 2 2 <!I Bansal Classes
Q. 140 A beam oflight consisting of red, green and blue and is incident on a ri
g ht angled prism. The refractive index ofthe material ofthe prism for the above
r ed, green and blue wavelengths are 1.39,1.44 and 1.47 respectively. The prism
wi ll: (A) separate part of the red color from the green and blue colors. (B) s
epar ate part of the blue colorfromthe red and green colours. _ (C) separate all
the three colorsfromthe other two colors. 450 (D) not separate even partially a
ny co lorfromthe other two colors. Question Bank on Geometrical Optics
[13]
Q. 141 A certain prism is found to produce a minimum deviation of 38. It produces
a deviation of 44 when the angle of incidence is either 42 or 62. What is the angl
e of incidencewhen it is undergoing minimum deviation? E (A) 45 (D) 55 (B) 49 (C)
40 c Q. 142 It is desired to make an achromatic combination of two lenses (Lj &
L ) m ade of materials having dispersive powers C0j and co (<]). Ifthe combinatio
n of l enses is converging then (A) Lj is converging ' , (B) L is converging (C)
Power of Lj is greater than the power ofL (D) None of these 2 2 2 2 Q. 143 A ra
y oflight is incident normally on thefirstrefracting face ofthe prism ofrefracti
ng angle A. The ray of light comes out at grazing emergence. If one h alf ofthe
prism (shaded position) is knocked off, the same ray will i (A) emerge at an ang
le of emergence sin sec A / 2 v^ (B) not emerge out of the prism f1 . . .A (C) e
merge at an angle of emergence sin sec A / 4 (D) None of these 1 1 Q. 144 An ach
romatic convergent cjoublet of two lens in contact has a power of + 2 D. The con
vex lens is power + 5 D. What is the ratio of the dispersive powers of the conve
rgent and divergent lenses? (A) 2 : 5 (B) 3 : 5 (C) 5 : 2 (D) 5 : 3 Q. 145 Light
ray is incident on a prism of angle A = 60 and refractive index p. = V2 . The an
gle of incidence at which the emergent ray grazes the surface is gi ven by (A) s
i n -1 K 2 J (B)Sin -l r i - V a ] I ' J 2 (C) sin1 I J 2 JL^ (D) sin" 'vV3y 1
Q. 146 Two incident monochromatic waves whose wavelengths differ by a small amou
nt dA, are separated angularly at 9 and 9 + d9. The dispersive power is given b
y (A) d9/dX, (B) d9/9 (C)dAA (D)A(dA/d9) Q. 147 A ray oflight is incident normal
l y on a prism of refractive index 1.5, as shown. The prism is immersed in a liq
ui d of refractive index 'p'. The 1 largest value ofthe angle ACB, so that the r
ay is totally reflected at the face AC, is 30. Then the value of p must be: V3 (A
) ( B) (C) (D) 3 V3 ItBansal Classes Question Bank on Geometrical Optics i [19]
Q.l ONE OR MORE THAN ONE OPTION MAY BE CORRECT Take approx. 3 minutes for answer
ing each question. A man ofheight 170 cm wants to see his complete image in a pl
ane mirror (while s tanding). His eyes are at a height of 160 cm from the ground
. (A) Minimum length of the mirror=80 cm (B) Minimum length of the mirror=85 cm.
(C) Bottom ofthe mi rror should be at a height 80 cm. (D) Bottom of the mirror
should be at a height 85 cm. Two plane mirrors at an angle such that a ray incid
ent on a mirror under goes a total deviation of240 after two reflections. (A) the
angle between the mir ror is 60 (B) the number of images formed by this system w
ill be 5, if an object is placed symmetrically between the mirrors. (C) the no.
ofimageswillbe 5 if an object is kept unsymmetrically between the mirrors. (D) a
ray will retrace its p ath after 2 successive reflections, ifthe angle ofincide
nce on one mirror is 60. W Aflatmirror M is arranged parallel to a wall W at a di
stance I from it. The li ght S 1 Wall produced by a point source S kept on the w
all is reflected by the m irror and produces / a light spot on the wall. The mir
ror moves with velocity v towards the wall. r M minimi* (A) The spot oflight wil
l move with the speed v on the wall, (B) The spot oflight will not move on the w
all. (C) As the mirror com es closer the spot oflight will become larger and shi
ft away from the wall with speed larger then v. (D) The size ofthe light spot on
the wall remains the same. A concave mirror cannot form (A) virtual image ofvir
tual object (C) real image of a real object (B) virtual image of a real object (
D) real image of a virtual object. Q.2 Q.3 Q.4 Q.5 In thefigureshown consider th
efirstreflection at the plane mirror and second at the convex mirror. AB is obje
ct. (A) the second image is real, inverted of 1/5 m agnification (B) the second
image is virtual and erect with magnificationl/5 (C) the second image moves towa
rds the convex mirror (D) the second image moves awa yfromthe convex mirror. th
^ jI _10cm A B E 50cm > i c ' Xi 10cm i 120cm c Q.6 A ray oflight is incident no
rmally on one face of 30 - 60 - 90 prism \P/ of refract ive index 5/3 immersed in w
ater of refractive index 4/3 as shown in figure. 1 \ (A) The exit angle 0 ofthe
ray is sin (5/8) (B) The exit angle 9 of the ray is s in (5/4J3) (C) Total inter
nal reflection at point P ceases ifthe refractive inde x of water is increased t
o 5/2V3 by dissolving some substance. (D) Total interna l reflection at point P
ceases if the refractive index ofwater is increased to 5 /6 by dissolving some s
ubstance. 2 -1 2 -1
<f Bansal Classes Question Bank on Geometrical Optics [23]
Q.7 A ray oflight in a liquid ofrefractive index 1.4, approaches the boundary su
rfac e between the liquid and air at an angle of incidence whose sine is 0.8. Wh
ich o f the following statements is correct about the behaviour ofthe light (A)
It is impossible to predict the behavior of the light ray on the basis of the in
format ion supplied. (B) The sine of the angle of refraction of the emergent ray
will l ess than 0.8. (C) The ray will be internally reflected (D) The sine of t
he angle of refraction of the emergent ray will be greater than 0.8. The figure
shows a ray incident at an angle i = TC/3 . Ifthe plot drawn shown the variation
of | r - i | versus Hi k, (r = angle of refraction) H2 : Q. 8 Mi v (A) the valu
e of kj is (C) the value of 6 = 7t/3 2 (B) the value of0, =7t/6 (D) the value of
k is 1 2 In the diagram shown, a ray oflight is incident on the interface betwee
n 1 and 2 at angle slightly greater than critical angle. The light suffers total
internal reflection at this interface. After that the light ray falls at the in
terface o f 1 and 3, and again it suffers total internal reflection. Which ofthe
following relations should hold true? (B) (A) Pj < p < p (D) p f + p > p (C)P?P >P^ Q.10 In the figure shown a point object O is placed in air on the principa
l axis. Th e radius of curvature of the spherical surface is 60 cm. I is thefina
limage form ed after all the refractions and reflections. (A) If dj = 120 cm, th
en the T ' i s formed on 'O' for any value of d . (B) If dj = 240 cm, then the T
' is formed on 'O' only if d = 360 cm. (C) If dj = 240 cm, then the T ' is form
ed on 'O' for all values of d.2(D) If dj = 240 cm, then the T ' cannot be formed
on 'O'. 2 3 3 2 2 2 f f 2 f 2 f f Q.9 ~n H3 n =3/2 g 2 Q.ll Two refracting medi
a are separated by a spherical interface as shown in the figure. PP' is the prin
cipal axis, Pj and P2 are the refractive indices of medi um of incidence and med
ium of refraction respectively. Then: (A) if P2 > pj, the n there cannot be a re
al image of real obj ect. (B) if pj > pj, then there canno t be a real image ofv
irtual object. (C) if Pj > P2, then there cannot be a virtu al image ofvirtual o
bject. (D) if pj > p , then there cannot be a real image of real object. 2 <f Ban
sal Classes Question Bank on Geometrical Optics [23]
A curved surface of radius R separates two medium of refractive indices p, and p
as shown in figures A andB 2 Question No. 12 to 14(3 questions) x Q.12 Choose t
he correct statement(s) related to the real image formed by the obj ect O placed
at a distance x, as shown infigureA (A) Real image is always formed irrespectiv
e of the position of object if p > p, (B) Real image is formed only when x > R (
C) Real image is formed due to the convex nature of the interface ir respective
of Pj and p^ (D) None of these Q.13 Choose the correct statement(s) r elated to
the virtual image formed by obj ect O placed at a distance x, as shown infigureA
(A) Virtual image is formed for any position of O if p < (B) Virtual image can
be formed ifx > R and p < Pj (C) Virtual image is formed if x < R and p > p, (D)
None of these 2 2 2 2 R Fig. A x Fig. B Q.14 Identify the correct statement(s)
related to the formation of images of a r eal obj ect O placed at x from the pol
e ofthe concave surface, as shown infigure B (A) I f p > p j , then virtual imag
e is formed for any value ofx 2 (B)If \u< p., then virtual image is formed if x<
Hi H (C) If p < Pj, then real i mage is formed for any value ofx (D) none ofthe
se 2 2 Q.15 Which of the following can form diminished, virtual and erect image
ofyour face. (A) Converging mirror (B) Diverging mirror (C) Converging lens (D)
Divergi ng lens Q.16 A convex lens forms an image of an object on a screen. The
height o f the image is 9 cm. The lens is now displaced until an image is again
obtained on the screen. The height ofthis image is 4 cm. The distance between th
e object and the screen is 90cm. (A) The distance between the two positions of t
he lens i s 3 0cm. (B) The distance of the obj ect from the lens in itsfirstposi
tion is 3 6cm. (C) The height of the object is 6cm. (D) The focal length of the
lens is 21 .6 cm. Q. 17 A diminished image of an object is to be obtained on a l
arge screen 1 mfromit. This can be achieved by (A) using a convex mirror of foca
l length le ss than 0.25 m (B) using a concave mirror offocal length less than 0
.25 m (C) us ing a convex lens offocal length less than 0.25 m (D) using a conca
ve lens of fo cal length less than 0.25 m <f Bansal Classes Question Bank on Geom
etrical Optics [23]
Q.18 Which of the following quantities related to a lens depend on the wavelengt
h of the incident light ? (A) Refractive index (B) Focal length (C) Power (D) R
a dii of curvature Q.19 A thin lens with focal length f to be used as a magnifyi
ng glass. Which of the following statements regarding the situation is true? (A)
A converging lens may be used, and the object be placed at a distance greater t
ha n 2ffromthe lens. (B) A diverging lens may be used, and the object be placed
bet ween f and 2f from the lens. (C) A converging lens may be used, and the obj
ect be placed at a distance less than f from the lens. (D) Adiverging lens may b
e us ed, and the object be placed at any point other than the focal point. Q.20
An ob ject O is kept infront of a converging lens of focal length 30cm behind wh
ich th ere is a plane mirror at 15 cm from the lens. (A) the final image is form
which (a) The pole ofthe mirror is the origin. (b ) The direction ofthe inciden
t rays is considered as positive x-axis. (c) Vertic ally up is positive y-axis.
Note According to above convention radius of curvatu re and focus of concave mir
ror is negative and of convex mirror is positive. MIR ROR FORMULA: 1 = 1 + 1 8.
f v u f = x-coordinate of focus u = x-coordinate of ob j ect ; v=x-coordinate of
image Note : Valid only for paraxial rays. &Bansal Classes Geometrical Optics 1
2]
10. 11. = V TRANSVERSE MAGNIFICATION m= h u h, h = y co-ordinate of images h, = y
co-ordi nate of the obj ect (both perpendicular to the principle axis of mirror
) NEWTON' S FORMULA : Applicable to a pair of real object and real image positio
n only. Th ey are called conjugate positions or foci. X, Y are the distance alon
g the princ ipal axis ofthe real object and real image respectively from the pri
ncipal focus . XY = f OPTICAL POWER: Optical power of a mirror (in Diopters)=- f
\ f = focal l ength (in meters) with sign. 2 2 2 REFRACTION -PLANE SURFACE 1. (i
) (ii) LAWS OF REFRACTION (AT ANY REFRACTING SURF ACE) : The incident ray (AB),
the normal (NN') to the refracting surface (II') a t the point of incidence (B)
and the refracted ray (BC) all lie in the same plan e called the plane of incide
nce or plane of refraction. for any two given media and for light ofa given wave
length. This is known as SNELL'S L a w . Sin i = Constant Sin r Note : Frequenc
y oflight does not change during refraction. 2. DEVIATION OFARAYD UE TO REFRACTI
ON \ | angle of | deviation i |1 5=i-r 3. (i) (ii) REFRACTION THROUGH A PARALLEL
SLAB : Emerged ray is parallel to the incident ray , ifmedium is same on both s
ides. Lateral shift t = thickness of slab t sin(i - r) cosr N J B FRV-.. N' ! \
AIR GLASS(M) Note : Emerged ray will not be parallel to the incident ray ifthe m
edium on both the sides are different. ^Bansal Classes Geometrical Optics [3]
4. APPARENT DEPTH OF SUBMERGED OBJECT : II I h h' L x / / / .* // / / '/ \ O (h'<
h) at near normal incidence h ' - ^ h Note : h and h' are always measuredfro msu
rface. 5. CRITICAL ANGLE & TOTAL INTERNAL REFLECTION (T. I. R.) (i) (ii) 6. COND
ITIONS OF T. I. R. Ray goingfromdenser to rarer medium Angle of incidence sh oul
d be greater than the critical angle (i > c). Critical angle C = sin" n 1 ; REFR
ACTION THROUGH PRISM: 1. 2. 3. 4. 5 = (i + i') - (r + r') r + r' = A Variation o
f 8 versus i (shown in diagram). T here is one and only one angle of incidence f
or which the angle ofdeviation is m inimum. When 8 = 8 then i = i' & r = r', the
ray passes symetrically about the p rism, & then m 1 1 i i1 , min i=i' 90 (e=90)
A where n = absolute R.I. of glass. Note : When the prism is dipped in a medium
th en n = R.I. of glass w.r.t. medium. (!%Bansal Classes Geometrical Optics [10]
For a thin prism (A <10) ; 8 = ( n - l ) A DISPERSION OF LIGHT : The angular spil
itting of a ray ofwhite light into a number of components when it is refracted
i n a medium other than air is called Dispersion of Light. Angle of Dispersion:
An gle between the rays of the extreme colours in the refracted (dispersed) ligh
t 7 . is called Angle of Dispersion . 6 = 5 - 8 . Dispersive power (oo) ofthe me
dium of the material ofprism. 8. angular dispersion mean ray v deviation of mean
ray (yellow) For small angled prism (A < 10) n +n 8 -8 n -n 00=^- = - ;n = n-1 n , n
& n are R. I. of material for violet, red & yellow colours respectively. 9. COMB
INAT ION OF TWO PRISMS : (i) ACHROMATIC COMBINATION: It is used for deviation wi
thout dispersion. Condition for this (n -n) A = (n' - n' ) A'. n +n n.', + n; 1
1 A'. Net mean deviation = or oo8 + G)'8' = 0 where co, co' are dispersive power
s for the two prisms & 8,8' are the mean deviation. (ii) DIRECT VISION COMBINATI
ON: I t is used for producing disperion without deviation condition n + n n' + n f
or thi s A'. Net angle of dispersion = (n - n) A = (n ' - n') A'. REFRACTION AT
SPERICA L SURFACE l.(a) 2 u V R v, u & R are to be kept with sign + vex 0 p as v
= PI c I u = -PO R = PC (Note radius is with sign) m mV (b) 1^2 2. LENS FORMULA:
+ ve (a ) v u J (b) (H-l) V i 2 y J (c) m = u v r r R v R v R v v r v R D v v 5
. 6. \ : u R R (!%Bansal Classes Geometrical Optics [10]
EXERCISE # III Q. 1 Two plane mirrors are inclined at angle 0 as shown in figure
. If a ray para llel to OB strikes the other mirror at P andfinallyemerges paral
lel to OA after two reflection thenfind0. Q. 2 Q. 3 A ray of light falls on a tr
ansparent sphere with centre at C as shown in figure. The ray emerges from the s
phere parallel t o line AB. Find the refractive index ofthe sphere. Face AC of a
right angled pri sm (j4, =1.5) coated with a thinfilmof liquid as ^(yuuuumiii^
is incident upon a quarter cylinder of radius R=5 cm, and has a refractive inde
x 2/V3 A patch on the table for a distance 'x'fromthe cylinder is unilluminated.
findthe value of'x'? (!%Bansal Classes Geometrical Optics [10]
Q.21 A thin converging lens Lj forms a real image of an object located far away
from the lens as shown in the figure. The image is located at a distance 4/ and
has height h. A diverging lens offocal length I is placed 21fromlens Lj at A. An
other converging lens of focal length 21 is placed 3/fromlens Lj at B. Find the
height offinalimage thus formed? Q.22 An object is placed at a certain distance
f roma screen. A convex lens of focal length 40 cm is placed between the screen
an d the obj ect. A real image is formed on the screen for two positions ofthe l
ens , which differ by a distance of 10 Vl7 cm. Find the distance ofthe obj ectfr
omth e screen? Q.23 A point object is placed at a distance of 25 cmfroma convex
lens of focal length 20 cm. If a glass slab of thickness t and refractive index
1.5 i s inserted between the lens and object. The image is formed at infinity. F
ind th e thickness t ? Q .24 An object is kept at a distance of 16 cmfroma thin
lens an d the image formed is real. Ifthe object is kept at a distance of 6 cmfr
omthe sa me lens the image formed is virtual. Ifthe size ofthe image formed are
equal, th enfindthe focal length ofthe lens? Q.25 A thin convex lens forms a rea
l image of a certain object 'p' times its size. The size of real image becomes '
q' times t hat of object when the lens is moved nearer to the object by a distan
ce 'a'findf ocal length ofthe lens? Q.26 A diverging lens of focal length 10 cm
is placed 10 cm infrontofa plane mirror as shown in thefigure.Lightfroma very fa
r away sourc e falls on the lens. Find the image of source due to plane mirror (
before hittin g lens again) at a distance from mirror? Q.27 In the figure shown,
the focal len gth ofthe two thin convex lenses is the same = f. They are separa
ted by a horizo ntal distance 3f and their optical axes are displaced by a verti
cal separation'd ' (d f ) , as shown. Taking the origin of coordinates O at the
centre ofthe firs t lens,findthe x and y coordinates ofthe point where a paralle
l beam ofrays comi ngfromthe leftfinallyget focussed? Q.28 A point source ofligh
t is kept at a dist ance of 15 cmfroma converging lens, on its optical axis. The
focal length of the lens is 10 cm and its diameter is 3 cm. A screen is placed
on the other side of the lens, perpendicular to the axis of lens, at a distance
20 cmfromit. Thenfin dthe area ofthe illuminated part of the screen? Q.29 Consid
er a "beam expander' which consists oftwo converging lenses of focal lengths 40
cm and 100 cm having a common optical axis. A laser beam of diameter 4 mm is inc
ident on the 40 cm fo cal length lens. The diameter ofthefinalbeam will be (see
figure) Q.30 An equila teral prism deviates a ray through 23 for two angles ofinc
idence differing by 23. Find p ofthe prism? List of recommended questions from I.
E. Irodov. 5.13 to 17,5 .21 to 24,5.26,5.27,5.31,5.34 to 37 f [? (!%Bansal Class
es Geometrical Optics [10]
EXERCISE # III Q. 1 An observer whose least distance of distinct vision is'd', v
iews his own fa ce in a convex mirror of radius r of curvature 'r'. Prove that m
agnification pro duced can not exceed ~ Q. 2 Two identical convex lenses Lj and L
are placed at a distance of20 cmfromeach other on the common principal axis. Th
e focal length of each lens is 15 cm and the lens L is to the right of lens A. A
point object is placed at a distance of 20 cm on the left of lens L on the comm
on axis of two le nses. Find, where a convex mirror ofradius of curvature 5 cm s
hould be placed so that the final image coincides with the object? Q. 3 A thin c
onverging lens is arranged between a small illuminated object & a screen so that
an image ofthe ob ject of linear magnification 3 is formed on a screen. The obj
ect and the screen are then 64 cm apart. A thin biconcave lens is then placed be
tween the convergin g lens & the screen so that the lenses are coaxial & 6 cm ap
art. To restore a sh arply focussed image on the image screen the object was mov
ed awayfromthe conver ging lens through a distance of 14 cm. The biconcave lens
has a surface ofradii of curvature 14 cm & 21 cm. Calculate the focal length of
the biconcave lens. Al so find the R. I. of the biconcave lens. 2 2 p Q. 4 A sur
veyor on one bank of canal observed the image of the 4 inch and 17ftmarks o n a
vertical staff, which is partially immersed in the water and held against th e b
ank directly opposite to him, coincides. If the 17ft mark and the surveyor's eye
are both 6ft above the water level, estimate the width ofthe canal, assuming th
at the refractive index ofthe water is 4/3. Two thin similar watch glass piec es
are joined together,fronttofront,with rear portion silvered and the combinati o
n of glass pieces is placed at a distance a = 60 cm from a screen. A small obje
ct is placed normal to the optical axis of the combination such that its two tim
es magnified image is formed on the screen. If air between the glass pieces is
r eplaced by water (jx = 4/3), calculate the distance through which the object m
us t be displaced so that a sharp image is again formed on the screen. A concave
mi rror has the form of a hemisphere with a radius of R=60 cm. A thin layer of
an u nknown transparent liquid is poured into the mirror. The mirror-liquid syst
em fo rms one real image and another real image is formed by mirror alone, with
the so urce in a certain position. One of them coincides with the source and the
other is at a distance of /=30 cm from source. Find the possible value(s) refra
ctive i ndex ji ofthe liquid. A ray of light refracted through a sphere, whose m
aterial has refractive index (i in such a way that it passes through the extremi
ties of two radii which make an angle 0 with each other. Prove that if a is the
deviatio n of the ray caused by its passage through the sphere 1 cos(0-a) = ( . c
os J 0 In the figure shown, find the relative speed of approach/separation ofthe
two final images formed after the light rays pass through the lens, at the momen
t when u= 30 cm. The speed object = 4 cm/s. The two lens halves are placed symme
trically w .r.t. the moving object. f=40cm Q. 5 Q. 6 Q. 7 Q. 8 u <!\Bansal Class
es Geometrical Optics
[6]
Q.9 Three right angled prisms of refractive indices \x2 and |x are j oined toget
her so that the faces ofthe middle prism in are in contact each with one of the
outs ide prisms. If the ray passes through the composite block undeviated, show
that fi, + fx - ja = 1. 3 2 3 2 2 2 2 Q. 10 Two rays are incident on a spherical
mirror ofradius ofR=5 cm parallel to its optical axis at the distance hj = 0.5
cm and h = 3 cm. Determine the distanc e Ax between the points at which these ra
ys intersect the optical axis after bei ng reflected at the mirror. Q. 11 A beam
oflight is incident vertically on a gla ss hemisphere ofradius R lying with its
plane side on a table. The axis ofthe be am coincides with the vertical axis pa
ssing through the centre ofthe base ofthe hemisphere and the radius r of the cro
ss section ofthe beam is smaller than R. F ind the radius ofthe luminous spot fo
rmed on the table. 0 Q. 12 In the figure shown Lisa converging lens of focal len
gth 10cm and M is a c oncave mirror of radius of curvature 20cm. A point object
O is placed infrontoft he lens at a distance 15cm. AB and CD are optical axes of
the lens and mirror re spectively. Find the distance ofthe final image formed b
y this systemfromthe opt ical centre of the lens. The distance between CD & AB i
s 1 cm. 0 -15cmH c 1 { 1cm D J M a -45cmQ.13 A thiefis running away in a car wit
h velocity of20 m/s. A police jeep is fo llowing him, which is sighted by thief
in his rear view mirror which is a convex mirror of focal length 10 m. He observ
es that the image of jeep is moving towar ds him with a velocity of 1 cm/s. Ifth
e magnification ofthe mirror for the jeep at that time is 1/10. Find (a) actual
speed ofjeep (b) rate at which magnificati on is changing. Assume that police je
ep is on axis of the mirror. Q.14 The figur e illustrates an aligned system cons
isting ofthree thin lenses. The system is lo cated in air. Determine: 5cm 5cm o(
a) the position (relative to right most lens) of the point of convergence ofa pa
rallel ray incomingfromthe left after passing through the system; +IO.OD -IO.'DD
+IO.OD (b) The distance between thefirstlens and a point lying on the axis to t
he left ofthe system, at which that point and its image are located symmetricall
y with respect to the lens system? Q.15 A cir cular disc ofdiameter d lies horiz
ontally inside a metallic hemispherical bowl r adius a. The disc is just visible
to an eye looking over the edge. The bowl is n owfilledwith a liquid ofrefracti
ve index j-i. Now, the whole ofthe / 2 IN disc i s just visible to the eye in th
e same position. Show that d = 2a = O +1) Q, 16 A luminous point P is inside a cir
cle. A ray entersfromP and after two ref lections by the circle, return to P. If
0 be the angle of incidence, a the dista nce of Pfromthe centre of the circle a
nd b the distance of the centrefromthe poi nt where the ray in its course crosse
s the diameter through P, prove that tan0= a + b (!%Bansal Classes
Geometrical Optics [10]
Q.17 A glass wedge with a small angle of refraction 9 is placed at a certain dis
tance from a convergent lens with a focal length f, one surface of the wedge be
i ng perpendicular to the optical axis ofthe lens. A point sources S oflight is
on the other side ofthe lens at its focus. The rays reflected from the wedge (no
tf rombase) produce, after refraction in the lens, two images of the source disp
lac ed with respect to each other by d. Find the refractive index ofthe wedge gl
ass. Q.18 An opaque sphere of radius R lies on a horizontal plane. On the perpen
dicu lar through the point of contact there is a point source oflight a distance
R ab ove the sphere. (a) Show that the area of the shadow on the plane is 37iR
. (b) A transparent liquid of refractive index V3 is filled above the plane such
that the sphere is j ust covered with the liquid. Show that the area of shadow
now be comes 2TCR . 2 2 (!%Bansal Classes Geometrical Optics [10]
EXERCISE # III Q.l Arayof light travelling in air is incident at grazing angle (
incident AIR P( xi,y,) angle=90) on a long rectangular slab of a transparent medi
um of thickness t = 1.0 (see figure). The point of incidence is the ,-*'B(x,y) o
rigin A (0,0). T he medium has a variable index ofrefraction n(y) given by: n (y
) - [ky + 1 ] , w here k = 1.0 mr . Medium . Air (0,0) The refractive index of a
ir is 1.0. Obtain a relation between the slope ofthe traj ectory oftherayat a po
int B (x, y) in th e medium and the incident angle at that point. Obtain an equa
tion for the trajec tory y (x) ofthe ray in the medium. Determine the coordinate
s (Xj, y,) of the po int P, where the ray the ray intersects the upper surface o
f the slab-air bounda ry. Indicate the path of the ray subsequently. [JEE '95] 3
/2 m vi (i) (ii) (iii) (iv) Q.2 E (i) (ii) Q.3 Aright angle prism(45-90-45) of refr
active index n hasaplate ofrefractive index n ( n, < n) cemented to its diagonal
face. The assembly is in air. a ray is incident on AB (see the figure). Calcula
te the angle of incidence at AB for which the ra y strikes the diagonal face at
the critical angle. Assuming n = 1.352. Calculate the angle of incidence at AB f
or which the refracted ray passes through the dia gonal face undeviated. [JEE'96
] t A thin plano-convex. Lens of focal length F is split into two halves, one of
the halves is shifted along the optical axis. The separation between object and
imag e planes is 1.8 m. The magnification ofthe image formed by one of the half
lense s is 2. Find the focal length of the lens and separation between the two h
alves. Draw the ray diagram for image formation. [JEE '96] 1.8 m Q. 4 Q.5 Which
ofthe following form(s) a virtual & erect image for all positions ofthe re al ob
j ect ? (A) Convex lens (B) Concave lens (C) Convex mirror (D) Concave mirr or [
JEE '96] A small fish, 0.4mbelowthe surface ofa lake, is viewed through a si mpl
e converging lens of focal length 3 m. The lens is kept at 0.2m above the wat er
surface such that thefishlies on the optical axis of the lens. Find the image o
f thefishseen by the observer. The refractive index of the water is 4/3. [REE '9
6] Q.6(i)An eye specialist prescribes spectacles having a combination of convex
len s of focal length 40 cm in contact with a concave lens of focal length 25 cm
. Th e power ofthis lens combination in diopters is: (A) + 1.5 (B) - 1.5 (C) + 6
.67 ( D) - 6.67 [JEE'97] <!\Bansal Classes Geometrical Optics [6]
(ii) A thin equiconvex lens of glass of refractive index |i=3/2 & of focal lengt
h 0.3 m in air is sealed into an opening at one end of a tank filled with water
(n = 4/3). On the opposite side of the lens, a mirror is placed inside the tank
on th e tank wall perpendicular to the lens axis, as shown in figure. The separa
tion b etween the lens and the mirror is 0.8 m. A small object is placed outside
the ta nk in front of the lens at a distance of 0.9 m from the lens along its a
xis. Fin d the position (relative to the lens) ofthe image ofthe object formed b
y the sys tem. [JEE' 97] 0.9m 0.8m Q. 7 Select the correct alternative(s): [JEE
'98] (i) A concave mirror is placed on a horizontal table, with its axis directe
d vertically upwards. Let O be t th e pole ofthe mirror & C its centre of curvat
ure. A point obj ect is placed at C. It has a real image, also located at C. Ift
he mirror is nowfilledwith water, th e image will be: (A) real, & will remain at
C (B) real, & located at a point bet ween C & co (C) virtual, & located at a po
int between C & O (D) real, & located at a point between C & O. (ii) (iii) A ray
of light travelling in a transparent medium falls on a surface separating the m
edium from air at an angle of incidenc e of 45. The ray undergoes total internal
reflection. Ifn is the refractive index of the medium with respect to air, selec
t the possible value(s) of nfromthe fol lowing : (A) 1.3 (B) 1.4 (C) 1.5 (D) 1.6
A spherical surface of radius of curvat ure R separates air (refractive index 1
.0)fromglass (refractive index 1.5). The centre of curvature is in the glass. A
point object P placed in air is found to have a real image Q in the glass. The l
ine PQ cuts the surface at a point O and PO = OQ. The distance PO is equal to: (
A) 5R (B) 3R (C) 2R (D) 1.5R A prism of r efractive index n, & another prism of
refractive index I , L are stuck together without a gap as shown in thefigure.Th
e angles of the prisms are as shown. n, & n2 depend on X, the wavelength of ligh
t according to n, = 1.20 + 10.8xl0 & n = 1 .45 + 1.80xl0 4 4 2 2 2 Q. 8 where X
is in nm. (l)^ Calculate the wavelength X0 for which rays incident at an y angle
on the interface BC pass through without bending at that interface. (ii) For li
ght ofwavelength X0,findthe angle of incidence i on the face AC such that the de
viation produced by the combination ofprisms is minimum. [JEE'98] Q X X V (!%Bans
al Classes A rod made of glass (fa = 1.5) and of square cross-section is bent in
to the shap e shown infigure.Aparallel beam oflight falls perpendicularly on the
planeflatsu rface A. Referring to the diagram, d is the width of a side & R is
the radius of inner d semicircle. Find the maximum value ofratio so that all lig
ht entering t he glass R through surface A emergefromthe glass through surface B
. [REE '98] *
frx\ semi circle Geometrical Optics [10] M
Q.10 A concave lens of glass, refractive index 1.5, has both surfaces of same ra
dius of curvature R. On immersion in a medium ofrefractive index 1.75, it will
b ehave as a [JEE '99] (A) convergent lens of focal length 3.5R (B) convergent l
en s of focal length 3.0 R. (C) divergent lens of focal length 3.5 R (D) diverge
nt lens of focal length 3.0 R Q.ll The x-y plane is the boundary between two tra
nsp arent media. Medium-1 with z > 0 has refractive index V2 and medium - 2 with
z < 0 has a refractive index V3 .Aray oflight in medium -1 given by the vector
A = 6^3 i + 8^3 j 10k is incident on the plane of separation. Find the unit vect
or i n the direction of refracted ray in medium -2. [JEE '99] Q.12 A quarter cyl
inder of radius R and refractive index 1.5 is placed on a table. A point object
P is kept at a distance ofmRfromit. Find the value ofm for which a ray from P wi
ll em erge parallel to the table as shown in the figure. [JEE '99] 2 T p Q.13 Tw
o symmetric double-convex lenses L, and L with their radii of curvature 0 .2m ea
ch are made from glasses with refractive index 1.2 and 1.6 respectively. T he le
nses with a separation of0.345 m are submerged in a transparent liquid medi um w
ith a refractive index of 1.4. Find the focal lengths of lens L, and L An ob jec
t is placed at a distance of 1.3 mfromL find the location of its image while the
whole system remains inside the liquid. [REE' 99] r p Q. 14 Select the correct
alternative. [JEE '2000 (Scr)] (a) A diverging beam ofl ightfroma point source S
having divergence angle a, falls symmetrically on a gla ss slab as shown. The a
ngles of incidence of the two extreme rays are equal. If the thickness of the gl
ass slab is t and the refractive index n, then the diverg ence angle ofthe emerg
ent beam is (A) zero (B) a (C) sin (l/n) (D) 2sin~ (l/n) s _1 i (b) A rectangula
r glass slab ABCD, of refractive index nj, is immersed in water fractive index n
^n > r^). Aray oflight is incident at the surface AB of the as shown. The maximu
m value ofthe angle of incidence a , such that the ray s out onlyfromthe other s
urface CD is given by -1 n. (B) sin" n, cos sm (A) . -cos sin n ni ) 1y max "2 c
-1 n 2 (C) sin" (c) n, V2 ) n (D) sin -1 n. v iy n A point source oflight B is
placed at a distance L in front ofthe centre ofa mir ror ofwidth d hung vertical
ly on a wall. A man walks infrontof the mirror along a line parallel to the mirr
or at a distance 2Lfromit as shown. The greatest dist ance over which he can see
the image ofthe light source in the mirror is (A)d/2 ofre slab come sm n
(B)d (C) 2d (D) 3d B. i< >1 L 2L (!%Bansal Classes Geometrical Optics [10]
(d) A hollow double concave lens is made ofvery thin transparent material. It ca
n be filled with air or either oftwo liquids L, or L having refractive indices n
, an d n, respectively (n >n > 1). The lens will diverge a parallel beam oflight
if i t isfilledwith (A) air and placed in air. (B) air and immersed in L,. (C)
L, and immersed in L (D) L and immersed inL 2 2 ) r 2 r Q.15 A convex lens of fo
cal length 15 cm and a concave mirror of focal length 30 cm are kept with their
optic axes PQ and RS parallel but separated in vertical direction by 0.6 cm as s
hown. The distance between the lens and mirror is 30 cm. An upright object AB of
height 1.2 cm is placed on the optic axis PQ of the lens at a distance of 20 cmf
romthe lens. IfA' B' is the image after refraction from the lens and reflectionf
romthe mirror,findthe distance A' B' from the pole ofthe mirror and obtain its m
agnification. Also locate positions of A' and B' with re spect to the optic axis
RS. [JEE 2000] Q.16 A thin equi biconvex lens ofrefracti ve index 3/2 is placed
on a horizontal plane mirror as shown in thefigure.The sp ace between the lens
and the mirror is then filled with water of refractive inde x 4/3. It is found t
hat when a point object is placed 15cm above the lens on its principal axis, the
object coincides with its own image. On repeating with anot her liquid, the obj
ect and the image again coincide at a distance 25cm from the lens. Calculate the
refractive index ofthe liquid. [JEE 2001 ] viiiiTiiriniirminiiin; Q.17 The refr
active indices ofthe crown glass for blue and red lights are 1.51 a nd 1.49 resp
ectively and those of the flint glass are 1.77 and 1.73 respectively . An isosce
les prism of angle 6 is made of crown glass. A beam of white light is incident at
a small angle on this prism. The other flint glass isosceles prism i s combined
with the crown glass prism such that there is no deviation ofthe inci dent ligh
t. Determine the angle of the flint glass prism. Calculate the net disp ersion o
fthe combined system. [JEE 2001 ] Q.18 An observer can see through a pin -hole t
he top end of a thin rod of height h, placed as shown in thefigure.The be aker h
eight is 3h and its radius h. When the beaker isfilledwith a liquid up to a heig
ht 2h, he can see the lower end of the rod. Then the refractive index ofth e liq
uid is (A) 5/2 (B)V572 (Q JJ/2 (D) 3/2 [JEE 2002 (Scr)] Q.19 Which one of t he f
ollowing spherical lenses does not exhibit dispersion? The radii of curvatur e o
f the surfaces ofthe lenses are as given in the diagrams. [JEE 2002 (Scr)] (A )
R R,*R 2 (B)R (C)R (D) (!%Bansal Classes Geometrical Optics [10]
Q.20 Two plane mirrors A and Bare aligned parallel to each other, as shown in th
e figure. A light ray is incident at an angle of 30 at a pointjust inside """uiun
u iiiainiu one end ofA. The plane of incidence coincides with the plane of the 0
.2 m ,0 3 figure. The maximum number oftimes the ray undergoes reflections ,, (i
nc luding thefirstone) before it emerges out is [JEE 2002 (Scr)] (A) 28 (B)30 (C
) 3 2 (D)34 |c Q.21 Aconvex lens of focal length 30 cm forms an image of height
2 cm for an obj ect situated at infinity. If a convcave lens of focal length 20
cm is placed coa xially at a distance of 26 cm in front ofconvex lens then size
image would be [J EE 2003 (Scr)] (A) 2.5 cm (B)5.0 (C) 1.25 (D)None Q.22 A menis
cus lens is made o f a material of refractive index Both its surfaces have radii
of curvature R. It has two different media of refractive indices (ij and |x res
pectively, on its t wo sides (see figure). Calculate its focal length for jx j <
\x2 < |a , when lig ht is incident on it as shown. [JEE 2003] 3 3 HI j R ft ft/
VR / ft<ft<ft Q .23 White light is incident on the interface of glass and air a
s shown in thef igure.If green light is just totally internally reflected then t
he emerging ray in air contains (A) yellow, orange, red (B) violet, indigo, blii
e (C) all colour s (D) all coloure except green [JEE 2004 (Scr)] Green Glass Q.2
4 A ray of light is incident on an equilateral glass prism placed on a horizo nt
al table. For minimum deviation which ofthe following is true ? [JEE 2004 (Scr )
] (A) PQ is horizontal (B)QR is horizontal (C)RS is horizontal (D) Either PQ or
RS is horizontal. Q.25 A point object is placed at the centre of a glass sphere
of radius 6 cm and refractive index 1.5. The distance ofthe virtual imagefromth
e surface of the sphere is [JEE 2004 (Scr)] (A) 2 cm (B) 4 cm (C)6cm (D)12cm Q.
2 6 Figure shows an irregular block of material of refractive index *J~2 . A ray
of light strikes the face AB as shown in the figure. After refraction it is inc
ident on a spherical surface CD of radius of curvature 0.4 m and p enters a med
i um of refractive index 1.514 to meet PQ at E. Find the distance OE upto two pl
ac es of decimal. [JEE 2004] Q.27 An object is approaching a thin convex lens of
fo cal length 0.3 m with a speed of 0.01 m/s. Find the magnitudes of the rates
of c hange ofposition and lateral magnification of image when the obj ect is at
a dis tance of 0.4 mfromthe lens. [JEE 2004] Q. 2 8 The ratio of powers of a thi
n conv ex and thin concave lens is and equivalent focal length of their combinat
ion is 30 cm. Then their focal lengths respectively are [JEE' 2005 (Scr)] (A) 75
,-50 (B ) 75,50 (C)10,-15 (D)-75,50 (!%Bansal Classes Geometrical Optics [10]
Q.29 Figure shows obj ect O. Final image I is formed after two refractions and o
ne reflection is also shown in figure. Find the focal length ofmirror, (in cm):
(A) 10 (B) 15 (C) 20 (D) 25 [JEE 2005 (Scr)] Q.30 What will be the minimum angl
e ofincidence such that the total internal reflection occurs on both the surface
s ? [JEE 2005] n=4/3 1 Q.31 Two identical prisms of refractive index V3 are kept
as shown in thefigure. A light ray strikes the first prism at face AB. Find, (a
) the angle of incidence , so that the emergent rayfromthefirstprism has minimum
deviation. (b) through w hat angle the prism DCE should be rotated about C so t
hat thefinalemergent ray a lso has minimum deviation. [JEE 2005] (!%Bansal Class
es Geometrical Optics [10]
ANSWER KEY EXERCISE # / Q.3 Q.7 Q.9 Q.l Q.5 60 45 Q.2 S Q.6 1.5 f f +d(f ~d) 5(f d) f f -d ' ~ f f - d 1 2 1 r 1 + 2 y 1 + 2 1 1.3 1000 m/s 2 cm Q.4 15 cm Q.10 8
0 m/s Q.13 42 cm Q.17 45 Q.21 2h apq Q.25 7 r Q.28 (7i/4) cm , 2 V7 Q.ll tan y- w
ith the principal axis, j- cm/sec Q.12 d/2 4 Q.14 sin" 1 Q.15 ( - 4 i - 3 j) Q.16
42 cm 1 Q.18 sin1 V2 Q.19 4/3 Q.20 5 cm Q.24 11cm Q.27 (5f, 2d) Q.22 1.70 m Q.2
3 15 cm Q.26 20 cm behind the mirror Q.29 1 cm Q.30 V43 2 EXERCISE # II Q.2 5.9
cm,10.9 cm Q.3 f = - 2 1 cm, 1.4 Q.5 15 cm towards the combination Q.6 1 .5 or (
V5-1) Q.10 5/8 0.625 cm Q- = 4 - ( r / R ) } ^ - ( r / R ) } ( r / R ) |' o Q.12
6^26 cm Q.13 (a) 21 m/s, (b) 1 x 10~ /sec Q.14 (a)3.3 cm, (b) / = (50/3) cm Q.17
a/2f9 11 r 0 2 0 2 + 0 2 = i f r 3 < < R Q.4 Q.8 16 feet 8/5 cm/s EXERCISE # II
I |V Q.l (a) tan9 = dx = coti (b) y = k ,4 (c) 4.0, 1 4 2 (d) It will become par
allel to x-axis Q.2 (i) sin" S^G/n -n, ) (ii) r, = sin" (n sin 45) = 72.94 Q.3 f =
0.4m, separatio n = 0.6 m Q.4 B,C Q.5 On the object itself Q.6 (i) B, (ii) 90 c
m from the lens t owards right Q.7 (i) D, (ii) C, D, (iii) A 2 2 _ n i 1 (!%Bans
al Classes Geometrical Optics [10]
Q.8(i) \ = 600nm, n = 1.5 (ii) i = sin" (0.75) = 48.59 1 Q - (~J 9 max Q10 A Q.ll
? = + ^k(angleofincidence=60 ;r=45) Q.12 m = 4/3 5V2 5 V2 Q. 13 f, = -70cm, f = 7
0cm, V= 560 cm to the right of L Q. 14 (a) B (b) A > (c) D (d) D Q. 15 A' B' at
15 cm to the right of mirror. B' is 0.3 cm above RS and A' is 1.5 cm below RS. M
agnif ication is 1.5 Q.16 1.6 Q.17 4 and -0.04 Q.18 B Q.19 C Q.20 B 0 2 2 Q.21 A Q
.25 C Q.27 Magnitude ofthe rate of change of lateral magnification is 0.3 sr . Q
.28 C Q.29 C Q.30 Max (Cj, c ) = 60 Q.31 (a) i = 60, (b) 60 (anticlockwise) 1 2 Q.2
2 f = = - ^ _ Q.23 A Q.24 B 1 514x0 4 Q.26 = 6.06 m correct upto two places of de ci
mal. v (!%Bansal Classes Geometrical Optics [10]
TARGET IIT JEE 2007 XII (ALL) GRAVITATION C O N T E N T S EXERCISE-I EXERCISE-II
EXERCISE-III ANSWER KEY
EXERCISE-III Q. 1 Q. 2 Q. 3 A remote sensing satellite is revolving in an orbit
of radius x t he equator of earth. Find the area on earth surface in which satel
lite can not s end message. Four masses (each of m)are placed at the vertices of
a regular pyra mid (triangular base) of side 'a'. Find the work done by the sys
tem while taking them apart so that they form the pyramid of side '2a'. 1 A smal
l mass and a thin uniform rod each of mass' m are positioned along the sam e str
aight line as shown. Find the force of gravitational attraction exerted by the r
od on the. small mass. Q. 4 An object is projected vertically upwardfromthe surf
ace ofthe earth of mass M with a velocity such that the maximum height reac hed
is eight times the radius R ofthe earth. Calculate: (i) the initial speed of pro
jection (ii) the speed at halfthe maximum height. Q. 5 A satellite close to the
earth is in orbit above the equator with a period of rotation of 1.5 hours. If i
t is above a point P on the equator at some time, it will be above P again a fte
r time . Q. 6 A satellite is moving in a circular orbit around the earth. The to
tal energy ofthe satellite is E = - 2 x 10 J. The amount of energy to be impa rt
ed to the satellite to transfer it to a circular orbit where its potential ene r
gy is U= - 2 x 10 J is equal to . Q . 7 A rocket starts vertically upwards with
speed v . Show that its speed v at a height h is given by (2gh) 5 5 0 2 2 V ry w
here Ris the radius of the earth. Hence deduce the maximum height reached by a r
ocket fired with speed equal to 90% of escape velocity. Q. 8 Q. 9 Find the gravi
tationalfieldstrength and potential at the centre of arc of linear mass de nsity
X subtending an angle 2a at the centre. Apoint P lies on the axis of a fix ed r
ing ofmass M and radius a, at a distance afromits centre C. A small particle sta
rtsfromP and reaches C under gravitational attraction only. Its speed at C w ill
arth centre. The radius of the earth is 6400 km. [REE 98] In a region of only gr
avitationalf ieldof mass 'M' a particle is shifted from A to B via three differe
nt paths in t hefigure.The work done in different paths are Wj, W , W respective
ly then 2 3 Q.5 (A)W!=W = W3 ( B ) W ! > W > W 3 2 2 (C)Wj=W >W 2 3 (D)W!<W <W [
JEE (Scr.) 2003] 2 3 Q. 6 A body is projected vertically upwards from the bottom
of a crater of moon of de pth R/l 00 where R is the radius of moon with a veloc
ity equal to the escape vel ocity on the surface of moon. Calculate maximum heig
ht attained by the body from the surface ofthe moon. [JEE' 2003 ] A B A B Q. 7 A
system ofbinary stars ofmasses m and m are moving in circular orbits of r adii
r and r respectively. If TA and T are the time periods of masses m and m re spec
tively, then [JEE 2006] ( A ) T > T (ifr >r ) (B)TA>T .(ifm >m ) b A B A b A B B
A B ft N 2 f (C) T !a \ (D)T =T A B (!%Bansal Classes Gravitation [2]
ANSWER KEY EXERCISE-I Q .3 Q.l Q.5 Q.6 R 4ttR2 Q.2 -1 3 L2 ^ " 31 R ^ 3 V 5R 1.6
hours if it is rotatingfromwest to east, 24/17 hours ifit is rotating from w est
to east lxio'j Q.7 - R 81 Q.8 2C5l (sinot), ( GA. 2ot) Q. 10h = V?-l 2 Q.9 \2GM(
. l - 1 ^ a v v^y Q.12 R 2 1-k' R \ R Q.ll (a)-GmM/r, (b)-2GmMe/r Q.13 t= GMm 2C
V e 1 x J Q.14 m 3 +
Jl V2 + V3 ' 3Gm f m +M Q.15 (i)R n ,09 R V3 +M Q.16 R R 2 Q.20 ? _ i, g = 27iGpR
i Q.18 (a) GM 1 _ 2GM Q.19 (b) 1.9 h 2xVR 3 /GM EXERCISE-IT Q1 Q5 2tcR3/2(6v/6)
VGM(2-\/2 +3-\/3) T=5. JlL 3Gp 47tr nQ 9 / 2 3 2 V VG(4M + m) Q3 J Gml 2d2
Q.4 J^nGpR2 Q 7 ( a ) T = 4 l ^ > ( b ) v = i ~ Q8 V ^ k m Q.9 cos0: Vio v 2 Q.l
l GM' R 2 _ _8_ 3 V15 Q.13 T = sin" Q.12 (a)h = , R, (b) 1.13R ' N ir T = 3 x io
~2 N Q.l B Q2 Q.5 A vmm .
3 Q.6 2 V a 5GM EXERCISE-III Q3 Q7 C D Q.4 h = 99R ^Bansal Classes Gravitation [
3]
BANSALCLASSES TARGET IIT JEE 2007 I XII (ALL) C JZT TZ ? ^ Al 1 / JL 7 L3S 4 l 7
J t v v r v i OMMMIQEIMK ON J L TX T O I V ^ ^
QUESTIONS FOR SHORT ANSWER Q. 1 .Two satellites move along a circular orbit in t
he same direction at a smal l distance from each other. A container has to be th
rownfromthefirstsatellite on to the second one. When will the container reach th
e second satellite faster: if its is thrown in the direction of motion of the fi
rst satellite or in the oppos ite direction ? The velocity ofthe container with
respect to the satellite u is much less than that ofthe satellite v. Q.2 Because
the Earth bulges near the equ ator, the source ofthe Mississippi River (at abou
t 50N latitude), although high a bove sea level, is about 5 km closer to the cent
re of the Earth than is its mout h (at about 30N latitude). How can the river flo
w "uphill" as it flows south? Q.3 Use qualitative arguments to explain why the f
ollowing four periods are equal ( all are 84 min, assuming a uniform Earth densi
ty): (a)' time of revolution of a satellite just above the Earth's surface (b) p
eriod of oscillation of mail in a tunnel through the Earth (c) period of a simpl
e pendulum having a length equal t o the Earth's radius in a uniformfield9.8 m/s
(d) period of an infinite simple p endulum in the Earth's real gravitational fi
eld. Q. 4 After Sputnik I was put in to orbit, it was said that it would not ret
urn to Earth but would burn up in its descent. Considering the fact that it did
not burn up in its ascent, how is thi s possible ? Q.5 An artificial satellite i
s in a circular orbit about the Earth. How will its orbit change if one ofits ro
ckets is momentarily fired, (a) toward s earth, (b) away from the Earth, (c) in
a forward direction, (d) in a backward direction, and (e) at right angles to the
plane of the orbit? Q.6 A stone is dro pped along the centre of a deep vertical
mine shaft. Assume no air resistance bu t consider the Earth's rotation. Will t
he stone continue along the centre ofthe shaft ? Ifnot, describe its motion. Q.7
An iron cube is placed near an iron sphe re at a location remotefromthe Earth's
gravity. What can you say about the locat ion of the centre of gravity ofthe cu
be? Of the sphere ? In general, does the lo cation ofthe centre of gravity of an
object depend on the nature of the gravitat ionalfieldin which the object is pl
aced? / Q. 8 Figure shows a particle ofmass m that is movedfroman infinite dista
nce to the # centre of a ring of mass M, alon g the central axis of the ring. Fo
r the trip, how | does the magnitude ofthe gra vitational force on the particle
due to the ring \ ' \ change. % i 2 m / X W / M Q.9 (a) (b) (c) (d) Infigure,a p
article ofmass m is initially at point A, at distance dfromthe centr e of one un
iform sphere and distance 4dfromthe centre of another uniform sphere, both of ma
ss M m. State whether, if you moved the particle to point D, the foll owing woul
d be positive, negative, or zero: the change in the gravitational pote ntial ene
rgy of the particle, the work done by the net gravitational force on th e partic
le, the work done by your force. What are the answers if, instead, the m ove wer
e from point B to point C ? B C ^T; D Q.10 Reconsider the situation of above que
stioa Would the work done by you be po sitive, negative, or zero ifyou moved the
particle (a)fromAto B, (b)fromAto C, ( c) from B to D ? (d) Rank those moves ac
croding to the absolute value ofthe work
done by your force, greatest first. 1*1<JjBansalClasses Question Bank on Gravita
tion [2]
ONLY ONE OPTION IS CORRECT. Take approx. 2 minutes for answering each question.
Q.l A large spherical planet of radius R, made of a material of density d, has a
sph erical cavity of radius R/2, with center of cavity a distance R/2 from the
centr e of the planet. Find the gravitational force on a small mass'm' at the ce
nter o f the cavity. (A) 27iRGmd/3 (B) 7iRGmd/3 (C) 27tRGmd (D) 47tRGmd/3 Q.2 At
what a ltitude will the acceleration due to gravity be 25% ofthat at the earth'
s surfac e (given radius of earth is R)? (A)R/4 , (B) R (C) 3R/8 (D)R/2 V Q.3 At
of he se 2 Q.4 Two masses m, & m are initially at rest and are separated by a v
ery large distan ce. If the masses approach each other subsequently, due to grav
itational attract ion between them, their relative velocity of approach at a sep
aration distance o f d is: 2Gd (m, + m ) G (A) t m,+ m )T (B) ^ 2d (C) (m, + m )
2G (D) (m,+m ) 2Gd >' Q.5 Let co be the angular velocity of the earth's rotatio
n about its axis. A ssume that the acceleration due to gravity on the earth's su
rface has the same v alue at the equator and the poles. An object weighed at the
equator gives the sa me reading as a reading taken at a depth d below earth's s
urface at a pole ( d R ) The value of d is co R OR 2O R jRg ,(A) g ( B ) ^2g ~ r
(C) g (D) ^ g 7 1/2 v 7 2 W 2 2 1/2 2 2 2 2 2 2 w W Q.6 A spherical hole of rad
ius R/2 is excavated from the asteroid of mass M as shown in fig. The gravitatio
nal acceleration at a point on the surface ofthe asteroid just above the excavat
ion is (A) GM/R (B) GM/2R (C) GM/8R (D) 7GM/8R 2 2 2 2 Q.7 Q.8 If the radius of
the earth be increased by a factor of 5, by what factor its den sity be changed
to keep the value of g the same? (A) 1/25 (C) 1/V5 (D) 5 A man o f mass m starts
falling towards a planet of mass M and radius R. As he reaches n ear to the sur
face, he realizes that he will pass through a small hole in the pl anet. As he e
nters the hole, he sees that 2M the planet is really made oftwo pie ces a spheri
cal shell of negligible thickness of mass and a point M mass at the c entre. Chan
ge in the force of gravity experienced by the man is 2 GMm (A) 3 - ^ 1 GMm 4 GMm
3l^~ 1*1 <JjBansalClasses (B)0 ( D ) Question Bank on Gravitation what distance
from the centre of the moon is the point at which the strength the resultantfie
ldof earth's and moon's gravitationalfieldis equal to zero. T earth's mass is 81
times that of moon and the distance between centres of the planets is 60R where
R is the radius of the earth (A) 6R (B) 4R (C) 3R (D)5R
[3]
Q. 9 An infinite number of masses, each of one kg are placed on the +ve X axis a
t 1 m , 2m, 4m, from the Q. 15 / origin. The magnitude ofthe gravitationalfielda
t orig in due to this distribution ofmasses is: 4G 3G (A)2G (B) (Q (D)oo Q.16 I Q.
10 Wit h what angular velocity the earth should spin in order that a body lying
at 3 0 l atitude may become weightless [R is radius of earth and g is accelerati
on due to gravity on the surface of earth] (A) (B) (C) J V 3R (D) Q.17 M Q. 11 T
wo concentric shells ofuniform density of mass Mj and Mj are situated as shown i
n the figure. The forces experienced by a particle of mass m when placed at posi
tions A, B and C respectively are (given OA= p, OB = q and OC = r) (A)zer o, G a
n d G--. (B) G ( M i + M 2 > Q.18 . , ( M ! + M 2 > and G ^ g 1 + 2 2 f f l a n d
( C ) G M^ (M M ) q p ; G G zero ^ Q. 19 ( d ) ( m 1 + M 2 )
W ; G M ^ zero QO 2 Q. 12 A satellite ofthe earth is revolving in circular orbit
with a uniform velo city V. If the gravitational force suddenly disappears, the
satellite will (A) c ontinue to move with the same velocity in the same orbit.
(B) move tangentially to the original orbit with velocity V. (C) fall down with
increasing velocity. ( D) come to a stop somewhere in its original orbit. Q. 13
A newly discovered plan et has a density eight times the density of the earth an
d a radius twice the rad ius ofthe earth. The time taken by 2 kg mass to fallfre
elythrough a distance S n ear the surface of the earth is 1 second. Then the tim
e taken for a 4 kg mass to fall freely through the same distance S near the surf
ace of the new planet is ( A) 0.25 sec. (B) 0.5 sec (C) 1 sec. (D) 4 sec. Q. 14
Four particles of equal mas ses M move along a circle of radius R under the acti
on of their mutual gravitati onal attraction maintaining a square shape. The spe
ed of each particle is (A)Q \ 2 q 22 GM 2V2+1 R (B) 1 GM V R 4 GM (D) 4GM R(V2+l
) & Bansal Classes Question Bank on Gravitation [4] 4lBan
height from the Q.15 At whatsurface?above the earth's surface does the accelerat
ion due to gravity fall to 1 % of its value at the earth's (A) 9R (B)10R (C) 99
R (D) 100R Q.16 Find the distance between centre of gravity and centre of mass o
f a two particle system attached to the ends ofa light rod. Each particle has sa
m e mass. Length ofthe rod is R, where R is the radius of earth (A) R (B) R/2 (C
) zero (D) R/4 Q.17 The radius of a planet is R. A satellite revolves around it
in a circle of radius r with angular velocity co . The acceleration due to the g
ra vity on planet's surface is 33 rco ra r_3 2 M (D) (B) (C) (A) R R R R 0 3 0 2
Q.18 A solid sphere of uniform density and radius R applies a gravitational forc
e of attraction equal to F on a particle placed at a distance 3R from the centr
e ofthe sphere. A spherical cavity ofradius R/2 is now made in the sphere as sho
w n in the figure. The sphere with cavity now applies a gravitational force F on
t he same particle. The ratio F / F j is: 22 41 (A) 50 (C) (B) 25 <">25 50 t 2
2 Q.19 The mass and diameter of a planet are twice those of earth. What will be
th e period of oscillation ofa pendulum on this planet if it is a seconds pendul
um on earth? 1 1 (A) V2 second (B) 2V2 seconds (C) ^ second (D) ^ ^ second Q.20
A p article of mass M is at a distance afromsurface of a thin spherical shell of
equ al mass and having radius a. (A) Gravitationalfieldand potential both are z
ero a t centre ofthe shell. (B) Gravitational field is zero not only inside the
shell but at a point outside the shell also. (C) Inside the shell, gravitational
fielda lone is zero. (D) Neither gravitationalfieldnor gravitational potential i
s zero inside the shell. Q.21 Three point masses, M each, are moving in a circle
, each with a speed v, under their mutual gravitational attractive force. The di
stance between any two masses must be: (A) 2GM/v (B) 3 G M / V ( C ) GMV3/v (D)
G M / V 2 2 2 2 Q. 22 A cavity of radius R/2 is made inside a solid sphere of ra
dius R. The cent re of the cavity is located at a distance R/2 from the centre o
f the sphere. Fin d the gravitational force on a particle of mass'm' at a distan
ce R/2 from the ce ntre of the sphere on the line joining both the centres of sp
here and cavity (op posite to the centre of cavity). [Here g = GM/R , where M is
the mass of the sph ere] g ^ mg (D) none of these (C) 16 (A) (B) 2 m 3 m 1*1 <J
jBansal Classes Question Bank on Gravitation [5]
Q. 23 How much deep inside the earth should a man go so that his weight becomes
one fourth of that at a point which is at a height R above the surface of earth.
(A)R/4 (B) 15R/16 (C)3R/4 (D) R/2 Y Q. 24 Two identical spherical balls each of
mass m are placed as shown in figure . Plot the variation of g(gravitation inte
nsity) along the x-axis. (A) J ) ( g1 0 A. o V (C) \ g1 0 ) m m e-x B (D) J r Q.
25 A satellite revolves in the geostationary orbit but in a direction east to we
st. The time interval between its successive passing about a point on the equa t
or is: (A) 48 hrs (B)24hrs (C)12hrs (D) never Q.26 A particle startsfromrest at
a distance Rfromthe centre and along the axis of a fixed ring ofradius R & mass
M. Its velocity at the centre ofthe ring is: / i>j (V2GM 2GM (A) (B) R GM GM (C
) <P) R I v2 R M) e Q. 27 Aspherical uniform planet is rotating about its axis.
The velocity of a po int on its equator is V. Due to the rotation of planet abou
t its axis the accele ration due to gravity g at equator is 1/2 of g at poles. T
he escape velocity of a particle on the planet in terms ofV. (A)V = 2V (B)V = V
(C)V =V/2 (D)V =,V Q.28 Two point masses of mass 4m and m respectively separated
by d distance are revo lving under mutual force of attraction. Ratio oftheir kin
etic energies will be: (A) 1 : 4 (B) 1:5 (C) 1 : 1 (D) 1 : 2 e e e Q.29 Two plan
ets Aand B have the same material density. Ifthe radius ofAis twice that of B, t
hen the ratio of v the escape velocity is v 4 D
(A) 2 (B) V2 (C) 1/V2 0 CD) 1/2 Q.30 The escape velocity on the surface ofthe ea
rth is V . If M and R are the ma ss and the radius of the earth respectively, th
en the escape velocity on another planet of mass 2M and radius R/2 will be : (A)
4V (B)2V (C)V . (D)V /2 Q.31 Abal l A' of mass m falls to the surface of the ear
th from infinity. Another ball B' of mass 2m falls to the earth from the height
equal to six times radius of the e arth then ratio of velocities of'A' and 'B' o
n reaching the earth is (A) V(6/5) (B) V(5/6) (C) 1 (D) V(7/6) 0 0 0 0 r & Bansa
l Classes Question Bank on Gravitation [278] 4lBan
Q. 3 2 If an artificial satellite revolves in circular orbit around the earth wi
th a speed equal to halfits escape velocity from the earth. Then its height abo
v e the surface of earth will be: [Radius of earth=6400 km] (A) 3200 km (B) 6400
k m (C) 12800 km (D) 24000 km Q. 3 3 The ratio of gravitational acceleration at
he ight 3R to that at height 4Rfromthe surface ofthe earth is : (where R is the
rad ius ofthe earth) (A) 9/16 (B) 25/16 (C) 16/25 (D) 16/9 Q.34 A small body of
supe rdense material, whose mass is twice the mass ofthe earth but whose size i
s very small compared to the size ofthe earth, startsfromrest at a height H R ab
ove th e earth's surface, and reaches the earth's surface in time t. Then t is e
qual to (A)V2H7^ (B)VHT^ (C) V2H/3g (D) V4H/3g. Q. 3 5 A rocket is launched stra
ight up fromthe surface ofthe earth. When its altitude is one fourth ofthe radiu
s of the earth, its fuel runs out and therefore it coasts. The minimum velocity
which th e rocket must have when it starts to coast if it is to escapefromthe gr
avitation al pull of the earth is [escape velocity on surface of earth is 11,2km
/s] (A) lk m/s (B) 5km/s (C) lOkm/s (D)15km/s Q. 3 6 Gravitational potential dif
ference bet ween a point on surface of planet and another point 10m above is 4J/
kg. Consider ing gravitationalfieldto be uniform, how much work is done in movin
g a mass of 2 .0 kg from the surface to a point 5. 0m above the surface ? (A) 0.
40 J (B) 2.5 J (C) 4.0 J (D)8.0J Q. 3 7 Referring to previous problem, what is t
he gravitation alfieldstrength in this region ? (A) 0.025 N kg(B) 0.40 N kg(C)2.
5Nkg-' (D)4.0Nk g" Q. 3 8 Select the correct choice(s): (A) The gravitationalfie
ldinside a spher ical cavity, within a spherical planet must be nonzero and unif
orm. (B) When a b ody is projected horizontally at an appreciable large height a
bove the earth, wi th a velocity less than for a circular orbit, it will fall to
the earth along a parabolic path. (C) Abody of zero total mechanical energy pla
ced in a gravitatio nalfieldwill escape the field (D) Earth's satellite must be
in equatorial plane. Q.39 The orbital velocity of an artificial satellite in a c
ircular orbit just a bove the earth's surface is V . The value of orbital veloci
ty for another satell ite orbiting at an altitude of half of earth's radius is 1
1 1 0 (A) (B) J h (C)JT O V (D) v / v j 0 4gR Q.40 A particle is projected with
a velocity vertically upward from the surf ace ofthe earth, R being the radius
of the earth & g being the acceleration due to gravity on the surface of the ear
th. The velocity of the particle when it is at half the maximum height reached b
y it is (A)Jf (B)Jf (C) VgR <P)ff Bansal Classes Question Bank on Gravitation
m
Q.41 A satellite is in a circular orbit very close to the surface of a planet. A
t some point it is given an impulse along its direction of motion, causing its
v elocity to increase r| times. It now goes into an elliptical orbit. The maximu
m possible value of ri for this to occur is (A) 2 <B)V2 (C) V2+1 (D)^i^ Q. 42 A
sa tellite ofmass m, initially at rest on the earth, is launched into a circular
or bit at a height equal to the radius ofthe earth. The minimum energy required
is (A) mgR (B)^mgR (C)^mgR (D)^mgR Q. 43 Thefigureshows the variation ofenergy
with the orbit radius of a body in c ircular planetary motion. Find the correct
statement about the curves A, B and C (A) A shows the kinetic energy, B the tota
l energy and C the potential energy o f if the system. s (B) C shows the total e
nergy, B the kinetic energy and Athe p otential energy of the system. (C) C and
A are kinetic and potential energies re spectively and B is the total energy of
the system. (D) A and B are kinetic and potential energies and C is the total en
ergy of the system. Q 44 The ratio of th e. radius of the earth to that of the m
oon is 10 The ratio of the acceleration d ue to gjravirj on the earth to that on
the moon is 6. The ratio ofthe escape vel ocityfromthe earth 's surface to that
from the moon is (A) 6 (B) 1.5 (C) 12 (D)V 60 Q.45 An artificial satellite of t
he earth releases a package. If air resistan ce is neglected, the point where th
e package will hit (with respect to the posit ion at the time of release) will b
e (A) ahead (B) exactly below (C) behind (D) i t will never reach the earth Q. 4
6 A space ship of mass m is in circular orbit o f radius 2R about the earth ofma
ss M and radius R . Energy required to transfer the space ship to circular orbit
of radius 3R is GMm GMm GMm GMm ( ) 8R ( > 24R7 e e e A C Q.47 A particle is pr
ojected from the mid-point of the line joining two fixed pa rticles each of mass
m. If the distance of separation between thefixedparticles is /, the minimum ve
locity of projection of the particle so as to escape is equa l to GM GM , 2GM ,
2GM (A)J (B ) J (C)J (D)2/ V2/ I I v x W Q.48 The escape velocity for a planet is
v . Atunnel is dug along a diameter oft he planet and a small body is dropped i
nto it at the surface. When the body reac hes the centre of the planet, its spee
d will be e (A) v e (B)^ (C) y (D)zero & Bansal Classes Question Bank on Gravita
tion [280] 4lBan
nanimpulse Q.49 A per son brings a mass of 1 kg from infinity to a point A. Init
ially the m ass was at rest but it moves at a speed of 2 m/s as it reaches A. Th
e work done by the person on the mass is -3 J. The potential at Ais: (A) -3 J/kg
(B) -2 J/kg (C) -5 J/kg (D)-7 J/kg Q.50 A small ball of mass'm' is released at
a height'R' above the earth surface, as shown in thefigureabove. Ifthe maximum d
epth ofthe b all to which it goes is R/2 inside the earth through a narrow grove
before comin g to rest momentarily. The grove, contain an ideal spring of sprin
g constant K a nd natural length R, find the value of K if R is radius of earth
and M mass of e arth 3 GMm 6GMm (A) R (B) R 7 GMm 9GMm (C) " R ^ (D) R 3 3 3 equ
al to the iystem. e to gravity o that from where the Q.51 The magnitude of the p
otential energy per unit mass ofthe object at the sur face of earth is E. Then t
he escape velocity ofthe object is: (A)V2E (B)4E (C)VE (D)2E 2 Q.52 Suppose a sm
ooth tunnel is dug along a straight line joining two points on the surface ofthe
earth and a particle is dropped from rest at its one end. Assu me that mass of
earth is uniformly distributed over its Volume. Then (A) the par ticle will emer
ge from the other end with velocity GM where M and R^. are earth' s mass 2R and r
adius respectively, (B) the particle will come to rest at centre o fthe tunnel b
ecause at this position, particle is closest to earth centre. (C) p otential ene
rgy of the particle will be equal to zero at centre oftunnel if it i s along a d
iameter. (D) acceleration of the particle will be proportional to its distancefr
ommidpoint ofthe tunnel. r e 1 e tl . Energy e Q.53 A hollow spherical shell is
compressed to half its radius. The gravitationa l potential at the centre (A)inc
reases (B) decreases (C) remains same (D) during the compression increases then
returns at the previous value. Q.54 A body is pr ojection horizontallyfromthe su
rface of the Earth (radius = R) with a velocity e qual to 'n' times the escape v
elocity. Neglect rotational effects of the earth. The maximum height attained by
the body from the Earth's surface is R/2. Then, ' n' must be (A) V06 (B) (V3J/2
(C)V04 (D)None Q.55 Consider two configurations of a system ofthree particles o
f masses m, 2m and 3m. The work done by external ag ent in changing the configur
ation of the systemfromfigure(i) tofigure(ii) is 6Gm .2 /1 + J J (A)zero (B) (C)
6Gm' , V2, (D)6Gm V2, 2 s m. If the he particle 3M all body is nr a 1
figure(i) 5" 2m m a v>3 figure(ii) A 2m m 1*1 <JjBansal Classes Question Bank on Gra
vitation 72, [9]
Q. 56 Two satellites of mass rrij & m are in same circular orbit around earth bu
t are revolving in opposite sense. When they undergo completely inelastic colli
s ion, the combination (A) continues in same orbit (B) goes to a circular orbit
of lesser radius (C) goes in an elliptical orbit within the original circle (D)
go es in an elliptical orbit outside the original circle 2 Q. 57 A uniform spher
ical planet (Radius R) has acceleration due to gravity at i ts surface g. Points
P and Q located inside and outside the planet have accelera tion due to gravity
. Maximum possible separation between P and Q is 7R 3R 9R (A ) (B) (O (D) none / A
g Q. 5 8 A particle is dropped on Earthfromheight R (radius of Earth) and it bo
unc es back to a height R/2 the coefficient of restitution for collision is (ign
ore air resistance and rotation of Earth) (A)f (B)JI (C)JI (D)j! Q. 5 9 A body o
f ma ss m is lifted upfromthe surface of the earth to a height three times the r
adius of the earth. The change in potential energy of the body is (A) 3mgR (B) 3
/4 mg R (C) 1/3 mgR (D) 2/3 mgR where g is acceleration due to gravity at the su
rface of earth. Q.60 Two satellites S and S describe circular orbits ofradiusr a
nd 2r respectively around a planet. Ifthe orbital angular velocity of S is co, t
hat of S is: (A) <b/(2V2) (B) (GW2)/3 (C) <a/2 (D) cW2 l 2 { 2 c Q ^ Q. 61 When
a satellite moves around the earth in a certain orbit, the quantity w hich remai
ns constant is : (A) angular velocity (B) kinetic energy (C) aerial ve locity (D
) potential energy Q. 6 2 A satellite is launched into a circular orbit ofradius
R around the earth. A second satellite is launched into an orbit ofrad ius 1.02
R. The period of second satellite is larger than thefirstone by approxim ately ^
(A) 1.5% (B)3% (C)l% (D) 2% Q. 63 Asatellite ofmass 5M orbits the earth in a ci
rcular orbit. At one point in its orbit, the satellite explodes into two Q piece
s, one ofmass M and the other of mass 4M. After the explosion the mass M ends up
travelling in the same circular orbit, but in opposite direction. After explosi
on the mass 4M is in (A) bound orbit (B) unbound orbit q (C) partially bo und or
bit (D) data is insufficient to determine the nature of the orbit. Q. 64 A satel
lite can be in a geostationary orbit around a planet at a distance rfromth e cen
tre of the planet. If the angular velocity of the planet about its axis dou bles
, a satellite can now be in a geostationary orbit around the planet if its d ist
ancefromthe centre ofthe planet is (A)^ (B)^ (C)-^TTT (D)-^TJ & Bansal Classes Q
uestion Bank on Gravitation [10] 4lBan
in opposite Q-65 Aplanetofmass mis in an elliptical orbit about the sun ( m M )
with an orbi tal period T. IfA bethe area of orbit, then its angular momentum wo
uld be: 2mA m A (B)mAT (D) 2mAT (A) (C) TT s u n nts P and Q 3 separation Q. 66
The planets with radii Rj, Rj have densities p,, p respectively. Their atm osphe
ric pressures are pj, p respectively. Therefore, the ratio of masses ofthei r at
mospheres, neglecting variation of g within the limits of atmosphere, is (A) p R
p /p R p (B)p,R p /p R p (C)p R p /p R p (D) p R p /p R p 2 1 2 1 2 1 2 2 2 2 1
1 ] 1 1 2 2 2 1 ] 2 2 2 1 2 ght R/2 the Q. 67 Suppose the gravitational force v
aries inversely as the n power of distanc e. Then the time period of a planet in
circular orbit of radius R around the sun will be proportional to n-2 n+1 n-1 2
(C)R (D) R' 2 (B) RV 2 (A)R th N >fthe earth. Q. 68 A satellite is seen after e
very 6 hours over the equator. It is known that it rotates opposite to that of e
arth's direction. Then the angular velocity oft he satellite about the centre of
earth will be: (A) 7c/2 rad/hr (B) n/3 rad/hr ( C) n/4 rad/hr (D) 7t/8 rad/hr Q
. 69 A satellite is orbiting round the earth. In a particular orbit its time per
iod is T and orbital speed is V. In another orbit the orbital speed is 2V, then
time period will be (A) 8T (B)2T (C) T/2 (D)T/8 Q . 70 In a double star system,
the masses ofthe two stars are M and 3M. The orbit radius of the lighter star is
R. The time period of each star is (A) 8TC[R3/GM] (B) 1 6 T I [ R / G M ] (C)4T
T[2R3/GM] (D)None 1/2 anet. If the ant is: 3 1/2 1/2 y :hed into an 'ly les into
two elling in the Figure shows the orbit of a planet P round the sun S. AB and
CD are ^ the minor and major axes ofthe ellipse. Q. 71 If t, is the time taken b
y the planet to tra vel along ACB and ^ the time along BDA, then (A)tj=t2 (B)t >
t (C)tj<t (D) nothin g can be concluded h 1 2 2 Question No. 71 to 72 V
Q. 72 If U is the potential energy and K kinetic energy then |U| > |K| at (A) On
ly D (B)OnlyC (C) both D & C (D) neither D nor C Q. 73 If a tunnel is cut at an
y orientation through earth, then a ball released from one end will reach the ot
h er end intime(neglect earth rotation) (A) 84.6 minutes (B) 42.3 minutes (C) 8
mi nutes (D) depends on orientation e planet. If jnary orbit & Ban sal Classes Q
uestion Bank on Gravitation [283] 4lBan
Questions 74 to 79 (6 questions) Two stars bound together by gravity orbit each
other because oftheir mutual attraction. Such a pair of stars is referred to as
a binary star system. One type ofbinary system is that ofa black hole and a comp
anion star. The black hole is a star that has collapsed on itselfand is so mass
i ve that not even light rays can escape its gravitational pull. Therefore, when
d escribing the relative motion of a black hole and a companion star, the motio
n o fthe black hole can be assumed negligible compared to that ofthe companion.
The orbit ofthe companion star is either elliptical with the black hole at one o
fthe foci or circular with the black hole at the centre. The gravitational poten
tial energy is given by U = - GmM/r, where G is the universal gravitational cons
tant , m is the mass of the companion star, M is the mass of the black hole, and
r is the distance between the centre of the companion star and the centre of th
e bla ck hole. Since the gravitational force is conservative, the companion star
's tot al mechanical energy is a constant of the motion. Because ofthe periodic
nature ofthe orbit, there is a simple relation between the average kinetic energ
y <K > ofthe companion star and its average potential energy < U>. In particular
, <K> = -<U/2> Two special points along the orbit are singled out by astronomers
. Perig ee is the point at which the companion star is closest to the black hole
, and ap ogee is the point at which it is furthestfromthe black hole. Q. 74 At w
hich poin t in the elliptical orbit does the companion star attain its maximum k
inetic ene rgy? (A) Apogee (B) Perigee (C) The point midwayfromapogee to perigee
(D) All po ints in the orbit, since the kinetic energy is a constant of the mot
ion. Q.75 Fo r circular orbits, the potential energy ofthe companion star is con
stant through out the orbit. If the radius ofthe orbit doubles, what is the new
value of the v elocity of the companion star? (A) It is 1/2 ofthe old value (B)
It is 1/V2 ofth e old value (C) It is the same as the old value. (D) It is doubl
e the old value Q. 76 Which ofthe following prevents the companion starfromleavi
ng its orbit and falling into the black hole? (A) The centripetal force (B) The
gravitational fo rce (C) The companion star's potential energy (D) the companion
star's kinetic e nergy Q. 77 The work done on the companion star in one complet
e orbit by the gra vitational force ofthe black hole equals (A) the difference i
n the kinetic energ y ofthe companion star between apogee and perigee. (B) the t
otal mechanical ener gy ofthe companion star (C)zero (D) the gravitational force
on the companion sta r times the distance that it travels in one orbit. Q.78 Fo
r a circular orbit, wh ich ofthe following gives the correct expression for the
total energy? (A) - (1/ 2) mv (B)mv (C)-(GmM)/r (D)(GmM)/2r 2 2 Q. 79 What is th
e ratio of the acceleration of the black hole to that ofthe comp anion star? (A)
M / m (B)m/M (C)mM/r (D) 1 /1 1*1 <JjBansalClasses Question Bank on Gravitation
[12]
>air of stars ianion star, i escape its on star, the ar with the re G is the c h
ole, and Since the ant of the ige kinetic =-<U/2> .ompanion >le. y? ee -bit. If
t he ONE OR MORE THAN ONE OPTION MAY BE CORRECT Take approx. 3 minutes for answe
ring each question. Q. 1 Assuming the earth to be a sphere ofuniform density the
acceleration due to gravity (A) at a point outside the earth is inversely propo
rtional to the squar e of its distancefromthe centre (B) at a point outside the
earth is inversely pr oportional to its distancefromthe centre (C) at a point in
side is zero (D) at a point inside is proportional to its distancefromthe centre
. Q2 Mark the correct statement/s (A) Gravitational potential at curvature centr
e of a thin hemispheri cal shell of radius R and mass M is equal to GM R (B) Gra
vitationalfieldstrength at a point lying on the axis of a thin, uniform circular
ring ofradius R and GM x mass M is equal to (K 2+x 2x3/2 where x is distance of
that pointfromcentre of the ring. ,T> ) (C) Nekton's law of gravitation for gra
vitational force between two bodies is applicable only when bodies have spherica
lly symmetric distributi on of mass. (D) None of these. Three particles are proj
ected vertically upward f rom a point on the surface of the earth with velocitie
s V(2gR/3), V(gR), V(4gR/3 ) respectively where R is the radius ofthe earth and
g is the acceleration due t o gravity on the surface ofthe earth. The maximum he
ights attained are respectiv ely h,,!^,!^. (A) hj: h = 2 : 3 (B) h^: h = 3 :4 (C
)h,: 1^=1:4 (D) h ^ R 2 3 Q.3 lack hole? ole equals Q4 A geostationary satellite
is at a height h above the surface of earth. If earth radius is R (A) The minim
um colatitude q on earth upto which the satellite can b e used for communication
is sin- (R/R + h). (B) The maximum colatitudes q on ear th upto which the satel
lite can be used for communication is sin" (R/R + h). (C) The area on earth esca
pedfromthis satellite is given as 2pR (1 + sinq) (D) The area on earth escapedfr
omthis satellite is given as 2pR (1 + cosq) 1 1 2 2 Q5 & Gravitational potential
at the centre of curvature of a hemispherical bowl of ra dius R and mass M is V
. (A) gravitational potential at the centre of curvature o f a thin uniform wire
of mass M, bent into a semicircle of radius R, is also equ al to V. (B) In part
(A) if the same wire is bent into a quarter of a circle the n also the gravitat
ional potential at the centre of curvature will be V. (C) In part (A) if the sam
e wire mass is nonuniformly distributed along its length and it is bent into a s
n
BANSAL CLASSES TARGETIIT JEE 2007 XI (P, Q, R, S) ill s C O N T E N T S KEY CONC
EPTS EXERCISE-I EXERCISE -II EXERCISE-III ANSWER KEY
KEY CONCEPTS THINGS TO REMEMBER ds dv dv v = ; a = = v ; s = Jvdt; have their us
ual meaning . The equations line with uniform acceleration, are , 1* - \(m) 2v 2_L1 2as ' v + u^ (iv) s = u v u + V t a t a t 2 n 2. If a body is thrown verti
cally up with a velocity u in the uniform gravitational field then (neglecting a
ir resistance): (i) Maximum height attained H= (ii) Tim e of ascent = time of de
scent = g 2u (iii) Total time of flight (iv) Velocity of fall at the point of pr
ojection=u downwards : KINEMATIC GRAPH: Slope ofthe displacement time graph at a
ny particular time give s the magnitude ofthe instantaneous velocity at that par
ticular time. Slope ofth e v -1 graph will give the magnitude of the instantaneo
us acceleration. The area between the v - t graph, the time axis and the ordinat
es erected at the beginni ng & end oftime interval considered will represent the
total displacement of the body. 5. RELATIVE VELOCITY: (a) Velocity of 'A' relat
ive to 'B' is given by V = V - V V refers to the velocity which 'A' appears to h
ave as seen by B. The abov e idea of 1 dimensional relative motion can be extend
ed to motion in 2 dimension s. (b) Angular velocity of A relative to B i.e. co i
s given by velocityof Arelat ivetoBinadirectionperpendiculartoAB AB AB 6. LEVEL G
ROUND PROJECTILE MOTION: When abody is thrown obliquely (in a vertical plane) in
to the uniform gravitationalf ieldthen the trajectory (actual path of motion) is
a parabola. The horizontal co mponent of velocity ucos a remains unchanged wher
e as vertical component decreas es up to the maximum height and then increases.
(a) Time taken to reach the heig ht point t ^ usina i y (minimum (b) Maximum hei
ght H - u sm a velocity) 2g AB A B AB AB = 2 2 (c) Total time of flight =2t u co
s a H (d) Horizontal range = (ucos a). T= - (ucos a) (usina) v u sin 2 a 2 u c o
s a
= Ja dt ; = Ja ds dt dt ds where the symbols ofmotion for a body moving in strai
ght u + (i) v = u + at (ii) s=|r11 = ut h=v t r + ^ a ( 2 n - l ) (v)
[Figure 1] >x ^Bansal Classes (e) Rm if a = 45 ' Note that for a given velocity o
fprojection & a given horizont al range there are in general two directions of p
roj ection which are complement ofeach other and are equally inclined to the dir
ection ofthe maximum range. Kinematics [2]
(F) VELOCITY & DIRECTION O F MOTION A T A GIVEN TIME : VcosB =ucosa Squaring & a
dding these 2 equations we will get the velocity of the VsinB =usina-gt projecti
le. Dividing the velocities in y and x directions gives the direction of motion.
V cos 0 =u cos a on adding V = u - 2 gh V sin 0 =u sin a-2gh_ 2 2 2 2 2 2 2 2 2
2 ( g ) VELOCITY & DIRECTION O F MOTION A T A GIVEN HEIGHT H : ( h ) EQUATIONS
O F MOTION IN VECTOR NOTATION : (i) V=u+ gt (ii) S=ut+gt (iii) V = -=u+-gt (V = a
verage velocity vector) 2 2 av t 2. av (i) EQUATION O F TRAJECTORY : gx - x tan
a 2u cos a v Ry dy Note that represent the direction of motion dx 7. PROJECTILE
UP AN INCLINED PLANE : (a) Total time of flight onthe inclined plane 2 / (aT _ 2u
sincosp P ) // \ s g Oblique Proj ection (refer fig-1) y = x tan a 2 2 / (b) Ra
nge PQ on the inclined plane PQ 2u cosa . sin(a-P) g cos p 2 2 (c) (d) (e) W 71
ForMaxmimumrange 2 a - P = =>a= u Z* +p ^ T " Hence the direction for maximum r an
ge bisects the angle between the vertical and the inclined plane. R = u 2 max gc
os (3 [sin (2 a - P) - sinP] kf N Greatest distance ofthe projectile from the in
clined plane; u sin (a-p) 2 2
g(l+sinP) S = 2g cosp when the projectile is at H, its velocity perpendicular to
the plane is zero. 8. PROJECTILE DOWN AN INCLINED PLANE: (a) Time offlight= ' (
P) (b) (c ) (d) gcosp Range OP 2u sin(a + p). cosa g cos p u Maximum range= g(l
-sinp) 2 2 2 u s n a + 7 _p C Angle ofproj ection a for maximum range= 4 2 faBan
sal Classes Kinematics [3]
Q.l Q. 2 Q.3 Q.4 Q.5 A butterfly is flying with velocity 10 i +12 j m/s and wind
is blowing along x a xis with velocity u. If butterfly starts motionfromA and a
fter some time reaches point B,findthe value of u. EXERCISE - / y B 37 Find the c
hange in velocity of the tip of the minute hand (radius =10 cm) of a c lock in 4
5 minutes. A,B&Care threeobjects each movingwith constant velocity. A's speed is
lOm/sec in a direction pQ. The velocity of B relative to A is 6 m/sec at an ang
le of, cos (15/24) to PQ. The velocity of C relative to B is 12 m/sec i n a dire
at est height ^2/5 is of its speed when it is at its half the maximum height. Th
e a ngle ofproj ection is and the velocity vector angle at half the maximum heig
ht i s . Q.25 A weightless inextensible rope on a stationary wedge forming angle
a wi th the horizontal. One end of the rope is fixed to the wall at point A. A
small load is attached to the rope at point B. The wedge starts moving to therig
htwith a constant acceleration. Determine the acceleration a, ofthe load when it
is st ill on the wedge. 777777777777/ Q.26 The horizontal range of a projectile
s is R and the maximum height attained by it is H. A strong wind now begins to b
low in the direction of motion of the p rojectile, giving it a constant horizont
al acceleration = g/2. Under the same co nditions ofproj ection, find the horizo
ntal range of the proj ectile. Q .27 Cons ider the acceleration of a particle fo
r a given time't' at 'a' m/s followed imme diately by retardation at the same ra
te of'a' m/s for time 't/2', as one cycle. If the particle startedfromrest,findt
he distance travelled by it after 'n' such cycles in succession. 2 2 Q. 2 8 A pa
rticle is thrown horizontally with relative velocity 10 m/sfroman inc lined plan
e, which is also moving with acceleration 10 m/s vertically upward. Fi nd the ti
me after which it lands on the plane (g = 10 m/s ) ^ 2 2 10m/s 3 0 2 faBansal Cl
asses Kinematics [6]
Q. 1 A steel ball bearing is releasedfromthe roof of a building. An observer sta
nding infrontof a window 120 cm high observes that the ball takes 0.125 sec to
f all from top to the bottom of the window. The ball continutes to fall & makes
a completely elastic collision with side walk & reappears at the bottom of the w
in dow 2 s after passing it on the way down. How tall is the building ? Q. 2 A t
rai n takes 2 minutes to acquire its full speed 60kmphfromrest and 1 minute to c
ome to restfromthe full speed. If somewhere in between two stations 1 km ofthe t
rack be under repair and the limited speed on this part be fixed to 20kmph, find
the late running ofthe train on account of this repair work, assuming otherwise
nor mal at running of the train between the stations. Q. 3 A speeder in an auto
mobil e passes a stationary policeman who is hiding behind a bill board with a m
otorcy cle. After a 2.0 sec delay (reaction time) the policeman accelerates to h
is maxi mum speed of 150 km/hr in 12 sec and catches the speeder 1.5 km beyond t
he billb oard. Find the speed of speeder in km/hr. Q. 4 Q.5 Q. 6 Q.7 Q. 8 (a) (b
) Q. 9 Q. 10 Q. 11 (i) (ii) (iii) Aballoon is ascending vertically with an accel
eration o f 0.2m/s , Two stones are droppedfromit at an interval of 2 sec. Find
the distan ce between them 1.5 sec after the second stone is released.(use g=9.8
m/s ) 2 2 EXERCISE # III A ship steaming north at the rate of 12 km/h observes a
ship due east to itself and distant 10 km, which steaming due west at the rate
of 16 km/h. After what ti me they are at least distancefromone another and what
is this least distance. An aeroplane is observed by two persons travelling at 60
km/hr in two vehicles mov ing in opposite directions on a straight road. To an
observer in one vehicle the plane appears to cross the road track at right angle
s while to the observer in the other vehicle the angle appears to be 45. At what
angle does the plane actual ly cross the road track and what is its speed relati
ve to the ground. A girl can paddle her canoe at 5m/sec. in still water. She wis
hes to cross a straight rive r which is flowing at 3m/sec. At what angle to the
river bank should she steer t o cross, (a) as quickly as possible, (b) by the sh
ortest route. How long will ap lane take to fly around a square with side a with
the wind blowing at a velocity u, in the two cases the direction ofthe wind coi
ncides with one ofthe sides the direction ofthe wind coincides with one diagonal
ofthe square. The velocity oft he plane in still air is v > u. Two ships A and
B originally at a distance d fro m each other depart at the same time from a str
aight coastline. Ship A moves alo ng a straight line perpendicular to the shore
while ship B constantly heads for ship A, having at each moment the same speed a
s the latter. After a sufficiently great interval oftime the second ship will ob
viously follow thefirstone at a ce rtain distance. Find the distance. The slopes
of the wind-screen of two motorcar s are p = 3 0 and p = 15 respectively. The fir
st car is travelling with a velocity of v horizontally. The second car is travel
ling with a velocity v in the same d irection. The hail stones are falling verti
cally. Both the drivers observe that the hail stones rebound vertically after el
astic collision with the wind-screen. Find the ratio of v,/v A rocket is launche
b are cons tants & x and y are respectively the horizontal & vertical distances
ofthe proje ctilefromthe point ofprojection. The maximum height attained is & th
e angle of p rojectionfromthe horizontal is . [JEE' 1997] 2 Q. 3 Q.4 (a) (b) Q.5
(i) (ii) Q.6 Q.7 A large heavy box is sliding without friction down a smooth pl
ane of inclination 9. From a point P on the bottom ofa box, a particle is proj e
cted inside the bo x. The'initial speed ofthe particle with respect to box is u
and the direction o f projection makes an angle a with the bottom as shown in fi
gure. ithe particle lands. (Assume that the particle does not litany other surfa
ce of the box. Negle ct air resistance). , ' Ifthe horizontal displacement ofthe
particle as seen by an observer on the ground is zero,findthe speed of the box
with respect to the g round at the instant when the particle was projected. [JEE
' 1998] A particle of mass 10~ kg is moving slong the positive x-axis under the
influence of a force K F(x)= whereK= 10 Nm .Attimet = 0itisatx-1.0m&itsvelocityis
v = 0. Find: 2x its ti me at when it reaches x = 0.25 m. thevelocitywhich it rea
ches x = 0.5 0 m [JEE' 1998] In 1.0 sec. a particle goesfrompoint Ato point B mo
ving in a semicircle of radius 1.0 m. The magnitude of average velocity is: [JEE
'99] (A) 3.14 m/sec (B) 2.0 m/sec im (C) 1.0 m/sec (D) zero BThe co-ordinates o
f a particle moving in a plane are given by x (t) = a cos (7it) and y (t) = b si
n (rat) where a, b (<a) & n are positive constants of appropriate dimensions. (A
) the path of the partic le is an ellipse (B) the velocity & acceleration of the
particle are normal to e ach other at t = n/(2n) (C) the acceleration ofthe par
ticle is always directed t owards a focus (D) the distance travelled by the part
icle in time interval t = 0 o t = n/(2n) is a. [JEE' 1999] 2 _2 2 2 ^Bansal Clas
ses Kinematics [9]
Q. 8 A ball is dropped verticallyfroma height d above the ground it hits the gro
und a nd bounces up vertically to a height dl2. Neglecting subsequent motion and
air r esistances, its velocity v varies with the height h above the ground as [
JEE'200 0 (Scr)] (A) (B) (C) (D) An object A is kept fixed at the point x = 3 m
and y = 1.25 m on a plank P raise d above the ground. At time t = 0 the plank st
arts moving along the+x direction with an acceleration 1.5 m/s . At the A same i
nstant a stone is projectedfromthe origin with a velocity u as 1.25m shown. A st
ationary person on the ground obse rves the stone hitting the object during its
downward motion at an angle of 45 to the horizontal. All the motions are in x-y p
lane. Find u and the time after Z 3 .0 m o i which the stone hits the object. Ta
ke g = 10 m/s . [JEE 2000] Q. 10 On africtionlesshorizontal surface, assumed to
be the x-y plane, a small trolley A is moving along a straight line parallel to
the y-axis (seefigure)with a constan t velocity of (V3 -1) m/s. At a particular
instant, when the line OA makes an an gle of 45 with the x-axis, a ball is thrown
along the surfacefromthe origin 0. It s velocity makes an angle <j) with the xaxis and it hits the trolley. o /V (a) The motion ofthe ball is observedfromthef
rameof trolley Calculate the angle 0 ma de by the velocity vector of the ball wi
th the x-axis in this frame. - 49 [JEE 2 002] (b) Find the speed of the ball wit
h respect to the surface, if 4> = . 2 2 5 Q.9 Q. 11 A particle startsfromrest. I
ts acceleration (a) versus time (t) is as show n a* in the figure. The maximum s
peed ofthe particle will be 10m/s [JEE 2004 (Sc r)] (A) 110 m/s (B) 55 m/s (C) 5
50 m/s (D) 660 m/s 2 11 t(s) Q. 12 A small block slides withoutfrictiondown an in
clined plane startingfromres t. Let Sn be the distance 2n 2n-l 2n - 1 2n + 1 (C)
2n + l (D) 2n + l (A) 2n (B) 2 n - l Q. 13 The velocity displacement graph of a
particle moving along a stra ight line is shown. The most suitable acceleration
-displacement graph will be v 7 travelledfromtime t = n -1 to t=n. Then 7 is ^nl-l S n [JEE' 2004 (Scr)] TfT-X (A) (B) (C) (D) [JEE 2005 (Scr)] faBansal Classe
s
Kinematics [10]
ANSWER KEY EXERCISE # I Q.l Q.4 Q.8 Q.12 6m/s tan (1/2) -1 Q.2 Q.5 Q.9 Q.13 1 W2
I 5s v8gy r axi/min Q.6 36.2 sec. Q.3 Q-7 Q.ll 5 m/sec 20V5 S7T 0 3/4 7IV Q.10 2
0 sec Q.14 100/3 m/s Q.18 75m B 2 1 ax Q.15 10 m/s Q.19 lm Q.22 5 m/s Q.25 2asin
(a/2) Q.16 2tan- (l/3) ptp Q.20 /n(2) Q.23 8m a Q.17 1 sec p Q.21 a = l m / s H
, a = 2 m / s t Q.24 60, tan" ( f i f i ) Q.27 n(3n + 4) at , Q.28 ^ sec 1 Q.26 R
+ 2H Q.l Q.4 Q.7 Q.8 Q.10 Q.12 Q.13 Q.16 Q.19 Q.l EXERCISE # 77 Q.2 160 sec 20.
5 m Q.5 24 min, 6 km 50m (a) 90, (b) 127 to the river flow 2 2 v y y 8 Q.3 Q.6 122
ow long will i t take fo. uie passenger to arrive at the top if he walks up the
moving escalato r ? (A) 30 sec (B) 45 sec (C) 40 sec t D) 35 sec Q.14 The co-ord
inates of a movi ng particle at a time t, are give by, x = 5 sin 101, y = 5 cos
1 Ot. The speed o f the particle is : (A) 25 " (B) 50 (G) 10 (D) None Q. 15 Tang
ential acceleration of a particle moving in a circle of radius 1 m var ies with
time t as (initial velocity of particle is zero). Time after which tota l accele
ration oi particle makes and urgl of 30 with radial acceleration is (A) 4 sec (B)
4/3 sec (C) 2 sec (D) ^2 m s e c time (sec) Q.16 A particle is proj ected from
a horizontal plane (x-z plane) such that its velocity vector at time t is given
by V = ai + (b - ct) j Its range on the horiz ontal plane is given by 3ba 2ba ba
(D) None (C) (B) (A) Bansal Classes
Question Bank on Kinematics [3]
Q.17 v-t graph of an obj ect of mass 1 kg is shown (A) net work done on the obje
ct in 30 sec is zero. (B) the average acceleration of the object is zero. (C) t
h e average velocity of the object is zero. (D) the average force on the object
is zero. v (m/s) 20-10-10 20 30 t(sec) Q. 18 A projectile of mass 1 kg is projec
ted with a velocity of V20 m/s such tha t it strikes on the same level as the po
int of projection at a distance of V3 m. Which of the following options are inco
rrect: (A) the maximum height reached by the projectile can be 0.25 m. (B) the m
inimum velocity during its motion can be Vl5 m/s (C) the minimum time taken for
the flight can be sec. (D) maximum poten tial energy during its motion can be 6J
. Q. 19 Velocity-time graph for a car is semicircle as shown here. Which of the
following is correct: (A) Car must move i n circular path. (B) Acceleration of c
ar is never zero, (C) Mean speed ofthe par ticle is n/2 m/s. (D) The car makes a
turn once during its motion. lm/s 2 sec V1 Q.20 A ball is projected from top of
a tower with a velocity of 5 m/s at an angl e of 53 to horizontal. Its speed whe
n it is at a height of 0.45 m from the point of projection is : (A) 2 m/s (B) 3
m/s (C)4m/s (D) data insufficient. Q.21 A par ticle moves along a straight line
in such a way that it's acceleration is increa sing at the rate of 2 m/s . It's
initial acceleration and velocity were 0, the d istance,covered by it in t = 3 s
econd is. (A) 27 m (B) 9 m (C) 3 m (D) 1 m 3 Q.22 A flag is mounted on a car mov
ing due North with velocity of 20 km/hr. Stro ng winds are blowing due East with
velocity of 20 km/hr. The flag will point in direction (A) East (B) North - Eas
t (C) South - East (D) South - West Q.23 A bal l is thrown vertically down with
velocity of 5m/s. With what velocity should ano ther ball be thrown down after 2
seconds so that it can hit the 1 ball in 2 seco nds (A) 40 m/s (B) 55 m/s (C) 1
5 m/s (D) 25 m/s st B Q.24 A man is crossing a river flowing with velocity of 5
m/s. He reaches a po int' directly across at a distance of 60 m in 5 sec. His ve
locity in still water should be \T=5 / 60 m (A) 12 m/s (B) 13 m/s (C) 5 m/s (D)
10 m/s m s Q. 2 5 Average velocity of a particle is proj ectile motion between i
ts starting point and the highest point of its trajectory is: (projection speed
= u, angle of projection from horizontal 0) (A) u cosG (B) ^Vl + 3cos 9 2 (C) ^V'
2 + COS 0 2 (D) U + COS
<6 Bansal Classes Question Bank on Kinematics m
Q.26 Find time of flight of projectile thrown horizontally with speed 50 ms from
a long inclined plane which makes an angle of 6 = 45 from horizontal. (A) 10V2 s
ec (B) 20V2 sec (C) 10 sec (D) 5-Jl sec -1 Q.27 Particle is dropped from the he
ight of 20m from horizontal ground. There is wind blowing due to which horizonta
l acceleration of the particle becomes 6 ms . Find the horizontal displacement o
f the particle till it reaches ground. (A) 6 m (B)10m (C) 12 m (D) 24 m -2 Q.28
A bail is dropped from height 5m. The time after which ball stops reboundin g if
coefficient of restitution between ball and ground e = 1/2, is (A) 1 sec (B ) 2
sec (C) 3 sec (D) infinite Q.29 A ball is hit by a batsman at an angle of 37 as
shown in figure. The man standing at P should run at what minimum velocity so th
at he catches the ball before it strikes the ground. Assume that height of ma n
is negligible in comparison to maximum height of projectile. (A) 3 ms" (B) 5 m s
" (C) 9 ms(D) 12 ms" 1 1 Q.30 Find the velocity of the hanging block if the velo
cities of the free ends o f the rope are as indicated in the figure. (A) 3/2 m/s
t (B) 3/2 m/s I (C) 1/2 m /s T (D) 1/2 m/s 4 2m/s IU.LJJ1I mi."" lm/s Q.31 A ma
n swimming down stream overcome a float at a point M. After travelling distance
D he turned back and passed the float at-a distance of D/2 from the poi nt M, th
en the ratio of speed of swimmer with respect to still water to the spee d of th
e river will be (A) 2 (B) 3 (C) 4 (D) 2.5 Q.32 Choose the correct alterna tive (
s) (A) If the greatest height to which a man can throw a stone is h, then the gr
eatest horizontal distance upto which he can throw the stone is 2h-. (B) T he an
gle of projection for a projectile motion whose range R is n times the maxi mum
height is tan (4/n) (C) The time of flight T and the horizontal range R of a pro
jectile are connected by the equation gT = 2Rtan9 v. here 0 is the angle of proj
ection. (D) A ball is thrown vertically up. Another ball is thrown at an ang le
0 with the vertical. Both of them remain in air for the same period of time. The
n the ratio of heights attained by the two balls 1:1. -1 2 Q.33 Acceleration ver
sus velocity graph ofa particle moving in a straight line s tarting from rest is
as shown in figure. The corresponding velocity-time graph w ould be (A) (B) (D)
1*1<JjBansalClasses Question Bank on G r a v i t a t i o n [5]
Q.34 Aparticle is projected vertically upwards from a point Aon the ground. It t
akes t time to reach a point B but it still continues to move up. If it takes f
u rther tj time to reach the ground from point B then height of point Bfromthe g
ro und is 1 (A) | g ( t ! + t ) (C)|g(t,+t y (B) g t, t (D) g t , t . Q.35 Mark
the correct statements for a particle going on a straight line (A) if the veloci
ty is zero a t any instant, the acceleration should also be zero at that instant
(B) if the v elocity is zero for a time interval, the acceleration is zero at a
ny instant wit hin the time interval (C) if the velocity and acceleration have o
pposite sign, t he object is slowing down (D) if the position and velocity have
opposite sign, t he particle is moving towards the origin 2 2 2 2 Q.36 A project
ile is fired with a speed u at an angle 0 with the horizontal. Its speed when it
s direction of motion makes an angle 'a' with the horizontal is (A ) u sec0 cosa
(B) u sec0 sina (C) u cos0 seca (D) u sin 0 seca Q.37 Balls are th rown vertica
lly upward in such a way that the next ball is thrown when the previ ous one is
at the maximum height. If the maximum height is 5m, the number of bal ls thrown
per minute will be (A) 40 (B) 50 (C) 60 (D) 120 Q.38 A projectile is f ired with
a velocity at right angle to the slope which is inclined at an angle 0 with the
horizontal. The expression for the range R along the incline is 2v 2v 2v sec (B)
- t a n 0 (C) tan0 sec 0 (D) -tan 0 (A) 2 : i : 2 Q.39 A bead is free to slide d
own a smooth wire tightly stretched between points A and B on a vertical circle.
If the bead starts from rest at A, the highest po int on the Gircle (A) its vel
ocity v on arriving at B is proportional to cos0 (B ) its velocity v on arriving
at B is proportional to tan0 (C) time to arrive at B is proportional to cos0 (D
) time to arrive at B is independent of 0 Q.40 The v elocity- time graph of a bo
dy falling from rest under gravity and rebounding fro m a solid surface is repre
sented by which ofthe following graphs? v v (D) (C) (B ). (A) -t -> t Q.41 A disc
arranged in a vertical plane has two groves of same le ngth directed along the
vertical chord AB and CD as shown inthefig.The same part icles slide down along
AB and CD. The ratio of the time t /t is (A) 1 : 2 (B) 1 : V2 (C) 2 : 1 (D) 4 l
1 AB CD Q.42 The magnitude of displacement of a particle moving in a circle of r
adius a with constant angular speed co varies with time t as cot (D) 2a cos cot
(C) 2a c os cot (B) 2a sin(A) 2 a sincot 1*1<JjBansalClasses Question Bank on G
r a v i t a t i o n [6]
Q.43 A glass wind screen whose inclination with the vertical can be changed is m
ounted on a car. The car moves horizontally with a speed of 2m/s. At what angle
a with the vertical should the wind screen be placed so that the rain drops fal
l ing vertically downwards with velocity 6 m/s strike the wind screen perpendicu
la rly. (A) tan-'(3) (B) tan- (l/3) (C) cos-'P) (D) s u r ^ l ^ ) Q.44 A particl
e i s projected vertically upwards from O with velocity v and a second particle
is p rojected at the same instant from P (at a height h above O) with velocity v
at a n angle of projection 0. The time when the distance between them is minimu
m is h (C) h/v (D) h/2v (A) 2vsin0 (B) 2vcos0 Q.45 A body moves with velocity v
= / n x m/s where x is its position. The net force acting on body is zero at: (A
) 0 m (B) x = e m (C) x = e m (D) x = 1 m Q.46 Wind is blowing in the north dire
ction at speed of 2 m/s which causes the rain to fall at some angle with the ver
tical. With what velocity should a cyclist drive so that the rain appears vertic
al to him : (A) 2 m/s south (B) 2 m/s north (C) 4 m/s west (D) 4 m/s south Q.47
A body A is thrown vertically upwards with such a velocity that it reaches a max
imum h eight of h. Simultaneously another body B is dropped from height h. It st
rikes t he ground and does not rebound. The velocity of A relative to B v/s time
graph i s best represented by : (upward direction is positive) ! 2 (A) V a b (B
) V a b (C) ' AB (D) VAB t! Q.48 A body of mass 1 kg is acted upon by a force F
= 2 sin 37rt i + 3 cos 3 ret j find its position at t = 1 sec if at t = 0 it is
at rest at origin. f 3 2^ r2 2 ^ f 2 2 ) (D) none of these (A) L37t ' 9TT J (B)
L 37r ' 3n ) (C) L3TT ' 3tc J 2 2 2 2 2 Q.49 A force F = Be acts on a particle w
hose mass is m and whose velocity is 0 a t t = 0. It's terminal velocity is: C.
B BC B (A) mB (B) mC ( D ) - mC (Q m y Q. 50 A man moves in x-y plane along the
path shown. At what point is c his average velocity vector in the same direction
as his instantaneous velocity vector. The man starts from point P. A (A) A (B)B
(C)C (D) D Ct <6 Bansal Classes Q.51 From the velocity time garph of a particle
moving in straight line decide w hich of the following is incorrect statement.
(A) the particle crosses its initi al position (B) the speed ofthe particle incr
eases continuously (C) the force on the particle is constant (D) the acceleratio
n of the particle is constant. t v
Question Bank on Kinematics m
Q. 5 2 If T is the total time of flight, h is the maximum height & R is the rang
e for horizontal motion, the x & y co-ordinates of projectile motion and time t
are related as: (A) y - 4 h ( i ) ( . - i ) ( O y = 4h ( ! ) ( , - ! ) (B)y = 4
h ( ! ) <b> -4h(|)(.-| y Q.53 A particle initially at rest is subjected to two
forces . One is constant, the other is a retarding force proportional to the par
ticle velocity . In the su bsequent motion of the particle : (A) the acceleratio
n will increase from zero t o a constant value (B) the acceleration will decreas
e from its initial value to zero (C) the velocity will increase from zero to max
imum & then decrease (D) the velocity will increase from zero to a constant valu
e. Q.54 A ball is projected from ground with a velocity V at an angle 9 to the v
ertical. On its path it make s an elastic collison with a vertical wall and retu
rns to ground. The total time of flight ofthe ball is 2vsin9 2vcos9 vsin29 vcos9
(A) - y (B) - 7 (C) ( ) Q.l Q.5 Q.9 C, D A, B, C, D C Q.2 Q.6 B C ANSWERKEY Q.3
Q-7 C Q.ll B Q.15 C Q.19 C Q.23 A Q.27 C Q.31 B B, C, D Q.4 Q.8 A, C C Q.10 B Q
.14 B Q.l 8 D Q.22 C Q.26 C Q.30 A Q.34 D Q.38 C Q.42 B Q.46 B Q.50 C Q. 54 B Q.
12 A Q.16 B Q.20 C Q.24 B Q.28 C Q.32 A, B, C, D Q.36 C Q.40 A Q.44 D Q.48 C Q .
52 A,B Q.13 B Q.17 A, B, D Q.21 B Q.25 B Q.29 B Q.33 D Q.37 C Q.41 B Q.45 D Q.49
B Q.53 B,D Q.35 B,C,D Q.39 A, D Q.43 A Q.47 C Q.51 B 1*1 <JjBansal Classes Ques
tion Bank on G r a v i t a t i o n [8]
XII (ALL) t . MA GNETIC EFFECT OF CURRENT CONTENTS KEY CONCEPT EXERCISE-I EXERCIS
E -II EXERCISE-III ANSWER KEY
A static charge produces only electric field and only electricfieldcan exert a f
orce on it A moving charge produces both electricfieldans magneticfieldand both
electricfieldand magnetic field can exert force on it. A current carrying condu
c tor produces only magneticfieldand only magneticfieldcan exert a force on it.
Ma gnetic charge (i.e. current), produces a magnetic field . It can not produce
ele ctric field as net charge on a current carrying conductor is zero. A magneti
c fi eld is detected by its action on current carrying conductors (or moving cha
rges) and magnetic needles (compass) needles. The vector quantity B known as MAG
NETIC INDUCTION is introduced to characterise a magnetic field . It is a vector
quant ity which may be defined in terms of the force it produces on electric cur
rents . Lines of magnetic induction may be drawn in the same way as lines of ele
ctric field. The number of lines per unit area crossing a small area perpendicul
ar to the direction of the induction bring numerically equal to B . The number o
f line s of b crossing a given area is referred to as the MAGNETIC FLUX linked w
i th th at area. For this reason B is also called MAGNETIC FLUX DENSITY . The ma
gnetic i nduction dB produced by an element d/ carrying a current I at a distanc
e r is gi ven by > l(dlxr) Ho M Id^sinB or dB= dB 4ti r " here the quantity Id/ i
s called a s current element strength. \i = permeability of the medium = u p, ,
\x(. = perm eability of free space = relative permeability of the medium (Dimens
ionless quan tity). Unit of M-o & n is NA" or Hrrr ; |i = 4 % x 10" Hm~ r z 0 r
ich sides of the conductor would this volt age have to be applied ? (e) If no el
ectricfieldis applied form the outside the electrons will be pushed somewhat to
one side & thereforce will give rise to a u niform electricfieldE across the con
ductor untill the force ofthis electrostatic field E balanace the magnetic force
s encountered in part (b). What will be the magnitude and direction of thefieldE
H? Assume that n, the number of conduction e lectrons per unit volume, is 1. Ixl
0 /m & that h = 0.02 meter, w = 0.1cm , i = 5 0 amp, & B = 2 webers/meter . d H
h 29 3 2
f,Bansa!Classes Magnetics Effect of Current [11]
Q. 13(a) A rigid circular loop of radius r & mass m lies in the xy plane on a fl
at table and has a current I flowing in it. At this particular place, the earth
' s magneticfieldis B = B 1 + B j . How large must I be before one edge of the l
oo p will lift from table ? (b) Repeat if, B = B 1 + B k. x y x z Q. 14 Zeeman e
ffect. In Bohr's theory of the hydrogen atom the electron can be t hought of as
moving in a circular orbit of radius r about the proton . Suppose t hat such an
atom is placed in a magnetic field, with the plane of the orbit at r ight angle
to B. (a) If the electron is circulating clockwise, as viewed by an o bserver si
ghting along B, will the angular frequency increase or decrease? (b) W hat if th
e electron is circulating counterclockwise? Assume that the orbit radiu s does n
ot change. Q.15 In above problem show that the change in frequency of ro tation
caused by the magnetefieldis given Be approximately by Av = . Such freque ncy sh
ifts were actually observed by Zeeman in 1896. 4um A Q.16 A square loop ofwire o
f edge a carries a current i. (a) Show that B for a p oint on the axis of the lo
op and a distance xfromits centre is given by, ia B= 7 1 (4x + a ) (4x + 2a\ )1/
2 (b) Can the result of the above problem be reduced to givefieldat x = 0 ? (c)
Does the square loop behave like a dipole for points su ch that x a ? If so, wha
t is its dipole moment? 2 2 2 2 2 1 Q.17 A conductor carrying a current i is pla
ced parallel to a current per unit w idth j and width d, as shown in the figure.
Find the force per unit lenght on th e coductor. 0 z. / / \Z 0 /' r y; A il "B
Q. 18 Find the work and power required to move the conductor of length / shown i
n thefig.one full turn in the anticlockwise direction at a rotational frequency
of n revolutions per second ifthe magneticfieldis of magnitude B everywhere and
points radially outwards from Z-axis. The figure shows the surface traced by th
e wire AB. Q.19 The figure shows a conductor of weight 1.0 N and length L = 0.5
m placed on a roughinclined plane making an angle 30 with the horizontal so that
c onductor is perpendicular to a uniform horizontal magneticfieldof induction B
= 0.10 T. The coefficient of staticfrictionbetween the conductor and the plane i
s 0.1. A current of I = 10 A flows through the conductor inside the plane of thi
s paper as shown. What is the force needed to be the applied parallel'to the inc
li ned plane to sustaining the conductor at rest? Q.20 An electron gun G emits e
lec tron of energy 2kev traveling in the (+)ve x-direction. The electron are req
uire d to hit the spot S where GS = 0. lm & the line GS makes an angle of 60 with
the x-axis, as shown in the fig. Auniform magnetic field B parallel to GS exist
s in the region outsiees to electron gun. Find the minimum value of B needed to
make the electron hit S . f ^
/)60 Gun X , Bansa! Classes Magnetics Effect of Current [11]
Q. 1 Abattery is connected between two points Aand B the circumference of a unif
orm conducting ring of radius r and resistance R. One of the arcs AB of the rin
g subtends an angle 0 at the centre. The value of the magnetic induction at the
c entre due to the current in the ring is : [ JEE '95, 2] (A) zero, only if 9 =
18 0 (B) zero for all values of 0 (C) proportional to 2(180-0) (D) inversely propo
rti onal to r Q. 2 Two insulated rings, one slightly smaller diameter than the o
ther , are suspended along their diameter as shown, initially the planes of the
rings are mutually' perpendicular when a steady current is set up in each of the
m: [I IT '95, 1] (A) The two rings rotate to come into a common plane (B) The in
ner ri ng oscillates about its initially position (C) The outer ring stays stati
onary w hile the inner one moves into the plane of the outer ring (D) The inner
ring sta ys stationary while the outer one moves into the plane of the inner rin
g An elec tron in the ground state of hydrogen atom is revolving in anticlock-wi
se directi on in a circular orbit of radius R . Obtain an expression for the orb
ital magnet ic dipole moment of the electron The atom is placed in a uniform mag
netic. Induc tion B such that the plane normal of the electron orbit makes an an
gle of 30 with the magnetic induction. Find the torque experienced by the orbitin
g electron. [ JEE'96, 5] A proton, a deuteron and an a-particle having the same
kinetic energy are moving in circular trajectories in a constant magnetic field
. If r r & r d enote respectively the radii of the trajectories of these particl
es then: " [JEE '97, 1] rP < r, (B) r a > rd > rp (C) ra = rd > rp (D)P r = rd =
a r (A) ' ' d 3 infinitely long thin wires each carrying current /' in the same
direction , are in the x-y plane of a gravity free space . The central wire is
along the y-axis while the other two are along x = d. Find the locus of the point
s for which the magnetic field B is zero . If the central wire is displaced alon
g the z-directio n by a small amount & released, show that it will execute simpl
e harmonic motion . If the linear density ofthe wires is X,findthefrequencyof os
cillation. [JEE '9 7, 5] d a r a v v V / EXERCISE # III Q. 3 (i) (ii) Q.4 Q.5 (i
) Cii) Q.6 C O (ii) Select the correct alternative(s). [ JEE '98, 2 + 2 + 2 ] Tw
o very long, straigh t, parallel wires carry steady currents I & - I respectivel
y. The distance betwe en the wires is d. At a certain instant of time, a point c
harge q is at a point equidistant from the two wires, in the plane of the wires.
Its instantaneous vel ocity v is perpendicular to this plane. The magnitude of
the force due to the ma gnetic field acting on the charge at this instant is : (
D) 0 (A) ^o iqv (B) Ho I qv (C) 2^0 2nd 7td rcd Let [ e ] denote the dimensional
formula ofthe permittivi ty ofthe vaccum and [|i ] that ofthe permeability of t
he vacuum . If M = mass, L = length, T = time and I = electric current, (A) [e ]
= M L T 1 (B) [ e j = M" L" T I (C) [^ ] = M E T ! (D) [ n j = ML T-'I 0 0 _1 3 2 1 3 4 2 0 2 2 2 f,Bansa!Classes Magnetics Effect of Current [11]
(iii) Q.7 Two particles, each of mass m & charge q, are attached to the two ends
of a ligh t rigid rod of length 2 R. The rod is rotated at constant angular spe
ed about a perpendicular axis passing through its centre. The ratio of the magni
tudes of th e magnetic moment of the system & its angular momentum about the cen
tre of the r od is : ( A )2m f (B) ( C )m ^ (D) ran m w w 0 A particle of mass m
& charge q is moving in a region where uniform, constant el ectric and magnetic
fields E & B are present, E & B are parallel to each other. At time t = 0 the v
elocity v of the particle is perpendicular to E . (assume tha t its speed is alw
ays c, the speed oflight in vacuum). Find the velocity v of th e particle at tim
e t. You must express your answer in terms of t, q, m, the vect ors v , E & B an
d their magnitudes v , E & B. [JEE '98, 8] 0 0 Q.8 (a) (b) A uniform, constant m
agneticfieldB is directed at an angle of 45 to the x-axis 'V lo in the xy-plane,
PQRS is a rigid square wire frame carrying a steady current y I (clockwise), wit
h its centre at the origin O. At time t = 0, the frame is a t rest in the positi
on shown in thefigure,with its sides parallel to the x & y a xes. Each side of t
he frame is of mass M & length L. What is the torque t about 0 acting on the fra
me due to the magnetic field ? Find the angle by which the fr ame rotates under
the action of this torque in a short interval of time At, & th e axis about whic
h this rotation occurs (At is so short that any variation in th e torque during
this interval may be neglected) Given the moment of inertia of t he frame about
an axis through its centre perpendicular to its plane is 4/3 ML . [JEE '98, 2 +
6] 0 / / / 2 Q9 A charged particle is released from rest in a region of steady a
nd uniform elect ric and magnetic fields which are parallel to each other. The p
article will move in a (A) straight line (B) circle (C) helix (D) cycloid [JEE'9
9,2] 0 rj Q.10 The region between x = 0 and x=L isfilledwith uniform, steady mag
neticfield B k. Aparticle of mass m, positive charge q and velocity v T travels
along x-axi s and enters the region ofthe magnetic field. Neglect the gravity th
roughout the question. (a) Find the value of L ifthe particle emergesfromthe reg
ion of magne ticfieldwith itsfinalvelocity at an angle 30 to its initial velocity
. (b) Find th efinalvelocity of the particle and the time spent by it in the mag
neticfield,if the magnetic field now extendsupto2.IL. [JEE '99, 6 + 4] Q. 11 (i)
Aparticle of c harge q and mass m moves in a circular orbit of radius r with ang
ular speed co. The ratio of the magnitude ofits magnetic moment to that of its a
ngular momentum depends on (A) co and q (B) co, q and m (C) q and m (D) co and m
(ii) Two long parallel wires are at a distance 2d apart. They carry steady equa
l currentsflowi ngout of the plane of the paper, as shown. The variation of the
magneticfieldB a long the XX' is given by
(A) (B) (C) (D) f,Bansa!Classes Magnetics Effect of Current [11]
(iii) An infinitely long conductor PQR is bent to form a right angle as shown. A
M cur rent I flows through PQR. The magneticfielddue to this current at the poi
nt M is H Now, another infinitely long straight conductor QS is P Qn o connected
at Q s o that the current in PQ remainingunchanged. The magnetic field at M is
now H Th e ratio H /H is given by R (A) 1/2 (B)l ~ (C) 2/3 (D) 2 (iv) An ionized
gas cont ains both positive and negative ions. If it is subjected simultaneousl
y to an el ectric field along the +x direction and a magneticfieldalong the +z d
irection, t hen (A) positive ions deflect towards +y direction and negative ions
towards -y direction (B) all ions deflect towards +y direction. (C) all ions de
flect toward s -y direction (D) positive ions deflect towards -y direction and n
egative ions towards +y direction. [JEE 2000 (Scr)] Q.12 A circular loop of radi
us R is bent along a diameter and given a shape as shown in the figure. One of t
he semicircle s (KNM) lies in the x - z plane and the other one (KLM) in the y-z
plane with th eir centers at the origin. Current I is flowing through each ofth
e semicircles a s shown in figure. (i) A particle of charge q is released at the
origin with a v elocity v ^ o Find the instantaneous force f on the particle. A
ssume that space is gravity free. (ii) If an external uniform magneticfieldB j i
s applied, determ ine the forces F and F on the semicircles KLM and KNM due to t
hisfieldand the ne t force F on the loop . [JEE 2000 Mains, 4 + 6] r 9 0 r ] 2 :
1 : 2 Q.13 A current of 1 OA flows around a closed path in a circuit which is i
n the h orizontal plane as shown in thefigure.The circuit consists of eight alte
rnating arcs ofradii ^ = 0.08 m and r = 0.12 m. Each arc subtends the same angle
at the centre. (a) Find the magneticfieldproduced by this circuit at the centre
. (b) An infinitely long straight wire carrying a current of 1 OA is passing thr
ough the centre of the above circuit vertically with the direction of the curren
t being into the plane of the circuit. What is the force acting on the wire at t
he centr e due to the current in the circuit? What is the force acting on the ar
c AC and the straight segment CD due to the current at the centre? [JEE 2001, 5
+ 5] Q.14 Two particles A and B of masses m and m respectively and having the sa
me charge are moving in a plane. Auniform magneticfieldexists perpendicular to t
his plane . The speeds of the particles are v and v respectively and the traject
ories are as shown in the figure. Then (A) m v < m v (B) m v > m v (C) m < m and
v < v (D) m = n^ and v = v [JEE, 2001 (Scr)] A B A B A A B B A A B B A B A B A
A B Q.15 A non-planar loop of conducting wire carrying a current I is placed as
show n inthefigure.Each ofthe straight sections ofthe loop is oflength2a. The ma
gneti c field due to this loop at the point P (a, 0, a) points in the direction
1 - ,H 1+ k) Ts 1 H+k+i) < A
> 7 T (i + j + k) (i+k) [JEE, 2001 (Scr)] f,Bansa!Classes Magnetics Effect of Cur
rent [11]
Q . 16 A coil having N turns is wound tightly in the form of a spiral with inner
and outer radii a and b respectively. When a current 1 passes through the coil,
the magneticfieldat the centre is [JEE, 2001 Screening] N H NI 2^i NI IV , b (C
) In(A) (B) (D) /n2(b - a) a > 2(b - a) a 0 n T [ ) 0 K Q.17 A particle of mass
m and charge q moves with a constant velocity v along th e positive x direction
. It enters a region containing a uniform magneticfieldB d irected along the neg
ative z direction, extending from x = a to x = b. The minim um value ofv require
d so that the particle can just enter the region x > b is (A ) q b B./m (B)q(b-a
)B/m (C)qaB/m (D) q(b + a) B/2m [JEE 2002 (screening), 3] Q. 18 A long straight
wire along the z-axis carries a current I in the negative z d irection. The magn
etic vector field B at a point having coordinates (x, y) in th e z = 0 plane is
[JEE 2002 (screening), 3] n i (xj-yi) ji I (yi - xj) (xi+yj) ( y (A) 2n (x +y )
(B) M (x + y ) ( Q 2n (x +y ) (D) M (x -+yj )) 2n 2n 0 0 X1 2 2 2 2 2 2 2 2 Q. 1
9 The magneticfieldlines due to a bar magnet are correctly shown in N V. ^. N [JE
E 2002 (screening), 3 ] ^ N , Q.20 A rectangular loop PQRS madefroma uniform wir
e has length a, width b and ma ss m. It isfreeto rotate about the arm PQ, which
remains.hinged along a horizont al line taken as the y-axis (seefigure).Take the
vertically upward direction as the z-axis. Auniform magneticfieldB = (3 i + 4 k
) B exists in the region. The lo op is held in the x-y plane and a current I is
passed through it. The loop is no w released and is found to stay in the horizon
tal position in equilibrium. R Wha t is the direction of the current I in PQ? (a
) (b) Find the magnetic force on th e arm RS. [JEE 2002, 1+1+3] (c) Find the exp
ression for I in terms of B a, b and m. 0 Q. 21 A circular coil carrying current
I is placed in a region of uniform magnet icfieldacting perpendicular to a coil
as shown in the figure. Mark correct optio n [JEE 2003 (Scr)] * (A) coil expand
s (B) coil contracts x (C) coil moves left ( D) coil moves right x x Q.22 Figure
represents four positions ofa current carrying coil is a magneticfie lddirected
towards right, h represent the direction of area ofvector of the coil . The cor
rect order ofpotential energy is: [JEE 2003 (Scr)] (A) I > III > II > I V (B) I
< III < II < IV (C) IV < I < II < II (D) II > II > IV > I f,Bansa!Classes Magneti
cs Effect of Current [11]
Q.23 A wheel of radius R having charge Q, uniformly distributed on the rim of th
e wheel is free to rotate about a light horizontal rod. The rod is suspended by
light inextensible stringe and a magneticfieldB is applied as shown inthe figur
e . The 3Tn initial tensions in the strings are T . Ifthe breaking tension ofthe
s trings are find the maximum angular velocity co with which the wheel can be r
ota te. [JEE 2003] 0 0 Q.24 A proton and an alpha particle, after being accelera
ted through same potent ial difference, enter a uniform magneticfieldthe directi
on ofwhich is perpendicu lar to their velocities. Find the ratio of radii ofthe
circular paths ofthe two particles. [JEE 2004] Q.25 In a moving coil galvanomete
r, torque on the coil can be expressed as T = ki, where i is current through the
wire and k is constant. The rectangular coil of the galvanometer having numbers
of turns N, area A and m oment of inertia I is placed in magneticfieldB. Find (
a) k in terms of given par ameters N, I, Aand B. (b) the torsional constant of t
he spring, if a current i p roduces a deflection of %!2 in the coil in reaching
equilibrium position. (c) th e maximum angle through which coil is deflected, id
charge Q is passed through t he coil almost instantaneously. (Ignore the dampin
g in mechanical oscillations) [JEE 2005] 0 Q.26 An infinite current carrying wir
e passes through point O and in perpendicul ar to the plane containing a current
carrying loop ABCD as shown in thefigure.Ch oose the correct option (s). (A) Ne
t force on the loop is zero. (B) Net torque o n the loop is zero. (C) As seen fr
om O, the loop rotates clockwise. (D) As seen from O, the loop rotates anticlock
wise f,Bansa!Classes Magnetics Effect of Current [11]
ANSWER KEY EXERCISE # I x 10-5 T Q.l Q.4 8 Til Q.2 JL M 2V2 3 Q.3 (2V2-l)jl /' 7
ta 3 1 ^o 7t +1 47tr 2 1 zero 05 ^ 4RU f rk + "1 1 k J Q.6 Q.7 Q.8 (i) 1.3 x 10 4
T, (ii)zero Q.9 ^ weber.nr1 Q. 10 Q.14 1W 2na Q 11 Q.15 10k Q. 12 2mvc Q. 13 Q.1
6
zero 4/^ F = aa2ij /' = 0.1110A, i2 = 0.096A Q 1 ? (a) 3mv2 3mv3 4qa ' ( b ) - ^
~ , ( c ) z e r o Q 18 In the plane of the drawing from right to left Q.19 B I
= Hobrf 3 fl = 2 H bR 0 3 Q 20 3r2 ' 0.57 s Q.21 a t - m~ , wherea = shr qB m EI
Be v V2mV y HoII'C 0 2% Q.22 \ Q.23 a b to the left
I I Q.24 V2IRB n Q 2 5 _ W - Ml 2 J / n r 2 Q.l Mo 2* (a +b 2 ) 2 V3b EXERCISE #
IT Q 2 471^ a y along Y-axis, <u> 4n v 2 a y Jfo fr 2 ^ V10 tan + 7t with posit
ive axis f,Bansa!Classes Magnetics Effect of Current [11]
Q.3 Q.5 Q.6 Q.7 Q.9 Q.ll Li I I " T ^ /n(3) along-vez direction F 'Ml 2n 0 Q.4 m
in rj2 + a* L , 2 V a-2 j , zero \l-k), ' 2 'l a ^ R p J ( a ) B = ~ y 2R - b 2
, (b) B = M R 4 4R + b 2 2 p J' 0 v ab ^ 4R + b 2 2 2 y -^h tan e 2 2 Qs 8 rz QV
p i /_3^3 - 1 \ 71 , (b) x=BI v y v 0 3 -6 a 2J (a) 0 (b) 1.41 x 10~ T, 45 in xz-p
lane, (c) 5 x 10 T, +x-direction] 2 Q. 10 (a) 20 min. (b) 5.94 x 10" Nm Vl5 C 4
23 4 6 Q. 12 (a) 1.4 x 10~ m/s (b) 4.5 x 10~ N (down) (c) 2.8 x 10" V/m (down) (
d) 5.7 x 10~ V (top +, bottom-) (e) same as (c) Q.13 (a) I = Q.17 7tr ( x 4- Ry)
\ + B B 2 7 m g (h\
(b)T I mg 7crB v Q. 14 (a) increase, (b) decrease Q.18 - 2 re r B / / , - 2 7t r
B z / 0 0 ^-tan 2hy H O 7t 1 V r a \ Q.19 0.62 N < F < 0.88 N Q-20 B eh ehB Q.3
(i)m=^;N min = 4.7X10- T 3 EXERCISE # III Q.l B Q.5 Q 7 Q.2 A z = 0,x = ^ , d t
a Q.4 A ^ ^ (iO^fe 1 Q.6 (i) D (ii) B, C (iii) A - (v x g ) / | v x g 0 0 v=^ E
l + v o coscot + [v sin rat] k, where co = 0 f,Bansa!Classes 4i Magnetics Effect
of Current 3 BIo At 4 M 2
Q.9 A [11]
mv 7im Q 10 ( ) 2qB^ (b)velocity=-v, time= 0 a Q.ll (i) C (ii) B (iii) C (iv) C
(V Q.12 (i) q v j; (ii) F = 2 I R B F , = 2 I R B , Net force = F , + F = 4 I R
B 1 0 5 2 5 6 Q. 13 (a) 6.6 x 10~ T, (b) 0, 0, 8 x io~ Nt Q.14B Q. 15 D Q.16 C Q
.17 B Q.18 A Q.19 D 6bB a 1 Q.20 (a) current in loop PQRS is clockwise from P to
QRS., (b) p = BI b (3k-4i), (c) I = Q.21 A Q.22 A Q.23 = dT P p q 0 QR B 2 Q.24
J a y a q V2 r m = a p 2iNAB NAB 71 Q.25 (a) k = NAB, (b) C = 7C , (c) Q x V 0 Z11
Q.26 A,C f,Bansa!Classes Magnetics Effect of Current [11]
I BANSALCLASSES TARGET IIT JEE 2007 XII (ALL) MA GNETIC EFFECT OF CURRENT QUESTI
ON BANK ON
QUESTION FOR SHORT ANSWER Q. 1 Consider a magneticfieldline. Is the magnitude of
B constant or variable al ong such a line? Can you give an example of each case
? Q. 2 Q. 3 A current is se nt through a vertical springfromwhose lower end a we
ight is hanging. What will h appen? B= fx i/ 2nd suggets that a strong magneticf
ieldis set up at points near a long wire carrying a current. Since there is a cu
rrent i and magneticfieldB, w hy is there not a force on the wire in accord with
the equation F = iL x B ? 0 0 Q.4 Twofixedwires cross each other perpendicularl
y so that they do not actually touc h but are close to each other, as shown infi
gure.Equal currents i exist in each wire in the directions indicated. In what re
gion(s) will there be some points of zero net magnetic field? II III I- I IV 3 Q
.5 A messy loop of limp wire is placed on a frictionless table and anchored at p
oin ts a and b as shown infigure.If a current i is now ' passed through the wire
, wi ll it try to form a circular lo op i or will it try to bunch up further? Q.
.L A v ery long conductor has a square cross section and contains a coaxial cavit
y also with a square cross section. Current is distributed uniformly over the ma
terial cross section ofthe conductor. Is the magnetic field in the cavity equal
to zer o? Justify you answer. Two long solenoids are nested on the same axis, as
infigure.They carry identical currents but in opposite directions, Ifthere is n
o magnetic field inside the in ner solenoid, what can you say about n, the numbe
r ofturns per unit length, for the two solenoids? Which one, if either, has the
larger value? Q. 8 The magnetic fieldat the center of a circular current loop ha
s the value B = M-i / 2R . Howev er, the electricfieldat the center of a ring of
charge is zero. Why this differe nce? 0 Q. 7 Q. 9 A steady current is set up in
a cubical network of resistive wires, as in figure . Use symmetry arguments to
show that the magneticfieldat the v'J center of the cube is zero J A
P Q. 10 A copper pipefilledwith an electrolyte. When a voltage is applied, the c
ur rent in the electrolyte is constituted by the movement of positive and negati
ve ions in opposite directions. Will such a pipe experience a force when placed
in a magnetic field perpendicular to the current. Q. 11 Magnetic moments arise d
ue to charges. Can a system have magnetic moments even though it has no charge.
Q. 12 Imagine that the room in which you are seated is fillie with a uniform mag
net icfieldwith B pointing vertically upward. A circular loop of wire has its pl
ane horizontal. For what direction of current in the loop, as viewed from above,
wil l the loop be in stable eqiulibrium with respect to forces & torques of mag
netic origin ? (SS Bansal Classes Question Bank on Magnetic Effect of Current [1
2]
Q .13 Two current-carrying wires may attract each other. In absence of other for
ces, the wires will move towards each other increasing the kinetic energy. From
where does this energy come? Q.14 In order to have a current in a long wire, it
should be connected to a battery or some such device. Can we obtain the magneti
c fielddue to a straight, long wire by using Ampere's law without mentioning thi
s other part ofthe circuit. Q.15 A uniform magnetic field fills a certian cubica
l region of space. Can an electron be fired into this cube from the outside in s
uc h a way that it will travel in a closed circular path inside the cube? Q. 16
In Ampere's law | B.dl - \i0 i the current outside the curve is not included on
the right hand side. Does it mean that the magnetic field B calculated by using
Amp ere's law, gives the contribution of only the currents crossing the area bou
nded by the curve ? Q.17 A magnetic field that varies in magnitude form point to
poi nt, but has constant direction (East to West) is set up in a chamber . A ch
arged particle enters the chamber and travels undeflected along a straight path
with constant speed . What can you say about the initial velocity of the particl
e? Q. 18 A charged particle enters an environment ofa strong & non-uniform magne
ticfie ldvarying from point to point both in magnitude and direction and comes o
ut of i t following a complicated trajectory. Would its final speed equal the in
itial sp eed , if it suffered no collisions with the environment. Q.19 A straigh
t wire ca rrying on electric current is placed along the axis of a uniformly cha
rged ring. Will there be a magnetic force on the wire ifthe ring starts rotating
about the wire ? If yes, in which direction ? Q.20 An electron travelling West
to East en ters a chamber having a uniform electrostatic field in North to South
direction . Specify the direction in which a uniform magnetic field should be s
et up to pr event the electron from deflecting from its straight line path . Q.2
1 The magnet ic field inside a tightly wound, long solenoid is B = ju0 ni. It su
ggests that t hefielddoes not depend on the total length of the solenoid, and he
nce if we add more loops at the ends ofa solenoid the field should not increase.
Explain quali tatively why the extra-added loops do not have a considerable eff
ect on the fiel d inside the solenoid. Q . 22 A lightening conductor is connecte
d to the earth b y a circular copper pipe. After lightning strikes, it is discov
ered that the pip e has turned into a circular rod. Explain the cause of this ph
enomenon. Q.23 We know that the work required to turn a current loop end for end
in an external ma gnetic field is 2pB. Does this hold no matter what the origin
al orientaion of th e loop was ? (SS Bansal Classes Question Bank on Magnetic Ef
fect of Current [12]
Q.l ONLY ONE OPTION IS CORRECT. Take approx. 2 minutes for answering each questi
on. A current of i ampere is flowing through each ofthe bent wires as shown the
magn itude and direction of magneticfieldat 0 is 1 3^ Poi_fj_ _2_ (B) fV R R' (A
) 4 ^ R R' \ l^o 1 M-oM (C) v.R 2R' j (D) 8 l R R' y + + 1 1 + Q. 2 Net magnetic
fieldat the centre ofthe circle O due to a current carrying loop as shown infigu
reis (9 < 180) /k \ (A) zero il>i 8^>0 ; (B) perpendicular to paper i nwards V' J
(C) perpendicular to paper outwards (D) is perpendicular to paper in wards if 9
< 90 and perpendicular to paper outwards if 90<9<180 The magneticfieldd ue to a c
urrent carrying square loop of side a at a point located symmetrically at a dist
ance of a/2 from its centre (as shown is) V2p i M-o i 2p i 0 0 c Q. 3 Q.4 A char
ge particle A of charge q = 2 C has velocity v = 100 m/s. When it passes t hroug
h point Aand has velocity inthe direction shown. The strength of magneticfi elda
t point B due to this moving charge is (r = 2 m). (A) 2.5 uT (B) 5.0 pT ' (C )2.
0pT (D)None Three rings, each having equal radius R, are placed mutually perp en
dicular to each other and each having its centre at the origin of co-ordinate sy
stem. If current I is flowing thriugh each ring then the magnitude of the magn e
ticfieldat the common centre is (B)zero ( Q ( M g f ( D ) ^ - ^ . (A) ^3 2R Two c
oncentric coils X and Y of radii 16 cm and 10 cm lie in the same vertical plane
containing N-S direction. X has 20 turns and carries 16 A. Yhas 25 turns & carr
ies 18A. X has current in anticlockwise direction and Yhas current in clockwise
direction for an observer, looking at. the coils facing the west. The magnitude
of net magneticfieldat their common centre is (A) 5?t x 10 T towards west (B) 13
% * 10- T towards east (C) 137t x 10" T towards west (D) 5,x * 10 T towards eas
t A uniform beam of positively charged particles is moving with a constant veloc
i ty parallel to another beam ofnegatively charged particles moving with the sam
e velocity in opposite direction separated by a distance d. The variation of mag
ne ticfieldB along a perpendicular line draw between the two beams is best repre
sen ted by 4 4 4 4 Q.6 Q.7 (A) d/2 (D) Question Bank on Magnetic Effect of Curre
nt d/2 (SS Bansal Classes
[12]
Q. 8 Q. 9 The dimension of where |i is permeability & s is permittivity is same
as : (B) I nductance (C) Capacitance (A) Resistance (D) None of these A current
I flows aro und a closed path in the horizontal plane of the circle as shown in
thefigure.Th e path consists of eight arcs with alternating radii r and 2r. Each
segment ofar c subtends equal angle at the common centre P. The magnetic field
produced by cu rrent path at point P is 3 |j, I (A) 8 r ; perpendicular to the p
lane of the pap er and directed inward. 0 (B) -8 ; perpendicular to the plane of
the paper and directed outward. r 0 3 JLT I (C) 1 Upl ; perpendicular to the pl
ane of the paper and directed inward. 8 r 1 (D) 8 Upl ; perpendicular to the pla
ne of the paper and directed outward.. r Q. 10 Infinite number ofstraight wires
each carrying current I are equally place d as shown in the figure. Adjacent wir
es have current in opposite direction. Net magneticfieldat point P is /n4 k P" H
o (A) f 4n V3a H0I In 4 (D) Zero (C) 471 V ia (-k) 1 / n 2 k Q. 11 A direct curr
ent is passing through a wire. It is bent to form a coil of o ne turn. Now it is
further bent to form a coil oftwo turns but at smaller radius . The ratio ofthe
magnetic induction at the centre ofthis coil L and at the cent re of the coil o
f one turn is (A) 1 : 4 (B) 4: 1 (C) 2 : 1 (D) 1 : 1 Q. 12 Two m utually perpend
icular conductors carrying currents Ij and I lie in one plane. Lo cus ofthe poin
t at which the magnetic induction is zero, is a (A) circle with ce ntre as the p
oint of intersection ofthe conductor. (B) parabola with vertex as t he point of
intersection ofthe conductors (C) straight line passing through the point ofinte
rsection ofthe conductors. (D) rectangular hyperbola 2 Q. 13 Find the magneticfi
eldat P due to the arrangement shown 2|i i Ho Ho 1 0 1 Ho 1 1+ ,/45i Q. 14 Equal
current i is flowing in three infinitely long wires along positive x , y and z d
irections. The magnitude "field at a point (0,0, -a) would be: M (C)i ^(i-i) ( D
)27ta0 + J + k) ^[12] (SS Bansal Classes Question Bank on Magnetic Effect of Cu
rrent
Q.15 A thin, straight conductor lies along the axis ofa hollow conductor of radi
us R. The two carry equal currents in the same direction. The magneticfieldB is
plotted against the distance rfromthe axis. Which ofthe following best represen
t s the resulting curve? Q.16 A long thin walled pipe of radius R carries a curr
ent I along its length. T he current density is uniform over the circumference o
fthe pipe. The magneticfie ldat the center of the pipe due to quarter portion of
the pipe shown, is 2p rV2 M-QIA/2 pI (D) None (C) 7t R (A) 4ti R 71 K Q.17 Two
very long straight parallel wires, parallel to y-axis, cany currents 41 and I, a
long +y direction and -y di rection, respectively. The wires are passes through
the x-axis at the points (d, 0,0) and (- d, 0,0) respectively. The graph ofmagne
ticfieldz-comp onent as one moves along the x-axisfromx = - d to x=+d, is best g
iven by 0 0 2 2 (A) (B) j (C) LJ (D) Q.18 A long straight wire, carrying current
I, is bent at i ts midpoint tofroman angle of p 45 . Induction of magneticfield
at point P, dista nt R from point of bending is " R , , X45 equal to: (V2-l)p I (
V2+l)p I (V2-1 VqI (V2 lKl (A) (D) 4V271R 4V2UR 4TTR ' 4tcR 4V2TTR ' Q.19 A holl
ow cylinder having infinite length and carrying uniform current per unit length
X along the circum ference as shown. Magneticfieldinside the cylinder is pX (C)2
pA (D) none (A) (B) Po^ 0 0 ( D ) + Il f u 0 v( _C / ) v 0 Q.20 A long straight
metal rod has a very long hole ofradius' a' drilled paralle l to the rod axis as
shown in the figure. Ifthe rod carries a current 'i' find t he value of magneti
c induction on the axis of the hole, where OC = c p rc (B) 2T C(V - a ) 7r(b -a
) p ic (D) 27iaV ( O ^ 2TCC' Q.21 Two long conductors are arra nged as shown abo
ve to form overlapping cylinders, each of raidus r, whose cente rs are separated
by a distance d. Current of density J flows into the plane ofth e page along th
e shaded | part of one conductor and an equal currentflowsout of the plane ofthe
page along the shaded portion ofthe other, as shown. What are th e magnitude an
d direction ofthe magneticfieldat point A? Vacuum (A) (p /27r)7tdJ , in the +y-d
irection (B) (p /27t)d /r, in the +y-direction (C) (p /27t)4d .T/r, in the -y-di
rection (D) (p /27t)Jr /d, in the -y-direction (E) There is no magn eticfieldat
A. 0 ( A ) 2 2 0 l ( b 2 a 2 ) V f r 0 0 2
0 2 0 2 (SS Bansal Classes Question Bank on Magnetic Effect of Current [12]
Q. 22 An electron is moving along positive x-axis. Auniform electric field exist
s towards negative y-axis. What should be the direction of magneticfieldof suit
a ble magnitude so that net force of electron is zero (A) positive z-axis (B) ne
ga tive z-axis (C) positive y-axis (D) negative y-axis Q.23 A particle of charge
q and mass m starts moving from the origin under the action of an electric fiel
d / V ^ E = E i and B = B i with velocity v = v j. The speed of the particle wil
l be come 2v after a time 2Bq V3Bq 2mv V3 mv (C)t = mv (A)t = qE (D)t E (B)t = m
v " " Q. 24 An electron is projected with velocity v in auniform electricfieldE
perpe ndicular to thefield.Again it is projetced with velocity v perpendicular t
o a un iform magneticfieldB/ If r is initial radius of curvature just after ente
nder the action ofan electric field E = E i and magnetic field B = B k. Its vel
o city at (x , y ,0) is (4i + 3 j). The value of x is: 25 5a 16aB 13 aE (C) 2aE
(B ) (A) 2 B Q.40 A particle of specific charge (q/m) is projected from the orig
in of coordinates with initial velocity [ui - vj ]. Uniform electric magneticfie
lds exist in the region along the +y direction, ofmagnitude E and B. The particl
e wi ll definitely return to the origin once if (A) [VB/2TCE] is an integer (B)
(u + v ) [B/7tE] is an integer (C) [VB/' TIE] in an integer (D) [uB/TTE] is an i
ntege r Q.41 An electron moving with a velocity V, = 2i m/s at a point in a magn
eticfi eldexperiences a force F, = - 2 j N. 0 0 0 0 0 c f r r 2 2 1/2 _ 2 A 2 A
Ifthe electron is moving with a velocity V = 2 j m/s at the same point, it exper
iences a force F = +2i N. The force the electron would experience ifitweremovin
g withavelocity V = 2k m/s at the same point is (A) zero (B) 2kN (C) - 2 k N (D)
i nformation is insufficient Q. 42 Two particles of charges +Q and -Q are proj
ect edfromthe same point with a velocity v in a region of uniform magneticfieldB
suc h that the velocity vector makes an angle q with the magneticfield.Their ma
sses are M and 2M, respectively. Then, they will meet again for the first time a
t a p oint whose distance from the point of projection is (A) 2:tMvcos9/QB (B) 8
TIMVCO S0/QB (C) 7tMvcos0/QB (D) 4TIMVCOS9/QB Q.43 A particle of charge Q and ma
ss M mo ves in a circular path of radius R in a uniform magneticfieldof magnitud
e B. The same particle now moves with the same speed in a circular path of same
radius R in the space between the cylindrical electrodes ofthe cylindrical capac
itor. Th e radius ofthe inner electrode is R/2 while that of the outer electrode
is 3R/2. Then the potential difference between the capacitor electrodes must be
(A) QBR( /n3)/M (B) QB R (/n3)/2M (C) QB R (/n3)/M (D)None Y Q. 44 A particle w
ith charge +Q and mass m enters a magneticfieldof magnitude B, B existing only t
o theright ofthe boundary YZ. The direction ofthe motion ofthe m particle is per
pendicular to the direction of B. Let T = 2 T . The time spent T by the particle
in thefiel dwill be 71-29 'tc + 29^ (A)T0 (B) 2T9 (C)T ( D ) T 271 2n 3 2 2 2 2
X Q.45 In the previous question, ifthe particle has -Q charge, the time spend b
y t he particle in thefieldwill be tc-29 tt + 29 (C)T ( D ) T 2TZ (B)2T9 (A) TO
27C Q.46 The direction of magnetic force on the electron as shown in the diagram
is along (A) y-axis (B) -y-axis (C) z-axis (D) -z-axis ' IL Y (SS Bansal Classe
s Question Bank on Magnetic Effect of Current [12]
Q.47 A particle having charge q enters a region ofuniform magnetic field B (dire
cted inwards) and is deflected a distance x after travelling a distance y. The
m agnitude of the momentum ofthe particle is: qB qBy qBy (B) x ( C ) y X +x (A) (
D) qBy' 2x Q.48 A block of mass m & charge q is released on a long smooth inclin
ed plane magnetic field B is constant, uniform, horizontal and parallel to surfa
ce as shown. Find the time from start when block loses contact with the surface.
m cosecG mcosB (B) qB (A) qB mcotQ (D)none (C) qB Q. 49 A particle moving with
velocity v having specific cha rge (q/m) enters a region of B 3mv P' 53>" magnet
icfieldB having width d = "^rj^ at angle 53 to the boundary ofmagnetic X field. F
ind the angle 9 in the60 diagram . (A) 37 (B) (C) 90 (D) none Q. 5 0 A charged part
icle enters a uriferm magneticfi eldperpendicular to its initial direction trave
lling in air. The path of the par ticle is seen to follow the path infigure.Whic
h of statements 1-3 is/are correct ? [1] The magneticfieldstrength may have been
increased while the particle was t ravelling in air [2] The particle lost energ
y by ionising the air entry* [3] The particle lost charge by ionising the air (A
) 1, 2, 3 are correct (B) 1,2 only a re correct (C) 2, 3 only are correct (D) 1
only Q. 51 A straight rod of mass m a nd length L is suspended from the identica
l spring as shown in thefigure.The spr ing stretched by a distance of x due to t
he weight of the wire. The circuit has total resistance RQ. When the magneticfie
ldperpendicular to the plane ofthe pape r is switched on, springs are observed t
o extend further by the same distance. T he magneticfieldstrength is mgR (A) 8 7
~; directed outward from the plane of the paper L mgR (B) 2ex ; directed outward
fromthe plane of the paper mgR (C) sL ; d irected into the plane of the paper (D
) ; directed into the plane of the paper 0 0 X Q. 52 A conducting wire bent in the
form of a parabola y = 2x carries a current i = 2 A as shown in figure. This wi
re is placed in a uniform magnetic field B = -4 k Tesla. The magnetic force on t
he wire is (in newton) (A) 16i (B) 321 (C)-32 i (D) 16i 2 y (m) (SS Bansal Class
s not zero. 0 ONE OR MORE THAN ONE OPTION MAY BE CORRECT Take approx. 3 minutes
for answering each question. -vp/ ? 0 p/ Q x^ . v ^V (D) P Qjy Consider the magn
eticfieldproduced by afinitelylong current carrying wire. j A ) the lines offiel
dwill be concentric circles with centres on the wire. : The re can be two points
in the same plane where magneticfieldsare same. (JJ&) There can be large number
of points where the magneticfieldis same. > (D) The magneti cfieldat a point is
inversally proportional to the distance ofthe pointfromthe w ire. x (SS Bansal
Classes Question Bank on Magnetic Effect of Current
[12]
Q.3/ Consider three quantities x = E/B, y = J l / p e andz= -. Here, I is the le
ngth of a wire, Ciis a CR capacitance and R is a resistance. All other symbols
h ave standard meanings. (A) x, y have the same dimensions (Wfy, z have the same
d imensions (P*z, x have the same dimensions (D) none ofthe three pairs have th
e s ame dimensions. 0 0 Two long thin, parallel conductors carrying equal curren
ts in the same direction arefixedparallel to the x-axis, one passing through y =
a and the other through y = -a. The resultant magnetic field due to the two con
ductors at any point is B. Which of the following are correct? JA) B = 0 for all
points on the x-axis 4B ) At all points on the y-axis, excluding the origin, B
has only a z-component. " fC) At all points on the z-axis, excluding the origin,
B has only a y-component. ^(D) B cannot have anx-component. T Q..5 / Currentflo
wsthrough uniform, square frames as shown. In which case is the magneticfieldat
the centre of the frame no t zero? (A) (B) V (C) (D) Qj}/' A wire carrying I is
shaped as shown. Section AB is a quarter circle ofrad ius r. The magneticfieldat
C is directed i (A) along the bisector of the angle A CB, away from AB ' (B) al
ong the bisector ofthe angle ACB, towards AB perpendicu lar to the plane of the
paper, directed into the paper (D) at an angle T 4 to th e plane of the paper C
/ Along straight wire carries a current along the x-axis. Consider the points A(
0, 1, 0), B(0, 1,1), C(1, 0,1) and D(1, 1, 1). Which of t he following pairs of
points will have magnetic fields of the same magnitude (A) A andB .(B) A and C (
C)BandC B and D In the previous question, if the current i s i and the magneticf
ieldat D has magnitude B, Ho !V B 1 9 1 (C) B is parallel to the x-axis >SB) B m
akes an angle of 45 with the xy plane Which ofthe following statement is correct:
JjA) A charged particle enters a reg ion ofuniform magneticfieldat an angle 8 5
to magnetic lines of force. The path o f the particle is a circle. (B) An electr
on and proton are movingwith the same k inetic energy along the same direction.
When they pass through uniform magneticf ieldperpendicular to their direction of
motion, they describe circular path. -^(C ) There is no change in the energy ofa
charged particle moving in a magneticfiel dalthough magnetic force acts on it.
Two electrons enter with the same speed but in opposite direction in a uniform t
ransverse magnetic field. Then the two desc ribe circle of the same radius and t
hese move in the same direction. (SS Bansal Classes Question Bank on Magnetic Ef
fect of Current [12]
Qyl 0 Two identical charged particles enter a uniform magneticfieldwith same spe
ed but at angles 3 0 and 60 withfield.Let a, b and c be the ratio oftheir time pe
r iods, radii and pitches ofthe helical paths than j/k) abc = 1 (B) abc > 1 (C)
ab c < 1 0 ) a = be i Consider thefollowingstatements regarding a charged partic
le in amagneticfield.Which ofthe statements are true: (A) Starting with zero vel
oci ty, it accelerates in a direction perpendicular to the magnetic field. (B) W
hile deflecting in magneticfieldits energy gradually increases. (Q) Only the com
pone nt of magnetic field perpendicular to the direction of motion of the charge
d ^pa rticle is effective in deflecting it. \(0) Direction of deflecting force o
n the moving charged particle is perpendicular to its velocity. v QA 2 A particl
e of charge q and velocity v passes undeflected through a space wi th non-zero e
lectricfieldE and magneticfieldB. The undeflecting conditions will hold if. (A)
signs of both q and E are reversed. (B) signs of both q and B are r eversed. (C)
both B and E are changed in magnitude, but keeping the product of | B| and |E|
fixed, both B and E are doubled in magnitude. . Two charged particle A and B eac
h of charge +e and masses G X \x 12amuand 13 amu respectively follow a circular
trajectory in chamber X after the velocity selector as shown in the f igure. Bot
h particles enter the velocity selector with speed 1.5 x 10 ms . A uni form magn
(A) This electricfieldis much weaker than the one between the deflecting plates
and can be neglected. (B) Onl y the deflection, d, + d caused by the deflecting
plates is measured in the expe riment. ..(C) There is no deflectionfromthis elec
tric field (D) The magneticfiel dcancels the force caused by this electric field
. 2 2 t 2 } 2 2 2 Question No. 17 to 21 (5 questions) (SS Bansal Classes Questio
n Bank on Magnetic Effect of Current [12]
k Q.21 Ifthe electron is deflected downward when only the electri c field is tur
ne d on (as shown in figure) then in what directions do the electric and magneti
cfi eldspoint in the second part ofthe experiment? (A) The electricfieldpoints t
o th e bottom, while the magneticfieldpoints into the page. / (B) The electricfi
eldpo ints to the bottom, while the magneticfieldpoints out ofthe page. (C) The
electr icfieldpoints to the top, while the magneticfieldpoints into the page. i(
D)The e lectricfieldpoints to the top, while the magneticfieldpoints out of the
page. Q/ L2 A conductor ABCDE, shaped as shown, carries a current i. It is place
d in the xy plane with the ends A and E on the x-axis. Auniform magnetic field o
fmagnitud e B exists in the region. The force acting on it will be Y 4JA) zero,
if B is in the x-direction -(B) XQi in the z-direction, if B is in the y-directi
on JJ2) AB /' in the negative y-direction, if B is in the z-direction (D)2aB/',.
ifB is in t he x-direction . / Q.23 A square loop of side i is placed in the nei
ghbourhood o fan infinitely long straight wire carrying a current I j. The loop
carries a cur rent I as shown in figure (A) The magnetic moment of the loop is p
(B) The magne tic moment ofthe loop is p = / Lk (C) The potential energy of the
loop is minimu m- / % k : (D) The torque experienced by the loop is maximum Q.2
4 The magnetic d ipole p is placed parallel to an infinitely long straight wire
as shown in figur e (A) the potential energy of the dipole is minimum (B) the to
rque acting on the dipole is zero (C) the force acting on the dipole is zero (D)
none of these z 2 u m m ONLY ONE OPTION IS CORRECT. ANSWER Q4 Q.ll Q.18 Q.25 Q.
32 Q.39 Q.46 Q.53 Q.60 Q.67 KEY Qi Q8 Q.15 Q.22 Q.29 Q.36 Q.43 Q.50 Q.57 Q.64 D
A B B C B C B A B Q.l Q.5 Q.9 Q 13 Q.17 Q.21 Q.2 Q.9 Q.16 Q.23 Q.30 Q.37 Q.44 Q.
51 Q.58 Q.65 A C B,C C C D C A A D C B C A D B Q.3 Q.10 Q.17 Q.24 Q.31 Q.38 Q.45
Q.52 Q.59 Q.66 Q.2 Q.6 Q.10 Q.14 Q.18 Q.22 C B C D C B D B A B A,B,C C AD A,B B
AB,C A B A B A C A A A A Q.3 Q.7 Q.ll Q.15 Q.19 Q.23 Q.5 Q.12 Q.19 Q.26 Q.33 Q.
40 Q.47 Q.54 Q.61 A C B A C C C C B Q.6 Q.13 Q.20 Q.27 Q.34 Q.41 Q.48 Q.55 Q.62
A A B D B A C D B Q.7 Q.14 Q.21 Q.28 Q.35 Q.42 Q.49 Q.56 Q.63
D A A B A D C D A ONE OR MORE THAN ONE OPTION MAY BE CORRECT AB,C B,D C,D A. A A
Q.4 Q8 Q.12 Q.16 Q.20 Q.24 AB,C,D AD D B C C (SS Bansal Classes Question Bank o
n Magnetic Effect of Current [12]
BANSAL CLASSES TARGET IIT JEE 2007 XI (PQRS & J) MECHANICAL WA VES Time Limit: 2
Sitting Each of 90 minutes, duration approx. Q UESTION BANK ON
There are 76 questions in this question Objective Question Bank On Mechanical Wa
ves bank. Q.l Q.2 An open organ pipe oflength L vibrates in second harmonic mode
. The pressure vib ration is maximum (A) at the two ends (B) at a distance L/4 f
rom either end insi de the tube (C) at the mid-point of the tube (D) none ofthes
e Figure shown the s hape of part of a long string in which transverse waves are
produced by attachin g one end of the string to tuning fork offrequency250 Hz.
What is the velocity o f the waves? (A) 1.0 ms (B) 1.5 ms(C) 2.0 ms" (D) 2.5 ms1 1 1 1 5cm - 5cm ' \ 0.3cm O.lcrnV / 0.5cm Q.3 A sinusoidal progressive wave is
generated in a string. It's equation is given b y y = (2 mm) sin (2%x 100 7tt +
7t/3). The time when particle at x = 4 m first p asses through mean position, w
ill be 1 1 1 sec 1 (A) 150 sec (D) .100 sec (C) (B ) 12 sec ' 300 v Q.4 A block
of mass 1 kg is hanging vertically from a string of length 1 m and mass/ length
= 0.001 Kg/m. A small pulse is generated at its lower end. The pulse reac hes th
e top end in approximately (A) 0.2 sec (B) 0.1 sec (C) 0.02 sec (D) 0.01 s ec Fi
nd the resultant of 2 wave progressing along x-axis. Yj = 3 sin (3t - 6x) y = 4 cos(3t - 6x) (A) 5 sin (3t- 6 x - 37) (B) 5 sin (3t - 6x + 53) (C) 5 sin (3 t 6x - 53) (D) None 2 ///////// ^^ il Q. 5 Q. 6 A pulse shown here is reflected fro
m the rigid wall A and then fromfreeend B. Th e shape of the string after these
2 reflection will be (A) OB (C) Q)B (B)<>B (D)<> B B Q.7 An open organ pipe of l
ength I is sounded together with another organ pipe of le
ngth I + x in their fundamental tones (x / ) . The beat frequency heard will be
would be the percentage change infrequencyas the source recedes the observer wit
h the same speed. Given that v < v. (v = speed of sound in air) (A) 14.3% (B) 20
% (C)10.0% (D)8.5% Q.23 Four o pen organ pipes of different lengths and differen
t gases H at same temperature a s shown in figure. Let f , f , f and f be N O, th
eir fundamentalfrequenciesthen: [Take Y co = 7/5] CO, 2113 1/3 (A) f /f = 42 (B)
f /f =V72/28 I i (A) (B) (C) (D) (C) fc/f = VTT/28 (D) y f = V W n Q.24 A suffic
iently long close organ pipe has a small hole at its bottom. Initially the pipe
is empty. Water is poured into t he pipe at a constant rate. The fundamental fre
quency of the air column in the p ipe (A) continuously increasing (B) first incr
eases and them becomes constant (C ) continuously decreases (D)firstdecreases an
d them become constant Q.25 Atuning fork offrequency 340 Hz is vibrated just abo
ve a cylindrical tube of length 120 cm. Water is slowly poured in the tube. Ifth
e speed of sound is 340 ms then the
minimum height ofwater required for resonance is: (A) 95 cm (B) 75 cm (C)45cm (
D)25cm Q.26 A metallic wire oflength L isfixedbetween two rigid supports. Ifthe
wire is cooled through a temperature difference AT (Y=young's modulus, p = densi
ty, a = coefficient oflinear expansion) then the frequency oftransverse vibrati
o n is proportional to: a [Ya (C) (B) V 7 F s 2 A B c D 2 f A B B c D A -1 < A )
s&Bansal Classes Objective Question Bank On Mechanical Waves [10]
Q.27 A source of sound moves towards an observer (A) thefrequencyof the source i
s increased. (B) the velocity of sound in the medium is increased. (C) the wave
l ength of sound in the medium towards the observer is decreased. (D) the amplit
ud e of vibration ofthe particles is increased. Q.28 A string isfixedat both end
s v ibrates in a resonant mode with a separation 2.0 cm between the consecutive
node s. For the next higher resonantfrequency,this separation is reduced to 1.6
cm. T he length ofthe string is (A) 4.0 cm (B) 8.0 cm (C) 12.0 ctn (D) 16.0 cm Q
.29 A car moves towards a Kill with speed v . It blows a horn offrequencyfwhich
is hea red by an observer following the car with speed v . The speed of sound in
air is v. (A) the wavelength of sound reaching the hill is j v-v (B) the wavele
ngth of sound reaching the hill is r v + v. \ , (C) the beat frequency observed
by the observer is v - V v. c y c 0 c f (D) the beat frequency observed by the o
bserver .is vc 2 - v,2o c Q.30 A gas is filled in an organ pipe and it is sounde
d with an organ pipe in fundamental mode . Choose the correct statement(s): (T =
constant) . (A) If gas is changed from t o 0 , the resonantfrequencywill increa
se (B) If gas is changed from 0 to N , the resonant frequency will increase (C)
If gas is changedfromN to He, the resonant frequency will decrease (D) If gas is
changed from He to CH , the resonant freq uency will decrease 2 V ( V + V ) f 2
2 2 2 4 Q.31 A composition string is made up byjoining two strings of different
masses p er unit length p and 4p. The composite string is under the same tensio
n. A trans verse wave pulse: Y = (6 mm) sin(5t + 40x), where't' is in seconds an
d 'x' in me ters, is sent along the lighter string towards the joint. The joint
is at x = 0. The equation of the wave pulse reflected from the joint is (A) (2 m
m) sin(5t 40x) (B)(4mm)sin(40x-5t) (C) - (2 mm) sin(5t - 40x) (D)(2mm)sin(5t- lO
x) Q.32 In theprevious question, the percentage ofpower transmitted to the heavi
er string t hrough the joint is approximately (A) 33% (B) 89% (C) 67% (D)75% Q.3
3 A wave tra vels uniformly in all directionsfroma point source in an isotropic
medium. The d isplacement of the medium at any point at a distance r from the so
urce may be re presented by (A is a constant representing strength of source) (A
) [A/ 4~ ] sin (kr - cot) (B) [A/r] sin (kr - cot) (C) [Ar] sin (kr - at) (D) [A
/r ] sin (kr-co t) x 2 Q.34 Three coherent waves of equalfrequencieshaving ampli
tude 10 pm, 4 pm and 7 pm respectively, arrive at a given point with successive
phase difference of 7t/ 2. The amplitude of the resulting wave in mm is given by
(A) 5 (B)6 (C)3 (D)4 s&Bansal Classes Objective Question Bank On Mechanical Wav
es [10]
Q.35 An organ pipe P, closed at one end vibrating in itsfirstovertone. Another p
ipe P open at both ends is vibrating in its third overtone. They are in a reson
a nce with a given tuning fork. The ratio ofthe length of Pj to that ofP is : (A
) 8/3 (B) 3/8 (C) 1/2 (D) 1/3 2 2 Q.36 In a closed end pipe oflength 105 cm, sta
nding waves are set up correspondi ng to the third overtone. What distance from
the closed end, amongst the followi ng, is a pressure Node? (A) 20 cm (B) 60 cm
(C)85cm (D)45em Q.37 A pipe's lower end is immersed in water such that the lengt
h of air columnfromthe top open end has a certain length 25 cm. The speed of sou
nd in air is 350 m/s. The air column is found to resonate with a tuning fork off
requency1750 Hz. By what minimum dis tance should the pipe be rai sed in order t
o make the air column resonate again with the same tuning fork? (A) 7 cm (B) 5 c
m (C)35 cm (D)10cm Q.38 The vibration of a stringfixedat both ends are described
by Y= 2 sin(rcx) sin( 1 007rt) where Y is in mm,x is in cm,t in sec then (A)Max
imum displacement of the particle atx = 1/6 cm would be 1 mm. (B) velocity ofthe
particle at x = 1/6 cm at time t = 1 /600 sec will be 157 V3 mm/s (C) If the le
ngth of the string be 10 cm, number of loop in it would be 5 (D) None of these Q
.39 A perfectly elastic uniform string is suspended vertically with its upper en
dfixedto the ceiling and the lower end loaded with the weight. If a transverse w
ave is imparted to the lower end of th e string, the pulse will (A) not travel a
long the length ofthe string (B) travel upwards with increasing speed (C) travel
upwards with decreasing speed (D) trav elled upwards with constant acceleration
Q.40 A wave is represented by the equat ion y = 10 sin27i(100t-0.02x)+ 10 sin27
t(100t+0.02x). The maximum amplitude and loop length are respectively (A) 20 uni
ts and 3 0 units (B) 20 units and 25 unit s (C) 3 0 units and 20 units (D) 25 un
its and 20 units Q.41 The length, tension, diameter and density of a wire B are
double than the corresponding quantities f or another stretched wire A. Then (A)
fundamental frequency of B is 1/2^2 times that of A. (B) the velocity of wave i
n B is 1/V2 times that ofvelocity in A. (C) the fundamentalfrequencyof A is equa
l to the third overtone ofB. (D) the veloci ty ofwave in B is half that ofveloci
ty in A. Q.42 A standing wave y = A sin 71xj cos (1000;ct) is maintained in a ta
ut string where y and x are expressed in met ers. The distance between the succe
ssive points oscillating with the amplitude A /2 across a node is equal to (A) 2
.5cm (B) 25 cm (C)5cm (D) 10cm 1 2 f 20 ) A . Q.43 A plane wave y=A sin co( ~ ~J
undergo a normal incidence on a plane bou ndary separating medium Mj and M, and
splits into a reflected and transmitted wa ve having speeds v and v then (A) fo
r all values ofv j and v the phase of transm itted wave is same as that of incid
ent wave (B) for all values ofv and v the pha se of reflected wave is same as th
at of incident wave (C) the phase of transmitt ed wave depends upon v. and v (D)
the phase of reflected wave depends upon v and v 2 l 2 2 s&Bansal Classes Objec
tive Question Bank On Mechanical Waves } 2 [10]
Q. 44 A Wire under tension between twofixedpoints A and B, executes transverse v
ibrations in lowest mode so that the mid point O of AB is a node. Then (A) all
p oints of the wire between A and B are in the same phase (B) all points between
A and O are in the same phase (C) any point between A and O and any point betwe
en O and B have a phase difference of %12 (D) any point between A and O and any
po int between O and B have a phase difference of'rc. Q. 45 In case of closed or
gan pipe which harmonic the p" overtone will be (A) 2p +1 (B) 2 p - l (C) p + i
(D) p - 1 Q.46 A wave equation is given as v = cos(500t - 7Gx), where y is in mm
, x inm adn t is in sec. (A) the wave must be a transverse porpagating wave. (B)
Th e speed of the wave is 50/7 m/s (C) The frequency of oscillations 1000n Hz (
D) T wo closest points which are in same phase have separation 207t/7 cm. Q. 47
Which ofthe following statements are wrong about the velocity of sound in air: (
A) de creases with increases in temperature (B) increases with decrease in tempe
rature (C) decreases as humidity increases (D) independent of density of air. Q.
4 8 A clamped string is oscillating in nth harmonic, then (A) total energy of o
scilla tions will be n times that offundamental frequency (B) total energy of os
cillati ons will be (n-1) times that offundamental frequency (C) average kinetic
energy ofthe string over a complete oscillations is half of that of the total e
nergy of the string. (D) none ofthese Q.49 A string of length 1m and linear mass
density O.Glkgnr is stretched to a tension of 100N. When both ends of the strin
g arefix ed,the three lowestfrequenciesfor standing wave are f,, f, and f . When
only one end ofthe string isfixed,the three lowestfrequenciesfor standing wave
are n., a , and n3. Then (A) n = 5n, = f = 125 Hz (B) f = 5f, = r^ = 125 Hz 5 2
2 1 3 3 3 3 (C)f = n = 3f =150Hz 3 2 1 2 (D) = = 75 Hz Q. 5 0 Consider two sound
sources S, and S having same frequency 100Hz and the o bserver 0 located betwee
n them, as shown in thefig.All the three are moving with same velocity in same d
irection. The beat frequency *, ofthe observer is s, 30m s- 030ms- s30ms~ (A) 50
Hz (B) 5 Hz (C)zero (D) 2.5 Hz Q.51 A 2.0m long string wi th a linear mass densi
ty of 5.2 x lO^kgnv and tension 52N has both of its ends f ixed. It vibrates in
a standing wave pattern with four antinoaes. Frequency of t he vibration is (A)
75 Hz (B) 150 Hz ' (C) 100 Hz (D)50Hz 1 1 2 ! 1 Q. 52 An isotropic point source
emits sound of a single frequency. The amplitude of the sound wave at a distance
rfromthe source is proportional to r . The valu e ofn is (A) 2 . (B) V2 (C) 1 (
D) 1/2 Q.53 An engine whistling at a constantfreq uencyn and moving with a const
ant velocity goes past a stationary observer. As t he engine crosses him, thefre
quencyof the sound heard by him changes by a factor f. The actual difference in
thefrequenciesofthe sound heard by him before and a fter the engine crosses him
is 1 1 1 1-f (A)-n (l-P) (B) 2 oj^ f (C) n0 1 (D) n. 1 + f n 0 2 0 n s&Bansal Cl
asses Objective Question Bank On Mechanical Waves [10]
Q.54 A closed organ pipe oflength 1.2 m vibrates initsfirstovertone mode. The pr
essure variation is maximum at: (A) 0.8 m from the open end (B) 0.4 mfromthe op
e n end (C) at the open end (D) 1.0 mfromthe open end Q.55 Thefigureshows four p
ro gressive waves A, B, C & D. It can be concludedfromthe figure that with respe
ct to wave A: (A) the wave C is ahead by a phase angle of 7t/2 & the wave B lags
be hind by a phase angle 7t/2 (B; the wave C lags behind by a phase angle of 7t
/2 & the wave B is ahead by a phase angle of nil (C) the wave C is ahead by a ph
ase angle of 7t & the wave B lags behind by the phase angle of % the wave D lags
beh ind by a phase angle (D) of re & the wave B is ahead by a phase angle of n,
Q.56 The resultant amplitude due to superposition of two waves y = 5sin (wt - k
x) an d y, = -5 c o s ( w t - k x - 150) (A) 5 (B)5V3 (C)5^V3 (0)5^2 + ^3 Q.57 A
closed organ pipe and an open pipe of same length produce 4 beats when they are
set in to vibrations simultaneously. Ifthe length of each ofthem were twice thei
r initi al lengths, the number ofbeats produced will be (A) 2 (B)4 (C)l (D)8 Q.5
8 Source and observer both start moving simultaneouslyfromorigin, one along x-ax
is and t he other along y-axis with speed of source=twice the speed of observer.
The grap h between the apparent frequency observed by observer f and time t wou
ld approxi mately be: l f (A)/ (B) (C)* 2 (D) * Q. 5 9 A closed organ pipe of rad
ius r, and an organ pipe of radius r and having same length 'L' resonate when ex
cited with a given tunning fork. Closed organ p ipe resonates in its fundamental
mode where as open organ pipe resonates in itsf irstovertone, then (A) i - r ,
= L (B) r,- r = L/2 (C) r -2r, = 2.5 L (D) 2r -r, = 2.5 L x 2 2 Q.60 A stationar
y sound source's' of frequency 334 Hz and a stationary observer 'O' are placed n
ear a reflecting surface moving away from the source with veloci ty 2 m/sec as s
hown in the figure. Ifthe velocity of the sound waves is air is V = 330 m/sec, t
he apparent frequency ofthe echo is (A) 332 Hz (B) 326 Hz 2 m/s ( C) 334 Hz (D)
330 Hz -H 0 g ; s&Bansal Classes Objective Question Bank On Mechanical Waves [10
]
Q.61 A person standing at a distance of 6 mfroma source of sound receives sound
wave in two ways, one directly from the source and other after reflectionfroma r
igid boundary as shown in thefigure.The maximum wavelength for which, the perso
n will receive maximum sound intensity, is 6m 16 (B) m (C)2m (A) 4 m ff3 s T Q. 62
Alistender is at rest w.r.t. the source of sound. A wind starts blowing al ong
the line joining the source and the observer. Then (A)frequencyand wavelengt h w
ill not change. (B)frequencyand velocity of sound will not change. (C) freque nc
y and time period will not change. (D)frequency,time period and wavelength wil l
not change. Q. 63 A source S offrequencyf and an observer O, moving with speed
s Vj and v, respectively, are movinng awayfromeach other. When they are separate
d by distance a (t =0), a pulse is emitted by the source. This pulse is receive
d by O at time t. then t., is equal to Q (A) s + 2 v v 0 3 (B) Vl+V s (C) s - 2
V V (D) V, + V? + VQ. 64 A detector is released from rest over a source of sound
of frequency 1 (Hz ) f = 10 Hz. The frequency observed by the detector at time
t is plotted 2000 in the graph. The speed of sound in air is (g = 10 m/s ) (A) 3
30 m/s (B) 350 m/s ( C) 300 m/s (D) 310 m/s 2 1000 t(s) Q.65 The frequency of a
sonometer wire is f, but when the weights producing the tensions are completely
immersed in water the frequency becomes f/2 and on immersing the weights in a ce
rtain liquid the frequency becomes f/3. The specifi c gravity ofthe liquid is: 1
where v is the f 1 X (ii) (iii) (iv) (v) 2. (i) (ii) 3. (i) = : t velocity of so
und in air. 2 4L' v Thefirstovertone f = = 2fj JL/ Propagation of sound in solid
s : The velocity o fpropagation of a longitudinal wave in a rod ofYoung's modulu
s Y and density p i s given by v =- P The velocity of propagation of a transvers
e wave in a streched string Vm where T is the tension in the string and m is the
mass per unit lengt h of the string. In a sonometer wire oflength L and mass pe
r unit length m under tension T vibrating in n loops n 2 L Vm f f l = IY (ii) [.
1 (iii) tilBansal Classes Mechanical Waves [6]
(iv) Propagation of sound in gases fyP Laplace formula - J ~ where y is the rati
o of specific heats, P is the pressure and p is the density. v T _ 1273 + t v V
T i 2 73 V = 1 = = 0 0 4, (i) Doppler ection, source. s s g f Effects: When a so
urce of sound moves with a velocity v in a certain dir the wavelength decreases
in front ofthe source and increases behind the v-v v v A,' (in front) = >
r behind)^;f'=^~f Here v is the velocity of sound in air. ( s (ii) (a) (b) (c) (
d) The apparent frequency = - f When the source is moving towards the observer and
th e observer is moving awayfromthe source, the apparent frequency V-Vp t s o v
. vv When the source and the observer are moving towards each other. s a s 5. 6
tilBansal Classes l^f . _ a V-V When the source and observer are moving awayfrome
ach other, ~ o fs v+v When the source is moving awayfromthe observer and the obs
erver is moving to wards the source v+ v a V + V,. o v s v Here all velocities a
re relation to the medium. Loudness of sound : The loudness level B of sound is
expressed in decibe ls, I B = 10 log T where I is the intensity, I is a referenc
e intensity. Beats : When two tuning forks of close but differentfrequenciesf an
d f are vibrating si multaneously at nearby places, a listener observes afluctua
tionin the intensity of sound, called beats. The number of beats heard per secon
d is fj - f . f = s S 0 v Vs s f = v y a s 0 * c 0 s 0 s 2 2 Mechanical Waves
[6]
Q. 1 Two stationary sources Aand B are sounding notes offrequency680 Hz. An obse
rver movesfromAto B with a constant velocity u. If the speed of sound is 340 ms
, what must be the value ofu so that he hears 10 beats per second? Q. 2 Find th
e intensity of sound wave whosefrequencyis 250 Hz. The displacement amplitude of
p articles of the medium at this position is 1 10 ^ m. The density of the medium
i s 1 kg/m , bulk modulus of elasticity of the medium is 400 N/m . Q. 3 Two str
ing s A and B with |i = 2 kg/m and u = 8 kg/m respectively are joined in series
and kept on a horizontal table with both the endsfixed.The tension in the string
is 200 N. If a pulse of amplitude 1 cm travels in Atowards the junction, thenfi
ndth e amplitude of reflected and transmitted pulse. Q.4 A parabolic pulse given
by e quation y (in cm) = 0.3 - 0. l(x- 5t) (y > 0) x in meter and t in second t
ravell ing in a uniform string. The pulse passes through a boundary beyond which
its ve locity becomes 2.5 m/s. What will be the amplitude ofpulse in this mediu
m after transmission? Q.5 A car moving towards a vertical wall sounds a horn. Th
e driver hears that the sound ofthe horn reflected from the cliff has a pitch ha
lf-octav e higher than the actual sound. Find the ratio ofthe velocity ofthe car
and the velocity of sound. Q. 6 Thefirstovertone of a pipe closed at one end re
sonates w ith the third harmonic of a stringfixedat its ends. The ratio ofthe sp
eed of sou nd to the speed of transverse wave travelling on the string is 2:1. F
ind the rat io ofthe length ofpipe to the length of string. Q.7 A stretched unif
orm wire of a sonometer between two fixed knife edges, when vibrates in its seco
nd harmonic gives 1 beat per second with a vibrating tuning fork of frequency 20
0 Hz. Find t he percentage change in the tension of the wire to be in unison wit
h the tuning fork. Q. 8 A train blowing its whistle moves with a constant veloci
ty v awayfrom an observer on the ground. The ratio of the naturalfrequencyofthe
whistle to tha t measured by the observer is found to be 1.2. Ifthe train is at
rest and the ob server moves awayfromit at the same velocity, thenfindthe ratio.
-1 x 3 2 2 EXERCISE-I Q. 9 Q. 10 Q. 11 Q. 12 Q. 13 Tuning fork A when sounded w
ith a tuning fork B of frequency 480 Hz gives 5 beat s per second. When the pron
gs of A are loaded with wax, it gives 3 beats per sec ond. Find the original fre
quency ofA. A sound wave offrequencyf propagating thro ugh air with a velocity C
, is reflectedfroma surface whi h is moving awayfromthe fixedsource with a const
ant speed n. Find thefrequencyofthe reflected wave, meas ured by the observer at
the position of the source. The loudness level at a dist ance Rfrom a long line
ar source of sound is found to be 40dB. At this point, the amplitude of oscillat
ions of air molecules is 0.01 cm. Thenfindthe loudness lev el & amplitude at a p
oint located at a distance' 1 OR' from the source. A sonome ter wires resonates
with a given tuning fork forming standing waves withfiveanti nodes between the t
wo bridges when a mass of 9 kg is suspendedfromthe wire. When this mass is repla
ced by M, the wire resonates with the same tuning fork formin g three antinodes
for the same position ofbridges. Find the value of M. A car is moving towards a
huge wall with a speed = d 10, where c = speed of sound in sti ll air. A wind is
also blowing parallel to the velocity of the car in the same d irection and wit
h the same speed. If the car sounds a horn of frequency f, then what is the freq
uency of the reflected sound of the horn heared by driver ofthe car? tilBansal C
lasses Mechanical Waves [6]
Q.14 A 40 cm long wire having a mass 3.2 gm and area of c.s. 1 mm is stretched b
etween the support 40.05 cm apart. In its fundamental mode. It vibrate with a f
r equency 1000/64 Hz. Find the young's modulus ofthe wire. 2 Q.l5 A steel rod ha
ving a length of 1 m is fastened at its middle. Assuming youn g's modulus to be
2 x 10 Pa. and density to be 8 gm/cm findthe fundamentalfreque ncyofthe longitud
inal vibration and frequency offirst overtone. 11 3 Q. 16 A sound source of smal
l size produces a spherical sound wave with a freque ncy of 3 kHz in air. At a d
istance r, = 100 m from the source, the sound loudnes s level is L, = 60 dB. Fin
d the sound loudness level at a distance of r,, = 200 m dB and the distance at w
hich the sound stops being heard km. Q.17 Two identica l sounds Aand B reach a p
oint in the same phase. The resultant sound is C. The l oudness of C is n dB hig
her than the loudness ofA. Find the value of n, Q. 18 So und ofwavelength A, pas
ses through a Quincke's tube, which is adjusted to give a maximum intensity I .
Find the distance through the sliding tube should be move d to give an intensity
I /2. 0 0 Q. 19 In a resonance-column experiment, a long tube, open at the top,
is clamped vertically. By a separate device, water level inside the tube can be
moved up o r down. The section of the tubefromthe open end to the water level a
ct as a clos ed organ pipe. A vibrating tuning fork is held above the open end,
and the secon d resonances occur when the water level is 24.1 cm and 74.1 cm rep
sectively belo w the open end. Find the diameter of the tube. [Hint: end correct
ion is 0.3 d] Q . 20 In a mixture of gases, the average number of degrees offree
domper molecule is 6. The mis speed of the molecules of the gas is c. Find the v
elocity of sound in the gas. Q. 21 A sonometer wire of length 114 cm is stretche
d between twofix edpoints. Two bridges, that should be mounted to divide the wir
e into three segm ents, such that their fundamental frequencies are in the ratio
1 : 3 : 4 must be mounted at distance and from onefixedend of the wire. Q. 22 A
fixedsource of sou nd emitting a certainfrequencyappears as f when the observer
is approaching the source with speed v and frequency f when the observer recedes
from the source wi th the same speed. Find the frequency of the source. Q.23 A,
B and C are three t uning forks. Frequency of A is 350Hz. Beats produced by A a
nd B are 5 per second and by B and C are 4 per second. When a wax is put on A be
at frequency between A and B is 2Hz and between A and C is 6Hz. Then,findthe fre
quency of B and C res pectively. tilBansal Classes Mechanical Waves [6]
Q, 1 Thefigureshows a snap photograph ofa vibrating string at t = 0. The particl
e P is observed moving \ up with velocity 2071 cm/s. The angle made by string w
i th x-axis at P is 6. (a) Find the direction in which the wave is moving V^(inio
~ m) (b) the equation ofthe wave (c) the total energy carried by the wave per cy
cl e ofthe string, assuming that p, the mass per unit length of the string = 50
gm/ m, Q.2 A uniform rope oflength L and mass m is held at one end and whirled i
n a horizontal circle with angular velocity . Ignore gravity. Find the time requi
red for a transverse wave to travelfromone end ofthe rope to the other. Q.3 A sy
mmet rical triangular pulse of maximum height 0.4 m and total length 1 m is movi
ng in the positive x-direction on a string on which the wave speed is 24 m/s. At
t = 0 the pulse is entirely located between x = 0 and x = 1 m. Draw a graph of
the t ransverse velocity of particle of string versus time at x =+1 m. 3 (in 10
m 2 EXERCISE-II Q.4 A uniform string240 cm long maintains a standing wave, with
the points on the st ring at which displacements of the amplitude equalling 3 V2
mm occur at 20 cm in terval along the length of the string. Find: (a) the order
ofthe overtone which these oscillations represent (b) the maximum amplitude on
the wire. Q.5 A steel wire 8 x 10" m in diameter isfixedto a support at one end
and is wrapped round a cylindrical tuning peg 5 mm in diameter at the other end.
The length ofthe wire between the peg and the support is 0.06 m. The wire is in
itially kept taut but without any tension. What will be the fundamentalfrequency
of vibration ofthe wir e if it is tightened by giving the peg a quarter of a tur
n? Density of steel = 7 800 kg/m ,Y of steel = 20 x 10 N/m . Q. 6 The displaceme
nt ofthe medium in a sou nd wave is given by the equation ;y = Acos(ax + bt) whe
re A a&b are positive con stants. The wave is reflected by an obstacle situated
at x = 0. The intensity of the reflected wave is 0.64 times that of the incident
wave. (a) what are the wa velength &frequencyofthe incident wave, (b) write the
equation for the reflected wave. (c) in the resultant wave formed after reflect
ion,findthe maximum & minim um values of the particle speeds in the medium. 4 3
10 2 1 Q.7 The harmonic wave y = (2.0 x 1Q- ) cos7C (2.Ox - 50t) travels along a
string tow ard a boundary it x=0 with a second string. The wave speed on the se
cond string is 50 m/s. Write expresions for reflected and transmitted waves. Ass
ume SI units . Q 8 In a stationary wave pattern that forms as a result of reflec
tion ofwavesf roman obstacle the ratio ofthe amplitude at an antinode and a node
is (3= 1.5. W hat percentage ofthe energy passes across the obstacle? Q.9(a) As
tanding wave in second overtone is maintained in a open organ pipe of length /.
The distance be tween consecutive displacement node and pressure node is . (b) T
wo consecutive o vertones produced by a narrow air column closed at one end and
open at the other are 750Hz and 1050Hz. Then the fundamental frequency from the
column is . (c) A standing wave of frequency 1100Hz in a column of methane at 20C
produces nodes t hat are 20 cm apart. What is the ratio ofthe heat capacity at
constant pressure to that at constant volume. Q.10 An open organ pipefilledwith
air has a fundamen tal frequency 500Hz. Thefirstharmonic of another organ pipe c
losed at one end an d filled with carbon dioxide has the same frequency as that
of the first harmoni c of the open organ pipe. Calculate the length of each pipe
. Assume that the vel ocity of sound in air and in carbondioxide to be 330 and 2
64 m/s respectively. i 3 tilBansal Classes Mechanical Waves
[6]
Q. 11 A string, 25cm long, having amass of 0.25 gm/cm, is under tension. Apipe c
losed at one end is 40cm long. When the string is set vibrating in its first ov
e rtone, and the air in the pipe in its fundamental frequency, 8 beats/sec are h
ea rd. It is observed that decreasing the tension in the string, decreases the b
eat frequency. Ifthe speed of sound in air is 320 m/s,findthe tension in the str
ing . Q.12 A metal rod of length I - 100 cmis clamped at two points. Distance of
eac h clampfromnearer end is a=30cm. If density and Young's modulus ofelasticit
y ofr od material are p = 9000 kg m" and Y= 144 GPa respectively, calculate mini
mum an d next higherfrequencyofnatural longitudinal oscillations ofthe rod. Q.13
Two sp eakers are driven by the same oscillator with frequency of 200 Hz. They
are loca ted 4 m apart on a vertical pole. A man walks straight towards the lowe
r speaker in a direction perpendicular to the pole, as shown in figure. (a) Ho w
many tim es will he hear a minimum in sound intensity, and (b) how far is hefro
mthe pole at these moments? Take the speed of sound to be 330 m/s, and ignore an
y sound re flections coming off the ground. Q.14 A cylinder ABC consists of two
chambers 1 and 2 which contains A B C two different gases. The wall C is rigid b
ut the wall s Aand B are thin diaphragms. A vibrating tuning fork approaches the
wall A with velocity u=30 m/s and air columns in chamber 1 and 2 vibrates with
v,=1100m/s . . , . ,v,=300Vse minimum frequency such that there is node (displa
ement) at B and , . * *, * o antinode (displacement) at A. Find (i) the fundament
alfrequencyo f air column, 0.5 m 1.0 m (ii) Find thefrequencyoftuning fork. Assu
me velocity o f sound in the first and second chamber be 1100 m/s and 300 m/s re
spectively. Ve locity of sound in air 330 m/s. Q.15 A source emits sound waves o
f frequency 100 0 Hz. The source moves to the right with a speed of 32 m/s relat
ive to ground. O n the right a reflecting surface moves towards left with a spee
d of 64 m/s relat ive to the ground. The speed of sound in air is 332 m/s. Find
(a) the wavelength of sound in air by source (b) the number ofwaves arriving per
second which meet the reflecting surface, (c) the speed of reflected waves. (d)
the wavelength of reflected waves. Q.16 A supersonic jet plane moves parallel t
o the ground at sp eed v=0.75 mach (1 mach = speed of sound). The frequency of i
ts engine sound is v = 2 kHz and the height of the jat plane is h = 1.5 km. At s
ome instant an obse rver on the ground hears a sound offrequencyv=2 v , Find the
instant prior to th e instant of hearing when the sound wave received by the ob
server was emitted by the jet plane. Velocity of sound wave in the condition of
observer=340 m/s. Q. 1 7 A train oflength/is moving with'a constant speed v alon
g a circular track ofra dius R, The engine ofthe train emits a whistle offrequen
cyf. Find the frequency heard by a guard at the rear end of the train, Q.18 A bu
llet travels horizontall y at 660 m/s at a height of 5 mfroma man. How far is th
e bulletfromthe man when he hears its whistle? Velocity of sound in air = 340 m/
s. 3 . : . 0 0 tilBansal Classes Mechanical Waves [6]
EXERCISE-III Q.l A metallic rod of length 1 m is rigidly clamped at its mid-poin
t. Longitudin al stationary waves are set up in the rod in such a way that there
are two nodes on either side of the mid-point. The amplitude of an antinode is
2* 10 m. Write the equation of motion at a point 2 cmfromthe mid-point and those
of the consti tuent waves in the rod. [Young's modulus = 2 x 10 Nm" , density =
8000 Kg m~ ]. ' [JEE'94, 6] Q. 2 A whistle emitting a sound offrequency440 Hz i
s tied to a str ing of 1.5 m length and rotated with an angular velocity of20 ra
d s in the horiz ontal plane . Calculate the range of frequencies heard by an ob
server stationed at a large distancefromthe whistle. [JEE '96,3 ] Q. 3 Select th
e correct alterna tive: [JEE ' 9 6 , 2 x 2 - 4 ] (i) The extension in a string,
obeying Hooke's la w is x. The speed ofwave in the stretched string is v. If the
extension in the s tring is increased to 1.5 x, the speed ofwave will be _6 11
2 3 _1 (ii) An open pipe is suddenly closed at one end with the result that the
frequency of third harmonic ofthe closed pipe is found to be higher by 100 Hz th
an the funda mentalfrequencyofthe open pipe. The fundamentalfrequencyof the open
pipe is: (A) 200 Hz (B) 300 Hz (C) 240 Hz (D) 480 Hz Q.4 A whistle giving out 4
50 Hz approac hes a stationary observer at a speed of 33 m/s. Thefrequencyheard
by the observe r in Hz is : [JEE '97,1 ] (A) 409 (B) 429 (C) 517 (D) 500 Q. 5 Th
e first overton e of an open organ pipe beats with the first overtone of a close
d organ pipe wit h a beat frequency of 2.2 Hz. The fundamentalfrequencyofthe clo
sed organ pipe is 110 Hz. Find the lengths of the pipes. [JEE'97, 5] Q.6 A place
progressive wave offrequency 25 Hz, amplitude 2.5 * 10~ m&initial phase zero pr
opagates along th e (-ve) x-direction with a velocity of300 m/s. At any instant,
the phase differe nce between the oscillations at two points 6 m apart along th
e line ofpropagatio n is & the corresponding amplitude difference is m. [JEE '97
, 2] Q.7 A band play ing music at afrequency/ is moving towards a wall at a spee
d v . A motorist is f ollowing the band with a speed v . Ifv is the speed of sou
nd, obtain an expressi on for the beat frequency hear. by the motorist. [JEE '97
,5] Q. 8 A travelling i n a stretched string is described by the equation y = A
sin (kx - cot). The maxi mum particle velocity is: [JEE '97,1] (A) A (B) <n/k (C)
dffl/dk (D) x/t Q. 9 Sel ect the correct alternative(s). [JEE 98, 2 + 2 + 2] (i
) The (x, y) co-ordinates of the corners of a square plate are (0, 0) (L, 0) (L,
L) & (0, L). The edges of the plate are clamped & transverse standing waves are
set up in it Ifu (x, y) de notes t he displacement ofthe plate at the point (x,
y) at some instant of time, the possible expressions) for u is/are: (a=positive
constant) 5 b m ! (A) 1.22v (B) 0.61v (C) 1.50v (D)0.75v (A) a c o s l ^ J cosl
I . fnx] . f2Tty^| (C) asinj^ j sin(jJ / 7ty \ (B) a s i n [ - J s i n ^ J K X^ (
7Z Y^
fTty^i (D) a c o s(^ .J sin[ ' tilBansal Classes Mechanical Waves [6]
(ii) (iii) Q.10 (i) (ii) (iii) (iv) Q, 11 Q. 12 (a) (b) Q.13 Q.14 Q.15 Q.16 Q.17
tilBansal Classes A string oflength 0.4 m & mass 10~ kg is tightly clamped at i
ts ends. The tensio n in the string is 1.6 N. Identical wave pulses are produced
at one end at equal intervals of time, At. The minimum value of At which allows
constructive interf erence between successive pulses is : (A) 0.05 s (B) 0.10 s
(C) 0.20 s (D) 0.40 s A transverse sinusoidal wave of amplitude a, wavelength A
&frequencyf is trave lling on a stretched v string. The maximum speed of any po
int on the string is , where v is speed ofpropagation of the wave. If a = 10~ m a
s. After 2 seconds, the tota l energy of the pulses will be (A) zero (B) purely
kinetic rem (C) purely potent ial (D) partly kinetic and partly potential [JEE 2
001 (Scr)] Q. 23 A boat is tra velling in a river with a speed of 10 m/s along t
he stream flowing with a speed 2 m/s. From this boat, a sound transmitter is low
ered into the river through a r igid support. The wavelength of the sound emitte
dfromthe transmitter inside the water is 14.45 mm. Assume that attenuation of so
und in water and air is negligib le. (a) What will be the frequency detected by
a receiver kept inside the river downstream ? (b) The transmitter and the receiv
er are now pulled up into air. Th e air is blowing with a speed 5 m/sec in th; d
irection opposite the river stream . Determine thefrequencyofthe sound detected
by the receiver. (Temperature of th e air and water = 20C; Density of river water
= 10 Kg/m ; Bulk modulus of the wat er = 2.088 x 10 Pa; Gas constant R = 8.31 J
/mol-K; Mean molecular mass of air = 28.8 10" kg/mol; Cp/C for air - 1.4) [JEE 2
001, 5 4 5] Q. 24 A siren placed at a railway platform is emitting sound offrequ
ency5 kHz. A passenger sitting in a m oving train A records afrequencyof 5.5 kHz
while the train approaches the siren. During his return j ourney in a different
train B he records a frequency of 6.0 kHz while approaching the same siren. The
ratio of the velocity of trainB to th at oftrain Ais [JEE 2002 (Scr), 3] (A) 24
2/252 (B)2 (C) 5/6 (D) 11/6 Q. 2 5 A so nometer wire resonates with a given tuni
ng fork forming standing waves withfivea ntinodes between the two bridges when a
mass of 9 kg is suspended from the wire. When this mass is replaced by a mass M
, the wire resonates with the same tuning fork forming three antinodes for the s
ame positions ofthe bridges. The value of M is [JEE 2002 (Scr), 3] (A) 25 kg (B)
5 kg (C) 12.5 kg (D) 1/25 kg 2 -2 3 2 2 2 2 ! 2 1 2 M M 3 3 9 x 3 v tilBansal C
lasses Mechanical Waves [6]
Q.26 Two narrow cylindrical pipes A and B have the same length. Pipe Ais open at
both ends and isfilledwith a monoatomic gas ofmalar mass M . Pipe B is open at
one end and closed at the other end, and is filled with a diatomic gas of molar
mass M . Both gases are at the same temperature. (a) Ifthefrequencyof the second
harmonic ofthe fundamental mode in pipe A is equal to thefrequencyof the third
harmonic ofthe fundamental mode in pipe B, determine the value of M /M . (b) Now
the open end of pipe B is also closed (so that the pipe is closed at both ends)
. Find the ratio of the fundamentalfrequencyin pipe Ato that in pipe B. [JEE 20
0 2,3 + 2] Q.27 A police van moving with velocity 22 m/s and emitting sound offr
eq uency176Hz, follows a motor cycle in turn is moving towards a stationary car
and awayfromthe police van. The stationary car is emitting frequency 165 Hz. If
mot orcyclist does not hear any beats then his velocity is [JEE 2003 (Scr)] (A)
22 m /s (B) 24 m/s (C) 20 m/s (D) 18 m/s Q.28 A cylindrical tube when sounded wi
th a tuning fork gives,firstresonance when length of air column is 0.1 and gives
seco nd resonance when the length of air column is 0.3 5 m. Then end correction
is (A ) 0.025 m (B) 0.020 m (C) 0.018 m (D) 0.012 m [JEE 2003 (Scr)] Q.29 A str
inge be tween x = 0 and x = /vibrates in fundamental mode. The amplitude A, tens
ion T an d mass per unit length p is given. Find the total energy ofthe string.
[JEE 2003 ] A B A B Q.30 A tuning fork offrequency480 Hz resonates with a tube c
losed at one end ofl ength, 16 cm and diameter 5 cm in fundamental mode. Calcula
te velocity of sound in air. [JEE 2003] Q.31 A closed organ pipe of length L and
an open organ pipe c ontain gases of densities p and p respectively. The compre
ssibility ofgases are equal in both the pipes. Both the pipes are vibrating in t
heirfirstovertone with same frequency. The length of the open organ pipe is [JEE
' 2004 (Scr)] L 4L 4L fp7 4L fp7 t 2 x=0 x^l ( A ) Q.32 A source of sound of fre
quency 600 Hz is placed inside water. The speed of sound in water is 1500m/s and
in air it is 300m/'s. Thefrequencyof sound recorde d by an observer who is stan
ding in air is (A) 200 Hz (B) 3000 Hz (C) 120 Hz (D) 600Hz [JEE2004 (Scr)] Q.33
A stringfixedat both ends is in resonance in its 2nd harmonic with a tuning fork
offrequency f,. Now its one end becomes free. If th e frequency of the tuning f
ork is increased slowly from f, then again a resonanc e is obtained when thefreq
uencyis f . Ifin this case the string vibrates in nth harmonic then 2 i WT ( C )
t ^ WTVft
(D) n = 5, fi, f, [JEE 2005 (Scr)] Q.34 In a resonance column method, resonance
occurs at two successive level of /,=30.7 cm and l = 63.2 cmusing a tuning fork
of f = 512 Hz. What is the maximum error in measuring speed of sound using relat
ions v = f X & X = 2(/2 -1 (A) 256 cm/sec (B) 92 cm/sec (C) 128 cm/sec (D) 102.
4 cm/sec [JEE 2005 (Scr)] Q.35 A whistling train approaches a junction. An obser
v er standing at junction observers thefrequencyto be 2.2 KHz and 1.8 KHz of the
a pproaching and the receding train. Find the speed of the train (speed sound =
30 0 m/s). [JEE 2005] Q.36 A transverse harmonic disturbance is produced in a s
trin g. Themaximum transverse velocity is 3 m/sand maximum transverse accelerati
on is 90 m/s . Ifthe wave velocity is 20 m/s thenfindthe waveform. [JEE 2005] 2
1 2 2 2 2 (A)n = 3 , f = | f (B) n = 3, f = fj (C) n = 5, f = | f, tilBansal Cla
sses Mechanical Waves [6]
ANSWER KEY Q.l Q.5 Q.10 2.5 ms1:5 1 Q.2 Q.6 9 2 71 X10 2 EXERCISER 2 -9 1:1 W/m
Q.7 Q.3 1% A = - - c m , \ = - cm Q.4 0.2 cm Q.8 1.25 Q.9 485 Hz r 1 2 Q.ll 30 d
B, 10VlO nm C+v Q.14 1 x 10 Nm Q. 15 2.5 kHz, 7.5 kHz Q. 16 54,100 Q.17 6 Q.18 X
/8 Q.20 2c/3 Q.l Q 2 Q.12 25kg Q.13 l l f / 9 Q.21 72, 96 or 18, 42 3 EXERCISE-I
I f Q.19 3 cm f +f Q.22 - Q.23 345, 341 or 349 Hz L (a) negative x; (b)y = 4x10'
sin IOOTC 3 t + 0 . 5 x + I (x, y in meter); (c) 12 % x 10~ J I 4 ) 2 5 , \ Q.4
(a)5, 11(b) 6mm; 3V2 mm Q.5 10800Hz Q.6 (a) 2 7t/a, b/2n, (b) y = 0.8 A cos (ax
-bt), (c) max =1.8 b A, min. = 0, Q.7 (a) 6.67 x lO" cos % (2.0x + 501) ; (b) 2.
67 10" cos n (1. Ox- 50t) SI units Q.8 96% Q.9 (a) //6; (b) 150 Hz; (c)1.28 Q .1
0 33 cm and 13.2 cm Q.ll 67.6 N Q.12 10kHz, 30kHz Q.13 (a) 2; (b) 9.28 mand 1. 9
9 m Q.14 1650 Hz, 1500 Hz Q. 15 (a) 0.3 m,(b) 1320, (c) 332 m/s, (d) 0.2 m Q.16
5.9 sec Q.17 f Q.18 9.7 m 2 4 x 3 it
19.2m/s Q 3 V'r 1/48 sec 1/24 sec _ -19.2m/s Q.l y=2* 10" sin(0. l7i)cos (25000
7rt +0), for 0=0: y -10" sin (5flx-250007it), y =10 sin (5toc+250007rt) Q /max =
484 Hz, f = 403.3 Hz Q.3 (i) A, (ii) A Q.4 D Q.5 L,-0.75 m; L = 0.99 m or 1.006
m Q.6 urad, 0m (v v Q.7 2v~2 +~~2 ) f Q.8 A Q.9 (i)B,C(ii)B,(iii)AC 6 t 6 2 -6
2 m i n o b m EXER CIS E-I11 V - v b Q.10 ( i ) L ^ r n , ( u ) ^ , ( i i i ) P
= P = P , ( i v ) P = V A P , P ^ P A P m a x m i 0 m x 0 0 r r 2 1 2 1 0 Q.ll B
Q.17 D (4-2^3) Q. 12 (a)Time = 140ms, (b) A = V + V, A- = 1.5 cm; A = ^ + v A= 2cm Q.13 A,C,D Q.14 B, C,D Q.15 A, B, C Q.16 A, B, C Q.18 Q.21 C Q.31 C B Q.19
Q.22 B 3 D Q.20 Q.23 (a) 100696 Hz (b) 103038 Hz Q.28 A Q.33 C h = 3.2, 2.4, 1.
6, 0.8, 0 ; v = 5 x 1 0 ~ 3 Q.24 B 2 J m ; A t = 80
Q.25 A Q.26 (a) 2.116, (b) Q.27 A Q.29 E = Q.34 D A TC T 2 4 / Q.30 336 m/s s Q.
32 D 3 Q.36 y = (10 cm) sin ( 301 x + <J>) Q.35V = 30m/s tilBansal Classes Mecha
nical Waves [6]
BANSALCLASSES TARGET IIT JEE 2007 XII (ALL) MODERN PHYSICS QUESMOa MMEJM
QUESTION FOR SHORT ATOMIC ANSWER PHYSICS Q.l Q. 2 Q. 3 Q. 4 Q. 5 Q. 6 Q.7 Q. 8 Q
. 9 In the photoelectric effect, why does the existence of a cutofffrequency spe
ak i n favour of the photon theory and against the wave theory? Explain the stat
ement that one's eyes could not detect faint starlight if light were not particl
e-lik e. How can a photon energy be given by E = h/when the very presence of the
frequ ency/in the formula implies that light is a wave? The momentum p of a pho
ton is given by p = hIX. Why is it that c, the speed oflight, does not appear in
this e xpression? Given that E = h/'for a photon, the Doppler shift in frequenc
y of rad iation from a receding light source would seem to indicate a reduced en
ergy for the emitted photons. Is this in fact true? If so, what happened to the
conservat ion of energy principle? Any series of atomic hydrogen yet to be obser
ved will p robably be found in what region of the spectrum? Can a hydrogen atom
absorb a ph oton whose energy exceeds its binding energy( 13.6 eV)? Only a relat
ively small number ofBalmer lines can be observed from laboratory discharge tube
s, whereas a large number are observed in stellar spectra. Explain this in terms
ofthe small density, high temperature, and large volume of gases in stellar atm
ospheres. Wn at is the origin ofthe cutoffwavelength X offigure shown? Why is it
an important clue to the photon nature ofx rays? mm e u a < u > 30 40 50 60 70
80 90 Wavelength (pm) Q. 10 Can atomic hydrogen be caused to emit x rays? If so,
describe how. Ifnot, why not? Q.ll Why is it that B ohr theory, which does not
work very well even fo r helium (Z = 2), gives such a good account ofthe charact
eristic x-ray spectra o fthe elements, or at least of that portion that originat
es deep within the atom? Q.12 The ionization potential of hydrogen is 13.6 V. Ye
t to obtain discharge in a cathode ray tubefilledwith hydrogen, a very high volt
age ( ~10 V) has to be a pplied across the tube. Explain this clearly. Also expl
ain why the gas must be a t low pressure to obtain discharge. 4 (fe Bansal Class
es Question Bank on Modern Physics 12]
Q.13 X-rays are produced when a fast electron hits a proper target. What happens
to the electron? Q.14 Why does the tail of a comet always point away from the s
un? Q.15 A neutron pion at rest decays into two gamma photons. 7t -> y + y Why ca
n not a single photon be born? What conservation law is in contradiction with it
? Q.16 What is so special about e/m rather than e end m separately? Q.17 Why is
it advisable to view a TV screen from a distance of about ten feet? Q. 18 The el
ec trical conductivity of a gas increases when X-rays or y-rays pass through it.
Ex plain this phenomenon. Q.19 In photoelectric emission exchange of energy tak
es p lace among... (photon and electron/' photon, electron and lattice). Q.20 Th
e thr eshold frequencies for photoemission for three metals numbered 1,2,3 are r
espect ively v v v and Vj > v > v . An incident radiation of frequency v > v ...
cause photoemissionfrom3 but... cause photoemissionfrom1 (fill in the gaps with
may, m ay not / will certainly). p 3 2 3 0 2 NUCLEAR PHYSICS Q. 1 Why does the
relative importance ofthe Coulomb force compared to the strong nuclear force inc
rease at large mass numbers? Q.2 Q. 3 In your body, are there more neutrons than
protons? More protons than electrons? Discuss Why is the bind ing energy per nu
cleon (seefigure)low at low mass numbers? At high mass numbers? Jnisiqp ii.. ~5 B
r 120* f iV i j r-^stability Region of greatest Fission !H . i 0 20 40 2 ' 1 60 8
0 100 120 MO 161) 180 200 220 240 Q.4 Q.5 Aradioactive nucleus can emit a positr
on, e . This corresponds to a proton in th e nucleus being converted to a neutro
n The mass ofa neutron, however, is greater than that ofa proton. How thai can p
ositron emission occur? In beta decay the e mitted electrons form a continuous s
pectrum, but in alpha decay the alpha partic les form a discrete spectrum. What
difficulties did this cause in the explanatio n ofbeta decay, and how were these
difficultiesfinallyovercome? + Mass number, A (fe Bansal Classes Question Bank
on Modern Physics 3]
Q.6 How do neutrinos differ from photons? Each has zero charge and (presumably)
zero rest mass and travels at the speed oflight. Q.7 In radioactive dating with
U, h ow do you get around the fact that you do not know how much U was present i
n the rocks to begin with? (Hint: What is the ultimate decay product of U?) Q.8
If it is so much harder to get a nucleon out of a nucleus than to get an electro
n out of an atom, why try? Q.9 In the generalized equation for thefissionof U by
ther mal neutrons, U + n -> X+Y + bn, do you expect the Q of the reaction to de
pend o n the identity of X and Y? Q.10 The half-life of U is 7.0 x 10 y. Discuss
the as sertion that ifit had turned out to be shorter by a factor of 10 or so,
there wo uld not be any atomic bombs today. Q.ll The binding energy curve offigu
retells u s that any nucleus more massive than A 5 6 can release energy by the f
ission pro cess. Only very massive nuclides seem to do so, however. Why cannot l
ead, for ex ample, release energy by the fission process? 238 238 238 235 235 23
5 8 Region of greatest ^"stability J-'usiqp "'"Jr 5 Fission 7 He 4 Bp B r I20g 1
I 5 7 f l c '^Au 2 3 9 Pu H 0 . .i 20 40 60 80 1 00 120 140 160 180 200 220 240
i iiii Mass number, A Q.12 Elements up to mass number w 5 6 are created by thermonu
ar fusion in the cores of stars. Why are heavier elements not also created by th
is process? Q.13 Which would generate more radioactive waste products: - afissio
nreactor or a fu sion reactor? Q. 14 How can Becquerel rays, i.e., the combinati
on of a-, P- and y-rays, be separated? Q.15 When a nucleus undergoes a-decay, is
the product atom electrically neutral? In (3-decay? Q.16 Experimental results i
n radioactivity s how small variations from the results predicted by theory. Exp
lain this. Q.17 If a nucleus emits only a y-rays photon, does its mass number ch
ange? Does its mas s change? (fe Bansal Classes Question Bank on Modern Physics
4]
ONLY ONE OPTION IS CORRECT. Take approx. 2 minutes for answering each question.
Q. 1 Let n and n be respectively the number of photons emitted by a red bulb and
a blue bulb of equal power in a given time. (A)n = n (B)n <n (C)n >n (D) data i
nsufficient Q.2 10~ W of 5000 A light is directed on a photoelectric cell. If t
h e current in the cell is 0.16 pA, the percentage of incident photons which pro
du ce photoelectrons, is (A) 0.4% (B) .04% (C) 20% (D) 10% Q.3 A proton and an e
lec tron are accelerated by same potential difference have de-Broglie wavelength
Xp and A,. (A) Xe = Xp (B) < (C) Xe > X (D) none of these. Q ,4 Two electrons a
re m oving with the same speed v. One electron enters a region ofuniform electri
c fie ld while the other enters a region ofuniform magneticfield,then after some
time i fthe de-Broglie wavelengths of the two are X{ and X2, then: (A) = X (B)Aj
> X (C ) X < X (D) X > X or X < X Q.5 In a photo-emissive cell, with exciting w
avelengt h X, the maximum kinetic energy of electron is K. If the 3X exciting wa
velength is changed to the kinetic energy ofthe fastest emitted electron will be
: (A) 3K/ 4 (B) 4K/3 (C) less than 4K/3 (D) greater than 4K/3 Q.6 If the frequen
cy of ligh t in a photoelectric experiment is doubled, the stopping potential wi
ll (A) be d oubled (B) halved (C) become more than doubled (D) become less than
double Q.7 A n electron with initial kinetic energy of 100 eV is acceleration th
rough a poten tial difference of 5 0 V Now the de-Broglie wavelength of electron
becomes r b r b r b r b 3 e p 2 2 l 2 1 2 l 2 ^ Q.8 (A)lA (B)VL5A 2 (C) V3 A 2
(D) 12.27 A 12 Q. 9 If h Planck's is SI (A) is10" h constant (B)h system, the mo
mentum of ahphoton o fwavelength 0.01 A is: (C)10 ^(D) 10 h The stopping potenti
al for the photo elec trons emitted from a metal surface of work function 1.7 eV
is 10.4 V. Identify t he energy levels corresponding to the transitions in hydr
ogen atom which will re sult in emission ofwavelength equal to that ofincident r
adiation for the above p
hotoelectric effect (A)n = 3 to 1 (B)n = 3 to 2 (C)n=2tol (D)n = 4 t o l Q.10 Wh
en a photon oflight collides with a metal surface, number of electrons, ( if any
) coming out is (A) only one (B) only two (C) infinite (D) depends upon fa ctors
Q. 11 Two radioactive material Aj and ^ have decay constants of 10 X0 and X0. I
f initially they have same number ofnuclei, the ratio of number of their un deca
yed nuclei will be (1/e) after a time ()r A L ^ ^ 1 (> i s : 1 c 1 dl Bansal Cla
sses Question Bank on Modern Physics i [5]
Q.12 The frequency and the intensity of a beam oflight falling on the surface of
photoelectric material are increased by a factor of two. This will: (A) increas
e the maximum energy of the photoelectrons, as well as photoelectric current by
a factor of two. (B) increase the maximum kinetic energy of the photo electrons
and would increase the photoelectric current by a factor of two. (C) increase t
h e maximum kinetic energy ofthe photoelectrons by a factor of greater than two
an d will have no effect on the magnitude ofphotoelectric current produced. (D)
not produce any effect on the kinetic energy ofthe emitted electrons but will in
cre ase the photoelectric current by a factor of two. Q Jo Light comingfroma dis
char ge tubefilledwith hydrogen falls on the cathode ofthe photoelectric cell. T
he wo rk function ofthe surface of cathode is 4eV Which one ofthe following valu
es of the anode voltage (in Volts) with respect to the cathode will likely to ma
ke the photo current zero. (A) - 4 (B)-6 (C) - 8 (D)-10 Q. 14 A point source of
ligth is used in a photoelectric effect. Ifthe source is removed fartherfromthe
emitti ng metal, the stopping potential: (A) will increase (B) will decrease (C)
will r emain constant (D) will either increase or decrease. QJ/5 A point source
causes photoelectric effect from a small metal plate. Which ofthe following cur
ves may represent the saturation photocurrent as a function of the distance betw
een the source and the metal ? (A) (B) (C) (D) Q.16 Let Kj be the maximum kineti
c energy of photoelectrons emit ted by a light of wavelength A, and K correspond
ing to X . If = 2"k , then: 2 2 2 2 2 2 (A) 2Kj = K (B) K, - 2K (C)K,<| (D) K, >
2K Q. 17 In a photoelectric experiment, the potential difference V that must be
maintained between the illuminated surf ace and the collector so as just to pre
vent any electron from reaching the colle ctor is determined for differentfreque
nciesfofthe incident illumination. The gra ph obtained is shown. The maximum kin
etic energy ofthe electrons emitted atfrequ encyf, is Vi (D)eV (f -f ) (C)h(f -f
) (A) iff. (^ )( f7fT3io ) M i-f Q.18 Radia tion oftwo photon energies twice an
dfivetimes the work function of metal are inc ident sucessively on the metal sur
face. The ratio ofthe maximum velocity of phot oelectrons emitted is the two cas
es will be (A) 1 :2 (B)2 . 1 (C) 1 4 (D)4: 1 Q. 19 Cut off potentials for a meta
l in photoelectric effect for light ofwavelength X ,X and X is found to be Vj, V
and V volts if Vj, V and V are inArithmetic Pro gression and A,,, X and A will
be: (A) Arithmetic Progression (B) Geometric Prog ression (C) Harmonic Progressi
and n are the principal quantum numbers of the two states. Assume the Bohr mode
l to be valid. The frequency of orbital motion of the electron in the initial st
ate is 1/27 of that in thefinalstate. Th e possible values of n and n are (A) n
=4, n = 2 (6)^=3,^=1 (0)^ = 8,^=1 (0)^ = 6,^ = 3 Q.37 The radiu s of B ohr' sfir
storbit is a . The electron in n orbit ha s a radiu s: (A) na (B)a /n (C)n a (D)
a /n t 2 2 2 } 2 2 2 2 2 t 2 t 2 0 th 0 0 2 0 0 2 (fe Bansal Classes Question Ba
nk on Modern Physics 8]
Q.38 The ionisation potential of hydrogen atom is 13.6 volt. The energy required
to remove an electron from ^ the second orbit of hydrogen is: (A) 3.4 eV (B)6.8
eV (C)13.6eV (D)27.2eV Q.39 Electron in a hydrogen atom is replaced by an ident
i cally charged particle muon with mass 207 times that of electron. Now the radi
us of K shell will be (A) 2.56 x 10~ A (B) 109.7 A (C) 1.21 x 10~ A (D)22174.4A
3 3 Q.40 Monochromatic radiation of wavelength X is incident on ahydrogen sample
con taining in ground state. Hydrogen atoms absorb the light and subsequently e
mit r adiations of ten different wavelengths. The value of X is (A) 95 nm (B)103
nm (C) 73nm (D)88nm Q.41 When a hydrogen atom, initially at rest emits, a photon
result ing in transition n = 5 -> n = 1, its recoil speed is about (A) 10^ m/s
(B) 2 x 10" m/s (C) 4.2 m/s (D) 3.8 x l(T m/s 2 2 Q. 42 An electron collides wit
h afixedhydrogen atom in its ground state. Hydroge n atom gets excited and the c
olliding electron loses all its kinetic energy. Con sequently the hydrogen atom
may emit a photon corresponding to the largest wavel ength ofthe Balmer series.
The min. K.E. of colliding electron will be (A) 10.2 eV (B) 1.9 eV (C)12.1eV (D)
13.6eV Q.43 Thefrequencyof revolution of electron in n Bohr orbit is v . The gra
ph between log n and log (v / v,) may be th n n Q. 44 Consider the spectral line
resulting from the transition n = 2 n = 1 in the atoms and ions given below. The
shortest wavelength is produced by: (A) hydroge n atom (B) deuterium atom (C) s
ingly ionized helium (D) doubly ionized lithium Q .45 In an atom, two electrons
move around the nucleus in circular orbits of radi i R and 4R. The ratio of the
time taken by them to complete one revolution is: ( neglect electric interaction
) (A) 1:4 (B) 4 : 1 (C) 1 : 8 (D) 8 : 1 Q.46 The ele ctron in hydrogen atom in a
sample is in n excited state, then the number of dif ferent spectrum lines obta
ined in its emission spectrum will be: (A) 1 + 2 + 3 + +(n - 1) (B) 1 + 2 + 3 +
+ (n) (C) 1 + 2 + 3 + +(n +1) (D) 1 2 x 3 x x ( _ l) Q .47 The total energy of a
hydrogen atom in its ground state is -13,6eV. If the p otential energy in the f
irst excited state is taken as zero then the total energ y in the ground state w
ill be : <L (A) -3.4eV (B) 3.4 eV (C)-6.8eV (D)6.8eV lh x n (fe Bansal Classes Q
uestion Bank on Modern Physics 9]
Q. 48 A neutron collides head on with a stationary hydrogen atom in ground state
(A) If kinetic energy of the neutronis less than 13.6eV, collisionmust be elast
ic (B) if kinetic energy of the neutron is less than 13,6eV, collision may be i
n elastic. (C) inelastic collision takes place when initial kinetic energy of ne
ut ron is greater than 13. 6eV. (D) perfectly inelastic collision cannot take pl
ace . Q. 49 The electron in a hydrogen atom make a transitionfroman excited stat
e to the ground state. Which ofthe following statement is true ? (A) Its kinetic
ene rgy increases and its potential and total energies decrease (B) Its kinetic
ener gy decreases, potential energy increases and its total energy remains the
same. (C) Its kinetic and toal energies decrease and its potential energy increa
ses. ( D) its kinetic potential and total energies decreases. Q. 5 0 The magnitu
de of a ngular momentum, orbit radius and frequency of revolution of electron in
hydroge n atom corresponding to quantum number n are L, r and frespectively The
n accordi ng to Bohr's theory of hydrogen atom, (A) fr L is constant for all orb
its (B)frL is constant for all orbits (C) frL is constant for all orbits (D) frL
is constan t for all orbits 2 2 Q.51 In a characteristic X- ray spectra of some
atom superimposed on continuous X-ray spectra: (A) P represents K line C (B) Q
represents Kp line (C) Q and P re presents K and K lines respectively (D) Relati
ve positions of K and K depend on the particular atom a a p a B a f J J J Q.52 T
he "K " X-ray s emission line of tungsten occurs at X = 0.021 nm. The ener gy di
fference between K and L levels in this atom is about (A) 0.51 MeV (B) 1.2 MeV X
> A B (C)59keV (D)13.6eV Q.53 Consider the nuclear reaction 200 110 + 90 Ifthe
binding energy per nucleon for X, AandB is7.4MeV, 8.2. MeV and 8.2 MeV respectiv
ely, what is the energy re leased ? (A) 200 MeV (B) 160 MeV (C) 110 MeV (D) 90 M
eV Q. 54 The binding energy per nucleon for C is 7.68 MeV and that for C is 7.5
MeV The energy required to remove a neutron from C is (A) 5.34 MeV (B) 5.5 MeV (
C) 9.5 MeV (D)9.34MeV Q. 5 5 The binding energies ofnuclei X and Y are E and E r
espectively. Two atoms of X fuse to give one atom of Y and an energy Q is releas
ed. Then: (A) Q = 2Ej-E (B) Q = E -2EJ (C)Q = 2EJ+E (D)Q = 2E + EJ 12 13 13 L 2
2 2 2 2 Q. 5 6 Radius ofthe second Bohr obit of singly ionised helium atom is (A
) 0.53 A (B) 1.06 A (C) 0.265 A (D) 0.132 A Q. 5 7 An electron in Bohr's hydroge
n atom h as an energy of-3.4 eV. The angular momentum ofthe electron is (A) h /
7i ' " (B ) h / 2TC (C) nh / (n is an integer) (D)2h/7t (fe Bansal Classes Quest
ion Bank on Modern Physics 10]
Q.58 If each fission in a U nucleus releases 200 MeV, how many fissions must occ
urs per second to produce a power of 1 KW (A) 1.325 x 10 (B)3.125 x 10 (C) 1.23
5 x 10 (D) 2.135 x 10 235 13 13 13 13 Q.59 The rest mass of the deuteron, ] H, i
s equivalent to an energy of 1876 MeV, the rest mass of a proton is equivalent t
o 93 9 MeV and that of a neutron to 94 0 MeV. A deuteron may disintegrate to a p
roton and a neutron if it : (A) emits a y - ray photon of energy 2 MeV (B) captu
res ay- ray photon of energy 2 MeV (C) emits a y-ray photon of energy 3 MeV (D)
captures a y - ray photon of energy 3 M eV Q.60 In an a-decay the Kinetic energy
of a particle is 48 MeV and Q-value oft he reaction is 5 0 MeV. The mass number
of the mother nucleus is: (Assume that d aughter nucleus is in ground state) (A
) 96 (B) 100 (C) 104 (D) none ofthese Q.61 In the uranium radioactive series the
initial nucleus is U , and thefinalnucleu s is Pb . When the uranium nucleus de
cays to lead, the number ofa - particles em itted is.. and the number of (3-part
icles - emitted... (A) 6, 8 (B) 8, 6 (C) 16, 6 (D) 32, 12 92 238 82 206 Q.62 The
radioactive sources Aand B ofhalf lives of2 hr and 4 hr respectively, i nitiall
y contain the same number ofradioactive atoms. At the end of 2 hours, the ir rat
es of disintegration are in the ratio : (A)4:l (B) 2 : 1 (C)V^:1 (D) 1 : 1 Q.63
In a RA element the fraction of initiated amount remaining after its mean life t
ime is 1 1 (A)l-(D) 1- e~ (B)^ (C) Q. 64 90% of a radioactive sample is le ft un
decayed after time t has elapsed. What percentage ofthe initialsample will decay
in a total time 2t: (A) 20% (B) 19% (C) 40% (D) 38% Q.65 A radioactive mat eria
l of half-life T was produced in a nuclear reactor at different instants, th e q
uantity produced second time was twice ofthat producedfirsttime. If now their pr
esent activities are Aj and A respectively then their age difference equals: t 2
, InA, A A (B)T In A, T In 2A, 2 2 A z (D)T l n2A, A 2 } R, Q.66 Activity of a r
adioactive substance is Rj at time tj and R^ at time t (t > t ). Then the ratio
^ is: h (A)(B) -Mt +t ) e v 2 \ -t ^ (C)e l 2 f l l
(D) Mti-t ) e 2 Q.67 There are two radionuclei Aand B. Ais an alpha emitter and
B is a beta emit ter. Their distintegration constants are in the ratio of 1 : 2.
What should be t he ratio of number of atoms of two at time t = 0 so that proba
bilities of gettin g a and (3 particles are same at time t = 0. (A) 2 : 1 (B) 1
: 2 (C) e (D) e" 1 (fe Bansal Classes Question Bank on Modern Physics 11]
Q.68 The activity of a sample reduces from Aq to A / y 3 inonehour. The activity
after 3 hours more will be A A o A () r 2 < >i7? A x 0 w-f n A 0 Q.69 Halflife
of radium is 1620years. How many radium nuclei decay in 5 hours in 5 gm radium?
(Atomic weight of radium = 223) (A) 9.1 10 (B) 3.23 x 10 (C) 1.72 x 10 (D)3.3xl0
12 15 20 17 Q. 70 Halflife for certain radioactive element is 5 min. Four nucle
i of that ele ment are observed at a certain instant oftime. Afterfiveminutes As
sertion (A): I t can be definitely said that two nuclei will be left undecayed.
Reasoning (R): After halflife i. e. 5 minutes, half of total nuclei will disinte
grate. So only two nuclei will be left undecayed. Then (A) A is correct & R is c
orrect explanat ion ofA. (B) Both are correct. But R is not correct explanation
of A. (C) A is i ncorrect & Ris correct. (D) Both are incorrect. Q. 71 A certain
radioactive nucl ide of mass number m^ disintegrates, with the emission of an e
lectron and y radi ation only, to give second nuclied ofmass number m^ Which one
ofthe following eq uation correctly relates rr^ and m ? y (A)m = m + 1 y x (B)m
= m - 2 y x (C)m = m - 1 y x (D)m = m y x Q.72 The number ofa and (3 "emitted d
uring the radioactive decay chain starting from gg Ra andendingat ^ I? Pb is (A)
3a&6p(B) 4a & 5(3~ (C)5a&4p" (D)6a&6p" Q.73 The activity ofa sample of radioacti
ve material is A, at time t, and .A, at tim e t (t >t,). Its mean life is T. A A 6 2 2 (A) Ajt, = A t / , (B)/,</; 2
2 2 (B) = constant(C) A = A, j w r (D) 2 = \ (MTt ) e 2 Q. 74 (A)/, >/, /, of a
radioactive sample decays in one mean life, and a fracti onf decays in one halflife. Afraction (C)/ =f (D) May be (A), (B) or (C) depend ing on the values of t
he mean life and halflife 1 Q.75 A radioactive substance is being produced at a
constant rate of 10 nuclei/s . The decay constant ofthe substance is 1/2 sec" .
After what time the number of radioactive nuclei will become 10? Initially there
are no nuclei present. Assum e decay law holds for the sample. 1 (A) 2.45 sec (
B) log(2) sec (C) 1.386 sec (D ) sec Q.76 The radioactivity ofa sample is R, at
time Tj and R at time T . If th e halflife of the specimen is T. Number of atoms
that have disintegrated in time (T - Tj) is proportional to (A) ( R J , - R T )
(B) (Rj - R , ) T (C) (RJ -R,)/ T (D) (Rj - R,) (T - T ) 2 2 2 2 2 t 2 (fe Bans
al Classes Question Bank on Modern Physics 12]
Q. 77 The decay constant of the end product of a radioactive series is (A) zero
(B) infinite (C)finite(non zero) Q. 78 At time t = 0, N, nuclei of decay constan
t rate of the mixture is : (A) N N e~^ " ^ 1 2 1+> 2 (D) depends on the end pro
duct. 2 & N, nuclei of decay constant X are mixed . The decay (B) + 2 2 X2t (x x
)t r 2 VN2 7 1 ] 2 2 (C) +(N X e" +N A e" ) 1 1 Xlt (D) +N X N X e % Bansal Cla
sses Question Bank on Modern Physics
ONE OR MORE THAN ONE OPTION MAY BE CORRECT Take approx. 3 minutes for answering
each question. Q.l Q. 2 Q.3 In photoelectric effect, stopping potential depends
on (A) frequency ofthe incident light (B) intensity ofthe incident light by vari
es source distance (C) emitter's properties (D)frequencyand intensity ofthe inc
i dent light An electron in hydrogen atomfirstjumpsfromsecond excited state tofi
rs texcited state and then, from first excited state to ground state. Let the ra
tio of wavelength, momentum and energy of photons in the two cases be x, y and z
, t hen select the wrong answer/(s): (A)z= 1/x (B) x=9/4 (C) y=5/27 (D)z=5/27 .A
n el ectron is in an excited state in hydrogen-like atom. It has a total energy
of-3. 4 eV. If the kinetic energy ofthe electron is E and its de-Broglie wavelen
gth is X, then (A) E = 6.8 eV, A, = 6.6 x 10" m (B) E = 3.4 eV, X = 6.6 x lO- m
(C) E = 3.4 eV, X = 6.6 10" m (D) E = 6.8 eV, X = 6.6 x 10" m 10 10 x 11 11 Q.4
A particular hydrogen like atom has its ground state binding "energy 122.4eV. It
s is in ground state. Then: (A) Its atomic number is 3 (B) An electron of 90eV
c an excite it. (C) An electron of kinetic energy nearly 91 8eV can be brought t
o almost rest by this atom. (D) An electron of kinetic energy 2.6eV may emerge f
ro m the atom when electron of kinetic energy 125eV collides with this atom. A b
eam ofultraviolet light of all wavelengths passes through hydrogen gas at room t
emp erature, in the x-direction. Assume that all photons emitted due to electron
tra nsition inside the gas emerge in the y-direction. Let Aand B denote the lig
hts e mergingfromthe gas in the x and y directions respectively. (A) Some of the
incid ent wavelengths will be absent in A. (B) Only those wavelengths will be p
resent in B which are absent in A. (C) B will contain some visible light. (D) B
will co ntain some infrared light. If radiation of allow wavelengthsfromultravio
let to i nfrared is passed through hydrogen agas at room temperature, absorption
lines wi ll be observed in the : (A) Lyman series (B) Baimer series (C) both (A
) and (B) (D) neither (A) nor (B) Q.5 Q.6 Q.7 In the hydrogen atom, if the refer
ence level of potential energy is assumed to b e zero at the ground state level.
Choose the incorrect statement. (A) The total energy of the shell increases wit
h increase in the value of n (B) The total ener gy of the shell decrease with in
crease in the value of n. (C) The difference in total energy of any two shells r
emains the same. (D) The total energy at the gro und state becomes 13.6 eV. Q. 8
Choose the correct statement(s) for hydrogen and deuterium atoms (considering m
otion of nucleus) (A) The radius offirstBohr orbi t of deuterium is less than th
at of hydrogen (B) The speed of electron in thefir stBohr orbit of deuterium is
more than that of hydrogen. (C) The wavelength offi rstBalmer line of deuterium
is more than that ofhydrogen (D) The angular momentu m of electron in thefirstBo
hr orbit ofdeuterium is more than that of hydrogen. (fe Bansal Classes Question
Bank on Modern Physics 14]
Q.9 Let A be the area enclosed by the n orbit in a hydrogen atom. The graph of I
n (A /A,) agains In (n). (A) will pass through origin (B) will be a stright line
wil l slope 4 (C) will be a monotonically increasing nonlinear curve (D) will b
e a c ircle. n th n Q, 10 A neutron collides head-on with a stationary hydrogen
atom in ground state . Which ofthe following statements are correct (Assume that
the hydrogen atom an d neutron has same mass): (A) If kinetic energy of the neu
tron is less than 20.4 eV collision must be elastic. (B) If kinetic energy of th
e neutron is less than 20.4 eV collision may be inelastic. (C) Inelastic collisi
on may be take place o nly when initial kinetic energy ofneutron is greater than
20.4 eV. (D) Perfectly inelastic collision can not take place. Q.ll When a nucl
eus with atomic number Z and mass number A undergoes a radioactive decay process
: (A) both Z and A will decrease, if the process is a decay (B) Z will decrease
but A will not change, ifthe process is p decay (C) Z will decrease but A will n
ot change, if the proce ss is (3~ decay (D) Z and A will remain unchanged, if th
e process is y decay. + Q.12 In a Coolidge tube experiment, the minimum waveleng
th of the continuous X-r ay spectrum is equal to 66.3 pm, then (A) electrons acc
elerate through a potenti al difference of 12.75 kV in the Coolidge tube (B) ele
ctrons accelerate through a potential difference of 18.75 kV inthe Coolidge tube
(C) de-Broglie wavelength of the electrons reaching the anti cathode is of the
order of 10pm. (D) de-Brog lie wavelength of the electrons reaching the anticath
ode is 0.01 A. Q.13 The pot ential difference applied to an X-ray tube is increa
sed. As a result, in the emi tted radiation: (A) the intensity increases (B) the
minimum wave length increase s (C) the intensity decreases (D) the minimum wave
length decreases Q.14 When th e atomic number A of the nucleus increases (A) in
itially the neutron-proton rati o is constant = 1 (B) initially neutron-proton r
atio increases and later decreas es (C) initially binding energy per nucleon inc
reases and later decreases (D) th e binding energy per nucleon increases when th
e neutron-proton ratio increases. Q.15 Let m be the mass of a proton, m the mass
of a neutron, M, the mas ofa ^ N e nucleus and M the mass of a [] Ca nucleus. T
hen (A)M = 2M, (B) M > 2Mj (C) M < 2Mj (D) M, < 10(m + m ) p n 2 2 2 2 2 n p Q.1
6 The decay constant of a radio active substance is 0.173 (years)" . Therefor e
: (A) Nearly 63% of the radioactive substance will decay in (1/0.173) year. (B )
halflife of the radio active substance is (1/0.173) year. (C) one -forth of th
e radioactive substance will be left after nearly 8 years. (D) all the above sta
tements are true. 1 Bansal Classes Question Bank on Modern Physics [15]
ANSWER KEY ONLY ONE OPTION IS CORRECT. Qi C D Q.2 Q.9 B A Q.3 C Q4 D Q.5 Q.12 D
Q.6 C Q.7 A Q.8 Q.10 A Q.17 C Q.24 B Q.31 D Q.38 A Q.45 C Q.52 C Q.59 D Q.66 D Q
.73 C Q.ll B Q.18 A Q.25 A Q.32 A Q.39 A Q.46 B Q.53 B Q.60 B Q.67 A Q.74 A Q.13
D Q.20 B Q.27 B Q.34 C Q.41 C Q.48 A Q.55 B Q.62 C Q.69 B Q.76 B Q.14 C Q.21 B
Q.28 C Q.35 D Q.42 C Q.49 A Q.56 B Q.63 C Q.70 D Q.77 A Q.15 D Q.22 B Q.29 A Q.3
6 B Q.43 C Q.50 B Q.57 A Q.64 B Q.71 D Q.78 C Q.l Q.5 Q. 9 Q.16 C Q.23 A Q.30 C
Q.37 C Q.44 D Q.51 C Q.58 B Q.65 C Q.72 C Q.19 C Q.26 A Q.33 D Q.40 A Q.47 C Q.5
4 A Q.61 B Q.68 B Q.75 C A,C A,C,D AB ONE OR MORE THAN ONE OPTION MAYBE CORRECT
Q2 B Q.3 B Q 4 AC,D Q.6 A Q.7 B Q.8 A Q.10 A,C Q.14 A,C Q.ll AB,D Q.15 C,D Q.12
B Q.16 A,C Q.13 A,D
TARGET IIT JEE 2007 XII (ALL) MODERN PHYSICS CONTENTS KEYCONCEPTS EXERCISE-I EXE
RCISE-II EXERCISE-III ANSWER KEY
KEY (a) (c) (d) CONCEPTS l. (b) 2. 3. CATHODE RAYS : Generated in a discharge tu
be in which a high vaccum is maintaine d . They are electrons accelerated by hig
h p.d. (lOto 15 K.V.) 1 = eV. K.E. of C .R. particle accelerated by a p.d. V is
mv' 2m Can be deflected by Electric & ma gnetic fields . red(7.6xl0~ m) * vioIet
(3.6*l(r m) ELECTROMAGNETIC SPECTRUM Orde red arrangement ofthe big family 3xlO"
m 3*10 m 3m 3 x l 0 ^ m of electro magnet ic waves (EMW) either in ascending or
der of frequencies infrared Ultraviolet Gam ma rays or ofwave lengths Radio wave
s Speed ofE.M.W. in vacuum C = 3 x 10 m/s = v X X-rays II \ Micro waves PLANK S
QUANTUM THEORY : Visible light (e.g. radar) A beam ofEMW is a stream of discrete
packets of energy called PHOTONS , 10 10 10 10 10 10 10 I0 10 each photon havin
g afrequencyv and Frequency (Hz) energy = E = hv . 7 7 4 l2 8 4 6 s 10 12 14 16
i8 2 4. (0 (ii) (v) (iii) (iv) h = plank's constant = 6.63 x 10" Js . PHOTO ELEC
TRIC EFFECT : The phenomenon of the emission of electrons , when metals are expo
sed to light (of a certain mini mum frequency) is called photo electric effect.
Results : Can be explained only on the basis of the quantum theory (concept of p
hoton). Electrons are emitted if the incident light hasfrequencyv > v (threshold
frequency)emission ofelectrons is independent ofintensity. The wave length corre
sponding to v is called threshold wave length X0 . v is different for different
metals . Number of electrons emit ted per second depends on the intensity of the
incident light .
34 Q 0 0 EINSTEINS PHOTO ELECTRIC EQUATION : Photon energy = K. E. of electron +
work function . h v = mv2 + ,<b 1 (vi) Note: (j) = Work function = energy neede
d by the electron in freeing itself from the a toms of the metal . d> = h v 0 2
5. The minimum value of the retarding potential to prevent electron emission is
: c utofr = (KE) The number of photons incident on a surface per unit time is ca
lled photon flux. WAVE NATURE OF MATTER : Beams of electrons and other forms ofm
atte r exhibit wave properties including interference and diffraction eV max STO
PPING POTENTIAL O R C U T O F F PO TENTIAL : with a de Broglie wave length given
by X = P (wave length of a praticle) . <iBansal Classes Modern Physics [11]
6. (a) (b) (c) ATOMIC MODELS : THOMSON MODEL : (PLUM PUDDING MODEL) (i) Most of
the mass and al l the positive charge of an atom is uniformly distributed over t
he full size of atom (10" m). (ii) Electrons are studded in this uniform distrib
ution . (iii) Fa iled to explain the large angle scattering a - particle scatter
ed by thin foils of matter . RUTHERFORD MODEL : (Nuclear Model) (i) The most of
the mass and all the positive charge is concentrated within a size of 10" m insi
de the atom . Thi s concentration is called the atomic nucleus . (ii) The electr
on revolves around the nucleus under electric interaction between themin circula
r orbits. An accel erating charge radiates the nucleus spiralling inward and fin
ally fall into the nucleus, which does not happen in an atom. This could not be
explained by this m odel . BOHR ATOMIC MODEL : Bohr adopted Rutherford model of
the atom & added som e arbitrary conditions. These conditions are known as his p
ostulates : 10 14 (i) (ii) (iii) The electron in a stable orbit does not radiate
energy .i.e. r = - r A stable or bit is that in which the angular momentum of t
he electron about nucleus ll ll is an integral (n) multiple of . i.e. mvr = n ;
n = 1, 2, 3 , (n * 0). m V The electron can absorb or radiate energy only if the
electron jumpsfroma lower to a higher orbit or fallsfroma higher to a lower orb
it . (iv) The energy emitte d or absorbed is a light photon of frequency v and o
f energy. E = hv . FOR HYDRO GEN ATOM : (Z - atomic number = 1) (i) L = angular
momentum in the n orbit = n . 2% (ii) r - radius of n circular orbit = (0.529 A )
n ; (1 A = 10" m); r a n . ( iii) E Energy of the electron in the n orbit = i.e
. E a . Note: Total energy oft he electron in an atom is negative , indicating t
hat it is bound . Binding Energ y (BE) = - E = . n (iv) E - E = Energy emitted w
hen an electron jumps from n orb it to n, orbit (n > n ). AE = (13.6 ev) 1 1 th
n th 0 2 0 10 n 2 n th e V n 1 3 , 6 e v n2 nl 2 th th 2 t Z7C 271 AE = hv ; n,
2 v = frequency of spectral line emitted . n n 7 1 n 2 2 = v = wave no. [no. ofw
aves in unit length (lm)] = R 2 2 A, i 2 Where R = Rydber g's constant for hydro
gen = 1.097 x 10 m" . (v) For hydrogen like atom/spicies o f atomic number Z : ^
n = (0.529A ) ^ ; E = (- 13.6) ^ ev z Z n R = RZ - Rydberg
's constant for element of atomic no. Z . Note : If motion of the nucleus is als
o considered, then m is replaced by p. . r n2 2 0 z 7 2 = ^ ^Bansal Classes Mod
ern Physics [3]
7. (0 Where p = reduced mass of electron - nucleus system = mM/(m+M). In this ca
se E = (-13.6 ev) . n. no e SPECTRAL SERIES : Lyman Series : (Landing orbit n = 1
) . n> 1 Ultraviolet region v"=R i 12 1 2 v 7 2 m 00 Balmer Series : (Landing or
bit n = 2) Visible region v = R 1 1 Paschan Series : (Landing orbit n = 3) In th
e near infrared region v = R 1 r, 3 n Bracket Series : (Landing orbit n = 4) 2 2
2 1 n 2 2 (iii) (iv) (v) 22 n 0 2 2 >2 n >3 2 In the mid infrared region v = R
4 Pfund Series : (Landing orbit n = 5) 2 >4 ^>5 etc . where n, = Landing orbit }
In far infrared region v = R In all these series n 2 = n, + 1 is the a line = n
, + 2 is the P line = n, + 3 is the y line EXCITATION POTENTIAL OF ATOM : Excita
tion potential for quantum jump from n 9. 1 0. 11. (0 (ii) (iii) (iv) -n
2 IONIZATION ENERGY : The energy required to remove an electronfroman atom . The
e nergy required to ionize hydrogen atom is = 0 - ( -13.6) = 13.6 ev . IONIZATI
ON POTENTIAL : -E. Potential difference through which an electron is moved to ga
ay from each other and beyond the range of interaction f orces is called the Bin
ding Energy of a nucleus . BE. =(AM)C . 2 MP 2 2 U nl 2 U I
4 Ba Kr 3 nl 7 9 1 1 <iBansal Classes Modern Physics [11]
Q.l Q. 2 (a) Q.3 (a) Q.4 Q. 5 Q. 6 Q.7 Q.8 Q. 9 Q.10 Q.ll A parallel beam of uni
form, monochromatic light of wavelength 2640 A has an inte nsity of 200W/m . The
number of photons in 1mm of this radiation are When photon s of energy 4.25 eV
strike the surface of a metal A, the ej ected photoelectrons have maximum kineti
c energy T eV and de Broglie wavelength Xa . The maximum kin etic energy of phot
oelectrons liberated from another metal B by photons of energ y 4.7eV is T = (T
-1.5) eV. If the De Broglie wavelength ofthese photoelectrons is = 2 X& , then f
ind The work function of a (b) The work function ofb is (c) T and T When a monoc
hromatic point source oflight is at a distance of 0.2 mfroma p hotoelectric cell
, the cut off voltage and the saturation current are respective ly 0.6 volt and
18.0 mA. Ifthe same source is placed 0.6 m away from the photoel ectric cell, th
en find the stopping potential (b) the saturation current An isol ated metal bod
y is illuminated with monochromatic light and is observed to becom e charged to
a steady positive potential 1.0V with respect to the surrounding. T he work func
tion of the metal is 3 0 eV. The frequency of the incident light is . 663 mW ofl
ight from a 540 nm source is incident on the surface of a metal. If only 1 of ea
ch 5 x 10 incident photons is absorbed and causes an electron to be ejectedfromt
he surface, the total photocurrent in the circuit is . Light of wave length 330
nm falling on a piece of metal ej ects electrons with sufficient ener gy which r
equires voltage V to prevent a collector. In the same setup, light ofw avelength
220 nm, ej ects electrons which require twice the voltage V to stop th em in re
aching a collector. Find the numerical value of voltage V .(Take plank's constan
t, h = 6.6 x icr Js and 1 eV= 1.6 x 10~ J) A hydrogen atom in a state ha ving a
binding energy 0.85eV makes a transition to a state of excitation energy 10.2eV.
The wave length of emitted photon is nm. A hydrogen atom is in 5 excited state.
When the electron jumps to ground state the velocity of recoiling hydrog en ato
m is m/s and the energy of the photon is eV. The ratio of series limit wav lengt
h ofBalmer series to wavelength offirstline of paschen series is An electro njoi
ns a helium nucleus to form a He+ ion. The wavelength ofthe photon emitted i n t
his process if the electron is assumed to have had no kinetic energy when it com
bines with nucleus is nm. Xi Three energy levels of an atom are shown in thef ig
ure.The wavelength corresponding to three possible transition are A,, X2 and X y
The value x o f X in terms of A, and X is given by . 2 3 a b a b 9 0 0 0 34 19
th E? -n = 2 EXERCISE # I 2 3 2 Q.12 Imagine an atom made up of a proton and a h
ypothetical particle of double t he mass of an electron but having the same char
ge as the electron. Apply the Boh r atom model and consider a possible transitio
ns of this hypothetical particle t o the first excited level. Find the longest w
avelngth photon that will be emitte d X (in terms of the Rydberg constant R.) Q.
13 In a hydrogen atom, the electron moves in an orbit of radius 0.5 A making 10
revolution per second. The magnetic moment associated with the orbital motion of
the electron is . Q.14 The positron is a fundamental particle with the same mas
s as that ofthe electron and with a charge equal to that of an electron but of o
pposite sign. When a positron and an electron collide, they may annihilate each
other. The energy corresponding to t heir mass appears in two photons of equal e
nergy. Find the wavelength ofthe radi ation emitted. [Take : mass ofelectron = (
0.5/C )MeVandhC= 1.2xlO~ MeV.m where h is the Plank's constant and C is the velo
city oflight in air] 16 2 I2
<iBansal Classes Modern Physics [11]
Q.15 Asmall 10W source of ultraviolet light ofwavelength 99 nm is held at a dist
ance 0.1 mfromametal surface. The radius of an atom ofthe metal is approximatel
y 0.05 nm. Find (i) the average number of photons strildng an atom per second. (
i i) the number ofphotoelectrons emitted per unit area per second ifthe efficien
cy ofliberation ofphotoelectrons is 1 %. Q.16 The surface of cesium is illuminat
ed with monochromatic light of various f 1wavelengths and the stopping potential
s for the wavelengths are measured. The 1 2- 0.41 results of this experiment is
pl otted as shown in thefigure.Estimate the value of I-.-71.5 1.0 1.5 V I O ' H
Z 1 -2V work function of the cesium and Planck's constant. 5 Q.17 A hydrogen lik
e atom has its single electron orbiting around its stationary nucleus. The energ
y to excite the electron from the second Bohr orbit to the th ird Bohr orbit is
47.2 eV. The atomic number of this nucleus is . Q.18 A single electron orbits a
stationary nucleus of charge Ze where Z is a constant and e is the electronic ch
arge. It requires 47.2eV to excite the electron from the 2nd B ohr orbit to 3rd
Bohr orbit. Find (i) the value of Z, (ii) energy required to ex cite the electro
nfromthe third to the fourth orbit (iii) the wavelength of radia tion required t
o remove the electronfromthefirstorbit to infinity (iv) the kinet ic energy, pot
ential energy and angular momentum in the first Bohr orbit (v) the radius of the
firstBohr orbit. Q .19 A hydrogen like atom (atomic number Z) is i n higher exci
ted state of quantum number n. This excited atom can make a transit ion to the f
irst excited state by successively emitting two photons of energy 22 .95 eV and
5.15eV respectively. Alternatively, the atomfromthe same excited stat e can make
transition to the second excited state by successively emitting two p hotons of
energies 2.4eV and 8.7eV respectively. Find the values of n and Z. Q.2 0 Find t
he binding energy of an electron in the ground state of a hydrogen like atom in
whose spectrum the third of the corresponding B aimer series is equal to 108. 5n
m. Q.21 Which level ofthe doubly ionized lithium has the same energy as the grou
nd state energy ofthe hydrogen atom. Find the ratio ofthe two radii of c orrespo
nding orbits. Q.22 The binding energies per nucleon for deuteron (jH ) an d heli
um ( He ) are 1.1 MeV and 7.0 MeV respectively. The energy released when t wo de
uterons fuse to form a. helium nucleus ( He ) is . 2 2 4 2 4 x s Q.23 Aradioacti
ve decay counter is switched on at t = 0. A P - active sample is present near th
e counter. The counter registers the number of P - particles emit ted by the sam
ple. The counter registers 1 10' P - particles at t = 36 s and 1.1 1 * 10 P - pa
rticles at t = 108 s. FindT, of this sample Q.24 An isotopes of Pot assium has a
half life of 1.4 x 10 year and decays to Argon ^ A r which is stabl e. (i) Writ
e down the nuclear reaction representing this decay. (ii) A sample of rock taken
fromthe moon contains both potassium and argon in the ratio 1 /7. Fin d age of r
ock Q.25 At t = 0, a sample is placed in a reactor. An unstable nuclid e is prod
uced at a constant rate R in the sample by neutron absorption. This nuc lide P~~
decays with halflife x. Find the time required to produce 80% ofthe equ ilibriu
m quantity ofthis unstable nuclide. Q.26 Suppose that the Sun consists en tirely
of hydrogen atom and releases the energy by the nuclear reaction, 4 |H > ,He wi
th 26 MeV of energy released. Ifthe total output power ofthe Sun is assume d to
remain constant at 3.9 x 10 W,findthe time it will take to burn all the hyd roge
n. Take the mass of the Sun as 1.7 x 10 kg. 9 26 30 <iBansal Classes Modern Physi
cs [11]
Q. 27 Assuming that the source of the energy of solar radiation is the energy of
the formation of helium from hydrogen according to the following cyclic reactio
n : ,H' X o + le 6C' + 1 / N + ,C + ,H' 1 / N 0 2 7 13 13 13 14 7 N + ,H 14 7 1
8 0 -> N + e 15 7 15 +1 1 6 12 2 4 N + H -> C + He Find how many tons of hydrogen
must be converted every second in to helium . The solar constant is 8 J / cm mi
n. Assume that hydrogen forms 35% o fthe sun's mass. Calculate in how many years
this hydrogen will be used up if th e radiation of the sun is constant. m = 5.4
9 x 10 amu, atomic masses m^l.00814 a mu, m =4.00388 amu, mass ofthe sun=2 10 kg
, distance between the sun and the ear th= 1.5* 10 m. 1 amu = 931 MeV. Q. 28 An
electron of mass "m" and charge "e" ini tially at rest gets accelerated by a con
stant electricfieldE. The rate of change of DeBroglie wavelength ofthis electron
at time t is 15 ] 2 e 4 He x 30 n List of recommended questions from I.E. Irodo
v. 5.247, 5.249, 5.260, 5.262, 5.26 3, 5.264, 5.265, 5.266, 5.270, 5.273, 5.277
6.21, 6.22, 6.27, 6.28, 6.30, 6.31, 6.32, 6.33, 6.35, 6.37, 6.38, 6.39, 6.40, 6.
41, 6.42, 6.43, 6.49, 6.50, 6.51, 6. 52, 6.53, 6.133, 6.134, 6.135, 6.136, 6.137
, 6.138, 6.141, 6.214, 6.233, 6.249, 6.264, 6.289 Q.l (a) (b) Q. 2 Find the forc
e exerted by a light beam of intensit y I, incident on a cylinder (height h and
base radius R) placed on a smooth surf ace as shown infigureif: surface of cylin
der i s perfectly reflecting surface of cylinder is having reflection coefficien
t 0.8. (assume no transmission) 7 EXERCISE # II I > t A small plate of a metal (
work function =1.17 eV) is placed at a distance of 2mf roma monochromatic light
source of wave length 4.8 * 10" m and power 1.0 watt. T he light falls normally
on the plate. Find the number of photons striking the me tal plate per square me
ter per sec. If a constant uniform magnetic field of stre ngth tesla is applied
parallel to the metal surface. Find the radius of the larg est circular path fol
lowed by the emitted photoelectrons. A Q. 3 Electrons in hydrogen like atoms (Z
= 3) make transitions from thefifthto the fo urth orbit & from the fourth to the
third orbit. The resulting radiations are in cident normally on a metal plate &
eject photo electrons. The stopping potential for the photoelectrons ejected by
the shorter wavelength is 3.95 volts. Calcula te the work function of the metal
, & the stopping potential for the photoelectro ns ejected by the longer wavelen
gth. (Rydberg constant = 1.094 x 10 m ) 7 1 Q.4
A beam of light has three wavelengths 4144A, 4972A & 6216 A with a total intensi
ty of 3.6x 10" W. m equally distributed amongst the three wavelengths. The beam
falls normally on an area 1.0 cm of a clean metallic surface of work function 2
. 3 eV. Assume that there is no loss of light by reflection and that each energe
ti cally capable photon ejects one electron. Calculate the number of photoelectr
ons liberated in two seconds. 3 2 2 <iBansal Classes Modern Physics [11]
Q. 5 (i) Q.6 Monochromatic radiation of wavelength = 3 000A falls on a photocell
operating in saturating mode. The corresponding spectral sensitivity of photoce
ll is J = 4.8 x 10~ A/w. When another monochromatic radiation of wavelength X =
1650A and pow er P = 5 x 10~ W is incident, it is found that maximum velocity of
photoelectron s increases n = 2 times. Assuming efficiency of photoelectron gen
eration per inc ident photon to be same for both the cases, calculate threshold
wavelength for t he cell. , (ii) saturation current in second case. 3 2 3 (i) (i
i) (iii) Q.7 (i) (ii) Q.8 Q. 9 A monochromatic point source S radiating waveleng
th 6000 A with SC power 2 watt, an aperture A of diameter 0.1 m & a large screen
SC are placed as shown in figu re. Aphotoemissive detector D of surface area S
D 0.5 cm is placed at the centre ofthe screen. The efficiency ofthe detector for
the photoelectron generation pe r incident photon is 0.9. Calculate the photonf
luxdensity at the centre of the s creen and the p.6 m photocurrent in the detect
or. If a concave lens L of focal l ength 0.6 m is inserted in the aperture as sh
own,findthe new values of photonflu xdensity & photocurrent .Assume a uniform av
erage transmission of 80% for the le ns. If the work-function of the photoemissi
ve surface is 1 eV, calculate the val ues ofthe stopping potential in the two ca
ses (without & with the lens in the ap erture). A 2 6 m A small 10 W source of u
ltraviolet light of wavelength 99 nm is held at a distan ce 0.1m from a metal su
rface. The radius of an atom ofthe metal is approximaterl y 0.05 nm. Find : the
number of photons striking an atom per second. the number of photoelectrons emit
ted per second ifthe efficiency ofliberation of photoelect rons is 1 % A neutron
with kinetic energy 25 eV strikes a stationary deuteron. F ind the de Broglie w
avelengths of both particles in the frame of their centre of mass. Two identical
nonrelativistic particles move atrightangles to each other, possessing De Brogl
ie wavelengths, A, & Xj . Find the De Broglie wavelength of each particle in the
frameoftheir centre of mass. + Q.10 A stationary He ion emitted a photon corresp
onding to thefirstline its Lyma n series. That photon liberated a photoelectronf
roma stationary hydrogen atom in the ground state. Find the velocity ofthe photo
electron. Q.ll A gas ofidentical hydrogen like atoms has some atoms in the lowes
t (ground) energy level A & some atoms in a particular upper (excited) energy le
vel B& there are no atoms in any other energy level. The atoms of the gas make t
ransition to a higher energy lev el by the absorbing monochromatic light of phot
on energy 2.7eV Subsequently, the atoms emit radiation of only six different pho
ton energies. Some of the emitted photons have energy 2.7 eV. Some have energy m
ore and some have less than 2.7 e V. (i) Find the principal quantum number of th
e initially excited level B. (ii) Find the ionisation energy for the gas atoms.
(iii) Find the maximum and the min imum energies of the emitted photons. Q.12 A
hydrogen atom in ground state absor bs a photon ofultraviolet radiation ofwavele
ngth 50 nm. Assuming that the entire photon energy is taken up by the electron,
with what kinetic energy will the el ectron be ejected ? Q.13 A monochromatic li
ght source of frequency v illuminates a metallic surface and ej ects photoelectr
ons. The photoelectrons having maximu m energy are just able to ionize the hydro
gen atoms in ground state. When the wh ole experiment is repeated with an incide
Q.24 Show that in a nuclear reaction where the outgoing particle is scattered at
an angle of 90 with the direction of the bombarding particle, the Q-value is exp
ressed as f l > \ Q=K v o) - I v o; Where, I = incoming particle, P = product n
u cleus, T = target nucleus, O = outgoing particle. + m P l v i K M Q.25 When Li
thium is bombarded by 10 MeV deutrons, neutrons are observed to emer ge at right
angle to the direction of incident beam. Calculate the energy of the se neutron
s and energy and angle of recoil ofthe associated Beryllium atom. Give n that :
m ( n ) = 1.00893 amu ; m ( Li ) = 7.01784 amu ; m (jH ) = 2.01472 amu ; and m ^
Be ) =.8.00776 amu. 0 ] 3 7 2 8 Q.26 A body of mass m is placed on a smooth hori
zontal surface. The mass of the body is decreasing exponentially with disintegra
tion constant X. Assuming that t he mass is ejected backward with a relative vel
ocity v. Initially the body was a t rest. Find the velocity of body after time t
. 0 Q.27 A radionuclide with disintegration constant X is produced in a reactor
at a constant rate a nuclei per sec. During each decay energy E is released. 20%
oft his energy is utilised in increasing the temperature of water. Find the inc
rease in temperature ofm mass ofwater in time t. Specific heat of water is S. As
sume that there is no loss of energy through water surface. 0 <iBansal Classes Mo
dern Physics [11]
EXERCISE # III Q.l (i) (ii) Q.2 A neutron of kinetic energy 65 eV collides inela
stically with a singly ionized helium atom at rest. It is scattered at an angle
of 90 with respe ct ofits original direction. Find the allowed values of the ener
gy ofthe neutron & that ofthe atom after collision. Ifthe atom gets de-excited s
ubsequently by e mitting radiation,findthefrequenciesofthe emitted radiation. (G
iven: Mass ofhe a tom = 4x(mass ofneutron), ionization energy ofH atom=13.6 eV)
[JEE '93] A hydrog en like atom (atomic number Z) is in a higher excited state o
f quantum number n. This excited atom can make a transition to thefirstexcited s
tate by successivel y emitting two photon s of energies 10.20 eV & 17.00 eV resp
ectively. Alternativ ely, the atom from the same excited state can make a transi
tion to the second ex cited state by successively emitting two photons of energi
es 4.25 eV& 5.95 eV re spectively. Determine the values of n&Z. (Ionisation ener
gy of hydrogen atom = 1 3.6eY)[JEE'94] Select the correct alternative(s): When p
hotons of energy 4.25 eV strike the surface of a metal A, the ejected photo elec
trons have maximum kinet ic energy T eV and de-Broglie wave length y . The maxim
um kinetic energy of phot o electrons liberated from another metal B by photons
of energy 4.70 eV is T = ( T -1.50) eV. If the de-Broglie wave length of these p
hoto electrons is y = 2y , then : (A) the work function of A is 2.225 eV (B) the
work function ofB is 4 20 eV (C) T = 2.00 eV (D) T = 2.75 eV [JEE'94] In a phot
o electric effect set-up, a point source of light of power 3.2 x 10" W emits mon
o energetic photons of ener gy 5.0 eV. The source is located at a distance of 0.
8 m from the centre of a sta tionary metallic sphere of work function 3.0 eV&of
radius 8.0 x 10" m.The effici ency of photoelectrons emission is one for every 1
0 incident photons. Assume tha t the sphere is isolated and initially neutral, a
nd that photo electrons are ins tantly swept away after emission. Calculate the
number of photo electrons emitte d per second. Find the ratio of the wavelength
of incident light to the De-Brogl ie wavelength ofthe fastest photo electrons em
itted. It is observed that the pho to electron emission stops at a certain time
t after the light source is switche d on. Why ? Evaluate the time t. [JEE' 95] A
n energy of 24.6 eV is required to r emove one of the electrons from a neutral h
elium atom. The energy (In eV) requir ed to remove both the electrons form a neu
tral helium atom is : (A) 38.2 (B) 49. 2 (C) 51.8 (D) 79.0 [JEE'95] An electron,
in a hydrogen like atom, is inanexcite dstate.lt has a total energy of-3.4 eV.
Calculate: (i) The kinetic energy & (ii) The De - Broglie wave length of the ele
ctron. [JEE 96] /1 g An electron in the ground state of hydrogen atoms is revolv
ing in \ anti-clockwise direction in a c ircular orbit of radius R. Obtain an ex
pression for the orbital magnetic dipole moment ofthe electron. / ^ The atom is
placed in a uniform magnetic induction, s uch that the plane normal to the elect
ron orbit make an angle of 3 0 with the mag netic induction. Find \ the torque ex
perienced by the orbiting electron. [JEE'96 ] A A B A B A a B 3 3 6 fi Q. 3 Q.4
(a) (b) (c) (d) Q.5 Q.6 Q.7 (i) (ii) Q.8 A potential difference of 20 KV is appl
ied across an x-raytube. The minimum wave length ofX-rays generated is . [JEE'96
the atom. (b) Calculate the smallest wavelength emitted in these transitions. [J
EE' 2002] Q.18 Two metallic plates A and B each of area 5 x 10 m , are placed at
a s eparation of 1 cm. Plate B carries a positive charge of33.7 x 10~ C. A mono
chrom atic beam oflight, with photons of energy 5 eV each, starts falling on pla
te A a t t = 0 so that 10 photons fall on it per square meter per second. Assume
that o ne photoelectron is emitted for every 10 incident photons. Also assume t
hat all the emitted photoelectrons are collected by plate B and the work functio
n of pla te Aremains constant at the value 2 eV. Determine (a) the number of pho
toelectro ns emitted up to t = 10 sec. (b) the magnitude ofthe electricfieldbetw
een the pl ates A and B at t = 10 s and (c) the kinetic energy of the most energ
etic photoe lectron emitted at t = 10 s when it reaches plate B. (Neglect the ti
me taken by photoelectron to reach plate B) [JEE' 2002] Q.19 The attractive pote
ntial for an atom is given by v = v In (r / r ), v and r are constant and r is t
he radius of the orbit. The radius r of the n Bohr's orbit depends upon principa
l quantum nu mber n as : (A)rocn (B) rc 1/n (C)rxn (D)roc 1/n [JEE' 2003 (Scr)] Q
. 20 Frequenc y of a photon emitted due to transition of electron of a certain e
lemrnt from L to K shell is found to be 4.2 x 10 Hz. Using Moseley's law,findthe
atomic number of the element, given that the Rydberg's constant R = 1.1 x 10 mr
1. [JEE 2003] Q.21 In a photoelctric experiment set up, photons of energy 5 eV f
alls on the ca thode having work function 3 eV (a) If the saturation current is
i = 4pA for int ensity 10~ W/m , then plot a graph between anode potential and c
urrent. (b) Also draw a graph for intensity of incident radiation of 2 x 10" W/m
? [JEE'2003] Q. 22 A star initially has 10 deutrons. It produces energy via, th
e processes H + j H > jH + p & jH +,H - He +n. If the average power radiated by the
star is 10 W, the deuteron supply of the star is exhausted in a time of the ord
er of: [JEE' 93 ] (A) 10 sec (B) 10 sec (C) 10 sec (D)10 sec Q. 23 A small quant
ity of solution co ntaining Na radionuclide (halflife 15 hours) of activity 1.0
microcurie is injec ted into the blood of a person. A sample ofthe blood of volu
me 1 cm taken after 5 hours shows an activity of296 disintegrations per minute.
Determine the total volume ofblood in the body of the person. Assume that the ra
dioactive solution m ixes uniformly in the blood of the person. (1 Curie = 3.7 x
10 disintegrations p er second) [JEE'94] Q.24(i)Fast neutrons can easily be slo
wed down by : (A) the use of lead shielding (B) passing them through water (C) e
lastic collisions with heavy nuclei (D) applying a strong electric field 16 16 1
7 15 ++ E u R Li H u H U H u H H u H h u -4 2 !2 16 6 0 0 0 Q th 2 2 18 7 A 5 2
5 2 40 } 2 2 3 2 3 2 4 16 6 8 12 16 24 3 10 <iBansal Classes Modern Physics [11]
(ii) Q. 2 5 Q.26 Q.27 (i) (ii) Q.28 Consider a-particles, P - particles&y rays,
each having an energy of 0.5 MeV. In creasing order of penetrating powers, the r
adiations are : [JEE'94] (A) a , P , y (B) a , y, (3 (C)(3,y,a (D)y,p,a Which of
the following statement(s) is (are) c orrect ? [JEE'94] (A) The rest mass of a s
table nucleus is less than the sum of the rest masses of its separated nucleons.
(B) The rest mass of a stable nucleus is greater than the sum ofthe rest masses
ofits separated nucleons. (C) In nucl ear fusion, energy is released by fusion
two nuclei ofmedium mass (approximately 100 amu). (D) In nuclearfission,energy i
s released byfragmentationof a very hea vy nucleus. The binding energy per nucle
on of 160 is 7.97 MeV & that of ,70 is 7 .75 MeV. The energy in MeV required to
remove a neutron from 170 is : [JEE'95] ( A) 3.52 (B) 3.64 (C) 4.23 (D) 7.86 At
a given instant there are 25 % undecayed r adio-active nuclei in a sample. After
10 sec the number of undecayed nuclei rema ins to 12.5 % . Calculate : [JEE 96]
mean - life ofthe nuclei and The time in wh ich the number ofundecayed nuclear
will further reduce to 6.25 % ofthe reduced n umber. Consider the following reac
tion ; ^ ^ H , = He + Q . [JEE 96] Mass ofthe deuterium atom = 2.0141 u ; Mass o
fthe helium atom = 4.0024 u This is a nuclear reaction in which the energy Q is
released is MeV. 4 2 Q.29(a)The maximum kinetic energy of photoelectrons emitted
froma surface when ph otons of energy 6 eV fall on it is 4 eV The stopping poten
tial in Volts is : (A) 2 (B) 4 (C) 6 (D) 10 (b) In the following, column I lists
some physical quantit ies & the column II gives approx. energy values associate
d with some of them. Ch oose the appropriate value of energyfromcolumn II for ea
ch ofthe physical quanti ties in column I and write the corresponding letter A,
B, C etc. against the num ber (i), (ii), (iii), etc. of the physical quantity in
the answer book. In your answer, the sequence of column I should be maintained.
Column I Column II (i) En ergy ofthermal neutrons (A) 0.025 eV (ii) Energy of X
-rays (B) 0.5 eV (iii) Bind ing energy per nucleon (C) 3 eV (iv) Photoelectric t
hreshold of metal (D) 20 eV (E)10keV (F) 8 MeV (c) The element Curium Cm has a m
ean life of 10 seconds. Its primary decay modes are spontaneous fission and a de
cay, the former with a proba bility of 8% and the latter with a probability of 9
2%. Each fission releases 200 MeV of energy. The masses involved in a decay are
as follows : ggCm=248.072220u , ^Pu=244.0641 OOu&jHe =4.002603u. Calculate the p
ower output from a sample of 1 0 Cm atoms. (1 u = 931 MeV/c ) [JEE'97] Q.30 Sele
ct the correct alternative(s) . [JEE'98] (i) Let m be the mass of a proton, m th
e mass of a neutron, M, the mas s of a ^Ne nucleus & M the mass of a ^Ca nucleus
. Then : (A) M = 2 Mj (B) M > 2 Mj (C) M < 2 Mj (D) M < 10 (m + m ) (ii) The hal
f-life of I is 8 days. Given a s ample of 1 at time t = 0, we can assert that: (
A) no nucleus will decay before t = 4 days (B) no nucleus will decay before t =
8 days (C) all nuclei will decay before t = 16 days (D) a given nucleus may deca
y at any time after t = 0. 13 2 2 20 2 p n 2 2 2 2 l n p 131 131 <iBansal Classes
Modern Physics [11]
Q.31 Nuclei ofa radioactive element A are being produced at a constant rate a .
The element has a decay constant X. At time t = 0, there are N nuclei of the ele
ment. (a) Calculate the number N of nuclei of A at time t. (b) If a=2N ?t, calc
u late the number ofnuclei ofA after one halflife ofA & also the limiting value
of N as t-*. [JEE '98] E Y O n Q.32(a) Binding energy per nucleon vs. mass number
cu rve for nuclei is shown in the figure. W, X, Y and Z are four nuclei indicat
ed o n the curve. The process that would release energy is (A) Y > 2Z (B) W > X +
Z 30 60 90 120 (C)W- 2Y (D) X Y + Z Mass Number of Nuclei (b) Order of magnitude
of de nsity of Uranium nucleus is, [m = 1.67 x 10~ kg] (A) 10 kg/m (B) 10 kg/m (
C) 10 kg/m (D) 10 kg/m (c) Ne nucleus, after absorbing energy, decays into two a
-parti cles and an unknown nucleus. The unknown nucleus is (A) nitrogen (B) carb
on (C) boron (D) oxygen (d) Which of the following is a correct statement? (A) B
eta ray s are same as cathode rays (B) Gamma rays are high energy neutrons. (C)
Alpha pa rticles are singly ionized helium atoms (D) Protons and neutrons have e
xactly th e same mass (E) None (e) The half-life period of a radioactive element
X is same as the mean-life time of another radioactive element Y. Initially bot
h of them have the same number of atoms. Then (A) X & Y have the same decay rate
initially (B) X & Y decay at the same rate always (C) Y will decay at a faster
rate than X (D) X will decay at a faster rate than Y [JEE'99] Q.33 Two radioacti
ve materia ls Xj and X have decay constants 10X. and X respectively. Ifinitially
they have the same number of nuclei, then the ratio ofthe number of nuclei ofXj
to that of Xj will be 1/e after a time (A) 1/(10X) (B) 1/(1 IX) (C) 11/(1 OA,)
(D)1/(9A) [ JEE'2000 (Scr)] Q.34 The electron emitted in beta radiation originat
es from [JEE '2001(Scr)] (A) inner orbits of atoms (B)freeelectrons existing in
nuclei (C) de cay of a neutron in a nucleus (D) photon escapingfromthe nucleus Q
.35 The half-l ife of At is 100 ps. The time taken for the radioactivity of a sa
mple o f At to decay to 1/16 of its initial value is [JEE 2002 (Scr)] (A) 400 ps
( B ) 6.3 ps ( C) 40 ps (D) 300 ps Q.36 Which of the following processes repres
ents a gamma - d ecay? [JEE 2002 (Scr)] (A) X + y > X _ ! + a + b (B) X +in - *
- XZ - 2 + C (C) x > x + / ( D ) X + e_! v -> X i + 8 Q.37 The volume and mass o
f a nucleus are r elated as [JEE 2003 (Scr)] (A) v qc m (B) v cc 1/m (C) v cc m
(D) v oc 1/m Q.38 The nucleus of element X (A= 220) undergoes a-decay. If Q-valu
e ofthe reaction i s 5.5 MeV, then the kinetic energy of a-particle is : [JEE 20
03 (Scr)] (A) 5.4Me V (B)10.8MeV (C)2.7MeV (D)None Q.39 A radioactive sample emi
ts n P-particles in 2 sec. In next 2 sec it emits 0.75 n P-particles, what is th
e mean life ofthe sa mple? [JEE 2003 ] 0 0 1 p 27 20 3 17 3 14 3 n 3 22
2 215 215 th A Z A Z A z 0 A A 3 7 A z A z A z 2 2 2 <iBansal Classes Modern Phys
ics [11]
Q.40 The wavelength of K X-ray of an element having atomic number z = 11 is X. T
he wavelength of K X-ray of another element of atomic number z' is 4A. Then z'
i s (A) 11 (B) 44 (C) 6 (D) 4 [JEE 2005 (Scr)] Q. 41 A photon of 10.2 eV energy
co llides with a hydrogen atom in ground state inelastically. After few microsec
ond s one more photon of energy 15 eV collides with the same hydrogen atomThen w
hat can be detected by a suitable detector. (A) one photon of 10.2 eV and an ele
ctro n of energy 1.4 eV (B) 2 photons of energy 10.2 eV (C) 2 photons of energy
3.4 e V (D) 1 photon of 3.4 eVand one electron of 1.4 eV [JEE 2005 (Scr)] Q. 42
Helium nuclie combines to form an oxygen nucleus. The binding energy per nucleon
ofoxy gen nucleus is if m = 15.834 amu and m = 4,0026 amu (D) 4 MeV (A) 10.24 M
eV (B)0 MeV (C) 5.24 MeV [JEE 2005 (Scr)] Q. 43 The potential energy of a partic
le of ma ss m is given by V(x)= E 0 < x < 1 x >1 Xl and X2 are the de-Broglie wav
elengths of the particle, when 0 < x < 1 and x > 1 respectively. If the total en
ergy of p article is 2E , find X / X . [JEE 2005] Q. 44 Highly energetic electro
ns are bom barded on a target of an element containing 3 0 neutrons. The ratio o
f radii of nucleus to that of helium nucleus is (14) . Find (a) atomic number of
the nucleu s (b) the frequency of K line ofthe X-ray produced. (R= l.lx 10 m an
dc = 3 x 10 m/s) [JEE 2005] Q.45 Given a sample of Radium-226 having half-life o
f 4 days. Fi nd the probability, a nucleus disintegrates within 2 half lives. (A
) 1 (B) 1/2 ( C) 3/4 (D) 1/4 [JEE 2006] x a 0 He 1 0 l 2 1/3 a 7 _1 8 Q .46 The
graph between 1IX and stopping potential (V) ofthree metals having wor k functio
ns (j^, (J> and <j) in an experiment of photometal 2 metal 3 electric e ffect is
plotted as shown in the figure. Which of the following statement(s) is/ are cor
rect? [Here X is the wavelength of the incident ray]. (A) Ratio of work f unctio
ns : <j) : <t> = 1:2 : 4 0.001 0.002 0.004 l/X (B) Ratio of work functions ()>,
: <j) : (j) = 4 : 2 : 1 (C) tan 9 is directly proportional to hc/e, where h is P
lanck's constant and c is the speed of light (D) The violet colour light c an ej
ect photoelectrons from metals 2 and 3. [JEE 2006] 2 3 2 3 2 3 Q. 47 In hydrogen
-like atom (z = 11), n line of Lyman series has wavelength X eq ual to the de-Br
oglie's wavelength of electron in the levelfromwhich it originat ed. What is the
value of n? [JEE 2006] th Q. 4 8 Match the following Columns Column 1 (A) Nucle
ar fusion (B) Nuclear fissi on (C) (3-decay (D) Exothermic nuclear reaction Colu
mn 2 (P) Converts some matter into energy (Q) Generally occurs for nuclei wi th
low atomic number (R) Generally occurs for nuclei with higher atomic number ( S)
Essentially proceeds by weak nuclear forces [JEE 2006]
<iBansal Classes Modern Physics [11]
ANSWER KEY Q.l Q.4 Q.5 Q.9 885 Q.2 (a) 2.25eV, (b) 4.2eV, (c)2.0 eV, 0.5 eV Q.3
(a) 0.6 volt, (b)2.0mA when the potential is steady, photo electric emission jus
t stop when hu = (3 + l)eV = 4.0 eV 5.76 x 1 0 A Q.6 15/8 V Q.7 487.06nm Q.8 4.
2 6m/s, 13.2eV _n EXERCISE # I Q.ll 12 7:36 23 2 Q.10 22.8 nm X { X2 A^i + X 2 Q
.12 18/(5R) Q.16 2eV, 6.53 x lO- J-s 34 n Q.13 1.257 x 1CT Am Q.17 5 Q , i 9 " z
= 3,n = 7 Q.23 (T = 10.8 sec) 1/2 5 1020 Q.14 2.48 xlO" m Q.15 16' 8071 Q.18 (i
) 5, 16.5 eV, 36.4A, 340 eV, - 6 8 0 eV, 1 . 0 6 x l 0 ~ m 2tc Q.20 54.4 eV Q.21
n = 3 , 3 : 1 Q.22 23.6 MeV Q.24 (i) ? K > Ar + e + v (ii) 4.2 x 10 years 9 +1 9 Q.
25 t = / n 2 v y Q.26 8/3xlO sec Q.27 1.14 x 10 sec 18 18 38IRh Q.l 8IhR/3C Q.2
4.8 x 10 , 4.0 cm Q.3 1.99 eV, 0.760 V Q.4 1.1 x io Q.5 (i ) 4125A, (ii) 13.2 pA
Q.6 (i) 1,33 x 10 photons/m -s ; 0.096 pA(ii) 2.956 x io p hotons/m s ; 0.0213
pA(iii) 1.06 volt Q.7 (i) 5/16 photon/sec, (ii) 5/1600'elect rons/sec Q.8 Xdeutr
on ""neutron ^ ' ^ P ^ 1 5 C 16 12 16 2 15 2 A EXERCISE # II Q.28 -h/eEt 2 Q.9 X
= yjx +x 2 Q.10 3.1 x 10 m/s Q.ll (i) 2; (ii) 23.04 xlO- J; (iii) 4 1 , 4 - > 3
Q.12 11.24 eV Q.13 6.8 eV, 5 x l 0 H z Q.14 489.6 eV, 25.28A { r 1 e ,1 3C r t
\ Q15 (i)- 87i8 r (ii) o , (iii) 10" x 100 sec 81 'o J v Q. 16 (i) 1.875 x i o V
, (ii) 2.7 x 10" J, (iii) 0.737 A, (iv) 2.67 x 10" J Q.17 6.04 x io yrs Q.18 4.8
7MeV Q.19 3 . 3 x l 0 - g Q.20 1.7 x io years Q.21 7.01366 amu Q.22 (a) 4 MeV ,
17.6 (b) 7.2 MeV (c) 0.384 % Q.23 5196 yrs Q.25 Energy ofneutron = 19.768 MeV; E
nergy ofBeryllium= 5.0007 MeV; Angle of recoil = tan" (1.034) or 46 2 { 6 !9 15 z
2 2 1 / 3 r
e ~ 10 0 4 15 15 6 9 10 1 Q.26 v = uXt Q.27 AT 0.2Er mS <iBansal Classes Modern P
hysics [11]
EXERCISE # III Q.l (i) Allowed values of energy of neutron = 6.36 eV and 0.312 e
V; Allowed valu es of energy of He atom = 17.84 eV and 16.328 eV, (ii) 18.23 x 1
0 Hz, 9.846 x 10 Hz, 11.6 x 10 Hz Q.2 n = 6, Z = 3 Q.3 B, C Q.4 (a) 10 s" ; (b)
286.18 ; (d) 111 s he ehB Q.5 D Q.6 (i) KE = 3.4 eV, (ii) A = 6.66 A Q.7 (i) 47t
m (ii) 871m Q.8 0.61 C (ii) A, D A Q.9 (i)D, Q.ll C (ii) KE= 151 eV, d =0.5 A Q
10 (i) Q 12 duri ng combination = 3.365 eV; after combination = 3 .88 eV (5 -> 3
(NEWTONS LAW FORCE & FRICTION) EXERCISE-I Q.l Q.2 A block ofmass 1 kg is station
ary with respect to a conveyor belt that i s accelerating with 1 m/s upwards at
an angle of30 as shown infigure.Determine fo rce of friction on block and contact
force between the block & bell. 2 A man ofmass 63 kg is pulling a mass M by an
inextensible light rope passing thr ough a smooth and massless pulley as shown i
n figure. The coefficient of frictio n between the man and the ground is p = 3/5
. Find the maximum value of M that ca n be pulled by the man without slipping on
the ground. Two blocks A and B ofmass m 10 kg and 20 kg respectively are placed
as shown infigure.Coefficient offrict ionbetween all the surfaces is 0.2. Then
find tension in string and acceleration of block B. (g = 10 m/s ) 2 Q.3 Q.4 Q.5
An inclined plane makes an angle 30 with the horizontal. A groove OA = 5m cut in
the plane makes an angle 30 with OX. A short smooth cylinder isfreeto slide down
the influence ofgravity. Find the time taken by the cylinder to reach from A to
O. (g = 10 m/s ) Same spring is attached with 2 kg, 3 kg and 1 kg blocks in thre
e different cases as shown in figure. If x,, x and x be the constan extensions
i n the spring in these three cases thenfindthe ratio oftheir extensions. //////
// //////// llllllll 2 0 3 Q.6 (a) (b) (c) A rope of length L has its mass per u
nit length X varies according t o the function X (x) = e . The rope is pulled by
a constant force of IN on a smo oth horizontal /777777777777777777777777I N smo
oth surface. Find the tension in the rope at x = L/2. LLLILLL x/L 2 k g C]2 kg I
3 kgQJ Q 2 k g 1 k g C2] C ] 2 k g Q.7 Q.8 Q.9 In figure shown, both blocks are
released from rest. Find the time to cross each other? A man of mass 50 kg is p
ulling on a plank of mass 100 kg kept on a smoot h floor as shown with force of
100 N. If both man & plank move together,findforc e offrictionacting on man. In
thefigure,what should be mass m so that block A sl ide up with a constant veloci
ty? M = 1/6 t 2*0 4 kg 1 kg 50 kg
4m 100 kg H - 0 77777777Z7777777777777 L 5H Q.10 What should be minimum value of
F so that 2 kg slides on ground but 1 kg do es not slide on it? [g = 10 m/sec ]
2 H=0.5 Wrr n=o.5 1kg F 2kg t t t t |.i=0.1 (! Bansal Classes Particle Dynamics [6]
Q.ll In figure shown, pulleys are ideal nij > 2 m . Initially the system is in e
quilibrium and string connecting m to rigid support below is cut. Find the init
i al acceleration of m ? 2 2 2 umm Q.12 Find the reading of spring balance as sh
own in figure. Assume that mass M i s in equilibrium Q.13 At what acceleration o
f the trolley will the string makes an angle of 37 with vertical if a small mass
is attached to bottom of string. Q.1 4 At what value of m will 8 kg mass be at r
est. t spring ^ balance /^gp Q.15 What force must man exert on rope to keep plat
form in equilibrium? Q.16 Inc lined plane is moved towards right with an acceler
ation of 5 ms as shown in figu re. Find force in newton which block of mass 5 kg
exerts on the incline plane. -2 man 50 kg platform, 40 kg 777^77777777777777777
77" ___ 37 ( A 5 m/s : Q.17 Find force in newton whi ch mass A exerts on mass B i
f B is moving towards right with 3 ms . -2 Q.18 Force F is applied on upper pull
ey. If F = 30t where t is time in second. F ind the time when m, loses contact w
ith floor. A i m, r i =30tN . <37 B /1kg 3 m/s 2 Q.19 Ablockofmass 1 kg is horizo
ntally thrown with a velocity of lOm/s on a stat ionary long plank of mass 2 kg
whose surface has a p = 0.5. Plank rests on frict ionless surface. Find the time
when mj comes to rest w.r.t. plank. JmL Q.20 Bloc k M slides down on frictionle
ss incline as shown. Find the minimum fiiction coef ficient so that m does not s
lide with respect to M. Q.21 The coefficient of stat ic and kinetic friction bet
ween the two blocks and also between the lower block and the ground are p = 0.6
and p = 0.4. Find the value of tension T applied on t he lower block at which th
e upper block begins to slip relative to lower block.
s k m,=4kg, m,=lkg M=2kg ( ^ 1 = 0 . 6 , ^ = 0 . 4 ) M=2kg T (! Bansal Classes Pa
rticle Dynamics [6]
Q.22 Three identical rigid circular cylinders A, B and C are arranged on smooth
inclined surfaces as shown in figure. Find the least value of G that prevent the
arrangement from collapse. ^Trmtimrmm Q.23 Two men A and B of equal mass held o
n to the free ends of a mass less rope which passes over a frictionless light pu
lley. Man Aclimbs up the rope with acceleration a relative to the rope while man
B hangs on without climbing. Find the acceleration ofthe man B with respect to
ground. Q.24 A thin rod of le ngth 1 m is fixed in a vertical position inside a
train, which is moving horizon tally with constant acceleration 4 m/s . A bead c
an slide on the rod, andfrictio ncoefficient between them is 1/2. If the bead is
releasedfromrest at the top of the rod, find the time when it will reach at the
bottom. Q.25 Abody of mass M = 5kg rests on a horizontal plane having coefficie
nt of fiction p = 0.5. At t = 0 a horizontal force F is applied that varies with
time as F = 5t. Find the time i nstant t at which motion starts and also find t
he distance of particle from star ting point at t = 6 second. 2 0 Q.l (a) (b) Q.
2 A block ofmass m lies on wedge ofmass M as shown in figure. Answer following p
ar ts separately. With what minimum acceleration must the wedge be moved towards
ri ght horizontally so that block m falls freely. Find the minimumfrictioncoeff
icie nt required between wedge M and ground so that it does not move while block
m sl ips down on it. A 20 kg block B is suspendedfroma cord attached Sc to a 40
kg ca rt A. Find the ratio of the acceleration <3of the block in cases (i) & (i
i) show n in figure A ~ A 1 immediately after the system is releasedfromrest, (n
eglect f riction) Case (ii) Case (i) The masses of blocks A and B are same and e
qual to m . Friction is absent everywhere. Find the normal force with which bloc
k B presse s on the wall and accelerations of the blocks A and B. The system sho
wn adj acen t is in equilibrium. Find the acceleration of the blocks A, B & C al
l of equal m asses m at the instant when (Assume springs to be ideal) (a) The sp
ring between ceiling & A is cut. (b) The string (inextensible) between A & B is
cut. (c) The spring between B & C is cut. Alsofindthe tension in the string when
the system i s at rest and in the above 3 cases. In the system shown. Find the
initial accele ration ofthe wedge of mass 5 M. The pulleys are ideal and the cor
ds are inextens ible. (there is nofrictionanywhere). The system is releasedfromr
est in the posit ion shown. Calculate the tension T in the cord and the accelera
tion a of the 30 kg block in the position shown. The small pulley attached to th
e block has negli gible mass and friction. 37 B A EXERCISE-II Q.3 Q. 4 uumu'uu Q.
5 Q. 6 [M! (! Bansal Classes Particle Dynamics [6]
Aplank ofmass m is kept on a smooth inclined plane. Aman ofmass r\ times the mas
s of plank moves on the plank, starts from A, such that the plank is at rest, w
. r.t. the inclined plane. Ifhe reaches the other end B of the plank in t=5sec.
Th en find the 9=sin~'(3/20) acceleration & the value of r|, ifthe length ofthe
pla nk is 50m. Q. 8 Two horizontal blocks each ofmass 1 12 kg are connected by a
mas sless, inextensible string of length 2m and placed on a long horizontal tab
le. T he coefficient of static & kineticfrictionare shown in tlie figure. Initia
lly if lL B the blocks are at rest. If the leading block is pulled with a time d
ependen t (.1=0.6 H=0.4 horizontal force F= kt i where k=lN/sec., determine H =0
.2 H =0. 4 (a) The plots of acceleration of each block with time from t = 0 to t
= 1 Osec (b) Velocity of blocks at t = lOsec. (c) Distance transversed by the b
locks in the time interval t = 0 to t = 1 Osec. (d) If F stops acting at t = 1 O
sec. find after how much further time would B collide with A. Q.9 m, = 20kg, m =
30kg. m, is on smooth surface. m, in, Surface between m, and m has p = 0.5 and
0.3. Find the acceleration of m, and m for m, m the following cases IIII1IHIIIII
IIIIIIIII I lllllllllllllllllllllll (a) (i) F = 160 N, (ii) F = 175 N ; (b) F =
160N (a) ( b) Q.10 A system of masses is shown in the figure with masses & co-ef
ficients of frictionindicated. Calculate: the maximum value of F for which there
is no slipp ing anywhere. (i) j'c ^kgV^ ' the minimum value of F for which B sl
ides on C. (i ii) the minimum value of F for which A slips on B. Q.ll A car begi
ns to move at time t = 0 and then accelerates along a straight track with a spee
d given by V(t ) = 2t ms- for 0 < t < 2 After the end of acceleration, the car c
ontinues to mov e at a constant speed. A small block initially at rest on the fl
oor of the car b egins to slip at t = 1 sec. and stops slipping at t = 3 sec. Fi
nd the coefficien t of static and kinetic friction between the block and the flo
or. Q.12 A smooth right circular cone of semi vertical angle a = tan (5/12) is a
t rest on a horizo ntal plane. A rubber ring of mass 2.5kg which requires a forc
e of 15N for an ext ension of 10cm is placed on the cone. Find the increase inth
e radius of the ring in equilibrium. Q.13 The collar of mass m slides up the ver
tical shaft under th e action of a force F of constant magnitude but variable di
rection of 6 = kt whe re k is a constant and ifthe collar starts from rest with
9 = 0, determine the m agnitude F of the force that will result in the collar co
ming to rest as 9 reach es n/2. The coefficient of kinetic friction between the
collar and the shaft is p . k Q. 7 k 2 2 s 2 2 If f 0 1 2 1 _1 k
Q.l A block of mass 0.1 kg is held against a wall by applying a horizontal force
of 5N on the block. If the coefficient offrictionbetween the block and the wall
is 0.5, the magnitude ofthefrictionalforce acting on the block is (A) 2.5N (B)
0.98 N (C) 4.9N (D)0.49N [JEE 1997] EXERCISE-III (! Bansal Classes Particle Dynam
ics [6]
Q.2 Block A of mass m and block B of mass 2m are placed on a fixed triangular we
dge by means of a massless inextensible string and africtionlesspulley as shown
in t he figure. The wedge is inclined at 45 to the horizontal on both sides. The
coeff icient of friction between block A and the wedge is 2/3 and that between b
lock B and the wedge is 1/3. If the system ofA and B is releasedfromrest, fmd (i
) the acceleration ofA, (ii) tension in the string, (iii) the magnitude and the
direct ion offrictionacting on A. [JEE 1997] Q.3 A spring of force constant k is
cut into two pieces such that one piece such tha t one piece is double the leng
th of the other. Then the long piece will have a f orce constant of (A) (2/3) k
(B) (3/2) k (C) 3k (D) 6k [JEE 1999] Q.4 In the fig ure masses m m and M are 20
kg, 5 kg and 50 kg respectively. The co-efficient of friction between M and grou
nd is zero. The co-efficient of friction between n^ and M and that between m and
ground is 0.3. The pulleys and the string are massl ess . The string is perfect
ly horizontal between Pj and mj and also between P M and m . The string is perfe
ctly vertical between P and P .An external Vmrnrrtuum uuu horizontal force F is
applied to the mass M. Take g = 10 m/s . Draw a free-b ody diagram for mass M, c
learly showing all the forces. (a) (b) Let the magnitud e ofthe force of frictio
n between m and M be f, and that between m and ground be f . For a particular F
it is found that fj = 2 f . Find fj and f . Write down e quations of motion of a
ll the masses . Find F, tension in the string and acceler ations of the masses.
[JEE 2000] Q.5 The pulleys and strings shown in the figure are smooth and of neg
ligible mass. For the system to remain in equilibrium, the angle 9 should be [JE
E (Scr) 2001 ] (A) 0 (B) 30 0 H 2" m (C) 45 (D) 60 Q.6 A strin g ofnegligible mass g
oing over a clamped pulley ofmass m supports a block of mas s M as shown in the
figure. The force on the pulley by the clamp is given [JEE ( Scr) 2001] (A)V2Mg
(B)V2mg M (C) - J ( M + m ) + m g (D) ^'(M + m) + M g 1? 2 2 2 2 ( 2 2 } 2 2 2 2
2 2 2 2 2 Q.7 Q.8 A block ofmass *J3 kg is placed on a rough horizontal surface
whose coefficient offrictionis lj 2 V3 minimum value of force F (shown in figur
e) for which the bl ock starts to slide on the surface. (g=10m/s ) mmum'uuuuuiu
(A) 20 N (B)20a/3N ( C) 10 V3 N (D) None of these [JEE (Scr) 2003] Two blocks A
and B of equal masses are released from an inclined plane of inclination 45 at t=
0. Both the blocks ar e initially at rest. The coefficient ofkineticfrictionbetw
een the block A and th e inclined plane is 0.2 while it is 0.3 for block B. Init
ially, the block Ais V2 m behind the block B. When and where their front faces w
ill come in a line. [Ta ke g= 10 m/s ]. , [JEE 2004] 60, 2 2 'MB ansaI Classes Pa
rticle Dynamics
[8J
1. CIRCULAR MOTION & WORK POWER ENERGY A body moving with constant speed in a ci
rcu lar path is continuously accelerated towards the centre of rotation. The mag
nitu de ofthis normal acceleration is given by V a = = or r 2 2 where v is the c
onstant speed (v = cor) and r is the radius of the circular path dv Ta ngential
area: a = , a = ^at + a t 2 2 2 n n r 2. 3. v Radius of curvature : r = a 4. Acc
ording to Newton's second speed must be acted upon by s the centre. This necessa
ry - = 2 F = morr r Centrifugal er in rotating frame. 5c f = m v 2 t m C 0 r law
, a body moving in a circular path with constant an unbalanced force which is al
ways directed toward unbalanced force is called the centripetal force. I force i
s a pseudo force which is observed an observ frame 2
Work (W): The work W done by a constant force F. when its point of application u
ndergoes a displacement s is defined as W = F.s =Fs'cos9 where 9 is the angle b
e tween F and s. Work is a scalar quantity and its wwww wwwwww SI units is N-m o
r joule (J). p : p Note: Only the component (F cos 9) of the force F which is al
ong the displacemen t contributes to the work done. If F= F i + F j + F k and s
= Axi + Ayj + Azk th en W = F-s ' = F Ax + F Ay + F A z x y z x z 5. Work done b
y a Variable Force: When the magnitude and direction of a force varie s with pos
ition, The work done by such a force for an infinitesimal displacement ds is giv
en by dW = F-ds In terms of rectangular components, W = jF dx+ jF dy + jF dz a Y
Z A B x y z x a a 6. Work Done by a Spring Force: The work done by the spring f
orce for a displacemen t from x to x is given by W =-ik(x -x ) ; f s 2 2 (! Bansa
l Classes
Particle Dynamics [6]
7. Work Energy theorem: Work done on a body can produce a change in its kinetic
ene rgy. Work is required to produce motion and it is also required to destroy m
otio n. W = AK = K - KJ F 8. 9. 10. Conservative Force: The force which does wor
k in complete independence of the pa th followed the body is called a conservati
ve force. The gravitational force, sp ring force and electrostatic force are the
examples of conservative forces. NonConservative Force: The work done by a nonconservative force not only depends o n the initial and final positions but also
on the path followed. The common exam ples of such forces are:frictionalforce a
nd drag force of fluids. Potential Ener gy: The potential energy is defined only
for conservative forces. U - U = -jF -d s B A c B 11. dU Conservative force : F
= - dx dU At equilibrium, = 0 dx c U(x)' d y The point B is the position of stab
le equilibrium, because U 0 dx 2 > d U The point C is the position odf unstable
equilibrium, because < 0 dx (! Bansal Classes Particle Dynamics [6]
BANSAL C L A S S E S TARGET IIT JEE 2007 XI (P, Q, R, S) IIT-JEE SCREENING 2007
QUESTION BANK ON PARTICLE DYNAMICS Time Limit: 3 Sitting Each of 60 minutes, dur
ation approx.
QUESTION ON PARTICLE DYNAMICS There are 81 questions in this question bank. Q.l
A small block of mass m is projected horizontally with speed u where friction co
efficient between block and plane is given by p = cx, where x is displacement o
f the block on plane. Find maximum distance covered by the block 2u u u (D) 2 V
S (A) (B) V2cg < C ) V S Q.2 A body is placed on a rough inclined plane of incli
n ation 0. As the angle 0 is increased from 0 to 90 the contact force between the
bl ock and the plane (A) remains constant (B) first remains constant than decrea
ses (C)firstdecreases then increases (D) first increases then decreases A block
is projected upwards on an inclined plane of inclination 37 along the line of gre
ate st slope of p = 0.5 with velocity of 5 m/s. The block 1 stops at a distance
of f rom starting point (A) 1.25 m (B) 2.5 m (C)10m (D) 12.5 m g&S'S hoMihg^ j W
hat s hould be the minimum force P to be applied to the string so that * block o
f mass m just begins to move up the frictionless plane. Mg cosO (D) None (A) Mg
tan 0/ 2 (B) Mg cot 0/2 (C) j f ~ st p Q.3 Q.4 Q. 5 Equal force F (> mg) is appl
ied to string in all the 3 cases. Startingfromrest, the point of application of
force moves a distance of 2 m down in all cases. In which case the block has max
imum kinetic energy? (A) 1 Q.6 (B)2 (i) (2) (3) (C)3 (D) equal in all 3 cases A
n=o m'urnUuuuwwuuuu Both the blocks shown here are ofmass m and are moving with
constant velocity in direction shown in a resistive medium which exerts equal co
nstant force on both blocks in direction opposite to the velocity. The tension i
n the string connect ing both of them will be: (Neglect friction) (A)mg (B) mg/2
(C) mg/3 (D) mg/4 Q.7 In which ofthe following cases is the contact force betwe
en A and B maximum (m = m = 1 kg) J2N A I a=2m/s A B H=0 ( D ) a=10m/s P D A L (
A) 30 N 7777 77777 Tm ( B) r ^ BP n (C) rrmf A B 2 2 <!I Bansal Classes Question
Bank on Particle dynamics [12]
Q.8 A . s 1 ni //////// 2T iLH m, A force F = i + 4j acts on block shown. The fo
rce of friction acting on the bloc k is : (A)-i (B)-1.8 i IKg (C) - 2.4 i (D)-3
i p - o .3 Q.10 A body of mass m ac celerates uniformly from rest to a speed v i
n time t . The work done on the body till any timet is Q.9 0 0 1 (A) mv t Q 2 2
(B) ~mv VIQ. t 2 2 (C)mv 0 2 Vo J l (D)mv 0 'P 3 Q.ll A man who is running has h
alf the kinetic energy of the boy of half his mas s. The man speeds up by 1 m/s
and then has the same kinetic energy as the boy. T he original speed of the man
was (A) V2 m/s (B)(V2-l)m/s (C)2m/s (D) (V2 + 1) m/ s Q.12 A particle originally
at rest at the highest point of a smooth vertical c ircle is slightly displaced
. It will leave the circle at a vertical distance h b elow the highest point, su
ch that (A) h = R (B) h = R/3 (C)h = R/2 (D)h = 2R Q.1 3 F = 2 x - 3 x - 2 . Cho
ose correct option (A) x = - 1 /2 is position of stable equilibrium (B) x=2 is p
cit y ofball A after collision is 7.5 m/s (D) velocity of ball B after collision
is 5 m/s. Q.28 Force acting on a body of mass 1 kg is related to its position x
as F = x - 3x N. It is at rest at x = 1. Its velocity at x = 3 can be : (A) 4 m
/s ( B) 3 m/s (C)2m/s (D)5m/s ; 0 0 0 3 Q.29 ' Which graph shows best the veloci
ty-time graph for an object launched ver tically into the air when air resistanc
e is given by | D j=bv? The dashed line s hows the velocity graph if there were
no air resistance. (A) (C) Q.30 A 1.0 kg block of wood sits on top of an identic
al block of wood, which sit s on top ofa flat level table made of plastic. The c
oefficient of staticfriction between the wood surfaces is p,, and the coefficien
t of static friction between the wood and plastic is p Ahorizontal force F is ap
plied to the top block only, and this force is increased until the top block sta
rts to move. The bottom block will move with the top block if and only if r (A)
pi, < -1^2 (B)~p <p <p 2 1 2 (C)p <pi 2 (D) 2p < p., 2 Q.31 To paint the side of
a building, pai nter normally hoists himselfup by pul ling on the rope A as in
figure. The painter and platform together weigh 200N. T he rope B can withstand
300N. Then (A) The maximum acceleration that painter can have upwards is 5m/s .
(B) To hoist himself up, rope B must withstand minimum 4 00N force. (C) Rope A w
ill have a tension of 100 N when the painter is at rest. (D) The painter must ex
ert a force of 200N on the rope A to go downwards slowly. 2 Q.32 A block of mass
2 kg slides down an incline plane of inclination 30. The coe fficient offriction
between block and plane is 0.5. The contact force between blo ck and plank is :
(A) 20 Nt .(B) 10V3 Nt (C) 5V7 Nt (D) 5Vl5 Nt Q.33 If force F is increasing with
time and at t = 0 , F = 0 where will FHTT1 ,[1 = 0.5 slipping first start? } I
i" 1 fi = 0.3 (A) between 3 kg and 2 kg (B) between 2 kg and 1 kg _L_T 7 (C) bet
ween 1 kg and ground (D) both (A) and (B) )i = 0. <!I Bansal Classes Question Ba
nk on Particle dynamics [12]
Q.34 Aropeofmass 5 kg is moving vertically in vertical position with an upwards
force of 100 N acting at the upper end and a downwards force of 70 N acting at t
he lower end. The tension at midpoint of the rope is (A)100N (B) 85 N (C) 75 N
( D)105N Q. 3 5 Find the acceleration of 3 kg mass when acceleration of 2 kg mas
s is 2 ms as shown in figure. 3 kg 2 kg ION (A) 3 ms" (B) 2 ms" 2ms "-> (C) 0.5
ms (D) zero Q. 3 6 Block of 1 kg is initially in equilibrium and is hanging by t
wo identical springs A and B as shown in figures. If spring A is cut from lower
po int at t=0 then, find acceleration of block in ms at t = 0. (A) 5 (B) 10 (C)
15 (D) 0 Q. 3 7 Assume the aerodynamic drag force on a car is proportional to it
s s peed. If the power output from the engine is doubled, then the maximum speed
of the car. (A) is unchanged (B) increases by a factor of J 2 (C) is also doubl
ed ( D) increases by a factor of four. -2 2 2 -2 -2 Q. 3 8 A body is moved from
rest along a straight line by a machine delivering c onstant power. The ratio of
displacement and velocity (s/v) varies with time t a s: tf tt tt tt (A) Q. 3 9
A pendulum bob is swinging in a vertical plane such that its angular ampl itude
is less than 90. At its highest point, the string is cut. Which trajectory is pos
sible for the bob afterwards. (A) (B) (C) (D) DIIDIII s/v (B) s/v (C) s/v (D) s/
v Q. 4 0 A conical pendulum is moving in a circle with angular velocity co as sh
ow n. If tension in the string is T, which of following equations are correct ?
(A) T = moo / (B) T sinG = mco / (C)T = mg cosB (D) T = mco 1 sinG 2 2 2 Q.41 A
particle is released from rest at origin. It moves under influence of pot ential
field U = x - 3x, kinetic energy at x = 2 is (A) 2J (B) 1 J (C) 1.5 J (D) 0 J 2
Q. 42 A ball whose size is slightly smaller than width ofthe tube of radius 2.5
m is proj ected from bottommost point of a smooth tube fixed in a vertical plan
e with velocity of 10 m/s. If Nj and N are the normal reactions exerted by inner
side and outer side of the tube on the ball (A) Nj> 0 for motion in ABC, N > 0
f or motion in CDA (B) Nj> 0 for motion in CDA, N > 0 for motion in ABC (C) N >
0 for motion in ABC & part of CDA (D) N, is always zero. 10 m/s
9 2 2 2 <!I Bansal Classes Question Bank on Particle dynamics [12]
Q.43 A man is standing on a rough (p = 0.5) horizontal disc rotating with consta
nt angular velocity of 5 rad/sec. At what distance from centre should he stand
s o that he does not slip on the disc? (A) R < 0.2m (B) R> 0.2 m (C)R>0.5m (D)R>
0. 3m Q.44 Aroad is banked at an angle of 30 to the horizontal for negotiating a
cur ve of radius 10^3 - At what velocity will a car experience nofrictionwhile n
egot iating the curve? (A) 54 km/hr (B)72km/hr (C)36km/hr (D)18km/hr * ? Q.45 A
bob a ttached to a string is held horizontal and released. The tension and verti
cal di stance from point of suspension can be represented by. / T (D) (B) m Q.46
The system of the wedge and the block connected by a massless spring as sho wn
in the figure is released with the spring in its natural length. Friction is abs
ent, maximum elongation in the spring will be 8Mg 3Mg 4Mg 6Mg (B) 5k (D) 5k ( A)
5k (C) 5k Q.47 Two massless string of length 5 m hangfromthe ceiling very nea r
to each other as shown in the figure. Two balls A and B of masses 0.25 kg and 0
.5 ihiiiiuiiiju kg are attached to the string. The ball A is released from rest
at a height 0.45 m as shown in the figure. The collision between two balls is c
ompletely elastic. Immediately after the collision, the kinetic energy of ball B
is 1 J. The velocity of ball Ajust after the collision is (A) 5 ms" to the righ
t (B) 5 ms" to the left (C) 1 ms- to the right (D) 1 ms" to the left Q.48 Consi
d er following statements [ 1 ] CM of a uniform semicircular disc of radius R =
2R /ft from the centre [2] CM of a uniform semicircular ring of radius R = 4R/37
Ifr omthe centre [ 3 ] CM of a solid hemisphere of radius R = 4R/3TI from the ce
ntre [4] CM of a hemisphere shell of radius R = R/2 from the centre Which statem
ents are correct'? (A) 1,2, 4 (C) 4 only .(D) 1,2 only (B) 1, 3, 4 v (ms"')i Q.4
9 Th e diagram to therightshows the velocity-time graph for two masses R and S t
hat c ollided elastically. Which of the following statements is true? (I) R and
S move d in the same direct ion after the collision. (II) Kinetic energy of the
system (R & S) is minimum at t = 2 milli sec, t (milli sec) (III) The mass of R
was gre ater than mass of S. (A) I only (B) II only (C) I and II only (D) I, II
and III Q.50 A smooth sphere is moving on a horizontal surface with a velocity v
ector (2 i + 2j)m/s immediately before it hit a vertical wall. The wall is paral
lel to ve ctor j and coefficient of restitution between the sphere and the wall
is e = 1/2 . The velocity of the sphere after it hits the wall is (A)i-j (B) - i
+ 2 j (C)i-j (D) 2 i - j 1 1 4 1 1.2 <!I Bansal Classes Question Bank on Partic
le dynamics [12]
Q.51 A man of mass M stands at one end of a plank of length L which lies at rest
on a frictionless surface. The M man walks to other end ofthe plank. Ifthe mass
of the plank is , then the distance that the man moves relative to ground is: 3
L L 4L (A) (B) (C) (D) Q.52 Two balls A and B having masses 1 kg and 2 kg, movi
n g with speeds 21 m/s and 4 m/s respectively in opposite direction, collide hea
d on. After collision Amoves with a speed of 1 m/s in the same direction, then t
he coefficient ofrestitution is (A) 0.1 (B) 0.2 (C) 0.4 (D) None Q.53 Two partic
le s of equal mass have velocities 2 i ms"" and 2j ms . First particle has an ac
cel eration (i + j) m s while the acceleration ofthe second particle is zero. Th
e ce ntre of mass ofthe two particles moves in (A) circle (B) parabola (C) ellip
se (D ) straight line Q.54 A particle ofmass 3m is projected from the ground at
some a ngle with horizontal. The horizontal range is R. At the highest point of
its pat h it breaks into two pieces m and 2m. The smaller mass comes to rest and
larger mass finally falls at a distance x from the point of projection where x
is equal to 3R 3R 5R (A) (B) (C) 4 (D)3R 4 2 Q.55 A block of mass M on a horizon
tal smoo th surface is pulled by a load of mass M/2 by means of a rope AB and st
ring BC a s shown in the figure. B M C The length & mass of the rope AB are L an
d M/2 resp ectively. As the M/2 block is pulled from AB = L to AB = 0 its accele
ration chan ges from 3g ( D ) - ^ t o 2g (C) - to g (A) f to g (B) 4 2 1 -1 2 v
y y A t 0 Q.56 A uniform rod of length L and mass M has been placed on a rough h
orizontal surface. The horizontal force F applied on the rod is such that the ro
d is just in the state of rest. If the coefficient offrictionvaries according to
the relat ion p = Kx where K is a +ve constant. Then the tension at mid point o
f rod is (A ) F/2 (B) F/4 (C) F/8 (D) None Q.57 In the arrangement shown in the
figure, mass of the block B and A is 2m and m respectively. Surface between B an
d floor is s mooth. The block B is connected to the block C by means of a string
pulley syste m. If the whole system is released, then find the minimum value of
mass ofblock C so that block Aremains stationary w.r.t. B. Coefficient of frict
ion between Aa nd B is p: r~ B z t IIII1111III! II11 III 111 f 6m 2m+ 1 3m m (D)
p + 1 (B) p + 1 (C) 1^4 (A) P <!I Bansal Classes Question Bank on Particle dyna
mics [12]
2 e e 0
t F = end 0 0
T \2 Q. 5 8 A particle of mass m, initially at rest, is acted on by a forc F > ^
T J during the interval 0 < t < T. The velocity ofthe particle at th of the int
erval is: 2F T 4F T 5F T 3F T (C) 3m (D) 2m (A) 6m (B) 3m 0 0
Q. 5 9 With what minimum velocity should block be proj ected from left end A tow
ards end B such that it reaches the other end B of conveyer belt moving with co
n stant velocity v. Friction coefficient between block and belt is p. AJM v B (A)
V pgL (B) /2pgL (D) 2^/pgL (C) V3ugL Q. 6 0 Two masses m and M are attached to
th e strings as shown in the figure. Ifthe system is in equilibrium, then 2M 2m
(A) tan9 = 1 + m (B) tanB = 1 ~M 2M 2m (C) cotQ = 1 + m (D) cote = 1 + Q.61 Bloc
k B of mass 100 kg rests on a rough surface offrictioncoefficient p= 1/3. Arope
is tied to block B as shown in figure. The maximum acceleration with which boy A
of 25 kg can climbs on rope without making block move is: 4g 3g (A) (B) (C) (D)
4 Q.62 In the system shown in the figure there is no friction anywhere. The blo
ck C goes down by a distance x = 10 cm with respect to wedge D when system is re
lea sed from rest. The velocity ofA with respect to B will be (g^ 10 m/s ): (A)
zero (B) 1 m/s (C)2m/s (D) None of these Q 2 100kg H=l/3 B 25kg Q.6 3 A car move
s along a circular track of radius R banked at an angle of 30 to the horizontal.
The coefficient of static friction between the wheels and the tr ack is p. The m
aximum speed with which the car can move without skidding out is y /t\ f _ .. . /
. rr. H/2 (A) [2gR(l + p)/V3j1/2 (B) [gR(l-p)/(p + V3)J (D) None (C) [gR(l + pV3
)/(p + V3)^' 2 Q.64 Potential energy of a particle is related to x coordinate by
equation x - 2 x. Particle will be in stable equilibrium at (A)x = 0.5 (B) x i (C) x = 2 (D) x = 4 2 BansaI Classes Question Bank on Particle dynamics [9]
Q.65 A particle of mass m is tied to one end ofa string of length /. The particl
e is held horizontal with the string mg taut. It is then projected upward with
a velocity u. The tension in the string is when it is inclined at an angle 30 to
t he horizontal. The value of u is (A) fig (B)V2/J (C)j| (0)2^/5 Q.66 A force F
= k[y i + x j] where k is a positive constant acts on aparticle moving in x-y pl
an e starting from the point (3,5), the particle is taken along a straight line
to (5,7). The work done by the force is: (A) zero (B) 35 K (C) 20 K (D)15K Q.67
Wat er is pumped from a depth of 10 m and delivered through a pipe of cross sect
ion 10 nr. If it is needed to deliver a volume of 10 m per second the power requ
ired will be: (A)10kW (B) 9.8 kW (C) 15 kW (D)4.9kW Q.68 A light spring of lengt
h 20 cm and force constant 2 kg/cm is placed vertically on a table. A small bloc
k of mass 1 kg. falls on it. The length hfromthe surface of the table at which t
he b all will have the maximum velocity is (A) 20 cm (B) 15 cm (C)10cm (D)5cm Q.
69 Th e ratio of period of oscillation of the conical pendulum to that of the si
mple p endulum is : (Assume the strings are of the same length in the two cases
and 9 i s the angle made by the string with the verticla in case of conical pend
ulum) (A ) cos 9 (B)VcosO (C)l (D) none of these Q. 70 A particle is moving in a
circle: (A) The resultant force on the particle must be towards the centre. (B)
The cros s product of the tangential acceleration and the angular velocity will
be zero. (C) The direction ofthe angular acceleration and the angular velocity
must be th e same. (D) The resultant force may be towards the centre. Q. 71 The
work done i n joules in increasing the extension of a spring of stiffness 10 N/c
m from 4 cm to 6 cm is: (A) 1 (B) 10 (C) 50 (D)100 Q.72 A man weighing 80 kg is
standing at the centre of a flat boat and he is 20 mfromthe shore. He walks 8 hi
on the boat towards the shore and then halts. The boat weight 200 kg. How far i
s he from th e shore at the end of this time ? (A) 11.2m (B) 13.8m (C) 14.3 m (D
) 15.4 m Q.73 From a circle of radius a, an isosceles right angled triangle with
the hypotenu se as the diameter of the circle is removed. The distance ofthe ce
ntre of gravit y of the remaining position from the centre of the circle is 2 _1
3 (A) 3 0 . - 1 ) . ( B ) ^ (C)J~ ( D ) Q.74 A sphere strikes a wall and reboun
ds with coefficient of restitution 1/3. I f it rebounds -with a velocity of 0.1
m/sec at an angle of 60 to the normal to th e wall, the loss of kinetic energy is
1 2 (A) 50% (B) 3 3 - % (C) 40% (D)66--% <!I Bansal Classes Question Bank on Pa
rticle dynamics [12]
Q.75 A truck moving elastically with a ty of the ball just t (C) 65 ms towards -
1 -1 -1 -1 -1 -1
on horizontal road towards east with velocity 20 ms collides light ball moving w
ith velocity 25 ms along west. The veloci after collision (A) 65 ms towards east
(B) 25 ms towards wes west (D) 20 ms towards east
Q.76 A spaceship of speed v travelling along + y axis suddenly shots out one fou
rth of its part with speed 2v along + x-axis. xy axes are fixed with respect to
ground. The velocity of the remaining part is Vl3 (D) - v (A) - V (C)f Q n 0 c
Q Q.77 From a uniform disc of radius R, an equilateral triangle of side -J3 R is
c ut as shown. The new position of centre of mass is: (A) (0,0) (B)(0,R) (D) no
ne of these (0(0,4^) Q.78 In an inelastic collision, (A) the velocity of both th
e p articles may be same after the collision (B) kinetic energy is not conserved
(C) linear momentum of the system is conserved. (D) velocity of separation will
be less than velocity of approach. (0,0). x Q.79 A man of mass 40 kg is standing
on a trolley A of mass 140 kg. He pushes an other trolley B of same material of
mass 60 kg, so that they are set in motion. Then: (A) speed of trolleyAis3times
that of trolley B immediately after the inte raction. (B) speed of trolley B is
3 times that of trolley A immediately after t he interaction. (C) distance trav
elled by trolley B is 3 times that of trolley A before they stop. (D) distance t
ravelled by trolley B is 9 times that of trolle y A before they stop. Q.80 A lon
g plank P of the mass 5 kg is placed on a smooth floor. On P is placed a block Q
of mass 2 kg. The coefficient of friction betwe en P and Q is 0.5. If a horizon
tal force 15N is applied to Q, as shown, and you may take g as lON/kg. (A) The r
eaction force on Q due to P is 10N (B) The accele ration of Q relative to P is 2
.5 m/s (C) The acceleration of P relative to the F loor is 2.0 m/s (D) The accel
eration of centre of mass of P + Q system relative to the floor is (15/7)m/s 2 2
2 Q.81 Ifthe linear density of a rod of length 3 m varies as X=2+ x, then the p
osi tion of centre of gravity of the rod is: (A) 7/3 m (B) 12/7m (C) 10/7m (D) 9
/7 m <!I Bansal Classes Question Bank on Particle dynamics [12]
ANSWER KEY Q.l Q.6 A B Q.2 Q.7 B A Q.3 Q.8 A C Q.4 Q.9 A A Q.5 C Q.10 A Q.15 A Q
.20 A, B, D Q.25 B, D Q.30 D Q.35 B Q.40 A Q.45 A Q.50 B Q.55 B Q.60 A Q.65 B Q.
70 D Q.75 A Q.ll D Q.16 B Q.21 A, C Q.26 B Q.31 A, C Q.36 A Q.41 A Q.46 B Q.51 B
Q.56 B Q.61 B Q.66 C Q.71 A Q.76 B Q.80 C, D Q.12 B Q.17 C Q.22 B Q.27 D Q.32 D
Q.37 B Q.42 C Q.47 D Q.52 B Q.57 C Q.62 C Q.6 7 C Q.72 C Q.77 B Q.81 B Q.13 A Q
.18 A Q.23 B Q.28 A Q.33 C Q.3 8 A Q.43 A Q.48 C Q.53 D Q.58 C Q.63 D Q. 68 B Q.
73 C Q.78 A,B,C,D Q.14 B Q.19 C Q.24 A, B, C Q.29 B Q.34 B Q.39 C Q.44 C Q.49 D
Q.54 C Q.59 B Q.64 B Q.69 B Q.74 D Q.79 B, D <!I Bansal Classes Question Bank on
Particle dynamics [12]
I BANSAL CLASSES TARGETIIT JEE 2007 XII & XIII REVISION PRACTICE PROBLEMS (With
Solutions) FOR JEE-2007 2 bonus question of Mathematics ALL THE B ST FOR JEE -20
07
Q.l Q.2 2 Bon us question of Mathematics L + 153 If L = Lim then find the value
of x->0 /n(l + x) il + x ) Two universities A and B write questions and their co
rrespond ing solutions for a high school mathematics tournament. University A wr
ites 10 q uestions every hour but makes a mistake in their solutions 10% of the
time. The university B writes 20 questions every hour and makes a mistake 20% of
the time. Each university works for 10 hours and then sends all problems to a M
iss 'C' fo r checking. However only 75% of the problems which she thinks are wro
ng are actu ally incorrect. Further she thinks that 20% of the questions from th
e university A have incorrect solutions, and that 10% of the questions from the
university B have incorrect solutions. If the probability that a problem definit
ely written and solved correctly, randomly chosen by her, / n ( x + 2 was though
t of as having incorrectly solved, is (p + q)Q.l where p and q coprimes, then fi
nd the value of PHYSICS QUESTION 1 UF 2Q 10 V In the circuit shown, the switch S
is in position1 since a I iVvWlong time. At a certain moment t = 0, it is shifted
to ,20 V posit ion-2. The 1 pF capacitor is initially uncharged. 2 (iF (a) Find
the current tha t flows through the 2 Q resistor as a function of time't' for t
> 0. Wr 1D (b) Wh at percentage of the work done by the 10 V cell is lost as hea
t from the 2Q resi stor, from t = 0 till infinity? Q.2 A beam consisting of two
wavelengths 8100 A and 4500 A is used to obtain interference fringes in a Young'
s double slit exper iment. The distance between the slits is 2 mm and that betwe
en the plane of the slits and the screen is 100 cm. (a) Find the least distance
in millimeters from the central maxima on the screen where the bright fringes du
e to both the wavele ngths coincide. (b) Find the least distance in millimeters
from the central maxi ma on the screen where the dark fringes due to bothrthe wa
velengths coincide: Q. 3 A cylinder contains a tight fitting piston of mass 2 kg
and cross-sectional ar ea 10 cm . Under the piston, there is 1 mole of a diatom
ic gas at 300 K initiall y. The walls of the cylinder are heat insulating and th
e piston is also thermall y insulating. By means of an electrical heater, the ga
s is slowly given a heat = 1000 Joules. The upper end of cylinder is open to the
atmosphere :{H= having at mospheric pressure = 10 Pascals. Neglect any friction
al loss. (a) By what distan ce does the piston shift up? (b) What is the final t
emperature of the gas? Q.4 A solid sphere with a hollow cavity (of radius R/2) h
aving net mass m and radius R is resting in. equilibrium on a rough horizontal f
loor, as shown. The sphere i s tilted slightly and released. Find the time perio
d of subsequent oscillations assuming that the sphere's surface does not slip ov
er the floor. wnunWrWfuuuuu Q .5 Two monochromatic and coherent point sources of
light, S, and S of wavelength 4000 A, are placed at a distance 4 mm from each ot
her. The line joining the two sources is perpendicular to a screen. The distance
of the mid-point of S,S from the screen is D = A/2 m. Find the radius (non-zero
) ofthe smallest bright ring o n the screen, using valid assumptions. 2 5 0 7 Ba
nsal Classes PHYSICS [2]
Q.6 A glass sphere of radius R has a point isotropic source of monochromatic lig
ht o f wavelength X. The thickness of the glass wall is't' ( R). The inner surfa
ce of the sphere is painted black so that it absorbs all the radiation incident
on it . Find the maximum power of the source such that the sphere does not ruptu
re due to the radiation pressure. Rupture stress of glass = a. In the figure sho
wn, th e sonic source of frequency 200 Hz is moving with a speed = 10 m/s. Find
the bea t frequency as heard by the listener L, who is himself moving with speed
= 5 m/s . The reflecting wall is moving with a speed = 15 m/s. A wind is also b
lowing to the right with a speed = 5 m/s. Speed of sound in still air = 340 m/s.
s Q.7 wall Q.8 A sphere of mass'm' collides elastically with another stationary
sphere of mass 'm/2' obliquely. Both the spheres are smooth and there are no ex
ternal forces ac ting on them. Solve the equations of collision and find the max
imum angle throug h which the sphere of mass'm' can be deflected w.r.t. its orig
inal direction. A thermally insulated cylinder is divided into two parts by a he
at insulating tigh t piston, which can move freely in the cylinder without frict
ion. The left part of the cylinder contains one mole of an ideal diatomic gas an
d the right part is evacuated. The piston is connected to the right wall of the
cylinder through a spring whose natural length is equal to the total length of t
he cylinder. The el ectrical heater is i : vacuum switched on for some time so th
at the gas temperatu re increases and 1 mole -mbWMmuof the piston shifts slowly
to the right. What pe rcentage of the heat diatomic supplied by the heater goes
in compressing the spr ing? Neglect the gas heat capacity of the piston or the c
ylinder. A ball is thro wn from a point O with some speed v at an angle of 37 wit
h the horizontal, such t hat the ball bounces from the vertical 31( wall and retu
rns to O. For the bounce, the coefficient of restitution 0 4m 777777777777777777
7777777 7 7 7 7 is 5/8. W hat must be the value of v ? g = 10 m/s . A spherical
body of mass M and radius R has a spherical cavity of radius R/2 inside it, as s
hown. The center of the ca vity O is displaced from the geometric center of the
sphere C by a distance R/2. A tiny body of mass m ( M) is placed at a distance 2
R from the geometric center of the first body. Find the force of gravitational a
ttraction on the tiny body. If the tiny body is released from rest, with what ve
locity will it hit the surf ace of the spherical body? T'^rnrew^ The circuit shown
is fed by an a.c. source hav ing emf = (15 V) sin coil-l coil-2 200t, where time
t is in seconds. Coil-1 has a resistance = 3 fl and inductance 20 mH, while coi
l-2 has a resistance = 6 0 an d inductance 40 mH. Find the voltages across the t
wo coils, V, and V , as functi ons of time, t. A certain radionuclide is getting
formed in some reactor at a co nstant rate = q (number per second). It undergoe
s alpha decay with half life T. At the moment t = 0, there are (4qT//n 2) number
of radionuclide in the reactor. Find the number of radionuclide 'N' in the reac
tor at any later time t > 0 and plot a graph of N versus t. Find the number of a
lpha particles emitted till t = 2T. Q.9 Q. 10 Q.ll 0 0
2 (a) (b) Q.12 2 Q.13 (a) (b) ^Bansal Classes PHYSICS [426]
Q. 14 In a modified Young's double slit experiment, there are three identical pa
rallel slits S,, S and S . A coherent monochromatic beam of wavelength 700 nm,
h aving plane wavefronts, falls on the slits, as shown. The intensity of the cen
tr al point O on the screen is found to be 7 x i(H W/m . The distance SjS = S S
= 0 .7 mm. (a) Find the intensity on the screen at O if S, and S are covered. {b
) Fi nd the intensity on the screen at 0 if only S is covered. (c) All three sli
ts ar e now uncovered and a transparent plate of thickness 1.4 pm and refractive
index 1.25 is placed in front of S . Find the intensity at point O. Q. 15 A jee
p is m oving at a certain moment with velocity = 10 m/s. The acceleration of the
jeep i s 'a'. A man sitting in the jeep throws a ball with initial velocity = 2
0 m/s, a t an angle of 53 with the horizontal, both w.r.t. himself. The motion of
the jeep is in the same direction and vertical plane as the motion of the ball.
Given: s in 53 = 4/5, cos 53 = 3/5. Neglect air resistance. (a) Find the actual i
nitial spe ed of the ball relative to an earth observer. (b) What should be the
acceleratio n 'a' of the jeep so that the man is able to catch the ball? (c) Wha
t is the far thest distance ofthe ball from the man, as perceived by him, in par
t (B)? Q.16 T wo blocks, 1 & 2, of masses m and 4m, interconnected by a massless
spring of spr ing constant k, and are resting on africtionlesshorizontalfloor.F
orces F and 2F start acting on the blocks, at t = 0, as shown. (a) Write the ear
th frame work-e nergy theorem for the system, in terms F 2F. \uMuuuu\uuu\fm of s
peeds v, and v , and displacements x, and x of the two blocks. \utMu\\uu\u\u\v,u
fl\mrv (b) Find t he maximum elongation ofthe spring during the motion of the two
blocks, if F = 5 mg. (c) Find the maximum speed of block-1 in the center of mas
s frame, if F = 5m g, Q.17 A uniform and thin rod AB of mass 5m and length L is
kept stationary on a frictionless horizontal surface. At a certain moment, a tin
y ball of mass m, m oving with a horizontal velocity = v collides inelastically
with the rod, at a p oint whose distance from end A of the rod is z. The directi
on of v is perpendicu lar to the rod, as shown. The coefficient of restitution f
or collision is 3/4. J ust after the collision, let v, = velocity of the center
of rod (rightwards), v = velocity of the ball, assumed leftwards and co = angula
r velocity of the rod. (a) Write the condition for coefficient of restitution =
3/4 in terms of relevan t parameters (b) It is found that the velocity of B just
after the collision is zero. Find z. (c) Assuming the condition of part (B), ca
lculate the percentage o f B energy lost during the collision. 2 3 2 2 2 3 3 3 2
2 2 Q 0 ( 5 2 Q.18 A gaseous mixture initially at 300 K and 2 x 10 N/m pressure
contains 6 g o f hydrogen and 8 gm of Helium. The m ixture is expanded to four
times its ori gi nal volume, through an isobaric heating process. Then, it is is
ochorically coole d until its temperature again becomes 300 K. After that, the g
as mixture is isot hermally compressed to its original volume. (a) Find the rati
o of molar specific heats = y ofthe mixture. (b) Plot the process in P-V and P-T
indicator diagrams , showing all values of P & T. (c) Find the efficiency of th
e entire cycle (take in 2 = 0.7) Q.19 Two radio stations broadcast their program
mes at the same ampl itude A, but at slightly different frequencies ro_ and co ,
where o) - co = 1000 Hz. A detector receives the signals from the two stations
simultaneously. It ca n only detect signals of intensity > 2A , (a) Find the tim
e interval between the successive maxima ofthe intensity ofthe signal received b
y the detector. (b) Fi nd the time for which the detector remains idle in each c
ycle of the intensity o f the signal, Q.20 A long wire PQR is made by joining tw
o wires PQ and QR of equ al radii. Their lengths and masses are respectively: 4.
8 m and 0.06 kg; 2.56 m & 0.2 kg. The tension is 80 N. A sinusoidal wave pulse o
f amplitude 3.5 cm is sen t along the wire PQ from the end P. No power is dissip
ated during the propagatio n ofthe wave pulse. Calculate the time taken by the p
ulse to reach the end R and the amplitude of reflected and transmitted wave puls
es at Q. 2 3 2 2 ^Bansal Classes PHYSICS
[4]
Q.21 otal that 1 Q.
In the circuit shown, the potentiometer wire AB has a length = 100 cm and t resi
stance 10 Q. What should be the distance of the jockey from point A so the readi
ng of the ammeter is 0,5 A? The coil resistance of the ammeter is The cell at th
e top has an emf = 15 Volts and internal resistance 1 O.
1\AVv Q.22 A soap bubble of radius r is blown at the end of a capillary of length
/ and of internal radius R. Surface tension of soap solution is T and coefficie
nt of viscosity of air is r\. The volume of air flowing per second through the
c apillary is given by Q.23 soap bubble. Find the lifetime of the soap bubble. T
wo small balls A and B are interconnected by an inextensible string of length L.
M ass of ball A= m, mass of ball B = 2m. The balls are resting on a frictionles
s h orizontal surface, with the distance between them = 3L/5. In this position,
ball A is suddenly given a horizontal velocity v , perpendicular to the line joi
ning the two balls. Find the speed of ball B just after the string becomes taut.
Fin d the impulse of the tension in string when the string becomes taut Find th
e ste ady tension in string much after the string has become taut. A wooden log
of mas s m with a cross-section shaped like an equilateral right-angled triangle
can sl ide on a horizontal surface without friction. Two point-like bodies of m
asses m and 2m, tied to each other using a thread, are placed onto the log as sh
own in t he figure. The length of the base of the log is L-54 cm. Friction and t
he masses of the thread and the pulley are negligible The bodies are released at
a certai n moment. What distance does the wooden log cover until the body of ma
ss 2m reac hes its bottom? Determine the speed ofthe bodies and that ofthe woode
n log when V the body of mass 2m reaches the bottom of the log. In a tennis rack
et, the c.m . is 12 inches from the end ofthe handle. The radius of gyration abo
ut an axis t hrough the c.m. as shown in the figure is 8 inches. If the tennis b
all is hit at a distance of 20 inches from the end ofthe handle, where should th
e player hold his racket so as not to feel any translational force when hitting
the ball? We have two liquids of different densities. A force of 1.36 N can hold
the same pie ce of metal in one of them, and of 0.82 N in the other. In what vo
lume proportio n should they be mixed so that the holding force is exactly 1 N?
A cart on an in clined plane of angle 9 - 30 is balanced as shown by a weight of
mass 10 kg. The cord Ais wound on a drum of diameter d, which is on the same sha
ft as a drum of diameter .j, d. = 3d, on which is wound cord B. What is the mass
a, , M of the c art? 0 2 rn 0 5Q 8rj/ , where P is the excess pressure on (a) (
b) (c) Q.24 (a) '(b) Q.25 Q.26 Q.27 J U l Q.28 Through the Looking Glass: A narr
ow beam oflight has entered a large thin l ass plate. Each refraction is accompa
nied by reflection of k = 30% of the beam's energy. What fraction ofthe light en
ergy is transmitted through the plate 9 ^ Bansal Classes
PHYSICS [428]
Q.29 Lake Placid: A radio receiver is set up on a mast in the middle of a calm l
ake to track the radio signal from a satellite orbiting the Earth. As the satel
l ite rises above the horizon, the intensity of the signal varies periodically,
th e intensity is at a maximum when the satellite is 8j= 3 above the horizon and
the n again at 9 = 6 above the horizon. What is the wavelength X of the satellite
sig nal? The receiver is h = 4.0 m above the lake surface. Q.30 In the figure,
water of density 1000 kg/m flows through the pipe. The cross-section area at sta
tions 1, 2 and 3 are 1 cm , 2 cm and A cm , respectively. The thin vertical tube
s tha t are connected to the pipe at these stations have water 20 cm levels as i
ndicat ed. Find the mass flow rate of water through the pipe and v . [Take g = 1
0 m/s ] 2 3 2 2 2 3 2 Q.31 A metal ring having three metallic spokes of lengths
r=0.2 m is in a vertic al plane and can spin around a fixed horizontal axis in a
homogeneous magnetic f ield of a magnetic induction of B=0.5 T. The lines of ma
gnetic field are perpend icular to the plane of the metal ring. Between the axis
of the metal ring and it s perimeter we connect a consumer of a resistance of 0
.15 with the help of two s liding contacts. We fix a thread of negligible mass t
o the rim of the ring and w ind it several times around the ring and to its end
we fix a body of a mass of 2 0 g. At a given moment we release the body of mass
m. The friction is negligible everywhere, the resistance of the ring, the spokes
www and the connected wiring is also negligible. (a) What is the torque exerted
on the ring with the spokes by the magnetic / B forces when the body of m is mo
ving with a constant velocity ? \ s (b) What current isflowingthrough the consume
r when the velocity of the bod y of mass m is 3 m/s? J > L (c) What is the highes
t velocity of the body of mass m? /s \\\\\\\ / Q.32 Figure shows a hypothetical s
peed distribution for particles of a certain g as: P (v) = Cv for 0 < v < v and
P(v) = 0 for v > v. (a) Show that C = 3/vJ, dN/N =P(v) dv Find (b) the average sp
eed of the particles, and (c) their rms speed. Q.33 A neutron moving with a kine
tic energy = 65 eV collides head-on and inelast ically with a singly ionized hel
ium atom at rest (in its ground state). Take the ionization energy of hydrogen a
tom =13.6 eV, Also, mass of Helium atom is four times that of a neutron. If the
helium ion gets de-excited subsequently by emitt ing radiation, calculate the po
ssible energies of the emitted photon(s) in eV. Q .34 A board of mass m is place
d on a frictionless inclined plane that makes an a ngle 0 = 37 with the horizonta
l. A block of same mass is placed on the board and is given a quick push up the
board with initial velocity v = 8 m/s. Find the dis tane d covered by the block
by the time its velocity drops to v/2. The board doe s not move relative to the
plane. Q.35 A 20 mH inductor is connected in series w ith a charged capacitor of
capacitance 2 pF, having initial charge = 10 mC. Afte r how much minimum time w
ill the energy in the capacitor become half of its init ial value? Leave answer
in terms of n. Q.36 A uniform and slender rod of mass 2m and length L is lying o
n a frictionless V3horizontal surface. Two insects, of m ass m each, moving hori
zontally with velocities v and 2v hit the rod simultaneou sly and symmetrically
and stick G3to it. 2 Q ^ Bansal Classes PHYSICS [6]
Q.37 (a) (b) Q.38 Q.39 Q.40 (a) (b) (c) Q.41 Q.42 The initial velocities of the
insects are perpendicular to the rod, as shown. Th e distance of each insects's
hit-point from the center of the rod is L/6. Just a fter hitting the rod, each i
nsect starts walking along the rod, away from its ce nter, with constant speed =
v relative to the rod. As the rod rotates and moves, the insects finally reach
the ends. Find the total angle rotated by the rod til l this moment in radians.
A thin uniform circular disc of radius R and mass m is hinged about its center p
oint O, so that it is free to rotate about a fixed hor izontal axis through O. T
he plane of the disc is vertical. A small body A, of ma ss m/2, is fixed at the
rim of the disc, as shown. Initially, the line OA makes an angle of 60 with the v
ertical. The disc is now released from rest, Find the ac celeration of point A j
ust after release. Find the magnitude of horizontal and v ertical reaction force
s: F and F on the hinge, just after the disc is released. In the figure shown, t
he spring constant is I6n N/m and its right end is fixed t o a vertical wall. Th
e floor is smooth. A block of mass 1 kg is initially at a d istance of 1 m from
the other 1 kg block. The left 4 m/s kg block, touching a ve rtical wall, is imp
arted a velocity = 4 m/s towards lm B the other block. All co llisions are elast
ic. Find the time period of this Hvmummm"rnrr 1kg oscillatory system. A ring of
radius r = 1 m is placed on the top of an inclined plane and r eleased from rest
. The inclined plane makes an angle of 30 with the horizontal. T he coefficient o
f friction between the ring and the incline is 0.2. Find the dis tance travelled
by the centre of the ring by the time it completes one revolutio n, as it rolls
down the incline. In the figure shown, a constant horizontal forc e F = mg/2 st
arts acting on the block of mass m, from the position shown. The sp ring is unde
formed in the position shown and has a narual length L, while the bl ocks are in
itially stationary. The spring constant is unknown. The surface is fr ictionless
. The mass of the hanging block is m/4, while [\wmmms\m the pulley is massless a
nd frictionless. Find the initial acceleration of the block of mass. W rite the
work-energy equation for the system consisting of the two blocks, and t he sprin
g, for any general value of 9 = angle which the spring makes with the ve rtical.
The maximum displacement of the bigger block is found to be LVJ . Based on this
information, find the spring constant. A lift is moving up with a consta nt ret
ardation = 2 m/s . When its upward velocity is 5 m/s, a boy in the lift to sses
a coin, imparting it an upward initial velocity = 3 m/s, with respect to hi msel
f His fingers at the moment of toss are midway between the floor and ceiling , w
hose total height is 2.0 m. After how much time will the coin hit the floor o r
roof of the lift? Also find the distance travelled by the coin and its displac e
ment in the earth frame till then. [Take g = 10 m/s ] At a distance of 20 m fro
m a point isotropic source of sound, the loudness level is 30 dB. Neglecting dam
ping of sound, find the loudness level at a distance of 10 m from the source an
d the distance where the sound is not audible by humans. hor v 2 2 2 Q.43 In the
figure shown, find the relative speed of approach/ separation of the two final
images formed after the light rays pass through the lens on the far r ight, at t
he moment when u = 30 cm. The speed of object = 4 cm/s. The two lens h alves are
placed symmetrically w.r.t the moving object. f=40cm f=60cm otfcct, infer -1
V 40 cm ^ Bansal Classes PHYSICS [430]
Q.44 Figure shows the Regnault's appratus to determine the specific heat capacit
y of a unknown liquid. A solid sphere of known specific heat capacity s, having
mass m, and initial temperature 0,, is mixed with the unknown liquid filled in a
calo rimeter. Let masses of liquid and calorimeter are m and m respectively, sp
ecific heat capacities are s and s and initially they were at room temperature 0
. Whe n the hot sphere is dropped in it, the sphere looses heat and the liquid
calorim eter system takes heat. This process continues till the temperature of a
ll the e lements becomes same (say 0). Heat lost by hot sphere = mjS, (Qj0) Heat
taken by liquid & calorimeter = m s (0-0 ) + m s (0-0 ) If there were no externa
l heat lo ss Heat given by sphere = Heat taken by liquid - calorimeter system m,
Sj (0,-0) = m s (0-0 ) + m s (0-0,) mjSj(0j-0) m s Get s = m ( 0 - 0 ) m 2 3 2 3
2 2 2 2 3 3 2 2 9 2 3 3 3 3 2 HEAT CAPACITY DETERMINATION OF A LIQUID USING CAL
ORIMETER : 2 2 2 steam Chamber "0" steam Disk D -Water (a) (b) By measuring the
final (steady state) temperature of the mixture, we can estimat e s : specific h
eat capacity of the unknown liquid. To give initial temperature (0,) to the sphe
re, we keep it in steam chamber ("O"), hanged by thread. Within some time (say 1
5 min) it achieves a constant temperature 0,. Now the calorimete r, filled with
water (part C) is taken below the steam chamber, the wooden remov able disc D is
removed, and the thread is cut. The sphere drops in the water cal orimeter syst
em and the mixing starts. If specific heat capacity of liquid (s ) were known an
d that of the solid ball (s^ is unknow then (m s +m s )(0-0 ) we ca n find s, =
"1,(0,-9) In the exp. of finding specific heat capacity of an unknow sphere (s )
mass of the sphere and calorimeter are 1000 gm and 200 gm respectiv ely and spe
cific heat capacity of calorimeter is equal to 1/2 cal/gm/C. The mass of liquid (
water) used is 900 gm. Initially both the water and the calorimeter w ere at roo
m temperature 20.0C while the sphere was at temperature 80.0C initially. If the st
eady state temperature was found to be 40.0C. estimate specific heat ca pacity of
the unknow sphere (s ). (Use s = 1 cal/g/C) Also find the maximum permi ssible e
rror in specific heat capacity of tinkown solid. What should be final te mperatu
re so that the error in s should ne minimum? 2 2 7 2 3 3 2 1 2 2 water Calorimet
er ^Bansal Classes PHYSICS [431]
Q.45 END CORRECTIONS IN METER BRIDGE In meter bridge circuit, some extra length
of wire called end corrections should be included at ends for accurate result. S
uppose null point is obtained at /;, then Qi _ i Q 100-ZJ+p When known resistan
c es are interchanged then balancing length is at l . R L T i ioo-/ +p The end c
or rections calculated from above readings are used to modify observation If 100
fi & 200 D values of known resistance is used to give null deflection at /,= 33
.0 cm & on interchanging the known resistances the null deflection is found at 6
7.0 cm. Find the value of end correction. INDEX ERROR IN OPTICAL BENCH In u-v me
tho d the distance between object or image from the pole of mirror or les is req
uire d. Practically the position of holder when read from scale do not exactly g
ive o bject or image distance. This mismatch is constant for every observation.
To det ermine index error a needle (usually usedfor knitting) of known length is
placed horizontally between the pole & object needle. The length of knitting ne
edle gi ves actual object distance while the separation between holder index is
read fro m the scale. Which becomes observed distance so index error (or excess
reading) is e = Observed distance - Actual Distance For index correction the e i
s subtrac ted from observed reading to get correct reading. (a) When a knitting
needle of length 20.0 cm is adjusted between pole and object needle, the separat
ion betwee n the indices of object needle and mirror was observed to be 20.2 cm.
Find the i ndex correction for u. (b) When the same knitting needle is adjustin
g between th e pole and the image needle, the separation between the indices of
image needle and mirror was found to be 19.9 cm. Find the index error for v. (c)
In some obse rvation, the observed object distance (Separation between indices
of object need le and mirror) is 30.2 cm, and the observed image distance is 19.
9 cm. Using ind ex correction from previous two equations, estimate the focal le
ngth of the conc ave-mirror. Q.47 A conducting sphere of radius a is surrounded
by another spheri cal thin conducting shell of radius b The space between them i
sfilledwith dielec tric material of conductivity a and dielectric constant k. Th
e charge Q. and Q a re given to the inner and outer shell at time t = 0. Find ch
arge on outer shell at time t. Q.48 The amplitude of the electric field in an el
ectromagnetic wave o f frequency = 2.0 x 10 s~ changes with times as E(t) = k (1
+ cos Ht), where k i s a constant and fi= 1.8 x 10 s~'. Would such a wave cause
ionization of hydroge n atoms? If yes, what is the energy of the ejected electr
ons E ? Assume that ato ms absorb light as photons. The ionization energy of hyd
rogen gas is E = 13.6 eV . the Planck constant h - 1.05 J * s. Q.49 An air-fille
d parallel-plate capacito r with the plate area A is connected to a battery with
an emf E and small intern al resistance. One of the plates vibrates so that the
distance between the plate s varies as d = d + a cos t (a d ). The capacitor bre
ak down when the instantaneo us current in the circuit reaches the value of I. F
ind the maximum possible ampl itude of vibrations a. Q.50 Two simple pendulums o
f length L each are attached t o the ceiling. The small balls attached to the st
rings have equal masses m. The weights are connected by a very light relaxed rub
ber band (not a spring) with th e force constant k. At a certain moment, each ba
ll is given a light quick push a s shown, resulting in equal initial speeds. Fin
d the period T of the ensuing mot ion. L l + a 2 2 2 2 + A = 2 2 16 x 15 e 0 Q ^
Bansal Classes PHYSICS [432]
Q.51 A proton (m, e) and an alpha particle (4m, 2e) approach each other from a l
arge distance. Initially, their velocities are the same (v). Find the minimum s
e paration r between the particles. Q.52 A wooden cube with a side of d = 0.10 m
i s placed on a horizontal support. A bullet of mass m = 0.010 kg is shot verti
cal ly up through the support and through the cube. As the bullet passes through
the cube, its speed decreases uniformly from v = 120 m/s to u = 115 m/s. Estima
te t he minimum mass M of the cube that would allow it not to lose contact with
the s upport. Q.53 In a strictly scientific experiment, a student athlete throws
rocks out the window in all directions. All rocks have the same initial speed v
. It t urns out that all rocks' landing velocities make angles 0 or greater with
the ho rizontal. Find the height h of the window above the ground. Q.54 An insu
lated co ntainer is filled with a mixture ofwater and ice at tc = 0C. Another con
tainer is filled with water that is continuously boiling at ^ = 100C. In a series
of exper iments, the containers are connected by various thick rods that pass t
hrough the walls of the containers (refer diagram). The rod is insulated in such
a way tha t there is no heat loss to surroundings. In experiment 1, a insulatio
n copper ro d is used and the ice melts in T, = 20 min. In experiment 2, a steel
rod of the same cross section is used and the ice melts in T = 60 min. How long
would it ta ke to melt the ice if the two rods are used "in series"? Q.55 How c
an you measur e the resistance of an unknown resistor r with an ammeter and a vo
ltmeter if you don't know the internal resistances of these devices? A voltage s
ource is avail able. Q.56 A dubmbell consists ofa light rod of length r and two
small masses m attached to it. The dumbbell stands vertically in the corner form
ed by two frict ionless planes. L After the bottom end is slightly moved to the
right, the dumbb ell begins to slide. Find the speed u of the bottom end at the
moment the top en d loses contact with the vertical plane. Bbi_ Q.57 Find the ma
ximum power of a h eating element that can be constructed from a piece of wire t
hat has a resistanc e of 536 Q. The element is to be powered by a constant volta
ge of V = 110 V. The current through the wire cannot exceed 2 A. Q.58 A heavy bl
ock is attached to t he ceiling by a spring that has a force constant k. A condu
cting rod is attached to the block. The combined mass of the block and the rod i
s m. The rod can slid e without friction along two vertical parallel rails, whic
h are a distance L apa rt. A capacitor of known capacitance C is attached to the
rails by the wires. Th e entire system is placed in a uniform magnetic field B
directed as shown. Find the period T of the vertical oscillations of the block.
Neglect the electrical r esistance of the rod and all wires. 2 Q.59 An electric
circuit contains a battery with emf E and internal resistance r , two coils with
inductances L, and L, and a resistor R, connected as shown. On the diagram, all
shown parameters are given. Initially, both switches are open. Switch S, is the
n closed. After a while, switch S is closed. What is the total c harge Q that pa
sses through the resistor after S- is closed? Q.60 Figure shows t hree identical
balls Mj, M and M each of radius 10 M, cm. The ball M is given a certain veloci
ty in the direction of AB such that after collision with M , it (M ) has a headon collision with the ball Mj. Find the distance BC (in cm) where B lies on the
line joining the centres of M, and M . The balls are assumed to be perfectly ela
stic. Given CjC = 1 m. 2 2 3 3 2 3 2 2 2 ^ Bansal Classes PHYSICS [10]
HINTS & SOLUTIONS MATHEMATICS 1. L = Lim x->0 /n(l + x) / + n ( x + A 1 /[ + x )
t = L = Lim ^(x W l x ) - / n ( x l ) _ x-,0 . M ^ > . VT^) 2 x ^ In x + Vl + x
1+^ 2 2 2 X / n ( x + x-Zn^x + V T ^ - l ) + l)(x + Vl + x -1) 2 (x+vr+x -i) 2
note that Lim x->0 /nf(x + Vl + x -1) + 1 X + Vl + x -1 2 ->1 \ hence L= Lim x->
0 /n x + Vl + x -1 vv 1 + X 2 /Y \ +1 X + Vl + X - l 2 2 x + Vl + x -1 (x + Vl +
x - 1 ) 1+x 2 /r \ A /n -1 + 1 1+x / y =i Note that Lim vv > x->0 x + Vl + x" l ~T+x~ x + Vl + x
(V = Lim x + Vl + x - 1 - x = Lim VT+ x -1 x(l + x)(x + V1 + x -1) - x(V 1 + x +
x -1) 2 z 2 x >0 2 (as Lim(l + x) = 1) x-M) L - Lim ( V ^ + l - l X V x ^ l + l
) x->0 ( V x + l + l ) - x ( V x ^ + l + x l ) 2 = x-(Vx +l+x-l V^T--(x-l)] x-2
Lim x 1 = Lim x-*o 2 (x + l ) - ( x - l ) 2x 2 2 Lim 1 2 [(x +1)-1][VX2+T-(X-1)
] 2 H 2 2 2 L + 153 (1/2)+ 153 hence ;L = 7 7 ^ = 1 + 2 153 = 1 + 306 = 307 Ans.
] (1/4 L = J <Bansal Classes PHYSICS IW
2. Let C: problem is solved correctly P(C) = 9-10 + 10-16 _ 5 300 ~ 6 ....(1) 1
A : Problems from the university A; P(A) = B : Problems from the university B; P
(B) 3 1 3 1 P(W,/B) 10 P(W/Wj) - ' P(Wj/A) ' P(C/Wj)= ; we have to find P(W/C) =
? P( Wj n C) P(Wj)-P(C/WJ) now P(W,/C) = " ^ c P P(CT ....(2) A Vw, now P(Wj) =
P(A n Wj) + P(B n Wj) = P(A) P(Wj/A) + P(B) P(W,/B) I _L _ A ~ 3 ' 5 3 ' 10 ~ 1
5 Hence from (1) and (2) (2/15)(1/4) _ J_ 6 _ _1_ _ p + q= l + 2 5 = 26 Ans. ] P
(W,/C) (5/6) ~ 30 5 ~ 25 4 5 W: problem is solved wrongly P(W) Cj: She thinks th
at the problem is correct Wj: She thinks that the problems is wrong 6 7 = 9 + lj
iF 2Q , 10 V ndl-AWv |Hq ^ where Q = 40 pC, the charge on 2pF just before closi n
g the switch 2. l.(a) 2 ]uF LHfi-H^ (Q-q) By kirchhoffs law (Q-q) 20+ 1 0 - 2 I
- q = 0 I 2 J dq 1 1 0 - ^ =21 = 2dq , 3q - 20 = - dt ' 2 dt 3q-20 4 + = 1 PHYSI
CS r__dt _ I f integrating both sides J _ o ~ 4 J q 3 q 2 =1 T 3q-20 20 on solvin
g q = (l- ~ }iC e 3t/4 20 dq I = -7- = 5e- amp dt 3t/4 ^ Bansal Classes
PHYSICS [12]
(b) 20 20 Work done by 10 V battery = x 10~ x io = x 10" J 6 5 Heat lost by 2 0
resistor = jl (2)dt = 50je~ dt= xlO" J o o 2 3/2 5 u xl0%= 50%] percentage of wo
rk done by 10V battery lost in the form of heat ^20 xlO".5 \ : rio xlO"-5 \ 2(a)
y mAD d = for coincidence of maxima nXD d 8100 m = 4500 n _n _ 9 m 5 9x4500xl0~
xl = 2.025 mm 2x10 -3 10 / (b) f V 0 x8100 2) = f l 0 2) ' n + 0 x 4500: v 2 j '
m + r 9 5 => n = 4; m = 2 y = 4 + V 2y 4500 xlO" 13 = 1.0125 mm Ans. ] 2x10 10 0 T
he whole process is isobaric with pressure = P + mg A AQ = nC AT 7 25 1000 = 1 x
- x x AT 2 3 6000 240 p 10 +- 2x10 N/m = 1,2x 10 N/m 10x10"' 3 2 5 2
(a) ^ 240 2000 AW = nRAT= 1 x x J =285.7 J PAY = AW P x A x Ah = AW 50 Ah = r m 21
2 5 (b) 4. Final temperature = (300 + (240/7)) K 2340 K] If x is the position o
f centre of mass below the centre of sphere xm R m 2 7 0 X 8m 14 Q \ Total energ
y = mg R - c ose + - I 14 P ~T 2 ....(1) ^Bansal Classes PHYSICS [13]
From parallel axis theorem r I * I - m R + m 13R 14 14 y p 0 0 (0 is small); "8m
^ m Also I = v'AzJ ^7 j differentiating equation (1) R d0 1 0 = - mg sin 6) + d _
mgR dt ~ 14I n ] 2 d dt Jlr p 5. D Ax= dcosO 4 (10 X-X)= \0 X cos 0 1 cos 0 = 1 10
' 4 ,4 > = tan9 d cos 0 2 sin (0/2) = 2 T ( cos 0 = 1 - 2 sin (0/2) ); sin (0/2)
= 2 0 6. h 100 i . i i V y D' y = - j ^ - m = 2 cm Ans. ] D\fl r = R sin 0 z i 4t
cRyJx(27cRsine)Rde = dE <r r i ^ \ P sin0d0 ^ he = (dn) 2 X V P sin 0 d 0 dn = 2h
c cw> : h 'PAsinGde^ C O S 0 dF cos 0 = , 2hc o 1 dF cos 0 0 f
x It/2 J eff = { s i n e COS 0 d 0 dF a(2itRt) p eff = 2c P 1 - 0 2c 2 4c 0 o2 T
t Rt = 4c P = 8 71 a Rt c 0 ^ Bansal Classes PHYSICS [437]
350x200 340 + 5 + 15 200x360 200 340 + 5 + 5 A - 200 340 + 5-10 fx 340+ 5-To 335
335 360 3 4 0 - 5 - 5 360 330 f2 = 200 x 200 x 335 340-5-15 335 x 320 360 330 3
50 200 360x330 200 360x33 y - / i = 200 x x - 2 0 0 x 335 335 320 -350 335 32 3 50 335 320 / - / , 12.68 Hz ] m m u cos 0 = v + mv. 2 2 2 2~ i O-ucos0 v - V =
u cos 0 V V 2 t u sin 8 u sin 0 Vj = u COS 0 = V, 4ucos 0 3 u cos 0 f ucosO = t
an~ 3usin0 V n 2 it $ = tan~ cot0 - tan" cot0 0 tan" cotG n -(P-0) cot 0 cot (p+
0) cot 0 cot P cot 0 - 1 3 "" cot p +cot0 cot P cot 0 + cot e - 3 cot P cot e -3
i cot p 2 tan 6 + 3 tan 0 2 => cot p is mm. at tan 0 = j j hence p is max, at 0
= 30 ] 9, V. = AXp V, AX,i. k X, kX, p _ _L p A 2 i mole of diatomic 1 A
vacuum IP 11Bansal Classes PHYSICS [15]
AW = JkXdx = Y ( X ^ - X F ) x, AQ - AU + AW = nC dT + AW= - R ( T -T,) + AW v 2
AQ = | ( R T - R T , ) + A W = | ( P V - P V ) + AW = | ( k X - k X f ) + | (X*
X?) 2 2 2 1 i 2 AW 10, u ti v c o s 3 7 ' 0 T = t + t = 0 (k/2)(X - X ) 100 2 7Xf)x 1 0 0 = % ^ (5 / 2)(kX - kXf) + (k / 2)(X 2 2 2 2 t2 ] u ev cos37 0 0 0 u 5
/8xv x4/5 Q A+iL-Ii i 2 v v v 2v sin 37 13 2 v x 3 / 5 _ 13 v'0 ' 10 vo i 13 v =
5 J j m/s Q Q A 0 TTTTTTTTT7TTT7 4 7R 11.(a) M = p - n 3 M,tota! 2 j 7 F = Fj F (b) (2R y 2 If V, and V gravitational potentials, v is final speed GM removed
3R 2 fT I 2J 4 Mremoved = P 71 R =. 3 8 "7 2GMm ( m\ 9R 3 M 2 R 7
where V GMM 2R al G M tola! R n G M removed y v J R/2 putting the value of V, an
d V and solving we get, 2 v= I6GM 1 \ 21R Lj r, 12. l O2 r. R, = 3fi a-3 Lj = 20
x 10" H L = 40 x 10" H 2 3 R 2 = 6Q e = 15 sin 200 t fa Bansal Classes Z,= y'Rf
-HtoLj) = V 3 7 4 = 5 2 T f PHYSICS
Z,= ,/R +(cdL ) 2 2 1 + 2 2 2 a/6 +8' 2 1 + 2 2 10 2 2 Z = ^ ( R R ) + c o ( L L
) = V 9 +12 = 15 I - ^-sin(200t-<j)) = j|sin(200t-<|>) I = sin (200t - <()) whe
re cos<() = Now, V, = IqZj sin(200 t - <j> + ()>,) = 5 sin (200t) V, = 5 sin(200
t) V = I Z sin(200t) V = 10sin(200t) ] 2 0 2 2 R,+R 2 9 3 == here cos<j)j = [ v <
|> = (f>,] dN 13.(a) dt : q - AN N JXT - f dN In 2 1 A = ln2 'dt 4qT ' in 2 = t
(-A) 4&*-N-q 0 ln(AN-q)-ln In AN-q 3q -At (b) AN 1 q =- + N = f (1- 3 e-^) 3q 3
X qT N = -r~z (1 + 3e" ) In 2 At t = 2T xt N 2T ^ -2( l + 3e- ) In qT 1 + In 2 V
2 No. o f a particle decaying = N + q(2T)-N ' "3 A/2-3 = qT V2in2 + 2 ] = 2Sn2 0
2T [N is N at t 0 fe Bansal Classes Simple Harmonic Motion [5]
14.(a) A x 1 2 = yd _ D 0.7xl0~3 x0.7x!0 2x0.3 A(|) 1 2 271 7x10~ 7 x Ax 7 x 1 0
" 271 _ x 7 x l 0 7 7 X 0.6 = 3 = 0 n + 3 71 Similarly, A(j) = 2tc + 23 (c) Ax =
(1.25 - 1) x 1 . 4 x 10-6 = - ^ x l O " 6 = X =>
A(j) ]2 = 7 T + 71 3 71 2 A(J) = 71 A(J)2, = 7 1 + A; = A2 + 4A2 2A 2 x 1 = 4 A
2 = 4I0 4 14 I res = 7 x 7 x 1 0 " 4 = x e (y 3 15. (a) W/m2 V = 1 2 + 10 v = 16
m/s x y = 22 m/s 2 V2 +v y x V= V256 + 484 = V 7 4 0 m/s v = V740 m/s 2 v (b) T i
m e o f flight i s = 2x16 10
3.2 sec x = 3.2 x 2 2 = 70.4 m 70.4 = 1 0 x 3.2 + x a x (3.2)2 70.4 = 3 2 + 5 .
1 2 a a = 1 7.5 m/s2 & Bansal Classes PHYSICS [18]
5 jeep 7.5i,a = b a l l =-10j = ^ b a l l / jeep = a ball ~ ajeep - 1 0 j - 7 5
i , ball/jeep 12.5 m/s 2 'ball/jeep ~ 12i + 16j ^ball/jeep = 2 0 m / s 0 = (20)
-2 x 12.5 x s, s ^>s = 16ffi I 2 400 25 2 2 16. (a) (b) (2FX, - F X ) - i k(X, X ) - i mvf + i 4mv 2 2F cm 2F-F 5m F 5m F+ma, F - 4ma 2F-4mx6F 5 > 6F 5 5m F +5
m m tx
6F 5 6F tm v 2 6F 5 ~ X m , + y X m , = ^ ( X m , +Xm.) (Xm, + Xm ) = - k(Xm. +
Xm ) , 2 2 2 2 fiF 1 6F k y =-(Xmj+Xm ) 2 12 F 12 5mg 12mg Xm, + Xm, = k = x - = 5~
5 k k 1 1 (c) maximum elongation^ mXnij = 4mXm , Xm, = 4Xm, 12mg 2 Xm, + Xm = ^
2 2 2 12mg Xm, = 4Xm 2 4Xm + Xm = K 12mg 48mg ' 5k 5k 48mg amplitude of mass m ~
~5k~ 12mg X m = 4 X 5Xm = k 0 2 12mg Xm = 2 12mg y r & Bansal Classes
PHYSICS [19]
a= K m x 4 m 5m _ " f5ke g s m a x 5k 48mg , of m = coA = J - x - = x24 V 4m 5k V
5k 17.(a)By momentum conservation, 5m x v - mv, = mv ...(1) By angular momentum
con servation, mv z = - mvj z 5 m/ I J I J ~rT By coefficient of restitution eq
uatio n, 2 Q 0 2 2 + x -(2) (I D 3 V, + VT + C Z U , 4 v -Q V -+V, = 5V 5v. - z
5/ co 1 2 0 0 2 2 x (3) 12 ^ 6V -V +CD\2/ z^ 7 0 6x 5OD/; 7v / 12 + z 2 -z V () B V
co/ B= v - Y - 0 2 => co/ 2=T I I
/ co 2 12 co/ T z= (C) C = O 3 4' 3 9 + tjl t + - V X4 6 0 N 21VQ 38/ 29v =5v -v
= -^f 2 0 v co/ 2 2 y 21v, 76 ' x m x v i K = 12 29v "l6 ( + x5mx 2i^o + x5mx x 2
2 12 76 ^ Bansal Classes PHYSICS [437]
1 2^ 29 +5x21 + 5x7 = 2~ n 76 2 2 m v 0 2 2 1 2 m v 2 x 0 3291 5776 AK K 18. (a) 2
845 xlOO =43% 5776 p,C + p C C =m p,+p 2 v 2 v J 2 'V, = 3 C = p 2 v 2 15R - + 3
3,i
= v J N i mu = 4mv cosQ ...(1) mvj = 4mv sin9 ...(2) From e q. (1) & (2) u + v?
= 16 v ...(3) Ej = -(13.6 eV)z = -54.4 eV o0 2 2 2 2 =0.775 v J 0 0 mvj E,i = -(13.6z) = -6.4 eV n 1 mu Before collision v 4invo After collision AEj = E AE =
E AE = E AE = E 2 3 4
2 3 4 3 - Ej = 40.8 eV - Ej = 48 eV - E , = 51 eV - E = 7.2 eV 2 2 m v 65eV= ~mv
f + | ( 4 m ) v + AE = ~ f + ~(4M) 1 1 u +v* a 16 + AE ...(4) 1 65eV = -2m v .2
+ 81 2+ - + AE -mv, 65eV 4 On substituting AE = 51 eV mv, comes out to be negative
, which implies that, electron transition upto n = 3 is possib le. In subsequent
de-excitation the possible energies are AEj -40.8 eV [n = 2 to n = 1] AE = 48 e
V [n = 3 t o n = l ] AE = 7.2 eV [n = 3 to n = 2] ] 3 2 4 34. ^Bansal Classes Ne
t external force = M system acm ( ma + 0 2mg sin 6 = 2m I 2m , => a = 2g sin 6 P
HYSICS [26]
m+m . . a = m gsinG Also v - = 2ad; 2 3v_ 8a solving we get d = 2 m/s Ans. ] 35.
Let at any instant t charge is q . dq [charge decreasing] ~ dF di d^q dt dt di
C dt C dt 2 ' 1 = 2 L c '-nmp1 q = q sin .VLC t + (j) at t = 0, q = q => <|) = rc
/2 0 0 r dq dt 2 2 LC q ' ^qocos^tj Now, when energy becomes half then, 2c 4 c Let
it happens at t = t V^ = q 0 f 1 ^ q 0 q 0 c o s fi IVTc 0 J 5 ; VLC l 0 = 7t/4
t = ^VLC = 5TI x 10- sec] Just before collision Just after collision some time a
fter collision 36. m. v C m, 2v L/6| L/6i "co 0 Applying conservation of angular
momentum about CM ofthe system which is CM ofth e rod just after collision ^ fL
l - m v f L m2v ~ UJ 3v 4L 2mL 12 m 2 UJ FLL +M J co n & Bansal Classes PHYSICS [
27]
Applying conservation of angular momentum about CM ofthe system just after colli
sion and a the time when insects are at distance x from centre r v 2mL + mx +mx
, co 12 7 2mL2 j co = dx 12 2co L L + 2x" 0 de= - + 2x 2 L a ) d t 6 2 L cd / ^
Jf d e =9V Jr L/6 2 q l 2 +x \ ' co LVn 0 r 9v tan" V 3 - t a n V3 0 1 -1 co L7r
71 9V3v ~ 12V3 0 r a d i a n A n s " ] 37. (a) Mg (R sin 60) = x = la v^J / N .'
. a M ^ (R sin 60) v^ j - m R + 'm R 2 _ r 2 2
a = gV3 4R a (b) and N A VP v gV3 4R R= y Nj = 1 cos 60 = ~ ~ 4 mg sm 60 - N =m a
. y 2 2 Na\ A a /'60( 2 \\ aA \ A = = mg + N, cos 60 + N cos 30 2 8 T" mg 21 N, '6
0 30 hor = Nj sin 60 - N sin 30 _ mgV3 2 kN, 16 ] mg
"hor ^Bansal Classes PHYSICS [28]
38. Time taken by A to reach to B t, = 1/4 now velocity of B will be 4 m/s time
take n by B to oscillate = n T I C t =n V I6n' 4tc 4 time taken by A to go back
to le ft wall is = 1/4 t^ 2 2 1 total time period of this oscillatory system = t
, +1 +1, = + 39. v m< | tan0 + , rolling will not occus mg(sin0~pcos0) m pmgR co
s 9 pg cos 9 Also a mR R If t is the time to complete on e revolution 1 , 2 Dist
ance travelled by centre 1 27ta _ 27tR(sin9-pcos9) _ 2TI(5-V3) xat = a pcos0 V3
2 at = 2p 2 mg _ mg 0 \ 40,(a) Initial acceleration = - - = g/5 (b) At the insta
nt when spri ng makes an angle 9 with vertical m/4 x = L tan9 mg xLtan0 g j m + i
jv 4 2V 4 J W = work done by spring force - - change in spring energy mgLt an _ m
gLtan -k[Lsec0-L] =5- m v " 1, , -> 2 4 2 8 xLtan0 + W = s rT T 2 Bansal Classes
PHYSICS
(c) 41. For v = 0 x = V3L V3mgL_J_ 2 4 2 k = V3mg 2L v I kL => 9 = 60 Zm JU | a =
2m/s 0 2 w.r.t. h lift to acceleration of coin, a' = g - a = 8 m/s u = 3 m/s u,
maximum h eight, H' = ^ = 0.56 m < 1 m 2a' so, it cannot touch the roof of lift.
Now, let t is time taken to reach the floor 0 rd 2 s 0 0 2 0 2 42. -l=3t --~(8)
t On solving, t = 1 sec w.r.t. ground Initial velocity, v = 8 m/s v Maximum heig
ht, H = = 3.2 m Time taken for upward motion, t, = v /g = 0.8 s Time taken for d
ownward motion, t = 1 - 0.8 sec = 0.2 Distance travelled during down ward motion
= (l/2)g * (0.2) = 0.2 m Total distance travelled = 3.2 + 0.2 = 3.4 m Displacem
ent till that time = 8(1) - (l/2)g x (l) = 3 m ] 1 Point source - sph erical wav
efront => I o c ~ j I, = 41 0 2 ff 2 2 2 L = 10 log ~~ = 30 10 10 (1) 10 i0 41 L
j = 10 log ^" = 10[log 4] + L = 20 log 2 + 30 36 dB sound will= be inaudible if
I I from (1) I= 1000I I d ~ = 1~0 0 0~ d ( 2 0 ) I d = 2007l0 m ] 2 0 G 2 2 1 W
U 2 2 & Bansal Classes PHYSICS [30]
43. 40 / m = f + u 40+ (-30) m = v/u v = -120 cm v 64 cm/s 2 cm 2 cm 4 cm/s i =m
v , 2 0< Vj = 1 6 x 4 = 64 cm/s Generaly equation for y-component of velocity o
f image A_l- v u / 1 1 1 v - 3 0 +40 120 40 / = 40 cm / = 60 cm 1 1 40 30 v = -12
0 y yi 0 / / + x 0 o' x m y f f + x Oj s dyu dt (/ +x ) 0 y0f U 2 _ x x y of =" m
Two discs Aand B touch each other as infigure.Arope tightly wound on A is p ull
ed down at 2 m/s . Find the friction force between A and B if slipping i s ab se
nt 2 R 2R1 2kg J 2 m/s lkg 2 Q.16 Two masses each of m are attached at mid point
B & end point C of massless rod AC which is hinged at A. It is releasedfromhori
zontal position as shown. Fin d the force at hinge Awhen rod becomes vertical Q.
17 An isosceles right triangul ar plate ABC of mass m is free to rotate in verti
cal plane about afixedhorizonta l axis through A. It is supported by a string su
ch that the side AB is horizonta l. Find the reaction at the support A. .18. A s
olid uniform sphere of radius R and mass M rolls without slipping with angula r
velocity o when it encounters a step of height 0.4 R. Find the angular velocit y
immediately after inelastic impact with the rough step. 0 11! I 11111 i 111!! 1
11111 Q . 19 A spool with a thread wound on it is placed on a smooth inclined pl
ane se t at an angle of 3 0 to the horizontal. Thefreeofthe thread is attached to
the wa ll as shown. The mass of the spool is m - 200 g, its moment of inertia r
elative to its own axis is I 0.45 gm , the radius of the wound thread layer is r
= 3 cm. Find the acceleration ofthe spool axis. 2 Auniform rod AB of length L a
nd mass m is suspendedfreelyat Aand hangs verticall y at rest when a particle of
same mass m isfiredhorizontally with speed v to str ike the rod at its mid poin
t. Ifthe particle is brought to rest after the impact . Thenfindthe impulsive re
action at A. Q.21 A ball of mass 0.1 kg rotates in a h orizontal circle of radiu
s lm at constant speed 1 ms on africtionlesstable as sh own in thefigure.The bal
l is attached to a string which passes through a hole in the table. By pulling t
he string at the lower end, the radius of the path is re duced to 0.5 m.Find the
new velocity of the ball and tension in the string.
-1 1111111111 m m B "2!_W ^Bansal Classes Rotation al Dyn amies [3]
Q.26 A solid sphere of mass m and radius R is placed on a smooth horizontal ace.
A sudden blow is given horizontally to the sphere at a height h = 4R/5 e the ce
ntre line. If I is the impulse ofthe blow then find (a) the minimum after which
the highest point B will touch the ground (b) the displacement e centre of mass
during this internal. q
surf abov time ofth
Q.34 A uniform ball ofradius R rolls without slipping between two rails such tha
t the horizontal distance is d between two contact points of the rail to the ba
l l. If R=10cm, d=T6cm and the angular velocity is 5rad/s then find the velocity
o f centre of mass ofthe ball. f^\co P-fr A cylinder of mass M and radius R is
res ting on a horizontal platform (which is parallel to the x-y plane) with its
axis fixed along the y axis and free to rotate about its axis . The platform is
give n a motion in the x-direction given by x = A cos (cot). There is no slippin
g bet ween the cylinder and platform. Find the maximum torque acting on the cyli
nder d uring its motion. Infigure,the load W weighs 200N, 0-37 and the beam has n
egligib le weight. Find the tension T in the cable and the horizontal and vertic
al compo nents ofthe force that the pivot exerts on the beam. The door ofan auto
mobile is open and perpendicular to the body. The automobile starts with an acce
leration of 2 ft/sec , and the width of the door is 30 inches. Treat the door as
a unifor m rectangle, and neglect friction tofindthe speed of its outside edge
as seen by the driver when the door closes. 2 f 2 (22t> A 5m beam weighing 250 k
g is lowered by means of two cables unwindingfromo verhead cranes, as the beam a
pproaches the ground the crane operater begins appl ying brakes to slow the unwi
nding motion. Knowing that the decelearation of cabl e Ais 6 m/s and the deceler
ation of cable B is 0.6 m/s , determine the tension i n each cable. (g=9.8m/s )
2 2 2 TA 1 5m c A 20 kg cabinet is mounted on small casters that allow it to mov
e freely (p = 0) on the floor. If a 100 N force is applied as shown, determine t
he acceleration of the cabinet, the range of values of h for which the cabinet w
ill not tip. One end of a uniform rod ofmass M and length L is hinged to the cei
ling such that i t can rotate freely about, the hinge in vertical plane. The arr
angement is shown in thefigure.Aball ofmass m moving horizontally with speed u h
its the rod at po int P separated by a distance x from hinge. For what value ofx
reaction of the h inge on the rod is minimum and what is it ? nunnffrm C 0.6m i
ii /1 II II i ^Bansal Classes
Rotation al Dyn amies [5]
Q.l (a) (b) Q.2 A uniform plate ofmass m is suspended in each of the ways shown.
For each case d etermine immediately after the connection at B has been release
d; the angular ac celeration ofthe plate, the acceleration of its mass center. E
XER CISE-II Pin support /\LLL1 l BlTT i -e (0 ('/T )c V i 3 wires "ft springs- c (
ii) (iii) (a) (b) (0 A horizontally oriented uniform disc of mass M and radius R
rotatesfreelyabout a stationary vertical axis passing through its centre. The d
isc has a radial guid e along which can slide withoutfrictiona small body of mas
s m. Alight thread run ning down through the hollow axle of the disc is tied to
the body. Initially the body was located at the edge of the disc and the whole s
ystem is rotated with a n angular velocity co . Then by means of a force F appli
ed to the lower end of t he thread the body was slowly pulled to the rotation ax
is. Find the angular velo city of the system in itsfinalstate the work performed
by the force F. A uniform thin rod of mass m=30kg and length L=0.80m is free to
rotate about a horizontal axis 0 passing through its centre. A particle P of ma
ss M=11.2kg falls vertical ly through a height h=36/245m and collides elasticall
y with the rod at a distanc e ofL/4 from 0. At the instant of collision, the rod
was stationary and was at a ngle a=37 with horizontal. Calculate co of the rod j
ust after collision velocity (magnitude and direction) of particle P after colli
sion [g=l Om/s ] o 2 (a) (b) Q.5 (QJ5
(a) (b) (Bansal Classes Rotational Dynamics [6]
Q.9y A bar of mass m is held as shown between 4 disks, each of mass m' & radius
r = 75 mm Determine the acceleration of the bar immediately after it has been re
leased from rest, knowing that the normal forces exerted on the disks are suffi
c ient to prevent any slipping and assuming that; (a) m = 5 kg and m' = 2 kg . (
b) the mass m' ofthe disks is negligible. (c) the mass m of the bar is negligibl
e. HH HH HG)y y y | A B (ii) Q.10 Three small balls of the same mass, white (w),
green(g) and blue(b), arefix edby weightless rods at the vertices of the equila
teral triangle with side I. Th e system ofball is placed on a smooth horizontal
surface and set in rotation abo ut the center of mass with period T. At a certai
n instant, the blue ball tears a way from theframe.Determine the distance L betw
een the blue and the green ball a fter the time T. Q.ll Show that, if a uniform
heavy right circular cylinder of r adius a be rotated about its axis, and laid g
ently on two rough horizontal rails at the same level and distant 2a sina apart
so that the axis of the cylinder is parallel to the rails, the cylinder will rem
ain in contact with both rails if t he coefficient of friction p < tan a, but wi
ll initially rise on one rail if p > tana. () ( 2a sina Q.12 A diwali cracker kn
own as sudarashan chakra works on the principle of thrus t. Consider such a toy
the centre ofwhich is hinged.The initial mass ofthe toy i s M and radius is R. T
he toy is in the shape of a spiral the turns ofwhich are v ery close (it can be
assumed as a disc ).The gases are ejected tangentially from the end ofthe toy wi
th a constant velocity u relative to the toy. Find the angu lar velocity ofthe t
oy when mass remains half. ///////////////////// '?fi 6> Q.1 3 A uniform rod is
suspended by two light strings. The left string makes an angl e 29 and the rod m
akes angle9 with the horizontal Find the angular acceleration ofrod and tension
in the left string just after the right string is cut. Q.14 A uniform thin rod w
ith a mass M = 0.60 kg and a length of 0.3 0 m stands on the e dge of africtionl
esstable as shown in thefigure.The rod is struck , a horizontal impulse blow at
a point 0.20 m above the table top, driving the rod directly of fthe table. Dete
rmine the orientation of the rod and the position of its C.M. Is after the blow
is struck. (g = 9.8 m/s ) 2 l=6Ns 0.3m 0.2m A Q.15 A uniform slender bar AB of m
ass m is suspendedfromtwo springs as shown. If spring 2 breaks, determine at tha
t instant; (a) the angular acceleration of the bar, (b) the acceleration ofpoint
A. (c) the acceleration ofpoint B. A !-L/3 L/3 - * - L / 3 (ii) ^Bansal Classes
Rotation al Dyn amies [7]
r Q. 16 Disk B has a mass m = 4 kg, a radius r = 90 mm and an initial angular ve
lo city co =750 r/min clockwise. Disk Ahas a mass m = 6 kg a radius r = 13 5 mm
and is at rest when it is brought into contact with disk B. Neglecting friction
in the bearings, determine, thefinalangular velocity of each disk. Q.17 A unifor
m r od AB, of mass 4kg and length L = 1.5 m is released from rest in the positio
n sh own. Knowing that p = 45, determine the values ^rL inclined (immedi ately af
ter r elease) of fixed plane 1111! I (a) the angular acceleration of the rod. (b
) the acceleration of end A. (c) the reaction of the inclined plane at A. Neglec
t the mass offriction on the roller at A. Q.18 Three particles A B, C of mass m
each a re joined to each other by massless rigid rods to form an equilateral tri
angle o f side a. Another particle of mass m hits B with a velocity v directed a
long BC as shown. The colliding particle stops immediately after impact. Calcula
te the t ime required by the triangle ABC to complete 0) mv half-revolution in i
ts subseq uent motion. What is the net displacement ofpoint B during this interv
al ? LL^Jl A slender bar AB is supported in a horizontal position as infigure.At
what dist ance xfromthe hinge A should the vertical string DE be attached to th
e bar in or der "Xgz that, when it is cut, there will be no immediate change in
the reaction at A. x D B Q.20 A rod of length R and mass M is free to rotate about
a horizontal axis passing through hinge P as in figure . First it is taken aside
such that i t M P m becomes horizontal and then released. At the lowest point t
he rod hits t he block B of mass m and stops. Find the ratio of masses such that
the block B c ompletes the circle. Neglect any friction. Q.21 A uniform rod of
mass M is poise d vertically on one ofits end resting on a horizontal rough surf
ace. Ifthe rod i s given a very slight impulse at its free end, it starts toppli
ng down about its lower end which does not slip find (a) the normal reaction by
the floor on the rod when the rod turned through an angle 9=53 (b) the static fri
ction between the floorand the rod. Q.22 A uniform rod oflength 2a is placed hor
izontally on afixe dthin horizontal rail atrightangles to the rail and is releas
edfromrest. Initial ly the centre of the rod was at a distance a/3 from rail. If
the rod slips after it has turned through an angle 9findthe coefficient offrict
ionbetween the rod a nd the rail. B B 0 A A Q 0 ////// Q.23 Auniform rod AB is b
ent in the shape of an arc of circle. Determine the ang ular acceleration ofthe
rod immediately after it is releasedfromrest and show th at it is independent of
P. Q. 24 Assume that the centre of mass of a girl crouch ing in a light swing h
as b een raised to 1. 2m. The girl has her centre ofmass i s 3. 7mfromthe pivot
of the swing while she is in the crouched position. The swi ng is releasedfromre
st and at the bottom of the arc the girl stands up instantan eously, thus raisin
g her centre of mass 0.6m. Find the height of her centre ofma ss at the top ofth
e arc. ^Bansal Classes Rotational Dynamics fSJ
(Q.25 A uniform ball ofradius R rolls without slipping between two rails such th
at the horizontal distance is d between the two contact points ofthe rail to th
e ball, (a) Show that at any instant, velocity of centre of mass is given as : v
=Q>JR'Discuss the above expression in the limits d=0 and d=2R. (b) For a unifor
m ball starting from rest and 10gh decending a vertical distance h while rolling
without slipping down a ramp, v , ifthe ramp is cni replaced with two rails, sho
w that: v 10gh l-d /4R 2 2 Q.26 A plank of length 2L, leans vertically against a
wall. It starts to slip do wnward withoutfriction.Show that the top ofthe plank
loses contact with the wall when it is at two-thirds of its initial height /111
1 II ii /11111 Q.27 A solid metallic cylinder of mass m = 1 kg and radius R = 20
cm is free to roll (without sliding) over the inclined surface of a wooden wedg
e ofmass M = 0. 28 kg. Surface of wedge is inclined at 37 with the horizontal and
the wedge lies on a smooth horizontalfloor.When the system is releasedfromrest,
calculate TTTTT TTTT1 (i) acceleration ofthe wedge, (ii) angular acceleration o
f the cylinder an d (iii) force of interaction between cylinder and the wedge. (
g = 10 ms ) Q.28 A uniform slender bar AB of mass m is suspended as shown from a
small cart ofthe same mass m. Neglecting the effect offriction,determine the ac
celeration ofpoint s A and B immediately after a horizontal force 777777*777 77^
/7777 P has been ap plied at B. -2 Q.29 A solid spherical ball which rests in eq
uilibrium at the interior bottom of a fixed spherical globe is perfectly rough,
the ball is struck a horizontal blo w of such magnitude that the initial speed o
fits centre is v. Prove that, if v l ies between (10 dg/7) and (27 dg/7) , the b
all will leave the globe, d being the difference between the radii of the ball a
nd globe. 1/2 1/2 Q.30 A240 mm radius cylinder of mass 8 kg rests on a 3 kg carr
iage. The system i s at rest when a force P of magnitude 10 N is applied as show
n for 1.2 s. Knowin g that the cylinder rolls without sliding on the carriage an
d neglecting the mas s ofthe wheels of the carriage determine the resulting velo
city of (a) the carri age, (b) the center ofthe cylinder. FFL (V) ' f77777777777
777777777 ,, Ql ^Bansal Classes Rotation al Dyn amies [9]
EXERCISE-III Q.l A uniform thin rod of mass M and length L is standing verticall
y along the y -axis on a smooth horizontal surface with its lower end at the ori
gin (0,0). a s light disturbance at t=0 causes the lower end to slip on the smoo
th surface alon g the positive x axis and the rod starts falling (a) What is the
path followed b y the centre of mass of the rod during its fall (b) Find the eq
uation of traject ory of a point on the rod located at a distance r from the low
er end. What is th e shape the of the path of this point. [JEE 93] A block X of
mass 0. 5kg is held by a long massless string on africtionlessinclined plane of
inclination 3 0 to t he horizontal. The string is wound on a uniform solid cylind
rical drum Y ofmass 2kg and ofradius 0.2 m as shown in thefig.The drum is given
an initial angular v elocity such that the block X starts moving up the plane. F
ind the tension in th e string during the motion At a certain instant of time th
e magnitude ofthe angu lar velocity of Y is lOrad/sec. Calculate the distance tr
avelled by X from that instant of time until it comes to rest. [JEE' 94] Two uni
form thin rods A andB o flength 0.6m each and masses 00.01kg and 0.02kg respecti
ve arerigidlyjoined and to end. The combination is pivoted at the lighter end P
fp as shown infig.such t hat it canfreelyrotate about the point P in a vertical
plane. A small A object o f mass 0.05kg moving horizontally hits the lower end o
fthe combination and stick s to it. What should be the velocity of the object so
that the system could just be raised to the horizontal position. [JEE 94] Two p
oint masses of 0.3kg and 0. 7kg are fixed at the ends of a rod which is oflength
1.4m and of negligible mass . The rod is set rotating about an axis perpendicul
ar to its length with a unifo rm angular speed. The point on the rod through whi
ch the axis should pass in ord er that the work required for rotation of the rod
is minimum is located at a dis tance of [JEE' 95] (A) 0.42 from the mass of 0.3
kg (B) 0.70 m from the mass of 0 .7kg (C) 0.98m from the mass of 0.3kg (D) 0.98m
from % mass of 0.7kg Arectangula rrigidfixedblock has a long horizontal edge. A
solid homogeneous cylinder of radi us R is placed horizontally at rest with its
length parallel to the edge such th at the axis ofthe cylinder and the edge ofth
e block are in the same vertical pla ne as shwon infigure,there is sufficientfri
ctionpresent at the edge so that a ve ry small displacement cause the cylinder t
o roll of the edge without slipping. D etermine the angle 0 through which the cy
linder rotates before it leaves contact with the edge, the speed of the centre o
fmass of the cylinder before leaving co ntact with the edge, and the ratio of th
e translational to rotational kinetic en ergies of the cylinder when its centre
ofmass is in horizontal line with the edg e. [JEE' 95] A mass m moving with a co
nstant velocity along a line parallel to t he x axis, away from the origin. Its
angular momentum with respect to the origin . [JEE' 97] (A) is zero (B) remains
constant (C) goes on increasing (D) goes on decreasing A uniform disk of mass m
and radius R is rolling up a rough inclined plane which makes an angle of 3 0 wit
h the horizontal. If the coefficient of stat ic and kinetic friction are each eq
ual to p and the only forces acting are gravi tational andfrictional,then the ma
gnitude ofthefrictionalforce acting on the dis k is and its direction is (write
up or down) the inclined plane. [JEE 97] Q.2 (i) (ii) Q.3 Q.4 Q.5 (a) (b) (c) Q.
6 Q.7 ^Bansal Classes Rotation al Dyn amies [10]
Q.8 (i) (ii) Q.9 (a) (b) Q.10 Q.ll Q.12 Q.13 Q.14 Q 15 ^Bansal Classes A uniform
disk of mass m and radius R is proj ected horizontally with velocity v on a rou
gh horizontal floor so that it starts offwith a purely sliding motion a t t=0. A
fter t seconds it acquires a purely rolling motion as shown in figure. C alculat
e the velocity of the centre of mass ofthe disk at t . Assuming the coeff icient
offrictionto be p calculate t . Also calculate the work done by thefricti onalf
orce as a function of time and the total work done by it over a time t much long
er than t . [JEE' 97] Two thin circular disks of mass 2kg and radius 1 Ocm each
are joined by a rigid massless rod of length 20cm. The axis of the rod is a long
the perpendicular to the planes ofthe disks through their centre. The objec t i
s kept on a truck in such a way that the axis ofthe object is horizontal and per
pendicular to the direction ofmotion of the truck. Itsfrictionwith thefloorof th
e truck is large enough so that the obj ect can roll on the truck without slip p
ing. Take x-axis as the direction ofmotion ofthe truck and z -axis as the verti
cally upwards direction. Ifthe truck has an acceleration of 9m/ s calculate : th
e force offrictionon each disk ^ ^ The magnitude and the direction of the frict
i onal torque acting on each disk . ] L j about the centre of mass O ofthe object
. Express the torque in the vector form \ J V/ 20cm of unit vectors in the x-y a
nd z directions. [JEE' 97] A rod of weight w is supported by two parallel knife
ed ges A and B is in equilibrium in a horizontal position. The knives are at a d
ist ance dfromeach other. The centre of mass ofthe rod is at a distance x from A
. Th e normal reaction on A is and on B is [JEE' 97] A symmetric lamina of mass
M con sists of a square shape with a semicircular section over each of the edge
ofthe square as infig.The side ofthe square is 2a. The moment ofinertia ofthe la
mina a bout an axis through its centre ofmass and perpendicular to the plane is
1. 6Ma . The moment of inertia ofthe lamina about the tangent AB in the plane of
lamina is [JEE' 97] Let I be the moment ofinertia of a uniform square plate abou
t an ax is AB that passes through its centre and is parallel to two ofits sides.
CD is a line in the plane ofthe plate that passes through the centre ofthe plat
e and ma kes an angle 6 with AB. The moment ofinertia of the plate about the axi
s CD is t hen equal to (A) I (B) I sin 9 (C)Icos 9 (D) Icos (9/2) [JEE'98] The t
orque x on a body about a given point is found to be equal to AxL where A is a c
onstant ve ctor and L is the angular momentum of the body about that point. From
this it fo llows that [JEE' 98] (A) dL/dt is perpendicular to L at all instants
of time (B) the components of L in the direction of A does not change with time
(C) the mag nitude of L does not change with time (D) L does not change with ti
me A uniform circular disc has radius R and mass m. Aparticle also of mass m is
fixed at a po int A on the wedge of the disc as in fig. The disc can rotate free
ly about a fix ed horizontal chord PQ that is at a distance R/4 from the centre
C of the disc. The line AC is perpendicular to PQ. Initially the disc is held ve
rtical with the point A at its highest position. It is then allowed to fall so t
hat it starts r otating about PQ. Find the linear speed of the particle at it re
aches its lowest position. [JEE 98] A cubical block of side a is moving with vel
ocity v on a hor izontal smooth plane as shown. It hits a ridge at point O. The
angular speed of the M block after it hits 0 is: 0 7777777777/77777777777 (A) 3v
/4a (B) 3v/2a [JE E 99] (C) V3WV2a (D) zero 0 0 Q 0 0 2 2 2 2 2 1
Rotational Dynamics [11]
Q.26 A smooth sphere Ais moving on a frictionless horizontal plane with angular
speed co and centre of mass velocity v. It collides elastically and head on with
an identical sphere B at rest. Neglectfrictioneverywhere. After the collision,
their angularspeeds are and co , respectively. Then [JEE' 99] (D)m CO (A) co. <
co ( B K ox. (C) OX CO Q . 1 7 A disc of mass M and radius R is rolling with ang
ular speed w on a horizontal as shown. The magnitude of angular momentum of the
disc about the origin 0 is: [JEE' 99] (A) (l/2)MR co (B) MR (C) (3/2)MR co (D)2
M R Q . 1 8 A man pushes a cylinder of mass rrij with the help of a plank of mas
s m as shown. There is no slipping at any contact. The horizontal component of t
he force applied by the man is F. Find 7777777777777777777777 the accelerations
of the plank and the center of mass of the cylinder, and (a) [JEE 99] (b) the ma
gni tudes and directions offrictionalforces at contact points. Q . 1 9 A cubical
blo ck of side L rests on a rough horizontal surface with coefficient of fricti
on p. A horizontal force F is applied on the block as shown. Ifthe coefficient L
offr ictionissufficiently high so that the block does not slide before toppling
, the minimum force required to topple the block is: [JEE'(Scr)'2000] (A) infini
tesima l (B)mg/4 (C)mg/2 (D)mg(l-p) Q . 2 0 A thin wire oflength L and uniform l
inear m ass density p is bent into a circular loop with centre at O as shown. Th
e moment ofinertia of the loop about the axis XX' is: [JEE'(Scr)'2000] (A) pL /8
7t (B) L 716TX (C) 5 L /16TC (D)3 L /8TC Q . 2 1 An equilateral triangle ABC for
medfromau niform wire has two small identical beads initially located at AO. The
n, the bea ds are released from rest simultaneously and allowed to slide down, o
ne along AB and the other AC as shown. Neglectingfrictionaleffects, the quantiti
es that are conserved as the beads slide down, are: [JEE'(Scr)'2000] (A) angula
velocity an d total energty (kinetic and potential) (B) total angular momentum a
nd total ene rgy (C) angular velocity and moment ofinertia about the axis of rot
aiton. (D) to tal angular momentum and moment of inertia about the axis of rotat
ion. Q . 2 2 A rod AB of mass M and length L is lying on a horizontal frictionle
ss surface. A particle of mass m travelling along the surface hits the end 'A' o
f the rod with a velocity v in the direction perpendicular to AB. The collision
is completely elastic. After the collision the particle comes to rest. (a) Find
the ratio m/M. (b) Apoint P on the rod is at rest immediately after the collisio
n. Find the di stance AP. [JEE' 2000] (c) Find the linear speed of the point P a
t a time 7tL/(3 v ) after the collision. Q . 2 3 Aparticle is placed at a corner
P of a cube of side 1 meter. Forces of magnitudes 2,3, and 5 kg. wt. act on the
particle long t he diagonals ofthe faces passing through the point P. Find the
moment of these f orces about the corner opposite to P. [REE 2000] Q.24 One end
of a uniform rod o fmass M and length L is supported by afiictionlesshinge which
can withstand a te nsion of 1.75 Mg. The rod isfreeto rotate in a vertical plan
e. To what maximum a ngle should the rod be rotated from the vertical po sition
so that when left, th e hinge does not break. [REE 2000] Q . 2 5 Auniform rod AB
oflength 10 meters an d weight 6kg. wt. is resting with its end A on a smooth h
orizontal plane AD and end B on a smooth plane DB inclined at angle 60 with the h
orizontal. The rod is k ept in equilibrium by tying a string DP to a point P of
the rod. If the length o f the string is equal to AP and AD = BD,findthe tension
in the string. [REE'2000 ] A B E : 2 2 2 2 2 Wl/llk it
: 3 2 P 2 P 3 2 P 3 Q 0 ^Bansal Classes Rotation al Dyn amies [12]
Q.26 Two heavy metallic plates are joined together at 90 to each other. A laminar
sheet ofmass 30 Kg is hinged at the line AB joining the two heavy metallic plat
es. The hinges are frictionless. The moment ofinertia ofthe laminar sheet about
an axis parallel to AB and passing through its centre of mass is 1.2 Kg-m . Two
rubber obstacles P and Q arefixed,one on each metallic plate at a distance 0.5
m fromthe line AB. This distance is chosen so that the reaction due to the hinge
s on the laminar sheet is zero during the impact. Initially the laminar sheet hi
ts one ofthe obstacles with an angular velocity 1 rad/s and turns back. Ifthe im
pu lse on the sheet due to each obstacle is 6 N-s. (a) Find the location of the
cen tre ofmass ofthe laminar sheet from AB. (b) At what angular velocity does th
e la minar sheet come back after the first impact ? (c) After how many impacts,
does the laminar sheet come to rest ? [JEE 2001] Q.27 One quarter sector is cut
from a uniform circular disc of radius R. This sector csJ has mass M. It is made
to r otate about a line perpendicular to its plane and passing through the cent
re of the original disc. Its moment of inertia about the axis ofrotation is [JEE
(Scr)2 001 ] 2 (A) ^ M R 2 (B) - MR v 2 ' 4 (C)^MR 2 (D) V^MR 2 Q.28 Three parti
cles A, B and C, each of mass m, are connected to each other by three y* massles
s rigid rods to form a rigid, equilateral triangular body of sid e /. This body
is placed on a horizontal frictionless table (x-y plane) and is h inged to it at
the point A so that it can move withoutfrictionabout the vertical axis through
A (seefigure).The body is set into rotational motion on the table about Awith a
constant angular velocity co. Find the magnitude of the horizontal force exerted
by the hinge on the body. (a) (b) At time T, when the side BC is parallel to th
e x-axis, a force F is applied on B along BC (as shown). Obtain th e x-component
and the y-component ofthe force exterted by the hinge on the body, immediately
after time T. [JEE 2002] Q.29 A particle is moving in a horizontal uniform circu
lar motion. The angular momentum ofthe particle is conserved about the point: [J
EE(Scr)2003] (A) Centre of the circle (B) Outside the circle (C) In side the cir
cle (D) Point on circumference Q.30 Two particles each of mass M are connected b
y a massless rod oflength /. The rod is lying on the smooth sufrace. If one of t
he particle is given an impulse MV as shown in thefigurethen angular velocity of
the rod would be: [JEE(Scr)2003] (A) v// (B)2v// (C)v/2/ (D) None Mv M Q.31 A di
sc is rolling (without slipping) on a horizontal surface. C is its c enter and Q
and P are two points equidistant from C. Let V , V and V be the magn itude ofve
locities of points P, Q and C respectively, then * [JEE 2004 (Scr)] (A )V >V >V
(B)V <V <Vp 1 (D)V <V >V ( C ) v Vp,V : vwwwTwftuwuu Q.32 A child is st anding w
ith folded hands at the center of a platform rotating about its central axis. Th
e kinetic energy of the system is K. The child now stretches his arms so that th
e moment of inertia of the system doubles. The kinetic energy of the sys
tem now is [JEE 2004 (Scr)] p Q c Q c p Q c c c q c p (A) 2K (B)f (C)* (D)4K ^Ba
nsal Classes Rotation al Dyn amies [13]
Q. 3 3 Ablock ofmass m is heldfixedagainst a wall by a applying a horizontal for
ce F. Which ofthe following option is incorrect: (A)frictionforce = mg (B) F wi
l l not produce torque (C) normal will not produce torque (D) normal reaction =
F R Q. 34 A disc has mass 9m. A hole of radius is cut from it as shown in the fi
gu re. The moment ofinertia of remaining part about an axis passing through the
cen tre 'O' of the disc and perpendicular to the plane ofthe disc is: 40 37 (D)
mR ( A) 8 mR (B) 4 mR (C) mR [JEE'2005 (Scr)] Q. 3 5 A particle moves in circula
r pat h with decreasing speed. Which of the following is correct (A) L is consta
nt (B) only direction of L is constant (C) acceleration a is toward s the centre
(D) i t will move in a spiral and finally reach the centre [JEE'2005 (Scr)] 2 2
2 2 [JEE2005 (Scr)] Q. 36 A wooden log of mass M and length L is hinged by a fr
ictionless nail at O. A bullet ofmass m strikes with velocity v and sticks to it
. Find angular veloci ty of the system immediately after the collision about 0.
[JEE 2005] jj M m - -<^3 v Q. 3 7 A cylinder of mass m and radius R rolls down a
n inclined plane of inclina tion 9. Calculate the linear acceleration ofthe axis
of cylinder. [JEE 2005] Q. 3 8 Two identical ladders, each of mass M and length
L are resting on the rough horizontal surface as shown in thefigure.Ablock ofma
ss m hangsfromP. If the Syst em is in equilibrium,findthe magnitude and the dire
ction offrictionalforce atAan dB. [JEE 2005] ^Bansal Classes Rotation al Dyn ami
es [14]
ANSWER KEY EXER CISE-I 3 Q.l mu sin 0cos0 3 2 2 Q 2 [3 ^7 2 s h Q ' , ^ v /g 6 r
2 Q4 ^(A3 Q.8 4 h Q.5 m/s 5 Q.9 12x rQ.6 4F /M Q.7 Q.ll /3, mR / n Q.10 2mcoV 2 Q.
12 5V5 m/s Q. 15 2 N Q.19 1.4 ms" 2 Q.13 2hi 2 kg m /s, remains constant 28mg Q.
16 y y Q.17 2mg/3 mv Q.20 Q.21 4 Q.2 4 (aMgL/4 Q.25 a 15 , b 4 Q.28 7 = 77 ~ = T
Q 29 b 14 c 3 72 V 7T 24MV Q 31 (a) y y (b) y i , (c) uRm Q.33 ( a ) t = ; (, b
) s =71R 2 A B 1 571 Q.14 6 5co Q.18 - y A/3 * 1 2 ms" ,0.8 N Q.22 (-k) N-m Q.23
3- m 8 10 4tz y cm Q.26 Q.27 M(R +r )/2 J37 V37 5N Q.30 (a) a>/3, (b) -mcoR, (c)
3 mcoR 3 Q.32 a /b 2 2 2 2
Q.34 0.3m/s x y 2 Q.35 (l/2)MRAco Q.36 T=1000/3N, F = 800/3N, F = 0 Q.37 J \ 5 f
t/sec Q.38 T = 175 0 N ; T = 1525 N Q.39 (a) 5 m/s ->, (b) 0.3 < h< 1.5 m Q.40x
= 2L/3 EXER CISE-II Q.l Q.2 (i)(a) (cw)(b)- 03. (i + 2 j)g (ii)(a) 24g/17c(cw)(b)
12g/17l (iii)(a)2.4g/c(cw)(b )0.5gl f \ 1 f i\ co = ,1 + 2m co TTT t o R2 1 + 2m
Q.3 W=mco M/ M V ly 2 3 rad/s, 9/7 m/s along horizontal JfgR 150 , 44 x Q.6 Q.7 1.
018 W 2 Q.8 (a) m/s, (b) m Q.9 (i)(a) 5g/9 I ( b ) g i (c)0 (ii)(a) ^ I (b) gi (
c) I Q.10 - J 1 +V3 7t + 37 t 2 Q. 12 w= ^R- ( V 2 - l ) Q.13 T = 2mgsin0cos0/(l
+3sin 0 ), a = 6Tsin0/ml x 2 (^j^awsa/ Classes Rotational Dynamics [IS]
200 Q.14 [10,-4.75m]w.r.t.initialpositionoflowerendofrod, - j - rad with upward
vertical Q 1 r-\ Q.15 (i) (a) 3 g/L (cw) (b) [ f ?i _L ijjI rg == 11.323 crg /Z
d49.1 f (c ) + r ^.TX 0 (v'3 i - 2 jj g = 2.18g Z-66.6 2 2 0 (ii) (a) g/L (cw) (b
) - ( f ) g i (c) - ( f i + j) g = 1.323 g Z -130.9 Q.16 w = 200 rpm(ccw), w = 30
0rpm(cw) Q.17 8 rad/s , sV2 ^ s , 8^2 N A B 6an Q.18 (i) = - ^ ; ( i i ) t + + Q
.19 2//3 M r 4mg 3mg = Vl5 Q.21 - f , m 25 25 Q.22 2tan9 Q.23 g/2b Q.24 2.3 m Q.2
7 (i) 3.7 5 ms" , (ii) 30 rad sec" , (iii) Normal reaction=5.75 N, friction=3. O
ON Interac tion force = 6.49 N Q.28 (a)2P/5m=a ->,a =16P/5m-^ Q.30 (a) 0.706m/s>, (b) 1.23 5 m/s-> Q.20 2 2 A B EXERCISE-III C 1 y QI. x=0, + 2L i Q2. 1.63N,1.2
24m Q3. 6.3m/s [M-f ^ Q.4 C Q.5 (a) 0 = cos" (4/7) , (b) v = fi/TgR , (c) K / K
= 6 Q6.B Q.7 Mg sin 9/3, up ^ 2 2 = T R Q.8 (i)2v /3, (ii)t= v / 3 p g , W = ^ [
3 p m g t - 2 p m g t v ] (t < t ), W = - j m ^ | t > t ) 0 0 2 2 0 0 0 0 2 s Q
9. 6N,-0.6j0.6k Q10. w(d-x)/d, wx/d Q11.4.8Ma Q.12 A Q.13 A, B, C Q14. v=- /5gR Q
15.A Q16. C Q17. C 4F 8F SmjF mF ' c= ( 3 m j + 8 m ) ' p ( 3 m + 8 m ) i (3m +
8m ")' ^ (3m +8m ) Q19. C Q.20 D Q21. B m 1 2L v Q22. ( a ) ; ( b ) x - T 2 V ^
Q.23 -77 kgwtm Q.24 60 t Q 1 8 a 2 a = 1 2 ; f = t 2 = 1 2 0 ; ( c ) 3mg 4 Q27. A
Q.29 A Q.25 Q.34 B Q26. (a) 1 = 0.1m; (b) w' = 1 rad/s; (c) laminar sheet will
never come to rest Q
.28 (a) V^mo) /,(b)F = F/4, F = ^ m / Q.31 A Q.32 B Q.33 C Q.30 A 3mv 2g sin 9 Q
.35 B -(3m M)L Q" axis2 x 2 Q 3 6 ffl + 37a 3 Q.38 f = (M+m) g cot0 Bansal Clas
ses Rotational Dynamics [16]
Q.22 A particle ofmass 0.1 kg is projected with a velocity 7l0 m/s making an ang
le of30 with the horizontal in the xy plane. Find the moment of the weight of th
particle about the point of projection when it is at one fourth of its range.
solid cylinder is released from rest from the top of an inclined plane of incl
nation 60 where friction 2-3x coefficient varies with distance x as p = Find th
distance travelled by the cylinder on incline before it starts slipping. Q. 24
A uniform rod placed on a horizontal floor and imparted an angular velocity abo
ut a vertical axis passing through its mid point. The mass of the rod is M, leng
th L and friction coefficient with the surface is p. Then, find the total retard
in g torque offrictionforces. Q. 2 5 Four point masses 2 kg, 4 kg, 6 kg & 8 kg a
re placed at four corners of a square of side 10 cm. Find the radius ofgyration
of system about an axis passing through centre O and perpendicular to square pla
ne. J5". 26 Two men, each of mass 75 kg, stand on the rim of a horizontal large
dis c, diametrically opposite to each other. The disc has a mass 450 kg and isfr
eeto rotate about its axis. Each man simultaneously start along the rim clockwis
e wi th the same speed and reaches their original starting points on the disc. F
ind t he angle turned through by the disc with respect to the ground. Q. 27 Find
the m oment of inertia of a disc ofuniform thickness of mass M and internal and
extern al radii r and R respectively about an axis through it centre perpendicu
lar to t he plane of the disc. Q. 28 A solid sphere of radius 3R, a solid disc o
fradius 2 R and a ring of radius R (all are of mass m) roll down a rough incline
d plane. T heir acclerations are a, b and c respectively. Find the ratio of a/b
and b/c. Q. 29 A uniform disc ofradius 1 m and mass 2kg is mounted on an axle su
pported on fixedfrictionlessbearings. A light cord is wrapped around the rim of
the disc an d a mass of 1kg is tied to the free end. If it is releasedfromrest,
then find th e tension in the cord. , Q 30 A uniform disc of mass M and radius R
rotates abou t afixedvertical axis passing through its centre with angular velo
city co. A par ticle of same mass m and having velocity 2CDR towards centre of t
he disc collide s with the disc moving horizontally and sticks to its rim. Find
the angular velo city ofthe disc, the impulse on the particle due to disc, the i
mpulse on the dis c due to hinge. Arod AC of length L and mass m is kept on a ho
rizontal smooth pl ane. It isfreeto rotate and move. A particle of same mass m m
oving with velocity v strikes rod at point B whichis at a distance L/4frommid po
int making angle 37 with the rod. The collision is elastic. After collision find
B c the angular vel ocity ofthe rod. *7/4 the distance which centre of the rod w
ill travel in the ti me in which it makes halfrotation. the impulse ofthe impact
force. A (a) (b) (c) Q. 3 2 A person pulls along a rope wound up around a pulle
y with a constant forc e F for a time interval of t seconds. If a and b are the
radii ofthe inner and t he outer circumference (a < b), thenfindthe ratio ofwork
done by the person in t he two cases shown in the figure is W /W . ] 2 Case I C
ase II ^Bansal Classes Rotation al Dyn amies [14]
BANSAL CLASSES TARGET IIT JEE 2007 XI(P,Q,R,S) r IIT-JEE ^S SCREENING 2007 ROTAT
IONAL DYNAMICS Time Limit: 3 Sitting Each of 90 minutes, duration approx. QUESTI
ON BANK ON
There are 82 questions in this question bank. Objective Question Bank On Rotatio
nal Dynamics Q. 1 Three bodies have equal masses m. B ody A is solid cylinder of
radius R, bo dy B has a square lamina of side R, and body C has a solid spherte
of radius R. Which body has the smallest moment of inertia about an axis passin
g through thei r centre of mass and perpendicular to the plane (in case of lamin
a) (A) A (B)B ( C)C (D) A and C both Q.2 A point mass m is connected to a point
mass m by a mass less rod oflength / as shown in thefigure.It is observed that t
he ratio ofthe mo ment ofinertia ofthe system about the two axes BB and AA which
is parallel to ea ch other and perpendicular to the -4> m Igg ! ! rod is 7 =3.
The distance of the centre of mass of the systemfromthe mass A is A B B l Q.3 Q4
Q.5 Q.6 Q.7 Q.8 (C) (1/2) I (D)(l/4)/ A horizontal force F = mg/3 is applied on
the upper surfac e of a uniform cube of mass'm' and side' a' which is resting o
n a rough horizont al surface having p = 1/2. The distance between lines of acti
on of 'mg' and norm al reaction 'N' is: (A) a/2 (B) a/3 (C)a/4 (D)None For the s
ame total mass which of the following will have the largest moment of inertia ab
out an axis passing through its centre of mass and perpendicular to the plane of
the body (A) a disc of radius a (B) a ring of radius a (C) a square lamina of s
e
A
i
e
ide 2a (D) four rods forming a square of side 2a A straight rod oflength L is re
leased on africtionl esshorizontalfloorin a vertical position. As it falls + sli
ps, the distance of a point on the rodfromthe lower end, which follows a quarter
circular locus is (A ) L/2 (B) L/4 (C) L/8 (D) None A block of mass m is attach
ed to a pulley disc of equal mass m, radius r by means of a slack string as show
n. The pulley is hinge d about its centre on a horizontal table and the block is
projected with an init ial velocity of 5 m/s. Its velocity when the string beco
mes taut will be (A) 3 m /s (B) 2.5 m/s (C) 5/3 m/s (D) 10/3 m/s Find the moment
of inertia of a plate cu t in shape of a right angled triangle of mass M, side
AC = BC = a about an axis perpendicular to the plane of the plate and passing th
rough the mid point of sid e AB 2Ma' Ma^ Ma Ma" (A) 12 (D) (B) (C) s (A) (3/4)/
AA (B) (2/3) / A B A man can move on a plank supported symmetrically as shown. T
he A variation of n ormal reaction on support A with distance x of the man from
the end of the plank is best represented by: lm N N N N (C) (B) (A) CD) B 4m lm
feBansal Classes Objective Question Bank On Rotational Dynamics [10]
Q.9 A uniform rod of mass m and length / hinged at its end is released from rest
whe n it is in the horizontal position. The normal reaction at the hinge when t
he ro d becomes vertical is : Mg 3Mg 5Mg (D) 2 Mg (A) (C) (B) Q.10 Two particles
of mass m each arefixedat the opposite ends of a massless rod oflength 5m which
is oriented vertically on a smooth horizontal surface and rel eased. Find the d
isplacement of the lower mass on the ground when the rod makes an angle of 3 7 wi
th the vertical. (A) 1.5 m (B)2m (C)2.5m (D)3.5m Q.ll A small b ead of mass m mo
ving with velocity v gets threaded on a stationary semicircular ring of mass m a
nd radius R kept on a horizontal table. Theringcanfreelyrotate a bout its centre
. The bead comes to rest relative to the ring. What will be thefi nalangular vel
ocity ofthe system? (A) v/R (B) 2v/R (C) v/2R (D) 3v/R Q.12 A sphe re ofmass m i
s held between two smooth inclined walls. The normal reaction ofthe wall 2 is eq
ual to (A)mg (B) mg sin 74 (C) mg cos 74 (D) None Q.13 ABCD is a squa re plate wit
h centre 0. The moments of inertia ofthe plate about the perpendicul ar axis thr
ough O is I and about the axes 1, 2, 3 & 4 are I,, I ,1 & I respectiv ely. It fo
llows that: (A) I = I, (B) I = Ij +1 (C) I = I + I (D) !^ 2 3 4 2 4 2 4 1 \ Q.14
A body weighs 6 gms when placed in one pan and 24 gms when placed on the ot her
pan ofa false balance. Ifthe beam is horizontal when both the pans are empty ,
the true weight of the body is : (A) 13 gm (B) 12 gm (C)15.5gm (D)15gm Q.15 A pa
rticle startsfromthe point (Om, 8m) and moves with uniform velocity of 3 m/s 3 i
m/s. After 5 seconds, the angular velocity ofthe particle about the origin T SM
will be: II a (B) - rad/s ( D ) - rad/s (A) 2.89 rad/s ( O H rad/ s /\ / \ Q.16
Ahinged construction consists of three rhombs with the ratio of sides 5:3:2 . V
ertex A moves in the horizontal direction at a velocity v. Velocity of A, is 3 (
A) 2.5 V (ofv (B) 1.5 V (D) 0.8 V Q.17 A block of mass m moves on a horizontal r
ough surface with initial velocity v. The height ofthe centre of mass of the blo
ck is h from the surface. Consider a point A on the surface. (A) angular momentu
m about Ais mvh initially (B) the velocity of the block decreases at time passes
. (C) torque of the forces acting on block is zero about A (D) angular mometum i
s not conserved about A. ^Bansal Classes Objective Question Bank On Rotational D
ynamics [3]
Q.18 A rod ofweight w is supported by two parallel knife edges A and B and is in
equilibrium in a horizontal position. The knives are at a distance dfromeach ot
her. The centre of mass ofthe rod is at a distance x from A. wx w(d-x) (A) the
n ormal reaction at Ais y (B) the normal reaction at Ais ~ wx (C) the normal rea
ct ion at B is . w(d-x) (D) the normal reaction at B is Q. 19 Two spheres are ro
lling with same velocity (for their C, M.) their ratio o f kinetic energy is 2 :
1 & radius ratio is 2 : 1, their mass ratio will be : (A) 2: 1 (B) 4 : 1 (C) 8 :
1 (D) 2^2 : 1 Q. 20 Three identical thin rods each of ma ss m & length / are pl
aced along x, y & z-axis respectively they are placed such that, one end of each
rod is at origin 'O'. Then moment of inertia of this syst em about z-axis is ^
(C) m/ (D) mf 3 4 Q.21 Twoidentical circular loops are moving with same kinetic e
nergy one rolls & other slides. Theratioof their speed is: (A) 2 : 3 (B) 2 : V 2
(C) 4 l : 2 (D) V5 : yfl Q.22 A paritcle falls freely near the surface of the e
arth. Consider afixedpoint O (not vertically below the particle) on the ground.
(A) Angular momentum of the particle about O is increasing. (B) Torque of the g
ravitational force on the particle about O is decreasing. (C) The moment of iner
tia of the particle about O is decreasing. (D) The angular velocity of the part
i cle about O is increasing. Q.23 A yo-yo is resting on a rough horizontal table
. Forces F F and'F areapplied separately as shown. The correct statement is (A)
wh en F is applied the centre of mass will move to the right. (B) when F is appl
ied the centre of mass will move to the left. (C) when F, is applied the centre
of mass will move to the right. nnililTiiinn (D) when F is applied the centre of
ma ss will move to the right. Q.24 Ablock with a square base measuring axa and
heig ht h, is placed on an inclined plane. The coefficient of friction is m. The
angl e of inclination (9) ofthe plane is gradually increased. The block will a
a (A) topple before sliding if p > (B) topple before sliding if p < a a (C) slide
befor e toppling if p > n (D) slide before toppling if p < n Q. 25 Inner and ou
ter rad ii of a spool are r and R respectively. A thread is wound over its inner
surface and placed over a rough horizontal surface. Thread is pulled by a force
F as sh own infig.then in case of pure rolling (A) Thread unwinds, spool rotate
s anticlo ckwise and friction act leftwards (B) Thread winds, spool rotates cloc
kwise andf rictionacts leftwards (C) Thread winds, spool moves to therightand fr
iction act rightwards (D) Thread winds, spool moves to the right andfrictiondoes
not come i nto existence. _ (B) mf (A) 3 2mf 2 l5 2 3 3 2 2 feBansal Classes Obj
ective Question Bank On Rotational Dynamics [10]
Q.26 Adiscof circumference s is at rest at a point A on a horizontal surface whe
n a constant horizontal force begins to act on its centre. Between A and B ther
e is sufficient friction to prevent slipping, and the surface is smooth to ( . )
, the right of B. AB = s. The disc movesfromA to B in time T. To the right ofB,
(A) the angular acceleration ofthe disc will disappear, linear acceleration wil
l remain unchanged (B) linear acceleration ofthe disc will increase (C) the disc
will make one rotation in time T/2 (D) the disc will cover a distance greater t
h an s in further time T. rorcc Q.27 A weightless rod is acted on by upward para
llel forces of 2N and 4N ends A and B respectively. The total length ofthe rod A
B = 3 m. To keep the rod in equi librium a force of 6N should act in the followi
ng manner: (A) Downwards at any p oint between Aand B. (B) Downwards at mid poin
t ofAB. (C) Downwards at a point C such that AC = lm. (D) Downwards at a point D
such that BD = lm. Q.28 Awheel of radiusr rolling on a straight line, the veloc
ity ofits centre being v. At a cert ain instant thepoint of contact of the wheel
with the grounds is M and N is the highest point on the wheel (diametrically op
posite to M). The incorrect statemen t is: (A) The velocity of any point P of th
e wheel is proportional to MP. (B) Po ints ofthe wheel moving with velocity grea
ter than v form a larger area ofthe wh eel than points moving with velocity less
than v. (C) The point of contact M is instantaneously at rest. (D) The velociti
es of any two parts of the wheel which are equidistant from centre are equal. Q.
29 A small object is attached to a ligh t string which passes through a hollow t
ube. The tube is held by one hand and th e string by the other. The object is st
et into rotation in a circle of radius r, . The string is then pulled down, shor
tening the radius of the circle to r . The ratio of the new kinetic energy to or
iginal kinetic energy is 2 (A) ~O 1 (B) 1 (C) 1 f \ 2 r Q.30 Consider a sphere o
f mass'm' radius'R' doing pure rolling motion on a rough surface having velocity
v as shown in the Fig. It makes an elastic impact with the smooth wall and move
s back and starts pure rolling after some time again. (A ) Change in angular mom
entum about 'O' in the entire motion equals 2mv R in magn itude. (B) Moment of i
mpulse provided by the wall during impact about O equals 2 mv Rin magnitude. 3_
(C) Final velocity of ball will be v 0 0 0 0 \hj (D) h \
2 V ri J (D) Final velocity of ball will be - v 3 0 Q.31 Two rods of equal mass
m and length / lie along the x axis and y axis with their centres origin. What i
sthemoment f inertia of both about the line x=y: feBansal Classes (A) 3 W w Objec
tive Question Bank On Rotational Dynamics (B)4 W ( C 12^ ) ( D )6I ^ [10]
Q.32 A plank with a uniform sphere placed on it, rests on a smooth horizontal pl
ane. Plank is pulled to right by a constant force F. If the sphere does not sli
p over the plank. (A) acceleration of centre of sphere is less than that of the
p lank //11111111111 nm (B) acceleration of centre of sphere is greater than the
p lank because friction acts rightward on the sphere (C) acceleration ofthe cen
tre of sphere may be towards left. (D) acceleration of the centre of sphere rela
tiv e to plank may be greater than that ofthe plank relative to floor. Q.33 A ho
llow sphere of radius R and mass M isfollyfilledwith water ofmass m. It is rolle
d do wn a horizontal plane such that its centre of mass moves with a velocity v.
If i t purely rolls Orl (A) Kinetic energy of the sphere is mv v\ M 4 (B) Kinet
ic ene rgy of the sphere is mv 2 2 2 (C) Angular momentum of the sphere about af
ixedpoint on ground is mvR 14 (D) Ang ular momentum of the sphere about afixedpo
int on ground is mvR Q.34 Portion AB o f the wedge shown in figure is rough and
BC is smooth. A solid cylinder rolls wi thout slipping from Ato B. The ratio of
translational kinetic energy to rotation al kinetic energy, when the cylinder re
aches point C is : (A) 3/4 (B) 5 (C) 7/5 (D) 8/3 - AB=BC Q.3 5 Two equal masses
each of mass M are joined by a massless r od oflength L. Now an impulse MV is gi
ven to the mass M making an angle of 30 wit h the length ofthe rod. The angular v
eloctiy ofthe rod just after imparting the impulse is M M 2v (B) ( A )L t MV v (
D) none of these. (C) 2L Q.36 A thin unifor m straight rod of mass 2 kg and leng
th 1 m isfreeto rotate about its upper w//// ///////, end when at rest. It recei
ves an impulsive blow of 10 Ns at its lowest point, normal to its length as show
n in figure, The kinetic energy of rod just a fter impact is IONS (A) 75 J (B) 1
00 J (C) 200 J (D)none Q.37 Aman, sittingfirml yover a rotating stool has his am
is streched. Ifhe folds his arms, the work done by the man is (A) zero (B) posit
ive (C) negative (D) may be positive or negativ e. Q.38 A disc of radius r is ro
tating about its centre with an angular speed co . It is gently placed on a roug
h horizontal surface. After what time it will be in pure rolling ? co r 3Qr o (D)
2 Mg mti/Wmmi (C) Mg (A) 2,ug (B) 3pg D V 0 n 0 feBansal Classes Objective Quest
ion Bank On Rotational Dynamics [10]
Q.39 A 5 m long pole of 3 kg mass is placed against a smooth vertical well as sh
own in thefigure.Under equilibrium condition, ifthe pole makes an angle of 37 wi
t h the horizontal, thefrictionalforce between the pole and horizontal surface i
s (A) 20 N (B) 30 N (C) 20 pN (D) 30 pN n=o 5m ''iiimiiniiiiunuhiiwuiiniiiui 37/V
* H* 0 Q.40 Two points of a rigid body are moving as shown. The angular velocit
y ofthe body is: o o 2o 2u (B) R (A) 2R (D) 3R Q. 41 A plank of mass M is placed
over sm ooth inclined plane and a sphere is also placed over the plank. Frictio
n is suff icient between sphere and plank. If plank and sphere are released from
rest, the frictionalforce on sphere is: (A) up the plane (B) down the plane (C)
horizontal (D) zero Q. 42 Two uniform rods of equal length but different masses
are rigidl y joined to form an L-shaped body, which is then pivoted as shown. I
f in equilib rium the body is in the shown configuration, ratio M/m will be: (A)
2 (B) 3 (C) V2 (D) V'3 A Q. 43 In thefigureshown, the plank is being pulled to
the right with a constant speed v. If the cylinder does not slip then: (A) the s
peed of the centre of mass ofthe cylinder is 2v. (B) the speed of the centre of
mass of the cylinder is ze ro. (C) the angular velocity of the cylinder is v/R.
(D) the angular velocity of the cylinder is zero. I ; I iI i I T Q. 44 A plank w
ith a uniform sphere placed on it rests on a smooth horizontal plane. Plank is p
ulled to right by a constan t force F. If sphere does not slip over the plank. W
hich of the following is inc orrect. (A) Acceleration of the centre of sphere is
less than that of the plank. (B) Work done by friction acting on the sphere is
equal to its total kinetic en ergy. I I ! ! i l l (C) Total kinetic energy of th
e system is equal to work done by the force F (D) None of the above Q.45 Moment
of inertia of a rectangular pl ate about an axis passing through P and P perpend
icular to the plate is I. Then moment ofPQR about an axis perpendicular to the p
lane of the plate: (A) about P = 1/2 (B) about R = I/2 s (C) about P > 1/2 (D) a
bout R > 1/2 Q. 46 A rod ofleng th / is given two velocities v, and v in opposit
e directions at its two ends at right angles to the length. The distance of the
instantaneous axis ofrotation fr om v, is: 2 (A) zero (B) v, + v 2 I ( C ) V, +
" vxl V(D)//2 feBansal Classes Objective Question Bank On Rotational Dynamics
[10]
Q.47 A ball of mass m moving with velocity v, collide with the wall elastically
as shown in thefigure.After impact the change in angular momentum about P is: (A
) 2 mvd (B) 2 mvd cosQ (C)2mv<isinG (D)zero Q.48 Auniform rod AB oflength L and
mass M is lying on a smooth table. A small particle of mass m strike the rod wi
t h a velocity v at point C at a distance x from the centre O. The particle come
s to rest after collision. The value ofx, so that point Aof the rod remains stst
io nary just after collision is: (A) L/3 (B) L/6 (C) L/4 (D)L/12 0 a i ni Jo T Q
.49 Two particles of equal mass m at A and B are connected by a rigid light rod
AB lying on a smooth horizontal table. An impulse J is applied at A in the plan
e ofthe table and perpendicular at AB. Then the velocity of particle at A is: J
2J (D) zero (B) m (C) m Q.50 A time varying force F = 2t is applied on a spool a
s shown infigure.The angular momentum ofthe spool at time t about bottommost po
i nt is: rt ( B ) <MlL t2 (C) (R + r)t (D) data is insufficient (A) ~FT 2 F=2t i
iiiinTnTfiiiiiiiin Q.51 A ring of mass m and radius R has three particles attach
ed to the ring as s hown in the figure. The centre of the ring has a speed v . T
he kinetic energy of the system is: (Slipping is absent) (A) 6 mvo (B) 12 mv (C)
4 mv (D) 8 mvo 0 2 2 /V ^V / 2m m m\ 1 1 l l l rx /v rv Q.52 A particle of mass
2 kg located at the position (i + j) m has a velocity 2 (+i - j + k) m/s. Its an
gular momentum about z-axis in kg-m /s is: (A) zero (B)+ 8 (C) 12 (D)-8 2 Q.53 T
he linear speed ofa uniform spherical shell after rolling down an inclined plane
ofvertical height h from rest, is: lOgh [4gh 6gh (A) (C) (B) \J 5 (P) /2g h Q.
54 Aright triangular plate ABC of mass m is free to rotate in the vertical plane
about afixedhorizontal axis through A. It is supported by a string such th at t
he A, sideAB is horizontal. The reaction at the support Ais: ^ mg mg 2mg (D) mg
(A) (B) (Q feBansal Classes Objective Question Bank On Rotational Dynamics [10]
Q. 5 5 A uniform sphere of radius R is placed on a rough horizontal surface and
given a linear velocity v angular velocity as shown. The sphere comes to rest af
ter moving some distance to the right. It follows that: a> (A)v = a R (B) 2 V = 5
R (C)5V = 2q R (D) 2 = CD R Q. 56 A particle is moving in a circular orbit of ra
d ius r, with an angular velocity co,. It jumps to another circular orbit of rad
iu s r and attains an angular velocity co . Ifr = 0.5 r, and assuming that no ex
ter nal torque is applied to the system, then the angular velocity , is given by
: ( D) 2 = , (A) 4 (C) , = 2 (B) co = 3 co 0 0 0 0 0 ; 0 0 0 0 V 2 2 ? 2 2 = Q.57 L
et Ij, I and I be the moment of inertia of a uniform square plate about ax es AO
C, xDx' and yBy' respectively as shown in the figure. The moments of inerti a of
the plate Ij: I :1 are in the ratio. 12 12 ]_ (B)l: 7 7 (A) 1: ~ : 7 2 3 2 3 7_
' 12 (D)1:7 : 7 Q.58 A solid uniform disk of mass m rolls without slipping down
afixedinclined p lane with an acceleration a. Thefrictionalforce on the disk du
e to surface of th e plane is : (A) 2 ma (B) 3/2 ma (C)ma (D) 1/2 ma Q.59 Aunifo
rm solid disc is ro lling on a horizontal surface. At a certain instant B is the
point of contact an d Ais at height 2Rfromground, where R is radius of disc. (A
) The magnitude ofthe angular momentum of the disc about B is thrice that about
A. (B) The angular mo mentum ofthe disc about Ais anticlockwise. (C) The angular
momentum ofthe disc a bout B is clockwise (D) The angular momentum of the disc
about Ais equal to that about B. Q.60 If a person sitting on a rotating stool wi
th his hands outstretch ed, suddenly lowers his hands, then his (A) Kinetic ener
gy will decrease (B) Mom ent of inertia will decrease (C) Angular momentum will
increase (D) Angular velo city will remain constant Q. 61 A man is sitting in a
smooth groove on a horizon tal circular table at the edge by holding a rope join
ed to the centre. The momen t of inertia oftable is I. Mass ofman = M. Man now p
ulls the rope so that he com es to the centre. The angular velocity of the table
: (A) must increase (B) may i ncrease (C) must decrease (D) may decrease Q. 62 A
sphere ofmass M and radius R
is attached by a light rod oflength 1 to a point P. The sphere rolls without sli
pping on a circular track as shown. It is releasedfromthe horizontal position,
t he angular momentum ofthe system about P when the rod becomes vertical is : (A
) M ^ y g / [/ + R] (C) m J j / J+-R 5 (B) M f f g ' /+R 5 (D) none of the above
feBansal Classes Objective Question Bank On Rotational Dynamics [10]
Q.63 In an experiment with a beam balance on unknown mass m is balanced by two k
nown mass m is balanced by two known masses of 16 kg and 4 kg as shown in figur
e . -H0 The value of the unknown mass m is (A) 10 kg (B) 6 kg 16kg 0 illillll)! 4
kg (C) 8 kg (D) 12 kg Q. 64 Athin uniform rod of mass M and length L has its mo
ment ofinertia I, about its perpendicular bisector. The rod is bend in the form
of a semicircular arc. Now its moment of" inertia through the centre ofthe semi
circular arc and perpen dicular to its plane is I . The ratio of I,: I will be _
_ _ _ _ (A) < 1 (B) > 1 (C)=l ~ (D) can't be said 2 2 Q.65 A body kept on a smo
oth horizontal surface is pulled by a constant horizont al force applied at the
top point of the body. If the body rolls purely on the s urface, its shape can b
e : (A) thin pipe (B) uniform cylinder (C) uniform sphere (D) thin spherical she
ll Q.66 A particle ofmass m is projected with a velocity u making an angle 45 wit
h the horizontal. The magnitude ofthe torque due to weigh t of the projectile, w
hen the particle is at its maximum height, about a point a t u a time ~ on the t
rajectory is : (A) mu 2 Q. 67 A rod is hinged at its centre and rotated by apply
ing a constant torque st arting from rest. The power developed by the external t
orque as a function of ti me is : ext ext 1 (B) -4 mu 2 (C) ~ mu 2 1 (D) - mu 2
ext ext (A) time (B) time
(C) time (D) time Q.68 The moment of inertia of semicircular plate of radius R a
nd mass M about ax is AA' in its plane passing through its centre is MR MR" cos
e MR' (c) MR' sin 9 (A) 2 (D) (B) 2 2 Q. 69 A pulley is hinged at the centre and
a massless thread is wrapped around i t. The thread is pulled with a constant f
orce F startingfromrest. As the time in creases, (A) its angular velocity increa
ses, but force on hinge remains constant (B) its angular velocity remains same,
but force on hinge increases (C) its ang ular velocity increases and force on hi
nge increases (D) its angular velocity re mains same and force on hinge is const
ant Q. 70 If a cylinder is rolling down th e incline with sliding. (A) after som
e time it may start pure rolling (B) after sometime it will start pure rolling (
C) it may be possible that it will never st art pure rolling (D) none of these &
A A' feBansal Classes Objective Question Bank On Rotational Dynamics [10]
Q.71 A horizontal force F = mg/3 is applied on the upper surface of a uniform cu
be of mass'm' and side' a' which is resting on a rough horizontal surface havin
g p = 1/2. The distance between lines of action of 'mg' and normal reaction 'N'
i s: (A) a/2 (B) a/3 (C)a/4 (D)None B Q.72 Auniform rod AB of length L and mass
M is lying on a smooth table. A small m C particle of mass m strike the rod with
a velocity v at point C a distance x from the centre 0. The particle comes to r
es t after collision. The value of x, so that O point A of the rod remains stati
ona ry just after collision, is : (A) L/3 (B) L/6 (C) L/4 (D)L/12 AU s 0 Q.73 Au
niform cube of side 'b' and mass M rest on a rough horizontal table. A ho rizont
al force F is applied normal to one of the face at a point, at a height 3b /4 ab
ove the base. What should be the coefficient of friction (p) between cube a nd t
able so that is will tip about an edge before it starts slipping? (A) p > (B )P>
J (C)p > (D) none 3b/4 ifniiiniiniiiiimi Q.74 A homogeneous cubical brick lies m
otionless on a rough inclined surface. Th e half of the brick which applies grea
ter pressure on the plane is : (A) left ha lf (B)righthalf (C) both applies equa
l pressure (D) the answer depend upon coeff icient of friction Q.75 A body weigh
s 6 gms when placed in one pan and 24 gms wh en placed on the other pan of a fal
se balance. Ifthe beam is horizontal when bot h the pans are empty, the true wei
ght ofthe body is: (A) 13 gm (B) 12 gm (C)15.5 gm (D)15gm Q.76 In the triangular
sheet given PQ = QR = /. IfM is the mass ofthe sheet. What is the moment of ine
rtial about PR Mr Mr Mf Ml2 (A) 24 (B) 12 (C) ( D) 18 Q.77 A slender uniform rod
of length is balanced vertically at a point P o n a horizontal surface having s
ome friction. Ifthe top of the rod is displaced s lightly to theright,the positi
on ofits centre of mass at the time when the rod b ecomes horizontal: (A) lies a
t some point to the right of P (B) lies at some poi nt to the left of P (C) must
be /2 to therightof P (D) lies at P Q.78 A solid sph ere with a velocity (of cen
tre of mass) v and angular velocity co is gently plac ed on a rough horizontal s
urface. Thefrictionalforce on the sphere: (A) must be forward (in direction ofv)
(B) must be backward (opposite to v) (C) cannot be ze ro (D) none of the above
Q.79 A ball is attached to an end of a light inextensib le string, the other end
ofwhich isfixedat the origin. The ball moves in vertica l x-y plane where x is
along horizontal and y along vertical. At the top ofits t rajectory, it's veloci
ty is *Js i m/s. The angular velocity vector when ball is at the bottom ofthe tr
ajectory is: [length of string = 0.5 m] (A) 10 k rad/s (B) V5 k rad/s (C) 5 j ra
d/s (D) - 10 k rad/s ^Bansal Classes Objective Question Bank On Rotational Dynam
ics [11]
Q. 80 Moment of inertia of a thin semicircular disc (mass=M & radius = R) about
an axis through point O and perpendicular to plane of disc, is given by: (A) 7 M
R 4 2 (B) -2 MR 2 (C) 7 MR 8 2 (D) MR 2 Q.81 Moment ofinertia of a semicircular
ring of radius R and mass M; about an ax is passing through A and perpendicular
to the plane of the paper is ^ 2 5 ( A ) j- M R (B)MR (C)71 MR (D) 2MR 2 2 2 2
Q. 82 Which ofthe following statements are correct. (A)frictionacting on a cylin
der without sliding on an inclined surface is always upward along the incline i
r respective of any external force acting on it. (B)frictionacting on a cylinder
w ithout sliding on an inclined surface is may be upward may be downwards depen
din g on the external force acting on it. (C)frictionacting on a cylinder rollin
g wi thout sliding may be zero depending on the external force acting on it. (D)
noth ing can be said exactly about it as it depends on thefrictioncoefficient o
n incl ined plane. A N S W E R K E Y Q.l Q.6 Q.ll Q.16 Q.21 Q.26 Q.31 Q.36 Q.41
Q.46 Q.51 Q.56 Q.61 Q.66 Q.71 Q.76 Q. 81 B D C D C B,C,D C A D B A A B C B B D Q
2 Q.7 Q.12 Q.17 Q.22 Q.27 Q.32 Q.37 Q.42 Q.47 Q.52 Q.57 Q.62 Q.67 Q.72 Q.77 Q.8
2 D B A A B, D A, C, D D A B D B D D D B B A B,C Q.3 Q.8 Q.13 Q.18 Q.23 Q.28 Q.3
3 Q.38 Q.43 Q.48 Q.53 Q.58 Q.63 Q.68 Q.73 Q.78 B B A, B, C, D B,C C D C B B, C B
C D C D A D Q.4 Q.9 Q.14 Q.19 Q.24 Q.29 Q.34 Q.39 Q.44 Q.49 Q.54 Q.59 Q.64 Q.69
Q.74 Q.79 D C B A A,D C B A D B B A B, C A A A D Q5 B Q.10 A Q.15 C Q.20 B Q.25
B Q.30 A, B, D Q.35 C Q.40 B Q.45 C Q.50 C Q.55 C Q.60 B Q 65 A Q.70 A, C Q.75
B Q.80 B feBansal Classes Objective Question Bank On Rotational Dynamics [10]
BANSAL CLASSES TARGET IIT JEE 2007 XI (P,Q,R,S & J) # SIMPLE HARMONIC MOTION CON
TENTS EXERCISE-I EXERCISE-II EXERCISE-III ANSWER KEY
Q.l Q.2 (a) (b) (c) Q.3 Q.4 Q.5 A body is in SHM with period T when oscillated f
rom a freely suspended spring. I f this spring is cut in two parts oflength rati
o 1 : 3 & again oscillated from t he two parts separately, thenfindthe periods a
re Tj & T, then T,/T The system sh own in the figure can move on a smooth surfac
e. The spring is initially compress ed by 6 cm and then released.Find k-800N/m 6
kg time period of sum amplitude of 3 kg block inininimm/ir maximum momentum of
6 kg block A body undergoing SHM abo ut the origin has its equation is given by
x = 0.2 cos 5rct. Find its average sp eed from t = 0 to t = 0.7 sec. A bead of m
ass m is fixed at the centre of the st ring oflength L fixed at both the ends in
a gravity free space. The tension in t he string is T. If the bead is displaced
slightly from it's position in a direct ion perpendicular to the string thenfin
dthe period of small oscillation about th e mean position. If velocity of a part
icle moving along a straight line changes sinusoidally with time as shown in the
given graph, its average velocity over ti me interval t=0 to t=2(2n -1) seconds
, n being any +ve integer, will be r 7777777 777 EXERCISE-I 4m/s - 4m/s /4s 8s Q
.6 Q.7 Q.8 Two blocks A (5kg) and B(2kg) attached to the ends of a spring consta
nt 1120N/m are placed on a smooth horizontal plane with the spring undeformed. S
imultaneous ly velocities of 3m/s and 1 Om/s along the line of the spring in the
same direct ion are imparted to A and B then 3m/s lOm/s find the maximum extens
ion ofthe spr ing, (a) (b) when does the first maximum compression occurs after
start. Q.10 A block of mass lOOgm attached to a spring of spring constant lOON/m
is lying on a frcitionless floor as shown. The block is moved to compress the s
pring by 10cm and then released. If the collisions with the wall infrontare elas
tic then find -mwmhu* wuuuwumvw the time period ofthe motion. Q.ll A particle is
performing SH M with accleration a = 8 71 - 4 7T X where x is coordinate of the
particle w.r.t . the origin.The parameters are in S.I. units. The particle is a
t rest at x = -2 at t=0. Find coordinate of the particle w.r.t. origin at any ti
me. 2 2 Q.9 a - a O -P Two particles Aand B execute SHM along the same line with
the same am plitude a, samefrequencyand same equilibrium position O. If the pha
se difference between them is <j) = 7 oin (0.9), then find the maximum distance
between the t wo. A block of mass 0.9 kg attached to a spring of force constant
K is lying on a frictionless floor as shown in the figure. The spring is compres
sed to 2 cm an d the block is at a distance \ j 4 l cmfromthe wall. When the blo
ck TOW is relea sed, it makes elastic collision with the wall and its period of
motion I* is 0.2 sec. Find the approximate value of K. The acceleration-displace
ment (a-x) graph of a particle executing simple harmonic motion is shown in the
oints distant one metrefromeach other. What will be the maximum velocity ofthe p
artic le? At the moment t = 0 a particle starts moving rectilinearly so that it'
s velo city varies as v 25cos7it cm/s where t is expressed in seconds. Find tlie
distan ce that this particle covers during t = 2.80 s after the start. One end
of an id eal spring isfixedto a wall at origin O and the axis of spring is paral
lel to xaxis. A block of mass m 1 kg is attached to free end of the spring and i
t is per forming SHM. Equation ofposition ofblock in coordinate system shown is
x =10 + 3 sinl Ot, t is in second and x in cm. Another block of mass M = 3kg, mo
ving towar ds the origin with velocity 3 Ocm/c collides with the block performin
g SHM at t 0 and gets struck to it, calculate : 1kg 3kg new amplitude of oscilla
tions, -MDM DMMW new equation for position of the combined body, loss of energy
during colli sion. Neglect friction. A mass M is in static equilibrium on a mass
less vertical spring as shown in the figure. A ball of mass m droppedfromcertain
height stick s to the mass M after colliding with it. The oscillations they per
form reach to height 'a' above the original level of scales & depth 'b' below it
. Find the con stant of force of the spring.; (b) Find the oscillation frequency
. What is the h eight above the initial levelfromwhich the mass m was dropped ?
Aparticle of mas s m moves on a horizontal smooth line AB oflength a such that w
hen particle is a t any general point P on the line two forces act on it. A forc
e mg(AP)/a towards A and another force 2mg(BP)/a towards B. Show that particle p
erforms SHM on the line when left from rest from mid-point of line AB. Find its
time period and am plitude. Find the minimum distance of the particle fj'oin B d
uring the motion. I fthe force acting towards A stops acting when the particle i
s nearest to B then find the velocity with which it crosses point B. //////////
The rod AB of mass M is attached as shown to a spring of constant K. A small blo
ck of mass m is plac ed on the rod at its free end A. n if end A is moved down t
hrough a small distan ce d and released, rm<< determine the period of vibration,
determine the largest allowable value of d ifthe block m is to remain at all tim
es in contact with the rod. Two blocks A(2kg) and B(3kg) rest up on a smooth hor
izontal surface are co nnected by a spring of stiffness 120 N/m. Initially the s
pring is undeformed. Ai s imparted a velocity of 2m/s along the line ofthe sprin
g 3ka 2m/s awayfromB. Fi nd the displacement ofAt seconds later. -3 : 1 I EXERCI
SE-II (i) (iii) Q.5 (a) (c) Q.6 Q.7 (a) (b) Q.8 ^Bansal Classes
Simple Harmonic Motion [4]
Q.9 (a) (b) (c) Q.10 (i) (ii) Q.ll Q.12 Q.13 Q.14 Being a punctual man, a lift o
perator hung an exact pendulum clock on the l ift wall to know the end ofthe wor
king day.Tlie lift moves with an upwards and d ownwards accelaration during the
same time (according to the stationary clock on the ground), the magnitudes ofth
e accelarations remain unchanged. Will the oper ator finish his working day in t
ime, or will he work more(less) than required Q. 15 Two elastic strings obeying
hooks law each ofunstretched length I, each has o ne end attached to a particle
ofmass m lying on smooth horizontal floor. The oth er ends ofthe string are atta
ched at points A & B which are at a distance 3 / ap art. Each would be doubled i
n length by a tension 2 mg. The particle is held at rest V2 + sm at A and then r
eleased. Show that after released that particle firs t reaches B at time Q.16 A
body A of mass m is connected to a light spring Sj of spring constant k. At the
right of A' there is a second light spring s, of spri ng constant 5 k and having
a massless vertical pan (P) attached to itsfreeend as shown in the figure. Dist
ance between the pan and the block when both the sprin gs are in the relaxed pos
ition is I. Body Ais moved by 3 / distance to left from the configuration of sta
tic equilibrium and then released. What is the period o f oscillation ofthe body
? What is the maximum force experienced by the body A ? Two identical balls A a
nd B each of mass 0.1 kg are attached to two identical ma ssless springs. The sp
ring mass system is constrained to move inside a rigid smo oth pipe in the form
ofa circle as in fig. The pipe is fixed in a horizontal pla ne. The centres ofth
e ball can move in a circle of radius 0.06m. Each spring has a natural length 0.
0671 m and force constant 0.1 N/m.Initially both the balls a re displaced by an
angle of 0 = 7t/6 radian with respect to diameter PQ ofthe ci rcle and released
from rest Calculate the frequency of oscillation ofthe ball B. What is the total
energy of the system. Find the speed of the ball A when A and B are at the two
ends of the diameter PQ. A rectangular tank having base 15cm x 20cm is filled wi
th water (p = 1000kg/m ) upto 20cm height. One end of an ideal spring of natural
length l = 20cm and force constant k=280N/m is fixed to the b ottom of a tank s
o that spring remains vertical. This system is in an elevator m oving downwards
with acceleration a = 2m/s . A cubical block of side / = 10cm an d mass m = 2kg
gently placed over the spring and 20c released gradually, (as sho wn) Calculate
compression of the spring in equilibrium position. Ifblock is slig htly down fro
m equilibrium position and released calculate the frequency ofits v ertical osci
llations. An ideal gas is enclosed in a vertical cylindrical contain er and supp
orts afreelymoving piston ofmass m. The piston and the cylinder have equal cross
-sectional area A, atmospheric pressure is P and when the piston is i n equilibr
ium position. Show that the piston executes SHM and find the frequency ofoscilla
tion (system is completely isolatedfromthe surrounding), y=Cp/Cv. Heig ht ofthe
gas in equilibrium position is h. Find the angular frequency of the sma ll oscil
lations of the cylinder of mass M containing water of mass m. The spring has a c
onstant K and cylinder executes pure rolling. What happens when the wate r in th
e cylinder freezes? A massless rod is hinged at O. A string carrying a ma ss m a
t one end is attached to point A on the rod so that OA = a. At another poi nt B
(OB= b) of the rod, a horizontal spring of force constant k is attached ^fl fraw
nmA as shown. Find the period of small vertical oscillations ofmass m around its
equilibrium position. What can be the maximum amplitude of its THrnr TtTTTV T o
scillation so that its motion may remain simple harmonic. 3 fl 2 0 flWTOfts
A TTH P S, I40000 0004SK | fe Bansal Classes Simple Harmonic Motion [5]
An object of mass 0.2 kg executes SHM along the x-axis with frequency of (25/TT)
HZ. At the point x = 0.04m the object has KE 0.5 J and PE 0.4 J. The amplitude
of oscillation is . [JEE' 94] Q.2 A body of mass 1 kg is suspended from a weight
less spring having force constant 600N/m. Another body of mass 0.5 kg moving ve
r tically upwards hits the suspended body with a velocity of 3.0m/s and get embe
dd ed in it. Find thefrequencyof oscillations and amplitude of motion. [REE' 94]
Q. 3 State whether true or false "Two simple harmonic motions are represented b
y t he equations x, = 5sin[2rct + tt/4] and x = 5 V2 (sin27it + cos27Tt) their a
mpli tudes are in the ratio 1 : 2" [REE' 96] Q.4 Ablock is kept on a horizontal
table . The table is undergoing simple harmonic motion offrequency3Hz in a horiz
ontal plane. The coefficient of staticfrictionbetween block and the table surfac
e is 0 .72. Find the maximum amplitude of the table at which the block does not
slip on the surface. [REE' 96] Q.5 A particle of mass m is executing oscillation
s about the origin on the x-axis. Its potential energy is V(x) = k|x| where k is
a posi tive constant. If the amplitude of oscillations is a, then its time peri
od T is (A) proportional to 1/Va (B) independent of a (C) proportional to Va (D)
proport ional to a [JEE' 98] Q.6 A particlefreeto move along the x-axis has pot
ential en ergy given by U(x) = k[ 1 -exp(-x )] for -oo < x < +oo, where k is a p
ositive co nstant of appropriate dimensions. Then (A) at point awayfromthe origi
n, the part icle is in unstable equilibrium. (B) for any finite nonzero value of
x, there is a force directed away from the origin. (C) if its total mechanical
energy is k/ 2, it has its minimum kinetic energy at the origin. (D) for small d
isplacementsf romx=0, the motion is simple harmonic. [JEE' 99] Q. 7 Three simple
harmonic moti ons in the same direction having the same amplitude a and same pe
riod are superp osed. If each differs in phasefromthe next by 45, then (A) the re
sultant amplitud e is (1+V2)a (B) the phase of the resultant motion relative to
the first is 90. ( C) the energy associated with the resulting motion is (3 + 2^2
) times the energy associated with a y single motion. (D) the resulting motion i
s not simple harmo nic. [JEE'99] Q.8 The period of oscillation of simple pendulu
m of length L suspe ndedfromthe roof of a vehicle which moves withoutfrictiondow
n an inclined plane of inclination a is given by [JEE' 2000] 2 3 3/2 2 Q. 1 EXER
CISE-III (A) 2 tygcosa ( B ) ygsma c J (C) 2n\ -g (D) \|gtana Q.9 A bob of mass
M is atta ched to the lower end of a vertical string of length L and cross sect
ional area A. The Young's modulus ofthe material ofthe string is Y. Ifthe bob ex
ecutes SHM in the vertical direction, find thefrequencyof these oscillations. [R
EE' 2000] Q .10 A particle executes simple harmonic motion between x = -A and x
= +A. The ti me taken for it to go from 0 to A/2 is T, and to go from A/2 to A i
. (A) 75 (B) 165 (C) 1 35 (D) 195 Find the ratio of time periods of two identical sp
rings if they arefirs tjoined in series & then in parallel & a mass m is suspend
ed from them: (A) 4 (B ) 2 (C)l (D)3 A simple harmonic motion having an amplitud
e A and time .period T is represented by the equation: y = 5 sin 7i(t + 4) m The
n the values ofA (in m) and T (in sec) are : (A) A= 5; T = 2 ( B ) A = 1 0 ; T =
1 (C)A=5;T=1 (D)A=10;T = 2 A particle is subjected to two mutually perpendicula
r simple harmonic motio ns such that its x and y coordinates are given by x = 2
sin cot ; y = 2 sin Vt + 4 J The path ofthe particle will be: (A) an ellipse (B)
a straight line (C) a pa rabola (D) a circle In an elevator, a spring clock ofti
me period T (mass attache d to a spring) and u pendulum clock oftime period T ar
e kept. If the elevator ac celerates upwards (A) T well as T increases (B) T rem
ain same, T increases (C) T remains same, T decreases (D) T as well as T decreas
es A man is swinging on a s wing made of 2 ropes of equal length L and in luiiii
iiiiiiiiiiiuiui direction pe rpendicular to the plane of paper. The time period
of the small oscillations abo ut the mean position is L\\ //L IT [V3L (B) 2TC 2g
(A) 271 s p s p s p s p s p (A) 45 (B) 90 (C) 135 (D)180 Q.3 Q.4 Q.5 Q.6 Q.7 (C) 2k
Q. 8 (D)7l Two bodies P & Q of equal mass are suspended from two separate massl
ess springs of force constants kj & kj respectively. If the maximum velocity of
them are equ al during their motion, the ratio of amplitude of P to Q is : k ki
(D) I*!. (B) k kT 2 ( C ) 2 <!Bansal Classes Question Bank On Simple Harmonic Mot
ion [5]
Q. 9 The magnitude ofthe force acting on a particle ofmass m during its motion i
n x-y plane according to the x = a sin cot, y = b cos cot, where a, b and co are
cons tants is (A)mco / +y (B)m^/ +y (C)mo(x + y ) (D) ma (x + y) Q.10 Speed v of
a par ticle moving along a straight line, when it is at a distance x from afixe
dpoint on the line is given by v = 108 - 9x (all quantities in S.I. unit). Then
(A) The motion is uniformly accelerated along the straight line (B) The magnitud
e of th e acceleration at a distance 3 cm from thefixedpoint is 0.27 m/s . (C) T
he motio n is simple harmonic about x = m. (D) The maximum displacementfromthefi
xedpoint is 4 cm. Q.ll A particle performing SHM is found at its equilibrium at
t = 1 sec . and it is found to have a speed of 0.25 m/s at t = 2 sec. If the per
iod of osc illationis 6 sec. Calculate amplitude of oscillation 2 A x 2 2 x 2 2
2 2 2 2 2 2 Q. 12 Q.13 Q. 14 Q.15 <A>im The displacement of a body executing SHM
is given by x=Asin(27tt + 7t/3). T he first timefromt = 0 when the velocity is m
aximum is (A) 0.33 sec (B) 0.16 sec (C) 0.25 sec (D) 0.5 sec The maximum acceler
ation of a particle in SHM is made two times keeping the maximum speed to be con
stant. It is possible when (A) ampl itude of oscillation is doubled whilefrequen
cyremains constant (B) amplitude is doubled whilefrequencyis halved (C) frequenc
y is doubled while amplitude is halv ed (D)frequencyis doubled while amplitude r
emains constant The potential energy of a simple harmonic oscillator of mass 2 k
g in its mean position is 5 J. If its total energy is 9J and its amplitude is 0.
01 m, its time period would be (A) 71 /10 sec (B) tt/20 sec (C) 7T/50 sec (D) u/
100 sec A 2 Kg block moving with 10 m/ s strikes a spring of constant n N/m atta
ched to 2 Kg block at rest kept on a sm ooth floor. The time for which rear movi
ng block remain in contact with spring w ill be 10m/s 1 2kg -ggflRRftfo-2kg (A) v
'2 sec (B) sec vrnmrUuuwwuuuuuvuu S 2 (C) 1 sec (D) ~ sec Q.16 In the above ques
tion, the velocity of the rear 2 kg block after its separa tesfromthe spring wil
l be : (A) 0 m/s (B) 5 m/s (C) 10 m/s (D) 7.5 m/s Q.17 Two particle execute SHM
with amplitude A and 2A and angular frequency and 2 respecti vely. At t = 0 they
starts with some initial phase difference. At t = 3 . They ar e in same phase. Th
ere initial phase difference is: (A)(B) (Q (D)TC Q.18 A plank with a small block
on top of it under going vertical SHM. Its period in 2 sec. T he minimum amplitu
de at which the block will separatefrompiston is: 10 20 71 (A) (B)(C)^ (D)t n 2
7 271 71 2tc 4TC <!Bansal Classes Question Bank On Simple Harmonic Motion [5]
Q.19 A particle starts oscillating simple harmonically from its equilibrium posi
tion then, the ratio of kinetic energy and potential energy of the particle at
t he time T/12 is: (T = time period) (A)2 : 1 (B)3 : 1 (C)4:l (D) 1 : 4 Q.20 Tim
e period of a particle executing SHM is 8 sec. At t = 0 it is at the mean positi
on . The ratio ofthe distance covered by the particle in the 1 st second to the
2nd second is: (A) (B)V2 (C)^ (D)V2 + 1 Q.21 Two particles are in SHM with same
ang ular frequency and amplitudes A and 2Arespectively along same straight line
with same mean position. They cross each other at position A/2 distance from mea
n po sition in opposite direction. The phase between them is: 571 _ (A) - s i n
-1 _ ( B ) n- s i n -1 ( C )5n- c o s -l y (D) 6 -cos -l T 4J V4y w Q. 22 A syst
em is oscillating with undamped simple harmonic motion. Then the (A) average tot
al en ergy per cycle of the motion is its maximum kinetic energy. 1 (B) average
total energy per cycle ofthe motion is y times its maximum kinetic energy. 1 (C)
root mean square velocity is times its maximum velocity (D) mean velocity is 1
/2 ofm aximum velocity. Q.23 A particle executing a simple harmonic motion ofper
iod 2s. When it is at its extreme displacement from its mean position, it receiv
es an a dditional energy equal to what it had in its mean position. Due to this,
in its subsequent motion, (A) its amplitude will change and become equal to 4 l
times i ts previous amplitude (B) its periodic time will become doubled i.e. 4s
(C) its potential energy will be decreased (D) it will continue to execute simp
le harmon ic motion of the same amplitude and period as before receiving the add
itional en ergy. Q. 24 The amplitude of the vibrating particle due to superposit
ion of two SHMs, Yj = sin ^co t + | and y = sin co t is : 71 7 2 (A) 1 (B) V2 (C
) V3 (D) 2 Q. 25 A particle of mass m performs SHM along a straig ht line with f
requency f and amplitude A. (A) The average kinetic energy of the particle2is ze
ro. (B) The average potential energy is m n2f A . (C) The frequenc y of ocillati
on of kinetic energy is 2f. (D) Velocity function leads acceleratio n by %/2. dy
Q. 26 The angularfrequencyofmotion whose equation is 4 + 9y = 0 is ( y = displac
ement and t = time) dt 9 4 3 2 (A)(B)(C)(D)Q. 27 The time taken by a particle pe
rforming SHM to pass from point A to B where its velocities are same is 2 second
s. After another 2 seconds it returns to B. The time period of oscill ation is (
in seconds) (A) 2 (B) 8 (C) 6 (D)4 2 <!Bansal Classes Question Bank On Simple Har
monic Motion [5]
Q.28 A block is placed on a horizontal plank. The plank is performing SHM along
a vertical line with amplitude of 40cm. The block just loses contact with the pl
ank when the plank is momentarily at rest. Then: (A) the period of its oscillat
i ons is 2TT/5 sec. (B) the block weighs on the plank double its weight, when th
e plank is at one ofthe positions ofmomentary rest. (C) the block weighs 1.5 tim
es its weight on the plank halfway down from the mean position. (D) the block we
ig hs its true weight on the plank, when velocity of the plank is maximum. Q.29
A l inear harmonic oscillator offorce constant 2 x 10 Nm and amplitude 0.01 m ha
s a total mechanical energy of 160 J. Its (A) maximum potential energy is 100 J
(B) maximum kinetic energy is 100 J (C) maximum p otential energy is 160 J (D) m
inim um potential energy is zero. Q.30 Abody executes SHM whose period is 16s. T
wo se conds after it passes the equilibrium position, its velocity is 1ms. The am
plitud e of SHM is (A) 6.3 m (B) 1.8 m (C)3.6m (D)2.4m Q.31 The displacement-tim
e graph of a p article executing SHM is shown. Which ofthe following statements
is/are true? (A) The velocity is maximum att = T/2 (B) The acceleration is maxim
um at t = T (C) The force is zero at t = 3T/4 (D) The potential energy equals th
e oscil lation energy at t = T/2. Q.32 The potential energy of a particle of mas
s 0.1 kg , moving along x-axis, is given by U = 5x(x-4) J where x is in metres.
It can be concluded that (A) the particle is acted upon by a constant force. (B)
the spee d of the particle is maximum at x = 2 m (C) the particle executes simp
le harmoni c motion (D) the period of oscillation of the particle is TC/5 S. Q.3
3 A mass of 0.2kg is attached to the lower end of a massless spring offorce-cons
tant 200 N/ m, the upper end ofwhich isfixedto a rigid support. Which ofthe foll
owing statem ents is/are true? (A) In equilibrium, the spring will be stretched
by 1cm. (B) I f the mass is raised till the spring is unstretched state and then
released, it will go down by 2cm before moving upwards. (C) The frequency of os
cillation will be nearly 5 Hz. (D) Ifthe system is taken to the moon, the freque
ncy of oscilla tion will be the same as on the earth. Q.34 Aparticle is executin
g SHM with ampl itude A time period T, maximum acceleration a and maximum veloci
ty v . Its start s from mean position at t=0 and at time t , it has the displace
ment A/2, acceler ation a and velocity v then (A) t=T/12 (B) a=a /2 (C)v=v /2 (D
)t=T/8 Q.35 Two bl ocks of masses 3 kg and 6 kg rest on a horizontal smooth surf
ace. The 3 kg block is attached to a spring with a force constant k = 900 Nm" wh
f motion for the block is fflf' sm co t. (D) The maximum speed of the block is v
. Q. 49 Two pendulums have time periods T and 5T/4, They start S HM at the same
timefromthe mean position. After how many oscillations of the sma ller pendulum
they will be again in the same phase: (A) 5 (B) 4 (C)ll (D)9 0 Q <!Bansal Classe
s Question Bank On Simple Harmonic Motion [5]
Q.50 In SHM, acceleration versus displacement (from mean position) graph: (A) is
always a straight line passing through origin and slope -1 (B) is always a stra
ight line passing through origin and slope+1 (C) is a straight line not necessa
r ily passing through origin (D) none of the above Q.51 Two simple harmonic moti
on s y j = A sin cot and y = A cos cot are superimposed on a particle ofmass m.
The total mechanical energy ofthe particle is: 2 ' (A) mco A 2 2 (B) mco A 2 0 2
(C)-mco A 2 2 (D)zero Q.52 A small ball of density p is released from rest from
the surface of a liqui d whose density varies with Po depth h as p = (a + J3h).
Mass of the ball is m. Select the most appropriate one option. (A) The particle
will execute SHM (B) Th e maximum speed ofthe ball is (C) Both (A) and (B) are
correct (D) Both (A) and (B) are wrong (Here a and (3 are positive constant of p
roper dimensions with a < 2) Q.53 The maximum acceleration of a particle in SHM
is made two times keeping the maximum speed to be constant. It is possible when:
(A) amplitude of oscilla tion is doubled whilefrequencyremains constant (B) amp
litude is doubled while fr equency is halved. (C)frequencyis doubled while ampli
tude is halved. (D) frequen cy of oscillation is doubled while amplitude remains
constant 2-q ANSWER KEY Q.l Q.5 Q.9 Q.13 Q.17 Q.21 Q.25 Q.29 Q.33 Q.37 Q.41 Q.4
5 Q.49 Q.53 C A A C B,C A B,C B,C A B, C, D C B C A C Q2 Q.6 Q.10 Q.14 Q.18 Q.22
Q.26 Q.30 Q.34 Q.38 Q.42 Q.46 Q.50 C B D A c . AB A B, C B A D Ac c c Q3 Q.7 Q.
ll Q.15 Q.19 Q.23 Q.27 Q.31 Q.35 Q.39 Q.43 Q.47 Q.51 B B A C B A B B, C, D AC B,
D D A B Q.4 Q.8 Q.12 Q.16 Q.20 Q.24 Q.28 Q.32 Q.36 Q.40 Q.44 Q.48 Q.52 A B A A D
C A B, C, D B, C, D A C B B A
<!Bansal Classes Question Bank On Simple Harmonic Motion [5]
BANSAL CLASSES TARGET IIT JEE 2007 XI (P, Q, R, S) UNITS & DIMENSIONS & BASIC MA
THEMATICS CONTENTS EXERCISE ANSWER KEY
EXERCISE Q.l " " Q.2 ' If force, acceleration and time are taken as fundamental
quantitie s, then the dimensions of length will be: (A) FT (B)F A T"' (C)FA T (U
f^T In a c ertain system ofunits, 1 unit oftime is 5 sec, 1 unit of mass is 20 k
g and unit oflength is 10 m. In this system, one unit ofpower will correspond to
2 -1 2 2 2 <A) 16 watts (B) ~ watts (C) 25 watts (D) none ofthese Q.3\l Three f
orces P, Q & R are acting at a point in the plane. The angle between P & Q and Q
& R are 150 & 120 respectively, then for equilibrium, forces P, Q & R are in the
ratio (A) 1 : 2 : 3 (B)l:2:& 0 (C) 3 :2 :1 0 (D) :2:1 Q.4 J The resultant of two
forces F, and F is P. If F is reversed, then resultan t is Q. Then the value of
(P + Q ) in terms of Fj and F is (A) 2(F, + F ) (B)F, + F (C)(F,+F ) (D) none o
f these Q.5 A man rows a boat with a speed of 18km/hr i n northwest direction. T
he shoreline makes an angle of 15 south ofwest. Obtain th e component ofthe veloc
ity of the boat along the shoreline. 2 2 2 2 2 2 2 2 2 2 2 (A)9km/hr Q.6 ( B ) 1
8 y km/hr M (C) 18cosl5km/hr (D) 18cos75km/hr A bird moves from point (1,-2,3) to
(4,2,3). If the speed of the bird is lOm/sec , then the velocity vector ofthe b
ird is: (A) 5 |-2j+3k) (B) 5 (4i+2j+3k) (C) 0. 6i+0.8j (D) 6i+8j -1 2 Q.7 ^ The
dimensions ML T" can correspond to : (A) moment of a force or torque ( B) surfac
e tension (C) pressure (D) co-efficient ofviscosity. (useful relation a re t = r
x F , S = F//, F = 6 n r) rv, where symbols have usual meaning) Q.8 The 10 N/m
of 10 dyne/cm N/m (A) pressure (B) 10 is equivalent to 10 N/m (C) 6 5 2 2 6 2 7
2 (D) 10 N/m 8 2 Q.9.J If area (A) velocity (v) and density (p) are base units,
then the dimensio nal formula of force can be represented as. (A)Avp (B)Av p (C)
Avp (D)A vp 2 2 2 Q.10 If the resultant of two forces of magnitudes P and Q acti
ng at a point at a n angle of 60 is V7Q, then P/Qis (A) 1 (B) 3 / 2 (C)2 (D)4 Q.l
l For a particle mo ving in a straight line, the position ofthe particle at time
(t) is given by x = t - 6t + 3t + 7 what is the velocity ofthe particle when it
's acceleration is z ero ? (A)-9 ms(B)-12 ms (C) 3 ms" (D)42ms3 2 1 -1 1 1
4Bansal Classes Unit & Dimensions & Basic Mathematics [4]
Q.12 If the angle between the unit vectors a and b is 60, then | a - b j is (A)0
(B)l (C)2 (D)4 Q. 1 I n a book, the answer for a particular question is expresse
s with vector A. Q.36 At timet the position vector ofa particle ofmassm = 3kg is
given by f = 6ti - t j + cost k-Find the 3 resultant force F (t), magnitude of
its acceleration when t = & speed when t = n . Q. 3 7 Given that the position ve
ctor of a particle moving in x-y plane is giv en by r = (t - 4 ) i + (t-4) j. Fi
nd (a) Equation of trajectory ofthe particle ( b) Time when it crosses x-axis an
d y-axis 2 n Q.38 The velocity time graph of a body moving in a straight line is
shown. Find its (a) instantaneous velocity at t - 1.5 sec. (b) average accelera
tion from t = 1.5 sec. to t = 2.5 sec. (c) draw its acceleration time graph from
t = 0 tot = 2 .5 sec x 2 | 2 2 5se T time in sec Q.3 9 The curvilinear motion of
a particle is defined by v =50-16t and y=100-4t , where v is in metres per seco
nd, y is in metres and t is in seconds. It is als o known that x=0 when t=0. Det
ermine the velocity (v) and acceleration(a) when t he position y=0 is reached. x
Q.40 The force acting on a body moving in a straight line is given by F=(3t 4t+1
) Newton where t is in sec. If mass ofthe body is 1kg and initially it was at re
s t at origin. Find (a) displacement between time t = 0 and t = 2 sec. (b) dista
nc e travelled between time t = 0 and t = 2 sec. 2 i fa Bansal Classes Unit & Di
mensions & Basic Mathematics [5]
ANSWER KEY EXERCISE # I Q.l Q.6 D D Q.2 Q.7 A C Q.3 Q.8 D A Q.4 Q.9 A B Q.5 A Q.
10 C Q.15 C Q.ll A Q.16 A Q.12 B Q.17 B 2 2 Q.13 C Q.18 B Q.14 D 7 2 Q.19 (a) 9.
95, (b) 0.99, (c) 4.986 Q.23 2 S Q.24 (a) 5i + 3j + 8k, (b) 2i + 16k, (c) 7^2 ,
(d) 2^65 Im Q.25 T= a J Q.26 (a) F- = 14 N, (b) F = - 6 i 3 2 Q.20 L-\ML T~ Q.21
ML~ T~ Q.22 0.14, 0.09 Q.27 a = - 7, b = -3, c = - 4 [GM' Q.28 o = l J ~ j p ,
v k 5 2 1/2 Q.29 F, (29-12^3 ) (-j) Q.30 ML T" K Q.31 co = ] Q.32 [M] = [h -c -G
~ ]; [L] = [ h - c ^ G " ] ; [T] = [h - G ] 1/2 1/2 ,/2 1/2 2 1/2 C 5/2 1/2 If Q
-33 5p j,4P i,6P i + 8P j, -12P i - 9P j, V20, tan [-2] with the +ve x axis -1
Q.34 (a) ISO, (b) 90 (c) 0 Q.36 -18t j-3cost k;3ji;3V4 4 + 7r Q.35 2^19 ^os" j j ^
1 Q.37 (a) y + 8y +12 = x ; (b) crosses x axis when t = 4 sec., crosses y axis w
he n t = + 2 sec. 2 1 V3 Q.38 (a) - = m / s , (b)-^--m/s ,( ) 2 C 1 tin sec 2 2.
5 Q.39 v = - 3 0 i - 4 0 j , a = - 1 6 i - 8 j Q.40 ( a ) 3 m , (b) t = 0, 1 <4.B
ansal Classes Unit & Dimensions & Basic Mathematics [61
BANSALCLASSES TARGETIIT JEE 2007 Mm IS (ALL) list OUESmm BANK ON w a
SHORT QUESTIONS Q.l Q.2 Q.3 QA Q.5 Q.6 Q. 7 Q.8 Q. 9 A person wets his eyeglass
to clean them. As the water evaporates he notices tha t tor a short time the gla
ss become markedly more non reflecting. Explain. A len s is coated to reduce ref
lection. What happens to the energy that had previously been reflected Is it abs
orbed by the coating? 9 If interference between light waves of different frequen
cies is possible, one sh ould observe light beats, just as one obtains sound bea
ts from two sources of so und with slightly differentfrequencies.Discuss how one
might experimentally look for this possibility. What is the shape of interferen
ce fringes as seen on a sc reen perpendicular to the line joining the sources in
Young's interference exper iment if the source are (a) pinholes, (b) slits? In
Young's double slit experime nt why must the slits be close and of same width? I
n Young's double slit experim ent why do we use monochromatic light ? Ifwhite li
ght is used, how would the pat tern change? Will interference be observed in You
ng's double-slit experiment ift he lightfroma source falls directly on the two s
lits? In what direction will the fringe system shift ifa glass plate is interpos
ed inthe path of one of the inte rfering beams? Suppose that a radio station bro
adcasts simultaneouslyfromtwo tra nsmitting antennas at two different locations.
Is it clear that your radio will have better reception with two transmitting an
tennas rather than one? Justify yo ur answer. feBansal Classes Question Bank On
Wave Optics [2]
ONLY ONE OPTION IS Take approx. 2 minutes for answering each question. CORRECT Q
. 1 Figure, shows wave fronts in still water, moving in tlie direction ofthe ar
row towards the interface PQ between a shallow region and a deep(denser) region.
Which of the lines shown may represent one of the wave fronts in the deep regio
n? (AJ1 (B) II (C) III Q.2 Q.3 Two coherent monochromatic light beams of intens
i ties 1 and 41 are superposed. The maximum and minimum possible intensities in
th e resulting beam are: (A) 51 and I (B) 51 and 31 (C) 91 and I (D) 91 and 31 T
wo point monochromatic and coherent sources oflight of wavelength 1 are placed o
n t he dotted line in front of an large screen. The source emit waves in phase w
ith each other. The distance between S, and S is'd' while their distancefromthe
scre en is much larger. Then, (1) If d = 1X12,O will be a minima r (2) -lfd = 4.3
X, th ere will be a total of 8 minima on y axis. _ ~ (3) -> If d = IX, O will be
a max ima. ' 2 5 (4) If d = X, there will be only one maxima on the screen. ^ Wh
ich is the set of correct statement: (A) 1, 2 & 3 (B) 2, 3 & 4 (C)l,2,3&4 (D)l,3
&4 2 y s s Q.4 Figure shown plane waves refracted for air to water using Huygen'
s principle a, b, c, d, e are lengths on the diagram. The refractive index of wa
ter wrt air is the ratio. (A) a/e (B) b/e (C) b/d (D)d/b Q.5 When light is refra
cted into a den ser medium, (A) its wavelength andfrequenyboth increases (B) its
wavelength incr ease but freqnency remains unchanged (C) its wavelength decreas
e butfreqnencyrem ains unchanged (D) its wavelength and freqnency both decrease.
Q. 6 Two point so urce separated by d = 5 pm emit light of wavelength X = 2 pm
in phase. Acircular wire of radius 20 pm is placed around the source as shown in
figure. (A) Point Aand B are dark and points C and D are bright. (B) Points Aan
d B are bright and point C and D are dark. (C) Points Aand C are dark and points
B and D are bright . (D) Points A and C are bright and points B and D are dark.
Q. 7 A fa Bansal Classes Plane microwavesfroma transmitter are directed normall
y towards a plane reflecto r. A detector moves along the normal to the reflector
. Between positions of 14 s uccessive maxima, the detector travels a distance 0.
13 m. If the velocity ofligh t is 3 * 10 m/s,findthe frequency of the transmitte
r. (A) 1.5 x 10 Hz (B) IO Hz (C)3*10 Hz (D)6xl0 Hz Two monochromatic (wavelength
= a/5) and coherent sources of electromagnetic waves are placed on the x-axis a
t the points (2a, 0) and (-a, 0). A detector moves in a circle of radius R(2a) wh
ose centre is at the origin. The number of maximas detected during one circular
revolution by the detector ar e (A) 60 ' (B) 15 . (C) 64 (D)None 8 ,0 10 lo 10 Q
uestion Bank On Wave Optics [91
Two coherent narrow slits emitting light of wavelength X in the same phase are p
laced parallel to each other at a small separation of 3X. The light is collecte
d on a screen S which is placed at a distance D ( X)fromthe slits. The smallest
d istance x such that the P is a mpama ,p (A)V3D ' (B)V8D D S,M WS (C)V5D (D)V5
r 3 t Q.10 Two coherent sources oflight are placed at points (- 5a , 0) and (+ 5
a 0). Wavelengtli of the light is , JL 4a X = . How many maximas will be obtained
on a CD planar circle of large radius with centre at origin. (A) 12 (B) 15 (C)
16 (D) 14 Q 11 In YDSE how many maxima can be obtained on the screen ifwavelengt
h ofli ght used is 200nm and d = 700 nm: ^ (A) 12 (B) 7 (C) 18 (D) none ofthese
Q.l? In a YDSE, the central brightfringecan be identified: (A) as it has greater
intens ity than the other bright fringes. (B) as it is wider than the other bri
ght frin ges. (C) as it is narrower than the other bright fringes. (D) by using
white lig ht instead ofsingle wavelength light. Q. 13 In Young's double slit exp
eriment, t he wavelength of red light is 7800 A and that of blue light is 5200 A
. The value of n for which n bright band due to red light coincides with (n+1)*
bright band due to blue light, is: (A) 1 (B) 2 (C) 3 .(D) 4 A Q.14 If the Young'
s double slit experiment is performed with white light, then w hich ofthe follow
ing is not true. (A) the central maximum will be white (B) ther e will not be a
completely dark fringe (C) thefringenext to the central will be red (D) thefring
enext to the central will be violet Q.15 Imagine a Young's doubl e slit interfer
ence experiment performed with waves associated with fast moving electrons produ
cedfroman electron gun. The distance between successive maxima wi ll decrease ma
ximum if (A) the accelerating voltage in the electron gun is decre ased (B) the
accelerating voltage is increased and the distance of the screenfro mthe slits i
s decreased (C) the distance of the screenfromthe slits is increased . (D) the d
istance between the slits is decreased. Q.16 Two identical narrow sli ts S, and
S are illuminated by light of wavelength X from a point source P. 2 If, as shown
in the diagram above the light is then allowed tofellon a screen, a nd if n is
a positive integer, the condition for destructive interference at Q i s that (A)
(/, -1 ) = (2n + 1 )X/2 (B) (/ - / ) = (2n + 1 )X/2 (C) (/, + / ) - ( / + l ) =
nX . (D) (/, + / ) - (/ +1 ) = (2n + \)X/2 2 3 4 2 2 4 3 2 4 fa Bansal Classes
Question Bank On Wave Optics [91
In Young's double slit experiment, the two slits act as coherent sources of equa
l amplitude Aand wavelength X. In another experiment with the same setup the tw
o slits are sources of equal amplitude Aand wavelength X but are incoherent. The
ratio ofthe intensity oflight at the midpoint of the screen in thefirstcase to
t hat in the second case is (A) 1 : 1 (B) 2 : 1 (C) 4 : 1 (D) none ofthese Q.18
1 n a Young's double slit experiment, a small detector measures an intensity of
il lumination of I units at the centre ofthe fringe pattern. If one of the two (
ide ntical) slits is now covered, the measured intensity will be (A) 21 (B) I (C
)I/4 (D) 1/2 Q.19 A student is asked to measure the wavelength of monochromatic
ligh t. He sets up the apparatus sketched below. S S , S are narrow parallel sli
ts, L is a sodium lamp and M is a microscope eyepiece. The student fails to obse
rve i nterference fringes. Yourfirstadvice to him will be Q s, 5cm (A) increase
the wi dth ofS, (B) decrease the distance between S and S (C) replace L with a wh
ite lig ht source "tocm"' 60cm" (D) replace M with a telescope (E) make S and S
wider. v 2 3 3 2 3 T (M Q.20 Light of wavelength 520 nm passing through a double
slit, produces interfer ence pattern of relative intensity versus deflection an
gle 9 as shown in the fig ure. The separation d between the slits is (A) 2 x 10"
mm (B) 5 x 10" mm (C)4.5 x io- mm (D) 1.1 x 10- mm 2 2 2 2 e Q.21 In Young's do
uble slit experiment the slits are 0.5 mm apart and the interf erence is observe
d on a screen at a distance of 100 cm from the slit. It is foun d that the 9th b
rightfringeis at a distance of 7.5 mm from the second darkfringe fromthe centre
of thefringepattern. The wavelength ofthe light used is , 2500 . (A). A s (B), 2
500 A (C) 5000 A ( D )5000- A - ! 8 Q. 22 In a YDSE apparatus, two identical slit
s are separated by 1 mm and distanc e between slits and screen is 1 m. The wavel
ength oflight used is 6000 A. The mi nimum distance between two points on the sc
reen having 75% intensity of the maxi mum intensity is: (A) 0.45 mm (B) 0.40 mm
(C) 0.30 mm (D) 0.20 mm Q.23 In a youn g double slit experiment D equals the dis
tance of screen and d is the separation between the slit. The distance of the ne
arest point to-the central maximum wher e the intensity is same as that due to a
single slit, is equal to (A) DX DX (C) 3d Ul D^ (D) 2DX th Q.24 A beam oflight
consisting of two wavelength 6300 A and X A is used to obtai n interference frin
ges in a Young's double slit experiment. If 4 bright fringe o f6300 A coincides
with 5 darkfringeof X A, the value of X (in A) is (A) 5200 (B) 4800 (C) 6200 (D)
5600
fa Bansal Classes Question Bank On Wave Optics [91
Q.25 A beam oflight consisting of two wavelengths 6500A and 5200A is used to obt
ain interference fringes in Young's double slit experiment. The distance betwee
n slits is 2 mm and the distance of screen from slits is 120 cm. What is the lea
s t distancefromcentral maximum where the bright due to both wavelength coincide
? (A) 0.156 cm (B) 0.312 cm (C) 0.078 cm (D) 0.468 cm Q.26 In a two slit experim
en t with monochromatic light, fringes are obtained on a screen placed at some d
ist ancefromthe slits. If the screen is moved by 5 * 10 m towards the slits, the
cha nge infringewidth is 3 x 10~ m. If separation between the slits is 10~ m, t
he wa velength oflight used is: (A) 6000 A (B) 5000 A (C) 3000 A ' (D) 4500 A 2
5 3 Q.27 The ratio ofthe intensity at the centre of a bright fringe to the inten
sity at a point one-quarter ofthe fringwidthfromthe centre is (A) 2 (B) 1/2 (C)
4 (D ) 16 Q.28 InYDSE, letS, and S be the two slits, and C be the centre ofthe s
creen . IfG is the angle S,CS and X is the wavelength, thefringewidth will be: 2
2 (A)X (B)xe (O 2X (D) X Q.29 In a Young's Double slit experiment,firstmaxima is
observed at afixedpoint P on the screen. Now the screen is continuously moved a
wayfromthe plane of slits . The ratio of intensity at point P to the intensity a
t point O (centre of the s creen) (A) remains constant (B) keeps on decreasing .
o (C) first decreases and then increases (D) First decreases and then becomes c
onstant j p*"]" Q.30 In a d ouble slit experiment, the separation between the sl
its is d = 0.25 cm and the d istance ofthe screen D = 100 cm from the slits. If
the wavelength oflight used i s X = 6000A and I is the intensity of the central
brightfringe,the intensity at a distance x = 4 * 10~ mfromthe central maximum is
(A)I (B)I /2 (C)3I /4 (D)I /3 0 5 0 0 0 0 Q.31 A monochromatic light source ofw
avelength displaced at S. ThreeslitsS,, S a nd S are equidistant from the source
S and the point P on the screen. S, P - S P = X/6 and S, P - S P = 2X/3. If I b
e the intensity at P when only one slit is o pen, the intensity at P when all th
e three slits are open is s^ 2 3 2 3 ( A ) 31 (C) 81 (D) zero (B) 5 I '
the upper slits is c overed with a thin, perfectly transparent sheet of mica, th
e intensity at the ce ntre of screen reduces to 75% of the initial value. Second
minima is observed to be above this point and third maxima below it. Which ofth
e following can not be a possible value of phase difference caused by the mica s
heet K 1371 1 lTC 17tc (D) 3 (C) 3 (B) (A) 3 3 Q.47 The figure shows a transpare
nt slab oflength 1 m p laced in air whose refractive index in x direction varies
as |_i = 1 + x (0 < x < 1). The optical path length of ray R will be JL (A) 1 m
m (B) (C) 2 f 43Bansal Classes (C)|m (D) V2 m Q 48 Two monochromatic and cohere
nt point sources oflight are pla ced at a certain distancefromeach other in the
horizontal plane. The locus ofall those points in the horizontal plane which hav
e construct interference will be (A) a hyperbola (B) family of hyperbolas (C) fa
mily of straight lines "" (D) fam ily of parabolas trim X Question Bank On Wave
Optics
Q. 49 A thin slice is cut out of a glass cylinder along a plane parallel to its
axis. The slice is placed on a flat glass plate with the curved surface downward
s. Monochromatic light is incident normallyfromthe top. The observed interferen
c efringesfromthis combination do not follow one ofthe following statements. (A)
t he fringes are straight and parallel to the length ofthe piece. (B) the line
of contact ofthe cylindrical glass piece and the glass plate appears dark. (C) t
hef ringespacing increases as we go outwards. (D) thefringesare formed due to th
e in terference oflight rays reflected from the curved surface of the cylindrica
l pie ce and the top surface of the glass plate. Q. 50 A circular planar wire lo
op is dipped in a soap solution and after taking it out, held with its plane ver
tical in air. Assuming thickness of film at the top very small, as sunlight fall
s on t he soap film, & observer receive reflected light (A) the top portion appe
ars dar k while thefirstcolour to be observed as one moves down is red. (B) the
top port ion appears violet while thefirstcolour to be observed as one moves dow
n is indi go. (C) the top portion appears dark while thefirstcolour to be observ
ed as one move down is violet. (D) the top portion appears dark while the first
colour to be observed as one move down depends on the refractive index ofthe soa
p solution . ^ >? , , i^ i Q.51 A thinfilmofthickness t and index of refraction
1.33 coats a glass with index of refraction 1.50. What is > + k ' - > the least t
hickness t that will strongly reflect light with wavelength 600 nm incident norm
ally? 2 (A) 225 nm (B) 300 nm (C) 400 nm (D) 450 nm It is necessary to coat a gl
ass lens wi th a non-reflecting layer. Ifthe wavelength of the light in the coat
ing is X, th e best choice is a layer of material having an index ofrefraction b
etween those of glass and air and a thickness of ? 3 2 8 Q.53 Radio waves coming
at Z a to vertical are recieved by a radar after ref lection from a nearby wate
r surface & directly. What should be height of antenna from water surface so tha
t it records a maximum intensity, (wavelength = X). 2 cos a (C) 4 sin a 4 cos a
Q.54 In a biprism experiment the distance of source fr om biprism is 1 m and the
distance of screen from biprism is 4 metres. The angle of refraction of biprism
is 2 x 10 radians, p of biprism is 1.5 and the wavelen gth oflight used is 6000
A. How many fringes will be seen on the screen? (A) 4 (B ) 5 (C)3 (D)6 Q.55 In a
biprism experiment using sodiumfightX = 6000 A an interf erence pattern is obta
ined in which 20 fringes occupy 2 cm. On replacing sodium light by another sourc
e of wavelength X without making any other change 30 fring es occupy 2.7 cm on t
he screen. What is the value of X ? (A) 4500 A (B) 5400 A ( C) 5600 A (D) 4200 A
(D) 3 2 2 (B) (C) 3X (D)X X (B): 2sina X Q. 56 A parallel coherent beam oflight
falls on fresnel biprism of refractive in dex p and angle a. The fringe width o
n a screen at a distance Dfrombiprism will
be (wavelength = X) XD D (D)none (A) 2 ( P - I ) a (C) 2(p - l)a (B) 2(p-l)a fa
Bansal Classes Question Bank On Wave Optics [91
ONE OR MORE THAN ONE OPTION MAYBE Take approx. 3 minutes for answering each ques
tion. CORRECT Q.l To observe a stationary interference pattern formed by two li
ght waves, it is no t necessary that they must have: (A) the same frequency (B)
same amplitude (C) a constant phase difference (D) the same intensity A light of
wavelength 600nm in air enters a medium of refractive index 1.5. Inside the med
ium : (A) itsfrequen cyis 5 * 10 Hz ' (B) its frequency is 7.5 * 10 Hz (C) its w
avelength is 400nm (D ) its wavelength is 900nm 14 14 Q.2 Q. 3 \) Four monochrom
atic and coherent sources oflight, emitting waves in phase ofwavel ength A, are
placed at the points -x = 0, d, 2d and 3d on the x-axis. Then (A) po ints having
| x | d appear dark if d = A/4 (B) points having | x | d appear dark if d = A/8
points having | x | >> d appear maximum bright if d = X/4 (D) points having | xj
>>d appear maximum bright if d = A/8 In the above question, the inte nsity of th
e waves reaching a point P far away on the +x axisfromeach of the fou r sources
is almost the same, and equal to I . Then, Q (A) If d = X/4, the inten sity at P
is 4I . (B) If d = A/6, the intensity at P is 3I . (C)Ifd = A/2, the i ntensity
at Pis 31 . (D) none ofthese is true. 0 0 0 Q.4 Q. 5 Thefigureshows two points
source which emit light of wavelength A in phase with each other and are at a di
stance d = 5.5 A apart along a line which is perp endicular to a large screen at
a distance L from the centre of the source. Assum e that d is much less than L.
Which of the following statement is (are) correct? Screen (A) Onlyfivebright fr
inges appeajr on the screen (B) Only six brightfrin gesappear on the screen (0.0
) (C) Point y = 0 corresponds to bright fringe (D) P oint y = 0 corresponds to d
ark fringe. Q.6 White light is used to illuminate two slits in a YDSE. The separ
ation between the slits is d and the screen is at a d istance D (D d) from the s
lits. At a point on the screen directly infrontof one ofthe slits, which of the
following wavelengths are missing. (A) (B)^ (D)^ V D D /C/ 3D 3D In a YDSE appar
atus, we use white light then : (A) thefringenext to t he central will be red (B
) the centralfringewill be white. (C) the fringe next t o the central will be vi
olet (D) there will not be a completely dark fringe. w Q.7 Q.8 If the source ofl
ight used in a Young's Double Slit Experiment is changed from r ed to blue, then
(A) thefringeswill become brighter (B) consecutivefringeswill c ome closer (C)
the number of maxima formed on the screen increases (D) the centr al brightfring
ewill become a dark fringe. feBansal Classes Question Bank On Wave Optics [10]
Q.9 In a Young's double slit experiment, green light is incident on the two slit
s. T he interference pattern is observed on a screen. Which of the following cha
nges would cause the observed fringes to be more closely spaced? (A) Reducing th
e sep aration between the slits (B) Using blue light instead ofgreen light (C) U
sed re d light instead of green light (D) Moving the light source further away f
rom the slits. fringes incoming light waves $ < < Q. 10 In a Young's double-slit
experiment, let Aand B be the two slits. Athin fi lm ofthickness t and refracti
ve index p is placed in front ofA. Let P = fringe w idth. The central maximum wi
ll shift : (A) towards A ( C ) b y t ( p - l ) P (D) by p t P (B) towards B X Q.
ll In the previous question,filmsof thicknesses t and t and refractive indices p
and p , are placcd in front ofA and B respectively. If p t = p t , the centra l
maximum will: (A) not shifty (B) shift towards A (C) shift towards B (D) optio
n (B),ift >t ; option (C) if t < t A n A B A A B B B A B A Q.12 In a double slit
experiment, instead of taking slits of equal widths, one s lit is made twice as
wide as the other. Then in the interference pattern: (A) th e intensities of bo
th the maxima and minima increase. (B) the intensity ofthe ma xima increases and
the minima has zero intensity. (C) the intensity of the maxim a decreases and t
hat of minima increases. (D) the intensity of the maxima decrea ses and the mini
ma has zero intensity. Q. 13 In a YDSE, if the siits are of uneq ual width : (A)
fringes will not be formed (B) the positions of minimum intensit y will not be
completely dark (C) bright fringe will not be formed at the centre of the screen
. (D) distance between two consecutive bright fringes will not be equal to the d
istance between two consecutive dark fringes. Q.14 If one of the s lits of a sta
ndard YDSE apparatus is covered by a thin parallel sided glass slab so that it t
ransmit only one half ofthe light intensity of the other, then: (A) the fringe p
attern will get shifted towards the covered slit. (B) the fringe pa ttern will g
et shifted away from the covered slit. (C) the bright fringes will b e less brig
ht and the dark ones will be more bright. (D) the fringe width will r emain unch
anged. Q.15 To make the central fringe at the centre O, a mica sheet o f refract
ive index 1.5 is introduced. Choose the correct statements (s). < S, J (A) The t
hickness of sheet is 2(42 -1) d infront of Sj. d V M (B) The thickness of sheet
is 2 - l)d infront of S . (C) The thickness of sheet is 2 42 d infront of Sj. (D
) The thickness of sheet is (2^2-l)d infront of S,. 2 ST fa Bansal Classes Quest
ion Bank On Wave Optics [91
Q.16 Q.17 Q.18 Q.19 The figure shows a schematic diagram showing the arrangement
of Young's Double S lit Experiment ^ o; Screen Choose the correct statement(s)
related to the wavele ngth oflight used (A) Larger the wavelength oflight larger
the fringe width (B) The position of central maxima depends on the wavelength o
flight used (C) Ifwhit e light is used in YDSE, then the violet colour forms its
first maxima closest t o the central maxima (D) The central maxima of all the w
avelengths coincide I If the distance D is varied, then choose the correct state
ment(s) I (A) The angular fringe width does not change (B) The fringe width chan
ges in direct proportion ' (C) The change in fringe fgasgfwidth is same for all
wavele
ngths (L)) The position o f central maxima remains unchanged If the distance d i
s varied, then identify th e correct statement (A) The angular width does not ch
ange (B) The fringe width c hanges in inverse proportion (C) The positions of al
l maxima change (D) The posi tions of all minima change 1 dcntify tlie correct s
tatement(s) if the source sli t S moved closer to S, S , i.e. the distance I. de
creases 0 k ) nothing happens tofringepattern JB) fiinge pattern may gets less s
harp 2 Question No. 16 to 19 (4 questions) Answer Key CI'3 V 91 0 V Zlb 3' 0 8 b
9 a'3'a 6i Q v si b v Vb a'3'a L'b * zb 5 0 V 9t>'b a 6'b 3 zzb V srb 3 si b a nb
3 vb SI NOIIdO a ' a 81 b a'3 V M b 3'v orb 3V 3'V V a V V a a a 3 9b zb a'QV A
I Q 9 i b Q eb aV s b a'a \b 3NO ID3UU0D 33 A VIM NOlid O 3N0 NVHI 3U01M 0 V 9Sb
3 ovb 3 zvb V srb V 8 Zb 3 i zb 3 w b V Lb a ss b a 8 vb 3 ivb a \7Zb V Lib V 0
zb a Zlb a 9b
a 3 V 3 V a a 3 LVb t?sb 017-Q, b 9 Zb 6ib a zs b srb 8 Zb Zl b sb izb t?zb Lib o
rb zb V 3 V 3 3 a a 3 isO t?rb LZb 0 zb zzb zb 9ib 6b 3 os b V zvb a 9b 3 6 tb a
zzb a sib V 8b V rb ID3HH0D 3NO A3 NO fa Bansal Classes Question Bank On Wave Op
tics [91